Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
INTERNATIONAL
BIOLOGY OLYMPIAD
Past Papers (1990-2013)
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Some bacteria possess an additional mechanism to regulate the production of enzymes involved
in tryptophan (Trp) biosynthesis. The (Trp) operon possesses, prior to the actual genes (trpA-E), a
leader sequence (trpL), coding for a leader peptide. trpL contains two tryptophan codons next to
each other.
Promoter
Operator
At high tryptophan concentrations, the ribosome translates the mRNA of the leader peptide and
stalls at its stop codon, thereby masking segment 2 of the mRNA and allowing segments 3 and 4
to form a stem loop. A stem loop followed by poly-U is a termination signal for the RNA
polymerase (RNA pol), which falls o the DNA.
complete leader peptide
ribosome
RNA polymerase
mRNA
Trp codons
DNA
However, at low tryptophan concentrations, the ribosome gets stalled at the tryptophan codons
allowing 2 and 3 to form a stem loop. The whole tryptophan operon can be transcribed by the
RNA polymerase.
ribosome
incomplete leader peptide
2
1
mRNA
RNA polymerase
Trp codons
DNA
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
the mechanism works only if the translation begins before the transcription nishes. In eukaryotes, the transcription
happens in the nucleus, then the mRNA is exported to the cytoplasm where it is translated and this mechanism cannot
work in this form.
B false
by reduced concentrations of the tryptophan's aminoacyl-tRNA synthetase, tRNA loaded with tryptophan will be
formed slower than in the normal case, so that less tRNA-Trp will be present. To inactivate the transcription of the
trpA-E genes, a higher tryptophan concentration than in the normal case is needed.
C true
with only 1 Trp codon, a lower concentration of Trp can still allow translation of the leader peptide and therefore
inhibit the synthesis of the enzymes.
D true
a mutation destabilizing stem loop 1-2 will promote the formation of stem loop 2-3 even at low tryptophan
concentrations, inhibiting the transcription of the trpA-E genes.
References
Walsh et al, Biochemistry (1979)
Bacterial count of a liquid culture can be determined by dierent methods: 1) Cells can be
counted under a microscope using a counting chamber, 2) the absorbance of the culture can be
measured in a spectrophotometer (with A600 = 1 corresponding to 8x108 bacterial cells/ml) or 3)
several dilutions of the culture can be plated on agar and the colonies can be counted (see
picture) to calculate the number of colony forming units per milliliter (cfu/ml).
Colony count
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
A culture with an OD600 = 0.1 and a doubling time of 30 minutes will have an OD600 = 0.2 after 30 minutes, 0.4 after 1
hour, and 0.8 after 1:30 hour, therefore it will will reach 4*108 cells/ml in less than 2 hours (4x108) cells correspond to
an OD = 0.5).
B true
Counting colonies on plates gives the number of cfu/ml, and only living cells can form colonies, whereas under the
microscope, dead cells are also counted.
C true
The plate giving the most accurate results is the one with 160 colonies that corresponds to a 1:1000 dilution of the
starting culture X. 160*1000 = 1.6x105
D true
The dilution f contains 0.16 cells/ml. Statistically, by plating it more than six times, colonies should grow.
In a living organism, cells die either through apoptosis (programmed cell death) or necrosis (cells
swell and burst).
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. Apoptosis is induced in immature T-cells that recognize self antigens.
B. Intestinal epithelial cells losing contact with the basal lamina undergo apoptosis.
C. Neural stem cells undergoing apoptosis expose on their surface a signal promoting
phagocytosis.
D. Necrosis often induces an inammatory immune response.
A. True
B. True
Original commentary
C. True
D. True
The chorismate pathway leading to the synthesis of aromatic amino acids in yeast is presented
here.
Prephenate
Erythrose-4-P
Chorismate
Phosphoenolpyruvate
CM = Chorismate mutase
AS = Anthranilate synthase
Anthranilate
The velocity of the enzyme chorismate mutase (CM) was measured in the presence of either
tryptophan (+Trp) or tyrosine (+Tyr), as well as in the absence of both (--).
Trp
Tyr
4
6
[Chorismate]
10
Based on these results and the pathway scheme, indicate if each of the following
statements is true or false.
A. Tryptophan increases the activity of chorismate mutase.
B. Tryptophan, but not tyrosine inhibits the synthesis of chorismate.
C. A high concentration of tyrosine is likely to increase the synthesis of tryptophan.
D. The prephenate and the anthranilate branches compete for chorismate.
A. True
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Under addition of tryptophane, at the same chorismate concentrations, the speed is higher
B false
The synthesis of erythrose-4-P is neither inhibited by tryptophan, nor by tyrosine. It would not make sense that only
tryptophan inhibits E4P, since E4P is needed for the synthesis of both tryptophan and tyrosine and their synthesis is
regulated dierently.
C true
When the tyrosine concentration is increased, CM gets slower, and the chorismate will be used by AS instead to
produce tryptophane.
D true
Both pathway branches have chorismate as a starting point and the positive/negative regulation by Trp/Tyr hints that
chorismate is not present in unlimited supply.
References
Schnappauf et al, Biochemistry (1998)
The following schematic shows a stage of cell division for an eukaryotic diploid cell.
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
as the chromosomes are dierent from each other in the picture, they cannot arise from pairs of chromosomes, which
would need to be the case for mitosis of a eukaryotic diploid cell.
B true
during meiosis II, the 2 chromatids are distributed between daughter cells.
C true
to reach anaphase, molecular motors working on microtubule are needed for the expansion of microtubuli
D false
in this stage, the DNA is highly condensed and not available to transcription. Furthermore, new histone proteins are
particularly necessary during the S-phase where the DNA is duplicated and needs to be packaged, not in the
anaphase.
The sensitivity of an enzyme for dierent inhibitors is assessed. The rate of product formation
was measured at dierent concentrations of substrate with 10 nM enzyme. The initial velocity v i
Initial velocity
(at t = 0 s) was calculated and plotted as a function of the substrate concentration in the absence
or presence of two dierent inhibitors.
no inhibitor
Inhibitor 1
Inhibitor 2
Substrate concentration
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Km is the [substrate] at which half the maximal velocity is reached, in this case v max is 300 nM/s, vmax/2 = 150 nM/s,
which corresponds to 0.5 M
B true
With inhibitor 1, only the KM is aected, not the vmax. The reaction to proceed at the same speed as without inhibitor if
more substrate is added (corresponds to a competitive inhibitor).
C true
The vmax is reduced (150 nM/s instead of 300 nM/s without inhibitor): corresponds to an uncompetitive inhibitor.
D true
kcat = vmax / [Enzyme] = (150 nM/s) / (10 nM) = 15/s
Three yeast strains (Saccharomyces cerevisiae) have been engineered to each contain a gene for
a dierent enzyme from glycolysis (Tpi, Eno or Pyk) under the control of a doxycycline-repressed
promoter such that addition of doxycycline down-regulates the synthesis of the corresponding
enzyme. Concentrations of some metabolites are measured in each yeast strain grown on glucose
at dierent doxycycline concentrations, relative to the concentrations without doxycycline.
Relevant steps of the glycolysis are shown above the measurements with metabolites and
enzymes abbreviated as follows:
Metabolites
Enzymes
ATP-dependent phosphofructokinase
fructose 6-phosphate
fructose 1,6-biphosphate
Aldolase
dihydroxyacetone phosphate
2- and 3-phosphoglycerate
Enolase
phosphoenolpyruvate
Pyruvate kinase
Tpi strain
Eno strain
Pyk strain
Doxycycline concentration
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
even if the substrate of the down-regulated enzyme undergoes a big concentration change, the concentrations of other
metabolites stays similar.
B true
as seen from the graphs, the metabolite undergoing the biggest change is the substrate of the down-regulated enzyme.
C false
down-regulation of Tpi aects strongly (more than 10 fold) the levels of DHAP, its substrate, but the concentration of
FBP stays constant, thus the equilibrium of FBP DHAP is strongly on the side of DHAP. In contrary, down-regulation
of Pyk does not only aect the concentration of PEP, its direct substrate, but also of 2+3PG, the substrate of the
previous enzyme in the pathway, Eno. This means that the increased level of PEP is enough to shift the equilibrium of
2+3PG PEP back to 2+3PG, therefore the equilibrium is not as strongly on the side of the glycolytic product than
FBP DHAP.
D true
During the reaction of F6P to FBP, ATP is hydrolyzed to phosphorylate F6P. Therefore, the equilibrium is strongly on
the side of FBP. Down-regulation of Al would result in an increase of the FBP concentration, but since the equilibrium
is strongly on the side of FBP (even more strongly than for the reaction FBP DHAP), the concentration of F6P will
stay unaected.
References
Fendt et al, Molecular Systems Biology (2010)
Some substances need to be transported (actively or passively) from their site of synthesis to the
location where they are active.
Indicate for each of the following substances if they are transported from the cytoplasm
to the nucleus.
A. tRNAs
B. Histone proteins
C. Nucleotides
D. ATP-synthase subunits
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
tRNAs are synthesized in the nucleus, but need to get to the cytoplasm to be used by the ribosome.
B true
Histones are proteins synthesized in the cytoplasm, but need to get to the nucleus to bind to the DNA.
C true
Nucleotides are obtained by endo/picocytosis or synthesized in the cytoplasm, but need to get to the nucleus to be
used in DNA replication and transcription.
D false
The ATP-synthase is a membrane protein synthetised in the cytoplasm (on the ER membrane) and transported to the
plasma membrane, but not to the nucleus
inhibition
CDK7
CyclinB
CDK1
entry in M-phase
phosphorylation
dephosphorylation
Indicate for each of the following mutations if it would promote entry into the M-phase
by activating the CyclinB/CDK1 complex.
A. A mutation that reduces the dephosphorylating activity of Cdc25.
B. A mutation that reduces the phosphorylating activity of Wee1.
C. A mutation that changes the ThrC of CDK1 to a valine that cannot be phosphorylated.
D. A mutation that inhibits the binding of CyclinH to CDK7.
A. False
B. True
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Cdc25 by dephosphorylating CDK1 at Tyr15 and Thr14 activates CDK1 (removes the inactivation). By reducing its
activity, CyclinB/CDK1 would be less active
B true
Wee1 inactivates CDK1 by phosphorylating it at Tyr15.
C false
to be active, CDK1 needs to have Thr161 phosphorylated, with a valine at position 161, CDK1 would be always inactive
D false
CDK7 needs to be bound to CyclinH and phosphorylated at Thr170 to be active and able to phosphorylate (and
therefore activate) CDK1 in complex with CyclinB. This mutation in CyclinH would make it unable to bind CDK7 which
would stay in an inactive state.
References
Fussenegger et al, Biotechnol. Prog. (1998)
10
To determine the precise transcription start site (TSS) of a newly discovered bacterial gene
promoter, a radioactively labeled primer complementary to the 3'-end of the gene is used both for
Sanger sequencing of the DNA construct and for primer extension of the mRNA. Primer extension
(similar to cDNA synthesis) is repeated on mRNA transcribed with addition of the transcription
factor .
Sanger sequencing
TSS
DNA
promoter
primer
transcription
Primer extension
TSS
primer
mRNA
The fragments obtained are separated by gel electrophoresis, a radiography is presented below.
Sanger sequencing
Primer extension
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
For Sanger sequencing, a DNA polymerase is needed, whereas for primer extension, reverse transcriptase is used.
B true
The PE lane on the radiography gives the length of the mRNA. The rst (most 5') base of the main mRNA corresponds
to the fragment from the sequencing with the same length (here: G). The second most 5' base of the mRNAc
corresponds from the sequencing one nucleotide shorter (=one band lower on the radiography) than PE (here: A).
C true
For this gene, a main and a secondary TSS exist.
D false
Transcription in the absence or presence of produces the same ratio of mRNA starting from the main and the
secondary TSS.
11
High levels of triglycerides in the bloodstream have been linked to higher risks of heart diseases.
An agonist (activating molecule) S of receptor Y was observed to reduce the triglycerides levels.
How could one convincingly prove that the eect of S is mediated specically via
receptor Y?
A. Generate genetically modied mice which overexpress (more than physiological) receptor Y.
B. Generate genetically modied mice in which receptor Y is knocked out (deleted).
C. Treat the mice with an antagonist (inactivating molecule) specic for receptor Y.
D. Treat the mice with an antibody that sequesters (removing from circulation) S.
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Even if the decrease in triglycerides levels observed would be more important than with wild-type mice, this is not
enough to prove that S-Y interaction is either suicient or necessary for the decrease.
B true
If in these mice, triglycerides levels decrease after addition of S, it is not mediated by Y. If no decrease can be
observed, the interaction of S and Y is necessary for the decrease in triglycerides levels
C true
If Y is inactivated by an antagonist, treatment with S should not decrease triglycerides levels, it shows that S-Y
interaction is necessary for the decrease in triglycerides levels. If a decrease would be observed, it would show that S
mediates triglycerides levels decrease via an other mechanism.
D false
Even if no decrease in triglycerides levels would be observed, this would only prove that S is necessary to decrease
triglycerides, but would not prove that it acts via Y.
12
Bilirubin is a breakdown product of heme catabolism which is transported to the liver where it is
conjugated to two glucuronic acid molecules by the enzyme UGT (see gure below). Conjugated
bilirubin is then secreted in the small intestine as a component of the bile.
B. False
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Glucuronic acid is a hydrophilic molecule, whereas bilirubin is hydrophobic and insoluble in water. Conjugation with
glucuronic acid increases its solubility in water.
B false
When the bile cannot enter the small intestine, the conjugated bilirubin accumulates in the bile duct and moves back
upwards in the intrahepatic bile ducts and enters the blood. As a result the conjugation is reduced or even stops
causing an accumulation of unconjugated bilirubin too.
C false
If the UGT is not working properly (like in patients suering from Morbus Meulengracht), the conjugation of bilirubin
is reduced and the level of unconjugated bilirubin is increased.
D true
At one stage, Plasmodium falciparum reproduces in erythrocytes. These erythrocytes burst when releasing ospring
parasites, leading to a liberation of hemoglobin, which in turn increases the level of bilirubin in the blood, which will
be conjugated.
13
While osteoblasts are secreting new bone material, they can trigger osteoclasts to break down
existing bone by excreting the protein RANKL, which activates its receptor RANK in osteoclasts.
This pathway is stimulated by either vitamin D (D3) or parathyroid hormone (PTH). In the
presence of oestrogen (E2), however, osteoblasts inhibit that process by secreting
osteoprotegerin (OPG), which sequesters RANKL.
Osteoblast
PTH
DNA
mRNA
DNA
mRNA
Osteoclast
cAMP
Bone formation
Bone resorption
Bone
B. True
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
After menopause the estrogen level declines. Estrogen replacement therapy increases OPG levels and prevents
thereby RANKL to bind to RANK, which would activate osteoclasts.
B true
Loss of bones mass is a symptom of hyperparathyroidism, where increased production of PTH leads to increased levels
of RANKL and increased osteoclast activity
C false
Estrogen and Vitamin D are lipophilic hormones as shown above they have to cross the cell membrane to operate
whereas PTH needs to bind to a extracellular receptor as it is hydrophilic and cannot cross the membrane
D false
Renal loss of calcium leads to a decrease of plasma calcium level which causes a elevation of PTH. PTH indirectly
activates osteoclasts which resorb bone, process during which calcium is released into the blood. This reestablishes
the calcium plasma level.
References
Seeman et al, NEJM (2006)
Stavros et al, NEJM (1995)
Weinstein et al, NEJM (2009)
14
Wing development in chickens starts with the formation of a wing bud which will develop into a
full wing consisting of three digits.
digit 2
digit 3
digit 4
To decipher development of digits, the zone III of the left wing was grafted as an additional zone
III in the wing bud of the right wing during early development. The resulting digit morphology
relative to the somite position is presented below for dierent positions of grafting (indicated by
Z).
control
graft experiments
somites
wing buds
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
No digits could develop at position of somites 14/15-16 where zone I is absent.
B true
A high concentration of the signal (near zone III) leads to formation of digit 4, a middle concentration to digit 3, a low
one to digit 2. Grafting a second zone III close enough to the normal one increases the concentration of the signal and
promotes the formation of digits 3/4 (see e.g. when Z is grafted at somite 17, the digit pattern posterior of it is 4-3-3-4,
without digit 2 being formed.
C true
The results suggest that digit number 4 is only formed next to a zone III. In fact, such a transplantation would result in
no digit being formed by somite 19.
D false
If it was the case, a digit 2 could only be formed next to a digit 3 itself near to a digit 4. As seen when Z is grafted at
somites 15 or 15/16, this is not the case, a digit 2 can be formed even in the absence of a digit 3/4 next to it.
References
Tickle et al, Nature (1975)
15
A neuron is kept in a solution similar to the extracellular uid of brain tissue under a pure oxygen
atmosphere. After a few minutes, cyanide, a substance that blocks the electron transport chain, is
added to the solution.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. The concentration of K+ ions in the cell increases.
B. The probability of a spontaneous action potential increases.
C. The concentration of H+ ions in the intermembrane space of the mitochondria increases.
D. The concentration of bicarbonate in the solution decreases.
A. False
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Addition of cyanide leads to a rapid depletion of ATP in the neuron. As a consequence, the Na + / K+ pump will no
longer exchange Na+ against K+ inside the cell. Through diusion, the distribution of ions will be equalized across the
cell membrane, and hence the concentration of K+ will decrease in the cell.
B true
With an increase of the membrane potential due to diusion (see A), the probability of a spontaneous action potential
increases.
C false
The concentration of H+ is kept high in the intermembrane space of the mitochondria by the electron transport chain.
After blocking this chain, the concentration quickly decreases through the production of ATP at the ATP-synthetase.
D true
After adding cyanide, the cell stops emitting CO2. The CO2 dissolved as bicarbonate in the solution from before adding
cyanide is entering the atmosphere with an extremely low partial pressure of CO 2 (as it was initially pure O2).
16
Concentration in blood
The eectiveness of antibiotic treatments depends on the time and concentration at which
bacteria are exposed to a specic drug, which in turn depends on the dosage, the intake interval
and the rate of drug elimination from the body. Two antibiotics X and Y, both somewhat toxic to
humans, are excreted by the kidney, but Y is also eliminated in the liver through cytochrome
complexes. While X makes the bacterial cell wall permeable for ions, Y inhibits the synthesis of
the cell wall during cell division. The gure below shows the average concentration of drugs X
(red) and Y (blue) measured in healthy individuals after a single intake of 500 mg or 250 mg,
along with the minimal concentration at which target bacteria are inhibited to grow in vitro (MIC,
solid black line).
MIC
10
12
14
16
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Drug X is eliminated only renally and thus in renal insuicient patients, the consideration of the risk of accumulation
of drug X is important. By increasing the intake interval, the kidney has more time to eliminate the drug and hence the
risk of accumulation is reduced.
B false
As shown in the graph a dosage of drug X of 250 mg causes blood concentration higher than MC only for 2-3 h but a
dosage of drug X of 500 mg causes blood concentration higher than MC for approx. 8 h, meaning more than double of
a dosage of 250 mg and meaning the interval has to be more than doubled.
C false
Substances inhibiting the cytochrome complexes (e.g. grapefruit) leads to slower inactivation/excretion of drug Y and
hence patients treated with this drug have to be given lower dosages or asked to increase the intake intervals to
prevent accumulation and intoxication.
D false
As bacteria cell division is a continuing process and bacteria divide not simultaneously the concentration of drug Y has
to be as a therapeutic level (higher than MC). A change in the membrane permeability of ions causes rapid bacterial
damage and death consecutively.
References
Tulane University; MIC & Time- vs Concentration-Dependent Killing
17
Dysfunctions of endocrine glands can be classied into three types, depending on the hormone
directly aected:
Primary endocrine dysfunctions alter the production of hormones with direct systemic eects
on metabolism or development.
Secondary endocrine dysfunctions alter the production of tropic hormones that act on other
glands.
Tertiary endocrine dysfunctions aect the hypothalamus.
Indicate for each of the following statements if it is true or false.
A. A patient with an elevated cortisol level, a reduced corticotropin-releasing hormone (CRH)
level and a elevated adrenocorticotropic hormone (ACTH) level is most likely aected by a
primary dysfunction.
B. An overproduction of the thyroid stimulating hormone TSH can be due to a primary
dysfunction.
C. An increased blood concentration of cortisol may be due to a tumor implying a primary or a
secondary dysfunction.
D. In the case of a tumor leading to a secondary endocrine dysfunctions, the blood concentration
of the corresponding releasing hormone is changed.
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The most likely explanation is a secondary dysfunction leading to an overproduction of ACTH, which in turn leads to an
elevated Cortisol level and, due to feedback, an decreased CRH level.
B true
Due to feedback interactions, a primary underproduction leads to an increase in the corresponding tropic hormone.
C true
A hormone-producing tumor of the adrenal gland as a primary dysfunction elevates the cortisol. The same is caused
secondary due a overproduction of ACTH causing a stimulation of the adrenal gland. The latter results in a
overproduction of cortisol.
D true
A secondary dysfunction aects the tropic hormone through a feedback mechanism.
References
Campbell Biology
18
Inhibiting platelet aggregation after a coronary intervention has been shown to greatly reduce
the risk of complications. The eectiveness of two competing inhibitors was assessed in a clinical
study in which 13,608 patients with symptoms of a myocardial infarction were randomly assigned
to a treatment with either inhibitor A or B after the intervention. The gure below shows the
fraction of patients that suered from a second cardiovascular incident such as an infarction or a
stroke, as well as the fraction of those that suered from major bleeding in the 400 days post
intervention.
Fraction of patients
Major bleeding
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Inhibitor B does indeed decrease the risk of a secondary cardiovascular incident, but at the same time increases the
risk of a major bleeding.
B true
The study suggests that patients treated with inhibitor B have a reduced risk of a secondary cardiovascular incidence
even after day 3. This can be read from the gure since the absolute dierence in the fraction of patients with a
secondary cardiovascular incident is increasing from day 3 to day 400. If there were no dierence in the eects after
day 3, the risk to suer a secondary cardiovascular incident in the following 397 days would be the same in both
treatments. Hence the number of patients with such an incident between days 3 and 400 can be calculated as
n*(1-f(3))*r where f(3) is the fraction at day 3, n the total number of patients and r the rate. The total fraction of
patients at day 400 is then given by f(400)=(f(3)*n + (1-f(3))*n*r)/n = f(3)+(1-f(3))*r=f(3)*(1-r)+r. The absolute
dierence at day 400 is thus (fA(3)*(1-r)+r) (fB(3)*(1-r)+r)=(1-r)*(fA(3)-fB(3)), which is always smaller than fA(3)f(B(3) unless r=0. But note that the students do not need to make these calculations but just realize that the absolute
dierence increases.
C true
To calculate the reduction in the total amount of aected patients, one need to compute the reduction from 5.8% to
4.9% of all patients, which is a reduction by 1-4.9/5.8=15.5%. Note that the exact numbers the students read o the
graph do not matter, as to get a reduction of less than 10%, the student would need to misread the percentage of
inhibitor A to be 9% or more.
D false
Given the known reduction in the risk of complications when inhibiting platelet aggregation it would not be ethical not
to give some patient any platelet inhibitor. In addition, the use of a placebo could only reairm the benecial use of
such an inhibitor but not add value to the comparison between inhibitors A and B.
References
Wiviott et al, NEJM (2007)
19
There is variability in the proteins transporting O2, and their ainities for O2, both within and
between organisms.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. At the same partial pressure of O2, the saturation of fetal hemoglobin is higher than the
saturation of the maternal hemoglobin.
B. Hemoglobin has a lower ainity to O2 in the vicinity of cells performing anaerobic glycolysis
heavily.
C. The hemoglobin of deep-diving mammals has a higher oxygen ainity than the hemoglobin of
mammals adapted to high altitude.
D. Hemoglobin is more eicient in transporting O2 than is hemocyanin, the equivalent protein of
many arthropods that binds O2 non-cooperatively.
A. True
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
This is an adaptation of the fetal hemoglobin to recruit oxygen from the maternal blood.
B true
Cells relying heavily on anaerobic glycolysis recycle their NADH by fermenting lactate, which increases the acidity of
the blood in the vicinity. In a more acidic environment, hemoglobin changes its conformation, which in turn reduces its
ainity for oxygen (Bohr eect). This is an eective way to release oxygen where it is needed most.
C false
The opposite is true. Mammals that are deep divers need hemoglobin that releases most of the oxygen in the blood.
Mammals adapted to high altitude, in contrast, need to ll their hemoglobin with oxygen in the lungs even at low
partial pressure, and hence have hemoglobin with higher ainity.
D true
The cooperativity between the dierent hemoglobin subunits allow for a larger dierence in ainity between the place
of oxygen uptake and oxygen release (a sigmoid dissociation curve).
20
The Hepatitis B virus contains the antigens HBs, HBc and HBe, of which HBs is commonly used
as a vaccine. HBe is expressed in only some strains. The following table shows the presence (+)
or absence (-) of viral antigens and antibodies measured in some patients. A question mark (?)
indicates that the respective test was not performed.
Patient
+
+
?
?
?
-
?
+
?
-
+
+
?
-
?
+
?
+
+
+
-
?
+
?
+
?
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Since vaccination is done using HBs, a vaccinated person is producing anti-HBs IgG after several weeks. A Hepatitis
infection, however would also lead to anti HBc and often anti-HBe antibodies, which were not found in P1.
B true
While no antigens were found, P2 produces IgG against all three antigens, even those not used in vaccination.
C true
The antigen HBe was found in P3, which is a good indication that the virus is present. In addition, the immune system
of P3 started its rst response by producing IgM antibodies. Since P4 shows anti-HBc and anti-HBe IgG, he or she
must have been infected at one point. The presence of HBs strongly suggest that the infection is still in progress since
the only alternative would be a very recent vaccination, which is unlikely to be applied to an already immunized
person.
D true
The presence of anti-HBs IgM suggest a recent and exposure to HBs. However, since HBc and HBe antigens are not
present, the likely source of exposure was a recent vaccination.
21
Participants of the IBO 2013 are going to visit mount Niederhorn. Before and right after a rapid
ascent by cable car from 400 m to 2000 m and just before descent 3 hours later, physiological
parameters of several participants will be measured and compared to the same measurements
obtained from an alpine herder who stayed on the Niederhorn for more than two consecutive
months. The participants are expected to hyperventilate at this altitude and get dehydrated.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. The heart rate of an IBO participant just after arriving on top is expected to be higher than
just before the ascent.
B. The pH of the blood of the alpine herder is expected to be higher than the pH of the blood of
an IBO participant when arriving on top.
C. The pH of the urine of an IBO participant is expected to be higher just before descent than
just after arriving on top.
D. Some IBO participants are expected to show a transient increase in the hemoglobin
concentration while on top.
A. True
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
The hypoxemia due to the lower partial concentration of oxygen will be compensated by an increased heart and
respiratory rate .
B false
The blood pH is tightly controlled and is not expected to change substantially. If any change is observed, then the pH
of the IBO participant is expected to increase due to hyperventilation, followed by a rapid reduction in the
carbondioxyde concentration in the blood.
C true
Due to hyperventilation, the carbondioxyde concentration in the blood is decreased rapidly. To prevent an increase of
the blood pH, the body excretes basic metabolites through the urine, leading to an increase of the urine pH.
D true
To avoid an increase of the blood pH (see answer to C), the kidney excretes basic metabolites, often leading to
dehydration, which is followed by an increase of the hemoglobin concentration in the blood. What is more
hyperventilation (especially on high altitudes) leads to dehydration, too.
References
Campell Biology
22
The rapid evolution of the inuenza antigen Hemagglutinin (HA) is a major challenge for the
development of eicient treatments. In order to identify antibodies eective against a wide
variety of inuenza strains, 13,000 plasma cells of a vaccinated person were individually isolated
and triggered to produce antibodies. These antibodies were tested against dierent types of HA
(H5 VN/04, H7 NE/03 and the mix present in the vaccine) by measuring their binding strength
(gure A). The binding eicacy of two particularly promising antibodies X and Y against several
HA types from groups 1 (red) and 2 (blue) was further assessed by measuring the required
concentration to achieve half the maximal binding eicacy (EC50, gure B). As a comparison, the
EC50 was also measured for an anti-HIV antibody (HIV) and an antibody X* produced by plasma
cells originally producing X but in which all mutations have been reverted to obtain the
corresponding sequence originally inherited from the parents.
group 1
H7 NE/03
>
group 2
Vaccine
Binding strength
Binding strength
H5 VN/04
HIV
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
As can be seen in the lower panel of gure A, there are a large number of plasma cells producing antibodies against
the HA present in the vaccine.
B true
This can be seen in gure B where antibody Y does not bind all group 1 HA better than the control antibody against
HIV.
C true
Since the germ line copies of all genes do not concur immunity, the dierence between X and X* antibodies must be
due to somatic mutations that occurred in the cell line leading to the plasma cell producing X. Note that somatic
mutations and rearrangements are common in antibody producing cells, a likely adaptation to deal with a wider range
of antigens.
D false
While an injection of antibody X concurs passive immunity against a wide range of inuenza strains, it does not
provide active immunity. Therefore, immunization will not last for more than a couple of weeks or maximally month.
References
Corti et al, Science (2011)
23
The following schematics illustrate two severe congenital heart malformations occasionally found
in newborns.
II
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Note
In the heart Malformation I, the aorta comes out of the right ventricle (instead of the left one) and the pulmonary
artery out of the left ventricle (instead of the right one). In Malformation II, the aorta is narrowed.
Correct answers
A true
This is true because there is no connection between the pulmonary blood circulation and the systemic one.
B true
As mentioned in the answer note the origins of the aorta and pulmonary artery are swapped.
C true
The narrowing of the isthmus of the aorta causes an increased resistance at this location leading to a reduced ow
downwards the aorta which increases the blood ow in the arteriae of the upper extremities and the head/brain. The
latter increases the blood pressure consecutively.
As a second mechanism the decreased blood ow in the aorta descendens/aorta abdominalis and in the ow renal
arteries consecutively. As a physiological mechanism the kidney rises the circular blood pressure to try to increase the
renal blood ow.
D false
The suggested operation does not change the patients problem. What is more it would create the same separation of
the pulmonary and systemic circulation as in Malformation I.
References
Universittsklinikum Bonn; D-Transposition der groen Arterien
24
In a community of marine brown algae (Phaeophyta), two multicellular life forms are observed
among the species:
1) A tall and fast-growing form that is strongly aected by environmental seasonality and
shows a high mortality.
2) A tiny and slow-growing form that is less sensitive to seasonality and shows a low mortality.
All species alternate between a haploid and a diploid generation. Isomorphic species show the tall
form both in the haploid and diploid generation. The life form of heteromorphic species, however,
depends on ploidy.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. Proportion of isomorphic species is likely to increase with more intense seasonality.
B. In heteromorphic species, the tall and fast-growing life form is observed during the more
productive season.
C. Heteromorphic species are limited to one generation each season (winter/summer).
D. In these algae, haploid full siblings from diploid parents are genetically less related than
diploid full siblings from haploid parents.
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The description of the small life form is giving a hint that it is adapted to endure a tougher, less productive season
(winter). A species with the tall and fast growing form alone will have an increasing handicap in regions with a more
intense winter compared to heteromorphic species more adapted to endure a tough season.
B true
As the tall life form is adapted to fast growth during summer, it will be more competitive during summer as compared
to individuals with the small life form present during summer.
C true
The small life form is adapted to outlive the unproductive winter - during summer the small life form would implicate a
loss of productivity. On the same time, the tall life form would be very vulnerable during winter and most likely not
survive. So heteromorphic species only make one new generation at the end of each season.
D true
Haploid plants derive from spores which are products of a meiosis and have only one parent. Therefore siblings share
half of their genome in average. Diploid plants derive from a zygote out of two gametes, resulting themselves from a
meiosis of their parents. All gametes from each parent are genetically identical, as are the full siblings among each
other.
References
Bessho et al, Evolutionary Ecology Research (2009)
25
A growing plant can be described by units called metamers (illustrated by boxes) that are
produced by a vegetative meristem. Each metamer consists of a stem segment and an additional
meristem that is inactive at rst, but may become active and develop into a vegetative meristem.
Vegetative mersitems can develop into a owering meristem. Vegetative and owering meristems
produce auxin, which is constantly transported downwards to lower metamers. The gure below
shows a plant at dierent ages ending up owering and illustrates the auxin concentration found
in each metamer.
metamer
inactive
owering
vegetative
root
auxin concentration
Based on the observed auxin concentrations, indicate if each of the following statements
is true or false.
A. Exceeding a minimal auxin threshold invariably activates meristems.
B. An apex turning to a owering stage is losing its apical dominance.
C. A high auxin concentration is enough to trigger the development of owers.
D. Auxin from dierent apical metamers can have cumulative eects on subsequent metamers.
A. False
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The opposite is true, below a certain threshold the apical dominance is lost and the uppermost inactive meristem is
activated.
B true
A metamer turning into a ower is reducing its production of auxin, so the concentration of auxin sinks in the
subsequent metamer and falls under the threshold needed to suppress meristem activation.
C false
If this was true, all meristems would turn into a owers.
D true
The residual auxin from all four owering apices accumulates along the stem and prevents the subsequent metamer
from being activated. /br>
References
Przemyslaw et al, PNAS (2009)
26
Two stable carbon isotopes 12C and 13C are present in the atmosphere, but 12C is approximately
100 times more frequent. Diverse metabolic processes discriminate against 13C in favor of 12C,
leading to a smaller proportion of 13C in biomass than in the atmosphere. The relative dierence
between expected and observed proportion is indicated by 13C, with a more negative value
indicating a stronger discrimination. The gure shows the distribution of 13C-values found in
plant species with C3 and C4 metabolism.
C4
C3
13C
13C
than the
reaction of RuBisCO.
C. Meat from cattle feeding on a meadow in the Swiss mountains is likely to have a lower
content than from cattle feeding in a central African savanna.
13C
D. It is possible to distinguish between puried sugar from sugar cane (C 4) and sugar beet (C3)
based on their mass.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Actually the opposite is true. The aim of the C4 metabolism is to increase the partial pressure of CO2 for RuBisCO to
increase the proportion of the carboxylase reaction compared to the oxigenase reaction. The higher partial pressure is
actually the reason of weaker discrimination of 13C in C4 plants.
B false
This reaction is the rst xation step in C4-plants which are less discriminative than C3 plants.
C true
C4 plants are much more present in tropical ecosystems than in temperate or cold ecosystem. The isotope ratio is
reported upwards in the food chain to herbivores and predators.
D true
As 13C is slightly heavier than 12C, the mean weight of a sugar molecule from cane is slightly higher.
27
Seeds of most plants are more resistant to environmental stress before germination has been
initiated. To demonstrate this, seeds of wheat (Triticum aestivum) were exposed to one of the
following four treatments.
Treatments
A
B
C
D
Soaked
5 h at room T
5 h at room T
-
Incubated
5 h; -20C
5 h; 30C
5 h; 4C
5 h; 50C
Indicate for each of the following treatments, if the seeds are expected to produce
sprouts (true), or not (false).
A. Treatment A.
B. Treatment B.
C. Treatment C.
D. Treatment D.
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
B true
C true
D true
References
Campbell Biology, 9th ed., p. 84-85 and gure 5.22 ("What determines protein structure?") and pages 807. and gure
39.11 ("Seed Development, Form, and Function").
28
The gure below shows the leaf temperature of two groups of common bean (Phaseolus vulgaris)
plants exposed to infrared light. One group (open squares) was kept at optimal water supply and
the other group (triangles) was drought stressed for 4 month before the experiment.
Temperature in leaves
42
Based on these results, indicate if each of the following statements is likely to be true or
false.
A. After 8 minutes of heat exposure, drought stressed plants kept more stomata open than
control plants.
B. The ability to regulate the opening and closing of stomata decreases over time in plants of
both groups.
C. Following about 15 minutes of heat exposure, leaves of drought stressed plants absorbed
roughly the same amount of thermal energy as they emitted.
D. Plants experience a trade-o between preventing water loss and protection from
over-heating.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Note
If stomata are open, transpiration increases and therefore leaf temperature decreases (through evaporative cooling).
The opposite is true for closing of stomata.
Correct answers
A false
B false
C true
D true
References
Reynolds-Henne et al, Environmental and Experimental Botany et al (2009)
Campbell, Biology (9th ed.) page 778 ("Eects of Transpiration on Wilting and Leaf Temperature").
29
In a buered suspension of freshly isolated thylakoids incubated in light, the rate of the Hill
reaction (photolysis) can be measured using DCPIP. DCPIP is reduced at Photosystem I and
changes its colour from blue to colourless.
Indicate for each of the following modications of the experimental setting if it would
signicantly reduce the rate of this reaction.
A. Raising the temperature of the solution from 20 C to 30 C.
B. Removing soluble gases from the buer solution prior to adding thylakoids.
C. Adding DCMU, a herbicide that binds to Photosystem II.
D. Adding 2,4-D, a herbicide acting as a synthetic auxin.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Temperature remains in the physiological optimum and the rate is expected to increase with temperature.
B false
No oxygen nor CO2 is needed for electron transport chain.
C true
If the electron transport chain is interrupted, DCPIP will not be reduced and the suspension will not turn colourless.
D false
Auxin has no eect on electron transport chain.
References
Campbell Biology, 9th ed., p. 193-194 (electron transport chain).
30
Infrared pictures are used to visualise the temperature of a plant surface. The gure below shows
the photograph of a plant and the corresponding infrared picture.
Based on the gure, indicate for each of the following statements if it is true or false.
A. Due to growing in the shade of older leaves, younger leaves of this plant are cooler than older
leaves.
B. Plant parts with high metabolic activity get several degrees warmer than parts with lower
metabolic activity.
C. Transpiration in leaf veins is signicantly lower than in leaf blades.
D. The high temperature of leaf A indicates that this plant begins suering drought stress.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Younger leaves are actually warmer than older leaves because they are transpiring less. The really old leaves in
senescing state are warmer, but do not provide shade.
B false
While metabolism may indeed increase the temperature of plant parts, this is usually a negligible factor. In addition,
the hottest parts of the plant (shoot and veins) are actually not those parts with the highest metabolism. Those would
rather be leaves producing starch, actively growing meristems and roots (which are not visible). Finally,
non-metabolizing structures such as the pot, the substrate or the small pole with a tag get equally warm as the hottest
parts of plants.
C true
The temperature of leaf veins is higher than that of the leaf blade because their transpiration is very low.
D false
Leaf A is senescing and thus not transpiring any more. Other leaves are healthy and transpiring, hence the reason
cannot be that the plant is suering from drought stress.
References
Campbell, Biology (9th ed.)page 778 ("Eects of transpiration on wilting and leaf temperature")
31
Consider the situation in which two Alleles A and B of a locus have probabilities rA and rB to
initiate a DSB and are initially present at equal frequencies in a large, isolated population.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. If rA is twice as large as rB, the frequency of Allele A is expected to change faster when
rB=0.05 than when rB=0.01.
B. If rB is large and rA is much smaller, the frequency of Allele A is expected to reach xation
(frequency=1) almost linearly.
C. If rA=rB, the frequency of Allele A will remain constant even if the population were small.
D. Unless there is an additional mechanism involved, recombination in the population is
expected to decrease over time.
A. True
B. False
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Note
It should be clear from both the gure and the text that the allele initiating the DSB is not transmitted, which leads a
bias in transmission in heterozygotes if the probabilities rA and rB are dierent.
Correct answers
A true
The larger the recombination rate, the more often the described mechanism can actually play. Hence the allele
frequency changes more rapidly.
B false
While such a setting will lead to a rapid increase in allele A, the increase cannot be linear because the process
depends on the frequency of heterozygous individuals, which become rapidly rare as the frequency of A approaches 1.
Thus, the frequency of A is expected to increase asymptotically.
C false
In the case of rA=rB, this mechanisms will not necessarily lead to a change. However, due to genetic drift, an allele
frequency is never expected to remain constant, unless the population is extremely (innitely) large.
D true
This mechanism eectively leads to a reduction in the recombination rate since alleles with a lower recombination rate
are favored.
32
In female fruit ies (Drosophila melanogaster), the oocyte is located between maternal nurse
cells and follicle cells providing nutrients, proteins and mRNA crucial for the development of the
embryo. In one of the genes whose mRNA is transported to the oocyte, a mutation X has been
found that leads to deformed, non-viable embryos.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. If the mutation is dominant, the female ospring of a heterozygous male and a wild type
female will be viable.
B. If the mutation is dominant, no adult individuals homozygous for X can be observed.
C. If the mutation is recessive, only the female embryos of a mother heterozygous for X will be
deformed.
D. If the mutation is recessive and two individuals heterozygous for X are crossed to produce the
F1, 1/6 of the F2 will be homozygous for X.
A. True
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Female with a mutation in a maternal eect gene are viable, even if they are sterile.
B true
To be homozygous for the mutation, an individual need to receive a mutant allele from each parent, however, females
with a dominant mutation are sterile and therefore cannot transmit the mutation to ospring.
C false
If the mutation is recessive, all ospring of a heterozygous mother will be viable.
D true
To be homozygous for the mutation, an individual need to receive a mutant allele from each parent. In the F1 of a cross
between heterozygotes, the genotypes are distributed 1:2:1. Males can give the mutant allele with a probability of 1/2,
however, the homozygous mutant female are sterile, therefore, only heterozygous females, representing 2/3 of the
fertile females can give the mutant allele to their ospring, this with a probability of 1/2. The nal probability of being
homozygous in the F2 is 1/2 * 2/3 * 1/2 = 1/6.
33
Population density
Direction of expansion
Space
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
The speed of the expansion is primarily dependent on the growth rate and, up to a limit, on the migration rate. If the
migration rate is very small (as is the case here), it will, on average, take multiple generations until the next deme is
colonized. Hence, an increase in the migration rate does lead to an increased colonization speed.
B false
The most likely fate of every mutation appearing in a population is that it is lost by genetic drift.
C true
While both mutations have the same probability to become common at their receptive positions, a mutation that
becomes common at position B will have a very low probability to become common at position A. In contrast, a
mutation that becomes frequent at position A is likely contributing to the newly colonized demes and will thus have a
higher chance to get xed in the whole population.
D true
Since the population density will increase rapidly at Position B, selection is very weak and genetic drift is not eicient
in losing new alleles. In contrast, both drift and selection are acting more strongly on a new mutation at position A
since the population is large and stable in size. Hence, a deleterious mutation is much more likely to persist in the
population when appearing at position B than when appearing at position A.
34
The red colour of a haploid fungus is produced by a pathway converting a precursor pigment
through several intermediates. To study this pathway, several mutant strains (I through IV) of
various colours have been obtained. The following table lists their colours along with those
observed in the haploid progeny of crosses among them.
Strain or cross
Colours observed
red
beige
yellow
pink
wild type
I
II
III
IV
I x wild type
II x III
II x IV
III x IV
X
X
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
In this pathway, 3 steps catalyzed by a total of 3 enzymes are enough to explain the results.
B true
Crossing I (beige) with the wild-type produces, besides beige and red (wild-type) ospring, also yellow ospring which
can only be explained if strain I is mutant both for the enzyme metabolizing the beige intermediate and the one
transforming the yellow one. Since strain I appears beige, it also means that the yellow pigment is situated further
downstream in the pathway as the beige one.
C false
Crossing II (beige) with IV (pink) does not produce any red (wild-type) ospring, this means that at least one of the two
strains is mutant for both alleles. Crossing III (yellow) with IV (pink) does not produce beige ospring. Since we know
from B that beige is upstream of yellow, this can only be explained if IV is only mutant for the gene metabolizing the
pink intermediate, therefore strain II is mutant both for the enzyme metabolizing beige and the one metabolizing pink.
Since II appears beige and not pink, the beige intermediate is upstream of the pink one.
D true
Ospring can only be red if between the 2 parents, at least one copy of each gene is wild-type. We know from B that I
is mutant only for the enzymes converting yellow and beige and from C that IV is only mutant for the enzyme
converting, therefore red (wild-type) ospring can be observed when crossing I and IV.
35
Three male members (A, B and C) of a family consult a genetic counsellor. The genealogy of the
family is given below with individuals aected by two genetic diseases X (black) and Y (orange)
are indicated. While Disease X is extremely rare, the disease causing allele of Disease Y has a
frequency of 6% in the population.
A B C
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false under the most likely modes
of inheritance.
A. Individual B must be a carrier of Disease X.
B. Individual C cannot be a carrier of Disease Y.
C. If Individual A was to have a son with an unrelated and unaected woman, the probability
that the son will be aected by Disease X is 50%.
D. If Individual B was to have a son with an unrelated and unaected woman, the probability
that the son will be aected by Disease Y is > 5.65%.
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Note
Mode of inheritance disease X
Since two aected individuals have a healthy son, disease X must be dominant and since both males and females are
aected, it cannot be Y-linked. Finally, since we know that the disease is extremely rare and thus most likely absent in
the family of the mother of A and B, the disease must be autosomal then an X-linked disease can not be inherited from
father to son (individual A).
Mode of inheritance of disease Y
Dominant inheritance can be excluded because two healthy individual have an aected son (individual B). Autsomal
recessive is unlikely because the father of individuals A and B has healthy parents, grand parents, uncles, aunts and
siblings. Hence the most likely mode of inheritance is X-linked recessive.
Correct answers
A false
Given a dominant inheritance of disease X, individual B cannot be a carrier of this disease. Note that it is enough to
realize that the disease must be dominant but not to distinguish between autosomal or gonosomal to answer this
questions.
B true
A male cannot be carrier of a X-linked recessive disease.
C true
Since the disease is dominant, individual A will pass on the aected allele in 50% of the cases.
D true
While individual B will pass on his Y-chromosome and hence not the disease causing allele, the probability that the
mother will pass it on is non zero. Given the allele frequency of 6% in the population and given that the mother is
healthy, she is a carrier with a probability of (2*0.06*0.94)/(1-0.06*0.06) = 11.32%, in which case she has a probability
of 50% to transmit the disease causing allele. Hence, the probability to have an aected son is 5.67%. A common
mistake is to assume the probability that the mother is a carrier to be 2*0.06*0.94*0.5 = 5.64%, and hence to ignore
the fact that we already know that the mother is not aected.
36
Several inbred lines with recessive mutations are studied in a plant species. Wild type owers are
purple due to a mix of a red and a blue pigment synthesized by two separate biochemical
pathways I and II involving enzymes encoded by genes A-D (all colorless compounds are named
"white"):
I)
white
II)
white
blue
yellow
red
white
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
A red inbred line is homozygous for a loss of function mutation in gene A (genotype aaBBCCDD). A blue inbred line is
homozygous for a loss of function mutation both in gene B and gene C (genotype AAbbccDD), as otherwise the plants
turn green. The F1 of such a cross has the genotype AaBbCcDD. F2 individuals with red owers must be homozygous
for a (which they are with probability 1/2*1/2=1/4) and may not be homozygous for both b and c at the same time,
which they are with probability 1-(1/2)^4=15/16. The total frequency of red individuals among the F2 is thus 1/4*15
/16=15/64=23.9%. However, note that the red inbred line might also be homozygous for either b or c, in which case
the F1 individuals have genotypes AabbCcDD or AaBbccDD. In this setting, the probability that an F2 individual is not
homozygous for both b and c is reduced to 1-(1/2)^2=3/4, and hence the frequency of red F2 individuals would be
1/4*3/4=3/16=18.75%. So independent of the assumptions, the frequency is always < 25%.
B true
Yellow inbred lines must be homozygous for loss of function mutations a and d. In a back-cross setting with an
individual homozygous for A and D (as the purple inbred line must be), the genetic distance can easily be computed as
the frequency of non-parental phenotypes (green and red) among the progeny (see Campbell chapter 15). Thus, the
distance is 80/400=20cM.
C false
From them stem we know that B and C are linked. We further know that B is closer to A than to C. This leaves us with
the orders A-B-C or B-A-C. Since A is closer to C than to B, only B-A-C remains (or C-A-B read from the other side).
D true
The only possible inbred purple genotypes that result in a purple F1 but some blue F2 when crossed are AAbbCCDD
and AABBccDD. Under this setting, the F1 is AABbCcDD, and hence purple. A blue F2 individual has then the genotype
AabbccDD, which requires a recombination to happen in both F1 parents (from the haplotypes AbCD and ABcD to
AbcD and ABCD). This occurs with probability 0.285 (since the two genes B and C are 28.5 cM apart). After
recombination, the needed haplotype is transmitted with a 50% chance. Hence the total probability for an F2
individual to be blue is (0.285*0.5)2=2.03%.
37
A common strategy to detect genes underlying a particular trait is to test for statistical
associations between the phenotype and a very large number of SNVs (single nucleotide variants)
in a large sample of individuals. The charts below give the results of such an approach for body
height and ve independent SNVs typed in 20,000 random individuals from Switzerland.
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
All three SNVs seem to be linked to a gene with an allele aecting body height. The dierence to SNV 2 is only that
the pattern observed at SNVs 1 and 3 is very likely due to the eect of a dominant-recessive locus in close proximity
since the heterozygous genotype results in a very similar phenotype as one of the homozygous genotypes, but the
pattern observed at SNV 2 is best explained with incomplete dominance.
B true
If the frequency of the C allele decreases from 50% to 30, the number of heterozygous individuals decreases from 50%
to 42%, and hence the average body height is expected to increase.
C true
SNV 5 has no eect on body height, and hence gives a direct estimate of the average height in the population (about
175 cm). If the A allele at SNV 1 has a frequency of 30%, the frequency of the dominant C/C genotype is only 49%,
which is not possible since the average height for this genotype had then to be > 180cm to obtain a population
average of 175cm. Higher allele frequencies of A would even make it worse. Note: the true allele frequency in the
example is 7%.
D false
All SNVs together can explain only 10% of the variation. The students are not able to calculate this value from the
data. However, they are able to judge that SNVs 1 through 4 each explain about 5cm max, which makes about 20cm
dierence between the most extreme genotypes ([A/A, T/T, G/G, A/C] vs [C/C, G/G, A/A, A/A]). However, the body height
in the populations spans a multiple of this dierence. Hence the conclusion from this data that a majority of the
variation s genetically determined is false. But note that in fact body height in humans is 60-80% heritable, yet one
needs dierent data to show this.
38
In cats, there is a genetic locus with two alleles (A, a). In a population, 1300 cats have genotype
AA, 7400 are heterozygous and 1300 individuals carry the recessive genotype aa.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. The frequency of Allele A in the population is 0.5.
B. Under Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium, only 6000 cats are expected to be heterozygous for this
locus.
C. If this population was isolated and mating randomly, the next generation of cats is expected to
be in Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium.
D. Sterility of homozygous individuals can explain this pattern.
A. True
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
The frequency of allele A is given by (2*1300+7400)/(2*(1300+7400+1300))=10000/20000=0.5.
B false
Under Hardy-Weinberg, 2*p*q=2*0.5*0.5=5000 cats are expected to be heterozygous.
C true
A population is always in the Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium after only a single generation of random mating.
D false
If only heterozygous individuals were fertile, the allele frequency would indeed be 0.5. However, the ospring would
still be expected to be heterozygous in only 50% of the cases.
39
To elucidate the phylogenetic relationship among three y species of the Lauxaniidae, the
nucleotide sequence of the 18S RNA and the cytochrome oxidase gene was determined in all
species. Dots indicate the same nucleotide as the rst sequence (Minettia) and hyphens represent
deletions or insertions of one or more base pairs.
18S RNA
Minettia
Lauxania
Lyciella
Cytochrome Oxidase
Minettia
Lauxania
Lyciella
Based on these data, indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. The gene for cytochrome oxidase accumulates mutations faster than the gene for 18S RNA.
B. Sequences of Minettia are evolutionarily more conserved than those of Lauxiana or Lyciella.
C. The fact that the cytochrome oxidase sequence of Minettia is 8 nucleotides longer than the
sequences of both Lauxiana and Lyciella suggest that the latter two taxa are more closely
related than either is with Minettia.
D. Single nucleotide substitutions of 18S RNA and cytochrome oxidase suggest dierent
relationship between Minetti, Lauxiana and Lyciella
A. True
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Cytochrome oxidase has13 point mutations and 4 deletions, 18S RNA has 6 point mutations and 1 deletion.
B false
Minettia was arbitrarily chosen as reference to align the other two species and do not mean that it is the most
primitive one.
C false
Between Lyciella and Minettia is only one deletion, Lauxiana has 3 independent deletions compared with Minettia and
Lyciella.
D false
False, 18S RNA and cytochrom oxidase do show the same general topology of the genetic tree.
40
Fruit set
Flowers of cherry trees (Prunus avium) can be pollinated by both domesticated honey bees and
wild insects such as wild bees or bumblebees. To study the inuence of these pollinators on the
fruit set (percentage of owers of a tree that develop into fruits), ower visits of domestic honey
bees and wild insects were counted during a standardized observation period for cherry trees
worldwide. The gure below shows a linear model best explaining the data.
Number of visits
(honey bees)
Number of visits
(wild insects)
B. False
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The regression predicts that about 10% of cherries would still be pollinated. This might be due to wind pollination or
self-pollination.
B false
The slope of wild bees~fruit set is steeper than the one for honey bees, thus wild insects are more eicient.
C false
Both regressions (domestic bees~fruit set and wild insect~fruit set) are linear. Wild pollinators enhance fruit set
regardless of the abundance of domestic honey bees.
D true
In a ower-rich backyard the density of both wild pollinators and domestic bees is expected to be higher than in a
monoculture of wheat because the backyard is likely to oer a more breeding sites and a more diverse owers
spectrum to feed on.
References
Garibaldi et al, Science (2013)
41
Individuals / L
In an accident in spring 2003, a large quantity of fertilizer was spilled into a small lake in
Switzerland. The gure shows the abundance of four species of zooplankton measured during
August for several years before and after the accident. The accident is indicated with an arrow
Years
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The decline in density of species C after the accident is in the range of its normal annual uctuation. A causal relation
with the accident is very unlikely.
B false
Zooplankton has short generation times. If the fertilizer itself were poisonous, the eect would be a drastic reduction
already within the rst two years after the accident.
C true
After the accident, species A and D show drastic and stable shifts in population densities. Those shifts are much bigger
than the stochastic uctuation before and some years after the accident and therefore seem to be reliable. The shift in
population density of species B is much smaller. Species C does not seem to react at all.
D false
After 10 years, species is likely to still have a much smaller density than before the accident. During the years 7-9 after
the accident, no signicant increase in population density happened.
42
To study the eects of re events on forest ecosystems around a Mediterranean lake, the amount
of microscopic (smaller than 10 m) charcoal particles and pollen of three dierent tree species
were counted in several slices of sediment layers dating from approximately 6000 years before
present. Since the response of forest ecosystems may be visible only after many years, the
correlation between the abundance of charcoal and pollen of a tree species was analyzed for
dierent time lags. The hypothetical tree species in the gure below, for instance, reaches the
highest abundance many years after the actual re event. Hence, the highest correlation is
achieved when the charcoal abundance is shifted with a specic time lag.
time lag
Abundance
pollen
charcoal
charcoal
(time lag shift)
Time
Correlation
The gure below shows the results of such an analysis for three tree species, of which Abies alba
has recently become locally extinct. Correlation coeicients exceeding the threshold (dotted
lines) are statistically signicant at =0.05.
B. False
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
According to the data shown the amount of Abies pollen is negatively correlated with the amount of charcoal for a few
decades after a re. Therefore the species seems not to be tolerant to re. An increase of frequency of res will lead to
successive regression of this species.
B false
The positive correlation between charcoal and pollen approximately 20-40 years after re event cannot be explained
by a reaction of individual owers or even trees to re stimulus. The period of increased pollen production lasts
several decades what is much too long for being explained by a punctual stimulus.
C false
As it is for Abies, Quercus seems to be less present during the period after a re event. The recent dominance must
have other reasons than tolerance to re.
D true
The negative correlation to re events is signicant after a time lag of about 10-15 years in Abies, but only after about
40 years in Quercus.
References
Colombaroli et al, Journal of Ecology (2007)
43
Many chironomid species (non-biting midges) are known to be abundant only within well-dened
ecological niches, as is shown below for three species commonly found in Switzerland.
Optimal trophic state
Species 1
Oligotrophic
7.1 - 12.9 C
Species 2
Mesotrophic
9.3 - 17.6 C
Mixed forests
Species 3
Hypertrophic
10.7 - 19.2 C
Farmland
Fossil chironomids in lake sediments can be used to reconstruct the past climatic and ecological
conditions in the vicinity of the lake. In a sequence of sediment layers of a small swiss lake, head
capsules of all chironomid species have been identied and counted. The relative abundance of
the three listed species in each sediment layer is shown in the gure.
Species 2
Species 3
Age
(yrs before present)
Species 1
Relative abundance
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The apparent increase in temperature and change of vegetation type at about 9000 years BP coincides with the end of
the last ice age, when alpine vegetation was replaced by forests. However, human impact seems to be clearly indicated
by appearance of species 3, whose optimal niche is in human made farmland that appeared about 3000 years BP.
B true
Since 2000 years, species 1 reappears in the sediment after an absence of several thousand years. It is the same
species that was predominant at the end of the ice age. This indicates that the average temperature fell below a
maximal level for this species.
C true
The sediment of the past 2000 years show that Species 3 is able to live in abundance at the same place as species 1,
which has a much dierent temperature range. Therefore it is not a very good indicator species for temperature. But
species 3 seems to be very closely linked to human farming activity, and predominates since the decline of forest
indicated by species 2.
D false
Interactions between predators and prey show uctuation periods of several years at maximum (insects are short
living), but will not be visible on a time scale of several hundreds of years.
References
Heiri et al, Palaeogeography, Palaeoclimatology, Palaeoecology (2003)
44
Cladistic analysis is an approach to infer the evolutionary relationship among organisms based on
the presence or absence of morphological or molecular characters. In order for cladistics to work
correctly, the following three assumptions have to be met:
Along a lineage, characters change over time.
Any pair of two organisms shares a common ancestor.
Evolutionary lineages split in a bifurcating manner.
Indicate if each of the following statements is in line with these assumptions (true), or
whether one or more of them are violated (false).
A. The presence or absence of nematocysts can be used in a cladistic analysis to reconstruct
phylogenetic relationship of metazoa. Nematocysts are complex cells of cnidaria (e.g. sea
anemone) that certain sea slugs incorporate into their own body for self defense by feeding on
sea anemones.
B. Cladistics can be used to reconstruct the phylogenetic relationship of ecologically distinct
plant species, of which one arose by hybridisation of two distinct parental species.
C. Cladistics can be used to reconstruct the phylogenetic relationship of two nch species that
arose from a generalist nch that colonized a remote island. The species dier in bill length
and depth, tarsus length and plumage color.
D. Cladistics can be used to reconstruct the phylogenetic relationship of lichen multicellular
eukaryotes. Lichen are a symbiotic interaction between green algae or cyanobacteria with
fungi.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Although both taxa have nematocysts, this trait cannot be used to put both of them in a distinct clade within metazoa,
as sea slugs do not produce nematocyst themselves. In regard of this trait the evolutionary lineages do not split in
bifurcating manner.
B false
Here, evolutionary lineages do not split in bifurcating manner, but the origin of one lineage is the fusion of two initially
separated lineages.
C true
This example is in agreement with all assumptions.
D false
Lichen behave functionally a single organism, but consists of two independent organisms with a completely dierent
phylogenetical background. Therefore the principle of splitting lineages in bifurcating manner is violated.
45
Fish species of the family Mormyridae are known for their ability to locate objects and
communicate by weak electric elds called electric organ discharges (EOD). They are also able to
sense EODs of other Mormyridae. The gure shows body shape, relative body size and and
EOD-waveform used for communication (white lines) for 16 Mormyridae species living in a
central African rainforest drainage system.
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Note
Since the students cannot be expected to know these sh, the question focuses on testing if the students can think of
typical features of sh of a specic lifestyle, and are then asked to check if the Mormyridae show such features. This
gets us around asking the students to judge the life style of Mormyridae.
Correct answers
A false
Fish specialized on preying other sh of similar size typically have a relatively large mouth with large conical teeth,
both absent from all species of Mormyridae.
B false
If Mllerian mimicry would be important to reduce pressure from predators, all shown Mormyrids should show very
similar, extremely contrasting colours most likely in combination of yellow and black or orange/red and black. In
contrast, all shown Mormyridae are of dull / camouage color. Furthermore, Mormyridae do not produce harmful
electric shocks which could be used as an anti-predation behavior (mentioned in the text).
C true
Mormyridae live in turbid water and are mostly nocturnal. They have very small eyes compared to body size what
indicates that vison is limited and seems to play a minor role for these sh. Large eyes are common in diurnal sh
species that live in clear water. The complex systems for object localization and communication via the generation and
reception of weak electric elds are very useful for nocturnal sh in turbid water.
D true
All Mormyroiadea are of dull color and have impaired vision. Hence, a system to attrackt mates using non-visual cues
is highly expected. In addition, the electric signals produced vary greatly between species and are used to attract
mates. /br>
References
Hopkins, Electroreception (1986)
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
activity of CAT
After transfection of individual constructs into cells, the [new text here] following CAT activities
were determined.
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Notes
I = II -> 2 plays no role,
I > III -> deletion of 4 reduces the promoter strength -> 4 enhances promoter activity,
I < IV -> removal of 3 increases promoter strength -> 3 reduces promoter activity,
V shows almost no activity -> 1 provides basal promoter activity
Correct answers
A false
4 enhances promoter activity, removal of it in a decreases the activity of a.
B false
This case is similar to III versus IV, since 2 does not aect promoter strength.
C false
Without 1, c will show almost no activity, further decreased by the presence of 3.
D false
2 does not play a role, c and d have the same promoter strength.
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
secretory proteins are folded in the ER, chaperones assist them in their folding and can increase the yield
B false
most secretory proteins are glycosylated, without glycosylation they are not recognised and are not traicked further,
and without glycosylating enzymes, the cell's membrane proteins cannot be glycosylated, the cells are not so healthy,
this will also reduce the yield.
C true
secretory proteins are transported from the Golgi to the plasma membrane by vesicles
D true
Since each of the gene copies can be transcribed independently, genes with multiple copies are generally expressed
more.
References
Peng et al, Biotechnology and Bioengineering (2009)
Tigges et al, Metabolic engineering (2006)
Target protein
Pup ligase
To determine if a protein X is pupylated, puried X is incubated with Pup and the Pup ligase over
night. Trypsin, which hydrolyses (by addition of water of 0.018kDa) proteins next to lysines (K)
and arginines (R), is added and the masses of the peptides are determined by mass spectrometry
(red) . A control reaction where Pup was not added was processed similarly (black). The masses
were rounded to two decimals. Note that the Pup fragments are out of the range to be detected.
Relative intesity
Control
+ Pup
Protein X
0.96
trypsin
2.11
trypsin
1.05
trypsin
1.22
1.33
trypsin
6.70
0.26
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Note
The masses given in the second gure correspond to tryptic monopeptides. During trypsin hydrolysis, water (m a 18.02
Da) is added, therefore, when calculating the mass of a dipeptide, the mass of water needs to be substracted.
Correct answers
A true
Masses corresponding to dipeptides can be observed in the black sepctra, e.g. the mass 3.05 kDa corresponds to a
dipeptide formed by the two rst tryptic peptides.
B true
The peak of the pupylated peptide at 2.78 kDa corresponds to a pupylated dipeptide and no pupylated monopeptide
can be observed (the peak would be at 1.46 kDa for this lysine).
C true
Only two peaks (2.78 and 3.81 kDa) are present in the red spectra (with Pup) but not in the black one. The peak at
2.78 kDa corresponds to a pupylated dipeptide formed by the last two peptides of the protein, the peak at 3.81
corresponds to a pupylated tripeptide formed by the last three peptides of the protein.
D false
Two peaks (1.22 and 1.33 kDa) are reduced after ligation with Pup. The peak at 1.33kDa goes from 0.6 to about 0.25
relative intensity. Therefore, the protein is pupylated to about 1-(0.25/0.6) = 58%, not 90%. Furthermore, the peak
corresponding to a pupylated peptide (2.78 kDa), has a relative intensity of only 0.4, added to the peak corresponding
to the pupylated tripeptide (3.81 kDa) with a relative intensity of about 0.15, the pupylation level would be only about
55%.
Upon light activation, rhodopsin proceeds to Meta-states, of which Meta-I and Meta-II are in a
dynamic equilibrium. This shifts towards Meta-II in the presence of arrestin (Arr) as some Meta-II
binds to arrestin. To study the minimal functional unit of rhodopsin, the dierence in absorption
of rhodopsin (absorption after light activation minus absorption before light activation) is
measured at dierent arrestin concentrations ([Arr]) for both monomeric and dimeric rhodopsin,
as shown below. Meta-II is known to show a stronger absorption at 380 nm than Meta-I.
Dimeric
A(after) - A(before)
Monomeric
Wavelength (nm)
B. False
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
the negative dierence absorption at 500 nm shows that dark-state rhodopsin absorbs light at 500 nm.
B false
as can be seen from the graph, the dierence in absorption between 2 and 4 M is smaller than the one between 1 and
2 M. If Meta-II would increase linearly with the arrestin, it should be equal to the double. Furthermore, one can
think, that as more arrestin is added, less free rhodopsin is present, therefore, less increase in absorption is observed.
C false
with monomeric rhodopsin, the increase of absorption at 380 nm is bigger than with oligomeric rhodopsin
D true
monomeric rhodopsin is enough for arrestin-binding, it is the minimal functional unit
The following picture depicts part of the binding site of a protein which recognizes RNA
specically over DNA, in complex with two RNA bases (B1 and B2).
Ala
C of the protein
C of the RNA
O
N
P
Tyr
B2
A
Asn
Base
Ribose
B1
Phosphate
B
Arg
Indicate for each of the following interactions if it provides specicity for RNA over
DNA.
A. Hydrogen bond A with Tyr
B. Hydrogen bonds B with Arg
C. Hydrogen bond C with Ala
D. Hydrophobic stacking D between Tyr and B2
A. True
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Only RNA, not DNA, has a hydroxyl group at the 2' position in the sugar.
B false
Both RNA and DNA have phosphate groups in the backbone.
C false
This hydrogen bond is specic for B2, but B2 is a guanine present both in RNA and DNA (the only dierence in term of
bases between RNA and DNA is uracil vs. thymine, both are pyrimidines, small bases with only 1 ring).
D false
Hydrophobic stacking is a non specic interaction which is found in interactions both with DNA and RNA.
References
Handa et al, Nature (1999)
The following gure depicts the shikimate pathway, which is part of the synthetic pathway
producing aromatic amino acids in bacteria.
HO
COO-
COO-
COO-
OH
OH
OH NADPH+H+
NADP+ HO
OH
OH
OH
Y
Z
COO-
c
COO-
PO4 3-
2- O3
PO
COO-
2- O3
PO
OH
COO-
2- O3
OH
PO
OH
B. True
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
A is a dehydration, the -OH group as well as a hydrogen are removed and form water.
B true
NADPH+H+ is a reducing agent. The oxidation number of the carbon of the carboxyl in the substrate changes from +2
to +1 in the product of b: this is a reduction.
C false
GDP cannot phosphorylate substrates, Y represents here ATP.
D false
In d, a phosphate group is released as part of the condensation of the 2 substrates.
To separate DNA fragments on an agarose gel, one liter of 10x TAE buer (consisting of Tris
base, Acetic acid and EDTA) has to be prepared. The desired concentrations for TAE as well as
the available stocks are as follows:
Chemical
Desired concentration
Available stocks
Tris base
Acetic acid
Solution 100 %
EDTA
Solution 0.50 M
Distilled water
B. True
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Tris base: 0.4 mol/l * 1 l * 121 g/mol =48.4 g
B true
acetic acid: dilution: V1 = c2*V2/c1 = 1.14% * 1l/100% = 11.4 ml
C false
EDTA: dilution: c1*V1 = c2*V2 <=> V1 = c2*V2/c1 = 0.01 mol/l * 1 l / 0.5 mol/l
D false
Tris, EDTA and acetic acid are rst added to a smaller amount of water. When Tris is completely dissolved, the volume
is adjusted to 1 l with water. If they were added to 1 l of water, the nal volume would be greater than 1 l and the
concentrations would be wrong.
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
A and B can only be expressed if X is present in the cell, for this, P1 needs to be active.
B wrong
gene B would be more expressed than A if the ribosome would bind stronger to the IRES than the 5'-cap
C false
if the DNA-binding domain of X was removed, X could not bind the DNA and activate gene expression, so neither A nor
B would be produced.
D true
an mRNA with a longer or shorter poly-A tail may survive longer in the cell and can be translated during a longer time,
so more X-protein could be produced.
References
Fussenegger et al, Biotechnol. Prog. (2001)
The toxicity of three dierent chemicals 1-3 was tested in vitro on neural crest cells by counting
the number of viable cells (black circles) and the number of cells migrating (red triangles). The
average and standard deviation of multiple replicates obtained at dierent concentrations are
plotted relative to the average counts from untreated cultures.
Response relative to untreated
Chemical
untreated
Chemical
untreated
Chemical
untreated
Concentration
B. True
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Chemical 1 aects only migration, not viability of neural crest cells. This could be explained e.g. by chemical 1
inhibiting receptors involved in migration.
B true
Even if the migration is reduced with increasing concentrations of chemical 2, it is so with the same amplitude as the
viability is reduced. The reduction in viability is enough to explain the reduction in migration (since dead cells do not
migrate).
C false
Even if the viability in the presence of 100 to 500nM of chemical 3 is higher than the viability of untreated neural crest
cells, this is due to the large standard deviation in the measurements, not to a benecial eect of chemical 3.
D false
As for chemical 1, the response in cell viability and migration is not always similar. Since during embryonic
development, neural crest cells need to migrate to create dierent tissues, it is important to take cell migration into
account when establishing maximum permissible concentrations.
10
The contraction of a muscle ber is triggered by an electric impulse that leads to the release of
Ca2+ ions from the sarcoplasmic reticulum (SR) into the cytosol. After contraction, the Ca 2+ ions
are pumped back to the SR by sarcoplasmic reticulum Ca2+ ATPases (SERCA). To better
understand the relative energy consumption of the actual contraction and the pumping of Ca 2+
ions, skeletal muscle bers of the frog species Xenopus laevis were treated with the chemicals
BTS and cyanide. BTS inhibits cross-bridging between myosin and actin and cyanide inhibits the
cytochrome c oxidase. The gure below shows the basal and peak cytosolic Ca 2+ concentration as
well as the pH of individual bers during repeated contractions under natural conditions (open
circles), in the presence of BTS (lled circles) and in the presence of both BTS and cyanide (red
triangles).
Peak
Basal
200
400
600
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
This can be seen easily from the right gure where the pH decreases over time (due to anaerobic glycolysis) is
substantial even when no ATP is hydrolyzed at actin heads (in the presence of BTS).
B false
The decrease in pH over time is due to anaerobic glycolysis. Since the pH decreases well beyond 200 seconds, aerobic
respiration may be contributing substantially to the production ATP, but is far from being the only important source. In
the rst 60 seconds, substantial sources of ATP are the stock of ATP and the phosphorylation of ADP from creatine
phosphate.
C false
It actually absorbs H+ ions (ADP + PCr + H+ = ATP + Cr). This can easily be seen in the right gure since the pH is
increasing at rst.
D false
In the absence of aerobic respiration, the drop in pH is expected to be even quicker than for the natural conditions.
References
Nogeira et al, AJPRICP (2013)
11
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The guts contain no skeletal but smooth muscles. The latter are usually not aected by Myastenia gravis due to the
absence of neuromuscular junctions.
B false
The antibodies block the access of acetylcholine to the post-synaptic receptor (as mentioned in the stem), which cause
a paralyzation or a reduced postsynaptic neuronal stimulation.
C true
Slowing down the degradation of Acetylcholin (for instance by inhibiting the Acetylcholinesterase) allows it to act
longer on the post synaptic receptors, which leads to a stronger signal since antibodies bind reversible on the ACh
Receptors (they are in competition).
D false
B-Lymphozytes not T-Lymphozytes produce antibodies.
12
In blood capillaries, uid movement (Jv) across the capillary membrane, between the lumen of the
capillary and the interstitial space, depends on the dierence in hydrostatic and oncotic
pressures between these two compartments. (Oncotic pressure is a form of osmotic pressure
exerted by proteins.)
The following equation applies for Jv
Jv = Kf x [(Pc Pi) (c i)]
with
Pc: the capillary hydrostatic pressure
Pi: the interstitial hydrostatic pressure
c: the capillary oncotic pressure
i: the interstitial oncotic pressure
Kf: the ltration coeicient
: the reection coeicient
Indicate for each of the following situations if the risk of edema (accumulation of uid
in the interstitial space) is increased.
A. Tennis competition in the sun leading to dehydration
B. Wearing anti thrombotic stockings
C. Inammation leading to increased blood vessel permeability
D. Proteinuria (excessive protein excretion by the kidneys)
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Excessive sweating causes a reduction of intravasal uid which lowers the hydrostatic pressure in the capillaries.
B false
Anti thrombotic stockings increase the interstitial hydrostatic pressure and peripheral edema are decreased
consecutively.
C true
Increased blood vessel permeability/leak -> plasma proteins move to the interstitium increasing the interstitial oncotic
pressure -> more water movement to the interstitial space.
D true
Proteinuria reduces the concentration of proteins in the blood resulting in a reduced capillary oncotic pressure.
13
Leukocytes
Neutrophils (%)
Proper treatment of chronic bacterial infections of articial implants (e.g. prosthetic joints)
requires expensive and demanding surgery. Unfortunately, such infections are often diicult to
distinguish from non-infected implant failures. To propose new diagnostic tests, the absolute
leucocyte count (A) and the fraction of neutrophils among white blood cells (B) were measured in
34 patients with true prosthetic joint infections and 99 patients with known non-infected implant
failures. For each test, dotted lines indicate proposed cut o values to diagnose a true infection.
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
By rising the cut o less patients without an infection would get the incorrect diagnosis (but less real infections would
be detected).
B true
With the cut o of 1700 /l, 2/34 Pat with a real joint infections get missed, so 32/34 = 94% were correctly diagnosed.
C false
By lowering the cut o all patients with a true infection in the study would be detected. However, given that 2 out of
34 patients show low proportion of neutrophils, there is no guarantee that in a larger sample no individual with an
even lower proportion was present. Given the distribution it seems even likely.
D true
Using the neutrophil count, more patient with a prosthetic joint infection were correctly diagnosed (33/34 vs. 32/34 for
the leucocyte count) and less patients without an infection got false-positive results (2/99 vs. 12/99 for the neutrophil
count).
References
Trampuz et al, AJM (2004)
14
While the glomerular ltration rate (GFR) is determined by blood pressure in the glomerulus, it
does not directly reect the systemic blood pressure. Instead, a stable GFR is maintained by
either dilation or constriction of the aerent (ow in) and eerent (ow out) arterioles of
glomeruli by an autoregulation mechanism. Several drugs interfere with this mechanism as
side-eects. Those include non-steroidal anti-inammatory drugs (NSAIDs) that reduce the
capability of the aerent arterioles to dilate, as well as angiotensin-converting-enzyme inhibitors
(ACEIs) that inhibit the production of Angiotensin II, and therefore reduce the capability of the
eerent arterioles to constrict.
Indicate for each of the following statements if it is true or false.
A. NSAID intake reduces glomerular blood ow.
B. ACEI intake reduces glomerular blood pressure.
C. The eects of NSAID and ACEI on the GFR may compensate each other when taking both
drugs together.
D. While a chronic overproduction of aldosterone can be treated with ACEIs, using an
Aldosterone antagonist aects the autoregulation mechanism less.
A. True
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
A side eect of NSAIDs is to inhibit dilation of the aerent arterioles. Hence the glomerulus is unable to increase blood
ow through that mechanism.
B true
If the glomerular ltration pressure is not high enough, Renin is produced, which coverts the pre-hormone
Angiotensinogen into Angiotensin I, which is then converted into Angiosin II by the Angiotensin-converting-enzyme. By
inhibiting this enzyme, the ability to constrict the eerent arteriols is reduced (as mentioned in the stem). In addition,
the production of Angiotensin II rises the blood pressure by rising the vascular pressure and rising the production of
Aldosterone, which itself rises the renal reuptake of Natrium and water. Inhibiting this further decreases blood
pressure system wide.
C false
While NSAID decrease the blood ow into the glomerulus, ACEI increase the outow of blood. Hence both lead to a
reduction on the glomerular pressure and lead to a reduction of the GFR.
D true
An Aldosteron overproduction can be treated by inhibiting the Angiotensin-converting-enzyme, as this leads to a lower
level of Angiotensin II, which is a stimulant for the production of Aldosteron. However, due to the larger role of
Angiotensin, a direct antagonist of Aldosteron implies a smaller eect, including the one described in this question.
References
Campell Biology
15
The respiratory quotient (RQ) of an adult woman was measured at 0.7, along with an oxygen
concentration of 170ml/l in her exhaled air. The RQ is the ratio between the eliminated amount of
carbon dioxide and the absorbed amount of oxygen of the body. The metabolization of glucose and
palmitic acid is as follows:
Glucose: C6 H12O6 + 6 O2 6 CO2 + 6 H2O
Palmitic acid: C16H32O2 + 23 O2 16 CO2 + 16 H2O
Indicate for each of the following statements if it is true or false.
A. The woman adds about 119ml of CO2 to every liter of exhaled air.
B. If the woman was metabolizing solely glucose, her RQ would be larger than when solely
metabolising palmitic acid.
C. The measurements are consistent with the woman solely metabolizing palmitic acid.
D. If the woman was forced to sprint for a few minutes, her RQ is expected to decrease rapidly.
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The adult woman is exhaling 170ml of O2 per liter of air. Since the concentration of oxygen in the atmosphere is about
210 ml/l, the woman is absorbing around 40 ml of oxygen per liter of air. Given an RQ of 0.7, 28 ml of carbon dioxide
(and not 119ml) must be eliminated per liter of exhaled air.
B true
An RQ of about 1 is expected when metabolizing glucose, but only 0.7 in the case of palimitc acid. Note that the
students do not need to make the full calculations to answer this question, but just observe that there is an imbalance
of O2 absorbed and CO2 eliminated when metabolizing palimitc acid, compared to a balance when metabolizing
glucose.
C true
Metabolizing solely palmitic acid requires an absorption of 23 O2 per 16 CO2 eliminated (see equation 2). Hence the
expected RQ is 16/23=0.69565, or 0.7 when rounded to the signicant digits provided in the question.
D false
Short but heavy exercise leads to a large usage of anaerobic metabolism by muscle cells. At rst, this is not expected
to change the RQ at all as lactate fermentation does neither eliminate CO 2 nor absorb O2. However, through time,
Lactate build up leads to an increase in RQ due to an inhibition of fatty acid metabolism. While the students are not
required to know the latter, they should know that anaerobic metabolism cannot lead to a decrease in RQ as less O 2 is
absorbed.
16
Mammalian herbivores use dierent strategies to digest cellulose. Ruminants (e.g. cattle) use
multiple stomachs, whereas monogastrics rely on an extended caecum or colon.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. The relative abundances of dierent amino acids in the small intestine of ruminants dier
from the relative abundances of the swallowed food.
B. Ruminants eat their faeces digested in the caecum to cover their nutritional need.
C. In monogastric herbivores, the absorption of nutrients occurs primarily in the colon.
D. The majority of the bacteria in the stomach of monogastric herbivores are able to produce
cellulase.
A. True
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Microorganisms metabolise anorganic nitrogen to build their own proteins which have a dierent amino-acid-pattern
than the food they swallowed. In the abomasum, microorganisms are killed by the HCL and their proteins are digested
from the ruminant.
B false
Not ruminants but monogastric herbivores like rabbits have to eat their faeces from the coecum.
C false
In most monogastric herbivores, it is still the small intestine where most nutrients are absorbed. That is why several
monogastric herbivores eat their feaces.
D false
Monogastric stomaches are not supposed to host bacterias.
17
Flow (l/s)
To assess respiratory function, the ow and the volume of the exhaled air are measured during a
forced expiration (positive ow) followed by a full inspiration (negative ow). Shown below are
the measurements from four dierent patients with an airway problem. The black dotted line
indicates normal respiratory function.
Volume (l)
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Restrictive lung diseases reduce the lung volume which is shown/documented in patients ow/volume graph #1.
B false
The patient suers from a obstructive disease. Hes volume is normal, but the ow is reduced. Sympathic eect on the
bronchial system causes an dilatation, the parasympathic eect an obstruction. An adaequate drug has either to
inactivate the parasympathetic nervous system or activate the sympathetic nervous system.
C true
The results shown are indeed typical for a cough attack in which a rhythmic pulse of fast expiration are observed.
D false
As mammals have a negative pressure breathing (rise of intrathoracal volume causes a negative intrathoracal pressure
leading to inspiration), an extrathoracal stenosis (obstruction) causes a xed air-ow reduction apparent during
inspiration.
The opposite is true for an intrathoracal obstruction, because the negative pressure during inspiration widens the
intrathoracal air ways. Vice-versa in expiration.
18
The following gure shows an experiment in which a dorsal lip from a darkly pigmented donor
embryo was transplanted to the ventral ectoderm of a lightly pigmented recipient embryo which
was allowed to develop into a tadpole. The developing second body axis consisted mostly of
non-pigmented cells.
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The experiment shows, that the resulting tadpole on the ventral side had a lightly pigmented surface too, so this cells
originate from the receiving embryo.
B false
A second body axis can only be induced when the cells are still able to dierentiate in all tissues, this is not anymore
the case at the neurula stage.
C false
The grafted cells are able to induce neurulation in the receiving embryo where cell fate was not to neurulate.
D false
The endoderm would not undergo neurulation and hence would not induce the cells to develop a secondary body axis
at all.
19
Three blood groups have been characterized in cats, all of which are encoded by a single gene
with three alleles, of which allele A is dominant over allele B, and allele AB is dominant over B,
but recessive to A. Most cats with blood groups A or B have anti-B or anti-A antibodies,
respectively. Cats with blood group AB do not produce either antibodies anti-A nor anti-B.
Antigens
Produced antibodies
Anti-A
Anti-B
Anti-AB
+
+
-
A
B
AB
The gure below shows the results of blood transfusion compatibility tests performed for a
mother cat (M), her kitten (K) and two potential father cats (P1 and P2). The cards consist of
three circles that contain anti-A (A) and anti-B (B) antibodies, or no antibodies at all as a negative
control (-). When adding a drop of blood to the circles, the occurrence of an agglutination
reaction becomes visible (red dots).
P1
P2
B. True
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
P2 produces anti-B, which are present in its serum and would cause an agglutination of erythrocytes of kitten K.
B true
The P2 serum has no anti-A and causes therefor no agglutination with antigens of erythrocytes in M.
C false
A cat with the blood group A has anti-B, which react both with AB and B antigens on erythrocytes. Since the mother
has genotype AB/B and the kitten B/B, any ospring of them has either blood group AB or B.
D false
The negative control indicates that the test failed. So the genotype of P1 is unknown and hence these results do not
suggest anything. Note, however, that if P1 had indeed blood group AB, he would have the same probability as P2 to
be the father of K. The corresponding probability for P2 is either 0% if he had genotype A/B or A/AB or 25% if he had
genotype A/B.
20
The urea-to-creatinine ratio is used to assess renal function. It is calculated by dividing blood
urea concentration by blood creatinine concentration. Urea and creatinine are both able to freely
pass the glomerular ltration barrier. However, while creatinine is not reabsorbed, a percentage
of urea is reabsorbed in the collecting ducts. An elevated rate of reabsorption is only observed
when the total blood volume is increased.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false. Compared to a healthy
individual, the urea-to-creatinine ratio is expected to be higher
A. ... in a patient suering from an acute obstruction of the urethra (urinary retention).
B. ... in a patient suering from an acute necrosis of the collecting duct epithelium.
C. ... in a patient suering from dehydration.
D. ... in a healthy individual after intensive exercise but with suicient water intake.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Urinary retention aects urea and creatinine equally, and hence does not lead to a change in the ratio.
B false
Less urea reabsorption leads to a decrease in the ratio.
C true
Due to volume depletion, a higher percentage of urea is reabsorbed in the kidney, which leads to a larger ratio.
D false
In case of intensive exercise, muscles release more creatinine, and hence the ratio is decreased.
21
Figure A illustrates the results of an examination of the visual eld of a patients left and right
eyes, whereby dark areas indicate poor, and white areas good visual reception. The way sensory
information is received by the eyes and transferred to the visual cortex is presented in gure B.
Visual elds
Left
Left
Right
Right
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
It causes a loss of function of the retinal receptors on the left side of both eyes which causes a visual loss of the right
side from patients view.
B true
The hypophysis is situated right below the optic chiasm. Tumors of the hypophysis consequently mainly aect those
nerves crossing at the optic chiasm, which are the nerves innervating the retinal receptors an the medial part of the
retina causing lateral visual eld defects.
C false
a lesion between the optic chiasm and retinae would aect both eyes but would most likely cause blindness in both
visual elds (right and left) of both eyes. A dysfunction of both visual pathways between the optic chiasm and the
retinae is much more unlikely to be the reason for the indicated visual eld than a single or multiple lesion(s) aecting
both orange part of the optic nerve (and not aecting the blue ones at the same time). The visual elds given are
typical for a lesion between the optic chiasm and the left visual cortex.
D true
A lesion aecting 100% visual eld of only one eye is usually located between the optic chiasm and the retina.
References
Duanes's Ophtalmology: E-book: Evaluation of Visual Function
22
The gure shows a schematic and representative cross section through a leaf of an angiosperm
plant. Vascular bundles are represented by circles and sclerenchyma bers by black surfaces.
Additionally, the position of trichomes and stomata is indicated. The relative position of the
vascular bundles is constant along the leaf.
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Note
The section belongs to a fescue (Festuca) out of the family of Poaceae.
Correct answers
A true
The regular position of vascular bundles that is constant all along the leaf indicates a parallel pattern of leaf veins
without branching. This is a typical trait of monocotyledons.
B false
The stomata are situated in cavities of the leaf surface and protected by trichomes. This is a typical trait of drought
adapted plants, reducing transpiration.
C true
The amount of supporting tissue (sclerenchyma) within the thin leaf is a hint to a very long length. A relatively short
(laceolate or round) leaf would not need such a tissue.
D false
Sclerenchyma contains dead cells without cytoplasma. Therefore they do not contain chlorophyll and appear colorless
in a fresh section.
23
Plant organelles can be isolated from plant lysate by multiple rounds of centrifugation and
washing. To distinguish between dierent organelles, centrifugation fractions are subjected to
simple assays before and / or after incubation for 30 minutes under specic conditions. Possible
assays include:
1) measuring the concentration of glucose and other aldoses using a Fehling reaction,
2) detecting the presence of DNA by measuring absorption at 260 nm,
3) observing gas bubbles.
Indicate for each of the following statements if it is true or false.
A. A Fehling assay before and after incubating in light distinguishes fractions of chloroplasts
from those of amyloplasts.
B. A Fehling assay before and after incubating with glucose distinguishes fractions of Golgi from
those of mitochondria.
C. Fractions of endoplasmic reticulum and nuclei can be distinguished by incubating with lipases
and proteases, followed by centrifugation and measuring absorbance at 260 nm in both
supernatants.
D. The presence or absence of gas bubbles after incubating with H2O2 distinguishes fractions of
peroxisomes from those of endosomes.
A. True
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Amyloplasts convert glucose in starch that does not react with the Fehling reagent, whereas in light, chloroplasts
produce sugars that will turn the Fehling solution blue.
B false
Neither Golgi nor Mitochondria are involved in the central sugar metabolism.
C true
Nuclei treated with lipases and proteases will liberate DNA that stays in the supernatant after pelleting the nuclei
debris. Endoplasmic reticulum does not contain DNA, therefore even if lipases break it down, no change in absorption
at 260nm will be observed.
D true
Peroxysomes transform H2O2 in H2O and O2, thereby liberating O2 bubbles, whereas endosomes do not.
References
Lang, Plant Cell Rep (2011)
Peroxisome Database
24
According to the ABCE-Model of ower development, activity of genes from dierent classes A, B,
C or E determines the identity of oral parts. Expression of class A genes is needed to determine
future sepals and petals, class B genes to determine future petals and stamen and class C genes
to determine future stamen and carpels. A and C genes inhibit each other's expression.
Dierentiation of each oral part additionally requires activity of class E genes. The gure
illustrates the ABCE-model and shows ower samples of Arabidopsis (A and B), the alpine grass
Poa alpina (C) and two owers of the snapdragon Antirrhinum majus (D; the arrow indicating the
bilateral wildtype, while the radial symmetric to the right is a mutant).
Sepal
Petal
Stamen
Carpel
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
B false
The best explanation is the loss of only class C genes.
C false
The leaves emerging from the owers represent grass seedlings and not altered owers with leaves at the position of
oral parts. The picture shows a viviparous plant with grains germinating before falling o the mother plant.
D false
The mutant shows a loss of bilateral symmetry and not an alteration in the dierentiation of oral parts.
References
Krizek, Nature (2005)
25
The pattern of leaf primordia (future leaves) at the apical meristem is determined by active auxin
transport. Auxin is transported towards the meristem tip. Young primordia act as auxin sinks
through the auxin eux carriers PIN1 and thus decrease the auxin level in nearby meristem cells.
A new primordium will be induced at the place with the highest remaining auxin level. The image
below shows the meristem of Arabidopsis with the primordia 1-9, with 1 being the oldest.
B. False
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
The characteristic angle of 137 between two subsequent primordia can be only explained with the youngest
primordium being a stronger auxin sink than the second youngest.
B false
According to the order of older primordia the next primordium will emerge between primordium 2 & 5.
C false
In this mutant the primordial pattern would be aberrant, as well as the leaf shape. But it would emerge at a random
position. There is no reason to assume that it will be position B.
D true
In this case the highest auxin concentration would be present directly opposite of the youngest primordium.
References
Reinhard, Nature (2003)
26
Many plants use, among other means, the ratio of red/far-red light to detect other plants
competing for light and react with adaptive growth to avoid shade. The ratio of red to far-red
light is detected by the photoreceptor phytochrome. Phytochrome is converted between two
forms PX and PY, depending on the wavelength of the photon it has absorbed. The ratio between
both forms reects the red/far-red ratio in the environment. A high proportion of P X mediates the
expression of genes responsible for shade-avoiding growth. The gure shows the spectra of
normal daylight (solid line) and daylight ltered through a tobacco canopy (dashed line). Tobacco
plant A has been grown under normal sunlight, plant B under a canopy of older plants.
Far-Red
Red
Wavelength
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The maximal ratio is observed in normal light and is slightly above 1.
B false
The opposite is true. Plant B has the genes activated with a red/far-red ration of about 0.5. As the far-red-converted
phytochrome form is dominant, this must be the active form.
C false
Shade-tolerant plants do not need to express the plant B-phenotype of growing out of the shade. In the shade they
keep the normal leaf exposition, allowing to maximize the amount of photons collected by the leaves.
D false
A plant trying to avoid shade by enhanced growth will invest in few elongated stems and not in a multitude of branches
that stay in the shade. Plant B doen't show any branching.
References
Vandenbussche, Current Opinion in Plant Biology (2005)
27
In the wood of trees of temperate climates, annual growth rings are present and reect dierent
growth conditions between years and individuals. Three coniferous trees of the same species
were cut at the same stem height in the same year. The stem cuts in the gure are drawn to the
same scale.
Based on these stem sections, indicate for each of the following statements if it is true
or false.
A. Trees I and II likely grew in the same region, whereas Tree III likely grew in a more distant
region.
B. Tree III is likely to have experienced more climate variation between years than Tree I.
C. Trees I and II may originate from the same forest.
D. The asymmetric pattern of Tree III may be due to constant exposure to strong wind beginning
roughly ten years ago.
A. True
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
I and II show the same pattern of two periods of narrow rings (bad growth conditions) 2-6 and 9-13 years before they
have been cut. Thus they have been growing in the same climatic conditions present in one same region. Tree III
shows a dierent, much more regular pattern and did not suer those two periods of bad years.
B false
Tree III has relatively regular rings throughout the lifetime on one side of the section. The asymmetric pattern can be
explained by very local eects like a physical obstacle or shadow on one side of the tree.
C true
Local ecological factors such as available light or soil conditions can result in very dierent growth rates even for
neighboring trees.
D true
The rst rings are regular, indicating an equilibrated light supply. The last rings are more and more asymmetric. A
likely explanation is that faster growing trees are competing for sunlight on one side of the tree, whereas on the other
side the tree is still suiciently exposed to sunlight.
28
The second leaf (Leaf 2) of a young and growing plant of wheat (Triticum aestivum) was fed via a
rectangular ap cut symmetrically in the middle of the lamina and brought into a tube with a
feeding solution containing radioactive nickel (63Ni), manganese (54Mn) and zinc (65Zn). After 1,
2, 7 and 28 days, the contents of radioactive elements were measured in dierent parts of the
plant. Concentrations measured in the ap and Leaf 2 are shown in orange in the gure.
1 Day
2 Days
7 Days
28 Days
Leaf 7
Leaf 6
Leaf 5
Leaf 4
Leaf 3
Leaf 2
Flap
Leaf 1
Roots
Leaf 2
Leaf 7
Leaf 6
Leaf 5
Leaf 4
Leaf 3
Leaf 2
Flap
Leaf 1
Roots
Leaf 7
Leaf 6
Leaf 5
Leaf 4
Leaf 3
Leaf 2
Flap
Leaf 1
Roots
Indicate if each of the following statements is in agreement with the results shown
above.
A. The plants absorbed the entire feeding solution provided before the rst measurement.
B. Nickel is mostly transported to growing organs.
C. Manganese has higher phloem mobility than zinc or nickel.
D. Leaf 2 is turning into a net sugar exporter after Day 1.
A. True
B. True
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
B true
Nickel is rst accumulated in leaf 3, then in leaf 4. After several days when these leaves are grown up nickel is
exported again towards leaves 5-7.
C false
Manganese (known to have low phloem mobility) stays in the second leaf, whereas Zn and Ni is reduced in leaf 2 and
appears in signicant amounts in other parts of the plant.
D false
Leaf two is an "adult" leaf already at the beginning of the experiment. At day one a fraction of nickel already has been
transferred from leaf 2 to 3. As the transfer is done by phloem transport, leaf 2 must already have a net sugar export.
References
Riesen, Journal of Plant Nutrition (2003)
Plant Physiology 5th ed., Lincoln Taiz and Eduardo Zeiger, section Essential nutrients, deciencies, and plant
disorders page 108 and following.
Campbell, Biology (9th ed.), table 37.1 page 791.
29
In xylem, water conduits occasionally undergo embolism, characterized by an inow of air into
the conduit lumen, followed by collapse of the water column. Each event of embolism emits a
sound called ultrasonic acoustic emission (UAE) that can be detected with adequate sensors. The
gure below shows such measurements of an oak tree (Quercus pubescens) during four
subsequent summer days. Radiation of sunlight (RN) and air temperature (T) were measured
simultaneously.
Day
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
The UAEs are recorded during periods of high radiation and temperatures. During this time the water potential in the
surrounding air is very low, leading to increased evaporation. During increased evaporation the dierence in water
potential between leafs and roots is big and therefore the tension forces within xylem is high.
B true
The audibility is indicated by the decibel value. At mornings and evenings the few measured UAEs have lower decibel
values and are therefore less loud. Keep in mind that the decibel scale is logarithmic. The dierence between the
water potential of air and leaves depends on radiation and temperature and is maximal at noon and early afternoon
but lesser at morning and evening. Therefore a relation is given.
C true
The radiation diagram shows how the cloud covers increases (huge variation within short time), leading to a decrease
in overall radiation, and hence to a decrease in water tension within water conduits.
D true
Water transport depends on a permanent water clomn. An embolism is leading to the interruption of a xylem conduit.
Until it is relled, further water transport through this conduit will be null or very limited.
References
Zweifel et al, New Phytologist (2008)
30
Based on these results, indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. One recombination event happened in each parent of X2 between the genotyped loci.
B. F1 individuals are likely showing intermediate levels of anthocyanin.
C. Among the studied loci, SNV3 is closest to gene G.
D. The phenotype ratio in the progeny of a cross between X4 and X5 is 2:1.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Most likely, a single recombination event happened in only one of the parents, as one of the haplotype is parental
(ACATC) and the other shows a recombination between SNV3 and SNV4.
B false
Gene G is linked to SNV3, and the table lists a heterozygous individual (X1) with an elevated anthocyanin level (which
is the dominant allele). But note that the students do not need to identify the most closely linked locus as for each of
them heterozygous individuals are given and the conclusion would remain unchanged.
C true
This is the only locus for which the genotypes match the phenotypes in a Mendelian fashion.
D false
A 2:1 ratio is impossible for any crossing, as we clearly have dominant-recessive inheritance. So it is possible to
answer this question even if the truly linked locus is not identied.
31
A plant species grows in three dierent habitats A, B and C, and populations from dierent
habitats also dier genetically. To test if some of these genetic dierences are driven by local
adaptation, a so-called reciprocal transplant experiment is carried out where seeds collected from
dierent habitats are grown in all three habitats. After a year, the tness of the plants are
measured by counting the number of viable seeds produced per individual.
Native habitat
Experimental habitat
Based on these results, indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. Plants from Habitat A are locally adapted to their native environment.
B. Plants from Habitat B are locally adapted to their native environment.
C. Plants from Habitat C are locally adapted to their native environment.
D. Habitat C is less suitable for these plant species than habitats A or B.
A. True
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Plants grown from seeds collected in habitat A show, on average, a much higher tness when grown in habitat A than
seeds collected form other habitats.
B true
Plants grown from seeds collected in habitat B show, on average, a much higher tness when grown in habitat B than
seeds collected form other habitats. Note that the fact that seeds from habitat B perform better in habitat A than in
habitat B is likely due generally better conditions in habitat A.
C false
Plants grown from seeds collected in habitat C follow the habitat quality, but do not indicate that they are specically
adapted to environment C since they do not perform better there than plants adapted to dierent environments.
D true
All plants perform much worse in environment C than environments A or B, inclusing the individuals originating from
this environment.
32
Consider a large and constant population of a diploid organism with non-overlapping generations
and sexual reproduction happening in spring. In addition, there is no dierence in allele
frequencies between sexes and there is no migration or natural selection acting. In such a
population, the frequencies of alleles uctuate at a given rate between generations due to the
random nature of reproduction.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false. Allele frequencies are
expected to uctuate at ...
A. ... a higher rate if the population was growing exponentially.
B. ... a lower rate if all individuals had the same number of ospring.
C. ... a similar rate even if there was strong inbreeding.
D. ... a higher rate if the population crashed every winter.
A. False
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
If a population is growing exponentially, stochasticity in reproduction is reduced due to a larger number of ospring
sampling alleles from the parent generation, and hence allle frequencies uctuate at a lower rate.
B true
If all individuals had the same number of ospring, allele frequencies are almost constant since each individual leaves
a xed number of copies of his alleles in the population. The only stochastic variation left comes from heterozygous
individuals randomly passing one of their alleles per ospring.
C true
While inbreeding decreases the frequency of heterozygotes, it does not lead to a faster change in allele frequencies.
D true
A population crash in winter leads to a recurrent bottleneck which removes alleles randomly from the population and
leaves a smaller number of individuals reproducing in spring. This leads to an increased stochasticity.
33
The eect of various mutations in a gene x coding for a protein X, essential for the synthesis of
leucine, is studied in a haploid yeast. The beginning and the end of the complete sequence of the
coding strand of x is given below.
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Note
Students are expected to know the start and stop codons. Nevertheless, for those who don't, they can nd out by
looking at the sequence, that ATG is a start codon and TAG a stop codon.
Correct answers
A false
Introducing the mutation C13T results in the TAG stop codon, but the transcription stops only at the transcription
termination sequence independently of the codons
B false
Introducing the mutation A16T results in the TAG stop codon. With a stop codon at the beginning of the sequence, no
functional protein is produced and no leucine can be synthesized by the yeast that would need to take it up from the
medium.
C false
Introducing the mutation T31A results in the ATG start and methionine codon. This will simply result in a methionine
at this position. The eukaryotic ribosome binds at the 5'-cap of the mRNA and starts translation at the rst AUG
encountered. Further AUG are simply translated into methionine.
D false
Introducing a G between positions 33 and 34 results in a shift of the translation frame. Instead of reading ...GAT AGC...
(positions 34-39), the ribosome will read ...GGA TAG... and reaches a stop codon. Translation stops there, the protein
will not be functional.
34
An operon encoding enzymes 1 and 2 is regulated by metabolite X and consists of four sequences
A, B, C and D of unknown function. To elucidate their function, the eect of mutations in the
sequences A-D on the synthesis of the enzymes is assessed in the presence and absence of X.
X present
Mutation in sequence
Enzyme 1
Enzyme 2
X absent
Enzyme 1
Enzyme 2
no mutation
B. False
C. False
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
This operon is repressed by X. This kind of negative transcriptional regulation is mostly found in biosynthetic
pathways.
B false
In the absence of X and mutation in A, enzyme 2 is still produced, enzyme 1 isn't, therefore A codes for enzyme 1.
C false
In the case of a mutation in B, enzymes 1 and 2 are produced even in the absence of X, therefore B corresponds to the
regulatory gene.
D false
In the case of a mutation in D, neither enzyme is produced, even in the absence of X, therefore D corresponds to the
promoter region.
35
In cells, most plasmids are supercoiled (a in gure below). While such plasmids can be uncoiled
to relaxed circles (b) using Topoisomerase IA (TopoIA), using restriction enzymes (R) linearizes
plasmids through cutting (c). A linearized plasmid may spontaneously self-anneal and
subsequently be ligated to form a relaxed circle. The ligation reaction can be inhibited by the
addition of phosphatase (AP).
b
AP
Topo IA
a
R
c
In an experiment, a plasmid was treated with dierent restriction enzymes (R1, R2, R3) under
similar conditions and separated on an agarose gel together with an untreated sample (P0) and a
marker consisting of linear DNA pieces. Topoisomerase IA and AP treatments in combination with
R3 were also analyzed, but the tubes were mixed up (R3+E1 and R3+E2 on gel).
(bp)
(bp)
B. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
C. True
D. True
A false
R1 and R2 are distant from 1000 bp, R2 and R3 from 2000 bp, even if 2 vector maps are possible:
R1 1000 bp R2 2000 bp R3 2000 bp
R1 1000 bp R2 3000 bp R3 1000 bp
B true
Since the shape of DNA plays a role in the migration, the length of DNA can only be determined by comparing
fragments with the same shape. The plasmid is linearized when using only 1 restriction enzyme. The supercoiled
plasmid from P0 (thick band) is converted to linearized DNA which migrates around 5000 bp (see R1 or R2).
C true
In R3, some uncut supercoiled is still present, only about half was cut, whereas in the same time, R1 could cut
everything
D true
Treatment with AP removes prevents re-formation of relaxed circles, the slowest migrating band disappeared in
R3+E1. Treatment with E2 converted the uncut supercoiled plasmid into relaxed circles, this corresponds to Topo IA.
36
A child aected by a rare genetic disease is born to two healthy parents. The child has a healthy
sister.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true or false.
A. If the disease was known to be segregating in the family of the father, the disease is more
likely autosomal than sex-linked recessive.
B. If the disease was sex-linked recessive, the probability of the sister being a carrier is 50%.
C. If the disease was autosomal recessive, the probability of the sister being a carrier is 50%.
D. If the disease was not known to be segregating in either family, the causal mutation is either
autosomal recessive or, within the family, unique to the child.
A. True
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
X-linked recessive would imply that the father was aected.
B true
In this case, the mother is carrier and the father healthy. Hence the sister inherits an unaected X chromosome from
the father and has a 50% chance to inherit the aected chromosome from the mother.
C false
In this case, both parents are carriers. But since we know that the sister is healthy, the probability is 2/3 (and not 1/2).
D true
A rare autosomal recessive disease is likely not to show up in an outbred family for many generations. An alternative
explanation for the disease, however, might indeed be a spontaneous mutation being unique to the child.
37
In a small pasture, 500 individuals of two closely related snail species were sampled. Genetic
analyses detected a locus at which none of the individuals were found to be heterozygous, despite
the presence of two alleles in each species. The two species and all genotypes were randomly
distributed in the homogenous habitat.
Snail species
Genotype
Number of snails
B. False
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Self-fertilization would indeed lead to all snails being homozygous.
B false
If the populations were experiencing strong drift through low population sizes, this would lead to a reduction in
diversity. However, there is no reason why this should aect heterozygous individuals preferentially.
C false
Hermaphroditic reproduction does not have any impact on allele frequencies as long as mating is random.
D true
If snails mate only with snails of the same genotype, heterozygous individuals would be very rare in the population.
38
A yeast-two-hybrid assay (Y2H) allows to test if a protein X interacts with another protein Y. In
this assay, the gene coding for X is fused to the gene of a DNA-binding domain (BD) of a
transcription factor T. The gene coding for Y is fused to the gene of the activating domain (AD) of
T. The resulting plasmids are transformed into a yeast strain containing the lacZ gene under the
control of a promoter P, which is specically recognized by BD. Plated on agar with X-gal, the
colonies turn blue if they are expressing LacZ, which is only the case if BD and AD are in close
proximity and hence if X and Y interact with each other.
interacting
not interacting
lacZ
lacZ
blue
white
B. False
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
The assay works correctly only if BD and AD by themselves are not enough to activate transcription, but are both
needed.
B false
This in vivo assay works only for soluble proteins. To study interaction of membrane proteins, the membrane proteins
need to be properly folded, which is only possible if they are in lipidic environment.
C true
If I binds to a third protein which binds to II, the assay can give positive results, even if I and II do not interact directly.
D true
The binding site can be distorted if it is too close to the junction to the transcription factor domain.
39
Consider a currently stable system in which three predatory insect species P1, P2 and P3, feed
exclusively on three herbivore insect species H1, H2 or H3, respectively, all of which feed on the
same limited plant resource R.
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Doubling the resource should lead to a doubling of all abundances in the system in the long term since the interactions
remain unchanged.
B false
Population size of predators depend on populations size of herbivores. H1 now lacking a predator will increases on
cost of H2. As a consequence the abundance of P2 decreases as well. This is expected unless H2 is limited almost
completely by its predator and not by competition with H1, but even in that case the abundance is expected to remain
unchanged, but not increase.
C true
Population size of predators depend on populations size of herbivores. H3 when having its predator removed, is able to
reduce H2, P3 must be a limiting factor for H3. H2 when having its predator removed does not seem to be able to
aect H3. Therefore the eect of the predator is not limiting enough to lead to signicant loss of competition against
H3.
D false
The top-predator will decrease the abundance of P1 and P2 and therefore lead to an increase of H1 and H2. As both
those herbivores are in competition with H3, the abundance of H3 is likely to decrease, leading to a dcrease in the
abundance of P3.
40
The following gure illustrates the result of an experiment during which a person was alone in a
room and was allowed to freely choose the awake and sleep periods by turning a bright light on
and o. The consecutive time of light for each day is shown as a rectangle with times at which the
person chose to eat a meal indicated by black bars. While the person had no time cues from the
outside world during the days shown in orange, the room was exposed to natural light during the
days shown in white.
Days
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
While the periods of light were extended in the absence of external cues, there us no indication the those periods got
longer during the experiment.
B false
Firstly, this experiment does not measure the endogenous clock since the bright light is an eective, external cue to
delay the endogenous clock. Secondly, the the observed rhythm is on the order of about 26 hours (average over the 17
days).
C true
The person chose extended periods of light, without extending the periods of sleep much. This is an indication that the
bright light resets the clock and delays the desire to go to sleep. A good example can seen at the beginning of the
experiment where the person stay up for more than 20 hours on the rst two days and apparently got very tired on the
third day.
D false
The transition back to normal conditions took the person at least four days. This can be seen best with the irregular
eating times.
References
Charles et al, Science (1999)
41
A herbivorous insect H is known to exclusively feed on the seedlings of two tree species X and Y.
In an experiment, patches of a forest were subjected to a treatment, or not. In the treatment,
seedlings of X and Y were protected from being fed on by H (open circles). Patches in which X
and Y were unprotected served as a control (lled circles). Panel A shows the average number of
all species for which seedlings were found in the patches. Panel B shows the average relative
abundance of seedlings of X and Y observed in the patches.
Number of species
Relative abundance
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Note
The two prey species must be excellent competitors, not inferior ones; otherwise they would not be able to dominate
the experimental plot communities in the absence of the predator (78% vs. 27%). When community organization is
regulated in this way, as opposed to the availability of nutrients recall seedling growth was not limited by light
availability it follows a top-down model and not a bottom-up model (p. 1206). A top-down regulatory role for the
predator is predicated on there being interspecic competition between prey and non-prey species for space when the
prey are largely sessile, which plants are (p.1205 top of Fig. 54.17). In this way, the predator pre-empts interspecic
competition among seedlings to promote local alpha diversity in the forest.
Correct answers
A false
Competition of species Y is only controlled by herbivore H. Without this control it dominates the tree seedlings in the
forest within a few years. Moreover it is clearly able to outcompete species X when both species are lacking herbivore
H.
B true
The diversity of tree species is regulated by the presence of herbivore H, a species at a higher position in the food
chain. This feature qualies a top-down process.
C false
After removing herbivore H, species X increases rapidly over two years, before diminishing again when being
exceeded by species Y. This feature is best explained by competition between species X and Y. A potential regulation by
another herbivore would be likely to prevent the initial strong increase of species Y.
D true
The predator not very abundant in the community, as both its host species only have a cumulative abundance of about
10%, but it clearly plays a pivotal ecological role in structuring the community by preventing potential dominance by
prey, so it therefore qualies as a "keystone species" (p. 1204; Campbell Biology 9th ed., 2010)
42
The meta-population concept describes the population size in a habitat patch as a function of
birth rate, mortality and migration. Consider the hypothetical meta-population given below,
consisting of two big source patches X and Y where the birth rate exceeds mortality and three
sink patches (A, B and C) where reproduction does not occur. Yearly net migration (individuals)
between dierent sub-populations is constant and indicated with arrows in the gure. In each
sink patch, 6 individuals die at the end of each migration season. Individuals cannot migrate
further than to the next patch within a year. The initial population sizes in the sink patches are
A=22, B=9 and C=12.
B. True
C. False
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Net migration for patch A is 3. With a mortality of 6 individuals a year the sub-population declines 3 individuals each
year. After 8 years, the population will reach 0.
B true
With the given migration and mortality, all sink population have a negative long-term trend and will die out. First,
population A will die out so migration between A and B will be interrupted. Without this migration, population B and
subsequently population C will die out as well. So no individual will be able any more to migrate between X and Y.
C false
With a constant net migration of 6 individuals into patch C, the population will fall below 7 individuals within three
years, but will not fall below 6 individuals.
D true
This reduction in mortality prevents A from dying out. Therefore all other subpopulations will not die out either.
43
You are given four drawings referring to typical representatives of four major groups of metazoa.
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
Both the drawing and the description are referring to the group of Plathelminthes (Tubularia).
B true
Both the drawing and the description are referring to the group of Nematoda.
C true
Both the drawing and the description are referring to the group of Tunicata (Chordata)
D false
The drawing shows a representative of the group of Cnidaria (Hydra) with typical polyps, whereas the description
refers to a typical representative of the group of Echinodermata.
44
The following gure shows the phylogenetic relationship among several sympatric sh species of
the family Mormyridae, which are known to use weak electric communication signals no predator
is capable of sensing and the transmission of which does not depend on environmental factors.
For each species, measurements informative about the trophic level (A), body shape (B) and the
shape and frequency of their electric signals (C) were determined for several individuals. The
gure below shows the position of each measured sh individual in a principal components space
for each of the three groups of measurements where all individuals of a species are enclosed in a
polygon. The colors refer to the phylogenetic positions shown above. Principal components
analysis is a statistical procedure that maximizes the variance on the rst few axes.
B. True
Original commentary
C. False
D. False
Correct answers
A false
Recently evolved sister species are as dierent or even more dierent in their communication signals than
phylogenetically distinct pairs.
B true
Currently diverged sister species are very distinct in their communication signals but show only limited dierences in
trophic ecology and morphology. Information (no predator with receptors able to track EODs, no eect of typic
ecological parameters like water turbidity and pH on communication system) given in the text make ecological driven
eects responsible for the pronounced dierences in signals very unlikely.
C false
Morphospace is mainly determined by phylogenetically very distinct taxa and therefore not created by recent changes
of habitats. Recently evolved taxa do dier only marginally in body shape.
D false
There is no obvious correlation between body shape and electric signals of Mormyridae. In addition, morphologically
very similar species dier heavily in their communication signals.
45
Trichoplax adhaerens is the only known animal (metazoa) of the phylum Placozoa. It appears as a
at disc with a very simple structure made of only very few distinct cell types. Nerves, sensory
cells and muscle cells are absent. Shown below is an electron microscope image of T. adhaerens
and a dendrogram based on molecular data indicating the phylogenetic position of T. adhaerens
in relation to other taxa.
200 m
B. True
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
As Placozoa are a sister group of all Eumetazoa, they are equally related to both humans and Drosophila.
B true
Taxa A has a more basal position than Cnidaria. Porifera are known to be the most basal group of metazoa, whereas
Mollusca are representatives of bilateria and therefore in the same group as humans or Drosophila are.
C true
Coelom and gastric tube are traits of higher Metazoa. Cnidaria do not yet have those organs, and Placozoa have even a
more basal position than Cnidaria. Moreover, these organs would demand for more distinct cell types than Placozoa
has.
D false
Placozoa have a more basal position than Cnidaria, which is a group of organisms that do not yet belong to Bilateria.
References
Srivastava, Nature (2008)
46
While some mammals are known for their large dierence in body size between males and
females, there is no apparent dierence in size between sexes in other mammal species. This
sexual dimorphism can often be well explained by the ecology and mating system of a species.
Indicate if each of the following statements is true of false. A signicant sexual size
dimorphism with larger males is expected in ...
A. ... a very small antelope (< 5 kg), in which a male and a female together defend their small
area (< 10 ha) with rich food resources, water and shelter.
B. ... a seal species where males are known to travel large distances oshore to feed on
dispersed food and to copulate with any oestrous female they encounter.
C. ... an antelope species, in which males gather on a sandy lake shore during the dry season,
where each of them defends a 20 m 2 area vigorously.
D. ... a small carnivore (about 20 cm in length) living in a predator-rich habitat in mixed sex
groups. The ospring rely heavily on parental care from both sexes and males are known for
their remarkably large testicles.
A. False
B. False
C. True
D. False
Original commentary
Correct answers
A false
Both sexes defend the small territory as a full time job year-round against conspecics, therefore selection pressures
are the same for both sexes.
B false
This particular case of ssion-fusion mating selects more for agile, fast travelling males and resource-rich females than
for heavily built competitive males.
C true
This territory is evidently too small and of bad food quality to serve as home range. Male-male interaction is
permanent and highly competitive, females choose under many males - selection to show good genes and heavy
bodies.
D false
This species is social and group members have similar functions. Male-male competition is limited since cooperation is
very important to limit own mortality and to increase survival rate of ospring. In this system it is likely that females
mate with several partners that cause sperm competition.
References
Floyd, Journal of Mammology(1998)
47
In ecology, two dierent measures of biodiversity are commonly used: alpha diversity
characterizes the biodiversity at a given location and beta diversity characterizes the diversity
found between habitats. A good estimate of alpha diversity is the Shannon index, which is
computed as
where the sum runs over all species 1, , S present in a habitat and p i is the relative abundance
of Species i.
The table shows the abundance of adult trees of eight tree species (A through H) in four plots of a
temperate ecosystem in both pristine and disturbed states.
Plot
State
pristine
pristine
disturbed
disturbed
B. True
C. True
D. True
Original commentary
Correct answers
A true
While the number of species present is the same in both plots, their relative abundance is rather dierent in that
species D dominates the system much more in plot 2 than plot 1, leading to a lower alpha diversity in plot 2.
B true
Beta diversity is much higher among plots 2 and 3 than plots 1 and 2. The students should be able to see this without
calculating anything since exactly the same species are present in plots 1 and 2, but several species are restricted to
either plot 3 or 4.
C true
Pioneer species are the rst species to colonize a damaged / disturbed habitat. While other species are also present
uniquely in either plots 3 and 4, none of them is present in both nor in that number, suggesting that species B.
D true
This is a typical characteristics of a species capable of dominating tree ecosystems, as species D is capable of doing in
the pristine state. Seedling of other trees only get a chance after disturbance through external factors.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
th
Practical Exam 1
Molecular Cell Biology
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
1 / 10
Dear participants,
This test consists of two tasks:
Introduction [2 points]
Task 1: Presence of the -glucuronidase [12 points]
Part 1.1: Determine the presence of the -glucuronidase [12 points]
Task 2: Presence of the procyclin protein [86 points]
Part 2.1: How to use the counting chamber [1 point]
Part 2.2: Washing the magnetic beads
Part 2.3: Density of trypanosomes not binding to magnetic beads [37.5 points]
Part 2.4: Total trypanosome density [25.5 points]
Part 2.5: Success of the deletion of the procyclin gene [9 points]
Part 2.6: Verification of binding to beads [9 points]
Part 2.7: Interpretation of your results [4 points]
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
7
8
10
10
Please write your student code into the box on the title page.
There is no separate answer sheet. Please fill in your answers into the specific answers boxes indicated
with a gray background. Only answers given inside these boxes will be evaluated.
The answers have to be given either with a tick () or with Arabic numbers. The numbers "1" and "7" can
look very similar in handwriting. To make sure that those two numbers can be well distinguished by the
IBO staff, please write them as you normally would into the following box.
1=
7=
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings at the end of the exam. Put
the entire protocol with all the answers back into the exam envelope.
2 / 10
Equipment
Water bath at 37C (used in common)
1 Micropipette P1000
1 Micropipette P200
1 Micropipette P20
1 Box of pipette tips for P1000
1 Box of pipette tips for P200 and P20
1 Eppendorf holder
1 Tube holder
1 Solid waste container
1 Liquid waste tube [LW]
1 Polystyrene (styrofoam) box filled with ice
1 Timer
1 Marker
1 Microscope
3 Cell counting chambers
3 Microscope slides
3 Cover slips
21 Eppendorf tubes
1 Magnetic Eppendorf holder
Blank paper
1 Flag to call an assistant
1 Yellow sheet labeled with your student code
Chemicals
1 Eppendorf tube with magnetic beads [MB]
1 Tube with phosphate buffer [PBSB]
1 Eppendorf tube with Fixation Buffer [FB]
1 Eppendorf tube with Substrate Buffer [SB]
1 Eppendorf tube with Substrate (X-gluc) [S]
Trypanosome suspensions
1 Eppendorf tube with suspension of Strain 1 [T1]
1 Eppendorf tube with suspension of Strain 2 [T2]
1 Eppendorf tube with suspension of Strain 3 [T3]
3 / 10
Introduction [2 points]
Trypanosoma brucei is a parasite causing sleeping sickness in humans and nagana in animals. It is
transmitted between individuals via the tsetse-fly and is almost exclusively found in Africa south of the
Sahara. To better understand the function of different proteins implicated in the life cycle and infection
pathway of T. brucei, it is the goal to create mutant strains that lack procyclin, but express another
protein of interest instead. Procyclin is a surface protein found in T. brucei but not in other trypanosome
species and is hypothesized to have an effect on the infection pathway. Different trypanosome species
rely on different surface proteins for their infectivity. For example, T. congolense relies on a surface
protein called GARP.
In this practical you will work with strains of the subspecies T. brucei brucei, which can infect domestic
and wild animals, but is not dangerous for humans. In a first step, cells were transfected or not with a
single construct coding for both GARP and -glucuronidase and grown as pure strains. -glucuronidase,
which is absent in wild-type T. brucei, is a protein that can cleave X-gluc, an artificial substrate, into a
blue product that can easily be observed by eye. In this setting, -glucuronidase serves as a convenient
reporter gene that will allow you to recognize the strains carrying a successfully introduced construct by
simply incubating the strains with X-gluc (Task 1).
The strains were then subjected to a protocol to delete the gene coding for the protein procyclin. This
would allow verifying whether procyclin is indeed important for the infectivity cycle and whether GARP
can compensate for the procyclin function. Since the deletion efficiency is not 100%, you will separate
the cells where the procyclin gene was successfully deleted from the ones in which the deletion did not
work. To achieve this, trypanosomes pre-incubated with antibodies specific against procyclin will be
separated with magnetic beads coated with protein A that specifically binds to the Fc part of antibodies,
as is illustrated below.
Before starting the practical work, indicate for each of the following statements if it is true or false with
a tick (). [2 points]
true
false
If the suspension of a strain incubated with X-gluc turns blue, the
-glucuronidase gene was successfully introduced.
Q1
Inferring the successful introduction of the GARP gene based on
the presence of the reporter gene (-glucuronidase) may result in
false positives or negatives if only one gene of the construct was
successfully inserted.
The location in the genome where the construct is introduced
affects the level of gene expression of the introduced genes.
A similar approach with magnetic beads and specific antibodies
can be used to separate cells, with successful deletion of a gene
coding for an intracellular protein, from cells where the deletion
did not work.
4 / 10
Strain T2
Strain T3
Blue
Q2
Colourless
5 / 10
The following steps should be performed when determining the density of trypanosomes in a
suspension:
1. Pipette 10 l of the suspension into a counting chamber.
2. Wait at least 2 minutes for the cells to sink to the bottom.
3. Put the slide under the microscope and count the number of trypanosomes individually in three
of the four larger squares highlighted in gray.
You may use either the 10x or the 40x objective, whichever you prefer. It is advised to follow a
serpentine (snake-like) route to go through each of the smaller squares to avoid losing orientation. In
order to prevent a potential bias, count trypanosomes within the square and those crossing the left or
bottom limit (filled circles), but not those outside the square or crossing the right or top limit (open
circles).
To obtain the trypanosome density from the number of counted trypanosomes, first determine the
volume in which the cells are counted and indicate it in the table below. Note that the height of the
counting chamber is exactly 0.1 mm and each of counting cell is exactly 1 mm wide (see figure above) [1
point].
Volume of 1 counting square (mm)
Q3
6 / 10
Part 2.3: Density of trypanosomes not binding to magnetic beads [37.5 points]
Pull down trypanosomes expressing procyclin in a sample of each of the three trypanosome strains T1,
T2 and T3 as follows:
1. Pipette 190 l of the trypanosome suspension in a fresh Eppendorf tube. Mix the trypanosome
suspension by inverting prior to pipetting.
2. Add 10 l of washed magnetic beads. Make sure the beads are resuspended prior to pipetting.
3. Incubate 30 minutes on ice. Resuspend the magnetic beads very gently every 3-5 minutes by
inverting and finger-flicking the tube. Consider working on other parts of Task 2 during the
incubation.
4. Pull down the magnetic beads using the magnetic holder.
5. Transfer the entire supernatant, while the tube is still in the magnetic holder, into a fresh
Eppendorf tube and put on ice.
6. Immediately resuspend the magnetic beads in 50 l phosphate buffer (PBSB) very gently and
put on ice.
7. Prepare 100 l of a 1:10 dilution of the supernatant in phosphate buffer (PBSB) in a fresh
Eppendorf tube.
8. Pipette 36 l of this dilution into a separate Eppendorf tube and add 4 l of Fixation Buffer (FB).
Mix well by pipetting up and down.
9. Count the number of trypanosomes according to the protocol in Part 2.1 and enter the values in
the table below.
10. Calculate the mean of the number of trypanosomes per square (precision: 3 positions after the
decimal point). You will use these numbers in Part 2.5. [37.5 points]
Strain T1
Strain T2
Strain T3
Square 1
Q4
Square 2
Square 3
Mean counts per square
7 / 10
2. Pipette 36 l of this dilution into a fresh Eppendorf tube and add 4 l of Fixation Buffer (FB). Mix
well by pipetting up and down.
3. Count the number of trypanosomes according to the protocol in Part 2.1 and report the values
in the table below.
4. Calculate the mean and the standard deviation of the number of trypanosomes per square
(precision: 3 positions after the decimal point). You will use these numbers in Part 2.5. [25.5
points]
The formula for the standard deviation (SD) is given below with
value of the replicate and the mean.
Strain T1
Strain T2
the
Strain T3
Square 1
Q5
Square 2
Square 3
Mean counts per square
Standard deviation of counts
per square
SEmean
Q6
8 / 10
The SEmean tells you the accuracy with which you estimated the mean number of trypanosomes per
square. Use this estimate to decide the correct number of significant digits (all digits including the first
for which you are uncertain) by comparing the estimated mean plus the SEmean with the estimated mean
minus SEmean. For instance, if the mean is 1234.567 and the SEmean 98.765, you will have to compare
1234.567 + 98.765 = 1333.332 with 1234.567 - 98.765 = 1135.802. In this case, there are two significant
digits and the mean should be reported as 1.2x103. Indicate the number of significant digits you should
use with your data. [1.5 points]
Strain T2
Strain T3
Strain T2
Strain T3
Strain T2
Strain T3
In order to assess the success rate of the gene deletion experiment, calculate the percentage of
trypanosomes that did not bind to magnetic beads for each of the three strains. Use the estimates for
the densities in the original suspension for your calculations and indicate your results in the table below
(precision: only full percentages). [1.5 points]
9 / 10
Strain T2
Strain T3
Strain T2
Strain T3
Strain T2
Strain T3
Indicate with a tick () the strain where the deletion was most efficient. [1 point]
Strain T1
Q14
Strain T2
Strain T3
10 / 10
Student Code:
Practical Exam 2
Plant Physiology, Morphology and Ecology
Total points: 88
Duration: 90 minutes
Dear participants,
This test consists of three tasks:
Task 1: Determination of glucose content in plant extracts [44 points]
Part 1.1: Calibration curve [13.5 points]
Part 1.2: Glucose content [15 points for measured raw values]
Part 1.3: Data analysis [15.5 points]
1.3.1 NADH calibration curve
1.3.2 Glucose concentration in plant extracts
1.3.3 Interpretation of your results
Task 2: Staining of transitory starch [9 points]
Task 3: Floral morphology and pollination ecology [35.5 points]
Part 3.1: Floral morphology
3.1.1 Type of inflorescence
3.1.2 Number of floral parts
3.1.3 Fusion of floral parts
3.1.4 Ovary position
3.1.5 Floral symmetry
Part 3.2: Pollination ecology
3.2.1 Floral shape
3.2.2 Pollinators
Please write your student code into the box on the title page.
You are strongly advised to start working with Task 1. During this task, you will have to incubate your
probes for 20 minutes and then allow for some time for the lab assistants to perform the necessary
measurements. During this waiting time you may work on Tasks 2 and 3.
There is no separate answer sheet. Please fill in your answers into the specific answers boxes indicated
with a gray background. Only answers given inside these boxes will be evaluated.
The answers have to be given either with a tick () or with Arabic numbers. The numbers "1" and "7" can
look very similar in handwriting. To make sure that those two numbers can be well distinguished by the
IBO staff, please write them as you normally would into the following box.
1=
7=
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings at the end of the exam. Put
the entire protocol with all the answers back into the exam envelope.
2/16
Task 1
Plant material:
6 x 250 l plant extracts [WT light, WT dark, sex1 light, sex1 dark, pgm1 light, pgm1 dark]
Solutions and reagents:
1.5 ml Master mix [MM]
1 ml NADH solution 500 M [NADH]
200 l G6PDH [G6PDH]
10 ml H2O [H2O]
Technical material:
1 micropipette 50 l-200 l (can be used down to 20 l)
1 96-well Microplate (dont touch the bottom of the plate!)
1 Timer
Container for used materials
2 blank paper sheets for notes
Flag to call the lab assistant
Task 2
Plant material:
8 tubes with de-pigmented plants [A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H]
Solutions and reagents:
10 ml Lugols solution [Lugol]
Technical material:
8 plastic dishes
Plastic Pasteur pipette
Waterproof pen for writing on plastic dishes
Task 3
Plant material:
5 tubes with floral specimen in 70% ethanol [V, W, X, Y, Z]
Color print with photos of the flowers V-Z
Technical material:
1 dissecting microscope
1 razor blade
1 forceps
2 toothpick
1 plastic dish filled with water
3/16
All plants were grown for 4 weeks with 8 hours light and 16 hours of darkness per day and then either
exposed to complete darkness for 48 hours (dark-incubated or dark) or to 10 hours of light (lightincubated or light) immediately prior to harvesting.
You are going to quantify the glucose content in those plant extracts by measuring the absorbance of
NADH. As shown below, one molecule of NAD+ is converted into one molecule of NADH per molecule of
glucose in a two-step reaction that is catalyzed by the enzymes hexokinase (HXK) and glucose-6phosphate dehydrogenase [G6PDH]. The master mix [MM] contains NAD+, HXK and ATP.
You will work with a 96-well microplate (see figure below). Only touch its edges! Positions on this plate
are indicated by a number (1-12) and a letter (A-H) specifying columns and rows, respectively. Use only
the wells which are listed in the protocol (contained within the area indicated by the dotted line).
4/16
A1
0
A2
50
A3
100
A4
150
A5
200
A6
250
A7
300
500 M
Q 1 NADH solution (l)
H2O (l)
Part 1.2: Glucose content [15 points for measured raw values]
To determine the concentration of glucose in the different plant extracts, you will now prepare two
solutions for each plant extract. The Wells B1-B6 will serve as a blank to quantify the base absorption
and differ from the Wells C1-C6 which will contain a solution of G6PDH. Begin by pipetting the following
into Wells B1-B6 and C1-C6:
1. 100 l Master mix into the Wells B1-B6 and C1-C6
2. 20 l H2O into the Wells B1-B6
20 l G6PDH solution into the Wells C1-C6
3. 80 l of the corresponding plant extract as indicated in the table below and mix by pipetting
three times up and down
Wells
Plant extract
B1 and C1
WT light
B2 and C2
WT dark
B3 and C3
sex1 light
B4 and C4
sex1 dark
B5 and C5
pgm1 light
B6 and C6
pgm1 dark
Incubate for at least 20 and up to 60 minutes at room temperature. After incubation, call an assistant by
placing your flag into the tube on your left partition wall. The assistant will measure the absorbance at
340 nm and bring you a printout of the absorbance values measured for each well. You will need these
values for the analysis in Part 1.3.
NOTE: Due to the limited number of microplate readers, you might have to wait up to 15 minutes to
have your microplate measured after putting up your flag. During incubation time and waiting time you
may work on Tasks 2 and 3.
5/16
where A0 is the background absorbance value at 0 M NADH (Well A1) and Ac the absorbance value at
concentration cNADH. s is equivalent to the extinction coefficient multiplied with l, the path length of
light through the solution. Write the calculated values in the answer fields (precision: five positions after
the decimal point). [3 points]
Well
[NADH] (M)
A2
50
A3
100
A4
150
A5
200
A6
250
A7
300
-1
Q 2 s ( M )
corresponding field below (precision: five positions after the decimal point). [1 point]
Q3
( M-1)
where AG6PDH is the absorbance measured for the sample incubated with G6PDH (Wells C1-C6), AH2O is
the absorbance measured for the sample incubated with H2O only (Wells B1-B6), and s is the mean
scaled extinction coefficient you have calculated above. Then, use these values to calculate the initial
glucose content that was present in the fresh leaves, indicated as mmol/g. Each plant extract was made
of 25 g leaf material per liter. Report your values in the table below (precision: one position after the
decimal point). [7 points]
6/16
WT light
Q4
WT dark
sex1 light
sex1 dark
pgm1 light
pgm1 dark
Q5
false
7/16
GROUP II
While all plants of one group have been harvested after incubating for 12 hours in light, all plants of the
other group have been harvested after incubating for 12 h in complete darkness. Each group contains at
least one wild type plant (WT), one starch degradation mutant (sex1) and one starch synthesis mutant
(pgm1).
Repeat the following steps for each of the plants A-H to stain them:
1. Transfer the plant specimen into a fresh plastic dish.
2. Remove residual liquid from the dish, with the Pasteur pipette.
3. Stain the plants by covering them with some drops of Lugols solution using the Pasteur
pipette.
4. Incubate at room temperature for 1 minute before doing your observations.
Indicate the observed staining pattern of leaves of each plant specimen in Group I (Plants A-D) and
Group II (Plants E-H) in the table below with a tick (). [4 points]
Group I
Plant
Q6
Light
orange
Dark
brown
Intense
black
Plant
Group II
Light
orange
Dark
brown
Intense
black
Based on the observed plants and staining pattern, indicate the corresponding growth condition for
Group I and Group II in the table below with a tick (). [1 points]
Growth condition
12 h in light
12 h in darkness
Q 7 Group I
Group II
8/16
Based on the observed plants and staining pattern, indicate the corresponding strain for each of the
plant specimen (A-H) in the table below with a tick (). [4 points]
Group
I
Q8
Plant
WT
Strain
sex1
pgm1
A
B
C
D
II
E
F
G
H
9/16
Indicate the most appropriate type of inflorescence for each Specimen V-Z with a tick ().[2.5 points]
V
Inflorescence type 1
Q9
Inflorescence type 2
Inflorescence type 3
Inflorescence type 4
Inflorescence type 5
Inflorescence type 6
Inflorescence type 7
number of sepals
Q 10
number of petals or tepals
number of stamens
number of styles (count branched
styles only once)
Indicate the correct state of fusion of sepals, petals and stamen for flowers of plant Specimens V-Z with
a tick () in the table below. [6.5 points]
V
Sepals
Q 11
Petals /
Free (fused part <10%)
tepals
Partially fused (fused part 10-90%)
Completely fused (fused part >90%)
Stamens
Free
Partially fused to other stamens
at the base or the top (fused part 10-90%)
Partially fused with petals / tepals (fused part
10-90%),
Partially fused to other stamens AND with
petals / tepals (fused part 10-90%)
Indicate the ovary position of the flowers for each specimen V-Z with a tick () in the table below. [2.5
points]
12/16
A (superior)
Q 12
B (inferior)
Indicate the floral symmetry for flowers of each of the specimens V-Z with a tick () in the table below.
[2.5 points]
V
A (radial)
Q 13
B (bilateral)
C (asymmetrical)
13/16
Open
flower
disk
Tubular flower
with
radial
symmetry
Radial symmetry
Pollen and/or nectar partially or
completely hidden in a narrow tube
Tube may be built from free or fused
floral parts
Tubular flower
with bilateral
symmetry
Bilateral symmetry
Pollen partially or completely hidden in
a narrow tube
Tube may be built from free or fused
floral parts
Brush flower
Based on the morphological characteristics you determined above, indicate the most appropriate floral
shape class for each specimen V-Z with a tick () in the table below. [5 points]
V
Floral shape 1
Q 14
Floral shape 2
Floral shape 3
Floral shape 4
14/16
3.2.2 Pollinators
As is shown for a subset of common pollinators in the following table, the floral shape and other
characteristics of the flowers or inflorescences are often strongly associated with their pollinators.
n
Pollinator
Wind
Characteristics of pollinator
Common shapes
inflorescences
of
flowers
Unspecific
Inconspicuous
Non-directional
Bees/ bumblebees
Day-active
Either
Biting mouthparts
Bilateral
Long tongue
Attracted by pollen and nectar
Pollen gathering
Moths
Night-active
Long proboscis
Fragrant scent
Butterfly
Day-active
Upright position
Long proboscis
Tight tube
Flies
Licking mouthparts
Either
Small and flat
Without scent
Nectar reward freely presented
Or
Brown/purple advertisement
Carrion- or excrement-scented
15/16
The following table lists additional floral traits of the plant specimen that cannot be observed from the
prepared samples (+: present, ++ : strongly present, -: (nearly) absent).
V
presence of nectar
++
++
scent
++
Based on the characteristics of the flowers or inflorescences you observed and given in the table above,
indicate with a tick () for each of the different plant specimens V-Z its most likely group of pollinators in
the table below. Use the numbers indicated for each group in the table above. If several groups are
equally likely, pick any one of them. [5 points]
V
Pollinator 1
Q 15
Pollinator 2
Pollinator 3
Pollinator 4
Pollinator 5
16/16
Practical Exam 3
Evolutionary Ethology
Total points: 94
Duration: 90 minutes
1 / 13
Dear participants,
This test consists of three tasks:
Task 1: Quantifying aggressiveness
Part 1.1: Experimental setup
Part 1.2: Aggressive behavior of Neolamprologus pulcher
Part 1.3: Examples of ramming or biting attacks
Part 1.4: Quantify ramming or biting attacks of N. pulcher [30 points]
Part 1.5: Additional replicates
Part 1.6: Statistical analysis of bite or ram attacks [20 points]
Task 2: Puffed throat behavior
4
4
4
5
5
6
6
10
10
10
10
11
12
Part 3.1: Quantifying task sharing in social groups of N. pulcher [15 points]
12
13
Please write your student code into the box on the title page.
There is no separate answer sheet. Please fill in your answers into the specific answers boxes indicated
with a gray background. Only answers given inside these boxes will be evaluated.
The answers have to be given either with a tick () or with Arabic numbers. The numbers "1" and "7" can
look very similar in handwriting. To make sure that those two numbers can be well distinguished by the
IBO staff, please write them as you normally would into the following box.
1=
7=
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings at the end of the exam. Put
the entire protocol with all the answers back into the exam envelope. Make sure you wrote your
student code into the box on the title page.
Equipment
1 Tablet with preloaded movies
scratch paper
2 / 13
Introduction
Most organisms are limited in resources such as food, mating partners or shelters. As a result, available
resources are often defended by aggressive interactions with conspecific (same species) and
heterospecific (different species) competitors. A very common phenomenon to monopolize resources is
the establishment of a well-defended territory. But territorial defense is costly as it may expose the
territorial resident to an increased risk of injury or predation or reduce the time available for other
activities such as foraging, mating or brood care. Given this, a territorial resident that is able to adjust its
aggressive response to match the degree of threat posed by an intruder is expected to have a selective
advantage.
In this practical you will test if individuals of the territorial African cichlid Neolamprologus pulcher are
using visual and / or olfactory cues of a competing conspecific to adjust their aggressive response. N.
pulcher is native to Lake Tanganyika where it forms breeding pairs, which defend a small contiguous
territory (mean area = 0.3 m2) used for feeding, breeding, and shelter from predators.
All experiments were conducted under laboratory conditions in aquaria and recorded on video. Your
task is now to analyze these recordings by quantifying the behavior of different individuals. All videos
are preloaded on a tablet computer and can be played at your convenience.
3 / 13
Throughout this task, you will only have to consider the behavioral response of the focal male in the
right compartment (indicated in gray).
4 / 13
Q1
Situation
Separation
Size
A
sealed
different
B
sealed
matched
C
porous
different
D
porous
matched
Replicate 1
Replicate 2
Replicate 3
5 / 13
A
sealed
different
24
34
27
B
sealed
matched
45
41
38
C
porous
different
10
17
12
D
porous
matched
15
8
16
where i runs over all replicates 1 through n and Ri are the observed counts in replicate i and M is the
mean across all replicates 1 through n.
Situation
Separation
Size
A
sealed
different
B
sealed
matched
C
porous
different
D
porous
matched
Mean (M)
Q2
sample variance ( 2)
Now compute the average sample variance within groups (Vg) as the average of the four variances.
Report your results in the box below with a precision of one digit after the decimal point.
6 / 13
Variance explained by the type of separation and difference in the size of males
Next compute the variance explained by the type of separation (Vseparation) and the variance explained by
the difference in size of males (Vsize). To do so, you will first have to compute the overall mean of bite or
ram attacks across all 24 replicates. Report your result in the box below with a precision of one digit
after the decimal point.
where i runs over both categories of the factor considered, n is the number of replicates within each
category (12 in your case), Mi is the mean within category i and MABCD the overall mean computed in Q4.
Compute the variance explained by each factor and report your results in the table below with a
precision of one digit after the decimal point.
Type of separation
If a factor does not explain any of the observed variance, we expect Vx to be zero. However, due to the
stochastic nature of this experiment, deviations from zero are expected. You will now test if the
7 / 13
deviations from zero you observed for both Vseparation and Vsize are statistically significant, which would
indicate that these factors are significantly explaining part of your observations. This is done by
computing the probability of observing deviations as large as or even larger than what you observed. To
do so, you will need a F-test, for which you now need to compute the test statistic Fx, which is given by
the variance explained by factor x (either separation or size) divided by the average sample variance
within groups (Vg) you calculated in Q3.
Calculate Fx for both factors and report your results in the table below with a precision of one digit after
the decimal point.
Type of separation
B
test statistic Fx
Q7
You can now use the properties of the F-distribution to translate the test statistic into the probability of
observing the Vx values you calculated or even more extreme Vx values if factor x does not explain any
of the variance observed. This probability is commonly referred to as the p-value. The table below
shows the corresponding F-values for a wide range of p-values.
Fx
0.47
2.96
4.32
8.02
14.59
22.89
33.28
46.27
62.46
82.65
p-value
0.5
0.1
0.05
0.01
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
10-7
10-8
Use this table to translate your test statistic values into p-values. For each factor, indicate in the table
below, the smallest p-value for which the p-value corresponding to the calculated F-value is smaller.
Type of separation
Q8
p-value <
8 / 13
Indicate with a tick () for each factor if it explains a fraction of the total variance significantly (p-value <
0.05) or not in the table below.
Type of separation
Q9
Indicate with a tick () if each of the following statements is a valid conclusion from your results or not.
valid
Q10
not valid
9 / 13
Situation
Separation
Q11 Size
A
sealed
different
B
sealed
matched
C
porous
different
D
porous
matched
Replicate 1
Replicate 2
Replicate 3
10 / 13
Q12
false
These results are in line with N. pulcher males using visual cues of a competing
conspecific to adjust their aggressive response.
The results are in line with N. pulcher males using puffed throat behavior to bluff
about their size, which is most effective if males are of equal size.
11 / 13
Part 3.1: Quantifying task sharing in social groups of N. pulcher [15 points]
Activate your tablet by tapping the screen with your fingers and open the Folder X. This folder contains
the Movie x with two sequences showing typical territory maintenance and brood care behavior of the
simplest social group of N. pulcher consisting of a large breeding male, a slightly smaller breeding female
and a small helper. You can recognize each individual easily in the very first scene of the sequence (see
figure below): the breeding male (A) is standing in the ceramic nesting cave in the background on the
right and the breeding female (B) is swimming in open water on the left. The only eggs in the aquarium
are attached to the top of the inner wall of the ceramic cave (C) within which the helper (D) hides.
While watching this movie, you will focus on two typical behaviors:
Digging behavior is a typical territory maintenance behavior in which the fish takes up sand,
carries it away in its mouth and spits it out at another location. Count the number of digging
sequences performed for each of the three individuals.
N. pulcher individuals perform egg care by cleaning the eggs from small particles such as fungi or
biofilms. This behavior is visible by back-and-forth movements in front of the eggs and
simultaneous mouth movements. Estimate the total time spent on this behavior by each
individual.
Report the total number of digging behavior for each individual in the table below.
12 / 13
Breeding male
Q13
Breeding female
Helper individual
D
Indicate with a tick () the time spent on egg care for each of the three individuals in the table below.
Breeding male
Breeding female
Helper individual
D
true
false
helpers are likely to have a larger effect on the survival rates of clutches of
breeding pairs after an oligotrophic (nutrient-poor) environment was suddenly
converted into a highly eutrophic (hypertrophic) environment.
large-bodied breeding males are crucial in maintaining breeding caves by
digging large quantities of sand.
... the presence of helpers allows the breeding female to spend most of her time
patrolling the territory rather than on territory maintenance.
Q15
... helper individuals accommodate the large breeding male by following it and
maintaining the cave currently occupied by it.
13 / 13
Practical Exam 4
Comparative and Functional Biosystematics
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
1 / 17
Dear participants,
This test consists of three tasks:
Task 1: Determine presence or absence of characters [42 points]
Part 1.1: Description of morphological characters
Part 1.2: Determine all character states [42 points]
Task 2: Resolve phylogenetic relationships [24 points]
Part 2.1: How maximum parsimony works
Part 2.2: Resolve the phylogenetic relationship using parsimony [10 points]
Part 2.3: Identify characters reflecting diet [4 points]
Part 2.4: How UPGMA works
Part 2.5: Resolve the phylogenetic relationship using UPGMA [10 points]
Task 3: Rate of morphological evolution [34 points]
Part 3.1: Obtain necessary skull measurements [15 points]
Part 3.2: Calculate the morphological distance between species pairs [15 points]
Part 3.3: Plot the phylogenetic versus the morphological distance [2 points]
Part 3.4: Interpret the results [2 point]
Appendix: Character states (presence or absence) of all specimens
5
5
5
6
6
7
8
9
11
13
13
13
15
16
17
Please write your student code into the box on the title page.
There is no separate answer sheet. Please fill in your answers into the specific answers boxes indicated
with a gray background. Only answers given inside these boxes will be evaluated.
The answers have to be given either with a tick () or with Arabic numbers. The numbers "1" and "7" can
look very similar in handwriting. To make sure that those two numbers can be well distinguished by the
IBO staff, please write them as you normally would into the following box.
1=
7=
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings at the end of the exam. Put
the entire protocol with all the answers back into the exam envelope. Make sure you wrote your
student code into the box on the title page.
2 / 17
Equipment
1 sliding caliper (150 mm)
1 ruler (300 mm)
1 calculator
scratch paper
Skull specimen
Arvicola terrestris
Capreolous capreoulus
Felis catus
Lepus europaeus
Meles meles
Sciurus vulgaris
Vulpes vulpes
arte
caca
feca
leeu
meme
scvu
vuvu
cesi
dima
eqfe
gase
gege
hiam
inge
mape
maru
muni
pipi
prca
ptva
somi
taac
toma
Print outs
skull diagrams
color print outs illustrating the presence (1) and absence (-) of the morphological characters.
Note legend on top.
3 / 17
Introduction
Mammals, which consist of more than 5700 extant species, are omnipresent on earth and often play key
roles in shaping terrestrial and aquatic ecosystems, both as predators and herbivores. Mammals are
morphologically very diverse. The smallest mammals, for instance, weigh only about 2 g, whereas the
blue whale, the largest animal that ever existed, is more than 100 million times larger.
In this practical exam, you will attempt to resolve the phylogeny of some representatives of major
mammal groups based on morphological characters of the skull (teeth and jaw), as well as molecular
data. You will use cladistics, an approach to infer evolutionary relationships, which assumes that
members of a taxonomic group have a common evolutionary history. They have therefore inherited a
set of derived traits (synapomorphies) from their last common ancestor, which distinguishes members
of this group from other groups.
Cladistic analysis consists of identifying specific traits and determining their state in all organisms
included in the analysis. Traits can be both molecular (e.g. the specific amino acid at a specific position in
a protein) or morphological (e.g. the presence or absence of a particular bone feature). The outcome of
a cladistic analysis is a cladogram - a tree-shaped diagram (dendrogram) that represents the inferred
phylogenetic relationships between organisms.
4 / 17
Description
Elongated incisors [I] with abrasive (rubbed) edges indicating continuously growth through
life on upper and/or lower jaw.
Incisors [I] on the front side coated with dental enamel (orange color).
Third upper incisors [I3] reduced and positioned behind the second incisors.
Diastema on upper jaw. A diastema is defined as a large gap (more than two times the
width of the largest tooth adjacent to the gap) between the position of incisors [I] or
canines [C] and the premolars [P] or molars [M]. Some of these teeth may be absent.
Carnassial dentition, characterized by [P4] in the upper jaw and [M1] in the lower jaw
forming a scissor-like structure which allows cutting and breaking, but not chewing.
Lophodont teeth, characterized by elongated ridges that run between cusps. Ridges are
perpendicular to the jaw (like an old-fashioned washboard).
10
11
12
The angular extension [Ang. Pr.] (Processus Angularis) of the lower jaw is bent medial
(towards the centre) and therefore more medial than [Cond. Pr.] (Processus condularis).
5 / 17
To choose among those phylogenies, the presence or absence of morphological characters 1 through 4
was assessed for each taxa and reported in the table below. All of these characters are known to be
absent in closely related taxa, indicating that each character was absent at the root of the phylogenies
(indicated by a black dot in the diagrams above).
A
B
C
1
1
1
2
1
1
3
1
-
4
1
1
-
First, the minimal number of state changes has to be determined for each character and phylogeny
individually. Trait 4, for instance, is present in Taxa A and B, but not in Taxon C, indicating that the state
of this character changed from absent to present along the lineages leading to A and B. While this
change could have happened independently on Branches A and B, the explanation leading to the
minimal number of state changes (and hence the most parsimonious solution) is a single change on the
branch leading to the most recent common ancestor of A and B.
As shown in the following figure, two equally parsimonious Solutions Ia and Ib can be found for
Phylogeny I when considering all characters. In Solution Ia, Characters 1 and 2 are assumed to have
arisen independently on Branches B and C. Alternatively (Solution Ib), these characters arose on the
branch coming from the root of the phylogeny, and were lost on the Branch A. Note that throughout
this practical, open circles indicate gains (changes from absent present) and black bars indicate
losses (state changes from present absent).
6 / 17
A key observation is that any character for which the state in a single taxon differs from the state at the
root (such as Trait 3 in this example) invokes a single character change, regardless of the phylogeny
considered. Such characters and those for which the state is identical in all taxa should be regarded as
uninformative and discarded prior to the analysis.
The following figure finally shows one of the most parsimonious solutions for each of the competing
phylogenies, along with the number of character state changes invoked by these solutions given in the
box. Thus, under the concept of maximum parsimony, Phylogeny II is chosen as the best estimate of the
true phylogenetic relationship between Taxa A, B and C.
Part 2.2: Resolve the phylogenetic relationship using parsimony [10 points]
You will now use maximum parsimony to resolve the phylogenetic relationship among the following
taxa, representing a major mammal clade:
Arvicola terrestris (arte)
Ceratotherium simum (cesi)
Equus ferus (eqfe)
Genetta genetta (gege)
Lepus europaeus (leeu)
Capreolus capreolus (caca)
Sorex minutus (somi)
First, indicate with a tick () if Characters 1 through 12 (page 5) are informative to resolve the phylogeny
of these taxa, or not. Note that all characters are known to be absent at the root of these taxa, with the
exception of 1, 6 and 11, which are present at the root.
Character
10
11
12
informative
Q2
not informative
7 / 17
Next, indicate any of the most parsimonious solutions regarding character state changes for each of the
two competing phylogenies I and II directly into the figure. Indicate gains with empty circles and losses
with bars and write the number of the corresponding characters above it. Finally, indicate the total
number of state changes necessary in the box provided.
Q3
Indicate the phylogeny that represents the best estimate of the true phylogenetic relationship among
those 7 taxa according to the concept of maximum parsimony with a tick () in the table below
I
Q4
II
8 / 17
The following are very distantly related species but are known to be highly herbivorous and feed on
grass, leaves, fruits and roots:
Arvicola terrestris (arte)
Capreolous capreolus (caca)
Equus ferus (eqfe)
Lepus europaeus (leeu)
Macropus rufus (maru)
Procavia capensis (prca)
Pteropus vampyrus (ptva)
Indicate with a tick () in the table below for each Character 1 through 12 whether its presence or
absence is typical for either an carnivorous or herbivorous lifestyle. Here, a typical character state is
defined as any character state shared by at least three of the taxa from one of the two groups but
absent from all members of the other group.
Character
10
11
12
A
B
C
D
A
0
6
7
8
B
0
8
9
C
0
4
D
0
Iteration 1: First, the pair of clusters with the smallest distance is the pair C and D, which is combined
into a higher-order cluster (C,D). The relative age of the newly formed cluster is computed as half of the
distance between the two clusters combined. In this case, the relative age of the cluster is thus 2.
9 / 17
Next, a new matrix of all distances is generated by computing the distance between clusters as the
average distance between all taxa from one cluster to all taxa of the other cluster. The distance between
cluster A and cluster (C,D), for instance, is computed as the average between d(A,C) and d(A,D), where
d(x,y) is a notation to indicate the distance between clusters x and y.
A
B
(C,D)
A
0
6
7.5
B
0
8.5
(C,D)
0
Iteration 2: The pair of clusters with the smallest distance is now the pair of A and B, which is thus
combined into a higher level cluster (A,B) with a relative age of 3. Again, distances are recomputed as
indicated above. The distance d((A,B),(C,D)) is thus the average between d(A,C), d(A,D), d(B,C) and
d(B,D), which is the same as the average between d(A,(C,D)) and d(B,(C,D)).
(A,B)
(C,D)
(A,B)
0
8
(C,D)
0
Iteration 3: In the last iteration, the two remaining taxa are combined into the new cluster ((A,B),(C,D))
and the relative age of this cluster is 4.
Computing branch length: After all taxa have been combined into a single cluster, the resulting tree is
plotted with the relative age of each cluster. From these relative times, it is then straight forward to
compute individual branch length.
10 / 17
Part 2.5: Resolve the phylogenetic relationship using UPGMA [10 points]
Resolve the phylogenetic relationship of all five Carnivora species included in this practical iteratively
using the UPGMA method. Standardized molecular distances between all pairs of these taxa are given in
the table below.
vuvu
muni
gege
meme
feca
Vulpes vulpes
Mustela nivalis
Genetta genetta
Meles meles
Felis catus
A
B
C
D
E
A
0.00
4.18
4.96
4.18
4.96
B
0.00
4.96
0.48
4.96
C
0.00
4.96
2.82
D
0.00
4.96
E
0.00
Proceed iteratively and always fill in the table with the molecular distances considered. Make sure to
always report the code of the cluster in the top and left most row. Use the notation introduced above to
denote higher level clusters. The term ((x,y),z), for instance, should refer to a cluster made of the
clusters (x,y) and z. Also, report the relative age of the newly formed cluster in each iteration (precision:
two digits after the decimal point).
Iteration 1
Relative age of newly
formed cluster
0.00
Q6
0.00
0.00
0.00
Iteration 2
Relative age of newly
formed cluster
0.00
Q7
0.00
0.00
Iteration 3
Relative age of newly
formed cluster
0.00
Q8
0.00
Iteration 4
Relative age of newly
formed cluster
Q9
11 / 17
Now draw the resulting phylogeny of the five species to scale and indicate the length of each branch on
the top and the species code on the right of it. Note that 5 mm indicates 0.1 unit of relative age of your
calculated tree.
Q10
12 / 17
M1
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M7
Description
distance in mm between [I1] and [NF1].
distance in mm between [Ang. Pr.] and end of masseter depression (masseter
muscle attachment point).
distance in mm between [Ang. Pr.] and [Cond. Pr.].
distance in mm between [I] and [Cond. Pr.].
distance in mm between end of eyes and end of [PA]
distance in mm between eyes and [PMX].
distance in mm between [PMX] or [NA] or [I] and [Cond. Pr.].
While results for features M5 and M6 will be provided below, measure the five features (M1 through M4
and M7) for both specimens (arte and leeu). Focus on the right side of the skull (the left side when facing
the skull). Report your results in mm in the table to a precision of 0.1 mm
M1
Q11
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M7
arte
Arvicola terrestris
leeu
Lepus europaeus
Part 3.2: Calculate the morphological distance between species pairs [15 points]
A major hurdle when studying different skull features is that they are primarily determined by the
overall size of the specimen. To study skull shape, begin by correcting for the overall size of the skull by
dividing each measurement by the length of the skull (M7) and taking the logarithm to base 10 from this
ratio. For each measurement Mi = {M1, ..., M4}, calculate:
Report your results in the table below with a precision of three digits after the decimal point.
13 / 17
arte
Q12 Arvicola terrestris
leeu
Lepus europaeus
-0.367
-0.478
-0.547
-0.382
where
is the standardized measure i of species x. The absolute difference is the difference
regardless of whether it is negative or positive (indicated by | |). Report your results with a precision of
three digits after the decimal point in the table below.
When combining the different measures into a single distance, it is important to first standardize the
distances in order to give them equal weight. A simple procedure to standardize is to divide the absolute
differences
by the median difference across all species pairs considered:
0.084
0.139
0.067
0.026
0.110
0.082
Standardize all distances and report your results with a precision of three digits after the decimal point
in the table below.
14 / 17
Calculate
for arte and leeu and report your results with a precision of three digits after the
decimal point in the table below.
Part 3.3: Plot the phylogenetic versus the morphological distance [2 points]
The graph below shows the phylogenetic distance
against the morphological distance
for pairs of some of the species listed in the Appendix, along with a linear regression best
explaining the observed values. Add your calculated distances to this plot by using a dot with a circle
around, similar to the other points. The phylogenetic distance between arte and leeu is 6.80.
Q16
15 / 17
Q17
no
Both species of pair P are closely related but were geographically separated
and evolved convergent adaptations to very similar habitats.
The ancestor of one species of pair P colonized a totally different
environment with very different selection pressures, changing its skull
morphology dramatically.
Both species of pair T are part of a fast, ecologically driven adaptive
radiation.
While only distantly related, both species of pair T feed on very similar
resources, for which their skulls evolved convergent adaptations.
16 / 17
caca
feca
leeu
meme
scvu
vuvu
cesi
dima
eqfe
gase
gege
hiam
inge
mape
maru
muni
pipi
prca
ptva
somi
taac
toma
Arvicola
terrestris
Capreolus
capreolus
Felis
catus
Lepus
europaeus
Meles
meles
Sciurus
vulgaris
Vulpes
vulpes
Ceratotherium
simum
Didelphis
marsupialis
Equus
ferus
Galago
senegalensis
Genetta
genetta
Hippopotamus
amphibius
Inia
geoffrensis
Manis
pentadactyla
Macropus
rufus
Mustela
nivalis
Pipistrellus
pipistrellus
Procavia
capensis
Pteropus
vampyrus
Sorex
minutus
Tachyglossus
aculeatus
Tolypeutes
matacus
10
11
12
17 / 17
2012, Singapore
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO2012 Singapore
Country: _____________________
Page 1 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
Dear Participants
You have a total of 3 hours (180 minutes) for answering this theory paper.
Use the Answer Sheet, which is provided separately, to answer all the questions.
Write your answers legibly. Note that there may be more than one correct/incorrect
answer and every cell should be filled.
For example:
NOTE: Some of the questions may be marked Skipped / Deleted. DO NOT attempt
these questions. Also, read the question completely before attempting it as some
questions may continue from one page to the next.
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings.
Your Answer Sheets as well as the Theoretical Test question paper will be collected at
the end of the test period.
Good Luck!
Page 2 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
CELL BIOLOGY
1.
Some viruses (e.g. tobacco mosaic virus (TMV)) have RNA sequences that contain a "leaky"
stop codon. In TMV 95% of the time the host ribosome will terminate the synthesis of the
polypeptide at this codon but the rest of the time it continues past it.
The following sequences show part of a mRNA from TMV. Indicate the sequence(s) that may
result in two polypeptides in the indicated frame with a tick () and those that will not with a
cross (). (1.8 points)
a.
5-AUG-UCU-UGU-CUU-UUC-ACC-CGG-GGG-UAG-UAU-UAC-CAU-GAU-GGU-UAA-3
b.
5-AUG-ACC-CGG-GGG-UUU-CUU-UUC-UAG-UAU-GAU-CAU-GAA-GGU-UGU-UAA-3
c.
5-AUG-CUU-UUC-UCU-UAU-UAG-CAU-GAU-GGU-UGU-ACC-CGG-GGG-CCC-UAA-3
d.
5-AUG-CAU-GUU-CUU-UUC-UCU-UAU-UGU-GGU-UGU-ACC-CGG-GGG-UUC-UAA-3
e.
5-AUG-CAU-GAU-GGU-UGU-ACC-CGG-GGG-UAG-CUU-UUC-UCU-UAU-UGC-UAA-3
f.
5-AUG-UCU-UAU-UGG-CAU-GAU-GGU-UGU-CUU-UUC-ACC-CGG-GGG-AAA-UAA-3
Page 3 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
2.
thermogenesis
b.
apoptosis
c.
production of ATP
d.
Indicate the extensive presence of mitochondria with a tick (), intermediate presence (-) and
absence of mitochondria with a cross (). Match the key function(s) of mitochondria (a to d)
suited to the respective cells. (1.8 points)
3.
Arrange the order of the DNA molecules from lowest to highest in terms of their melting
temperature (Tm). (0.9 points)
a.
5-AAGTTCTCTGAA-3
3-TTCAAGAGACTT-5
b.
5-AGTCGTCAATGCGG-3
3-TCAGCAGTTACGCC-5
c.
5-GGACCTCTCAGG-3
3-CCTGGAGAGTCC-5
Page 4 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
4.
There are various mechanisms by which a cell can commit suicide a phenomenon known as
apoptosis. One of the mechanisms is triggered by reactive oxygen species. The outer
membrane of mitochondria normally expresses a protein Bcl-2 on its surface. Another protein
Apaf-1 binds Bcl-2. Reactive oxygen species cause Bcl-2 to release Apaf-1 and a third protein
Bax to penetrate the mitochondrial membrane, releasing cytochrome c. The released
cytochrome c forms a complex with Apaf-1 and caspase 9. This complex sequentially activates
many proteases that digest cellular proteins.
What will be the fate of a cell exposed to reactive oxygen species in the following conditions?
I.
The cell has expressed a mutant form of Apaf-1 that constitutively (always) bind Bcl-2.
II.
III.
The cell overexpresses a form of Bcl-2 that is targeted to cell membrane only.
IV.
A chemical which extends the half life of Bcl-2 is added to the cell.
Match the following fates of the cell with the conditions (I to IV). (2 points)
a. The cell resists apoptosis.
b. The cell is forced towards apoptosis.
c. The fate of the cell cannot be predicted.
Page 5 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
5.
The Table below shows the chemical structure, pK1, pK2 and pKR of some amino acids.
pK1
-COOH
pK2
-NH2
pKR
side chain
Glycine (Gly)
2.35
9.78
---
Alanine (Ala)
2.35
9.87
---
Serine (Ser)
2.19
9.21
---
1.99
9.9
3.9
2.1
9.47
4.07
Lysine (Lys)
2.16
9.06
10.54
Amino acid
Structural formula
5.2. What is the best pH for the electrophoretic separation of these three peptides from each
other?
Indicate the best pH with a tick () and the other pH values with a cross (). (0.6 points)
Page 6 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
6.
Which of the following sequence(s) of cell-cycle phases is/are characteristic of eukaryotes [G:
gap; S: synthesis; M: mitosis]? Indicate correct sequence(s) with a tick () and incorrect ones
with a cross (). (0.5 points)
7.
a.
G1 - S - G2 - G0 - M
b.
G0 - G1 - S - G2 - M
c.
G1 - G0 - G2 - S - M
d.
G1 - G0 - G1 - G2 - S - M
e.
G1 - G0 - G1 - S - G2 - M
b.
The homologous chromosomes have been pulled to their respective poles by the
spindle apparatus.
c.
d.
7.2. How many chromatin threads are there in a human somatic cell in the G2 phase? (0.5
points)
Page 7 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
8.
8.1. Bacteria in nature prefer to attach to surfaces and exist in a form known as biofilms.
During the attachment stage, before reaching the surface for attachment, bacteria will
encounter a zone of repulsive force as they come very close to the surface. Which bacteria
are likely to have an advantage to overcome this repulsive zone? Indicate the correct
answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a cross (). (0.6 points)
a.
Bacterium A
b.
Bacterium B
c.
Bacterium C
8.2. After overcoming the repulsive zone and reaching the surface, the strength of attachment
on the surface of the three bacteria is likely to be different. Arrange the correct order of
attachment strength of the three bacteria in the Answer Sheet. (0.6 points)
Page 8 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
8.3. A stagnant pool of water was originally rich in organic content, but the nutrient
concentration soon became diluted with rainwater. All three bacteria were affected and
would attempt to survive the best way they could under this condition. Indicate true
statement(s) with a tick () and incorrect statement(s) with a cross (). (0.6 points)
9.
a.
Bacterium A allows the fastest relative diffusion of nutrients into the interior of its cell.
b.
Bacterium B can extend its flagellum to reach nutrients above the water level.
c.
A laboratory technician stained unknown bacterial cells with different dyes before observing
them. The dyes (stains) used are known to target (i) lipopolysaccharide, (ii) nuclear envelope,
(iii) DNA, (iv) cytoplasm and (v) ribosomes. Which dyes are likely to stain positive no matter
what type of bacteria there may be in the sample? Indicate with a tick () if they will be stained
and with a cross () if they will not be stained. (1 point)
Page 9 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
10.1. Match the codes (1 18) given in the table below with the labeled parts (A to H) in the
above figure. (1.6 points)
No.
Part
No.
Part
Hypodermis
10
Sclerenchyma cell
Epithelial cell
11
Casparian strip
Xylem parenchyma
12
Central vacuole
Epidermal cell
13
Phloem parenchyma
Xylem fiber
14
Pericycle
Root hair
15
Companion cell
Exodermal cells
16
Phloem fiber
Xylem vessel
17
Endodermal cell
18
Collenchyma cell
Page 10 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
10.2. The following are three pathways of ion and water absorption:
I.
a symplastic pathway
II.
an apoplastic pathway
Draw continuous lines and label (with I, II and III) the three different pathways from the
outside to H in the figure provided in the Answer Sheet. (3 points)
11. Match plant structures (1 10) with the corresponding function (A J). (3 points)
Plant cell / Tissue structure
Function(s) / Feature(s)
Thylakoid membranes
Vascular cambium
Central vacuole
Plasmodesmata
Apical meristem
Periderm
Mechanical support
Sieve tube
Trichome
Micropyle
10
Page 11 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
12. Study the graph below and determine which of the statements (a to h) are correct.
Indicate correct answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect ones with a cross (). (1.4 points)
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Plants stop growth when they grow under the irradiance greater than the value shown at
point B.
f.
Respiration rate is greater than photosynthetic rate when plants are grown under the light
below the value shown at point A.
g.
Plants grow (accumulate biomass) when their growth light environments are higher than
the photon flux shown at point A.
Page 12 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
13. Study the light response curves for leaf photosynthesis of C4 and C3 plants shown below.
Indicate correct statement(s) with a tick () and incorrect statement(s) with a cross (). (1.2
points)
a.
b.
C3 plants have a competitive advantage over C4 plants at high temperature and under full
sunlight because of a reduction in photorespiration.
c.
C3 plants have a competitive advantage over C4 plants at low temperature and under low
light because of the higher quantum yield.
Page 13 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
14. Some statements about photosynthesis are given below. Indicate true statement(s) with a tick
() and false statement(s) with a cross (). (1.0 points)
a.
b.
The essential initial role of light in initiating the light reaction of photosynthesis is to produce
free oxygen.
c.
In a plant cell, the ATP synthase complexes are only located in the thylakoid membrane.
d.
e.
It is currently believed that the specific enzymes necessary for the fixation of CO 2 into
sugar are located in the chloroplast stroma.
15. Arrange the following plants A to C in evolutionary order starting with the most primitive
specimen to the most modern. (1.5 points)
Vascular Tissues
Page 14 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
16. Match the description or effect (A J) with their corresponding terms (1 10). (1.8 points)
Term
Description / effect
Physiological reaction of organisms to the length of day or
Ethylene
A
night
Photoperiodism
Apical dominance
Thigmotropism
D
flowering
Phyllotaxy
Cytokinin
Gibberellin
Statolith
Vernalization
Delayed senescence
Gravitropism
Page 15 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
[DELETED]
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
VI.
VII.
VIII.
18. Given below are data on the breathing rate, heart rate and body temperature of four different
mammals, A to D.
Animals
Breathing rate
(inhalations/min)
Heart rate
(beats/min)
Body temperature
(C)
160
500
36.5
15
40
37.2
28
190
38.2
28
35.9
18.1. Rank Animals A to D in descending order for surface area per unit volume of the body.
(0.8 points)
18.2. Rank Animals A to D in descending order for total volume of blood in the body. (0.8
points)
Page 16 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
19. Evaluate the following two statements regarding the respiratory processes of amphibians,
reptiles, birds and mammals. Indicate true statement(s) with a tick () and false statement(s)
with a cross (). (1.6 point)
I. Negative pressure used to force air into lungs
II. Lungs are completely ventilated during each breathing cycle
20. Gas exchange in animal taxa involves various respiratory organs (a d), as well as, the
circulatory system (open and closed). For each animal, indicate open circulatory system(s) with
a tick () and closed circulatory system(s) with a cross (). Match the appropriate organs (a
d) with the animals (adult). (2.6 points)
a.
lungs
b.
gills
c.
skin
d.
trachea
Page 17 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
21. Urine production is the result of continuous filtration of plasma through the kidneys. Indicate
true statement(s) about the mammalian kidney with a tick () and false statement(s) with a
cross (). (2 points)
a.
b.
c.
The loops of Henle remove water, ions and nutrients from the blood.
d.
Those able to excrete the most hyperosmotic urine, such as the kangaroo rats living in the
desert, have relatively short loops of Henle.
e.
f.
The kidneys help maintain blood pH by excreting hydrogen ions and reabsorbing
bicarbonate ions as needed.
g.
h.
i.
j.
22. The amount of saliva secreted by a mammal is related to how much chewing is required on
feeding. Match the following animals (a e) to the quantity of saliva secreted as given in the
table in the Answer Sheet. (0.8 points)
a.
wolf
b.
horse
c.
cattle
d.
human
Page 18 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
23. Allergy is a hypersensitive human immune system reaction which is a result of repeated antigen
exposure. In comparison, although pseudoallergy is identical to allergy in clinical terms, there is
no immunological stage in its development.
b.
c.
d.
Indicate for allergy, as well as pseudoallergy, the observation(s) that apply with a tick () and the
observation(s) that do not with a cross () in the Answer Sheet.(0.8 points)
24. The age of animal fossils can be determined by measuring the content of carbon isotope 14C in
the bones. How is 14C accumulated in the bones? Indicate correct statement(s) with a tick ()
and incorrect statement(s) with a cross (). (0.6 points)
a.
b.
c.
Page 19 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
25. European (freshwater) eel usually obtains oxygen by gills but can spend long periods of time
out of water using dermal respiration. The graph below shows the level of blood saturation by
oxygen and oxygen supply through different organs when the eel was removed from the water
(in arbitrary units):
A, B, C, D
Match the following statements (I to IV) to the corresponding lines (A D) shown above. (1.2
points)
I.
II.
Page 20 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
26. Anatomical characteristics of animals are adapted for their different modes of feeding (a d).
a.
carnivores
b.
omnivores
c.
non-ruminant herbivores
d.
ruminant herbivores
26.1. Match the different modes of feeding (a d) with the corresponding dental features (I
IV). (1.2 points)
I.
no upper incisors, have dental pad, molars allow only lateral movements
II.
26.2. The gastrointestinal (GI) tract surface area to the body surface area ratio differs between
herbivores, omnivores and carnivores. Match the different modes of feeding (a d) with
the corresponding GI tract surface/body surface area ratio as listed in the table in the
Answer Sheet. (1.2 points)
Page 21 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
27. Match the adaptations of the digestive systems (a c) with the corresponding anatomical
descriptions. (0.9 points).
Anatomical descriptions:
I.
II.
III.
Digestive adaptations:
a.
b.
c.
28. Fishes are specially adapted for aquatic life in different parts (e.g., surface, middle, bottom) of
the water column and various special habitats (e.g., sea grass beds, rock crevices). Their
swimming speeds are also partly dependent on their body morphology. Match the fishes (A H,
not drawn to scale) with their respective habitats and indicate the two fastest swimmers and the
two slowest swimmers. (2.4 points)
Page 22 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
29. In all classes of vertebrates, there are at least a few species that may occasionally take to the
air (e.g., flying fish, frog, lizard, and squirrel). They are not capable of true flight but make use
of non-flapping locomotion such as gliding and parachuting to slow their descent.
29.1. Animals that glide minimize drag (D) and use lift (L) to produce a more favourable lift-todrag ratio (L/D ratio). In contrast, animals that parachute maximize D as they often have
no significant surface area to produce enough L. When an animal has a steady glide,
several forces act upon it (see figure below). Resistance (R) of the outstretched body
against the airstream produces L. Drag (D) in the direction opposite to travel is also
present, and weight (mg) acts as well. The descending path makes an angle () with the
ground.
Match the correct animal, (a or b), with the expected values of L/D and in the table in
the Answer Sheet. (1 point)
29.2. In flying lizards, the patagium is a fold of skin connecting the forelimbs and hind limbs.
Russell and Dijkstra (2001) compared the patagia and accessory aerodynamic surfaces
between two species of lizards, Draco volans (flying dragon) and Ptychozoon kuhli
(flying gecko).
Page 23 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
Ptychozoon kuhli
Indicate correct conclusion(s) that can be drawn from the study about the morphological
adaptations of the lizards for aerial locomotion with a tick (), and incorrect conclusion(s)
with a cross (). (2 points)
a. Although the mean weight of D. volans is smaller than that of P. kuhli, their body area
per unit mass is very similar.
b. Comparison of the patagial area to mass indicates that the patagia of P. kuhli are
larger than those of D. volans of equivalent mass.
c. The accessory structures contribute more significantly to total available aerodynamic
area in D. volans than they do in P. kuhli.
d. The total body area of the two taxa is very similar.
e. The proportional area that is contributed by the patagium is much larger in D. volans
than in P. kuhli, which compensates by the addition of extensive accessory flaps and
folds.
Page 24 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
30. In the hypophysis, several regulatory peptides are built from the propeptide, Proopiomelanocortin (POMC). POMC is cleaved proteolytically (A E) into various products.
Every polypeptide below is represented with N- terminal on the left and C- terminal on the right.
Note that each enzyme digests only matured precursor peptide.
30.1. Write down the minimum number of enzymes needed by a cell to produce -MSH from
POMC. (1 point)
30.2. Write down the minimum number of enzymes needed by a cell to produce -MSH from
POMC. (1 point)
Page 25 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
ETHOLOGY
31. Male fiddler crabs use their enlarged claws chelipeds (major chelipeds) for signalling (e.g.,
fighting for burrows, waving at females, etc.). A student studied male-female interactions by
using mirrors to reflect two different-sized images of the same waving male crab to females.
Mirror combinations used in the experiment were: 10x : 3x (Treatment I), 3x : 1x (Treatment II)
and 10x : 1x (Treatment III). Ten waving males were presented to 20 females in three trials for
each treatment. She recorded the percentage of females (Graph A) and time taken by each
female to approach each reflection (Graph B) for each treatment as well as whether the male
was right or left-handed (Graph C).
Larger image;
Smaller image;
Right-handed male;
Left-handed male
Page 26 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
Indicate correct conclusion(s) that can be drawn about the interactions between male and
female crabs with a tick (), incorrect conclusion(s) with a cross () and the statement(s) that
cannot be concluded with a dash (). (1.5 points)
a.
b.
c.
d.
The mean time taken for females to make a choice differed between Treatments II and III.
e.
An obvious difference in cheliped size of males may be necessary before females become
more decisive.
Page 27 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
32. Cormorants (Phalacrocorax carbo) feed on fish. They dive in the water and chase fish by sight,
so water clarity is important. Normally cormorants fish individually, but if the water is murky
they may develop a cooperative hunting method in a group. (1.2 points).
Indicate the process(es) that play(s) a role in developing the collaborative hunting strategy of
the cormorants with a tick () and use a cross () for inappropriate process(es).
a. competition
b. conditioning
c. habituation
d. social learning
e. imprinting
f.
Page 28 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
33. The figure below from Dittman et al. (1999) shows the behavioural response of mature
hatchery-reared Coho salmon, Oncorhynchus kisutch to an artificial odorant, -phenylethyl
alcohol (PEA) placed in one arm of a two-arm arena. These salmon were exposed to PEA at
different specific developmental stages: alevin (Stage I), parr (Stage II) and smolt (Stage III) in
the hatchery before maturity and experimentation. Control fish had never been exposed to PEA.
PEA absent;
PEA present
Indicate correct conclusion(s) with a tick (), incorrect conclusion(s) with a cross () and the
statement(s) that cannot be concluded with a dash (). (1.2 points)
a.
Salmon that had previous exposure to PEA had equal preference for both arms of the
arena.
b.
Age of salmon is the most important criterion for navigation to natal stream.
c.
d.
Page 29 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
Observed
296
19
27
85
427
34.1. If the genetic traits are assorted independently, what phenotype ratio would you expect
to see? Fill in the expected values for the respective phenotype and test for independent
assortment by calculating the 2 value. (4 points)
df
3.841
5.991
7.815
9.488
11.070
Table:
34.2. Indicate the likely explanation with a tick () and inappropriate explanations with a cross
() for the above observation. (0.8 points)
Page 30 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
35. The DNA sequence of the Atlantic salmon (Salmo salar) genome, which contains 28 pairs of
autosomal chromosomes and a pair of sex chromosomes (XY), has been recently completed.
DNA microinjection technique was used to successfully transfer a growth hormone transgene
construct into the zygotic stage of salmon fish embryos. Subsequently, 4 transgenic individuals
(F0 founders), 2 males and 2 females, were obtained. The growth hormone transgene is under
the regulation of a liver-specific enhancer and all 4 transgenic founders have high plasma
growth hormone levels leading to accelerated growth. It was confirmed that the transgene is
inserted as a single copy within their genomes. Stable lines of transgenic salmon with
accelerated growth will be established through crossing. For the establishment of the F1
generation, both the male and female transgenic founders (F0) are outcrossed to the respective
gender of wild-type (non-transgenic) salmon
Page 31 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
35.1. For the establishment of the F2 generation you have been asked to carry out a sibling-pair
cross in order to recover homozygous transgenic individuals carrying the growth hormone
transgene. What would be the expected genotype ratio expressed as a %? (1.5 points)
35.2. When you check the ratio of males versus females of the F2 generation you found that
there are always more females (70%) than males (30%) regardless of whether the growth
hormone transgene is present as null, heterozygous or homozygous within the individuals
of the F2 generation. Indicate the appropriate reason(s) with a tick () and the
inappropriate one(s) with a cross () from the list below. (0.8 points)
a.
Epigenetic silencing in some male individuals has shut down the growth hormone
transgene.
b.
c.
d.
The growth hormone transgene has translocated onto the sex chromosomes leading
to sex reversal of some males.
Page 32 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
36. Chicken with short wings and legs are called creepers. When creepers are mated with normal
birds they produce creepers and normal chickens with equal frequency. When creepers are
mated with creepers they produce two creepers to one normal. Crossing between normal birds
produce only normal progeny.
36.1. What is the simplest genetic basis for creepers and normal chicken? Indicate the correct
answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a cross (). (0.6 points)
36.2. Indicate the correct phenotype of chickens carrying two creeper alleles with a tick () and
incorrect phenotypes with a cross (). (0.5 points)
37. The black hair of guinea pigs is produced by a dominant gene B and white by its recessive
allele b. Assume that II1 and II4 do not carry the recessive allele.
37.2. What is the probability that one particular offspring of III1 x III2 will have white hair? (1
point)
Page 33 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
38. Some allele combinations can result in a particular mental disorder in humans. The Table
shows the enzyme activities of different genotypes (reported as percentage of the normal
activity).
Allele 1
Allele 2
R231X
P292L
R407W
R231X
<1
P292L
<1
<1
R407W
<1
<1
<1
IVS-12
<1
<1
<1
E290K
IVS-12
E290K
R158Q
R271Q
<1
~2
<3
R158Q
~6.5
10
R271Q
~20
30
40
Y424C
Y424C
50
All individuals homozygous or heterozygous for any combination of the first 5 alleles listed
above exhibit the classical symptoms of the disease. Individuals heterozygous between Y424C
and any of the first four alleles however have mild symptoms. R158Q/R158Q homozygous
show classical symptoms of the disease, while R271Q/R271Q homozygous and R271Q/Y424C
heterozygous have mild symptoms.
Page 34 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
38.1. What is the enzyme activity in individuals for genotype combinations marked by X
(R271Q/E290K) and Y (Y424C/ R158Q)? (2 points)
38.2. What is the critical range defining those with classical symptoms from those with mild
symptoms? (1 point)
39.
In a particular crop plant, several genes govern the production of anthocyanin. In the
absence of anthocyanin, the seedling leaves show only green chlorophyll pigmentation.
In the presence of anthocyanin, the seedlings have a purple cast on top of the green
coloration. A gene locus called Colourless 1 (C1) appears to function as a transacting
inducer locus for at least two other loci (ChsA and ChsJ) that encode two enzymes in the
pathway for anthocyanin synthesis (see figure below). The pathway for anthocyanin is
blocked in homozygous recessive genotypes as shown for chsA in the figure. Assume
the following conditions exist: (i) independent assortment applies to all three loci; and (ii)
homozygosity for the recessive alleles at any of the three loci causes green seedlings.
Indicate the expected phenotypic progeny ratios for the two crosses listed in the table in
the Answer Sheet with a tick () and inappropriate ones with a cross (). (2.0 points)
Page 35 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
40. The marsupial moles (order Notoryctemorphia) inhabit the sandy desert regions of South
Australia, Western Australia and the Northern territory. They tunnel through the sand, filling in
the tunnel behind them and giving the appearance of swimming through the sand. The eyes
of the marsupial mole are completely covered by skin, measure about 1 mm in diameter and
lack a lens or pupil. The optic nerve is greatly reduced. Indicate the correct statement(s) (a c)
with a tick () and incorrect statement(s) with a cross (). (0.6 points)
a.
b.
c.
The eyes of the marsupial mole are analogous to the eyes of kangaroos.
Page 36 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
41. Interphotoreceptor retinoid binding protein (IRBP) is a single-copy gene, the product of which
plays a role in the regeneration of rhodopsin in the visual cycle in mammals. This gene was
sequenced in several marsupials and the resulting sequences were aligned for comparison. A
portion of the sequence of the coding strand of IRBP is shown below. Note that this is not the
beginning of the gene and that the correct reading frame has been indicated.
41.1. Starting with the codon involving the frameshift mutation, write down three consecutive
amino acids coded for by this gene for Vombatus and Notoryctes. Use the genetic code
table provided in Question 1. (1.8 points)
41.2. Indicate true statement(s) with a tick (), false statement(s) with a cross () and
inconclusive statement(s) that cannot be concluded with a dash (-). (0.9 point)
Compared with that of Vombatus, the protein product of the IRBP gene in Notoryctes will:
a.
b.
c.
Page 37 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
ECOLOGY
42. The zonation patterns of littorinid snails on the rocky shores in Singapore were studied at a
vertical cliff and a sloping rock. Two taxa of littorinids were found on the vertical cliff (see A)
and an additional third species was found on the sloping rock (see B). The snail distribution
was recorded in July, September and December 2002 when the mean temperatures of the rock
surfaces were 42 C, 34 C and 27 C respectively.
Kite diagram showing the distributions of littorinid species on (A) a vertical cliff: (a) July, (b)
September, (c) December 2002; (B) a sloping rock.
EM: Echinolittorina malaccana; EV: E. vidua; LL: Littoraria sp.;
Page 38 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
42.1. Indicate correct conclusion(s) about the distribution patterns of the littorinids with a tick
(), incorrect conclusion(s) with a cross () and inconclusive statement(s) that cannot be
concluded with a dash (). (2 points)
a.
Sampling period has no influence on distribution pattern of the two littorinid taxa at
the vertical cliff.
b.
c.
The upper limits of the Echinolittorina malaccana zone at the vertical cliff were
constant regardless of sampling period.
d.
e.
42.2. Snails were collected from the field and extracts of six tissue samples of each of the three
littorinid taxa were incubated separately at different temperatures. Glutamate
oxaloacetate transaminase (GOT) activity was determined and the results of the enzyme
assays are presented in the graph below. Indicate the correct taxon (EM, EV or LL) that
corresponds to the graph shown in the table in the Answer Sheet. (1 point)
Page 39 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
43. The ecology of a group of dung beetles was studied in West Africa by Krell-Westerwalbesloh et
al. (2004). The beetle community was divided into four categories: (i) rollers, (ii) tunnellers, (iii)
dwellers, and (iv) obligatory kleptoparasites. The rollers rapidly form balls from the faeces (in <
1 hour), roll them away from the food source, and deposit them in or on the soil to ensure
exclusive use of the dung. The tunnellers make nests directly under the food source and
transport dung into the nest where they form dung balls ( a few hours). Dwellers feed and
reproduce directly in the dung pat. Kleptoparasites use faeces portions monopolised by other
groups, e.g., by penetrating dung balls made by the rollers or the dung mass in the
subterranean nests of the tunnellers. The abundance (see Table) and flight activity (see Figure)
of these beetles (pooled data of 15 samples) at six different periods of the day were recorded.
0200-0600 h
0600-1000 h
1000-1400 h
1400-1800 h
1800-2200 h
2200-0200 h
Period
N
Dwellers
51
6.46
31
1.45
0.03
Obligatory
kleptoparasites
51
6.46
536
25.01
1351
34
4.30
997
46.52
654
82.78
579
27.02
Rollers
Tunnellers
Rollers;
78
2.09
1795
27.91
172
48.45
10.87
1230
33.00
253
3.93
24
6.76
8559
68.87
1243
33.35
22
0.34
45
12.68
2514
20.23
1176
31.55
4362
67.82
114
32.11
Tunnellers;
Dwellers;
Kleptoparasites
Page 40 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
Indicate correct conclusion(s) that can be drawn from the study with a tick (), incorrect
conclusion(s) with a cross () and inconclusive statement(s) that cannot concluded with a dash
(). (1.8 points)
a.
b.
c.
The four groups of dung beetles cannot co-exist as they all exploit the same resource in
similar ways.
d.
One or more of the groups will eventually be out-competed and eliminated in the
community.
e.
The results of this study support the principle of competitive exclusion and provide
evidence for resource partitioning.
f.
The realized niche of each group is similar to their respective fundamental niche.
Page 41 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
44. Mount St Helens in southwest Washington state (USA) erupted catastrophically on May 18,
1980. The eruption produced a landscape with low nutrient availability, intense drought and
frequent surface movements. Permanent plots were established at several sites above the
treeline around the crater to monitor recovery after the eruption. The figure below shows the
number of species and percentage cover at one of the sites from 1981 to 1998.
Indicate the correct conclusion(s) that can be drawn from the figure above with a tick () and
incorrect conclusion(s) with a cross (). (1.2 points)
a.
b.
c.
Neither space nor light are limiting resources for plants in this environment.
d.
e.
Total plant cover in this area has increased relatively slowly due to harsh conditions on the
volcanic deposits.
f.
A stable plant community of 20 species has been reached at the study site indicating the
climax stage in the succession process.
Page 42 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
45. The schematic figure below shows a simulation of a marine community done with the objective
to study the relationships between its populations.
Based on the above figure, indicate correct statement(s) with a tick () and incorrect
statement(s) with a cross (). (1.8 points)
a.
The community, in its natural state, includes four species of the Kingdom Animalia.
b.
All the animals of this community have three germ layers and are deuterostomates.
c.
d.
e.
In their natural environment, mussel density is larger in the middle intertidal zone than in
the lower intertidal zone because starfish live in the lower intertidal zone.
f.
At the end of the study, the community collapses and only one population increases its
ecological niche.
g.
The competitive exclusion of the other populations by the mussels was demonstrated.
h.
Mussels occupy the fundamental niche including both the middle intertidal zone and lower
intertidal zone.
i.
Natural conditions include biotic interactions like inter-specific competition and predation.
Page 43 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
46. Growth rate of most intertidal organisms generally declines in an upshore direction. Lim and
Green (1991) studied a population of the Baltic clam, Macoma balthica (a common bivalve),
from two levels of the shore at Hudson Bay, Canada. Annual shell growth rings are distinct in
the two sub-populations (see figure below) and the clams from the two zones do not differ
genetically. The Baltic clam normally buries itself and is generally hidden from predators. It is
the intermediate host to trematodes; the daughter sporocysts of the parasites are found mainly
in the gonads of the clam, causing partial or total disappearance of the gonads. Shorebirds, the
definitive host of these trematodes, are present in large numbers at the upper shore during ebb
tide. The clams in Hudson Bay have been observed to make conspicuous tracks on the sand
flats at ebb tide. The number of metacercariae (the next stage in the parasites life cycle)
encysted on the inner shell surface of crawling and burrowing clams from the two shore regions
were counted.
Symbols represent number of clams: , 1; , 2; x, 3. The vertical line divides clams that were
smaller and larger than their median length at their respective tidal level.
Page 44 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
Indicate valid conclusion(s) about the behaviour and biology of the Baltic clam with a tick ()
and invalid conclusion(s) with a cross (). (2.8 points)
a.
The growth rate of Macoma balthica in Hudson Bay conforms to the general rule observed
for most intertidal organisms that lower intertidal organisms grow faster than those at the
upper shore.
b.
c.
Crawling behaviour of the clams could enhance the completion of the parasites life cycle.
d.
Clams that are buried in the sand generally have more metacercaria cysts regardless of
shore level.
e.
Increased exposure of the clams at the upper shore to shorebirds, the final host of the
trematodes, could probably account for the difference in parasite load between the two
sub-populations.
f.
High parasite load promotes increased somatic growth as reproductive output is reduced
due to host castration by the trematodes.
g.
Environmental factors probably played a greater role in determining clam growth rate of the
sub-populations than heredity.
Page 45 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
BIOSYSTEMATICS
47. Match the following characteristic features with the correct organisms. (1.2 points)
Features:
I. book lung, claws formerly made of three parts, but now reduced to only two, gizzard
II. reduced ribs, undergoes a metamorphosis during ontogenesis
III. hind extremities covered with scales, respiration organ using ventillating air bags, movable
upper jaw (maxilla) and lower jaw (mandibula)
IV. thin, tube-like excretion organs ending between mid- and hind-gut, body made of three
parts (tagmata), a pair of antennae
V. specialized epithelic muscle cells, nettle cells, radial symmetric body
VI. uses ampullae of Lorenzini to sense electric fields and temperature differences, cartilage
skeleton, spiraculum
Organisms:
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
Page 46 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
48. One of the known hypothesis of the origin and evolution of plastids is shown in the Figure below.
The processes that facilitated evolution are represented by the numbers (1 to 4) in the diagram
above: (1) for primary endosymbiosis, (2) for loss of primary plastids, (3) and (4) for secondary
endosymbiosis. These processes resulted in the presence or absence of certain plastids in
various taxa.
Match the taxa (a d) with the corresponding type of plastids in the Answer Sheet. (1.2 points)
Page 47 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
49. Cladistic systematic researchers apply comparisons among groups in order to differentiate
derivative characters and shared primitive characters. In doing this, they use an external group,
closely related with the one they are studying.
Condition: The external group is less related to any member of the studied group than the
members of the last one are between themselves.
Supposition: The primitive characters that precede the divergence of both groups are
homologies.
Taking into account these theoretical concepts, some researchers studied a group and the
information they obtained is presented in the following table.
Animals represented by double digit codes
Characters
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
a. Hair
d. Jointed jaws
e. Vertebral spine
f.
Notocord
49.1. After analyzing the information above, identify the external group. (0.2 points)
49.2. Identify the characters (a f) that are shared between the external and internal groups.
(0.2 points)
Page 48 of 49
IBO2012 Singapore
49.3. Identify the primitive character present in all members of the internal group alone.
(0.2 points)
49.4. Identify the last point of divergence of the cladogram given in the Answer Sheet
using the most appropriate character. (0.2 points)
49.5. Fill in the cladogram which best represents the relationships between A1 to A6
using the information analyzed in the Answer Sheet. (1.8 points)
END OF PAPER
Page 49 of 49
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO2012 Singapore
Country: _____________________
Page 1 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
Dear Participants
You have a total of 3 hours (180 minutes) for answering this theory paper.
Use the Answer Sheet, which is provided separately, to answer all the questions.
Write your answers legibly. Note that there may be more than one correct/incorrect
answer and every cell should be filled.
For example:
NOTE: Some of the questions may be marked Skipped / Deleted. DO NOT attempt
these questions. Also, read the question completely before attempting it as some
questions may continue from one page to the next.
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings.
Your Answer Sheets as well as the Theoretical Test question paper will be collected at
the end of the test period.
Good Luck!
Page 2 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
CELL BIOLOGY
1.
Four mixtures of microorganisms were collected from different sites around a school and each
microbial mixture was inoculated into a medium that contained all essential elements (in the
form of ionic compounds) except carbon. The medium was at first clear (i.e., not turbid), and
this was left to be cultured with agitation in the dark for 24 h (Stage I). The culture was
subsequently continued in bright light for 24 h (Stage II) and then a further 24 h in the dark
(Stage III). The turbidity of the four samples was monitored at the end of each stage and the
following results were obtained.
End of Stage
Sample
I
II
III
Clear
Clear
Clear
Clear
Slightly turbid
Slightly turbid
Slightly turbid
More turbid
Very turbid
Slightly turbid
Slightly turbid
Slightly turbid
Which of the following organisms (a-d) are likely to be present in samples 1 to 4? Use a tick ()
to indicate presence and a cross () to indicate absence in the Answer sheet. (3.2 points)
a.
photoautotrophic microorganisms
b.
chemo-organotrophic microorganisms
c.
d.
Page 3 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
2.
A rod-shaped bacterial cell is observed to have numerous pili and fimbriae growing all over its
surface. These structures appear to be able to lengthen and shorten. Indicate the correct
function(s) (a d) of these structures with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a cross (). (1
point)
3.
a.
recombination
b.
attachment to surfaces
c.
d.
for defence
Two bacterial cells were cross sectioned, and Bacterium A showed a single membrane
covering its cell, while Bacterium B is covered by two membranes which are separated by a
narrow space containing peptidoglycan material. Identify which bacterium is Gram positive and
Gram negative respectively in the Answer sheet. (0.4 points)
Page 4 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
4.
Research was conducted to examine the presence of regulator element in the upstream of
transcription start site from eukaryotic gene. As a preliminary study, a researcher performed in
silico analysis by multiple alignment of nucleotide -37 to -26 from 900 different genes. The
resulting homology percentage data are shown in the table below.
-26
-37
(5)
(3)
21
16
91
95
67
97
52
41
16
24
Base
frequency
23
39
10
35
37
(%)
28
35
12
40
38
30
28
10
83
100
33
36
10
11
4.1. Based on the given data, predict the most likely nucleotide sequence -35 to -29 within the
conserved area which is essential for its regulator function. In the Answer Sheet, fill the
boxes with A, C, T, and G, at the appropriate positions. (1.4 points)
4.2. Deletion of nucleotides -50 to -26 of several genes resulted in dramatically decreased RNA
polymerase binding within the gene. Which type(s) of sequence element may be
represented by nucleotides -50 to -26? Indicate appropriate answer(s) with a tick () and
inappropriate answer(s) with a cross () in the Answer Sheet. (1.0 point)
Page 5 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
5.
Hormones regulate physiological processes in various specialised cells. Match the hormones
listed below (a e) with the physiological processes (I VII) that they regulate. Note: some
processes can be regulated by more than one corresponding hormone. (2.8 points)
Hormone
6.
Physiological process
a.
insulin
I.
gluconeogenesis
b.
cortisol
II.
glycogenesis
c.
glucagon
III.
glycogenolysis
d.
thyroid hormone
IV.
lipolysis
e.
epinephrine
V.
lipogenesis
VI.
protein catabolism
VII.
protein anabolism
Which of the following allow(s) cell membranes to remain fluid under cold temperatures?
Indicate correct answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a cross (). (0.8 point)
a.
b.
c.
d.
Page 6 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
7.
Cellular abnormality can often lead to manifestation of disease or disorders in our body. Match
the following cellular abnormalities (I V) each with their most likely disorder (a e). (1.5
points)
Cellular abnormalities:
I.
II.
III.
IV.
enzyme absence
V.
Disorders:
a.
A child has chronic respiratory infections; secretions of the gut and lung are thick in this
child, and his sweat is altered, with high Na+ and Cl- levels.
b.
A young man has pain in his chest and biopsy test demonstrates presence of abnormal,
unspecialized, metastatic cells.
c.
d.
A young boy has progressive weakness and muscle wasting atrophy of calf muscles.
e.
Affected children gradually lose skills and sight; have massive accumulation of lipid in brain
cells. Death occurs at young age. There is no treatment.
Page 7 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
8.
A replicating cell population was stained with a dye that became fluorescent when bound to
DNA. The DNA content of its individual cells was then determined by fluorescence-activated
cell sorting (FACS) which is shown in the graph below.
a. From the graph, which group of cells (A C) are in the S phase of the cell cycle? (0.9 point)
b. Which group of these cells (A C) are in the LONGEST phase of the cell cycle? (0.9 point)
Indicate appropriate answer(s) with a tick () and inappropriate answer(s) with a cross ().
Page 8 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
9.
Phospholipids are a class of lipids that are a major component of all cell membranes as they
can form lipid bilayers.
9.1. Indicate true statement(s) with a tick () and false statement(s) with a cross (). (0.8 point)
a.
The hydrophobic tails are oriented towards the interior of the cell membrane.
b.
The fatty acids present in the membrane do not have double bonds.
c.
Once phospholipids are incorporated they remain in the cell membrane permanently.
d.
9.2. Mammalian plasma membranes are characterized by the presence of different types of
phospholipids (SM, PC, PE, PS and PI). The graph below shows the percentage
distribution of each phospholipid across the plasma membrane of human erythrocytes.
Page 9 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
Indicate the correct statement(s) with a tick () and incorrect statement(s) with a cross ().
The numbers indicated are approximate figures. (0.8 point)
a.
b.
c.
80% of the inner total membrane phospholipids contain PE and 16% contain PC.
d.
Most PC is confined to the outer surface of the erythrocytes while most of the PE and
PS are confined to the inner surface of the erythrocytes.
10. In a study of a rice plant, it is found that gibberellins (GA) play an important role in the growth of
seedlings. The GA repressor protein (GARP) controls the expression of GA induced genes.
This protein contains two domains: (i) regulatory domain (DELLA) and (ii) the repressor domain
(GRAS). GA bound to its receptor, attaches to DELLA domain and facilitates association of
repressor domain with SCF ubiquitin ligase complex. It results in GARP getting targeted and
degraded by proteasome. This leads to GA induced gene expression and seedling growth.
Based on this information, indicate growth of the seedlings with a loss of function mutation in the
DELLA domain or the GRAS domain with a tick () under the presence or absence of
gibberellins, and use a cross () if no growth is predicted in the Answer Sheet. (1.2 points)
Page 10 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
11. The following enzymes(1 6) catalyse the formation of the chemical bonds, I to VI.
Enzyme
Chemical bond
1. DNA ligase
I.
Carbon-oxygen bond
2. magnesium chelatase
II.
Carbon-sulfur bond
3. acetate-CoA synthase
III.
Carbon-nitrogen bond
4. amino acid-tRNA
synthase
IV.
Carbon-carbon bond
5. pyruvate carboxylase
V.
6. glutathione synthase
VI.
Nitrogen-metal bond
Match the enzyme and corresponding enzymatic reactions with the respective bond types. (2.4
points)
Page 11 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
Treatment protocol
1
The length of the hypocotyl can either increase or remain the same. Indicate the outcomes with
an arrow () for an increase in length and an equal sign () for the same length for the different
treatments. (1.2 points)
Page 12 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
13. The ABC model explains how three homeotic genes control floral organ identity:
Indicate what the floral parts (I IV) develop into in a mutant with a loss of activity of its B gene?
Write the resultant outcome in the Answer Sheet. (1.2 points)
a.
sepal
b.
petal
c.
stamen
d.
carpel
14. Indicate the type of cell division involved in the organ/cell formation and the ploidy of the cells.
Use I for mitosis and II for meiosis. (2 points)
Page 13 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
15. Delves et al. (1986) studied the influence of different organs on nodulation phenotype. To
analyze whether shoot or root factors have a regulatory role in the nodule formation, they
grafted wildtype plant (Bragg cultivar) with two plant mutants (nts382 and nts1116). The grafts
were inoculated with Bradyrhizobium japonicum strain USDA110 and harvested 9 weeks later.
Nodules were picked and counted from each plant and dry weights obtained. The results are
summarized in Table 1.
Indicate correct deduction(s) with a tick () and incorrect deduction(s) with a cross (). (1.8
points)
a. Genetic factors expressed in the shoot are affecting the number of nodules present in
the root.
b. Genetic factors expressed in the root are affecting total nodule mass.
c. Grafts are compensating an increased number of nodules with a lower mass per nodule.
Page 14 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
16. The bar chart shows the concentrations of various minerals in the nutrient solution () and in
the root cells () after 2 weeks of plant growth. Based on the graph given below, indicate
appropriate answer(s) with a tick () and inappropriate ones with a cross () in the Answer
Log [concentration]
NO3-
K+
Mg2+
Fe3+
17. Chemical Z, produced in germinating barley (Hordeum) seeds plays a role in the -amylase
synthesis by the aleurone layer cells. To investigate the role of Z more closely, the promoter of
the -amylase gene was fused with the gene for -glucuronidase (enzyme producing blue
product with certain substrate). The transgenic plants were then tested under various
conditions for the presence of blue color in the aleurone layer cells, upon addition of the glucuronidase substrate. The results are shown in the table below:
Experimental condition
Normal seed
Present
Absent
Present
Absent
Present
Page 15 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
Indicate correct deduction(s) about Z with a tick () and incorrect deduction(s) with a cross ().
(1.0 point)
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
It is likely to be ethylene.
Page 16 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
19. Tom ran after a snatch thief and caught him after a 80m chase. Which of the following
biochemical pathways was important in his muscles during the chase? Indicate the correct
answer with a tick () and incorrect answers with a cross (). (1 point)
a.
b.
glycolysis
c.
gluconeogenesis
d.
glycogenolysis
e.
proteolysis
Page 17 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
20. The schematic drawing below was traced from the horizontal section of a chick embryo showing
the axon outgrowth pattern of the motorneurones after an experimental manipulation. N is the
neural tube which will normally develop into the spinal cord. The segmented structures flanking
the neural tube are the somites which will contribute to the muscles and vertebrae development.
Somites are subdivided into anterior (a) and posterior (p) segments.
The control side (C) has somites in the original orientation whereas the experimental side (E)
has some somites surgically rotated. The objective of the experiment was to determine if the
outgrowth pattern of the motor axons is dependent on the orientation of the somites.
Based on the above figure, indicate correct deduction(s) with a tick () and incorrect
deduction(s) with a cross (). (2 points)
a.
The axons grow out of the neural tube regardless of the orientation of the somites.
b.
The axons preferentially grow through the anterior segment of the somite.
c.
The axons preferentially grow through the posterior segment of the somite.
d.
The segmented axon outgrowth pattern is an intrinsic property of the motor neurons.
e.
The somite segmentation pattern determines the motor axon segmentation pattern.
Page 18 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
21. Dorsal root ganglia are formed by neural crest cells migrating away from the neural tube during
embryo development. The crest cells forming the ganglia differentiate into sensory neurones.
In an experiment, a two-day old chick embryo had the anterior part of two somites surgically
removed (arrowed) and allowed to develop until the dorsal root ganglia (d) had formed in day 5.
In the image below, the right side of the embryo was the experimental side (E) and the control
side (C) is to the left. Note the ganglia scattered on the E side of the embryo (next to the
arrows).
Based on the image above, indicate correct deduction(s) with a tick () and incorrect
deduction(s) with a cross (). (1.6 points)
a.
b.
The ganglia segmentation is dependent on the presence of the anterior part of the somite.
c.
Ectopic ganglia formed possibly because of somites lacking the anterior segments
disrupted the normal crest cell migration pathway.
d.
Page 19 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
22. Combining the observations and deductions derived from Questions 20 and 21, it is quite
obvious that the anterior segment of the somites are conducive for the outgrowth of
motorneurones and the migration of neural crest cells. Indicate valid inference(s) with a tick ()
and invalid inference(s) with a cross (). (1.5 points)
a. The anterior segments of the somites are likely to express extracellular matrix molecules
that guide the axons and the crest cells.
b. The molecules expressed in the anterior segments of the somites are likely to be
adhesive proteins for contact inhibition.
c. The posterior segments of the somites may produce repulsive molecules that axons and
crest cells avoid.
23. A transverse section through the spinal cord is examined under high magnification of the
microscope. Indicate which figure (A or B: not drawn to scale) corresponds to grey and white
matter respectively. (0.6 points)
Page 20 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
24. Blood glucose concentration is regulated by homeostasis. Indicate the concentrations at which
the following responses are elicited. Use tick () and a cross () for high and low blood
glucose concentrations respectively. (1.2 points)
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
25. Match the digestive systems (I III) with the corresponding animal feeding adaptation (a c).
(1.5 points)
a.
b.
c.
Page 21 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
26. The graph below shows the different responses of marine animals to salinity changes.
An extremely heavy and sustained week-long rainfall resulted in the salinity at a river mouth to
fall from 28 ppt to 8 ppt. This caused many soft-bodied intertidal organisms to die. Which group
of organism survived best? Write your answer in the Answer Sheet. (1 point)
Page 22 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
27. Q10 values are often used to describe the effects of temperature on the rate of many reactions
involved in biological processes. The Q10 value is the ratio of the velocity constants k1 (at t +
10 C) and k2 (at t C), [k1/k2].
27.1. Using the data on the oxygen consumption of the three organisms below, calculate the
Q10 values for temperature intervals of (i) 10 20 C, (ii) 15 25 C, and (iii) 20 30 C.
(3.6 points)
B: O
C:
Page 23 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
28. Ghost crabs (Ocypode ceratophthalmus) are common on tropical shores, with the adults being
nocturnal (staying in their burrows in the day) and the juveniles, diurnal in activity behaviour.
Adult crabs generally excavate burrows higher up the shore than juveniles. Heart beat rates of
juvenile and adult ghost crabs were measured at various temperatures.
28.1. Graphs (A D) below represent the trend of typical physiological response of organisms
to temperature change as measured by Q10 values. Identify the correct graph for the two
stages of crab development. (1 point)
Page 24 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
28.2. The heart beat patterns of the crabs at 30 C over a period of 5 s are shown in the figure
below. Match the patterns with the correct stage of crab development. (1 point)
28.3. Indicate correct statement(s) with a tick () and incorrect statement(s) with a cross ().
(1.6 points)
a.
As heart rate and metabolic rate are strongly correlated, this study provides evidence
that smaller organisms have higher basal metabolisms regardless of temperature.
b.
The higher heart rates of juvenile crabs are compensated by more heat lost via the
proportionately larger surface area to volume ratio.
c.
Adult crabs show endogenous nocturnal activity as they are not so heat tolerant,
preferring to stay in their burrows during the day.
d.
Page 25 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
29. The types of cleavage pattern and blastulas (1 6) for some animal embryos are shown below:
29.1. Match the cleavage patterns and blastulas (1 6) with the corresponding animals.
Indicate P for protostome and D for deuterostome. (1.2 points)
29.2. Identify the main factor that influences the cleavage. (1 point)
a.
b.
c.
d.
Page 26 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
ETHOLOGY
30. Vervet monkeys (Cercopithecus aethiops) warn fellow monkeys by producing unique warning
signals according to the type of predators such as eagles, leopards and snakes. Depending on
the type of signals, monkeys in the group choose the appropriate method to escape. A
newborn Vervet monkey is capable of producing all of these signals but it does not know which
signal should be used in each case. If a baby monkey produces the signal for eagles when a
sparrow is flying over, adult monkeys look up at the sky and then ignore the signal. However, if
an eagle is indeed hovering, the entire group joins in the warning. Sometimes, baby monkeys
are punished by their mothers for producing wrong signals.
Which of the following learning types are associated with the warning signal development in
baby monkeys? Indicate the correct answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a
cross () in the table provided in the Answer
a.
imprinting
b.
associative learning
c.
problem solving
d.
social learning
Page 27 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
31. The Asian honey-bee, Apis cerana is the primary pollinator of Portulaca grandiflora. Bees
pollination of four flower varieties of P. grandiflora: white flowers (single and double-petalled)
and pink flowers (single and double-petalled), was studied. Bees visitations to the four flower
varieties at six observation periods of half hour duration from 0930 h to 1230 h were recorded.
Pollen production per flower in the four flower varieties was determined. Three different floral
patch sizes (small, medium, and large: 20, 40, and 80 flowers respectively) placed at a distance
of 1.5 m apart from each other, were presented to the bees.
Single white,
Single pink,
Double white,
Double pink
Page 28 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
Indicate correct conclusion(s) about the honey bees behaviour with a tick () and incorrect
conclusion(s) with a cross (). (2 points)
a.
b.
Pink flowers were always preferred over white flowers as they had more pollen grains for
the bees to harvest.
c.
d.
Pollinators did not respond to diminishing rewards but floral patch size influenced their
foraging patterns significantly.
e.
Larger floral patch size provided stronger advertising signals and the promise of larger
rewards.
Page 29 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
32. Fruit flies usually find food by following the odour of ethanol produced from fruits. The fruit also
serves as the place for male and female flies to mate and reproduce. The graph below shows
the relationship between the number of allured flies and the concentration of ethanol.
Based on the graph, indicate the correct statement(s) with a tick () and incorrect statement(s)
with a cross (). (1 point)
a.
The male/female ratio in the number of flies occupying the food source varies depending
on the ethanol concentration.
b.
The number of mating animals would be the lowest when ethanol concentration is 9.
c.
The competition between males would be most severe when ethanol concentration is 7.
d.
The number of laid eggs would be the highest when ethanol concentration is around 6
and 7.
e.
The number of attracted flies would be the highest when ethanol concentration is 8.
Page 30 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
In the F2 progeny of a cross between G1G1g2g2 and g1g1G2G2 individuals, what fraction is
expected to show an elevated level of the metabolic intermediate B? (2 points)
34. In a particular breed of dogs, the hairless condition is produced by the heterozygous genotype.
Normal dogs are homozygous recessive. Puppies homozygous for the H allele are usually born
dead with abnormalities of the mouth and absence of external ears. If the average litter size at
weaning is 6 in matings between hairless dogs, what would be the average expected number of
hairless and normal offspring at weaning for matings between hairless dogs and between
hairless and normal dogs? (1.8 points)
Page 31 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
35. There are two types of red-green colour blindness deuteranopia and protanopia, governed by
two linked loci on the X chromosome. Among 18,121 Norwegian children examined in a study,
9049 were males, of which, 725 were males with colour blindness, 551 had deuteranopia and
174 had protanopia. Of the 40 females with colour blindness, 37 had deuteranopia and 3 had
protanopia.
df
3.841
5.991
7.815
9.488
11.070
Table:
Estimate the allele frequencies for deuteranopia (independent of protanopia) from the data on
males. Use these values to test the phenotypic distribution in females for compatibility with the
Hardy Weinberg equilibrium (HWE) using the
test.
Indicate compatibility with HWE with a tick () and incompatibility with a cross (). (4.0 points)
Page 32 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
36. The diagram below presents the patterns of clan membership for a kinship group of Native
Americans. The diagram shows the conditions of marriage and the way the clan of the father
determines the clan of the children. The broken lines point from the fathers clan to the clan of
his children and the solid lines point from a mans clan to the clan of a potential wife.
A disease X, that is prevalent in this clan community, is a dominant sex linked trait and is
carried on the Y chromosome. Answer the following questions relevant to disease transmission
between the four clans.
36.1. Maska of clan D has disease X. After two generations both including sons, indicate the
clans that will be affected if only Maska carried the disease, with a tick () and nonaffected clans with a cross (). (2 points)
36.2. What is the probability of Tala (clan A) and Yonato (clan B) having a son with disease X in
clan D if Yonatos father had disease X? (2 points)
Page 33 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
37. A number of nutritional mutant strains were isolated from wild-type red bread mold Neurospora
crassa that responded to the addition of certain supplements in the culture medium by growth
(+) or no growth (0). Given in the Table below are the responses for single-gene mutants.
Glutamic
semialdehyde
Arginine
Ornithine
Glutamic acid
37.1. Indicate the sequence (1 5) of the five metabolites within the metabolic pathway in the
Answer Sheet. (1.5 points)
37.2. Indicate the strain that is blocked at each of the four steps in the metabolic pathway in
the Answer Sheet. (1.2 points)
38. Given that A1A1 = lethal, A1A2 = gray, A2A2 = black, B1B1 = long hair, B1B2 = short hair, B2B2 =
very short hair (fuzzy), and parents that are A1A2B1B2.
38.1. What is the fraction of adult offspring that is expected to be gray and fuzzy? (1 point)
38.2. In the case when fuzzy is also a lethal trait, what is the fraction of adult progeny expected
to be black and short? (1 point)
Page 34 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
Female
Total
wild type
80
60
140
mutant
30
30
60
If the mutation was inherited via a simple autosomal recessive mode, what is the most likely
parental genotype? Indicate the correct answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a
cross (). (1 point)
a.
w w X w+w+
b.
w+w X w+w
c.
w+w X w w
d.
w+w X w+w+
e.
w+ w+ X w+ w+
Page 35 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
40. If a paternal chromosome has alleles L, M, and n and the maternal chromosome has l, m, and
N. Which of the following chromosomes could possibly be produced as a result of a single
crossing over? Indicate the correct answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a
cross (). (1 point)
I.
LMN
II.
LMn
III. LmN
IV. Lmn
V. lmn
41. The closest living relative of human (Homo sapiens) is widely considered to be the chimpanzee
(Pan troglodytes) and bonobo (Pan paniscus). Together with the orangutans (Pongo pygmaeus
and P. abelii) and gorilla (Gorilla gorilla and G. beringei) they form the subfamily Homininae.
This evolutionary relationship can be presented as shown below.
Page 36 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
41.1. The phylogenetic tree demonstrating the evolutionary relationship of the higher primates
is constructed using molecular data and is considered to be reliable because:
a.
b.
DNA sequences can be converted into protein sequences for comparative analysis.
c.
d.
physically intact and unfragmented genomic DNA can be recovered after millions of
years.
Indicate true statement(s) with a tick () and false statement(s) with a cross (). (0.8 point)
41.2. Most of the oldest fossils belonging to the subfamily Homininae are found in the African
continent. This is similarly reflected by the living species, with orang utans being the only
species not found in Africa. This observation of fossil distribution supports the:
a.
"Out of Africa" hypothesis whereby the first human beings evolved in Africa and
subsequently migrated to other continents.
b.
"Out of Asia" hypothesis as the oldest living species, the orang utans, are found only
in South-East Asia.
c.
Indicate true statement(s) with a tick () and false statement(s) with a cross (). (0.6
point)
Page 37 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
ECOLOGY
42. Borges and Brown (1999) studied the arthropod species richness in three islands (Pico, Santa
Maria and Terceira), in the Azorean archipelago. The figure below shows the location of the
islands with respect to major land masses, Africa and Europe (in the east) and North America
(in the west).
Some other characteristics of the islands are given in the table below.
Island
Pico
Santa Maria
Terceira
Altitude (m)
2351
0.037 0.300
1866
587
8.12
1585
1023
0.300 2
1770
Page 38 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
42.1. Match the following x axes with the correct graphs (I to IV). (2.4 points)
a.
b.
Log10 (altitude in m)
c.
d.
42.2. Estimate from the graphs, the number of endemic species (to the nearest whole number)
in the three islands. (1.2 points)
Page 39 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
42.3. From the data indicate correct conclusion(s) that can be drawn from the study with a tick
() and incorrect conclusion(s) with a cross (). (1.5 points)
a.
Diversity was greater on the island with the lowest maximum altitude and decreased
with increasing altitude.
b.
c.
Isolation alone cannot be used to explain the species richness patterns found in the
arthropod assemblage in the three islands.
d.
Species richness patterns in these islands are influenced by both ecological and
evolutionary factors.
e.
Page 40 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
43. Daniel boiled water and hay in a beaker for some time, and left it uncovered for some days.
During that period only heterotrophic bacteria were found in the beaker. He then added a few
drops of ditch water and covered it loosely. The water from the ditch only contained
heterotrophic unicellular organisms (no bacteria or fungi). Daniel regularly determined the size
of the populations of the different species (p u) present in the beaker over a period of time.
II.
III.
V.
the number of the other dividing heterotrophic unicellular organism will decrease to zero
VI.
a climax stage will develop, comprising bacteria and other heterotrophic unicellular
organisms, in a stable natural equilibrium
Indicate correct statement(s) with a tick () and incorrect statement(s) with a cross (). (1.2
points)
Page 41 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
44. Increasing concentration of carbon dioxide (a greenhouse gas) has been linked to global
climate change. Carbon dioxide can be removed from the atmosphere and deposited in a
reservoir in order to either mitigate or defer global warming and avoid dangerous climate
change. The removal process includes carbon dioxide uptake from the atmosphere by all
chlorophyllous plants, through photosynthesis. Indicate correct statement(s) concerning the
amount of carbon stored per unit area in different ecosystems with a tick () and incorrect
statement(s) with a cross (). (1 point)
a.
net primary productivity (NPP) (or net carbon absorption rate) of coniferous forests
temperate forests tropical forests
b.
carbon stocks (the amount of carbon stored) of coniferous forests temperate forests
tropical forests
c.
d.
net primary productivity (NPP) of secondary forests climax forests or old growth forests
e.
as compared to other ecosystems, coral reefs have very high net primary productivity, and
their contribution to global production of biomass is large
Page 42 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
45. Male fiddler crabs have an enlarged cheliped (the major cheliped) to attract mates and defend
territories. However, the major cheliped is useless for foraging; hence males are left with only
one feeding appendage the minor cheliped. Many strategies have been proposed by
researchers to explain how male fiddler crabs compensate for this apparent disadvantage. A
student conducted a study to investigate some of these strategies. She videotaped the foraging
bouts of males and females on the first five patches of sediment upon first emergence at low
tide. Sediment samples from these five patches were collected after the crabs have vacated
the patch and chlorophyll a content in these samples was determined. Various dimensions of
the feeding cheliped in males and females were also compared. The mean number of scoops
per second for the two sexes was determined from the videotapes: females, 2.39 0.08 scoops;
males, 1.60 0.06 scoops.
Females;
Males
Page 43 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
Indicate correct conclusion(s) that can be drawn from the students study with a tick () and
incorrect conclusion(s) with a cross (). (2.4 points)
a.
b.
c.
d.
Male fiddler crabs generally leave a foraging patch at a higher threshold of chlorophyll a
content than females.
e.
f.
Results of this study do not support the principles of the optimal foraging theory.
Page 44 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
BIOSYSTEMATICS
46. Morphological characters (1 6) shared by two or more organisms and their recent common
ancestor are shown in the cladogram below.
46.1. Which of the morphological characters (1-6) are the synapomorphies for the
corresponding taxonomic groups indicated in the Answer Sheet. (1.2 points)
46.2. Identify the taxonomic groups (W Z) in the table provided in the Answer Sheet. (1.2
points)
Page 45 of 46
IBO2012 Singapore
46.3. Based on your knowledge of these organisms and groups, match the morphological
characters listed below (I VI) among the labelled morphological characters from 1 to 6.
(1.2 points)
I.
body organised into head, and elongated (and segmented) trunk; numerous pairs (>
12 pairs) of legs
II. body organised into head, thorax, and abdomen; three pairs of legs (from thorax)
III. jointed/segmented appendages
IV. antennae (one or more pairs); mandibles (chewing mouthparts)
V. two pairs of antennae; biramous (two branches) appendages
VI. no antennae; no mandibles
46.4. Classify the groups listed below (I IV) according to their respective phylogenetic origins
in the Answer Sheet. (1.2 points)
I.
W and X
II.
X and Y
III. Y and Z
IV. W, X, Y, and Z
END OF PAPER
Page 46 of 46
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
Theoretical Test
Paper 1
Answer Key
1.
2.
(1.8 points)
a
(1.8 points)
Cell
Functions (a d) if present
Mitochondria present
Sperm cell
Brown fat cell
Red muscle fibers
Intestine epithelia
3.
4.
(0.9 points)
Lowest Tm
Medium Tm
Highest Tm
(2 points)
Condition
II
III
IV
Cell fate
Page 1 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
5.
Paper 1
Answer Key
(4.2 points)
5.1. (3.6 points)
Heptapeptide
Peptide A
Asp-Ala-Glu-Asp-Gly-Ser-Ser
Peptide B
Gly-Lys-Asp-Ala-Ala-Ser-Gly
Peptide C
Ser-Lys-Ser-Lys-Gly-Asp-Ala
pH 1 net
charge
pH 7 net
charge
pH 12 net
charge
+1
-3
-4
+2
-2
+3
+1
-2
6.
7.
pH 1
pH 7
pH 12
(0.5 points)
a
(0.9 points)
7.1. (0.4 points)
a
Page 2 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
8.
Paper 1
Answer Key
(1.8 points)
8.1. (0.6 points)
Bacterium A
Bacterium B
Bacterium C
>
____B____
>
____A____
9.
ii
iii
iv
(1 point)
Page 3 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
12
11
17
14
10.2. (3 points)
11. (3 points)
1
10
Page 4 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
Intermediate
Most modern
___III__
___IV___
___II___
___V____
___VII__
Page 5 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
____A____
>
____C____
>
____B____
>
____D____
>
____B____
>
____C____
>
____A____
____D____
Amphibians
Reptiles
Birds
Mammals
II
Frog
Salmon
Crayfish
Lizard
Earthworm
Dragonfly
Circulatory
system
Respiratory
organ
a, c
21. (2 points)
a
Page 6 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
< 0.75
0.75 1.5
10 12
130 180
Pseudoallergy
II
III
IV
Page 7 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
II
III
IV
1.2:1
2:1
3:1
II
III
Swimming speed
Surface
Middle
Bottom
Sea grass
beds
Rock
crevices
Fast
Slow
D, H
A, C, E
D, H
A, G
Page 8 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
29. (3 points)
29.1. (1 point)
L/D < 1
> 45
29.2. (2 points)
a
30. (2 points)
30.1. (1 point)
The minimum number of enzymes needed to produce -MSH = ______3_______.
30.2. (1 point)
The minimum number of enzymes needed to produce -MSH = ______3_______.
31. (1.5 points)
a
Page 9 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
Observed
Expected
296
19
27
85
427
(1 points)
Dominant epitasis
Linkage
Maternal
inheritance
heterozygous
wild type
25
50
25
Page 10 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
Heterozygous
Homozygous
recessive
Normal
Creepers
Normal
Short wings
Short legs
Short wings
and legs
Lethal
37. (2 points)
37.1. (1 point)
The fraction expected is = _____2/3_______.
37.2. (1 point)
The fraction expected is = _____1/12______.
38. (3 points)
38.1. (2 points)
The estimated enzyme activity of X (R271Q/E290K) is _ 16.5 (any value between 15 to
17)____________.
The estimated enzyme activity of Y (Y424C/ R158Q) is __ 30 (any value between 28 to
32)_________________.
38.2. (1 point)
The critical range is somewhere between __10___ % to __25___ % of normal activity.
Page 11 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
39. (2 points)
Progeny ratio (purple to green)
Cross
3:1
9:7
15:1
1:7
1:1
i.
ii.
Tyr
Asp
Arg
Notoryctes
Leu
STOP
Pro
42. (3 points)
42.1. (2 points)
Page 12 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
42.2. (1 point)
Line
Taxon
EM
II
III
IV
VI
Page 13 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
Taxa
Two-membrane rhodoplast
Two-membrane chloroplast
Four-membrane rhodoplast
Three-membrane chloroplast
Page 14 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 1
Answer Key
A6
A2
/A
5
A2
/A
5
A3
A4
A1
END OF PAPER
Page 15 of 15
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
Theoretical Test
Paper 2
Answer Key
1.
(3.2 points)
Types of organism
Sample
2.
3.
(1 point)
a
(0.4 points)
Page 1 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
4.
Paper 2
Answer Key
(2.4 points)
4.1. (1.45 points)
-35
-34
-33
-32
-31
-30
-29
A/T
A/T
4.2. (1 point)
Sequence element
5.
6.
7.
Operator
Promoter
Origin of
replication
(ORI)
Telomere
Enhancer
II
III
IV
VI
VII
b, c
c, e
b, d, e, f
a, d, f
(0.8 point)
a
II
III
IV
(1.5 points)
Page 2 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
8.
Paper 2
Answer Key
(1.8 points)
Group
Cell cycle
9.
a. S phase
b. Longest phase
(1.6 points)
9.1. (0.8 points)
9.2.
(0.8 points)
DELLA mutant
GRAS mutant
Present
Absent
II
III
IV
VI
Ligase
Reaction
Page 3 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
II
III
IV
Ploidy of cells
Endosperm of
angiosperm
3n
Pollen grain
II
Central cells
n+n
Egg of angiosperm
II
Spore of moss
II
Protonema
Sperm of moss
Fern gametophyte
Spore of fern
II
Egg of fern
nts382
nts1116
Page 4 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
Required as trace
element
Absorbed by passive
transport
2+
3+
Nutrient
-
NO3
K
Mg
Fe
18. (2 points)
Condition
Curve
In the lung
In human fetus
Page 5 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
20. (2 points)
a
White matter
II
III
26. (1 point)
Answer: _____C_____
Page 6 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
2.3
2.4
2.5
3.0
2.9
3.3
5.0
3.3
6.0
Endotherm
A, B
Juvenile
Adult
Adult
Page 7 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
Mouse
Snail
Toad
Chicken
Seastar
Fruit fly
31. (2 points)
a
Page 8 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
32. (1 point)
a
33.2. (1 point)
Answer: _____4/16_______.
Hairless
Normal
6.09
0.338
(3 decimal places)
Hardy-Weinberg Equilibrium
36. (4 points)
36.1. (2 points)
A
Page 9 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
36.2. (2 points)
The probability is _____0_____.
Citrulline
Glutamic semialdehyde
Arginine
Ornithine
Glutamic acid
12
2 3
34
45
38.2. (1 point)
Answer: _____2/9______.
Page 10 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
40. (1 point)
I
II
III
IV
II
III
IV
41.3. (1 point)
Pico
Santa Maria
Terceira
48 - 52
100 - 104
63 - 68
Page 11 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
II
III
IV
VI
44. (1 point)
X+Y
W+Z
Morphological
character(s)
Crustacea
Hexapoda
Myriapoda
Page 12 of 13
IBO2012 Singapore
Paper 2
Answer Key
III
IV
VII
VI
II
Paraphyletic
I, IV
II, III
Polyphyletic
END OF PAPER
Page 13 of 13
2012, Singapore
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 1
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 1
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 1
Dear Participants
Use the Answer Sheet, which is provided separately, to answer all the questions.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each task.
If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand immediately.
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings.
At the end of the test, place the Answer Sheet and Question paper in the envelope provided.
Our Assistants will collect the envelope from you.
Page 2 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 1
Quantity
Unit
4 l
tube
4 l
tube
10 l x 4
tube
tube
set
piece
stopwatch
piece
DNA ladder (as internal size markers, L1 for 100 bp range and
L2 for 1 kbp range) (on ice)
tube
tube
piece
large petri dish (for placing the gel for imaging purposes)
piece
card with your country code (in a clip holder): for signalling for
assistance
piece
piece
micro-centrifuge
set
set
set
Page 3 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 1
Design your DNA digests (you may do a maximum of 4 tubes) in a total volume of 20 l by
using the Table in the Answer Sheet.
Q1.1
(20 points) Record the desired amounts of reagents in your plan. One example is
already given for Tube 2 in the table provided. All units are in l.
Page 4 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
2.
PRACTICAL TEST 1
Prepare the mixtures by carefully pipetting the correct amount of the reagents and gently mix
them by pipetting them up and down in each tube. Label the tubes. Do not contaminate one
sample with another when preparing the mixture. Use a clean pipette tip for each operation.
Note: use p10 micropipette (white-coded) for pipetting reagents of less than 10 l. [NOTE:
there will be a penalty of 20 points if additional samples are requested. Please prepare the
samples carefully.]
3.
Spin down the mixture by placing all four tubes in the micro-centrifuge (please balance the spin
by placing tubes opposite to each other). During preparation and after spinning, always keep
the tubes on ice.
4.
After all the tubes have been prepared, remove them from the ice and place them into the
labelled floatation rack and incubate them for 20 minutes (stopwatch is provided) at 37 C in the
water bath assigned to you. Make sure that you retrieve your own samples after the 20 minutes
incubation time.
5.
During this 20 minute incubation duration, answer the following questions in the Answer Sheet:
Q1.2
b.
c.
d.
e.
Page 5 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
Q1.3
PRACTICAL TEST 1
b.
The smaller DNA fragments move faster across the gel under the electric current.
c.
The smaller DNA fragments are lesser charged than the larger fragments hence
they move faster across the gel.
d.
The relative density of the gel matrix affects how long the separation takes.
e.
6.
When the 20 minutes of DNA digests duration is up, retrieve your own tubes from the water
bath.
7.
Add 4 l of DNA loading-dye (blue colour). Mix them well by pipetting the mixture up and down
and spin down any residual liquid using the micro-centrifuge.
8.
Using the p100 micropipette (yellow-coded), load 15 l of the sample mixture of DNA digests
with the loading dye into the wells of the agarose gel provided. Make sure that you position
the pipette tips carefully on top of the wells and gently deliver the mixture to the wells without
spilling them. Load 15 l of each of the Markers, L1 and L2. Add your samples according to
the following scheme of lanes, starting from the left end of the gel.
Marker L1
9.
Tube 1
Tube 2
Tube 3
Tube 4
Marker L2
Cover the gel with a lid and connect the power supply to run at 100 volts for 20 min. Please be
careful and do not touch any part of the electrodes and power supply.
Page 6 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 1
10. Check regularly that the samples have entered the wells and are indeed running towards the
positive electrode. If you need help from the technicians to ensure proper runs for the samples,
please signal for assistance by clipping your signal card at the edge of right wall of your cubicle.
11. While waiting for the gel run, answer the following questions in the Answer Sheet:
Q1.4
(20 points) Consider the following scenario: A piece of linear human DNA (1 kbp) was
digested by a particular enzyme RE3, resulting in 2 fragments of 650 bp and 350 bp.
The same piece of 1 kbp DNA was digested with another enzyme RE4, releasing 2
fragments of 800 bp and 200 bp. And when this 1 kbp DNA was digested with RE3 and
RE4 together, 3 fragments of DNA were generated, 650 bp, 200 bp and 150 bp.
Sketch a linear map of this piece of DNA by indicating the position of RE3 and RE4
digests in the space provided. An example of such a sketch is provided below as a
guide.
12. When the 20 minutes of gel running time is up, turn off the power supply and remove the lid of
the gel tank. Carefully remove the gel (still on the gel tray) and place it on the petri dish
provided. Bring your gel to the gel doc that has been assigned for your usage and the
technician will photograph it for you.
13. Bring your gel and the photograph back to your cubicle and use your signal card to get
assistance for an invigilator to staple it in the space provided on the Answer Sheet.
Q1.5
(10 points) Your skills in running a gel will be assessed by the quality of the gel
produced.
Page 7 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 1
14. Based on the gel results, answer the following questions in the Answer Sheet:
Q1.6
(1 point 5 = 5 points) Using the DNA ladder markers (in basepairs) provided below
as the reference, estimate the sizes of the fragments/bands. You may draw a line
across the band of your query and the size marker to do the estimation. How many
fragment(s) of DNA were generated by RE1 and RE2? And what is/are the estimated
size(s)? Answer using numerals.
Q1.7
(1 point) What is the estimated size of the test DNA sample (T)? Answer using
numerals.
Page 8 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
Q1.8
PRACTICAL TEST 1
(1 point) Based on your results, is the test DNA sample (T) larger, smaller or the same
size as the empty vector? Indicate your answer with a tick () in the correct box.
Q1.9
(1 point) Does the test DNA sample (T) contain any insert? Indicate yes with a tick ()
and no with a cross ().
Q1.10 (2 points) Uncut DNA appears to move faster than any of the samples digested with
RE2. Why? Indicate your answer with a tick () in the correct box.
a.
b.
The uncut DNA is more compact and therefore moves faster through the gel.
c.
RE2 still binds to the DNA and therefore slows down their movement through gel.
END OF PAPER
Page 9 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 2
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
Dear Participants
In this test, you have been given the following two tasks:
Task 1:
Task 2:
Use the Answer Sheet, which is provided separately, to answer all the questions.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each task.
If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand immediately.
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings.
At the end of the test, place the Answer Sheets and Question paper in the envelope provided.
Our Assistants will collect the envelope from you.
Page 2 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
Quantity
Unit
box
box
box
micropipette 1 - 10l
piece
micropipette 2 - 20l
piece
micropipette 20 - 200l
piece
piece
piece
cuvette rack
piece
many
tube
tube
tube
tube
tube
tube
piece
stopwatch
piece
piece
set
set
set
Quantity
Unit
25 ml burette
piece
25 ml pipette
piece
100 ml beakers
piece
piece
magnetic stirrer
set
Page 3 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
set
pipette bulb
piece
Kimwipe papers
box
set
100
ml
80
ml
Page 4 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
Q1.1
(1 point) To dilute the E. coli culture from 1 107 cells/ml to 2 105 cells/ml, what would be
the dilution factor needed?
Q1.2
(1 point) For 1 ml of E coli culture at a cell density of 2 105 cells/ml, the final concentration
of ampicillin used should be 10 g/ml. What would be the volume of ampicillin stock (1mg/ml)
used?
Q1.3
(1 point) For 1 ml of E coli culture at a cell density of 2 105 cells/ml, final titre of phage
used should be 106 pfu/ml. What would be the volume of phage stock (108pfu/ml) used?
Q1.4
(1 point 15 = 15 points) With the above calculated dilution factors, fill in the table in the
Answer Sheet with your experimental plan. One example is already given for Tube 1 in the
table provided. All units are in l. Carry out your proposed experiment by incubating the
four tubes (placed in the labelled floating rack) for 40 minutes (stop watch provided) in the 37
Page 5 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
C water bath assigned to you. Hand over the floating rack to the technician at the water
bath.
After incubation, transfer your samples to the cuvettes labelled 1 to 4. In order to observe
the killing of bacteria cells, measure the absorbance at 595 nm wavelength. Bring your
samples to the spectrophotometer that is allocated for your use and hand over your samples
to the technician. You are to record your own readings as the samples are measured.
Q1.5
(0.75 2 + 1.5 points 6 = 10.5 points) Fill in the absorbance reading at 595 nm of the
different tubes of reactions in the table provided in the Answer Sheet. Taking 1 absorbance
unit of the E. coli cells at 595 nm to be equivalent to 1 107 cells/ml, what are the cell
densities of the E. coli in the respective reaction tubes?
Q1.6
(0.5 points 5 = 2.5 points) Which of the following are correct? Indicate correct answer(s)
with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a cross ().
a.
Due to the ampicillin resistance, the bacteria cell wall prevented easy penetration of the
antibiotics, but allowed the phages to enter the E. coli cells to cause lysis.
b.
The ampicillin resistance in the E. coli did not prevent the ability of the phage to adsorp
onto the bacteria cells.
c.
The bacteriophage likely has a lytic life cycle of around 20 to 30 mins and hence lysis of
the E. coli was observable during the short experiment.
d.
The temperature of 37 C was not the correct temperature for ampicillin to kill the E. coli
cells.
e.
The phages competed with the E. coli for the nutrients in the LB broth and the bacteria
cells lysed due to insufficient nutrients.
Page 6 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
-6
B = 10 dilution
-4
D = 10 dilution
E = 10 dilution
-2
F = 10 dilution
G = neat phage
H = E. coli lawn
uninfected by phage
A = 10 dilution
C = 10 dilution
-5
-3
-1
Page 7 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
Q1.7
PRACTICAL TEST 2
(2 points 4 = 8 points) Based on the number of plaques observed in the photos, calculate
the number of plaques that would be observed if the original undiluted phage culture were
used.
Q1.8
(3 points) To estimate the titre of a phage culture, serial dilutions as shown in the photos (A
to H) are normally performed. Based on the number of plaques shown, indicate with a tick ()
which is the best dilution to confirm the phage titre.
Q1.9
(4 points 2 = 8 points) Using the information given and your answers above, determine:
a.
the plaque forming units per milliliter (pfu/ml) of the phage culture used and
b.
Page 8 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
H+ + A is Ka.
Ka = [H+][A] / [HA]
More often, the strength of acids is expressed in terms of the pKa of the acid:
pKa = log Ka
In the titration of such a diprotic amino acid, the titration will thus occur in two steps as the more
acidic carboxyl group (lower pKa1) and the less acidic amino group (pKa2) successively lose their
protons.
In addition, the pH at which the net charge on the molecule is zero is called the isoelectric point (pI)
of the molecule, a useful constant in characterizing and purifying molecules. Using a titration curve,
the pI can be empirically determined as the inflection point between the pKas of the anionic and
cationic forms.
Page 9 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
The apparent pKa values for the two dissociation steps may be extrapolated from the midpoints of
each step. This can be shown by the Henderson-Hasselbalch equation:
pH = pKa + log { [A] / [HA] }
The pKa1 (pKa for the carboxyl acid group) is where half the acid group has been titrated. Therefore
the equation becomes:
pH = pKa
Similarly, the pKa2 (pKa for the amino group) can be determined.
In this experiment, you will titrate an unknown amino acid Z and determine its pI, pKa1 and pKa2.
Procedure
1.
Fill the burette with the standardized NaOH solution. Record the exact concentration of this
standardized NaOH solution in the Answer Sheet.
2.
Pipette 25 ml of the unknown amino acid solution Z into a clean 100 ml beaker.
3.
Carefully place the pH probe and a magnetic stirring bar into the amino acid solution, so that
the probe is far enough into the solution, but not touching the stirring bar or beaker. Clamp and
adjust the pH probe such that the stirring bar will not hit the probe while stirring. DO NOT
TOUCH THE CALIBRATION.
4.
Titration 1
Rinse the pH probe with deionized water. Dry the probe gently with a piece of Kimwipe paper.
Determine the pH of the amino acid solution Z before the addition of NaOH. Next, titrate the
amino acid solution with the NaOH from the burette. Add approximately 1.00 ml of the NaOH to
the amino acid at a time. Record the exact volume dispensed and the pH of the solution after
every 1.00 ml interval in the Answer Sheet. Continue until approximately 25 ml of NaOH has
been added.
5.
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
Q2.1
PRACTICAL TEST 2
(3 points 3 = 9 points) Table 1 shows the chemical structures of the twenty standard
amino acids. With reference to these structures, draw structures to show the complete
dissociation of glycine, proline and asparagine.
Q2.2
(3 points 2 = 6 points) For both titrations, record the volume of NaOH (ml) added during
the titration and the observed pH value for the unknown amino acid.
Q2.3
(5 points 2 = 10 points) Using your data, plot the graphs of each titration run (pH versus
Vol. of NaOH (ml)) in Graphs 1 and 2 provided in the Answer Sheet.
Q2.4
(2 points 2 = 4 points) From your titration curves, find the pI and label it on each graph.
Q2.4.1 (2 points) What is the mean pI?
Q2.5
(4 points 2 = 8 points) Find and label the pKa1 and pKa2 on each graph.
Q2.5.1 (2 points 2 = 4 points) What is the mean pKa1 and pKa2?
Q2.6
(5 points) 0.9210 g of the unknown amino acid Z was dissolved in 80 ml of deionized water.
Determine the molecular weight of the unknown amino acid Z. Note: In order to start with a
fully protonated amino acid, HCl solution has been added. This is equivalent to 3.2 ml of the
NaOH solution. To determine the actual number of moles of NaOH needed to reach the pl,
subtract 3.2 ml from the volume of NaOH used to reach the first end point.
Page 11 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
Q2.7
PRACTICAL TEST 2
glycine
b.
proline
c.
asparagine
d.
tyrosine
e.
tryptophan
Page 12 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
PRACTICAL TEST 2
MW (g/mole)
Glycine
75
Proline
115
Asparagine
132
Tyrosine
181
Tryptophan
204
END OF PAPER
Page 13 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 3
PRACTICAL TEST 3
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Dear Participants
In this test, you have been given the following two tasks:
Task I: Plant diversity and anatomy. (60 points)
Part A: Morphology of seedlings (14.25 points)
Part B: Seed morphology and anatomy (27.25 points)
Part C: Ficus propagule dissection (5 points)
Part D: Functional, ecological and phylogenetic aspects of seeds and seedlings (13.5
points)
Task II: Plant anatomy and physiology. (40 points)
Part A: Anatomy of a plant stem (13 points)
Part B: Study of leaf epidermis and physiology (15 points)
Part C: Interpretation of photosynthetic data (12 points)
Use the Answer Sheet, which is provided separately, to answer all the questions.
Write your answers legibly in ink (you may use a pencil for diagrams).
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each task.
If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand immediately.
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings.
At the end of the test, place the Answer Sheets and Question paper in the envelope provided.
Our Assistants will collect the envelope from you.
Page 2 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Quantity
Unit
specimen
specimen
specimen
piece
pair
hand lens
piece
Quantity
Unit
piece
piece
bottle
bottle
bottle
filter paper
sheet
forceps
pair
razor blade
piece
plastic dropper
piece
piece
petri dish (labelled LL, LU and SS with the correct student code)
piece
beaker (small)
piece
glass slides
piece
cover slips
piece
compound microscope
set
Page 3 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
(0.5 points 20 = 10 points; 2 points for quality of drawing; 2.25 points for not
damaging specimens) Make a simple schematic diagram of each seedling (A D) in the
corresponding space provided in the Answer Sheet and label the following (if present) with
a to e and indicate if any are absent:
a.
cotyledons
b.
epicotyl
c.
hypocotyl
d.
leaves
e.
seed coat
(0.25 points 11 = 2.75 points) Draw each whole seed (1 6) in the corresponding space
provided in the Answer Sheet (Note: (1) you do not need to draw Seed 7; (2) seed coat of
Seed 5 has been removed). Label the following (if present) with a and b and indicate if any
part is absent:
a.
seed coat
b.
Page 4 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
Q1.3
PRACTICAL TEST 3
(0.5 points 24 = 12 points; 1 point for quality of drawing) After drawing the exterior of
each seed, dissect in longitudinal section and draw the sectioned seed in the corresponding
space provided in the Answer Sheet. (Note: Some seeds have been pre-cut for your
convenience. The seed coat of Seed 5 has been removed.). Label/indicate the following
items on your diagram with a to d:
Q1.4
a.
cotyledons
b.
food storage
c.
hypocotyl
d.
seed coat
(0.5 points 23 = 11.5 points) Indicate the likely ploidy (1N, 2N or 3N) of each of the items
labelled a to d in Q1.3 in the Answer Sheet.
(1 + 1 + 3 points) Dissect Specimen E longitudinally and draw the longitudinal section of the
propagule (dispersal unit). Draw and label an enlarged section to show in detail the features
of a to c.
a.
fruit
b.
seed
c.
stigma
Part D. Functional, ecological and phylogenetic aspects of seeds and seedlings (13.5 points)
Q1.6
(0.5 points 9 = 4.5 points) Based on the observations in Parts A, B and C, and the
information given in the Table provided in the Answer Sheet, indicate the primary function
of the cotyledon with P (for photosynthesis) or S (for storage of nutrients) and the probable
Page 5 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
germination pattern with O (orthodox: seed can undergo dormancy) or R (recalcitrant: seed
does not undergo dormancy).
Q1.7
(1 point 5 = 5 points) Based on the information in the Table and the diagrams that you
have drawn, determine if each of the following statements is true () or false ().
a.
b.
c.
d.
Seed size varies considerably in plant families and is probably not phylogenetically
constrained.
e.
Q1.8
Large seed size may be advantageous for some tropical rainforest plants.
a.
b.
Large seeds have evolved on more than one occasion in some lineages.
c.
Recalcitrant seeds are more associated with tropical plants than with temperate plants.
d.
Gymnosperms are unable to produce fleshy structures associated with animal dispersal
because they lack ovaries.
Page 6 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Phylogeny of Malvaceae
Phylogeny of Moraceae
Gymnosperms
(Seeds 5, 6, 7)
Monocots
Moraceae
+ related families
(Seed 2, Specimen E)
Malvaceae, Sapindaceae
+ related families
(Seeds 1, 3, 4)
Page 7 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Using the razor blade, cut as thin as possible transverse sections of the stem, S.
2.
3.
Place a drop of water onto a glass slide and transfer the best cross-section to the centre of the
slide.
4.
Place a small drop of phloroglucin stain (P) onto the cross-section, followed by a small drop of
concentrated hydrochloric acid, HCl (H). Be very careful when handling H as it is corrosive.
5.
Leave for 1 minute and then remove excess stain with the filter paper.
6.
Cover the cross-section with a coverslip and examine it using the compound microscope under
low magnification (4 objective lens).
(1 point) Is S a monocot stem or dicot stem? Indicate M for monocot and D for dicot.
Q2.2
(1 point) Is there any pith? Indicate presence of pith with a tick () and absence with a
cross ().
Q2.3
(1 point) Where is the vascular bundle in the stem located? Indicate centre with C and
periphery with P.
Page 8 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Q2.4 (0.5 points 3 = 1.5 points) Based on your observations, is S the stem of a shrub, tree,
or herb? Indicate correct answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a cross
() in the Answer Sheet.
Q2.5
(0.5 points) Identify the tissue (a e) that is stained red. Indicate the correct answer
with a tick () in the Answer Sheet.
7.
a.
cortex
b.
endodermis
c.
epidermis
d.
phloem
e.
xylem
When you have completed Part A, place your slide with the stem section into the petri dish SS
for grading purposes.
Q2.6
(8 points)
Lower epidermis
Procedure:
1.
Peel off the lower epidermis of the leaf, L, with a pair of forceps.
2.
Place it in a drop of water on a glass slide and cover the peeled layer with a cover slip.
3.
Page 9 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
(2 points) Do you see any stomata? Indicate presence of stomata with a tick ()
and absence with a cross ().
Q2.8
(3 points) Measure the lengths and widths of FIVE (5) epidermal cells that are
representative of the majority of the cells. Smallest unit in the eyepiece micrometer
as seen under 10 objective lens is 10 m. Calculate the mean values and fill in your
answer in the table provided.
4.
When you have completed Part B (i), place your slide with the epidermal peel into the
petri dish LL for checking purposes. The slide will also be used to check for accuracy of
your measurement of epidermal cell dimensions.
Peel off the upper epidermis of the leaf, L, with a pair of forceps. You may either use
the same leaf as before or a fresh leaf from petri dish L.
2.
Place it in a drop of water on a glass slide and cover the peeled layer with a cover slip.
3.
Page 10 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
(2 points) Do you see any stomata? Indicate presence of stomata with a tick ()
and absence with a cross ().
Q2.10 (3 points) Measure the lengths and widths of FIVE (5) epidermal cells that are
representative of the majority of the cells. Smallest unit in the eyepiece micrometer
as seen under 10 objective lens is 10 m. Calculate the mean values and fill in your
answers in the table provided.
4.
When you have completed Part B (ii), place your slide with the epidermal peel into
the petri dish LU for checking purposes. The slide will also be used to check for
accuracy of your measurement of epidermal cell dimensions.
Q2.11 (0.5 point 3 = 1.5 points) Based on your observations in Part B (i) and (ii), indicate
the correct answer(s) with a tick () and incorrect answer(s) with a cross ().
a.
There are more stomata in the lower epidermis than in the upper epidermis.
b.
Epidermal cells of the upper epidermis are smaller than those of the lower
epidermis.
c.
Q2.12 (1 point) Based on your observations, determine what type of plant this is. Indicate
the correct answer with a tick () in the Answer Sheet.
a. hydrophyte
b. mesophyte
c. xerophyte
Page 11 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Q2.13 (0.5 point 5 = 2.5 points) Some statements about stomatal structure, function and
development are given below. Indicate true statement(s) with a tick () and false
statement(s) with a cross ().
a. Stomata consist of a pair of highly specialized guard cells that are usually
surrounded by a pair of larger subsidiary cells.
b. Guard cells differ significantly from other epidermal cells in that they have
chloroplasts.
c. Chloroplasts of guard cells differ from mesophyll chloroplasts in that they lack
grana.
d. The number of stomata on any leaf surface is under genetic control and is not
modified by any environmental factors.
e. Stomatal development involves asymmetric cell divisions.
Part C. Interpretation of photosynthetic data from plants measured at different CO2 concentrations
(12 points)
Introduction
Single leaves from plants A and B that had been grown under full sunlight in the same greenhouse
were studied. The responses of their net photosynthetic CO2 assimilation rates to varying levels of
ambient CO2 under saturating light intensity of 1,200 mol quanta m2 s1 at 25 C and 21% O2
measured on leaves in the laboratory are given on the next page:
Page 12 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Plant B
20
0.5
-4
40
11
-1
60
19
2.5
80
28
5.5
100
33
180
41
18
300
44
27
400
44
32
600
44
40
800
44
44
1000
44
45.5
Q2.14 (4 points). Plot a graph by using the data above for Plant A and B in Graph 1 provided in
the Answer Sheet. Use an X-axis scale from 0 to 1000 l l-1.
Q2.16 (2 points) What is the net photosynthetic CO2 assimilation rate for Plant A and Plant B
measured at 200 l l-1 of CO2 concentration?
Page 13 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Q2.17 (2 points) Plot another graph by using CO2 assimilation rate from 20 to 100 l l-1 of CO2
concentration only (i.e., at low CO2 concentrations) for Plant B in Graph 2 provided in the
Answer Sheet. Use an X-axis scale from 0 to 100 l l-1.
Q2.18 (1 point) Based on Graph 2, what is the CO2 compensation point for plant B? Write the
value in the Answer Sheet.
Q2.19 (1 point) Compared to the data in Graph 2, would the CO2 compensation point increase,
decrease or remain unchanged if the measurements were carried out at 35 C and 21% O2?
Indicate the correct answer(s) with a tick () in the Answer Sheet.
Q2.20 (1 point). Compared to the data in Graph 2, would the CO2 compensation point increase,
decrease or remain unchanged if the measurements were carried out at 25 C and 2% O2?
Indicate the correct answer(s) with a tick () in the Answer Sheet.
END OF PAPER
Page 14 of 14
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Dear Participants
In this test, you have been given the following two tasks:
Task I: Anatomy of molluscs. (20 points)
Task II: Rank-abundance plots, ABC curves and community structure. (80 points)
Use the Answer Sheet, which is provided separately, to answer all the questions.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each task.
If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand immediately.
Stop answering and put down your pen IMMEDIATELY when the bell rings.
At the end of the test, place the Answer Sheet and Question paper in the envelope provided.
Our Assistants will collect the envelope from you.
Page 2 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Quantity
Unit
specimen
specimen
stereomicroscope
set
scissors
pair
forceps
pairs
plastic tray
piece
1000
mL
sheet
For Task II: Rank-abundance plots, ABC curves and community structure
Materials
Quantity
Unit
Community 1
bag
Community 2
bag
Table A
sheet
Table B
sheet
Page 3 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Introduction
Members of the class Bivalvia are successful molluscs with a long evolutionary history. They
possess hinged left and right shell valves that enclose a headless animal within.
Vials labelled 1 and 2 contain two species of marine bivalves that are common in tropical Asia but
live in different habitats. The specimens were partly boiled and preserved in 70% ethanol.
Follow the instructions below to open the animals up for detailed examination under the
stereomicroscope.
Locate the anterior (if present) and posterior adductor muscles that join the left and right
valves of the animal.
Use the pair of scissors to cut the adductor muscles so that the valves can be separated to
expose the internal parts of the animal.
(3 points 2 = 6 points) In which habitat (a d) would you expect to find species 1 and 2
respectively?
a.
b.
c.
d.
Page 4 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
Q1.2
PRACTICAL TEST 4
(2 points 2 = 4 points) How many pairs of ctenidia (gills) are there in species 1 and 2
respectively? Answer using numerals.
Q1.3
(2 points 2 = 4 points) How many pairs of labial palps are there in species 1 and 2
respectively? Answer using numerals.
Q1.4
(2 points 2 = 4 points) Locate the anus near the posterior end of the animal in each
species. The anus empties its contents into the path of the exhalant water flow. Starting
with the anus, trace the path of the intestine forwards towards the stomach. Indicate the
position of the intestine in relation to the heart (a e) in the two species respectively.
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Q1.5
molluscs. Indicate with a tick () if the feature may be present in bivalves and with a cross
() if it is always absent.
a.
crystalline style
b.
eye
c.
foot
d.
penis
e.
radula
Page 5 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Introduction
Changes in community structure may be visualized using a variety of graphs. A rank-abundance
plot or Whittaker plot is used by ecologists to display relative species abundance, a component of
biodiversity. In this type of graph, the rank of each species is plotted along the X axis. The most
abundant species is ranked 1, the second most abundant species is ranked 2, and so forth. The
abundance of each species is plotted on the log scale of the Y axis. The shape of the curve can
provide an indication of dominance or evenness.
Page 6 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
Q2.1
PRACTICAL TEST 4
You are a summer intern at the marine laboratory in which this EIA study is conducted. Your
responsibilities include the processing of benthic samples. You are given two bags
containing Community 1 and 2 and your job is to process the samples and collate
information similar to that carried out by a senior research assistant for Community 3 and 4
(see Table A, page 11 for Summary of the information). Each community may contain any of
the 17 species (A Q) listed in Table B (page 12); the respective mean fresh biomass per
individual of each species is also provided in Table B.
Page 7 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
The abundance of each species in Community 1 and 2 is indicated with different-sized chips
(see photograph below); e.g., there are 61 individuals of species A shown here:
1 individual
10 individuals
50 individuals
Determine the abundance of each species in Community 1 and record your data in
Table 1 in the Answer Sheet.
Fill in the rest of the required information (to 2 decimal places) in the table. Please note
that lg in the table and figure represents log10 and in the calculator, this is represented
by the log button.
Q2.2
(3 points 4 = 12 points) Using your data in Tables 1 and 2, as well as the data provided
in Tables 3 and 4, plot the rank-abundance curves for Community 1 to 4 on Graphs 1 to 4
provided in the Answer Sheet.
Answer the following questions in the Answer Sheet. Indicate correct answer(s) with a tick
() and incorrect answer(s) with a cross ().
Q2.2.1 (1 point 5 = 5 points) Low evenness is:
a.
b.
shown in Community 1.
c.
shown in Community 2.
d.
shown in Community 3.
e.
shown in Community 4.
Page 8 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Q2.2.2 (2.5 points 4 = 10 points) Indicate the correct ABC curves (A H) that
correspond to Community 1 to 4.
abundance; biomass
Page 9 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Q2.2.4 (1 point 10 = 10 points) A careless summer intern, mixed up the labels for the
sampling stations (A1 A3; B1 B7) when the samples were transferred from
leaking containers to new bottles. From which stations could the benthic samples
containing Community 1 to 4 likely to be collected?
Q2.2.6 (2.5 points) Which of the17 species (A Q) has the potential to be a bioindicator of
organic enrichment?
Page 10 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Table A
Community 3
Community 4
Species
Abundance
Rank
Log10 (lg)
Abundance
Cumulative
%
Abundance
Cumulative
%
Biomass
Species
Abundance
Rank
Log10 (lg)
Abundance
Cumulative
%
Abundance
Cumulative
%
Biomass
200
2.30
14.31
28.30
320
2.51
60.49
7.83
180
2.26
27.18
41.03
78
1.89
75.24
38.37
175
2.24
39.70
50.76
50
1.70
84.69
60.39
150
2.18
50.43
58.34
32
1.51
90.74
71.35
120
2.08
59.01
68.65
25
1.40
95.46
85.42
112
2.05
67.02
73.74
10
1.00
97.35
91.53
98
1.99
74.03
81.17
0.70
98.30
93.98
80
1.90
79.76
86.02
0.60
99.05
96.62
75
1.88
85.12
88.29
0.48
99.62
98.53
62
10
1.79
89.56
92.36
10
0.30
100.00
100.00
35
11
1.54
92.06
94.40
30
12
1.48
94.21
96.45
28
13
1.45
96.21
97.44
25
14
1.40
98.00
98.45
15
15
1.18
99.07
98.48
16
0.90
99.64
98.99
17
0.70
100.00
100.00
Total
1398
Total
529
Page 11 of 12
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Species
0.70
0.90
1.40
2.80
1.30
1.15
0.80
1.35
1.25
0.05
4.00
1.10
1.50
1.00
0.60
1.70
1.20
END OF PAPER
Page 12 of 12
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANSWER KEY
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 1
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 5
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANSWER KEY
Q1.2
Q1.3
Q1.4
Tube 1
Tube 2
Tube 3
Tube 4
10
10
10
10
RE1 (Ndel)
RE2 (EcoRI)
water
10
Total
20
20
20
20
(2 points 5 = 10 points)
a
(2 points 5 = 10 points)
a
(20 points)
Either orientation
Page 2 of 5
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANSWER KEY
Q1.5
(10 points)
3kbp
0.75kbp
500bp
300bp
Q1.6
(1 point 5 = 5 points)
Number of fragments
Estimated size
RE1
RE2
2 (1 point)
1 (1 point)
3.33 kbp
(any value between
3.0 to 3.5 kbp)
(1 point)
Page 3 of 5
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANSWER KEY
Q1.7
(1 point)
Answer: ___3.33 kbp (between 3 and 3.5 kbp)_______ .
Q1.8
(1 point) [for having one correct tick; no points if there are more than 1 ticks]
Larger
Smaller
Same
size
Q1.9
(1 point)
Answer: _____ .
Q1.10 (2 points) [for having one correct tick; no points if there are more than 1 tick]
a
Page 4 of 5
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
CELL & MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANSWER KEY
Page 5 of 5
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER KEY
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 2
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
ANSWER KEY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER KEY
(1 point)
Answer: ____50-fold or 1/50_
Q1.2
(1 point)
Answer: _____10______l
Q1.3
(1 point)
Answer: _____10______l
Q1.4
(5 points 3 = 15 points)
Tube 1
Tube 2
Tube 3
Tube 4
20
20
20
10
10
deionised water
10
10
LB broth
1000
970
970
970
Total (l)
1000
1000
1000
1000
(5 points)
(5 points)
(5 points)
Page 2 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER KEY
Q1.5
Q1.6
Tube
Absorbance reading at
595 nm
Blanked absorbance at
595 nm
0.143
0.312
0.166
1.69 x 106
0.313
0.165
1.71 x 106
0.157
0.015
1.42 x 104
Q1.8
(2 points 4 = 8 points)
Plate
Dilution factor
Number of plaques
observed
10-6
10 -5
200,000
10 -4
15
150,000
10 -3
153
153,000
10 -2
1560
156,000
(3 points)
10-6
10 -5
10 -4
10 -3
10 -2
Q1.9
(4 points 2 = 8 points)
a
61
Page 3 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER KEY
(3 points 3 = 9 points)
Glycine dissociation:
Proline dissociation:
Asparagine dissociation:
Page 4 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER KEY
Q2.2
(3 points 2 = 6 points)
Titration 1
Concentration of standardized NaOH: _____0.3024 M_______________
Starting volume of NaOH: ____0.00 ml________________
pH
0.00
1.3
1.00
1.4
2.00
1.4
3.00
1.5
4.00
1.6
5.00
1.7
6.00
1.8
7.00
2.0
8.00
2.1
9.00
2.3
10.00
2.6
11.00
3.0
12.00
9.1
13.00
9.8
14.00
10.1
15.00
10.3
16.00
10.5
17.00
10.8
18.00
11.0
19.00
11.2
20.00
11.5
21.00
11.7
22.00
11.9
23.00
12.0
24.00
12.1
25.00
12.2
Page 5 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER KEY
Titration 2
Concentration of standardized NaOH: _____0.3024 M______________
Starting volume of NaOH: _____0.00 ml_______________
pH
0.00
1.4
1.00
1.4
2.00
1.5
3.00
1.6
4.00
1.7
5.00
1.8
6.00
1.9
7.00
2.1
8.00
2.2
9.00
2.4
10.00
2.7
11.00
3.2
12.00
9.4
13.00
9.9
14.00
10.2
15.00
10.4
16.00
10.6
17.00
10.8
18.00
11.0
19.00
11.3
20.00
11.6
21.00
11.8
22.00
12.0
23.00
12.1
24.00
12.2
25.00
12.3
Page 6 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
MICROBIOLOGY & BIOCHEMISTRY
Q2.3
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER KEY
Q2.4
Q2.5
Q2.6
(5 points)
Answer: ___115_____.(5 pts: based on volume of NaOH used to obtain value of pI in Q2.4,
create formula in Excel to check if MW has been calculated correctly)
Q2.7
(2 points)
Answer: ___b_______.
Page 7 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER SHEET
Graph 1
Page 8 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANSWER SHEET
Graph 2
Page 9 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 3
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
(0.5 points 20 = 10 points; 2 points for quality of drawings; 2.25 points for not
damaging specimens)
A
Absent: _____c________
D
Absent: _____c________
Page 2 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Absent: _____________
3
Absent: _____________
5
Absent: ____a_________
Absent: _____________
4
Absent: _____________
6
Absent: ____b_________
Page 3 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Q1.3
Page 4 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Q1.4
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
3N
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
2N
1N
2N
---
2N
1N
2N
2N
Page 5 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
(1+1+3 points)
E
Enlarged section
Page 6 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Part D. Functional, ecological and phylogenetic aspects of seeds and seedlings (13.5 points)
Q1.6
Table 1
Seeds
Family
Primary
Seed dry
Probable
function of
weight as %
germination
cotyledon*
fresh weight
pattern+
Malvaceae
60%
Tropical / wet
Moraceae
45%
Tropical / wet
Malvaceae
80%
Tropical-Subtropical / dry
Sapindaceae
65%
Tropical / wet
Pinaceae
80%
Temperate / subtropical
Ginkgoaceae
***
55%
Tropical / wet
Moraceae
85%
Tropical / wet
Q1.7
Q1.8
(1 point 5 = 5 points)
a
(1 point 4 = 4 points)
a
--
--
Page 7 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Q2.1 Q2.3
Q2.4
Q2.5
(1 point 3 = 3 points)
Q2.1 (M or D)
Q2.2 ( or )
Q2.3 (C or P)
Shrub
Tree
Herb
(0.5 points)
Page 8 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Q2.6
(8 points)
CRITERIA
Completeness of stem section
SCORE
/10
/10
Yes: 10 points
No: O point
Thickness of stem section
/40
/20
/20
0 bubbles: 20 points
<10 small bubbles: 15 points
>10 small bubbles and some large bubbles: 10 points
Numerous large bubbles, section obscured: 0 point
TOTAL
100
Page 9 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Lower epidermis
Q2.7
(2 points)
Answer: ___________ .
Q2.8
Mean
Length (m)
120
100
100
150
150
124
Width (m)
100
80
110
70
80
88
Acceptable Answers:
Length: 120225 m; Width: 80130 m
(Length: 125225 m; Width: 80125 m, Chimpan & Sipos; 2009)
(2 points)
Answer: ___________ .
Mean
Length (m)
180
220
240
210
200
210
Width (m)
180
240
210
210
160
200
Acceptable Answers:
Length: 220 270 m; Width: 160 230 m
(Length: 225 250 m; Width: 175 225 m, Chimpan & Sipos; 2009)
Page 10 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Q2.12 (1 point)
Part C. Interpretation of photosynthetic data from plants measured at different CO2 concentrations (12
points)
Q2.14 (4 points) Graph 1
CRITERIA:
1. Plot
a. Accuracy (1 mark) one point off, - 0.5
mark , two points off, -1 point
b. Differentiation of curves by different symbols
or labels ( 1 point)
2. Smoothness of curves: 2 points, 1 point for
each curve
Page 11 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
C4
Q2.16 (2 points)
42 0.5
20.5 0.5
mol CO2 m2 s1
mol CO2 m2 s1
CRITERIA:
1. Plot
Accuracy (1 point)
one point off, 0.5 point,
two points off, 1 point
2. Straight line (1 point)
Q2.18 (1 point)
Answer: 46 1 mol CO2 m2 s1
(Note: without a unit, 0.5 points will be deducted.)
Page 12 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PLANT DIVERSITY, ANATOMY & PHYSIOLOGY
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ANSWER KEY
Q2.19 (1 point)
increase
decrease
remain unchanged
decrease
remain unchanged
Q2.20 (1 point)
increase
Page 13 of 13
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANSWER KEY
Country: _____________________
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Total points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Page 1 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANSWER KEY
Q1.2
Q1.3
Q1.4
Q1.5
(3 points 2 = 6 points)
1
(2 points 2 = 4 points)
1
(2 points 2 = 4 points)
1
(2 points 2 = 4 points)
1
Page 2 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANSWER KEY
Q2.2
B1, B6
A3, B7
B2, B5
B7
B2, B5
or
A3, B1, B6
Q2.2.6
Page 3 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Table 1. Community 1
Species
Abundance
Rank
Log10 (lg)
Abundance
%
Abundance
Cumulative %
Abundance
(+/- 0.10)
Biomass of
individual
Total
biomass of
species
% Biomass
Cumulative %
Biomass
(+/-0.10)
120
2.08
17.39
17.39
1.00
120.00
10.05
10.05
115
2.06
16.67
34.06
2.80
322.00
26.98
37.03
100
2.00
14.49
48.55
1.25
125.00
10.47
47.50
85
1.93
12.32
60.87
1.70
144.50
12.11
59.61
78
1.89
11.30
72.17
1.15
89.70
7.51
67.12
62
1.79
8.99
81.16
4.00
248.00
20.78
87.90
50
1.70
7.25
88.41
1.30
65.00
5.45
93.34
25
1.40
3.62
92.03
0.90
22.50
1.88
95.23
20
1.30
2.90
94.93
1.50
30.00
2.51
97.74
15
10
1.18
2.17
97.10
1.35
20.25
1.70
99.44
12
11
1.08
1.74
98.84
0.05
0.60
0.05
99.49
12
0.70
0.72
99.57
0.80
4.00
0.34
99.82
13
0.48
0.43
100.00
0.70
2.10
0.18
100.00
Total
690
1193.65
Page 4 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Table 2. Community 2
Species
Abundance
Rank
Log10 (lg)
Abundance
%
Abundance
Cumulative %
Abundance
(+/- 0.10)
Biomass of
individual
Total
biomass of
species
% Biomass
Cumulative %
Biomass
(+/-0.10)
1200
3.08
96.93
96.93
0.05
60.00
64.38
64.38
15
1.18
1.21
98.14
0.70
10.50
11.27
75.65
0.90
0.65
98.79
0.90
7.20
7.73
83.38
0.70
0.40
99.19
0.80
4.00
4.29
87.67
0.60
0.32
99.52
1.00
4.00
4.29
91.96
0.48
0.24
99.76
1.25
3.75
4.02
95.98
0.30
0.16
99.92
1.30
2.60
2.79
98.77
0.00
0.08
100.00
1.15
1.15
1.23
100.00
Total
1238
93.20
Page 5 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Graph 1
Page 6 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Graph 2
Page 7 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Graph 3
Page 8 of 9
IBO2012
SINGAPORE
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL ANATOMY & ECOLOGY
ANSWER KEY
Graph 4
Page 9 of 9
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
Student Code:
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
Dear participants,
Check your Student Code on the Answer Sheet before starting the test.
The questions in Part A have only one correct answer. Fill your answer in the Answer Sheet.
Mark the correct answer with X on the Answer Sheet clearly, as shown below.
No.
A0
Good Luck!!
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
I. Cell Biology
A1. Endorphin is a natural analgesic secreted by the pituitary gland. Upon binding to its receptor
in brain cells, endorphin can relieve pain and create a sense of euphoria. Morphine can
achieve similar pain relief effects by binding to the endorphin receptor. Why do both
endorphin and morphine bind to the endorphin receptors in brain cells?
(A) Sizes of both molecules are similar.
(B) Molecular weights of both molecules are similar.
(C) Both are isomers.
(D) Shapes of both molecules are similar.
(E) Net charges of both molecules are identical.
A2. Most biological macromolecules are made by the polymerization of small principal
components. The major structural polysaccharide of the insect exoskeleton is a polymer.
Which of the following statements regarding this kind of polysaccharide is NOT correct?
(A) It is made by polymerization of glucose.
(B) It contains C, H, O and N atoms.
(C) Its structure is similar to that of cellulose.
(D) It can be used to produce chitosan and glucosamine in industry.
(E) This polymer can also been found in the cell wall of fungi.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
A3. In some cells, synthesis of isoleucine from threonine is catalyzed by the sequential action of
five enzymes a, b, c, d and e which produce 4 intermediates A, B, C, D, and the end product
isoleucine, respectively. What is most likely to happen when isoleucine is overproduced and
there is an ample supply of threonine in cells?
(A) Isoleucine associates with threonine to inhibit the activity of enzyme a.
(B) Isoleucine associates with intermediate D to inhibit the activity of enzyme e.
(C) Isoleucine binds to enzyme a and inhibits its activity.
(D) Isoleucine binds to enzyme e and inhibits its activity.
(E) Threonine is converted into isoleucine continuously through the 5 enzymes.
A4. In some prokaryotic organisms, SO42- is used as the final electron receptor at the end of
electron transport chain during cellular respiration. Which of the following statements
regarding cellular respiration in these prokaryotic organisms is NOT correct?
(A) It is anaerobic respiration.
(B) The reception of electron by SO42- is accompanied by the production of H2O.
(C) Operation of the electron transport chain builds up a proton motive force.
(D) ATP can be produced.
(E) Production of ATP is correlated with the mobility of H+.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
Lag phase
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
A7. Histones are small basic proteins that assemble with DNA molecules to form chromosomes.
There are five histones, including H1, H2A, H2B, H3 and H4, in eukaryotic cells. Which of
the following structural features of chromosomes is associated with Histone H1?
(A) Telomere
(B) Nucleosome fiber (10-nm fiber)
(C) 30-nm fiber
(D) Looped domains
(E) Centromere
A8. DNA is a double helix molecule containing four different types of nitrogen bases. Which of
the following statements regarding both the replication and chemical composition of DNA
is correct?
(A) Base sequences of both strands are the same.
(B) The amount of purine is equal to that of pyrimidine in a double-stranded DNA.
(C) Both strands are synthesized continuously in 53 direction.
(D) The first base of the newly synthesized DNA is catalyzed by DNA polymerase.
(E) The proof-reading activity of DNA polymerase proceeds in the 53 direction.
A9. Mister Spiderman has compared the DNA, the corresponding RNA and protein sequences of
many human genes. What conclusion can be drawn from the sequence comparison?
(A) The number of exons is always more than that of introns.
6
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
(B) The translation start codon is located within the first exon.
(C) The translation stop codon is located within the last exon.
(D) The G nucleotide of RNA capping is the first nucleotide transcribed from DNA.
(E) The polyA tail is transcribed from the polydT of DNA.
A10. Miss Ling-Ling conducts DNA synthesis and transcription reactions in two separate test
tubes. Which of the following substances needs to be added to both reactions?
(A) ATP
(B) DNA template
(C) RNA primer
(D) DNA polymerase
(E) DNA ligase
A11. The Nobel Prize in Physiology or Medicine 2009 was awarded jointly to Blackburn, Greider
and Szostak for the discovery that chromosomes are protected by telomeres and the enzyme
telomerase is highly correlated with aging and cancer in animals. Which of the following
statements regarding telomere and telomerase is correct?
(A) Telomerase is a DNA exonuclease.
(B) Telomerase is an RNA polymerase.
(C) Embryonic cells possess long telomeres and high telomerase activity.
(D) Telomeres are longer and telomerase is inactive in cancer cells.
7
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
(E) Telomeres are longer and telomerase is highly active in somatic cells.
A12. EcoRI restriction enzyme is a DNA endonuclease that can recognize the sequence GAATTC.
It was first discovered in E. coli, therefore it was named EcoRI. To produce a large quantity
of the endonuclease, the DNA fragment encoding the gene was subcloned into an
expression plasmid and the resultant recombinant plasmid was transformed into E. coli cells
to produce recombinant enzyme for a study. Why is the host DNA not cleaved by the
recombinant EcoRI?
(A) The host DNA does not contain EcoRI cleavage sites.
(B) EcoRI is secreted out of the host cells.
(C) Environmental factors such as temperature and pH value inhibit EcoRI activity.
(D) The E. coli host produces inhibitors to block EcoRI activity.
(E) The EcoRI cleavage sites within the host DNA are modified.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
(C) CDP-MEP
(D) ME-cPP
(E) HMBPP
A16. The plant MEP pathway is located in which of the following organelle?
(A) nucleus
(B) vacuole
(C) chloroplast
(D) mitochondrion
(E) endoplasmic reticulum
A17. Dennis dissected a plant leaf and found bundle sheath cells full of starch granules. Which of the
following characteristics can be observed in this plant?
I. Stomata open at night
II. Presence of PEP carboxylase in mesophylls
III. Presence of Rubisco in bundle sheath cells
IV. High photorespiration rate on hot summer days
V. Light reaction and carbon fixation occur in different cell types
VI. Carbon assimilation rate is saturated in the early morning on summer days
(A) Only I, III
(B) Only II, IV
(C) Only II, IV, V
11
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
It often
They
screened mutants of the model plant Arabidopsis thaliana that respond abnormally to ABA
treatment to identify the involving components of the pathway.
phenotype is ABA-insensitive (abi).
12
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
SunUp papaya in Hawaii. The construct used for transformation includes the CP gene and a
selectable marker gene (nptII) conferring kanamycin resistance. Both CP and nptII genes
are driven by a constitutive cauliflower mosaic virus (CaMV) 35S promoter. According to
the above information, which of the following statements is NOT correct?
(A) The SunUp papaya is resistant to kanamycin.
(B) The SunUp papaya contains some DNA sequences from CaMV.
(C) The SunUp papaya contains some genomic DNA of Agrobacterium tumefaciens.
(D) The SunUp papaya contains a portion of the Ti plasmid termed T-DNA.
(E) The SunUp papaya contains the nptII gene.
15
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
(D) The shark metabolizes its stored energy more readily than the dolphin does
(E) The shark has a better insulation on its body surface
A26. Increased arteriolar resistance contributes to hypertension. Which one of the following
factors contribute to the increased vascular resistance most significantly?
(A) Vessel length
(B) Blood viscosity
(C) Vascular diameter
(D) Total leukocyte counts
(E) Heart rate
A27. A method to estimate an mammals blood volume uses a specific radioactive isotope of
iodine(123I). This isotope, usually produced synthetically, has a half-life time of 13 hours. It
decays to 123Te, which is almost perfectly stable. To estimate the blood volume, 10 mL of
iodine solution are injected into the animals vein. The activity of the solution at the
injection is 2mSv. A sample of 10 mL of the animals blood, taken 13 hours after the
injection, is 0.0025mSv. The estimate volume of the animals blood volume is?
(A) 10.0 L
(B) 8.0 L
(C) 4.0 L
(D) 2.5 L
17
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
(E) 1.25 L
A28. Which of the following events will result in an excitatory postsynaptic potential?
a.
18
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
A29. Which of the following is the correct effect of hyperthyroidism (hypersecretion of thyroid
hormone) on Thyrotropin-releasing hormone (TRH), thyroid-stimulating hormone (TSH), and
Thyroid hormones T3 and T4?
: increase : decrease
: remains unchanged
TRH
TSH
T3
T4
A30. Which of following receptors/molecules are required for the activation of Helper T cells
trigged by antigen-presenting cells.
1. CD8
2. CD4
3. Class I MHC molecule
4. Class II MHC molecule
5. T cell receptor
(A) Only 1, 3 & 5
19
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
What
How
Where
6. Loop of Henle
7. Collecting duct
8. Proximal tubule
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
(E) 3-5-7
A32. When people lose blood quickly as happens in a car accident, which of the following
situations will NOT occur
(A) Stroke volume increases; cardiac output increases
(B) Blood volume decreases but interstitial fluid increases
(C) Increase in the resistance of blood vessel
(D) Decrease of sodium concentration in urine
(E) Decrease in the proportion of red blood cells in blood.
A33. The following figure illustrates the membrane potential changes measured at three different
sites (A, B, C) along a sensory neuron and the release of neurotransmitters from the axon
termini when depolarizing electrical stimuli with varied intensities were applied to the
dendrite. Based on the information provided in the figure below, choose the correct
statements in the following box.
21
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
22
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
Which one of the above receptors in human receptors will be activated by a stimulation and
trigger the opening of a potassium channel?
(A) 1
(B) 2
(C) 3
(D) 4
(E) 5
23
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
IV. Ethology
A35. There are three types of chemical substances that organisms emit to mediate interspecific
interactions: kairomone, allomone, and synomone. Kairomone benefits individuals of
another species which receives it but is disadvantageous to the emitter. Allomone benefits
the emitter, and does not benefit or harm the receiver. Synomone benefits both the emitter
and receiver. A plant species emits a volatile essential oil that attracts a phytophagous beetle
to feed and lay eggs on its leaves. At the same time, it also attracts a parasitoid wasp, and
helps this parasitic natural enemy of the beetles to locate the beetle larvae within which they
can lay their own eggs. Which of the following descriptions of the role that this essential oil
plays is correct?
(A) It acts as a synomone between the plant and the beetle, and an allomone between the
plant and the parasitoid wasp.
(B) It acts as a kairomone between the plant and the parasitoid wasp, and a synomone
between the beetle and the parasitoid wasp.
(C) It acts as a kairomone between the plant and the beetle, and a synomone between the
plant and the parasitoid wasp.
(D) It acts as a kairomone between the plant and the beetle, and an allomone between the
beetle and the parasitoid wasp.
(E) It acts as a kairomone between the plant and the parasitoid wasp, as well as between the
24
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
habitat than in places with dense vegetation. Consider the following graphs showing song
characteristics of great tits from 6 locations. Which of the following statements is correct?
25
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
26
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
27
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
A41. An X-linked allele determines the coat color of cats with orange being dominant and black
being recessive. Which of the following statements regarding the inheritance pattern of
orange/black mosaic cats is correct?
(A) Half of all male cats are mosaic.
(B) The mosaic phenotype is a consequence of gene interaction.
(C) The mosaic phenotype is correlated with genomic imprinting.
(D) The mosaic phenotype results from random X-chromosomal inactivation.
(E) The offspring from matings of orange males and black females are mosaic.
Questions 42 and 43 are a problem set
A42. On a remote island, Dr. Yeh discovered a new plant species, which can produce either white
or blue flowers. This species is self fertilized or cross pollinated by insects. Genetic
experiments showed that the white-flower phenotype is recessive to the blue-flower
phenotype. Statistical analysis revealed that 91% of these plants on the island produce blue
flowers. If one is to randomly select two blue-flower plants and cross them, then what is the
approximate probability that their F1 offspring will produce white flowers?
(A) 0.09
(B) 0.21
(C) 0.42
(D) 0.49
(E) 0.91
A43. Dr. Yeh treated the seeds of the above-mentioned homozygous blue-flower plants with
chemical mutagen to produce a mutant population. Three recessive mutants, wf1, wf2, and
wf3, produced white flowers were selected. He crossed the mutants and obtained the
29
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
following results: wf1 x wf3 produced F2 offspring with only white flowers, and wf2 x wf3
produced F2 offspring with blue and white flowers in a ratio of 9:7. According to these data,
which of the statements below is NOT correct?
(A) wf1 and wf3 are unable to complement each other.
(B) wf2 and wf3 are able to complement each other.
(C) wf1 and wf3 are in the same locus.
(D) wf2 and wf3 are not in the same locus
(E) The F1 offspring from crossing wf1 and wf2 will all produce white flowers
30
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
VI. Ecology
A44. Biogeography researchers found that continental islands tend to have a species composition
similar to the mainland, but a lower degree of species differentiation comparing to oceanic
islands. If one compares the biome of an oceanic island (X) to a continental island (Y),
assuming the two have approximately the same area, and are located in the same latitudinal
range, which of the following descriptions is correct?
Proportion of endemic species
X<Y
X>Y
X>Y
X>Y
X>Y
X<Y
X<Y
X<Y
X=Y
X<Y
A45. In the figure below, A to E denote five different species in an ecosystem. Which of the
species is most likely to be a keystone species?
31
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
A46. A group of students would like to know how the discharge of waste water from a factory
might influence water quality of a river. The picture shows 7 potential sampling locations
( to ) in relation to the locations of the factory and the river. Which locations are
essential to be included in the sampling in order to draw valid conclusions about the
pollution of the river by the factory?
(A) Locations 1, 2, 4, 7
(B) Locations 1, 3, 4, 7
(C) Locations 1, 2, 5, 7
(D) Locations 2, 3, 4, 6
(E) Locations 2, 5, 6, 7
A47. Biogeography researchers have long recognized that terrestrial biomes on islands are often
associated with dispersal and colonizing ability of different organisms. Based on dispersal
and colonizing ability of the following groups of organisms, which one is least likely to
occur on an oceanic, tropical island with a large area, numerous mountains, a dense
vegetation cover, and a high level of biodiversity?
(A)
Insects
(B)
Birds
32
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
(C)
Ferns
(D)
Amphibians
(E)
Reptiles
A48. A male guppy (Poecilia reticulata) with large, bright spots on the body is more likely to
attract females, which increases his opportunity to reproduce. In the meantime, he is also
more easily detected by the natural enemy, which increases his predation risk. Consider
male guppies from three different rivers: X, Y and Z, males from X have the largest spots,
males from Y have the intermediate-sized spots, and males from Z have the smallest spots.
Which of the following descriptions about the guppies in the three rivers is correct?
The density of
(A) male guppies in X is higher than in the other rivers.
(B) male guppies in Z is higher than in the other rivers.
(C) natural enemy of guppies in X is higher than in the other rivers.
(D) natural enemy of guppies in Z is higher than the other rivers.
(E) female guppies in X is higher than the other rivers.
A49. Species M had been introduced multiple times to an ecosystem outside its native
distribution, but could not establish itself. Although no parameter in ecosystem changed
between the different attempts, the final one introduction was eventually successful, and led
to a rapid and wide-spread expansion of species M in the ecosystem. Which of the
33
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
followings is the most plausible explanation for why species M was not natively distributed
in this ecosystem?
(A) There are too many competitors of species M in the ecosystem.
(B) There are too many predators of species M in the ecosystem.
(C) Species M is not able to disperse to the ecosystem on it own.
(D) The abiotic environment in the ecosystem is not suitable for the growth of species M.
(E) The ecosystem is frequently under disturbance, which creates an unfavorable condition
for species M to sustain.
A50. A large forest is cleared. The land is rapidly colonized by species with which of the
following characteristics?
(1) long lifespan, (2) rapid reproduction, (3) fast growth, (4) strong dispersal ability, (5)
strong defense against natural enemies or predators.
(A) Only 1, 2, 3
(B) Only 1, 2, 5
(C) Only 1, 4, 5
(D) Only 2, 3, 4
(E) Only 3, 4, 5
A51. A large proportion of angiosperms are pollinated by animals. Assign the following flower
descriptions (I to V) to the most likely pollinator (a to e).
I. Flower white, open during night, intensive fragrant, nectar hidden in long, tight tubes.
II. Flower often with ultraviolet coloring pattern, open during daytime, pleasant fragrant.
III. Flower large and coarse, bright red, open during daytime, no fragrance but large
34
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
amounts of nectar
IV. Flower large and coarse, far opened, open during night, intensive fragrant, large
amounts of nectar
V. Flower reddish brown, no nectar, smell of rotten flesh
a. bats
b. birds
c. bees
d. flies
e. moths
Which of the following statement is correct?
(A) Ia, IIb, IIIc, IVe, Vd
(B) Ib, IIc, IIId, IVa, Ve
(C) Id, IIe, IIIa, IVb, Vc
(D) Ie, IIc, IIIb, IVa, Vd
(E) Ie, IId, IIIc, IVb, Va
A52. It has been demonstrated that house roaches show less threat to human health than
mosquitos in terms of serving as disease vectors. Which feature possessed by roaches given
below may explain this observation?
(A) piercing mouthpart, injecting saliva into the tissue which it feeds upon
35
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
36
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
VII. Biosystematics
[Questions 53-55] The following table shows the main characteristics of 8 different animals (taxa
1 to 8).
A + sign indicates that the animal possesses such characteristic, and a blank
Characteristic
1
Amnion
Limbs with fingers
Mammary glands
Lateral line system
+
+
Cycloid scales
Sternum
Semicircle canals
+
+
+
+
+
+
Please answer questions A53 to 55using the information in the table above.
A53. Which of the following taxa most likely belongs to the same Class as Taxon 4?
(A) Taxon 1
(B) Taxon 2
(C) Taxon 3
(D) Taxon 5
(E) Taxon 6
37
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
Animal A
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Animal B
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Animal C
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
Animal D
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0
38
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
If relationship among organisms can be inferred from the degree of similarity, and the degree
of similarity is defined as a coefficient S:
39
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
A58. A scientist unearthed four plant fossils (I to IV) with some prominent structures intact.
These are listed in the following table:
Structure
Spore
Ovary
Embryo
Pollen
Xylem
Ovule
Fossil #
I
II
III
IV
According to this table, which sequence below correctly represents the order of evolution of
these plants?
(A) IIIIIIIV
(B) IIIIIIVI
(C) IIIIVIII
(D) IVIIIIII
(E) IIIIVIII
(F) IIIIIVII
40
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
Student Code:
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
Dear participants,
Check your Student Code on the Answer Sheet before starting the test.
The questions in Part B may have more than one correct answer. Fill your answers in the
Answer Sheet. The marks, numbers, or characters to answer questions in Part B vary
depending on questions. Mark the correct answers with and incorrect answers with
on the Answer Sheet clearly, as shown below.
No.
B0.
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Some of the questions may be marked DELETED. DO NOT answer these questions.
All answers must be correct in each question. Then you will get the points.
Stop answering and put down your pencil IMMEDIATELY after the end bell rings.
:
Good Luck!!
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
I. Cell biology
Problem set: Figure 1 depicts the cross-section of a certain cell surface structure observed by
electron microscope. Answer questions 1 and 2.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
(B) Locomotion
(C) Transportation
(D) Secretion
(E) Absorption
Composition options:
(P) Cellulose
(Q) Protein
(R) Mucin
(S) Lipid
(T) Nucleic acid
B3. Some pathogens produce exotoxins that can cause human diseases. One type of exotoxins
consists of two polypeptides, subunits A and B. Subunit B can bind to surface receptors on
the target cells and cause the transport of the subunit A or associated molecules across the
plasma membrane into the cell. Once the subunit A enters the cell, it inhibits protein
synthesis and destroys the cells. Which of the following statements regarding exotoxins is/are
correct?
(A) Subunit A alone can cause disease.
(B) Subunit B alone can bind to target cells.
(C) Subunit A may carry other molecules to kill target cells.
4
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
(D) Subunit B may carry other molecules and assist these molecules to enter target cells.
(E) When conjugated with an antibody against breast cancer cells, subunit A can kill breast
cancer cells.
Problem set: Some leucocytes can ingest invaded pathogens by phagocytosis. Digestive enzymes
that kill pathogens only function in acidic conditions. Please answer questions 4 and 5.
B4. Based on the information provided in the following table, complete the synthesis process of
digestive enzymes during phagocytosis:
Replication
Endoplasmic reticulum
Translation
Vesicle
Transcription
Lysosome
Mitochondrion
Golgi apparatus
and
to continue
for modification.
(A) a:
b:
c:
d:
e:
(B)
a:
b:
c:
d:
e:
(C) a:
b:
c:
d:
e:
(D) a:
b:
c:
d:
e:
(E) a:
b:
c:
d:
e:
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B5. Tom isolated phagocytes from a blood sample. He cultured these phagocytes in a test tube for
a period of time. To observe phagocytosis, E. coli was co-cultured with phagocytes. What
will be the consequence if an antacid is added to the culture?
(A) Phagocytes can ingest and kill E. coli.
(B) Ingestion of E. coli by phagocytes is inhibited.
(C) E. coli is viable in phagolysosome.
(D) If phagolysosomes are formed, the digestive enzymes in them are inactive.
(E) Phagocytes can secrete ingested debris out of the cells.
Problem set: Jessica is dissecting a signal transduction pathway (depicted in the following figure)
that leads to oncogenesis in cancer cells, in the hope that she can find inhibitors to block the
signaling pathway and use them as chemotherapy drugs for cancer treatment. Please answer
questions B6-B8.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B6. Components of signal transduction, including A, B and C, usually are activated through
phosphorylation or dephosphorylation reactions. What are the mechanisms by which
proteins A , B and C are phosphorylated or dephosphorylated?
(A) Receptors may contain enzyme domains which can catalyse
phosphorylation/dephosphorylation reactions.
(B) Enzymes that participate in phosphorylation/dephosphorylation reactions may exist in
the cytoplasm.
(C) Proteins A, B and C may contain enzyme domains which can catalyse
phosphorylation/dephosphorylation reactions.
(D) Phosphorylation or dephosphorylation may not be mediated through enzymatic
reactions.
(E) A phosphate group is transferred from the receptor to protein A.
(F) The phosphate group can only be provided by H3PO4.
B7. Which of the following experiment can prove that the signal transduction pathway is BC,
but not CB?
(A) Adding an A antagonist will activate B.
(B) Adding an A agonist will activate C.
(C) Adding a B agonist will activate C.
(D) Adding a B antagonist will activate C.
7
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
(E) Increasing the expression level of B will generate more active C molecules.
(F) Cell response can be observed when B antagonist and active C molecules are added to
the cell.
B8. If this is a highly activated signal transduction pathway in cancer cells, which of the
following processes does the signaling pathway involve?
(A) Inhibiting cell division
(B) Inhibiting cell differentiation
(C) Hypomethylation of some tumor suppressor genes
(D) Activating the transcription of an oncogene
(E) Arresting the cell cycle at S phase
(F) Inhibiting the expression of some DNA repair genes
B9. In protein synthesis, there are 64 codons, 61 codons specify the 20 amino acids and the other
3 for termination STOP (Table). The following sequence of amino acids occurred in the
structure of a polypeptide found in a wild-type organism:
Ser-Arg-Ile-Leu-Ala-Ala-Lys-Tyr. Which of the following may generate the mutant amino
acid sequence Ser-Arg-Ile-Trp-Arg-Gln-Lys-Tyr?
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
10
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B11. Mary divided 30 pots of plant X of similar condition into 10 plants per group, with each
group being treated with different types of light regime. After a month, the flowering
phenotypes of each group are shown in the table below:
Treatment
Light regime
Flowering result
(I)
12 hr
12 hr
(II)
14 hr
10 hr
(III)
16 hr
8 hr
Light
Darkness
According to the information above, which of the following descriptions of plant X are
correct?
(A) Plant X is a short day plant
(B) The critical dark-length required by plant X for flowering is less than 10 hours
(C) If group III is given an one-minute dark treatment in the middle of the light period,
after one month, most plants in this group will flower
(D) If group II is given an one-minute red light treatment in the middle of the dark period,
most plants in this group will not flower right after one month
(E) If the apical buds of group I plants are removed before giving the light regime treatment,
then most plants will not produce florigen required for flowering after giving light
regime treatment.
11
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B12. Which of the following pathways potentially depicts the relationship of Phototropin 1 and
Phototropin 2 on a molecular level?
12
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B13. Which of the following processes could be regulated and/or mediated by Phototropin 1 and
2?
(A). K+ ion efflux
B14. Phytochromes exist in two isoforms, Pr and Pfr. In darkness, they are synthesized as Pr form,
then turned into Pfr form after absorbing red light (most effective at 666 nm). When
irradiated with far red light, Pfr transforms back to Pr. According to the description above,
which of the following are likely to be the absorption spectra of phytochrome?
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(E)
13
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
functional AG would produce flowers with only sepals and petals. A scientist generated a
transgenic plant harboring a green fluorescence protein (GFP) gene driven by the AG
promoter in a wild type background that produces normal flowers. In which of the
following flower parts, you are likely to observe strong GFP fluorescent signals?
(A) Receptacle
(B) Sepal
(C) Petal
(D) Stamen
(E) Carpel
14
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
15
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B17. During evolution, the gas exchange in gills has become more effective by
(A) A decrease in the thickness of the structure C
(B) A decrease in the number of cell layers in structure C
(C) An increase in the metabolic rate of the structure C
(D) An increase in the cell volume of the structure C
(E) An increase in the surface area of the structure C
B18. Scientists found a kind of epithelial cell (X cell) in the structure of D with which fish can
maintain body fluid osmolarity. Consequently, X cells are supposed to
(A) Absorb salt actively in freshwater fish
(B) Excrete salt actively in seawater fish
(C) Excrete water actively in freshwater fish
(D) Absorb water actively in seawater fish
(E) be rich in mitochondria
16
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B19. The following image represents a gastric fold from the interior surface of the stomach. The different
structures are indicated by roman numerals:
Structure code (I ~ V)
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
17
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B20. The graph below depicts the different pulmonary volumes and capacities:
Below, you will find two charts, please correlate with each other and with the graph above:
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
II
III
IV
VI
VII
VIII
Letter
Number
B21. Which of the following statements about thermo-adaption in animals are correct?
(A) Blue-fin tuna is able to raise their core temperature. Therefore, it is an endothermic
animal.
(B) Some icefish are able to survive in the freezing ice-laden water and maintain a very
stable body temperature. Therefore, icefish are homeothermic animals.
(C) Shivering can help mammals to generate heat, and it is regulated by hypothalamus in
mammals.
(D) Brown adipose tissues help mammals to generate heat by supplying energy to skeletal
muscles.
(E) Brown adipose cells are rich in mitochondria for heat generation.
19
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B22. Maintenance of the blood glucose level is important for normal physiological function. It is
modulated by both neural and endocrine systems. The diagram below shows two different
situations resulting from physiological stress or low blood glucose level. Complete the table
in the answer sheet by using appropriate letters shown below.
Structure/hormone
Answer
20
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
21
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
Structure/hormone
Answer
Sertoli cells
Anterior pituitary
Gonadotropin
releasing hormone
FSH
Inhibin
B24. The application of available and suitable hormonal therapy to the male patients with gonad
failure is very important. Consider how the following case may be improved by a hormonal
treatment.
Patient A suffered from testicular cancer and had both testis removed.
According to the figure of Q22, select the most appropriate letter to patient A.
Patient
Answer
22
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
A.
Release of neurotransmitter.
B.
C.
D.
Re-uptake of neurotransmitter.
E.
Degradation of neurotransmitter.
Mechanism
Figure number
Blocking of step A
Facilitation of step B
Blocking of step C
Facilitation of step D
Blocking of step E
(I)
(IV)
23
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
(II)
(V)
(III)
B26. Epilepsy is a common neurological condition. Patients suffer convulsions which result from
hyperactivity of certain cerebral areas. Symptoms can be reduced by using antiepileptic drugs. If
the receptor activated in the above figure was a chloride channel instead of a sodium channel,
which of the following mechanism(s) may form the basis for an antiepileptic drug?
24
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
Mechanism
Answer
Blocking of step A
Facilitation of step B
Blocking of step C
Facilitation of step D
Blocking of step E
Choose and fill in the appropriate answering code shown below to each statement in the
following table. The statements are about a muscle fiber undergoing an isotonic contraction.
Statement
Answer
25
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
IV. Ethology
B28. There are two types of bird hatchlings: precocial and altricial. In general, precocial birds are
covered with feathers when they hatch, and can find their own food with help and
instructions from their mothers. In contrast, altricial hatchlings require feeding and caring
for from the parents. Based on this, which of the following statements are correct?
(A) Precocial hatchlings usually take longer to hatch than altricial hatchlings.
(B) Altricial hatchlings usually develop imprinting earlier than precocial hatchlings.
(C) Parents invest more in precocial hatchlings than in altricial hatchlings during nestling
period.
(D) For a group of young birds that hatch at the same time, altricial hatchlings tend to
develop the ability to fly earlier than precocial hatchlings.
(E) Parents of precocial and altricial hatchlings have the same level of investment in
reproduction during the breeding season.
B29. An entomologist found that a species of cockroach use the dramatic change of light intensity
at dusk (given as 6:00 pm) to reset its biological clock. He also found out that the circadian
(daily) rhythm is 25 hrs. If a student cages a cockroach of this species into a dark box at
6:00 pm, at what time the cockroach will be active after 12 days? Fill in the time in the
given space, then circle am or pm in the Answer Sheet.
B30. A biologist discovered that a species of moth is capable of flying in a straight line at night
because it keeps a constant angle (80) between its body axis and the direction of moon light
26
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
using photoreceptors as a tool. If the moth encounters a bright light in a dark night, what
kind of flight path of the moth one will expect to see in relation with the light source?
(A)
(D)
(B)
(E)
(C)
B31. A researcher monitored 10 pairs of adult birds during the breeding season. For each of the
pairs, he recorded body lengths of the male and female, and their nesting date (Table 1).
Table 1. The body lengths of the males and females, and the nesting dates for the 10 pairs of
birds (A to J)
Female
body length
(cm)
Male body
length (cm)
Nesting
date
A
26.4
B
27.8
C
25.1
D
25.0
E
27.0
F
28.1
G
25.5
H
25.9
I
28.3
J
27.4
28.3
28.4
28.9
29.0
27.9
30.2
29.6
27.4
29.7
30.5
5/6
5/3
5/4
4/28
5/1
4/27
4/29
5/2
5/1
4/26
27
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
Based on the data in Table 1, the mean body length is 26.65 cm for the females, and 28.99 cm
for the males. In comparison with the mean body length of 26.10 cm in females and 27.60 cm
in males in the total adult ( breeders + non-breeders) population (N=30) of the study area,
which of the following statements are correct?
(A) All males in this species are larger than females.
(B) Females tend to pair with males that are larger than themselves.
(C) Male body lengths do not affect female mate choices.
(D) Nesting dates are linked to male body lengths.
(E) The chance of breeding of this species is most likely affected by the body size.
28
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
29
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B33. Fur of Guinea pigs can have different colors (black and white).
Hairs can be rough and smooth. Alleles Q and q are coding for
color, alleles R and r for type of hair. A number of cavias with
exactly the same genotype (parents group) are allowed to mate and the result is a big F1
offspring. Most of these have a black rough fur. A small number has white smooth fur.
Besides about the same number of offspring is white and rough, or black and smooth.
B33.1. Using the given letters, indicate the genotype of the guinea pigs in the parents
group:
B33.2.
If
1024
smooth?
.
F1
offspring
were
born,
how
many
of
them
are
black
and
B33.3. Guinea pigs often have a fur spot pattern. According to a simplified model spot pattern is
determined by one gene with two alleles: G and g. If G is present the guinea pig is spotted.
Students investigate the population Guinea pigs in a territory and find out that 84 % was
spotted. Presuming this population is in (Hardy Weinberg) equilibrium. Calculate the
frequency of G. Give your answer in one decimal.
B33.4. At one day all unspotted guinea pigs are caught and transported to another territory. What
will be the number of unspotted guinea pigs in the next generation? Give your answer as a
percentage without decimals.
30
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B34. It is believed that land plants are evolved from charophytes. Which of the following
statements support this hypothesis?
(A) Both have alternation of generation in life cycles
(B) Both contain chlorophyll a and chlorophyll b
(C) Both have peroxisomes that contain photorespiration related enzymes
(D) Both can form phragmoplasts during cytokinesis
(E) Both contain cellulosic cell walls
(F) Both have the cellulose synthase arranged on the plasma membrane in a rosette pattern
31
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
primer
primer
primer
(A) The mRNA level of LFT in the mutant is the same as that in the wild-type at the same
developmental stage
(B) The LFT protein found in the wild type plants cannot be detected or is lower in the mutant
32
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
(C) The DNA methylation patterns on LFT are altered in the mutant
(D) The levels of histone proteins are dramatically altered in the mutant
(E) Introducing the cloned LFTm into the wild-type plant generates a transgenic plant with
late flowering phenotype
33
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
VI. Ecology
B37. The population size of a dragonfly in a pond was estimated to be 50,000 during a survey.
Their sex ratio is 1:1. Each female lays approximately 400 eggs. A second survey of the
next generation revealed that the population size is still 50,000 and the sex ratio is still 1:1.
What is the average survival rate (surviving to adult stage) of the eggs?
(A) 0.2%
(B) 0.25%
(C) 0.5%
(D) 1%
(E) 5%
B38. Biologists found that the threshold temperature for development of a mosquito species is
15. They also found that the product of (1) the number of days it takes to complete
development, and (2) the difference between the temperature during development and
threshold temperature, is a constant. That is, the result of multiplying (1) and (2) is a
constant. It is known that this mosquito requires 15 days to complete development at 30,
and given that there was an unusually warm May in India this year with an average
temperature of 40, how many days it should take this mosquito to complete development
this May in India?
B39. Assuming human, birds, and fish respectively have Type I, II, and III survival curves (the
34
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
vertical axis is survival rate, and horizontal axis is time), which of the following figures
most accurately describes mortality curves (obtained by replacing survival rate with
mortality rate) for these three groups of organisms (Type I, II and III)?
35
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B40. The figure below shows a nutrient cycle, and the six groups of organisms (A to F) involved
in this cycle.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B41. When comparing closely-related bird species, mortality of breeding individuals appears to
be higher for species in temperate regions than in tropical regions. Therefore, predation
risks to parents themselves, their young and eggs are given different priorities for species in
different regions. In an experiment where specimen of three different predators (crows,
owls, and hawks) were placed at close distances to the nests during the day in the breeding
period, which of the following responses from the parents can be expected? Note that crows
are predators of the young and eggs, owls are nocturnal predators, and hawks are diurnal
predators of adult birds.
(A) The owl specimen is more strongly avoided by the parents than the hawk specimen.
(B) With the crow specimen, the parents of tropical species reduce the frequency of
returning to the nests and feeding the young to a lesser degree than parents of temperate
species.
(C) With the hawk specimen, the parents of tropical species reduce the frequency of
returning to the nests and feeding the young to a lesser degree than parents of
temperature species.
(D) With the hawk specimen, the parents of tropical species reduce the frequency of
returning to the nests and feeding the young to a greater degree than parents of
temperature species.
(E) The degree to which the parents reduce their frequency of returning to the nests and
feeding the young when predator specimen is present is not affected by the type of
predators or the latitudes in which the species is distributed.
37
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B42. The figure below shows a scheme of the assimilation efficiency (A/I) and production
efficiency (P/A) of two groups of mammals in a meadow ecosystem.
Suppose I = 100 J
Which of the following descriptions are correct?
(A) Digestion of plant materials costs relatively less energy than digestion of animal
materials.
(B) Plant materials that are reabsorbed have less organic contents than animal materials that
are reabsorbed.
(C) R ranges between 40 and 60 J in carnivores.
38
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
(A) Seedlings with mycorrhizae grow more rapidly than seedlings without mycorrhizae in
low-phosphorus soils.
(B) Hyphae of arbuscular mycorrhizae can penetrate the cortical cells of the roots and cell
membranes to form symbiotic associations intracellularly.
(C) Hyphae of ectomycorrhizae can penetrate the cortical cells of the roots, and form hyphal
sheaths around the roots.
(D) Mycorrhizae have similar functions as root hairs of plants, and therefore, plants with
mycorrhizae have less-developed root hairs.
(E) Each mycorrhiza forms symbiotic associations with the roots of specific plants.
39
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
VII. Biosystematics
B44. Eggleton et al (2007) studied the phylogeny of Dictyoptera, as shown below. According to
the proposed phylogeny, determine whether the following statements are true (T) or false (F).
40
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
B45a. Systematic positions of some butterflies such as satyrids (ringlets, etc.), nymphalids (frush
foots, etc), danaids (milkweed butterflies, etc.) were controversial. Some researchers
regarded them as distinct families, the others disagreed. Recent studies supported the view
to pool them into a single family. Below is a phylogeny of these butterflies reconstructed
by Freitas & Brown (2004). Answer the following questions based on this phylogeny.
Determine whether the following statements are true (T) or false (F).
(A) Danaid butterflies may still be a distinct family according to Freitas & Browns
phylogeny.
(B) Although Calinaginae butterflies resemble danaid butterflies in appearance, they should
be classified as Nymphaloid butterflies.
41
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
(C) Satyrinae and Brassolinae were considered distinct families, but Apaturinae was always
placed in Nymphalidae. If we want to keep Apaturinae in Nymphalidae, both Satyrinae
and Brassolinae should be lumped into Nymphalidae.
(D) Danaid butterflies may be considered as the ancestors of Nymphaloid + Satyroid.
B45b. According to the phylogeny diagram above, fill in the blanks.
If Libytheinae is treated as the outgroup on the phylogeny, and 5 major groups (clades) are
recognized for the ingroup. The maximum number of lineages of such a major group shown
on THE PHYLOGENY is
42
(B)___.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Student Code:
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Dear Participants,
Check your Student Code on the Answer Sheet before starting the test.
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed items is
missing, raise your sign.
You should organize your work efficiently but ensure that you complete Task II early
enough to obtain the spectrophotometer readings to answer the questions that follow.
After test, enclose the Answer sheets, Question paper, and Data printout in the provided
envelope. Our lab assistants will collect it promptly.
Good Luck!!
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Shared instruments:
Camera, spectrophotometer, printer
Quantity
1 Power supply
1 each
5 Wire test tube rack with 15-mL centrifuge tubes (6) (yellow cap)
1 each
9 Timer
10 96-well microplate
1 each
1 each
16 Tissue paper
17
Mini centrifuge (if you need to spin down the samples in the
microcentrifuge tubes)
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Materials:
Quantity
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
injecting slowly the sample will sink to the bottom of the well by gravity (Figure 1).
2. If you need to practice, use the P20 micropipette with tip to withdraw 10 L of loading dye
from microcentrifuge tube L (pink tube with orange label) on rack. Load the dye into wells 1 to
3 or 7 to 10.
3. Each of the microcentrifuge tubes M, U1 and U2 (pink tube with orange label) contains 15 L
of protein molecular weight marker, unknown protein U1 and unknown protein U2, respectively.
Use micropipette P20 to withdraw 10 L solution from each tube and load the samples into
wells 4 to 6 as shown in Figure 1.
4. As soon as you finish sample loading, Lift the sign, lab assistants will connect the power cord
to power supply and set the voltage to 200 V for you. The gel will run for 25 minutes. The
timer will be set up by an assistant to countdown.
5. After finishing electrophoresis, Lift the sign, lab assistants will disassemble the electrophoresis
set-up and give back your gel. Wipe clean the surface of the gel with tissue papers and label the
gel with your Student Code sticker. Lab assistants will take the photo of your gel. Put the
photo on the answer sheet using double-sticker (5 points).
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Figure 1
Answer the following questions:
Q.1.1. (2 points) Figure 2 shows a photograph of a SDS-PAGE gel. The electrophoresis start point
and dye-front are indicated. Which side of the gel should be connected to the anode (+ charge) of
the power supply? Mark your answer (X) on the answer sheet.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Figure 2
Q.1.2. (8 points) Based on the information provided in Figure 2, plot the molecular weight of the
five marker proteins versus their relative migration-Rf values on the graph paper provided (4
points). Use the graph to estimate the molecular weights of unknown proteins on lanes A and B (4
Q.1.3. (5 points) A protein complex of molecular weight 246 kDa is composed of multiple
subunits bound by non-covalent interaction. Two protein bands of 57 and 33 kDa were identified
after SDS-PAGE. How many 57-kDa and 33-kDa subunits, respectively, are included in the
8
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Q.1.4. (5 points) The average molecular weight of amino acid residues is about 110 daltons. How
many amino acids are there in the 33-kDa protein subunit? How many nucleotides of RNA are
translated into the protein? Write down your answers on the answer sheet.
Q.1.5. (5 points) Suppose the average molecular weight of nucleotides is 330 daltons. Excluding
introns and the stop codon, what is the mass ratio of dsDNA that encodes the 33-kDa protein, to
the 33-kDa protein? Write down your answer on the answer sheet.
Q.1.6. (5 points) Suppose a protein P can bind to a protein Q (MW = 1000 daltons). The binding
can be revealed by gel-mobility shift assay. 200 pmol of protein P were mixed with various
amounts (0 to 500 ng) of protein Q. These mixtures were resolved by 10% (w/v) polyacrylamide
gel. The gel was stained by Coomassie blue and is shown in Figure 3. Calculate the binding
molar ratio of proteins P and Q. Write down your answer on the answer sheet.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Figure 3
10
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
2. Add 200 L of CBG reagent per well in A1 to A6 and B1 to B6. Mix and observe the color
11
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
change.
3. To determine the two concentrations X and Y of enzyme E, add various amounts (2, 4, 6, 8 and
10 L) of enzyme E (green color) in duplicate to empty wells and bring up the volume to 10
L with H2O.
4. Add 200 L of CBG reagent per well to the diluted enzyme E. Mix and observe the color
change.
5. Lift the sign, lab assistants will accompany you to measure the absorbance values of your
samples at 595 nm using spectrophotometer. Put your Student Code on the print-out data
with marker pen.
6. Return to your work bench, and put the result on the answer sheet using double-sticker.
Table 1
Well of a microplate
Materials
A1 & B1
A2 & B2
A3 & B3
A4 & B4
A5 & B5
A6 & B6
10
H2O (L)
10
Diluted BSA
concentration (mg/mL)
12
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 4
13
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
14
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
15
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Figure 5
16
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
In the problem set, you will perform the following experiment (5 points):
1. Label six 15-mL centrifuge tubes (yellow cap) a1 to a3 and b1 to b3 accordingly, with a
marker pen.
2. Take the anion chromatography column (Figure 6A), un-plug the tube and allow the solution
to be drained by gravity. Plug the tube intermediately when the liquid surface reaches the top
of the disc (Figure 6A, white arrow). Do not over-dry the gel as it may affect protein
purification.
3. Withdraw 200 L of protein solution from microcentrifuge tube C (blue tube with blue label)
using a P200 micropipette, and apply the sample to the chromatography column slowly by
touching the filled pipette tip lightly against the inside wall of the tube (Figure 6B).
4. Un-plug the column and allow the protein sample buffer to drain out, then transfer the column
to centrifuge tube a1 (yellow cap). Withdraw 3 mL of anion buffer A (blue cap) with a plastic
dropper and apply the solution to the gel by touching the pipette tip against the wall of the
tube (Figure 6C).
5. Collect ~1 mL eluent in centrifuge tubes a1 to a3 (yellow cap) sequentially. It takes about 2
to 3 minutes for each tube.
6. Allow the contents of the column to drain entirely out then transfer the column to centrifuge
tube b1 (yellow cap). Withdraw 3 mL of anion buffer B (blue cap) with a plastic dropper and
17
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
apply the solution to gel by touching pipette tip against the wall of the tube (Figure 6C).
7. Collect ~1 mL eluent in centrifuge tubes b1 to b3 (yellow cap) sequentially. It takes about 2 to
3 minutes for each tube.
8. Withdraw 50 L of eluent from tubes a1 to a3 & b1 to b3 (yellow cap) and transfer to
centrifuge tubes A1 to A3 & B1 to B3 (red cap), respectively. Mix and observe color change.
The CBG reagent (see introduction in Task II) in tubes A1 to A3 & B1 to B3 will turn blue
when it reacts with the eluted protein.
9. After finishing all the experiments, Lift the sign, lab assistants will take a photo of your
experiment results and put a stamp mark on your answer sheet. Without a stamp mark you
will not be evaluated for Q3.1.1 AND Q3.1.2
Figure 6
18
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Q.3.1. (7 points) Mark the deepest color change (X) on the answer sheet (Q.3.1.1. 5 points).
Which of the following buffers (buffer A or buffer B) can be used to elute the protein? Mark your
answer (X) on the answer sheet (Q.3.1.2. 2 points).
Q.3.2. (5 points) Enzyme A is a protein whose surface is evenly distributed with electric charges.
If enzyme A can be eluted from anionic exchange chromatography by a high concentration of
anionic buffer, what is the property of enzyme A with respect to electric charge? Mark (X) the
answer on the answer sheet.
(A) High negative net charges
(B) Low negative net charges
(C) Zero net charge
(D) Low positive net charges
(E) High positive net charges
19
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Q.3.3. (4 points) Amino acids differ in the chemical nature of the R group (side chain). Figure 7
shows four amino acids A, B, C, and D in their prevailing ionic forms at pH 7.2, with the side
chain marked in a white box. Which of the following amino acids in Figure 7 would be present
more frequently on enzyme A? Write down your answer (X) on the answer sheet.
Figure 7
Q.3.4. (5 points) Hydrophobic interaction chromatography can be used to separate proteins
based on their hydrophobicity. To perform the chromatography, protein samples were first treated
with buffer containing a high concentration of salts such as ammonium sulfate (NH4)2SO4, which
will remove water molecules from the protein surface. This causes the hydrophobic area on the
surface of the protein to be exposed. When the salt-treated proteins are subjected to
chromatography, they will be adsorbed on the stationary phase through hydrophobic interactions.
The higher the hydrophobicity of the protein, the stronger the adsorption. As salt concentration
can affect the hydrophobic interaction between the protein and the stationary phase, different
proteins can be separately eluted by using different concentrations of salt-containing buffers. If
enzyme A is highly hydrophobic, which of the following buffers should be used to separate
20
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
enzyme A from other proteins by chromatography? Mark (X) the answer on the answer sheet.
(A) Low-salt buffer
(B) High-salt buffer
(C) Buffer without salt
(D) Low-salt buffer first then high-salt buffer
(E) High-salt buffer first then low-salt buffer
Q.3.5. (4 points) If enzyme A is highly hydrophobic, which of the amino acids in Figure 7
would be present more frequently on enzyme A? Mark (X) the answer on the answer sheet.
Q.3.6. (5 points) Gel filtration chromatography separates proteins based on their sizes. The gel,
or stationary phase, consists of cross-linked polymer beads with engineered pores of a particular
size. Small proteins enter the pores and move slowly through a complex path. Large proteins
cannot enter the pores and so take a short path through the column, around the beads. Table 2 is
a list of gels and their fractionation ranges. Suppose both enzyme A (22 kDa) and protein B (44
kDa) are single-subunit proteins. Which gel is best suited for the task of purifying enzyme A
from a mixture containing enzyme A and protein B, using gel filtration chromatography. Mark
your answer (X) on the answer sheet.
21
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Table 2
Types of stationary phase
G-10
<700
G-15
<1500
G-25
1,000-6,000
G-50
1,500-30,000
G-75
3,000-70,000
G-100
4,000-150,000
G-150
5,000-400,000
G-200
5,000-800,000
Q.3.7. (5 points) Assume that the concentration of total proteins in the original solution is 1
mg/mL and the activity of enzyme A is 0.5 units in 1 mL protein sample. The concentration of
total proteins after purification is 0.1 mg/mL and the activity of enzyme A is 1 unit in 1 mL
protein sample. Calculate the purification factor (number of times purified) of enzyme A. Write
down your answer on the answer sheet.
22
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
PRACTICAL TEST 1
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER KEY
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.1.1. (2 points)
Start point
Dye-front
Anode (+ charge)
X
Q.1.2. (4+4 points)
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Protein
STUDENT CODE:
Lane A
Lane B
56 (53-59)
72 (68-76)
Molecular weight
(kDa)
Q.1.3. (5 points)
Number
57 kDa
33 kDa
Q.1.4. (5 points)
Number
Amino acid
Nucleotide
300
900
Q.1.5. (5 points)
DNA
18 :
Protein
Q.1.6. (5 points)
P
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
BSA
X
Y
Q.2.1.1. (5 points)
Well of a microplate
Materials
A1 & B1
A2 & B2
A3 & B3
A4 & B4
A5 & B5
A6 & B6
10
H2O (L)
10
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
Diluted BSA
concentration (mg/mL)
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
Solution Y
10
10
H2O (L)
0.859
0.452
out of range
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.2.3. (8 points)
Concentration of X
Concentration of Y
(mg/mL)
(mg/mL)
2.0
0.26
(1.6-2.4)
(0.21-0.31)
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.3.1.1. (5 points)
Tube
A1
A2
A3
B1
Color
change
Q.3.1.2. (2 points)
Buffer
Q.3.2. (5 points)
Q.3.3. (4 points)
B2
B3
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.3.4. (5 points)
Q.3.5. (4 points)
Q.3.6. (5 points)
G-10
G-15
G-25
G-50
G-75
Q.3.7. (5 points)
20
G-100
G-150
G-200
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Student Code:
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Dear Participants,
Check your Student Code on the Answer Sheet before starting the test.
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed items is
Good Luck!!
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Quantity
unit
Bullfrog specimen
piece
Dissecting tray
piece
piece
500
mL
10
pieces
pieces
set
Wet paper
set
Gloves
pair
1
1
pair
pair
pairs
fine forceps
For task II: The observation of tissue morphology and the match of their functionality
Instruments/materials
Quantity
unit
Microscope
set
10
slides
set
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Region
Switch
OFF ON
Spinal Nerve IX
of
Spinal Nerve X
stimulation
Sciatic Nerve
Red LED
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Q.1.1. (9 points) When you have finished the above five steps, raise the sign to notify the Lab
assistant to videotape the contraction.
Step 6 to 10: (To keep the tissues wet, a small amount of Ringers solution may be added
onto the tissues at any time)
6. Use a pair of scissors to make a circular cut through the skin spanning the circumference of
the upper part of one thigh of the bullfrog. Starting from the cutting point, completely peel off
the skin by hand to remove it from the hind limb (Fig. 4) It may be necessary to cut some
connections between the skin and underlying tissue.
7. Lay the bullfrog on the dissecting tray with its back facing up.
8. Push two pins separately into both ends of the gastrocnemius and separate it from the
tibiofibular (shinbone) (Fig. 5).
9. The sciatic nerve is located in a trough surrounded by thigh muscles. Carefully separate the
muscles on both sides of the trough and to expose the pale yellow colored sciatic nerve.
Pass a cotton thread underneath the sciatic nerve to label it.
10. Stimulate the cotton thread-labeled sciatic nerve with the provided electric stimulating device
and observe the contracting response of the gastrocnemius.
Cotton
thread
Skin
Pin
Sciatic nerve
Gastrocnemius
Fig. 4. Demonstration of skin peeling
Q.1.2. (8 points) When you have finished steps 6 to 10, raise the sign to notify the Lab assistant
to videotape the contraction.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Step 11 to 12: (To keep the tissues wet, a small amount of Ringers solution may be added
onto the tissues at anytime)
11. Completely separate and isolate the INTACT sciatic nerve gastrocnemius muscle
preparation from the bullfrog specimen and place it in a petri dish, as shown in Fig. 6. (The
sciatic nerve must be at least 2cm long).
12. Stimulate the sciatic nerve with the electric stimulating device and observe the contraction
response of the gastrocnemius.
Tendon (A)
Gastrocnemius
Sciatic nerve-gastrocnemius connection (B)
Sciatic nerve
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
2. Artery
3. Ganglion
4. Neuron
5. Blood ( frog )
10. Skeletal
muscle
7. Ovary
8. Testis
9. Lung
12. Cardiac
muscle
13. Kidney
14. Cartilage
15. Bone
17. Intestine
18. Gastric
tissue
19. Skin
20. Rectum
Q.2.1. (30 points) Match each slide specimen (A to J) with its correct name from the 20 different
tissue/organ names listed in table above. (Note: there is ONLY one correct answer for each
specimen). Fill in the correct number in the answer sheets.
Identify the photographed tissue sections and match their correct functions (12 points)
Fig. 1-9 are enlarged pictures of tissue sections of different mammalian tissues. Based on their
structural features, identify the tissue and answer the questions below.
The functions of 11 organs are listed in the following table. Each specific function is assigned an
alphabetic letter (A to K).
Symbol Functional description
A
Producing vitamin D3
Producing erythropoietin
Producing urea
Helping vein compression and promoting blood flow back to the heart
Digesting proteins
Secreting secretin
Producing inhibin
Producing progesterone
7
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Q.2.2. (13 points) Correctly write down the functional symbols, i.e. the alphabetic letters (A
to K), on the answer sheets. Match the organ with their functionalities. Note: some organs may
have more than one function (1 point will be deducted for each incorrect answer and the
minimum score will not be less than zero).
Fig 1.
Fig 2.
Fig 3.
Fig 4.
Fig 5.
Fig 6.
Fig 7.
(200 x)
Fig 8.
Fig 9.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER KEY
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.1.1. (9 points) When you have finished the above five steps, raise the sign to notify
the Lab assistant to videotape the contraction.
Points
0 or 9
Lab assistant
signature
Q.1.2. (8 points) When you have finished the steps 6 to 10, raise the sign to notify the
Lab assistant to videotape the contraction.
Points
Gastrocnemius contraction
0 or 4
Lab assistant
signature
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.1.3. (40 points) When you have finished the steps 11-12, write down the results of
your observation on the answer sheets. And, raise the sign to notify the Lab assistant
for checking the results and videotape the contraction.
Lab assistant
Points
signature
0 or 15
and B parts)
Contraction of the isolated
sciatic nerve-gastrocnemius
0 or 10
tissue.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.2.1. (30 points) Match each slide specimen (A to J) with its correct name from 20
different tissue/organ names listed in above table. (Note: only one correct answer for
each specimen). Fill in the correct number in the answer sheets.
Answers3 points each
Slide specimen
A.
B.
C.
15
D.
10
E.
14
F.
11
G.
18
H.
I.
12
J.
17
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
Q.2.2. (13 points) Correctly write down the functional symbols, i.e. the alphabetic
letters (A to K), on the answer sheets.
Note: some organs may have more than one function (1 point will be deducted for
each incorrect answer, minimum score will not be less than zero).
Figure
Functional symbol
1.
B,E
2.
3.
4.
D,E
5.
6.
I, K
7.
8.
G,H
9.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Student Code:
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
Dear Participants,
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Task I: Reconstruct the phylogenetic tree for the given spiders (60 points)
Task II: Test of species association in a community (40 points)
Check your Student Code on the Answer Sheet before starting the test.
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed
Stop answering and put down your pen immediately after the end bell rings.
After test, our lab assistants will check the condition of the spiders and fill out the spider checklist at
the end of your answer sheet. Each undamaged spider in the original vial will get you one bonus
point. Please put down student code and sign after the check is done.
Enclose both the Answer Sheets and Question Paper in the provided envelope after the spider
check is finished. Our Lab Assistant will collect it promptly.
Good Luck!!
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
pictures:
4
1
Petri dish
70% ethanol
Plastic dropper
1-m quadrat cardboard (represented by a small cardboard in a zip
lock bag)
Materials:
1 Four spider samples in glass vials (W, X, Y, Z)
2
1
1
1
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
cervical
B
Figure 1-1 External morphology of spider. A. Dorsal view. B. Ventral view.
4
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
B. Close or in contact.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Figure 1-11 Tibia and metatarsus of legs I and II have a series of long spines interspersed with
much shorter setae. A. Absent. B. Present.
Figure 1-12 Double-rowed trichobothria on femora IV. A. Absent. B. Present.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
characters with the aid of figures 1-1 to 1-12 and identify all spiders using the key.
7
(Caution!
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
You may take out the specimen from the vials for identification. When you do so, you should
place a spider in the petri dish with some 70% alcohol to examine its characters under the
stereomicroscope. Because the spiders body is very fragile, the best way to handle the
specimen is to gently grasp its legs with a pair of forceps to move it in or out from the vial.
Dont break the spiders body or its legs. Undamaged spiders in their original vials will get
extra bonus points. Please handle everything with care!
alcohol at all times to prevent desiccation).
Q1.1.1 (4 points for each correct spider; 16 points total) Match each spider code with the
correct taxon name respectively in your Answer Sheet Note: each spider code can only be used
once; repeated taxa cells will not be given any points.
Q1.1.2 (0.65 points for each cell; 13 points total) If a spider has the characters listed in the
left column of the table in your Answer Sheet, indicate with a and if the character is absent,
indicate with a . (Penalty of 0.2 points for each wrong answer, minimum 0 point)
1-2 Reconstruct a phylogenetic tree for eight spiders
Data matrix 1-1 represents character entries (a to t) for a group of hypothetical organisms A
to H. Based on Data Matrix 1-1, Taxon A serves as the outgroup and the other 7 organisms (Taxa
B to H) are ingroups. Character state 0 represents the pleisiomorphy (ancestral character) and
states 1-6 are apomorphies (derived characters). - represents missing character. We may
reconstruct a cladogram (cladistic tree) by using synapomorphies (shared derived characters).
Each change represents one step of the evolutionary events (indicated by the character and its
state, e.g., e-5, t-4). The following tree (Figure 1-13) is the only resulting most parsimonious
cladogram that shows all the character changes on the tree. Numbers 1 to 15 represent 15 steps
of the tree.
Data Matrix 1-1
Taxa
Character
a
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Figure 1-13
Q1.2. (1.2 points for each cell; 18 points total) Fill in the character code and state (e.g., e-1) in
the Answer Sheet for each of the 15 steps.
1-3 Based on the cladogram (figure 1-13), answer the following questions:
Q1.3.1. (2 points) How many steps of the cladogram are there in total?
Q1.3.2. (2 points) Besides character e-1, which character is homoplasious (i.e., not an
homologous character)?
Q1.3.3. (2 points) Which of the following taxon is the sister group of taxon {C, D}?
(A) {E, F} (B) {H, B, G} (C) {F} (D) {H} (E) {B, G}
Q1.3.4. (Each correct answer will get 0.4 points, 2 points total) Mark with an X in the
True cell in the Answer Sheet if the characters given below appeared prior to the evolution of
character m-1 in the cladogram; otherwise, mark the False cell.
Character
s-1
s-2
a-1
g-1
d-1
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Q1.3.5. (1 point for each cell; 5 points total) To what kind of grouping do the following taxa
belong? Use code I for polyphyletic, II for paraphyletic, or III for monophyletic grouping.
Taxon
{H}
{B, C, G, H}
{C, D, E, F}
{B, G, H}
{B, E, G}
10
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Present
Absent
Total
Present
a+b
Absent
c+d
a+c
b+d
Total
n=a+b+c+d
Probability of obtaining species x, P(x) = (a+c)/n
Probability of obtaining species y, P(y) = (a+b)/n
Joint probability (JP): the probability of both species x and y being present,
JP = P(x) P(y)
Expected joint occurrences = n x JP
Significance level for Chi-squared statistical test (2)
Significance level () 0.05
0.01
df
1
3.841
6.635
5.991
9.210
7.815
11.345
Figure 2-1 (the figure on a separate paper) is a distribution map of two plant species, Plant-A ()
and Plant-B (), and a sympatric spider species, Spider (), in a hypothetical community. Each
square is 0.5 0.5 m2.
11
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
2-1 Association between Plant-A () and Spider (): analyzed by quadrat method.
Put a 1-m square quadrat on Figure 2-1 using the following 40 randomly assigned coordinates as
the center (i.e., 2 2 complete squares) and determine the type of each quadrat.
N-11, S-8, F-10, Q-18, O-16, K-2, L-4, M-17, M-4, H-17
X-2, K-11, T-19, M-8, P-10, G-8, B-19, M-19, S-10, O-12
J-18, D-7, B-17, I-11, B-10, G-13, V-16, C-3, F-5, R-15
L-2, Q-11, R-5, G-11, K-10, T-10, X-9, R-3, O-3, F-16
For example, a coordinate of C-3 would look like this:
Q2.1.1. (1 point each; 9 points total) Write down your results in Table 2-1-1 and complete all
the blank cells.
Answer the following in your Answer Sheet:
Q2.1.2a. (0.6 points) Calculate P (Plant-A).
Q2.1.2b. (0.6 points) Calculate P (Spider).
Q2.1.2c. (0.6 points) Calculate JP (Plant-A and Spider)
Q2.1.2d. (0.6 points) Calculate the expected joint occurrences.
Q2.1.2e. (0.6 points) Two species are more likely to be positively associated if the actual
observation of the joint occurrence is greater than the expected one, and negatively associated if
the actual observation is smaller than the expected one. What kind of association exists between
Plant-A and Spider? [Answer Code: P for positive association, N for negative association.]
2-1-3 A simple Chi-squared statistical test (2) with one degree of freedom (df = 1) is calculated
as follows:
n=a+b+c+d
n (ad-bc)2
2=
(a+b)(c+d)(a+c)(b+d)
Q2.1.3. (2 points) Based on Table 2-1-1, calculate 2 (to the fourth decimal place).
12
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
2-1-4 The strength of the association between the two species can be estimated from a coefficient
(V), defined as follows:
ad bc
(a b)(c d )(a c)(b d )
Present
Absent
Total
Present
14
16
30
Absent
10
Total
22
18
40
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Q2.2.2b. (2 points) The larger the quadrat size used, the more accurate the results.
Q2.2.2c. (2 points) Increasing the sampling efforts in the quadrat method should improve the
accuracy for the results for species association.
2-3 Association between Plant-A () and Plant-B (): analyzed by the nearest neighbor method.
Tally up the frequencies of the nearest neighbor of each plant systematically for all individuals.
Fill in the totals in the table printed in the Answer Sheet.
Q2.3.1. (0.5 points for each cell; 3 points total) Write down your results in Table 2-3-1 and
complete all the blank cells.
Q2.3.2a. (2 points) Based on Table 2-3-1, with one degree of freedom (df = 1), calculate 2
(to the fourth decimal place).
Q2.3.2b. (3 points) Are these two plant species randomly distributed, associated or segregated?
(Mark your answer with an X in the cell)
2-4 Mark with an X on the Answer Sheet whether each of the following are true or false.
(4 points total)
Q2.4.1. (2 points) The null hypothesis of the 2 test for the nearest neighbor method is that both
Plant-A and Plant-B are randomly distributed.
Q2.4.2. (2 points) Using the nearest neighbor method to test species association can avoid the
quadrat-size effect.
14
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 FIGURE
SYSTEMATICS AND ECOLOGY
A: two pairs
B: one pair
B: two pairs
Figure 1-5
B: present
Cribellum
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 FIGURE
SYSTEMATICS AND ECOLOGY
A: absent
Figure 1-6
B: present
Calamistrum on metatarsus IV
A: three claws
B: two claws
B: present
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 FIGURE
SYSTEMATICS AND ECOLOGY
A: widely separated
B: close or in contact
B: laterigrade
B: present
Figure 1-11 Tibia and metatarsus of legs I and II with series of long spines interspersed
with much shorter setae.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 FIGURE
SYSTEMATICS AND ECOLOGY
A: absent
B: present
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER KEY
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
STUDENT CODE:
PRACTICAL TEST 3
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER KEY
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER KEY
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
STUDENT CODE:
Spider code
Taxon name
A. aus
P. mus
C. gus
P. nus
L. ous
O. lus
S. dus
M. bus
N. pus
Spider code
T. fus
Y
W
T. kus
Z. cus
P. eus
Z. hus
Q.1.1.2. (0.65 points for each right answer cell; 13 points total)
(Penalty of 0.2 point for each wrong answer, minimum 0 point)
Taxon
Calamistrum present on
metatarsus IV
Present a cluster of
double-rowed trichobothria
on femora IV
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER KEY
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
STUDENT CODE:
Up to 4 points bonus will be granted to students who keep the intact specimens.
a-1 or b-1
b-1 or a-1
s-2
h-1 or m-1 or
n-1
h-1 or m-1 or
n-1
10
h-1 or m-1 or
n-1
d-1
e-4
s-1
t-3
11
12
13
14
15
d-1
e-6
e-3
o-1
g-1
Q1.3.1.
Q1.3.2.
Q1.3.3.
19
d-1
Q1.3.4. (Each correct answer will get 0.4 points, 2 points total)
Character
True
s-1
s-2
a-1
g-1
False
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER KEY
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
d-1
STUDENT CODE:
Kind of grouping
{H}
III
II
II
III
I
{B, C, G, H}
{C, D, E, F}
{B, G, H}
{B, E, G}
Present
Absent
Total
2
4
6
10
24
34
12
28
40
Q2.1.2a.
Q2.1.2b.
Q2.1.2c.
Q2.1.2d.
0.3
0.15
0.045
1.8
Q2.1.3.(2 points)
0.0373
Q2.1.2e.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER KEY
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
STUDENT CODE:
Q2.1.4a. (2 points)
0.0306
Q2.1.4b. (2 points)
Association Strong
V value
-1=V-0.6
Moderate
None
Moderate +
Strong +
-0.6V-0.2
-0.2V0.2
0.2V0.6
0.6V=1
Q2.2.1a. (2 points)
Q2.2.1b. (2 points)
Association
Strong
Moderate
None
Moderate +
Strong +
V value
-1=V-0.6
-0.6V-0.2
-0.2V0.2
0.2V0.6
0.6V=1
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER KEY
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
STUDENT CODE:
Q2.2.2a. (2 points)
Q2.2.2b. (2 points)
True
Q2.2.2c. (2 points)
X
False
Plant-B ()
Total
24
21
45
16
19
35
40
40
80
Plant-A ()
Plant-B ()
Total
Q2.3.2a. (2 points)
0.4571
Q2.3.2b. (3 points)
randomly distributed
associated
segregated
True
Q2.4.1 (2 points)
Q2.4.2 (2 points)
False
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER KEY
ECOLOGY AND SYSTEMATICS
STUDENT CODE:
Damaged
Undamaged
Signed by Inspector:
Student Code:
(Without Student Code written here, the 4 bonus points will not be awarded)
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Student Code:
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Dear Participants,
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed items is
Good Luck!!
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Quantity
20
30
1
1
5
1
1
1
1
1
Materials:
1. Double distilled water (labeled as ddH2O in carrier box)
2. 1 M hydrochloric acid (HCl) (in carrier box)
3. Transparent nail polish (in carrier box)
4. Section slides X, Y, and Z of the root of plant K in slide box K
5. Four-compartment plastic petri dish
(Containing tissue samples from plants V, W, M, N, P, Q, R, S
in each compartment)
6. Template paper (with student code) for placing the slides
with sections you made and for documenting
Quantity
20 mL/vial
5-10 mL/vial
1 vial
1 slide each
2 petri dishes
1 sheet
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Figure 1
There are three slides (X, Y, and Z), which are transverse sections (located within the circular
label on the slides) from different regions of the root of plant K. You need to determine whether
plant K is monocot or dicot to answer some questions later. Observe these sections under a
compound microscope and answer the following questions.
Q1.A.1.2 points each, 6 points total
Sections X, Y, and Z each correspond to a part of the root depicted in Figure 1. Check [X] the
correct answers on the answer sheet.
Q.1.A.2. single answer, 4 points
What is the direction of maturation of primary xylem in the root (tissues mature earlier tissues
mature later)? Check [X] the correct answers on the answer sheet.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Equipment:
1.
2.
3.
Quantity
1 each
1 box each
7. Marker pen
Materials:
1.
2.
3.
4.
12 (6 extra
unlabeled)
1 each
1
1
Quantity
10 mL/tube
10 mL/tube
50 mL/vial
Introduction:
Phosphate is an important plant nutrient found in cell membranes, nucleic acids, and
energy compounds like ATP. When lacking phosphates, plant growth and development can be
dramatically affected. Plants can sense changes in phosphate concentration in the environment
and accordingly regulate their gene expression, changing the activity of phosphate transport
proteins on the cell membranes to maintain homeostasis of phosphate concentration within the
cells. Using the model plant Arabidopsis, scientists discovered that root cells respond to
phosphate-sufficient (Pi-sufficient; e.g. 1mM) or phosphate-deficient (Pi-deficient; e.g. 10M)
conditions as depicted below in Figures 2 and 3, respectively:
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Figure 2
Figure 3
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Table 1
Sample
No.
Plant
[Pi] in
medium
Fresh weight of
seedlings (mg)
1 mM
40.4
10 M
17.3
1 mM
28.0
1 mM
39.2
1 mM
30.6
1 mM
33.8
Use the provided equipment and solutions to measure the phosphate concentration in each sample
in accordance with the experimental procedures.
Experimental Procedures:
1. Use the 400-M KH2PO4 solution (Solution B), ddH2O, and pre-labeled 1.5-mL
microcentrifuge tubes to prepare the following concentrations of phosphate solutions for a
standard curve: 0, 25, 50, 100, 200, 400 M. Vortex the samples to mix solutions thoroughly.
For each concentration, there should be at least 0.5 mL of solution. Use the P200 micropipette
with fresh tips to transfer 0.1 mL of each standard solution into the 96-well microplate at
specified positions (as in Figure 4; make 2 replicates for each standard).
Figure 4 Positions of standards and samples in 96-well microplate
Standards
Samples
Standards
A
#1
#1
25
#2
#2
25
50
#3
#3
50
100
#4
#4
100
200
#5
#5
200
400
#6
#6
400
G
H
1
10
11
12
2. Transfer 0.1 mL of each sample into the 96-well microplate at specified positions (as in
Figure 4, make 2 replicates for each sample).
3. Add 0.1 mL of the phosphate detection solution (Solution A) into the wells that contain the
standards and the samples. Mix by gently tapping the side of the plate.
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
4.
Lift the sign after you finish Step 3, and wait for lab assistants to guide and help you with
measuring the absorbance of the reaction mixtures with the ELISA reader at 820 nm.
5. The lab assistant will print out the data for you. Put your student code on the print-out.
6. Answer the following questions:
Q.2.1. (18 points total)
Calculate the mean values of the absorbance for each sample and standard. Use the graph paper
on the answer sheet to plot a standard curve. (0.5 point for each standard point correctly
plotted)
Determine the phosphate concentrations of the samples in M and the nmol phosphate per mg of
seedling fresh weight for sample # 1 to # 6. Fill in your results in the table of answer sheet. (2
points for each phosphate concentration measured, 0.5 point for each nmol/mg of phosphate
calculated)
Q.2.2. (Multiple answers, 4 points. Points given when all correct answers are selected)
For each of the following statements, determine whether they are true or false explanations for
those plants having higher phosphate content (nmol/mg) than the wild type. Check [X] the correct
answers on the answer sheet.
(A) X cannot be activated in the plant, thus leading to an increase in phosphate uptake.
(B) Loss of function of Gene Y in the plant causing an increase in phosphate uptake.
(C) Loss of function of Gene Z in the plant causing an increase in phosphate uptake.
(D) The plant harbors a transgene that over-expressed gene Y, causing the loss of inhibition
of protein T, leading to higher activity in phosphate uptake.
(E) Protein T of the plant has a defect and is unable to transport phosphate efficiently.
(F) The transcription factor X of the plant has a mutation, and is unable to bind the
promoter of gene Y.
Q.2.3. (2.5 points each, 10 points total)
Using the results from the experiment, assign the corresponding plant (B, C, D, or E) to the
correct description on the answer sheet.
Q.2.4. (Single answer, 4 points)
If a wild type plant (W), a gene X knockout mutant (X), and a gene Y knockout mutant (Y) were
all grown in the same Pi-deficient condition, what would be the phosphate level in their shoots
(rank from the lowest to highest)? Check [X] the correct answer on the answer sheet.
(A) X < W < Y
(B) Y < W < X
(C) W < X < Y
(D) W < Y < X
(E) X < Y < W
(F) Y < X < W
10
IBO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
11
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
PRACTICAL TEST 4
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER KEY
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
Part B
Part C
Part D
Section X
Section Y
Section Z
X
Q.1.B.3 points for each plant, points are given when all correct answers are
selected; 6 points total
Check [X] the correct answers
Distribution pattern of vascular bundles in the stem
arranged in a ring
Plant V
Plant W
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
Q.1.C.18 points
Fill in the correct answers
(a)
i)
_m. (1 point)
m. (3 points)
___ 0.2
( 0.05)
( 50)
___mm2. (1 point)
_ __(stomatal number /mm2). (3 points)
Q.1.C.2 6 points, points are given when all correct answers are selected
Check [X] the correct answers
True
An aquatic plant
False
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
Monocot
Dicot
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
Q.1.E 6 points for each plant with the presence of crystals, points are given
when all correct answers are selected; 2 points for the plant with the absence of
crystals; 20 points total
Fill in the corresponding letters
Presence of
crystals
Absence of
Plant
Location of crystals
Crystal type
(P, Q, R, or S)
(A or B)
(C or D)
crystals
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
(2 points for each phosphate concentration measured, 0.5 point for each nmol/mg
of phosphate calculated)
Sample Plant
Fresh weight
Average phosphate
of seedlings
concentration of
(mg)
extract (M)
(nmol/mg)
40.4
160 10%
39.6 10%
17.3
33 10%
19.0 10%
28.0
75 10%
26.8 10%
39.2
150 10%
38.3 10%
30.6
380 10%
124.2 10%
33.8
300 10%
88.8 10%
Q.2.2. (Multiple answers, 4 points. Points given when all correct answers are
selected)
(B)
True
False
(C)
(D)
(E)
(F)
BO 2011
TAIWAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER KEY
PLANT ANATOMY, PHYSIOLOGY, AND GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
(F)
X
(B)
(C)
(D)
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
5. Use pencils and erasers. You may use a scale and a calculator provided.
6. Some of the questions may be crossed-out. DO NOT answer these questions.
7. Stop answering and put down your pencil IMMEDIATELY after the end bell rings.
8. At the end of the test session you should leave all papers at your table. It is not allowed to take
anything out.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Country: _______________
Student Code:
___________
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Changwon, KOREA
3. Use pencils and erasers. You can use a ruler and a calculator provided.
4. Some of the questions may be crossed-out. Do not answer these questions.
5. The maximal point of Part A is 51 (1 point for each question).
6. Stop answering and put down your pencil immediately after the end bell rings.
7. At the end of the test session you should leave all papers at your table. It is not allowed to take
anything out.
CELL BIOLOGY
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A1.
Select the chemical property that is shared by all types of lipids forming the plasma membrane.
A. Polar head
B. Sugar component
C. Glycerol backbone
D. Phosphate group
E.
Hydrophobic region
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A2.
The following photograph shows filamentous growth of a kind of cyanobacteria, Nostoc sp. The
bacteria form heterocysts (thick-walled cells), when nitrogen sources such as ammonia or nitrates are
deficient in the environment.
I.
II.
III.
A. Only I
B.
Only II
C.
Only I and II
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A3.
A generegulatory protein X controls cell proliferation. Protein X is found in the cytosol and has
no typical nuclear localization signal (NLS). When cells are treated with a specific growth hormone,
protein X re-localizes from the cytoplasm into the nucleus where it activates the transcription factors
involved in cell proliferation.
Recently, a protein (Y) that interacts with protein X has been identified in unstimulated cells. To
investigate the function of protein Y, a mutant lacking the gene encoding protein Y was generated.
Fractionation of cells from the wild type and mutant produced membrane (M), cytoplasmic (C), and
nuclear (N) fractions for each cell type. Proteins extracted from each fraction were separated by
SDS-PAGE and analyzed by Western blotting for the presence of proteins X and Y.
On the basis of the results shown above, which of the following statements is the most plausible
characterization of protein Y?
A. In the absence of growth hormone, protein Y associates with protein X, and the X/Y
complex is subjected to a degradation pathway.
B.
In the presence of growth hormone, protein Y interacts with protein X, and the complex
remains in the cytoplasm.
C.
Protein X interacts with protein Y in the absence of growth hormone. Upon growth
hormone treatment, protein X is released from protein Y and re-localizes to the nucleus.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A4.
A GFP (green fluorescent protein) tagged form of protein P was expressed in fibroblast cells. The
subcellular distribution of protein P can be observed using fluorescence microscopy. To determine
the precise movement mechanism of protein P in the cells, fluorescence recovery after
photobleaching (FRAP) was performed. As shown below, protein P is expressed in the nucleus (ROI
1) and in the cytoplasm (ROI 2). Protein P in the ROI 1 area was photobleached using a laser beam.
Photobleaching causes an irreversible loss of flouorescence. Changes in the fluorescence intensity of
protein P in ROI 1 and ROI 2 following photobleaching are shown in the graph and figures below.
Which of the following is the best explanation for the distribution and movement of protein P?
A. P is a nuclear membrane protein.
B.
C.
D. P is imported to the nucleus via vesicular trafficking through Golgi and ER.
E.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A5.
The domain structure of protein Z, which is composed of 180 amino acids, is shown in the upper
part of the figure below. Protein Z is palmitoylated at a cysteine residue (the third amino acid)
through the mechanism shown in the box.
Which of the following diagrams shows the correct topology of protein Z in the plasma membrane?
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A6.
The figure below shows the nucleotide sequence of the mouse -globin gene. The DNA nucleotide
sequence represents the coding strand, and the 3-letter abbreviations below represent the amino acid
sequence. The 79th cAp marked with the black arrow is the 5 capping site, and the 1467th pA is the
site where the poly-A tail is attached.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A7.
Which one of the following graphs shows the relative change in the amount of mitochondrial DNA
of a cell undergoing mitosis?
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A8. DNA helicase, a key enzyme for DNA replication, separates double-stranded DNA into
single-stranded DNA. The following describes an experiment to find out the characteristics of this
enzyme.
A linear 6 kb ssDNA was annealed with a short (300 bp) complementary ssDNA that is
labeled with radioactive nucleotides (a). The annealed DNA was then treated in one of three
ways: with DNA helicase, boiling without helicase, or boiled helicase. Treated DNA
samples were electrophoresed on an agarose gel. The gel in b shows the DNA bands that
could be detected in the gel by autoradiography. (It is assumed that the ATP energy needed
for this enzyme reaction was provided during the treatment of DNA helicase).
The band appearing in the top part of the gel is the 6.3 kb ssDNA only.
B.
The band appearing in the lower part of the gel is the labelled 300 bp DNA.
C.
If the annealed DNA is treated only with DNA helicase and the reaction is complete, the
band pattern looks like the lane 3 in b.
D.
If the annealed DNA is treated only with the boiling without helicase treatment, the band
pattern will look like lane 2 in b.
E.
If the annealed DNA is treated only with boiled helicase, the band pattern will
look like lane 1 in b.
10
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A9.
As shown in the picture below, microarray was used to find genes whose expression is regulated
when a plant is treated with the ABA hormone.
Which of the following explanations is not correct about the microarray experiment?
A. All cDNAs of the expressed mRNA from both the experimental group and the control group
hybridizes competitively with the corresponding genes on the DNA chip.
B. Genes whose expressions are induced by ABA appear red after hybridization.
C. Because we used different colored probes with each sample, we can measure the relative
amount of genes which are expressed differentially.
D. We can only know the expression profile of genes which are included on the microarray.
E. This process includes reverse transcription and hybridization.
11
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Expressed genotype
SI type
Pollen of plant 1
Style of plant 2
GSI
S1 or S2
S2S3
II
GSI
S2 or S3
S2S3
III
SSI
S1 or S2
S1S3
IV
SSI
S1 or S2
S3S4
Which of these crosses (I, II, III, and IV) result in successful fertilizations?
A. I and II
B. I and III
C. I and IV
D. II and III
E. II and IV
12
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Based on this experiment, find the most accurate explanation or expectation for the light control of
flowering in this plant,
A. This plant flowers whenever the total night length exceeds a 12 hr threshold (out of the 24 hr
night/light period) with or without light interruption.
B. This plant is likely to be a short-day plant that requires a certain length of uninterrupted light
period for flowering.
C. The plant in experiment 3 will flower if it is irradiated with a flash of far-red light, instead of
white..
D. The plant in experiment 4 will flower.
E. The plant in experiment 5 will not flower.
13
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A12. Which statement correctly describes the differentiation and development of cells and organs in
flowering plants?
A. Organomorphogenesis involves cell movement as one of the important mechanisms.
B. Post-embryogenesis is a growth process, as all of the plant organs are pre-formed during
embryogenesis.
C. Totipotency of plant tissues provides the original source of power to develop a complete plant
by re-differentiation, without going through the de-differentiation process.
D. The direction of cell division determines cell type and function.
E. Lineage information obtained by genetic inheritance overides environmental factors in
determining the time for organ development.
14
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A13. The graphs below show sucrose (Suc)- and/or indole 3-acetic acid (IAA, an auxin)-induced cell
growth (Figure a) and the kinetics of IAA-induced cell elongation and cell wall acidification in
coleoptiles (Figure b). Based on these results, together with the fact that these processes are
delayed by cold treatments or inhibitors of protein synthesis, the "acid-growth hypothesis" was
proposed as the best model to explain auxin-induced cell growth.
15
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A14.
Rubisco is an enzyme crucial for carbon fixation in plants. In addition to the predominant
carboxylation reaction, this enzyme catalyzes an oxidation reaction as well. For an aquatic plant, the
frequency of the oxidation reaction depends on the relative concentrations of the reagents CO 2 and
O2 in the aquatic solution, which in turn are coupled to temperature. The figures show the absolute
(a) and relative (b) concentrations of CO2 and O2 dissolved in water that is at equilibrium with the
atmosphere.
16
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A15. As depicted in the following figure, an oat seedling was germinated in the dark. A blue light was
given unilaterallyto the right side of the coleoptile, and an agar block containing Ca 2+ was attached to
the right side of root tip below the elongation zone.
What do you expect the bending responses of the oat seedling will be in a few days?
Coleoptile
Root
Growing upright.
Growing downwards.
Growing upright.
17
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Which of the following statements about the signal transmissions of these synapses are correct?
I.
Action potentials would be generated in neuron (N) if nerve terminals (a) and (c)
were stimulated simultaneously.
A. Only I and II
B.
Only I and IV
E.
I, II and III
18
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
19
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A17. Animal cap cells from the animal pole were removed from a Xenopus blastula embryo. These
cells were then incubated in culture media containing different concentrations of activin. As seen in
the table below, the cells differentiated into various tissues or cells depending on the concentration of
activin.
Tissues
Concentration of
or cells
activin in medium
differentiated
0 (control)
epithelial cells
~ 0.1 ng/mL
blood cells
~ 1 ng/mL
muscles
~ 10 ng/mL
notochord
~ 100 ng/mL
heart
A. Only I
B. Only III
D. Only II and IV
20
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A18. This illustration shows the molecular mechanism of the signal transduction pathway that occurs
in rod cell membranes when rod cells receive light.
Only I and II
Only I and III
Only III and IV
I, II, and IV
II, III, and IV
21
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A19. The figure shows muscle fibers, muscle spindle, and their nerve innervations of biceps of human
arm.
Nerve (a) is sensitive to the stretch of muscle fibers outside of the spindle when muscle fibers within
the spindle are relaxed. Choose a case when the afferent signals in nerve (a) increase?
22
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A20. The following experiments are designed to investigate the differentiation mechanism of skeletal
muscle.
<Experiment 1> Cultured mouse muscle cells were chemically induced to fuse with undifferentiated
human cells.
Result 1:
Result 2:
<Experiment 2> Cytoplasmic portions of human muscle cells were injected into undifferentiated
mouse stem cell.
Result: The cells injected with the cytoplasm of human muscle cells transiently
expressed mouse muscle-specific genes. However, the expression of muscle
specific gene was disappeared after 24 hours.
23
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A21. The following figures indicate changes in phosphate concentration as the filtrate passes through
regions a and b, according to the increase in plasma phosphate concentration.
Using this information, choose the most appropriate graph that depicts the changes in the renal
reabsorption rate of phosphate ions according to the increase of its concentration in the plasma.
24
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A22. The table below shows the results of experimental tests on skin graft rejection between two
different mouse strains. (Strains [A] and [B] are genetically identical except for the MHC loci.)
Skin donor
mouse
Exp.
Skin recipient
mouse
Skin rejection
6~8 d
10~13 d
[A]
[A]
II
[A]
[B]
occurred weakly
occurred strongly
occurred strongly
III
[A]
IV
[A]
25
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A23. The phagocytic activity of macrophages against a certain pathogenic bacteria is described below.
26
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A24. Oskar, nanos and hunchback are three major genes that establish the anterior-posterior (A-P) axis
during Drosophila embryogenesis. The diagram below shows how the mRNA and protein products
of these three genes are distributed in Drosophila eggs (darker shades represent higher
concentrations). The table below lists the outcome of disrupting one of these genes, as reflected in
protein distribution and anterior-posterior development.
Mutation in
nanos
Mutation in
hunchback
Mutation in oskar
Distribution of
the Nanos protein
normal
abnormal
Distribution of
the Hunchback protein
abnormal
abnormal
Distribution of
the Oskar protein
normal
normal
abnormal
abnormal
abnormal
27
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Based on these data, which of the given statements correctly describes the interaction among the
three genes?
28
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A25. The diagram on the left depicts the different areas of the spinal cord from the cervical region to
the coccyx. The statements on the right provide descriptions about the spinal cord.
Suppose that an athlete injures the left half of the spinal cord T4 during a football game.
Choose the correct statement concerning this patient's sensory or motor function.
A. Abnormal touch sensation in the right foot.
B. Disability in the movement of the right leg.
C. Normal pain perception in the left leg.
D. No cutaneous sensation in the left hand.
E. Normal pain perception in the right leg.
29
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A26. This picture illustrates monthly changes in the human ovary during the reproductive cycle.
30
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A27. The diagram below represents the development of a human zygote from fertilization to the late
blastocyst stage.
most
appropriate
stage
for
the
collection
of
Embryonic
stem
cells
31
for
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A28. Figure I illustrates a skeletal muscle and its innervation. Figures II and III depict cross and
longitudinal sections of the muscle, respectively. Figure IV shows an electron micrograph of
neuromuscular junction.
Which of the following statements gives the most accurate description of each structure?
A. The number of muscle cells innervated by a single motor neuron is larger in a muscle that
controls fine movement than in one that controls unskilled movement.
B. During embryonic development, structure (a) is derived from a single cell.
C. Within the same muscle, the population of small-diameter cells (b) is increased after several
weeks of intense exercise.
D. Structure (c) is called a myofibril, which is the structural unit of the skeletal muscle.
E. The main mechanism to terminate the action of secreted acetylcholine at the neuromuscular
junction is neurotransmitter reuptake into the nerve terminal (d).
32
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A29. Figures I~III depict the excretory systems of planaria, earthworms, and grasshoppers. Figure IV
illustrates the habitat of the salmon life cycle.
33
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A30. Which of the following statements is correct concerning gas exchange organs in animals?
A. In starfish, the gill plays a role in gas exchange, but the tube feet do not play a role in that
process.
B. In grasshoppers, well-developed muscles surrounding the tracheae control movement of air
inward and outward through an external opening.
C. In fish, blood flows through the gill-filament capillaries in the same direction as that of water
exiting from the mouth and pharynx to the outside.
D. In birds, during exhalation both air sacs deflate, forcing air to the outside, whereas the lung is
filled with air.
E. In humans, surfactants are required to increase the surface tension in the trace amount of fluid
coating the inner alveolar surface; in the absence of surfactants, the alveoli collapse during
exhalation, blocking the entry of air during inhalation.
34
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A31.
The following picture of the midsagittal section of the human brain illustrates diencephalic
structures.
35
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A32. Which of the following statements about the regulation of male reproduction is not correct?
A. Follicle stimulating hormone (FSH) promotes the activity of Sertoli cells located within the
seminiferous tubules.
B. Luteinizing hormone (LH) regulates Leydig cells located in the interstitial space between the
seminiferous tubules.
C. In response to LH, Leydig cells secrete testosterone and other androgens, which promote
spermatogenesis in the tubules.
D. Testosterone regulates blood levels of gonadotropin-releasing hormone (GnRH), FSH, and LH
through inhibitory effects on the hypothalamus and anterior pituitary.
E. Inhibin, a hormone produced by Leydig cells, acts on the anterior pituitary gland to reduce LH
secretion.
36
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
ETHOLOGY
A33. An experiment is designed to test this hypothesis: the number of yellowjacket wasps at a feeding
site visually affects the feeding-site choices of workers collecting nectar.. Four feeders with zero, one,
two or eight individual decoys are prepared, as shown in the figure below. One nectar dish is placed
in the middle of each feeder. You then observe the feeding-site choice made by each worker.
37
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A34. As seen in the left-hand graph, a population of moth species A exhibits individual variation in
body color. The environment in which this population lives includes predators, such as birds, which
find species A palatable. The environment also includes other moth species unpalatable to birds: one
individual from each of three species (1~3) is shown in the right-hand illustration. Species 1, 2, and 3
are similar to different phenotypes found within species A: species 1 to lighter individuals, species 2
to individuals with intermediate phenotype, and species 3 to darker individuals. After capturing and
tasting species 1, 2 and 3, birds learn to avoid eating them. Species A is considered a Batesian mimic
of the other species. If species 3 becomes most abundant in this habitat, which graph accurately
predicts what you would observe in species A? (The dotted line represents the mean value of the
original population of species A.)
38
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A
.
B
.
39
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A35. Eusocial honeybees have a specific system of sex determination. Females are diploid (2n) and
develop from fertilized eggs; males are haploid (n) and develop from unfertilized eggs. Assuming
that the queen copulated with a single male, which of the following is/are most likely true for this
social group?
A. Only I and II
B.
C.
Only I and IV
40
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
41
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A37. In Drosophila melanogaster, yellow body and white eye are both X-linked recessive genes.
Wild-type males were crossed with yellow females with white eyes, and F1 progenies were produced
in the numbers and phenotypes shown in the table below.
Progeny group
Progeny number
(a)
wild-type female
3,996
(b)
3,997
(c)
(d)
wild-type male
Which of the following is the best explanation for how progeny groups (c) and (d) were produced?
A. Genetic recombination during meiosis I.
B. Genetic recombination during meiosis II.
C. Somatic mutations in the eye and body of wild-type flies.
D. Nondisjunction of sex chromosome.
E. Dosage compensation for X-linked genes.
42
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A38. Four mutant strains of bacteria (1~4) all require substance S to grow (each strain is blocked at
one step in the S-biosynthesis pathway). Four plates were prepared with minimal medium and a trace
of substance S, to allow a small amount of growth of mutant cells. On plate a, mutant cells of strain 1
were spread over entire surface of the agar to form a thin lawn of bacteria. On plate b, the lawn was
composed of mutant cells of strain 2, and so on. On each plate, cells of each of the four mutant types
were inoculated over the lawn, as indicated in the figure by the circles. Dark circles indicate excellent
growth. A strain blocked at a later step in the S substance metabolic pathway accumulates
intermediates that can feed a strain blocked at an earlier step.
What is the order of genes (1~4) in the metabolic pathway for synthesis of substance S?
A. 2 4 3 1
B. 2 1 3 4
C. 1 3 4 2
D. 1 2 4 3
E. 3 4 2 1
43
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A39.
By using modern technology, the gene that determined height in Mendels pea plants was
discovered to be the gene Le that codes for the enzyme involved in biosynthesis of the gibberellin
hormone GA1. The two alleles for this gene, T and t, differ in only one nucleotide. The enzyme
produced by the recessive t allele has efficiency as low as 1/20 of the normal enzyme. Which of the
following statements is correct?
44
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
45
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A41. The direction of shell coiling in the snail Limnaea peregra is either dextral or sinistral. Coiling
direction is determined by a pair of autosomal alleles. The allele for dextral (S+) is dominant over the
allele for sinistral (s). Experimental results of two reciprocal monohybrid crosses are shown below.
What is the genetic phenomenon that explains the inheritance pattern for coiling direction?
A. Cytoplasmic inheritance.
B. Epistasis.
C. Genetic imprinting.
D. Maternal effect.
E. Sex-limited inheritance.
46
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A42. Some fruit flies (Drosophila melanogaster) have a mutation that makes them shake. These fruit
flies are called shakers.
What kind of inheritance best explains the inheritance pattern for the shaker gene?
A. Somatic dominant.
B. Somatic recessive.
C. X-linked dominant.
D. X-linked recessive.
E. Y-linked dominant.
47
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A43.
'Coefficient of relatedness' (or 'genetic relatedness') refers to the probability of two related
individuals inheriting a particular allele of a single gene from their common ancestor.
In this family tree of diploid individuals, which of the following 'coefficient of relatedness' is not
true?
Coefficient of relatedness of
A.
A being 1/2
B.
B being 1/2
C.
C being 1/4
D.
D being 1
E. E being 1/4
48
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
ECOLOGY
A44. The figure below shows the change in the abundance pattern of three trophic levels in a lake when
it was polluted by city sewage. Ground-feeding carps increase in frequency because they benefit
directly from additional mineral nutrients.
Which ecological control methods could improve the water quality of the lake?
Control methods
II.
Top-down control: Attempt to reduce the nutrients in the river entering the lake.
III.
IV.
A. Only I and II
E. Only II and IV
49
C. Only I and IV
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A45. The figure below depicts life-history strategies for three plant species (a~c) along 3
axes: strength of competition with other organisms, level of disturbance in the habitat, and
level of environmental stress in the habitat. Species a grows in habitats where competition
among species is high but disturbance and stress are low. Species b grows in habitats with
high environmental stress but with low interspecies competition. Species c grows in
highly disturbed habitats with low environmental stress.
Characteristics of a-type plants are slow growth rate and short-lived leaves.
Desert annual plants are b-type species. They have rapid growth and produce large
amount of seeds in a short time after rains.
III
Most plants belonging to c-type species would be herbaceous while a-type and
b-types species are likely to be trees or shrubs.
A. Only II
B. Only I and II
C. Only I and III
D. Only II and III
E. I, II, and III
50
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A46. In the photic zone of freshwater and marine environments, where light penetrates, cyanobacteria
are found in the upper part of the zone, and purple and green bacteria are in the lower part of the
zone. Which of the following statements best explains the vertical distribution of the photosynthetic
bacteria?
A. Green and purple bacteria are anaerobic, while cyanobacteria are aerobic.
B. Green and purple bacteria are better able to use light wavelengths that cyanobacteria do not use
as efficiently.
C. Habitat isolation develops due to competition for nutrient and oxygen.
D. Cyanobacteria are better able to use oxygen as an electron donor for photosynthesis.
E. It is the result of adaptation to lower temperatures in purple and green bacteria.
51
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A47. The following figure shows nitrogen cycling in an ecosystem. Numbers I~V represent different
chemical conversion steps in the cycle.
Which process (I ~ V) is correctly paired with the organismal group performing that step?
A. I- photoautotrophs.
B. II- bacteria symbiotic with plants.
C. III- anaerobic bacteria living in conditions such as wetland ecosystem.
D. IV- eukaryotic organisms.
E. V - nitrogen fixing bacteria such as Rhizobium or Cyanobacteria.
52
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A48. The following graph shows the relationship between the frequency or strength of disturbance and
species diversity.
53
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
II. C4 plants will grow increasingly better than C3 plants in environments where water is
limiting.
III. the increased C:N ratio in litter will cause an increase in decomposition rate by soil
microorganisms.
A. Only I
B. Only II
C. Only III
D. Only I and II
E. Only II and III
54
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
BIOSYSTEMATICS
Research 1. Wu and Li (1985): The comparative analysis of homologous genes between human and
mouse genomes suggests that the evolutionary rate of homologous genes was higher in the
mouse lineage than in the human lineage.
Research 2. Smith and Donohue (2008): The plant families Caprifoliaceae, Asclepiadaceae, and
Lamiaceae are composed of both herbaceous and arborescent species. The comparative analysis
of homologous genes between the herbaceous and the arborescent species within a single plant
family suggest that the evolutionary rates of homologous genes in herbaceous lineages were
faster than that of arborescent lineages in all three plant families.
Research 3. Gilman et al. (2009): The comparative analysis of 130 homologous mitochondrial genes
between a sister species pair of vertebrates from the temperate region and from the tropical
region indicate that the base substitution rates of homologous genes from the tropical region are
1.7 times faster than that of the temperate region.
55
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Based on these studies, which of the following statements best describes the common evolutionary
processes in plant and animal genes?
A. The evolutionary rates of genes are accelerated in short-lived animals and plants.
B. The evolutionary rates of genes are accelerated in higher animals and plants.
C. The evolutionary rates of genes are accelerated in animals and plants which lived in higher
temperature regions.
D. Direct comparisons of homologous genes between animals and plants show that plants evolve
faster than animals.
E. The fast evolutionary rates of mitochondria genes make them ideal for phylogenetic
comparison between distant lineages.
56
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A51. Which of the following pairs does not show a monophyletic group - paraphyletic group
relationship?
A. Monocots - Dicots
B. Tetrapods - Bony fishes
C. Echinoderms - Chordata
D. Birds - Reptiles
E. Vascular plants - Nonvascular plants
57
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A52. The following figure shows a hypothetical evolutionary tree of species a~ e along with the
variability between pairs of these species.
58
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
59
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Which of the following combination is correct for the nuclear ploidy states of structures a~ c?
2n
n+n
2n
n+n
n+n
2n
n+n
n+n
60
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
A1
No.
No.
A19
A37
A38
A2
A20
A3
A21
A39
A22
A40
A41
A4
A5
A6
A7
A23
A24
A25
A8
A26
A9
A27
A10
A28
A11
A29
A12
A42
A43
A44
A30
A45
A46
A47
A48
A13
A31
A49
A14
A32
A50
A15
A33
A16
A34
A17
A18
A51
A52
A35
A53
A36
A54
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Country: ________________
Student Code:
___________
Changwon, KOREA
3. Use pencils and erasers. You can use a scale and a calculator provided.
4. Some of the questions may be crossed-out. Do not answer these questions.
5. The maximal point of Part B is 107.1.
6. Stop answering and put down your pencil immediately after the end bell rings.
7. At the end of the test session you should leave all papers at your table. It is not allowed to take
anything out.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
CELL BIOLOGY
B1. (2.7 points) The Western blot below shows migration distances of five signal molecules (a~e)
involved in a growth hormone-regulated cell-signaling pathway.
To determine the order of molecules (a~e) in the signal cascade that occurs upon the growth hormone
treatment, cells were treated with different inhibitors (I~IV) of cell signaling. The following blots
show the changes in signal molecule expression patterns resulting from inhibitor treatment.
B1.1. (1.5 points) Fill in the boxes in the answer sheet to show the order of proteins (a~e) in the
signaling cascade.
B1.2. (1.2 points) Fill in the circles in the answer sheet to show the site where each inhibitor (I~IV)
exerts its action.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B2. (2.7 points) Match the molecular constituents (a~f) on the right with the cellular structures
(A~D) that maintain cell morphology on the left. Each cellular structure can have more than one
molecular constituent.
a. Cadherin
A. Cytoskeleton
b. Cellulose
B. Cell wall
c. Collagen
C. Desmosome junction
d. Actin
D. Extracellular matrix
e. Keratin
f. Lignin
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Match each listed organ or tissue in the answer sheet to the correct box in the figure.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B4.1. (1 point) Which pair of graphs correctly shows the changes in glucose concentrations in the
medium and -galactosidase activity within the cells?
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B4.2. (1.2 points) The graph below shows the expression pattern of lac mRNA in wild-type and mutant
E. coli cells after lactose is added to a glucose-depleted medium.
Indicate with a checkmark () in the answer sheet whether each mutant is able or unable to show the
mutant expression pattern.
Mutant
I. An E. coli mutant in which the repressor is not expressed.
II. An E. coli mutant in which the repressor can bind to the operator, but not to lactose.
III. An E. coli mutant in which the operator is mutated so that the repressor cannot bind
to the operator.
IV. An E. coli mutant in which RNA polymerase cannot bind to the promoter of the lac
operon.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Transcription and translation of a gene in a prokaryote cell are depicted in the picture
below.
Indicate with a checkmark () in the answer sheet whether each description is true or false.
Description
I. The direction of transcription is from (B) to (A).
II. Location (C) of the mRNA is the 5' - end.
III. The polypeptide on ribosome (D) is longer than the polypeptide on ribosome (E).
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B6. (2 points)
A part of the nucleotide sequence of one strand of a double-stranded DNA molecule and
the corresponding amino acid sequence are shown. The table shows a portion of the genetic code.
Codon position
DNA strand
Polypeptide
Phe
Lys
Codon
Amino acid
UUU
Phe
UUA
Leu
AAG
Lys
AGC
Ser
Leu
Ser .......
Indicate with a checkmark () in the answer sheet whether each description in true or false.
(Assume that the length of the DNA is the same as that of its primary transcript.)
Description
I. The DNA strand shown is a template strand.
II. If the G+C content of the DNA strand shown is 40%, then the A+T content of its
complementary DNA strand is 60%.
III. If the G+C content of the DNA strand shown is 40%, then the A+U content of the
primary transcript is 60%.
IV. The nucleotide sequence of mRNA is 5' ....... UUU AAG UUA AGC ....... 3'.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B7. (2 points)
The picture below shows the process of generating a transgenic plant harboring gene X
Restriction enzymes and ligase are used to make the recombinant DNA.
Plant tissue culture techniques are used to differentiate the leaf discs into a plant.
The whole recombinant Ti-plasmid harboring gene X gets integrated into the plant
genome.
IV.
The introduction of gene X into the transgenic plant genome can be confirmed by
using genomic PCR or genomic Southern blot analysis.
V.
The expression of the introduced gene X in the plant cell can be checked by using
RT(reverse transcriptase)-PCR, Northern blot analysis, or Western blot analysis.
10
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B7.2. (1 point) Evaluate whether the following description is true or false for a plant expression vector
in general?
Description
I.
It should include the selection marker gene that is needed for selecting the
transformed cell.
II.
It should include a promoter that can express the introduced gene within the plant cell.
III.
It usually contains a multiple cloning site used for insertion of the foreign gene.
IV.
It should have the same nucleotide sequence with the specific part of the plant genome
because the foreign gene is inserted by homologous recombination.
V.
It should have the replication origin needed for cloning during the process of making
the recombinant vector.
11
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B8. (1.5 points) Caulobacter bacteria undergo a special cell division. Division of the mother cell results
in two different daughter cells: a roaming (r) cell and a pedicle (p) cell. Roaming cells permit
Caulobacter to spread out. Pedicle cells stay and use the pedicle to stick at that place. The picture
below shows how roaming and pedicle cells divide.
The division cycle period when starting with a roaming cell (r = 90 min) is longer than when starting
with a pedicle cell (p = 60 min). The extended length of period (r) is because the roaming cell
A. produces more DNA than the pedicle cell.
B. produces a pedicle before division.
C. produces a flagellum during division.
For each of the above explanations, indicate with a checkmark () on the answer sheet whether it is
true or false.
12
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B9. (2 points) In the experiment described below, cells (1) were put in a medium with a salt concentration
lower than the cytoplasm, causing them to swell and rupture at one location (2). Ruptured cells were
then washed out and resealed to form ghosts (3). This process also produced smaller vesicles whose
membrane was either right-side-out (4) or inside-out (5), depending on the ionic conditions of the
solution used for the disruption procedure.
Prepared ghosts/vesicles were then mixed with a radioactive labeling reagent that is water-soluble and
could covalently attach to proteins (3~5). The proteins embedded in the membrane were then
solubilized with detergent and analyzed by SDS polyacrylamide-gel electrophoresis. Segregated
proteins were visualized by Coomassie Blue staining (I) and autoradiography (II).
13
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
14
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Subcellular organelles and their cellular components can be easily separated by the
size-fractionating differential centrifugation method, as depicted below. During the process, four
pellets (nucleus and 1~3) are formed.
The table below shows descriptions about subcellular organelles collected in different centrifugation
pellets.
Pallets
Description
Nucleus
Pellet 1
Pellet 2
Pellet 3
15
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Provided that the subcellular structures are not disrupted during the centrifugation process, determine
whether descriptions A, B and C of different subcellular structures in the same pellets are true or false
taking above information as a reference. Mark the appropriate box with a checkmark () in the answer
sheet.
Pellet
Description
Pellet 1
Pellet 2
Pellet 3
16
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B11. (2 points)
The SalI and XhoI restriction map of a 5 kb linear DNA molecule is shown below.
The 3.5 kb DNA fragments obtained from a XhoI digestion were ligated with the 1.0 kb DNA
fragments obtained from a SalI digestion. The resulting 4.5 kb DNA molecules were digested with
SalI. Write down all the different lengths of DNA fragments you can get from this digestion. (Assume
that restriction enzymes completely cut all the DNA molecules, and ignore blunt-end ligation.)
17
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
The following graphs show the quantitative change in DNA content at each of four
18
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B13. (2 points) A transgenic Arabidopsis plant (2n) has a total of two copies of a kanamycin-resistant
gene in its nuclear genome, one on chromosome 1 and the other on chromosome 3. For each
description of this plant, indicate with a checkmark () in the answer sheet whether the description is
true or false.
Description
I. All pollen grains of this plant have kanamycin-resistant genes.
II. Endosperms formed by self-fertilization of this plant have 0~6 copies of the
kanamycin-resistant gene.
III. If seeds from self-fertilization of this plant are germinated, the ratio of kanamycin-resistant
to kanamycin-sensitive seedlings is 3 to 1.
IV. A cell containing 4 copies of the kanamycin-resistant gene exists among root cells at
prophase of mitosis in this plant.
19
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B14. (1.5 points) Figure a shows an ABA signal transduction pathway in a guard cell. Figure b shows
changes occurring after ABA treatment in (1) the cytoplasmic Ca2+ concentrations of guard cell and (2)
stomata aperture size.
For each description about ABA action, indicate with a checkmark () in the answer sheet whether the
description is true or false.
Description
I.
With ABA treatment, Ca2+ is moved from outside of the guard cell into the cell interior.
II.
With ABA treatment, the concentration of K+ is increased in the cytoplasm of guard cells.
III.
20
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B15. (3 points)
however, many proteins in the chloroplast are encoded from genes in the nuclear genome.
B15.1. (1.2 points) For each property of chloroplast DNA, indicate a checkmark () in the answer sheet
whether the property is similar to that of prokaryote or eukaryote genomic DNA.
Property
I. The DNA is a circular double strand.
II. Introns are found.
III.
21
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B15.2. (1.8 points) Protein X, a thylakoid lumen protein, is transcribed in the nucleus and translated in
the cytoplasm. Next, the protein is translocated into the stroma of the chloroplast by signal peptide
I. In the stroma, signal peptide I is cleaved, and the remaining protein is targeted to the thylakoid
lumen by signal peptide II. In the thylakoid lumen, signal peptide II is cleaved, and the remaining
polypeptide III is usually observed.
Several recombinant vectors of protein X are transformed into the nuclear genome and expressed.
For each recombinant vector, fill the blanks in the 2nd column with the cellular location (A~D)
where the expressed proteins are mainly observed. Fill the blanks in the 3rd column with the
polypeptides (E~H) observed in that location.
B. Stroma
C. Thylakoid membrane
D. Thylakoid lumen
I-II-III
F.
I-III
G.
22
II-III
H.
III
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
different concentrations of IAA (an auxin) and kinetin (a cytokinin). In nature, Agrobacterium, a soil
bacterium, induces crown gall tumors on the roots of legume plants. The bacterium induces these
tumors by integrating its T-DNA into the plant genome and by expressing a group of genes necessary
for gall formation (Figure b).
B. Rooty callus
C. Undifferentiated callus
D. Propagation-deficient callus
Gene mutation
I. Deletion of iaaH, overexpression of ipt.
II. Overexpression of iaaH, deletion of ipt.
III. Deletion of iaaH and ipt.
23
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Plant root cell type is determined by the division and differentiation of a particular
stem cell (meristematic cell). Figure a shows the whole microscopic structure of a longitudinallysectioned Arabidopsis primary root. Figure b is an enlarged diagram corresponding to a region of the
inset in Figure a, showing the arrangement of root primordia (stem cells).
Fill in the table to best match the listed function with the correct root cell type (1~6 in Figure a) and
with the corresponding initial cell (7~11) in Figure b.
24
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B18. (1.5 points) The figures below show the inner structures of pine and persimmon seeds.
Indicate with a checkmark () whether the following statements are true or false.
I.
II.
Structures a and b are the same in ploidy, but they differ in genetic composition.
Structures a, b, and c consist of two different sporophytic structures and one
gametophytic structure.
III.
Structures x and y are the same in both ploidy and genetic composition.
IV.
V.
25
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B19. (1.8 points) Human blood can be separated into three parts using a table top centrifuge, as shown
in the following figure.
Of these blood parts (a~c), select the part that contributes most to the listed functions of blood.
Answer by placing a checkmark () in the appropriate box in the answer sheet.
Function
I. Antibody production.
II. Transport of carbon dioxide.
III. Transport of iron.
IV. Transport of oxygen.
V. Formation of blood clot.
VI. Neutralizing snake venom.
26
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B20. (2.2 points) The picture depicts the adult human skeleton and the table lists different types of
joints.
B20.1. (1.2 points) Choose the type of each joint by placing a checkmark () in the appropriate box in
the answer sheet.
B20.2. (1 point) For each statement concerning the function of joints and bones, indicate with a
checkmark () whether the statement is true or false.
Function
I. The joint between the skull and the first cervical vertebra enables the rotation of the
head.
II. The fibula, as well as the tibia, plays an important role in supporting the body weight.
27
morphological characters.
B21.1. (1.2 points) Choose the 4 key morphological characters from the following list and write their
numbers in the left-hand column of the table in the answer sheet.
Morphological character
1. Cirri,
2. Brain,
3. Pharyngeal slits,
4. Gills,
5. Notochord,
6. Intestine,
8. Anus,
9. Tail.
B21.2. (1.2 points) The morphological characters of a lancelet (Branchiostoma) are shown in the
illustration below. Find each of the morphological characters that you listed in the table (from
B21.1) - write the corresponding letter code in the right-hand column of the table in the answer
sheet.
28
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B22. (2 points)
The graph below depicts the pressure changes in an aorta, left ventricle, and left atrium
that occur concurrently during the mammalian cardiac cycle. Below the graph are sketches of the
heart illustrating blood flow and valve state (opened/closed).
Match each numbered event in the cardiac cycle graph with the letter of its corresponding heart sketch.
Write the corresponding letter code in the right-hand column of the table in the answer sheet.
29
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Fig. I shows the relationship between weight and the specific metabolic rate of the
indicated animal species, and Fig. II shows the O2 consumption rate of the indicated species as a
function of running speed (on a treadmill machine).
30
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Read each of the following explanations, and indicate with a checkmark () in the answer sheet
whether the explanation is true of false.
Explanation
A. At rest, smaller animals consume more energy per weight than the bigger animals
consume.
B. Using the same amount of food per body weight, a smaller animal can travel a longer
distance than a bigger animal can travel.
C. Using the same amount of food, bigger animals generate more ATP than the smaller ones
generate.
31
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
If an astronaut lived on a heavier and larger planet than Earth, he would experience
stronger gravitational forces. In that case, what would you expect to happen in this astronauts body?
For each symptom listed below, indicate with a checkmark () whether the symptom is expected or
unexpected.(Assume that the composition of the atmosphere of the planet is the same as that of Earth.)
Symptom
32
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
The following dissection figure shows the blood vessels in liver tissue. The three main
Following statements describes properties of blood that flows through particular blood vessels. For
each description, indicate with a checkmark () in the appropriate box with matching vessel where
that blood would be found.
Description
I. Blood with the highest oxygen content.
II. The blood shows the first increase in lipid content after the meal.
III. The blood shows the first increase in glucose content after the meal.
33
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B26. (3 points) A Korean professor, Charlie Shin, was bilingual, such that he is fluent in Korean and
English. He was also good at communicating using sign language. Unfortunately, he had a stroke
while taking part in discussions at the 2010 IBO International Jury meeting. Dr. Oliver diagnosed that
Charlie had damage in his left cerebral cortex which controls some part of his language output area
and whole arm areas.
B26.1. (1 point) A novice nurse examined Charlies language ability. Select a correct diagnosis among
below.
A. Charlie had difficulty in understanding Dr. Olivers talk.
B. Charlie had difficulty in understandings of the 2010 IBO theoretical questions written on a
paper.
C. Charlie had a hard time to understand a word LOVE written on his back by Dr. YT Kim.
D. Charlies ability to speak Korean fluently had disappeared.
E. Charlies ability to write Korean poems with his right hand remained intact.
B26.2. (1 point) The ability of Charlies sign language and the movement of upper extremity were also
carefully examined by Dr. Oliver. The results showed that he was also incapable of proper
execution of sign language expression in either arm and of moving his right arm. What can we
conclude from this?
A. The damaged language area is responsible for both sign as well as spoken language.
B. Motor neurons in the right cerebral cortex govern the muscles of the right side.
C. The language comprehension region is located in the right hemisphere.
D. His visual system is also damaged.
E. His sign language expression with left arm is normal.
34
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B26.3. (1 point) A brain-machine interface (BMI) study using a monkey was reported in the Science
journal. An array of micro-wire recording electrodes was implanted in associative, arm movement
planning area in the frontal cortex of a normal monkey. During upper arm movements
electromyogram (EMG), recordings were taken from upper extremities, and at the same time
neural recordings were made from implanted recording electrodes in the frontal cortex.
Correlations between EMG and neural signals were obtained every 200 msec and used as
commands for robot arm movement. The monkey intentionally controlled the robot arm with
almost 100% success rate, without using arm muscles. Evaluate whether the following would be
true or false if this BMI technology is used for human.
Description
I
II
III
It is more difficult to design prosthetic robot fingers than a robot arm using this kind
of BMI technology.
IV
The described BMI technology can be classified as a motor (output) BMI, while
artificial cochlea can be classified as an sensory (input) BMI.
35
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B27. (3 points) A spinal nerve has four different kinds of axons carrying out physiological functions like
muscle contractions and cutaneous sensory, thermal and pain sensations. Myelinated, large-diameter
axons carry motor information, while unmyelinated, small-diameter axons carry pain information. An
electrophysiological experiment was carried out using an isolated rat spinal nerve. Four different
intensities of electrical stimulation were delivered to the nerve. Since the stimulation caused
simultaneous activation of all axons in the nerve, including both small and large diameter axons, we
observed different peaks (a to d) in the compound action potential (CAP) traces on an oscilloscope.
The averaged post-stimulus time delays of these CAP peaks were: a, 2 ms; b, 2.5 ms; c, 12 ms; and d,
55 ms. The length of the spinal nerve was 10 cm.
B27.1. (1 point) Calculate the conduction velocity (m/sec) of the CAP peak a.
36
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B27.2. (1 point) After the middle part of the nerve is exposed to a local anesthetic that blocks Na+
channels, which of the following is expected to occur?
A. The height of all CAP peaks is reduced.
B. The post-stimulus time delays of all CAP peaks are shortened.
C. Peaks are reduced and delays are shortened selectively in CAP peaks c and d.
D. Peaks are reduced and delays are shortened selectively in CAP peaks a and c.
E. Peaks are reduced and delays are shortened selectively in CAP peaks b and c.
B27.4. (0.5 point) Which CAP peak is responsible for muscle contractions?
37
The figures below present the skeletal structures of Tetrapod anterior limbs. In the
figure, (a) corresponds to an early amphibian limb. The numbers and letter codes with each limb
represent different bones as indicated in the legend under the figure.
H: Humerus,
M: Metacarpals,
U: Ulna,
R: Radius,
S: Sesamoid bone,
38
C: Carpals,
1~5: Phalanges.
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B28.1. (1.8 points) Among the following statements, decide which statements are true or false?
I.
(c) and (e) show loss or fusion in the skeletons as compared to the ancestral
condition.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
VI.
B28.2. (0.9 point) Which of the anterior limbs in the figure above show adaptation for flight or no
adaptation for flight? Indicate with checkmarks () in the appropriate box the answer sheet.
39
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
ETHOLOGY
B29. (3 points)
In matriphagy, a spider female is cannibalized by her offspring who attack and eat her
body, when they reach a specific age. The young then live in a group for a short time period and
disperse from the nest individually after the third molt. However, some mothers avoid matriphagy. If a
mother is not eaten by the first clutch, there is a 30% probability that she will be able to produce a
second clutch. The table presents demographic data for this species.
Clutch size
at emergence
Survival rate at
rd
the 3 molting
Body mass
Survival rate
at dispersal
from emergence
until
reproductive age
100
95%
3.5 mg
20%
100
70%
2.0 mg
10%
40
95%
3.5 mg
20%
B29.1. (1 point) If spiders avoid matriphagy and attempt to produce a second clutch, what is the total
clutch size, on average, that these spiders would produce?
40
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B29.2. (1 point) Calculate and write down the reproductive success of the two strategies in which a
female spider
(i)
B29.3. (1 point) From an evolutionary perspective and given the constraints above, which behavior
would be selected for?
A. The female does not allow matriphagy because the behavior decreases her survivorship.
B. The female leaves the nest before emergence of the young from the egg sac.
C. The female is eaten by its second clutch after leaving the first clutch just before
matriphagy.
D. The female is eaten by its first clutch.
E. The female does not produce the offspring which cannibalize the mother.
41
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B30. (2.6 points) Honeybee workers (Apis species) perform dances to transmit information about the
distance and direction of the food source.
B30.1. (1 point) What is the primary sensory mechanism involved in this communication between
colony members in the nest?
A. Acoustic
B. Gustatory
C. Olfactory
D. Tactile
E. Visual
42
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B30.2. (1.6 points) The figure below shows the location of 8 food sources (1~8) relative to the hive.
The next figure shows a waggle dance pattern for food source 1. The dotted line indicates the
direction of gravity.
Match each food source direction with its corresponding waggle dance pattern in the following
figures.
43
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B31. (1.5 points) Over a number of generations, two strains of rats were selected in a normal environment
for their increased or decreased maze-learning ability: Maze-bright rats vs. 'Maze-dull rats. For the
experimental test, rats from each strain were reared in three environments that differed in the amount
of visual stimuli present: restricted, normal, and enriched. The graph below shows the behavioral
performance of adults in terms of the number of errors committed in running a maze for the
maze-bright and maze-dull rats.
Mark whether each of the conclusions below is true or false by putting a checkmark () in the
appropriate box in the answer sheet.
Conclusion
I.
This experiment proves that selection for a behavioral trait leads to genetic differences
between strains.
II.
If the two strains of rats are raised in a normal environment, the two strains make a
similar number of errors.
III.
This experiment shows that exposure to visual cues during early development
influences behavioral performance in adult rats.
IV.
The threshold amount of visual stimuli that markedly improves adult behavioral
performance is different for maze-dull and maze-bright rats.
44
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B32. (2 points)
determination. The Y chromosome determines maleness in humans, but not in Drosophila. Instead,
sex determination in Drosophila depends on the ratio of the number of X chromosomes to the number
of autosomal haploid sets in an individual fly.
The table below describes five mutants whose sex-chromosome complements and haploid sets of
autosomes differ from the normal condition.
Indicate with a checkmark () the sex phenotype of all the mutant flies.
Sex-chromosome complement
XXY
XXX
XXXY
XX
45
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B33. (2.4 points) The following statements concern evolutionary patterns of animal morphological traits.
Mark whether each statement is true or false by putting a checkmark () in the appropriate box on the
answer sheet.
Statements
I. Evolution is invariably a phenomenon with direction; therefore, morphological
complexities evolved from simplicities.
II. Genetic mutations always lead to morphological changes.
III. Increases in animal body size are not universal within evolutionary lineages.
IV. Morphological changes of individuals do not result from allometric growth, the
differential growth of body parts.
V. Chordate species are more similar in the embryonic stages rather than in the adult stages.
VI. Phylogenetic analyses have revealed trends of morphological evolution in some lineages.
46
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B34. (3 points)
The following tables present results of plant crosses involving three linked genes: F is a
flower-color gene, S is a seed-color gene, and L is a plant-height gene. Each gene has two alleles with
one allele exhibiting complete dominance over the other allele. Dominant phenotypes are red flowers,
yellow seeds, and tall plants; recessive phenotypes are white, green, and short, respectively. Assume
that crossing-over between two genes occurs once.
Parents
Red flower /
White flower /
Red flower /
White flower /
Yellow seed
Green seed
Green seed
Yellow seed
F1 phenotypes
Frequency of F1
0.49
Parents
0.49
0.01
0.01
Tall height /
Short height /
Short height /
Yellow seed
Green seed
Yellow seed
Green seed
0.51
0.24
0.24
0.01
F1 phenotypes
Frequency of F1
B34.1. (0.9 point) Indicate with a checkmark () in the answer sheet whether each description is true
of false.
Description
I.
II.
III.
S is closer to L than to F.
Some of F1 plants with tall height / green seed are due to crossing-over.
Crossing-over occurs at prophase of meiosis I.
47
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B34.2. (0.8 point) How many genotypes can be observed in F1 plants having tall height/yellow seed?
B34.3. (1.3 points) Calculate the map unit between gene L and gene S. (One map unit = distance of 1%
recombination)
48
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B35. (2 points) Shown below is a pedigree for the genetic trait PKU (phenylketonuria) that is caused by
a recessive mutation of the PAH gene (that encodes phenylalanine hydroxylase). Under the pedigree
is the RFLP (Restriction fragment length polymorphism) pattern of each individual for the PAH gene.
II-2 individual has the PKU.
B35.1. (1 point) The RFLP phenotype for individual II-2 is not given. From the gel shown below
(A~D), choose all the patterns that would be a correct match for II-2.
B35.2. (1 point) The RFLP phenotype for individual II-4 is not given. From the gel shown below,
determine whether each molecular phenotype (A~D) could be a possible match for II-4.
<Example>
49
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B36. (2 points) 105 cells of a triple-mutant yeast strain (leu his trp ) were spread either on minimal
medium or on minimal medium supplemented with various combinations of histidine, leucine, or
tryptophan. The cultures were grown at either 25 or 37 for 3 days. Colony numbers in each plate
were counted, and the data are listed in the following table.
Number of colonies
Supplements
added on minimal medium
25
37
None
None
None
His, Trp
None
None
Leu, His
Leu, Trp
Confluent
11
Confluent
Confluent
B36.1. (1 point) What kind of mutation most probably causes the his phenotype?
A. Conditional mutation
B. Deletion mutation
C. Point mutation
D. Missense mutation
E. Nonsense mutation
50
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B36.2. (1 point) What type of mutation most probably causes the leu phenotype?
A. Conditional mutation
B. Deletion mutation
C. Point mutation
D. Missense mutation
E. Nonsense mutation
51
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B37. (2 points)
Human ABO blood type is determined by two genes (H and I). First, the H gene codes
for the antigen precursor. The dominant allele (H) leads to expression of the precursor; the recessive
allele (h) does not. Second, the I gene has three allele forms, IA, IB and i, and determines blood type
(A, B, O or AB).
A male with blood type A and a female with blood type B marry. Each of them is heterozygous for
both the H gene and the I gene. What is the probability of having a son with blood type O? Give your
answer as a percentage (%) rounded to an integer (without any decimals).
52
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B38. (2 points)
The presence of a beard on some goats is determined by the B (beard) gene, which has
two alleles: beardless (B+) and bearded (Bb). The Bb allele is dominant in males but recessive in
females. F1 progeny were born from a cross between a beardless male and a bearded female; F 2
progeny were produced by crossing two F1 individuals.
F1 F1
F2
Mark whether each statement is true or false by putting a checkmark () in the appropriate box on the
answer sheet.
Description
A. F1 females have beards.
B. One half of F2 progeny have beards.
C. One fourth of F2 females have beards.
D. The beard gene is sex-linked.
E. The beard gene is inherited according to Mendel's principles.
53
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B39. (3 points)
You sequence a 16 bp DNA molecule with the Sanger DNA sequencing procedure.
Shown below is the high resolution electrophoretic pattern of the fragments. As you can see, the
ddCTP lane was damaged.
B39 .1. (1 point) Indicate with a checkmark(() which of the following components are required in the
reaction mixture containing ddGTP?
Component
A. DNA polymerase
B. Primer
C. dATP
D. dGTP
E. Template DNA to be sequenced
54
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B39.2. (1 point) How does the absence of a 3-OH group in ddNTPs affect DNA synthesis?
55
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B40. (2 points)
Answer the next two questions using the genetic code table provided below.
B40.1. (1 point) Which of the following mutations would create new template DNA from which the
shortest peptide would be translated?
5-
ATG
GCT
GGC
AAT
CAA
CTA
TAT
TAG
-3
3-
TAC
CGA
CCG
TTA
GTT
GAT
ATA
ATC
-5
13
16
sequence
Nucleotide number
10
56
19
22
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B40.2. (1 point) A series of point mutations occurred in a bacterial gene, resulting in the substitution of
amino acid residues in the order shown in the diagram below.
Which amino acid in the diagram can have more than one option for its codon given this particular
process of point mutation?
A. Gly
B. Arg
C. Ile
D. Leu
E. Lys
57
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B41. (2 points)
Suppose you have a population of flour beetles with 1,000 individuals. Normally the
beetles are a red color; however, this population is polymorphic for a mutant autosomal body color,
black, designated by b/b. Red is dominant to black, so B/B and B/b genotypes are red. Assume the
population is in HardyWeinberg equilibrium, with f(B) = p = 0.5 and f(b) = q = 0.5.
B41.1. (1 point) What would be the expected B and b allele frequencies, respectively, if 1,000 black
individuals migrated into the population? (Assume that all other HardyWeinberg conditions were
met.)
B41.2. (1 point) What would be the frequencies of B and b alleles respectively, if a population
bottleneck occurred and only four individuals survived: one female red heterozygote and three
black males?
58
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
ECOLOGY
B42. (2 points)
Island biogeography theory states that the number of species on an island is determined
by immigration rates of new species to the island and extinction rates of species on the island.
Immigration rates to an island decline as its distance from the mainland increases, and extinction rates
decrease with increasing island size. When the immigration and extinction rates on an island are equal,
the number of species on the island reaches equilibrium.
Give the correct equilibrium number of species (S1~S4), in the answer sheet, for each of four islands
with different combinations of distance (near and far) and area (small and large) as shown in the
figure above.
59
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B43. (2 points)
The contents of 3 soils (a, b, and c) were examined for soil pH and amounts of acidic
cations (H+, Al3+) and other cations (Ca2+, Mg2+, K+, Na+). The figure below shows the results of that
examination: the white and shaded portions of each column represent the amount of acidic and other
cations, respectively. (Values given are in units of centimoles/kg.)
For each description below, indicate with a checkmark () whether it is true or false.
Description
I. Aluminum toxicity tends to be most severe in soil a.
II. Soil b contains the most nutrient minerals plants can use.
III. Anions such as NO3- and PO4- tend to be retained in soil more than cations are retained.
IV. As more H+ displaces other cations, the soil becomes more acidic.
60
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
The figure below shows standing biomass pyramids of two ecosystems, each with
B44.1. (1.2 point) Which of the following explanations are true or false? Indicate with a checkmark ()
in the answer sheet.
Explanation
I.
Pyramid a reflects energy losses due to respiration within trophic levels and energy
losses during energy transfer between trophic levels.
II.
Pyramid b represents an ecosystem with fast turnover in the primary producer level.
III.
For each ecosystem, its energy pyramid is opposite to its biomass pyramid.
IV.
For both ecosystems, production efficiency becomes higher as the trophic level
increases.
B44.2. (1 point)
Assuming an ecological efficiency of 10% between trophic levels, how much net
primary productivity is required to harvest 2 g C/m2 annually from the tertiary consumer level?
61
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Recent changes in the mean global temperature are largely attributed to increases in
levels of some atmospheric gases and aerosols (small particles suspended in air), many of which have
been generated by human activities.
B45.1. (0.8 point) Evaluate whether the following statements are true or false in relation to the role of
these gases and aerosols changing global temperature.
I.
II.
III.
IV.
Regardless of the presence of gases or aerosols, solar radiation itself has increased
recently.
62
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B45.2. (2 points) For each statement below, choose from the following list of gases the one that is most
likely to be related to that description.
<List of gases>
a. Hydrofluorocarbons (HFCs)
d. N2
b. CH4
c. CO2
e. O3
f. N2O
Description
I. The gas largely derived from fossil fuels and clearing of forests that contributes the
most to global warming.
II. The gas with the highest global warming potential (compared to CO2).
III. A gas that in the stratosphere is essential to support human life on earth, while in the
troposphere it exerts harmful effects on humans.
IV. A gas that is not thought to contribute to global warming.
V. A gas derived from landfills and the livestock sector that has increased most rapidly in
the past 200 years.
63
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B46. (2 points) The picture shows a schematic representation of the production of three well-known trees
of a deciduous forest. The production is indicated in kg dry mass per hectare per year.
Calculate how much of the total production comes from above ground woody parts.
Give your answer as a percentage (%) rounded to an integer (without any decimals).
64
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
BIOSYSTEMATICS
B47. (2 points)
Figures a and b show the characteristics of a cactus from the American desert and a
spurge from the African desert, respectively. An evolutionary mechanism has been proposed to
explain the morphological similarities between these nonrelated species. That same evolutionary
mechanism has been reported to operate at the DNA sequence level.
a. Cactus
b. Spurge
Which of the molecular evolutionary trees shown in Figure c is the best molecular model of the
morphological evolutionary mechanism that we observe in the cactus and spurge? The symbols A, C,
G, and T on the molecular evolutionary trees represent DNA bases.
A. Tree (a), 1 with 4.
B. Tree (b), 1 with 2.
C. Tree (c), 1 with 5.
D. Tree (c), 2 with 3.
65
B48. (2 points)
The following figure represents a recent phylogenetic tree for the animal kingdom.
Carefully observe the tree topology, and answer the following questions.
B48.1. (1 point) What are the most appropriate synapomorphic characters for the numbers (1) and (2),
respectively? Mark appropriate boxes with a checkmark ().
A. Segmented body
B. True tissue differentiation
C. Embryogenesis
D. Bilateral symmetry
E. Exoskeleton development
66
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B48.2. (1 point) Which of the following groups are members of Deuterostomia (taxon number (3))?
A. Echinodermata, Arthropoda.
B. Echinodermata, Chordata.
C. Mollusca, Arthropoda.
D. Annelida, Mollusca.
E. Chordata, Mollusca.
67
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B49. (2 points) The Influenza A virus is responsible for annual flu epidemics and for occasional flu
pandemics. Influenza A has a genome composed of eight RNA strands that encode a total of 11
proteins. Influenza A strains can be classified based on the combination of two coat proteins,
Hemagglutinin (H1~H13) and Neuraminidase (N1~N9). In this way, various flu types such as H1N1,
H3N1, H7N2, etc. can be recognized. The virus strains also can be classified by the host animal. The
following figure represents the phylogeny of flu viruses based on the nucleoprotein gene of the flu
virus genome. Indicated for each viral strain is the host species from which it was isolated, the year,
and the type of Hemagglutinin and Neuraminidase it carries. Indicate with checkmarks ().
whether
I.
The avian flu virus consists of the most diverse types, and some avian flu types also are
found in some mammalian species such as whales and dolphins. Therefore, the avian flu
virus represents the most archaic type of flu virus.
II.
The phylogenetic tree suggests that the host shift and genetic recombination of flu virus
have occurred between birds and pigs.
III.
The virulence of virus can be changed rapidly by host shifts and mutations. Therefore,
vaccine developments are relatively difficult compared to other common diseases.
IV.
Swine flu strains are phylogenetically more closely related to the human flu strains than to
other strains.
68
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
69
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Following table summarizes the main characteristics of the four major phyla of seed
Check () in the answer sheet whether each characteristics is absent () or present (+) for
A~E.
Development of
Character
Flagellated
Double
Vessel in
Flowers
sperm
fertilization
xylem
and fruits
the secondary
Phylum
xylem
Cycadophyta
Ginkgophyta
Pinophyta
Magnoliophyta
70
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
All organisms use carbon as well as energy in order to live and function. Organisms
can be divided into four nutrition modes based upon the species main sources of energy and of
carbon.
B51.1. (1.2 points) From the following list of nutrition modes, fill in the answer sheet with the correct
term corresponding to each combination of carbon and energy source.
<Nutrition mode>
I. Photoautotroph,
II. Chemoautotroph,
III. Photoheterotroph,
IV. Chemoheterotroph.
B51.2. (1.2 points) From the list of organisms provided, choose two organisms belonging to each
nutrition mode.
<Organisms>
a. Cyanobacteria,
d. Fungi,
e. Most archaebacteria,
f. Most plants,
g. Animals,
h. Nitrifying bacteria.
71
IBO2010 KOREA
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B52. (2 points)
The following figure represents a recent phylogeny for the plant kingdom.
For each number (1)~(4), select the appropriate apomorphic trait from the list provided.
72
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
B
C
Brain
Liver
Heart muscle
Skeletal muscle
Adipose tissue
Mutant
II
III
IV
Description
True
II
III
false
Description
True
False
I
II
III
IV
B7. (2 points)
B7.1 (1 points = 0.2 5)
Explanation
True
II
false
III
IV
Description
True
II
III
False
IV
Explanation
True
False
B9. (2 points)
True
False
B11. (2 points)
1.0, 3.5 kb
Graphs
Cellular activity
and response
I
II
III
Description
True
I
II
III
IV
False
Description
True
False
II
III
B15. (3 points)
B15.1 (1.2 points = 0.3 4)
Property
Prokaryote
Eukaryote
II
III
IV
Recombinant gene
Cellular location of
Observed polypeptides
expressed proteins
I-II-III
I-III
II-III
III
Gene mutation
Callus phenotype
A
II
III
Characterization
11
B. Storage parenchyma
C. Perception of gravity
10
True
I
II
False
III
IV
Function
I
II
III
IV
V
VI
10
Labels in
Types of joint
the Figure
Function
true
False
II
11
Heart
E
C
A
D
12
Explanation
True
False
Symptom
Expected
B
C
E
F
Unexpected
13
Blood vessel
Description
A
I
II
III
B26. (3 points)
B26.1 (1 point)
B26.2 (1 point)
14
Description
True
II
III
False
IV
B27. (3 points)
B27.1 (1 point)
50
m/sec
B27.2 (1 point)
d
15
True
I
II
III
IV
V
VI
False
16
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
B29. (3 points)
B29.1 (1 point)
112
17
(i)
20
(ii)
12.4
B29.3 (1 point)
18
True
False
II
III
IV
Mutant
Male
Female
19
True
False
II
III
IV
V
VI
B34. (3 points)
B34.1 (0.9 point = 0.3 3)
True
False
I
II
III
4
20
20
B35. (2 points)
B35.1 (1 point)
B35.2 (1 point)
Possible
Impossible
B36. (2 points)
B36.1 (1 point)
21
B36.2 (1 point)
B37. (2 points)
22
Description
True
False
A
B
22
B39. (3 points)
B39.1 (1 point = 0.2 5)
Required
A
Not required
B39.2 (1 point)
B39.3 (1 point)
23
B40. (2 points)
B40.1 (1 point)
B40.2 (1 point)
B41. (2 points)
B41.1 (1 point)
0.25
0.75
B41.2 (1 point)
0.125
0.875
24
Small island
Large island
S3
S4
S1
S2
Description
True
II
III
IV
False
25
True
I
II
False
III
IV
B44.2 (1 point)
2000
g C/m2
True
I
II
False
III
IV
26
Description
Gas (a~f)
II
III
IV
B46. (2 points)
49
B47. (2 points)
27
B48. (2 points)
B48.1 (1 point)
(1)
(2)
B48.2 (1 point)
True
False
I
II
III
IV
28
En
Energy source
Oxidation of inorganic molecules
Light
CO2
II
Organic molecules
IV
III
Carbon source
Organisms
Nutrition mode
nutrition
I
II
III
IV
29
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
30
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT AND ANIMAL SYSTEMATICS
Total Points: 50
Duration: 90 minutes
Dear Participants,
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed
items is missing, please raise your hand.
Stop answering and put down your pencil immediately after the end bell rings. The supervisor will
collect the Question Paper and the Answer Sheet.
Good Luck!!
TASK I. (25 points) Reconstruct the phylogenetic tree of six plant species
using parsimony method
This task is composed of 4 parts.
Plant taxa (species)
A, B, C, D, E, and F.
Plant materials
Each set consists of the following materials:
1) The flowers of six species preserved in 70% ethanol (Flowers A-F).
2) The fruits of six species preserved in 70% ethanol (Fruits A-F).
3) Six dried flowering specimens (Flowering specimens A-F).
4) Six dried fruiting specimens (Fruiting specimens A-F).
5) Three prepared pollen slides (Each slide contains the pollen grains of two species,
labeled A-B, C-D and E-F.).
Instruments
Stereomicroscope (20X), microscope (400X), razor blade, dissecting forceps, dissecting
needles (2), petri-dishes (2), 20-cm ruler.
Part I-1. (9 points) Using the suggested materials and methods in Table 1, observe the
following 10 characters. Enter each character state in the Data Matrix 1. Each
character state should be recorded as the appropriate number (0, 1, or 2) based
on the following descriptions. Figure 1 is provided as a reference of the
descriptive terminology.
Table 1. Character descriptions for plants (See Figure 1 for illustration of the character states for
the character 1, 2, 4, 7, 8, 9 and 10.)
No
1.
Character
Flower petal
2.
1:
Polypetalous
0:
Corymb or umbel
1:
Raceme
2:
Axillary or terminal
0:
Longer than 1 cm
1:
Shorter than 1 cm
0:
Superior
1:
Half-inferior
2:
Inferior
0:
Shrub
1:
Tree
Trichomes on
the fruit surface
0:
Hairless
1:
Densely haired
0:
0:
Cylindrical or circular
with emarginated tip
(Dia.<1 cm)
Circular with pointed tip
(Dia.< 1 cm)
Circular-elliptic with
pointed tip (Dia. 1 cm)
Pome or capsule
1:
Drupe
0:
Tetrad
1:
Monad
0:
Entire or undulate
1:
Serrate or dentate
Inflorescence
3.
Fruit stalk
4.
Ovary position
5.
Habit
6.
7.
Character state
0: Sympetalous
1:
2:
8.
Fruit types
**9
Pollen grains
.
10.
*If
**
Leaf margin at
maturity
Materials
Flowers
Methods
Naked eye
Flowering specimens
Naked eye
Fruiting specimens
Naked eye
Flowers
Dissect with
razor blade,
Stereomicroscope (20X)
Given answer
Given answer
Fruiting specimens
Naked eye
Naked eye
Fruits
*Dissect
Pollen slides
Fruiting specimens
with
razor blade,
Naked eye
Microscope
(400X)
Naked eye
the endocarp is hard, carefully remove exocarp and mesocarp to identify the fruit type.
Figure 1. continued
Q1. (9 points) Fill the empty cells of Data Matrix 1 on your Answer Sheet. The sheet consists of
6 x 10 cells. Taxon F and character 5 are already filled for your reference.
Character
10
Taxa
Part I-2. (4 points) Refer to your completed Data Matrix 1 to answer the following questions
Q2.1. (1 point) Indicate with checkmarks () which of the characters are phylogenetically
informative.
Q2.2. (1 point) Indicate with checkmarks () which of the characters are polymorphic (more
than two states).
Q2.3. (2 points = 1 2) Use the following numerical formulae to define the number of
possible trees for a given number of taxa (n).
The number of possible unrooted trees = (2n-5)!/2n-3(n-3)!
The number of possible rooted trees = (2n-3)!/2n-2(n-2)!
The symbol ! in the formulae indicate the factorial.
What is the numbers of rooted and unrooted trees in this case?
Part I-3. (8 points) Cladistic analysis can be used to construct a phylogenetic tree of this
species group. The primitive character state (plesiomorphy) is hypothesized to be
the same as the state found in the outgroup F. Therefore, the character state 0
represents the primitive state for all given characters. Any change in state from
that primitive trait is considered to be a derived character state, representing an
evolutionary event (apomorphy). The character states of 1 and 2 represent
derived condition. In this analysis, all characters are given equal weight. Tree
construction is done in a step-by-step process. Place the appropriate character
numbers and group members on the tree at each step.
Q3.1. (1 point) The initial Tree 1 can be created if we separate the ingroup (A, B, C, D, E)
from the outgroup (F) using the two characters that distinguish all members of the
ingroup (shared derived traits) from the outgroup F.
Identify these two characters (a and b) shown in Tree 1 and write them in the Answer
Sheet. Character state should be given in parenthesis if the character is a polymorphic
one.
Q3.2. (2 points) The step-by-step method to create the final tree from this initial tree can be
illustrated by the concept of membership. Analysis proceeds to progressively less
inclusive groupings supported by other derived characters. A less inclusive group(s) can
be separated from the more inclusive group by the supported character change(s) on the
tree. In the second step, the five ingroup taxa can be further divided into two subgroups
(GI and GII) based on three synapomorphic characters.
Identify the subdivided species group members of GI and GII and the three character
numbers (c, d and e) shown on Tree 2 and write them in the Answer Sheet. Character
state should be given in parenthesis if the character is a polymorphic one.
Q3.3. (3 points) The group II (GII) can be further divided into two less inclusive subgroups
(GII1 and GII2) by four and one synapomorphic character(s), respectively.
Identify the members of GII1 and GII2 and write the corresponding character numbers
(shown in locations f-j in Tree 3) in the Answer Sheet. Character state should be given in
parenthesis if the character is a polymorphic one.
10
Q3.4. (2 points) At the final stage of tree construction, all autapomorphic (singly derived)
characters should be located on the tree, and any conflicting characters should be
adjusted using the parsimony principle. There are two autapomorphic characters (l and
m) and only a single conflicting character (k) in this case.
List the taxon name for each of the five ingroup species on the fully resolved Tree 4, and
give the character numbers that correspond to k, l and m, respectively, in the Answer
Sheet. Character state should be given in parenthesis if the character is a polymorphic
one.
11
Part I-4. (4 points) Use the complete phylogenetic tree to answer the following questions.
Q4.1. (1 point) What is the number of character changes (steps) on the maximum parsimonious
tree?
Q4.2. (1 point) The consistency index (CI) is defined as the minimum number of character
state changes required in an absolutely consistent tree (all character states changed only
once) divided by the observed number of character state changes in the final tree.
What is the CI of the final Tree 4?
Q4.3. (1 point) What is the maximum number of genera that can be recognized from the final
tree if taxa C and D are congeneric species?
Q4.4. (1 point) How many monophyletic groups can be recognized from the final tree?
12
TASK II. (18 points) Reconstruct the phylogenetic tree of six insect species
using the Unweighted Pair Group Method with Arithmetic mean
(UPGMA) method
Insect materials
Pinned and dried specimens of six beetles, labeled T1~T6.
Experiment tools
Insect stage, ruler, stereomicroscope (20X)
Note: Please be careful. Do not break the legs or antennae of the beetle specimens. There will
be three point deduction penalty if you break the parts of any specimen.
Most insect specimens and their parts can be observed directly from the plastic case
after removing the cover.
13
Part II-1. (8 points) The character states are defined in Table 2. Carefully observe the
morphological characters of the beetle specimens using the naked eye and the
stereomicroscope. Then, complete the Data Matrix 2. Figure 2 is provided as a
reference for the Coleoptera body parts.
No.
Longitudinal
discontinuous
ridges on elytra
0: Present
Methods
Stereomicroscope
1: Absent
2.
Horns on head
and pronotum
0: Absent
Naked eye
1: Present
3.
Compound eye
4.
Mandible length
5.
Antennae length
Stereomicroscope
Naked eye
7.
Antennae shape
0: Filiform or serrate
Antennae
Naked eye
1: Elbowed
8.
Hind tarsi
0: 5 segments
Stereomicroscope
1: 4 segments or less
*9.
Notopleural
sutures of the
prothorax
0: Fused
Given answer
1: Not fused
*10.
0: Separated
Given answer
1: Not separated
*11.
Food preference
0: Zoophagy or
saprophagy
1: Phytophagy
Given answer
14
Q5. (8 points) Complete the Data Matrix 2 in your answer sheet. The sheet consists of 6 x 11
cells. Characters 9, 10, and 11 are already filled in.
Data matrix 2.
Character
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
C10
C11
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Taxa
15
Part II-2. (3 points) Create a character difference matrix between all possible pair-wise
taxa from the completed Data Matrix 2. The difference value (Dij) between
taxon i and j is the sum of the character (C) numbers for which Ci Cj.
Calculate the difference values, and fill the table below (Difference Matrix 1).
The values of three pair-wise comparisons (T1/T2, T3/T4, and T5/T6) are
already provided as examples.
Q6. (3 points) Complete the following Difference Matrix 1 on your answer sheet.
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
16
Part II-3. (7 points) Construct a phylogenetic tree based on the UPGMA algorithm using
the pair-wise difference matrix that you created in Part 2. During the procedure,
you will create nested clusters of taxa (smaller clusters into larger clusters) using
successive difference matrices and phenograms until you construct a single
cluster. The order for clustering is: 1) Pick the smallest entry Dij. 2) Join those
two species into a cluster, 3) Compute new distances from that cluster to the
other taxon k, using the Unweighted Pair Group Method with Arithmetic mean
(UPGMA). A new distance between a new species k and a cluster (i and j) is
defined as D(k(ij)) = (1/2)((D(ki)+D(kj)). Repeat the clustering process 1) ~ 3) to
create the next cluster. This process should be continued to construct a single
cluster for the entire group.
Q7.1. (1 point) Two alternate initial trees (a and b) can be constructed from the Difference
Matrix 1 as shown below. Combine the two alternative trees and draw as a single tree
(Tree 1). Draw Tree 1 on your Answer Sheet.
Initial Trees a and b: (T1, T2, T3, T4, (T5, T6)) or (T1, T2, (T3, T4), T5, T6)
a
17
Q7.2. (2 points) Complete the Difference Matrix 2. Calculate new difference values
between cluster and taxon (or between cluster and cluster) using UPGMA algorithm and
fill the cells in the answer sheet. Find the taxon pair(s) that shows the lowest difference
values and make a newly clustered tree (Tree 2). Draw the tree in the answer sheet.
Difference Matrix 2:
Dij or Dk(ij)
T1
T2
T(3,4)
T(5,6)
T1
T2
T(3,4)
T(5,6)
Q7.3. (2 points) Complete the Difference Matrix 3. Again calculate the new difference
values between cluster and taxon (or between cluster and cluster) using UPGMA
algorithm and fill the cells in the answer sheet. Find the taxon pair that shows the lowest
difference values and make a newly clustered tree (Tree 3). Draw the tree in the answer
sheet.
Difference Matrix 3:
Dij or Dk(ij)
-
18
Q7.4. (2 points) Complete the Difference Matrix 4. Calculate the new difference values
between cluster and cluster using UPGMA algorithm and fill the cells in the answer
sheet. Make a complete clustered tree (Tree 4) and draw it in the answer sheet.
Difference Matrix 4:
Dij or Dk(ij)
-
19
Q8. (3 points) If the insect species T2, T3, and T5 feed on the plant species E, D, and A,
respectively, what kinds of plant species are fed upon by insect species T1, T4, and T6,
respectively?
Q9. (2 points) Which plant and insect species pair shows different phylogenetic positions in the
trees?
Q10. (2 points) Which are the two best possible reasons to explain the differences between the
insect and plant phylogenies? (Select the two best answers).
A. Host shift of insect species
B. Adaptive radiation of plant species
C. Genetic bottleneck during the insect species evolution
D. Different tree reconstruction methods
E. Genetic drift of plant species
20
PRACTICAL TEST 1
Answer Sheet
PLANT AND ANIMAL SYSTEMATICS
Total Points: 50
Duration: 90 minutes
10
10
Q2.1. (1 point)
Character
Number
Phylogenetically
informative
Q2.2. (1 point)
Character
Number
10
Polymorphic
Q2.3. (2 points = 1 x 2)
The number of possible unrooted trees: ___________
The number of possible rooted trees: ____________
Part I-3. (8 points) Character state should be given in the parenthesis if the character
is polymorphic one.
Q3.1. (1 point)
Character numbers
Character a and b
Q3.2. (2 points). Character number and taxon name will be assign one point, respectively.
Character numbers
Character c, d
and e
Taxon name(s)
GI
GII
Q3.3. (3 points)
Character number(s)
Taxon name(s)
Character f
GII1
Character g, h, i
and j
GII2
Q3.4. (2 points)
Character number
Taxon name
Character k
GI
Character l
GII1a
Character m
GII1b
GII2a
GII2b
Q4.2. (1 point)
CI =
Q4.4. (1 point)
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
C10
C11
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Q7.2. (2 points)
Difference Matrix 2
Dij or Dk(ij)
T1
T2
T(3, 4)
T(5, 6)
T1
T2
T(3, 4)
T(5, 6)
Tree 2
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Q7.3. (2 points)
Difference Matrix 3:
Dij or Dk(ij)
-
Tree 3
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Q7.4. (2 points)
Difference Matrix 4
Dij or Dk(ij)
-
Tree 4
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Plant Species
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Q9. (2 points)
Insect species
Plant species
Q10. (2 points)
A
PRACTICAL TEST 1
Answer Key
PLANT AND ANIMAL SYSTEMATICS
Total Points: 50
Duration: 90 minutes
10
10
Taxa
Polymorphic
10
105
945
Part I-3. (8 points) Character state should be given in the parenthesis if the character
is polymorphic one.
Q3.1. (1 point)
Character a and b
1, 9
Q3.2. (2 points)
Character numbers
Character c, d
and e
4(1), 8, 10
Taxon name(s)
GI
GII
A, B, C, D
1. 1 point for Character numbers. (Deduct 0.3 point per wrong answer. Both character
number and state should be correct for characters c,d, and e.)
2. 1 point for Taxon name(s) (0.5 point for GI, 0.5 point for GII)
Q3.3. (3 points)
Character number(s)
Taxon name(s)
Character f
7(1)
GII1
A, B
Character g, h,
i and j
2(2), 3, 6, 7(2)
GII2
C, D
Taxon name
Character k
GI
Character l
4(2)
GII1a
Character m
2(1)
GII1b
GII2a
GII2b
1. 1 point for Character number(s) of characters k~m. (Deduct 0.3 point per wrong
answer. Both character number and state should be correct.)
2. 1 point for Taxon name. (0.2 point per box.)
Part I-4. (4 points)
Q4.1. (1 point)
14
steps
Q4.2. (1 point)
CI = 13/14
1. Any decimals possible. (0.92857..)
Q4.3. (1 point)
4
Q4.4. (1 point)
5
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
C10
C11
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
1. 1 point per each character. (Deduct 0.15 point per box with wrong number.)
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Q7.2. (2 points )
Difference Matrix 2
Tree 2
(1 point = 0.2 5)
Dij or Dk(ij)
T1
T2
T(3,4)
T(5,6)
T1
T2
T(3,4)
T(5,6)
Q7.3. (2 points)
Difference Matrix 3
Dij or Dk(ij)
T1
T(2(3,4))
T(5,6)
T1
T(2(3,4))
5.5
T(5,6)
4.5
Tree 3
Q7.4. (2 points)
Difference Matrix 4
(1 point = 0.2 5)
Dij or Dk(ij)
T1
T(2(3,4),(5,6))
T1
T(2(3,4),(5,6))
5.75
Plant Species
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
Q9. (2 points = 1 2)
Insect species
Plant species
T2
Q10. (2 points)
A
PRACTICAL TEST 2
PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Total Points: 49
Duration: 90 minutes
Dear Participants,
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed
items is missing, please raise your hand.
If you have any problem with your computer, raise your hand.
Stop answering and put down your pencil immediately after the end bell rings. The supervisor will
collect the Question Paper and the Answer Sheet.
Note: All animals used in the pictures and the described experiments were treated according
to guidelines approved by the institutional animal care and use committee and
conformed to the NIH guidelines on care and use of animals in research.
TASK I. (25 points) The response of the rat cerebral cortex to skin stimulation
Press
The primary somatosensory (S1) cortex receives tactile information from a specific body
surface region. These specialized receptive areas in the human brain is shown in Figure 1. A
similar body representation within the rat S1 (Fig. 2) will be created from these experiments.
Press
or
1.
Background information
1.1 Skull immobilization with brain exposure
The stereotaxic device is used to immobilize the skull (Fig. 3). The incisor bar is adjusted to
make the skull surface horizontal (Fig. 4). Following a scalp incision, a hole is drilled in the skull
over the location of S1, and a recording electrode (a red, moving needle) is inserted into the brain
(Fig. 5). A micro-driver is used to move the electrode downward (25 m/step) from the surface
into the brain (Fig. 6).
Press
or
Press
or
action potentials are accumulated to produce a histogram (Fig. 13). In the histogram, the X-axis
stands for time (ms) before (-), the exact moment of (0), and after (+) stimulation. The Y-axis
represents the mean firing rate (Hz) within the recorded neuron.
Press
or
Press
or
Table 2.2
Fig.
Depth
Area of
S1 response to
S1 Response to
(number of steps)
skin stimulation
skin stimulation
joint movement
18
0-30
Broad
Weak
no
19
31-48
Tip
Strong
no
20
49-60
Broad
Weak
strong
Press
or
Response of S1 neuron
Cursor on 21
No conspicuous spike
Cursor on 22
Strong (2 mA)
Q1. (1 point) Based on the results of mechanical and electrical stimulation, which of the
following statements is correct?
A. The strongest response to mechanical stimulation is observed in neurons at 0.50.75 mm deep from the surface.
B. Neurons at a depth of 0.775-1.2 mm respond to the smallest skin area.
C. Neurons at a depth of 0.775-1.5 mm respond only to skin touch.
D. The thickness of the S1 cortex is less than 1mm.
E. The firing rate (Hz) of S1 neurons has no correlation with stimulus intensity.
Q2. (1 point) Calculate the minimum (p) and maximum (q) velocities (unit: m/sec) of
information transmission from the digit to the S1.
Q3. (1 point) During the period of 6-15 ms after stimulation, what is the net increase in the mean
value (
Cursor on 23
No conspicuous spike
Cursor on 24
Strong (2 mA)
Response of S1 neuron
Q4. (2 points) Based on the results of before and after the antagonist application, which of the
following statements is correct?
A. The net increase in the mean firing rate (Hz) of the first peak in histogram 24 is about
2.14 times of that of the peak in histogram 22.
B. After the antagonist application, the mean firing rates (Hz) always increase regardless of
stimulation intensity.
C. The GABA antagonist inhibits excitatory synaptic activity in the S1.
D. Based on histogram 24, a net increase in the mean firing rate (Hz) for the first peak is 4.5
times of the one for the second peak.
E. The second peak in histogram 24 is not associated with S1 processing of the cutaneous
input from the digit.
Press
or
Q5. (1 point) Based on neural response before anesthesia (Fig. 29), choose the correct statement.
Case
Neurons
Locations a, b and c
2nd digit
3rd digit
Locations a, b and c
4th digit
3rd digit
Location b
4th digit
2nd digit
During 3rd digit stimulation, neurons at locations a and c have longer response
durations than neuron at location b.
Location a
4th digit
Other digits
Q6. (1 point) Based on neural response before anesthesia (Fig. 29), choose the correct statement.
A. All three neurons respond to 4th digit stimulation.
B. A single S1 neuron responds to the stimulation of only one digit.
C. Neurons at location a respond to the stimulation of more of the hindpaw digits than
neurons at location b.
D. Neurons at location c respond to the stimulation of more of the hindpaw digits than
neurons at location b.
E. All three neurons receive convergent sensory information from two or more digits.
Q7. (1 point) Based on the responses shown by the neurons in all three locations in Figs. 29 and
30, choose the incorrect statement.
Case
Location of stimulation
Timing of response
Magnitude of response
2nd digit
Increased
3rd digit
Decreased
4th digit
Increased
application
digit
Q8. (2 points) Based on the response after anesthesia (Fig. 30), select an appropriate inference.
A. The drug is absorbed into the blood and is transferred to the S1.
B. The drug has changed the structure of peripheral nerve branches.
C. Neuronal response is not altered after local anesthesia.
D. The drug causes reversible, temporary changes in S1 neuronal synapses.
E. The change in response after anesthesia is due to newly-synthesized proteins within the
S1.
Press
or
10
4. S1 body map
4.1 Normal S1 map
Following repeated stimulation/recording procedures, the normal S1 body map (Fig.
31) is obtained (Note: the electrode is moved along the x or y axis by the distance of
0.5 mm). If the computer cursor is laid on each symbol (, , , ), the
abbreviation for appropriate body surface is shown as a note and, at the same time,
the
equivalent
body
Abbreviations
fl
forelimb
position
fp
forepaw
fpd 1-5
fm
forelimb muscle
hl
hindlimb
hp
hindpaw
hpd 1-5
hm
hindlimb muscle
trunk
mv
mystacial vibrissa
rv
rostral vibrissa
forelimb
The
hindlimb
will
following
provides
anatomical
be
table
the
term
for
trunk
vibrissa
11
in the figure.
Q9. (5 points = 0.5 10) Find the following points (n=10) from Fig. 31 and fill in the
blanks with
abbreviations (i.e., notes within the boxes of the screen) for body surfaces.
Q10. (1point) Based on the answers to Q9, which of the following statements is correct?
A. The fpd4 region is medial to the fpd2 region.
B. The hpd2 region is medial to the hpd4 region.
C. The fl region is rostral to the hp region.
D. The fl region is caudal to the t region.
E. The mvB2 region is lateral to the mvA3 region.
Q11. (1 point) Based on the normal S1 map, what can you conclude about the following areas?
Case
Smaller area
Larger area
Trunk (t)
Trunk (t)
12
Q12. (1 point = 0.5 2) In the hindlimb region, S1 neurons receiving sensory information overlap
with the motor neurons that cause muscle contraction. Find a coordinate (unit: mm) which
supports this observation.
Press
or
Q13. (4 points = 0.5 8) Put the cursor on the corresponding spots within Figs. 32 and 33, and
notice where the post-amputation response is different from the normal response. For the
locations where alterations occurred, fill in the appropriate table boxes with the
abbreviations (i.e., notes within the boxes of the screen) for the digit numbers (you will fill
in 4 boxes on each table, for a total of 8 boxes).
Normal
hpd4 amputated
lateral
lateral
2.8
2.8
2.6
2.6
2.4
2.4
13
2.2
(mm)
2.2
0.6
0.8
1.0
(mm)
1.2
0.6
0.8
caudal
1.0
1.2
caudal
Q14. (1 point) What changes occurred in the S1 body map after digit amputation?
Case
Became responsive to
hpd3
hpd2
hpd3
hpd2 or hpd5
hpd4
hpd2
hpd4
hpd3 or hpd5
hpd5
hpd2 or hpd3
Press
or
14
Q15. (2 points) Based on Figs. 33, 34, and 35, choose the incorrect statement.
A. An increase in neuronal excitability is observed at 1 week after amputation.
B. An increase in neuronal inhibition is observed 4 weeks after amputation.
C. In the normal state, the S1 body map is maintained by a balance between excitatory
sensory input and local inhibition within the cortex.
D. During 1-4 weeks after amputation, the balance between excitatory input and local
inhibition is always maintained.
E. Electrophysiological changes at 4 week after amputation are accompanied by biochemical
and histological changes in S1 tissue.
Press
Lets dissect a spider and be a Spiderman!
15
Caution:
Handle carefully, because only one spider will be provided for each student.
Please note that the vials are labeled Venom gland, Silk gland, Heart, and Book lung in
English.
Q16. Both spiders and insects are members of phylum Arthropoda. In general, insects have two
kinds of eyes; compound eye and single eyes (ocelli). Examine the spider specimen
carefully under the microscope and answer the following questions.
Q16.1. (2 points) Record the types and total number of the spider's eyes.
Q16.2. (2 points) Generally, spiders eyes are arranged around its head in two distinct rows; i.e.
the anterior and posterior rows. Within each row, the inner pair of eyes are designated
as medial, while the outer pair is described as lateral (Table 1). Each eye is defined
using two anatomical terms: anterior vs. posterior and medial vs. lateral. Examine the
specimen and draw the relative position of eyes in the figure on the Answer Sheet.
Label the drawn eyes with specific codes given in Table 2.
16
Posterior
opposite of anterior
Medial
Lateral
AME
ALE
PME
PLE
Q17. Spiders can be divided into two suborders based on the positions of the cheliceral fangs.
Using the forceps, examine the movement of the spider fangs under the dissecting
microscope. Then, answer the following questions.
17
Q17.2. (1 point) The fang forms an articulation (or joint) with the chelicerae. What type of
joint is the articulation?
A
Plane joint
Pivot joint
Hinge joint
Saddle joint
Ball-and-socket joint
Q18. (1 point) As arthropods, spiders have segmented bodies with jointed limbs. The head is
composed of several segments that fuse during development. Being chelicerates, their
bodies consist of two segments the cephalothorax and the abdomen (Figure 1).
Which of the following (1~4) correctly represents the segmental differentiation of the
cephalothorax in spiders compared to Trilobite, an ancient chelicerate?
18
Eye
Eye
Eye
Eye
Eye
A
L
Body
Body
Body
Body
Body
Trilobite
<Abbreviations>
A: Antenna,
C: Chelicera,
L: Leg,
P: Pedipalp
Caution: From now on, you will dissect the internal organs (venom glands, silk gland, heart, and
book lung) of the spider. Using the Ringers solution provided, you need to keep the
dissected organs from drying. You will be scored based on the correctness and the
intactness of the preparation. Points will be deducted when there is a failure to remove
the correct organ.
Q19. Most spiders possess venom that is injected into prey through the fangs of the chelicerae.
Spiders have a pair of venom glands that lie either in the chelicerae or in front of the
cephalothorax (see the diagram of spider in Figure 1). The venom gland consists of an
outermost muscle layer, an underlying secretion layer and a duct. Locate the venom glands
of the spider provided.
19
Q19.1. (2 points) Dissect out the pair of venom glands from the spider and put it in the vial
labeled Venom gland after the following examination. It is not required to separate the
venom glands from the chelicerae.
Q19.2 (1 point) Examine the outermost muscle layer of the venom gland under the microscope.
What is the direction of the muscular orientation?
A
Longitudinal direction
Circular direction
Spiral direction
Bilateral direction
Irregular direction
Q20. (2 points) In most spiders, each leg has several segments and the tip of the last segment has
claws. Remove the 1st and 2nd legs from the spider body. Using the microscope, count the
number of segments and claws on each leg.
Q21. Many spider species exhibit sexual dimorphism. In sexually mature male spiders, the final
segment of the pedipalp develops into a complicated structure that is used to transfer sperm
to the female during mating. This apparatus makes the male palp so enlarged that it is often
described as resembling a boxing glove.
Q21.1. (1 point) Examine the external morphology of the spider specimen provided and
identify the sex of the spider.
20
Q21.2. (1 point) Pedipalps of spiders also have segmentation like the legs. Using the
microscope, count the number of the segments and claws in each pedipalp.
Q22. (1 point) The abdomen and cephalothorax of a spider are connected by a thin waist called
the pedicel, which allows the abdomen to move in all directions (see the diagram of spider
in Figure 1).
Which of the following organ systems does not pass through the pedicel?
A
Nervous system
Respiratory system
Circulatory system
Digestive system
Integumentary system
Q23. The silk-spinning apparatus of the spider is located at the posterior end of the ventral
abdomen. This apparatus is composed of three pairs of spinnerets. Generally, the spinnerets
are arranged in two distinct rows; anterior and posterior. Anatomically, the inner pair of
spinnerets is defined as medial, and the outer pair is lateral (Table 3). Accordingly, the
position of a spinneret is defined using these two positional terms.
21
Q23.1. (1 point) Compare the external morphology of the spinnerets with the following
diagram. Label each spinneret in the answer sheet using the codes given in Table 3.
Position of spinneret
Anterior
AM
Anterior medial
AL
Anterior lateral
Posterior
PM
Posterior medial
PL
Posterior lateral
Q23.2. (1 point) Identify the structure posterior to the spinneret under the microscope .
Anus
Spermatheca
Spiracle
Copulatory organ
Spinneret
22
Q24. Spiders produce various kinds of silk fibers from the silk glands. There are seven gland
types in the specimen provided, each producing a different type of silk (Table 4).
Number of pairs
Connection to spinneret
Numerous
Posterior
Posterior
Anterior
Middle
Numerous
Anterior
Q24.1. (1 point) Dragline silk is produced by the largest silk glands of this spider (Figure 2).
Use the codes in Table 4 to locate the largest silk gland.
23
Q24.2. (2 points) Dissect one complete silk gland which produces dragline silk from this spider.
After dissecting the silk gland, place the organ in the vial labeled Silk gland.
Q25. (2 points) With reference to Figure 1, dissect the heart tube from the abdomen and place it
in the vial labeled Heart.
Q26. (2 points) With reference to Figure 1, locate and dissect one complete book lung. Place the
organ in the vial labeled Book lung.
24
PRACTICAL TEST 2
Answer Sheet
PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Total Points: 49
Duration: 90 minutes
Q4. (2 points)
A
Q5. (1 point)
A
Q6. (1 point)
A
Q7. (1 point)
A
Q8. (2 points)
A
Q10. (1 point)
A
Q11. (1 point)
A
hpd4 amputated
Q14. (1 point)
A
Q15. (2 points)
A
Compound eye
Ocellus
.
Frontal view of the head
Q17.1. (1 point)
A
Q17.2. (1 point)
A
Q18. (1 point)
1
Q19.1. (2 points)
(Place the organ in the provided vial, labeled Venom gland in English)
Q19.2. (1 point)
A
2nd
Number of segments
Number of claws
Q21.1. (1 point)
Sex of the spider provided
Male
Female
leg
Q23.2. (1 point)
A
Q24.1. (1 point)
Code of silk
gland
Q24.2. (2 points)
(Place the organ in the provided vial, labeled Silk gland in English.)
Q25. (2 points)
(Place the organ in the provided vial, labeled Book lung in English.)
7
PRACTICAL TEST 2
Answer Key
PHYSIOLOGY AND ANATOMY
Total Points: 49
Duration: 90 minutes
20
Q3. (1 point)
Hz
40
Q4. (2 points)
A
Q5. (1 point)
A
Q6. (1 point)
A
Q7. (1 point)
A
Q8. (2 points)
A
Q11. (1 point)
A
2.5
2
1. Numbers without hpd are also evaluated as correct answers, because the picture of the rat
contains digit numbers only.
Q14. (1 point)
A
Q15. (2 points)
A
Compound eye
Ocellus
Q16.2. (2 points)
Q17.2. (1 point)
A
Q18. (1 point)
Q19.1. (2 points)
(Place the organ in the provided vial, labeled Venom gland in English)
1. 2 points will be given if you dissect out a pair of venom glands with or without chelicerae.
2. 1 point will be given if you dissect out the chelicerae with one venom gland.
3. 0 point will be given if you dissect incorrect organ.
Q19.2. (1 point)
A
2nd leg
Number of segments
Number of claws
Q21.1. (1 point)
Sex of the spider provided
Male
Female
Number of claws
PL
Q23.2. (1 point)
A
Q24.1. (1 point)
Code of silk
gland
Q24.2. (2 points)
(Place the organ in the provided vial, labeled Silk gland in English.)
1. 2 points will be given if you dissect proper silk gland with both regions of ampulla and tail.
2. 1 point will be given if you dissect proper silk gland with ampulla region only.
3. 0 point will be given if you dissect incorrect silk gland.
Q25. (2 points)
(Place the organ in the provided vial, labeled Book lung in English.)
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS AND CELL BIOLOGY
Total Points: 50
Duration: 90 minutes
Dear Participants,
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed
items is missing, please raise your hand.
Stop answering and put down your pencil immediately after the end bell rings. The supervisor will
collect the Question Paper and the Answer Sheet.
Good Luck!!
Treatment
Label
Treatment
WT-0
WT-1
Plant WT + 1 M hormone H
WT-100
dA-1
Plant dA + 1 M hormone H
dA-100
dAB-1
dAB-100
dABC-1
dABC-100
Handling of Micropipettes
Adjustment method
Turn the plunger to set the volume to the desired value, which can be seen in the display
window. Remember that each micropipette has designated range of volumes as indicated on
the pipette. Do not exceed the limits of this range.
Usage method
1) Secure the pipette tip to the tip holder. Gently push down the plunger to the first stop.
2) Hold and lower the tip down into the solution to a depth of 2~4 mm. Release the plunger
slowly to allow it to return to its original position.
3) Remove the pipette from the liquid, and transfer the contents to the desired tube. Push the
plunger to the first stop and then push further to the second stop to discharge the solution
completely from the tip.
4) Remove the pipette from the tube and release the plunger. Eject the used tip into the tip
disposal container by pressing the tip-ejector.
Usage method
Important: Please be sure not to touch the light path of cuvettes.
1) Press the PWR (
after a beep.
2) To set the blank sample to zero, insert the blank cuvette in an appropriate holder (use cuvette
holder A to measure protein concentration, and cuvette holder B to measure GUS activity).
The cuvette indicator will be turned on (
Note: Two blank samples for measurement of GUS activity and amounts of proteins are
provided in the microfuge tubes labeled as GUS BL and Pro BL, respectively.
3) Press the BL button, and the blank indicator ( ) will appear when the blank is set at 0.0.
4) To measure a sample, remove the blank cuvette and insert the test cuvette in the same
cuvette holder, and press the TS button. The result will be displayed after 5-10 seconds, and
the indicator will appear in the display window ( )
5) To end the machine, keep the PWR button pressed till beep is heard.
2) After verifying that the operation switch of the power supply is OFF, close the migration
tank lid.
Do this as follows:
(1) First, insert the 2 tabs on the cover into the holes in the migration tank.
(2) Then, rotate the cover forward to close it.
5) In this experiment, the gel running time should be 30 min. Make sure to turn the operation
switch OFF when the running is finished.
Part I. (20 points) Using the gene X-fused GUS reporter gene to analyze hormonal effects on
gene expression and to characterize the hormone-responsive elements in the
promoter.
Q1. The purpose of the first experiment is two-fold: (1) to find the promoter region containing a
hormone-responsive cis-element and (2) to investigate the effects of different hormone H
concentrations on gene X expression. All transgenic plants (WT, dA, dAB, and dABC) were
treated with either 1 M or 100 M of hormone H. To assess the level of GUS expression,
plant extracts were prepared from these treated plants. (See the table in the materials and
method section.)
Using the methods described in the next section, measure the fluorescence value and
absorbance at 595 nm of each 50 L plant extracts. Based on these measurements,
calculate the amount of MU (nmole MU/50 L plant extracts), the amount of proteins
(g/50 L plant extracts), and the resulting GUS activity (nmole MU/g protein/min) for
each extract. Record your results in Table 1 in the answer sheet to find answers for Q1.1,
Q1.2, and Q1.3.
1)-6. Calculate the amount of MU in the sample using the formula provided below. Record the
fluorescence value and the calculated amount of MU in Table 1 in the answer sheet. This
is the amount of MU produced from each of 50 L plant extracts.
Y = 0.04 X + 2.5
Y: the amount of MU (nmoles/ 50 L plant extracts)
X: the measured fluorescence value [from step 1)-5]
10
Q1.1. (4 points) Based on your results in <Table 1>, put a checkmark () in the appropriate
box of each plant in Table Q1.1 in the answer sheet.
Note: - stimulation: more than 3-fold increase in gene X expression
- no effect: less than 3-fold increase in gene X expression
Q1.2. (6 points = 2 3) Based on your previous conclusions in Q1.1, determine the regulatory
function (enhancer, silencer, or minimal promoter) of each cis-element (A~C). Put a
checkmark () in the appropriate box in Table Q1.2 in the answer sheet.
Q1.3. (1 point) How does 100 M of hormone H regulate the expression of gene X? Based on
your finding from <Table 1>, determine the mode of action of hormone H. Put a
checkmark () in the appropriate box in Table Q1.3 in the answer sheet.
11
Part II. (15 points) A co-relationship analysis between genotype and phenotype, and the
prediction of gene pool frequencies using Hardy-Weinberg mathematics.
Q2. Gene Y encodes a protein that regulates plant growth. The schematic figure below depicts
the region of gene Y in genomic DNA and a point mutation within.
There are eight plants with homozygous (YY or yy) or heterozygous (Yy) genotype, showing
either wild type or dwarf phenotypes (Y: wild type allele, y: mutant allele. The alleles Y and
y do not specify whether they are dominant or reccessive). To analyze the genotype of these
plants, the
1 kb region of gene Y was amplified by PCR. This fragment was then digested with EcoRI
restriction enzyme, which cuts GAATTC sequence. Other than the EcoRI site created by the
point mutation, there is no other EcoRI recognition sequence in gene Y. Using the protocol
described below, perform a gel electrophoresis of the EcoRI-digested PCR products.
12
(1) A total of ten microfuge tubes are provided: two DNA size marker tubes (M) and eight
tubes containing EcoRI-treated PCR product from Plants 1~8 (P1~P8, respectively).
Starting from left, in the order of M, P1~P8, M, load 20 L out of 50 L DNA solution
into each well of a prepared agarose gel in the electrophoresis apparatus. Use the 20 L
micropipette to load samples. Change pipette tip for each sample.
Note: The DNA size marker solution contains 0.4, 0.6, and 1.0 kb DNA fragments.
DNA loading buffer and DNA-staining dye are already included in each tube.
(2) Refer to <Operating instructions for DNA gel electrophoretic apparatus> to put the cover
on the electrophoresis apparatus, to turn on the apparatus, and to run the electrophoresis.
Note: Upon starting the electrophoresis, make sure that the output indicator LED is lit and
that bubbles are forming on the platinum electrodes.
(3) Run the gel for 30 min at Half voltage.
* IMPORTANT: While the gel is running, proceed to TASK II !!!
(4) Turn off the apparatus. Then, raise the green card to request help for photography of the
agarose gel.
Note: The assistant will bring a gel transfer box to you. Make sure that your student code is
on the box.
(5) When you receive the agarose gel picture, attach it to Q2.1 of the answer sheet using
Scotch tape. Label the number of each plant (P1~P8) on each lane of the gel picture.
(6) In Table Q2.2 in the answer sheet, put checkmarks () to designate the size of DNA
fragments and the genotype of each plant.
13
Q2.1. (3 points) Attach the agarose gel picture to a space given on the answer sheet. And
label the number of each plant (P1~P8) on each lane of the gel picture.
Q2.2. (4 points) Determine the size of DNA fragment(s) and the genotype (YY, Yy or yy)
of each plant. Put a checkmark () in the appropriate box in Table Q2.2 in the
answer sheet.
Q2.3. (2 points) Based on the genotype and phenotype of each plant given in Q2.2, deduce
the characteristic of the mutation. Put a checkmark () in the appropriate box in the
Table Q2.3 in the answer sheet.
Q2.4. (2 points) If you cross Plant 1 with Plant 3 (from Q2.2), what is the probability (%)
that an offspring will be a dwarf plant? Write your answer in the answer sheet.
Q2.5. (4 points) The eight plants in Q2.2 represent a population. If this population produces
10,000 plants in the next generation, what would be the expected number of
heterozygous and dwarf offspring, respectively? (Assume that this population is in
Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium.)
14
TASK II. (15 points) Observation of meiotic cells in preserved rye anthers
Numbers
5 each
6. Forceps
7. Ceramic tile
8. Petri-dish (6 cm diameter)
10. Pencil
11. Eraser
Background
Using a light microscope, you will observe meiotic cells in preserved rye anthers. Anthers
at a specific stage of meiosis were selected and were preserved in 70% ethanol.
15
Requirements Overview
Using the microscope, identify anther cells undergoing meiosis. In the space given in the
answer sheet, sketch an image of meiotic cell you observe at 400X magnification (Q3.2)
Procedure
1) Before you start observation, check for the presence of two small preserved anthers in the
vial.
2) Take out the ceramic tile out of the tray, and put one glass slide on it.
3) Observe your specimen under the microscope at 100X magnification, and find at least one
cell undergoing meiosis. Then, observe one cell at 400X magnification and draw this
image in the given area of the answer sheet (Q3.2). Make sure that this cell is at the center
of your field of view. After you finish drawing, raise the red card. The lab assistant will
come to you and will take a photograph of the slide.
16
Notes :
1. In step (1), if the anthers won't come out, put the solution back into the vial using the
disposable plastic pipet and repeat step (1).
2. Be careful not to break the anther in step (2).
3. You may use a filter paper to remove excess 70% ethanol in step (3).
4. Do not press too hard, or you may break the cells and/or the cover slip in step (7).
5. You are provided with two anthers to prepare your specimen. If you fail to make good
specimen with the first anther, please repeat the procedure and make another
preparation using the other. However keep in mind that the time for your experiment is
limited.
17
Q3.1. (1 point) What kind of cells in the anther undergoes meiosis? Put a checkmark () in the
appropriate box in the answer sheet.
Q3.2. (8 points) Draw one cell undergoing meiosis at 400X magnification in the answer sheet.
Do not label the drawing.
Important : This cell must be at the center of your field of view when the picture is taken.
18
Q3.3. (4 points) At what meiotic stage are the cells? Put a checkmark () in the appropriate
box in the answer sheet.
Q3.4. (2 points) What is the amount of DNA in the cell undergoing meiosis that you observed
and a cell of the anther wall, respectively? Put checkmarks () in the appropriate boxes
in the answer sheet.
19
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Answer Sheet
GENETICS AND CELL BIOLOGY
Total Points: 50
Duration: 90 minutes
<Table 1> GUS expression, after treatment with different concentrations of hormone H, in
transgenic plants containing various deletions within the gene X promoter
Plants
Measured
fluorescence
Amount of MU*
produced by 50 L
Measured
absorobance
Amount of
proteins* in 50 L
GUS activity*
[nmole MU/g
[value from
1)-5]
plant extracts
[nmole MU, value
at 595 nm
[value from
plant extracts
[g, value from
protein/min,
value from 3)-1]
from 1)-6]
2)-3]
2)-4]
WT-0
(control)
WT-1
dA-1
dAB-1
dABC-1
WT-100
dA-100
dAB-100
dABC100
* The calculated values should be rounded to the nearest hundredth.
WT-0
No effect
Control
WT-1
dA-1
dAB-1
dABC-1
WT-100
dA-100
dAB-100
dABC-100
Q1.2. (6 points = 2 x 3)
Function (enhancer, silencer, or minimal promoter)
Region in gene X promoter
enhancer
A
B
C
Q1.3. (1 point)
Action mode
Transcriptional positive feedback regulation
Transcriptional negative feedback regulation
silencer
minimal promoter
Plant
0.6
1.0
Genotype
Phenotype
YY
Yy
yy
Plant 1
Wild type
Plant 2
Wild type
Plant 3
dwarf
Plant 4
dwarf
Plant 5
Wild type
Plant 6
Wild type
Plant 7
Wild type
Plant 8
dwarf
Q2.3. (2 points)
Dominant
Characteristic of the mutation
Recessive
Q2.4. (2 points)
Probability of dwarf offspring
(%)
Q2.5. (4 points = 2 x 2)
Number of heterozygous (Yy) offspring
Number of dwarf offspring
TASK II.
(15 points)
Q3.1. (1 point)
synergid cells
egg cells
megaspore mother cells
Pollen (microspore)mother cells
pollen
antipodal cells
Q3.2. (8 points)
400X
Q3.3. (4 points)
Meiosis I
Meiosis II
Q3.4. (2 points = 1 2)
The amount of DNA
The cell undergoing meiosis
1C
2C
3C
4C
PRACTICAL TEST 3
Answer Key
GENETICS AND CELL BIOLOGY
Total Points: 50
Duration: 90 minutes
Plants
WT-0
Measured
fluorescence
Amount of MU*
produced by 50 L
Measured
Amount of
absorbance at proteins* in 50 L
GUS activity*
[nmole MU/g
[value from
1)-5]
plant extracts
[nmole MU, value
595 nm
[value from
protein/min,
value from 3)-1]
from 1)-6]
2)-3]
plant extracts
[g, value from
2)-4]
600-900
26.5-38.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.04-0.07
WT-1
6,000-9,000
242.5-362.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.34-0.70
dA-1
6,000-9,000
242.5-362.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.34-0.70
dAB-1
600-900
26.5-38.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.04-0.07
dABC-1
600-900
26.5-38.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.04-0.07
WT-100
600-900
26.5-38.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.04-0.07
dA-100
6,000-9,000
242.5-362.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.34-0.70
dAB-100
600-900
26.5-38.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.04-0.07
dABC100
600-900
26.5-38.5
0.5-0.7
51.8-71.4
0.04-0.07
(control)
1. A correct answer for each measurement or calculation within ranges indicated in the
Table 1 is worth of 0.2 point.
WT-0
No effect
Control
WT-1
dA-1
dAB-1
dABC-1
WT-100
dA-100
dAB-100
dABC-100
1. Answers that are not supported by the GUS activity data in Table 1 will be
considered as wrong answers.
2. Plural choices for each hormone-treated plant are null.
Q1.2. (6 points = 2 x 3)
Function (enhancer, silencer, or minimal promoter)
Region in gene X promoter
enhancer
silencer
minimal promoter
1. An answer that is not supported by the data in Table 1 and Q1.1 will be considered
as a wrong answer.
2. Plural choices for each promoter region are null
Q1.3. (1 point)
Action mode
Transcriptional positive feedback regulation
Transcriptional negative feedback regulation
1. The answer that is not supported by the answers for WT-0, WT-1 and WT-100 in
Table 1 and Q1.1 will be considered as a wrong answer.
1. 3 points :
At the least one of the two DNA marker lanes was loaded, together with ALL of
the plant samples.
2. 2 points :
1) Both marker lanes were loaded but one of the plant sample is missing.
Or
2) All plant samples were loaded but both of the marker lanes are missing.
In all cases, electrophoresis should be performed long enough to allow the
genotyping. Otherwise no point will be given.
Plant
0.6
Genotype
Phenotype
1.0
YY
Yy
yy
Plant 1
Wild type
Plant 2
Wild type
Plant 3
dwarf
Plant 4
dwarf
Plant 5
Wild type
Plant 6
Wild type
Plant 7
Wild type
Plant 8
dwarf
Q2.3. (2 points)
Dominant
Characteristic of the mutation
Recessive
Q2.4. (2 points)
Probability of dwarf offspring
50 (%)
Q2.5. (4 points = 2 x 2)
Number of heterozygous (Yy) offspring
3750
4375
TASK II.
(15 points)
Q3.1. (1 point)
synergid cells
egg cells
megaspore mother cells
Q3.2. (8 points)
400X
**
1. 8 points will be given if a cell undergoing meiosis with proper chromosome is drawn
and photo evidence is available.
2. 4 points will be given if drawing is good but photo evidence is not available.
3. 2 points will be given if only anther wall cell(s) were drawn.
4. 0 point will be given if i) no cell is drawn, ii) no chromosomes is discernable, iii)
only cell debris are drawn.
3
Q3.3. (4 points)
Meiosis I
Meiosis II
1. 4 point will be given if the meiotic stage drawn in Q3.2 is correctly checked.
Q3.4. (2 points = 1 2)
The amount of DNA
The cell undergoing meiosis
1C
2C
3C
4C
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ECOLOGY
Total Points: 51
Duration: 90 minutes
Dear Participants,
Write down your results and answers in the Answer Sheet. Answers written in the Question
Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials listed for each task. If any of the listed
items is missing, please raise your hand.
Stop answering and put down your pencil immediately after the end bell rings. The supervisor will
collect the Question Paper and the Answer Sheet.
Good Luck!!
Quantity
Materials
1. Community model board (40 x 37 cm)
3. Electronic calculator
Introduction
A population is defined as a group of individuals of a single species inhabiting a specific
area, and a community is a group of populations of different species inhabiting a specific area.
Identification of the characteristics of populations and communities is a basic element in
predicting ecological change due to environmental factors.
Using Calculator
2 2 , press
52
( 2 x 2 ) ab/c ( 5 x 2 ) =
3. To correct characters, move the cursor by pressing or , and press DEL to delete the
character or SHIFT DEL to insert character
4. To clear all of the calculation you have entered, press AC.
5. Press Shift AC to turn off the calculator. Calculator will automatically turn off if you do
not perform any operation for about 10 minutes.
Q1. (4 points) The model provided on the board is a coastal community consisting of nine animal
species. Determine the population size (abundance, N) of each species in the community
using a complete enumeration survey and the population density (per unit area, 1 m2) of each
species. The size of each quadrat is 1 m x 1 m. Round values to the nearest hundredth (two
decimal places) during your calculations, and record the values in the answer sheet.
Species
Population size
Starfish
Razor clam
Sea slater
15
Sea urchin
Fiddler crab
13
Octopus
Oyster
Mudskipper
Sea anemone
13
Q2. (2 points) The table below records species population sizes in two different coastal
communities. Calculate the proportion of relative abundance of each species. Round
values to the nearest hundredth (two decimal places) during your calculations, and record
the values in the answer sheet.
Community A
Community B
Species
Population size
Species
Population size
Starfish
13
Fiddler crab
Razor clam
18
Barnacle
18
Sea slater
13
Sea anemone
15
Sea urchin
12
Sea cucumber
Fiddler crab
11
Hermit crab
Gastropod
Gastropod
Oyster
12
Mudskipper
Sea anemone
10
Total
106
Total
50
Q3. (4 points) A rank-abundance curve is a chart that displays the species in a community
ordered from most abundant to rare based on relative abundance. Using the relative
abundances you previously calculated (in Q2), make a rank-abundance curve for each
community on the grid-line in the answer sheet. Indicate community A as A and
community B as B on the curve, and write appropriate titles and scales for the X-axis and
the Y-axis.
Q4. (4 points) Calculate the Shannon-Wiener species diversity index (H) for each of the two
coastal communities using the following equation. Round values to the nearest hundredth
(two decimal places) during your calculations. Put the values in the box in the answer sheet.
where,
pi = the proportion of the ith species
ln pi = the natural logarithm of pi
n = the number of species in the community
Q5. (1 point) Which statement is/are correct for your rank-abundance curves? Put checkmark(s)
() in all appropriate boxes in the answer sheet.
A. Species evenness is higher in community A than in community B.
B. Species evenness is lower in community A than in community B.
C. Species richness is higher in community A than in community B.
D. Species richness is lower in community A than in community B.
Q6. (1 point) Which statement is correct for the species diversity index of the two communities?
Put a checkmark () in the appropriate box in the answer sheet.
A. The area with the higher diversity index (H') should be conserved.
B. The species diversity index (H') indicates the species number inhabiting the coastal area.
C. The species diversity index (H') is inversely proportional to species evenness in an area.
D. The species diversity index (H') depends on both species richness and species evenness.
Quantity
Materials
1. Pottery with beads
3. Electronic calculator
Introduction
A few individuals are captured, marked and released back into the population. The population is
sampled again and the numbers of marked individuals in this sample counted. Assuming an equal
recapture rate for all individuals and without repetitive counting of the same individual, the
population size can be simply estimated by using a modified Lincoln Index as follows:
In this task, the pottery represents a pond with a diving beetle population (the beads). One bead
represents one diving beetle. This population contains 40 individuals marked with a red sticker that
had been captured during the first sampling. You will be performing the second sampling of this
population.
Q7. (4 points) Using the sampling net, capture a sample of diving beetles from the pond (the second
sampling). Take two full scoops and combine them. (Assume this population does not have birth,
death, emigration, or immigration of individuals between the first and the second sampling events).
Estimate population size to the nearest tenth (one decimal place) and record your result in the
answer sheet.
Q8. (4 points) The mark and recapture method has a degree of uncertainty because it is an estimation
by sampling, not by a total population count. We can measure uncertainty through the calculation
of standard error (SE). Standard error (SE) can be obtained by the function given below.
The 95% confidence interval can be obtained by this calculation: N t SE. The 95% confidence
interval means that the size of original population is within the range of the confidence interval with
95% certainty. The t-value is the Student's t- value when the degree of freedom is infinity. (At
infinity, the Students t-value is also refer to as Z-value). The critical values of the Student's t
distribution are provided.
Find the appropriate t in the table and calculate SE and the 95 % confidence interval for your
estimate of population size. Enter the numbers you obtain in the table in the answer sheet. Round
your value to the nearest hundredth (two decimal places) during your calculations and record
your values in the answer sheet.
Degree of freedom
0.1
0.05
0.01
0.001
1
2
3
6.31
2.92
2.35
12.71
4.30
3.18
63.66
9.93
5.84
636.62
31.60
12.92
4
5
2.13
2.02
2.78
2.57
4.60
4.03
8.61
6.87
1.94
2.45
3.71
5.96
7
8
9
10
1.89
1.86
1.83
1.81
2.37
2.31
2.26
2.23
3.50
3.36
3.25
3.17
5.41
5.04
4.78
4.59
11
12
1.80
1.78
2.20
2.18
3.11
3.06
4.44
4.32
13
1.77
2.16
3.01
4.22
14
1.76
2.14
2.98
4.14
15
16
17
1.75
1.75
1.74
2.13
2.12
2.11
2.95
2.92
2.90
4.07
4.02
3.97
18
1.73
2.10
2.88
3.92
19
20
21
22
1.73
1.72
1.72
1.72
2.09
2.09
2.08
2.07
2.86
2.85
2.83
2.82
3.88
3.85
3.82
3.79
23
24
1.71
1.71
2.07
2.06
2.82
2.80
3.77
3.75
25
26
1.71
1.71
2.06
2.06
2.79
2.78
3.73
3.71
27
28
29
30
1.70
1.70
1.70
1.70
2.05
2.05
2.05
2.04
2.77
2.76
2.76
2.75
3.69
3.67
3.66
3.65
40
60
120
1.68
1.67
1.66
2.02
2.00
1.98
2.70
2.66
2.62
3.55
3.46
3.37
1.65
1.96
2.58
3.29
10
Quantity
Materials
1. Two species model board (30 32 cm)
3. Electronic calculator
Introduction
Spiral shellfishes and clams live in the same habitat. In order to know whether there is an
interaction between these two species, we examine the distribution of each species in that habitat.
Q9. (2 points) Using the given quadrat board, observe whether the spiral shellfish and the clam are
absent and/or present in each quadrat. Write the number of quadrats you have observed in the box
in the answer sheet.
Q10. (2 points) The significance of the species distributions measured in this habitat can be examined
by using the Chi-square (2) test. The null hypothesis for the 2 test in this situation is that the
distribution of each species:
A. is nonrandom.
B. is independent of each other.
C. shows a mutually negative influence.
D. shows a mutually positive influence.
E. is influenced by a third species.
Put a checkmark () in the appropriate box in the answer sheet.
11
Q11. (4 points) To perform the 2 test, first determine the expected counts for each observational class.
For example, the expected counts of quadrats where both species are present is calculated by
multiplying the number of quadrats where one species is present with the number of quadrats
where the other species is present divided by the total number of quadrats. Compute the other
expected counts similarly to the nearest tenths (one decimal place) and fill the table in the answer
sheet.
Q12. (2 points) Using the function below, calculate the 2 value for this data set. Record your value to
the nearest hundredth (two decimal places) in the answer sheet.
Q13. (1 point) In order to evaluate the Chi-square value (2), the degree of freedom for the data set must
be determined (df). What is the degree of freedom for this data set? Record the value in the answer
sheet.
Q14. (2 points) Decide whether to reject or not reject the null hypothesis using the significance level
(probability, p) of 0.05. In the given 2 table, locate the degree of freedom in the appropriate
column. Compare your calculated 2 test statistic to the tabular 2 value to make your decision. Put
a checkmark () in the appropriate box in the answer sheet.
12
Q15. (1 point) Considering the spatial pattern of the distribution, what kind of interactionis likely to be
taking place between the two species? Choose all possible options and put a checkmark () in the
appropriate box in the answer sheet.
A. No interaction
B. Commensalism
C. Competition
D. Parasitism
E. Exclusion
13
Chi-square Table
Probability, p
Degree of freedom
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
0.99
0.95
0.05
0.01
0.001
0.000
0.020
0.115
0.297
0.554
0.872
1.239
1.646
2.088
2.558
3.05
3.57
4.11
4.66
5.23
5.81
6.41
7.02
7.63
8.26
8.90
9.54
10.20
10.86
11.52
12.20
12.88
13.57
14.26
14.95
0.004
0.103
0.352
0.711
1.145
1.635
2.167
2.733
3.325
3.940
4.58
5.23
5.89
6.57
7.26
7.96
8.67
9.39
10.12
10.85
11.59
12.34
13.09
13.85
14.61
15.38
16.15
16.93
17.71
18.49
3.84
5.99
7.82
9.49
11.07
12.59
14.07
15.51
16.92
18.31
19.68
21.03
22.36
23.69
25.00
26.30
27.59
28.87
30.14
31.41
32.67
33.92
35.17
36.42
37.65
38.89
40.11
41.34
42.56
43.77
6.64
9.21
11.35
13.28
15.09
16.81
18.48
20.09
21.67
23.21
24.73
26.22
27.69
29.14
30.58
32.00
33.41
34.81
36.19
37.57
38.93
40.29
41.64
42.98
44.31
45.64
46.96
48.28
49.59
50.89
10.83
13.82
16.27
18.47
20.52
22.46
24.32
26.13
27.88
29.59
31.26
32.91
34.53
36.12
37.70
39.25
40.79
42.31
43.82
45.32
46.80
48.27
49.73
51.18
52.62
54.05
55.48
56.89
58.30
59.70
14
2. Electronic calculator
Introduction
A foraging animal encounters various types of prey items. Each type of prey can be characterized
by its energy content (E), the time required to search for that prey (searching time, Ts), and the time
required to capture and consume it (handling time, Th). Therefore, we can measure prey profitability
by the function E/(Ts+Th). In this situation, according to optimality theory, natural selection would
favor behaviors that maximize an animals net energy intake per amount of foraging time.
The behavioral options for a forager are whether to accept or to reject an item of a given prey type
when it is encountered. Assume that there are two kinds of prey item, Type 1 and Type 2. Let the
profitability be higher for Type 1 that is, E1/(Ts1+Th1) > E2/(Ts2+Th2). Thus, Type 1 items should
always be accepted. Prey profitability is density-dependant. That is, profitability of a prey species
changes if the prey species becomes less abundant.
On the boards for Site I and Site II, there are three prey items for gulls:
Prey A: Spiral shellfish
Prey B: Clam
15
Q16. (2 points) For Site I, record the density of each of the prey species A, B, C (number of individuals
per m2, assuming that each quadrat is 1m x 1m). Calculate searching time (Ts) for each of the prey
species, where the species-specific searching time at density = 1 has been provided. Ts=
(1/density)a (sec). The value a is a species-specific constant. Calculate the values to nearest
hundredth (two decimal places).
Ts (sec)
Prey species
when the prey density is 1
Prey A
10
Prey B
15
Prey C
Q17. (2 points) After capturing a prey item, gulls fly high and drop the item to break its shell. The
forager repeats the behavior if the shell does not break. The table below indicates the drop height
and the average number of drops required at that height to break the preys shell. For each prey
type, indicate with a checkmark (), in the answer sheet, the optimal drop height that gulls should
choose, if they are optimal foragers.
Height of drop (m)
60
40
20
10
15
Prey A
16
60
20
10
15
30
10
10
15
Prey B
Prey C
Q18. (2 points) Gulls fly one meter up or down in 0.5 seconds. Given the optimal drop height for each
prey species, calculate the handling time (Th) for each prey item. Record the number in the box in
the answer sheet.
17
Q19. (3 points) The table below lists the average energy gain from eating an individual of each prey
species (kilojoules (KJ) per prey). Calculate the profitability of each prey species at Site I to the
nearest hundredth (two decimal places), and record the number in the box in the answer sheet.
Prey species
Prey A
Prey B
25
Prey C
Q20. (2 points) Of the following choices, what would be the optimal decision for the gulls at site I? Put
a checkmark () in the most appropriate box in the answer sheet.
A. Eat all of prey A.
B. Eat all of prey B.
C. Eat all of prey C.
D. Eat prey A at first and then switch to prey B.
E. Eat prey B at first and then switch to prey C.
18
Q21. (2 points) A gull finds an item of prey C in Site II. The gull can, however, decide not to take
this item and fly to Site I where it can search for prey B. Given that Site I requires 50
seconds of flying time from Site II, what should the gull do in order to maximize the
profitability of the next prey item, if it is an optimal forager? Distribution of the prey items in
Site II has been provided to you. Put a checkmark () in the most appropriate box in the answer
sheet.
A. The gull will eat the prey C in Site II.
B. The gull will move to Site I to search for prey B.
C. The gull will search for prey B in Site II.
D. The gull will move to site I to search for prey C.
E. The gull will search for prey A in Site II.
19
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Answer Sheet
ECOLOGY
Total Points: 51
Duration: 90 minutes
Q1. (4 points)
Species
Population size
Starfish
Razor clam
Sea slater
15
Sea urchin
Fiddler crab
13
Octopus
Oyster
Mudskipper
Sea anemone
13
Density
(number of individuals/m2)
Q2. (2 points)
Community A
Species
Population
size
Starfish
Community B
Proportion of
relative
abundance
Species
Population
size
13
Fiddler crab
Razor clam
18
Barnacle
18
Sea slater
13
Sea
anemone
15
Sea urchin
12
Sea
cucumber
Fiddler
crab
11
Hermit crab
Gastropod
Gastropod
Oyster
12
Mudskipper
Sea
anemone
10
Total
106
Total
50
Proportion of
relative
abundance
Q3. (4 points)
Q4. (4 points)
Species diversity index
of community A (H'A)
Q5. (1 point)
A
Q6. (1 point)
A
Q8. (4 points)
t-value
SE
Confidence interval of the estimated population size
Q9. (2 points)
Spiral shellfish
Observed count
Present
Clam
Present
Absent
Q10. (2 points)
A
Absent
Q11. (4 points)
Spiral shellfish
Expected count
Present
Absent
Present
Clam
Absent
Q12. (2 points)
2
Q13. (1 point)
Degree of freedom
(df)
Q14. (2 points)
Fail to reject
Null hypothesis
Reject
Q15. (1 point)
A
Q16. (2 points)
Prey species
Density
2
(number of individuals/m )
Ts (sec)
Ts (sec)
at the Site I
Prey A
10
Prey B
15
Prey C
Q17. (2 points)
Prey A
Height of drop
(m)
60
40
20
10
15
7
7
Height of drop
(m)
60
20
10
15
Height of drop
(m)
30
10
10
15
Prey B
Prey C
Q18. (2 points)
Prey species
Prey A
Prey B
Prey C
Q19. (3 points)
Energy
Prey species
Prey profitability
Prey B
25
Prey C
Q20. (2 points)
A
Q21. (2 points)
A
PRACTICAL TEST 4
Answer Key
ECOLOGY
Total Points: 51
Duration: 90 minutes
Q1. (4 points)
Population size
Density
(number of individuals/m2)
Starfish
15
0.31
Razor clam
20
0.41
Sea slater
15
0.31
Sea urchin
13
0.27
Fiddler crab
13
0.27
Octopus
10
0.20
Oyster
14
0.29
Mudskipper
11
0.22
Sea anemone
13
0.27
Species
1. One point will be subtracted for any error in rounding value and error in decimal
place.
2. In case of calculation error for any value, one point is subtracted for each error.
3. Only one point is subtracted for incorrect answers within each row of the table.
Q2. (2 points)
Community A
Community B
Species
Population
size
Proportion of
relative
abundance
Species
Population
size
Proportion of
relative
abundance
Starfish
13
0.12
Fiddler crab
0.04
Razor clam
18
0.17
Barnacle
18
0.36
Sea slater
13
0.12
Sea
anemone
15
0.30
Sea urchin
12
0.11
Sea
cucumber
0.04
Fiddler crab
11
0.10
Hermit crab
0.10
Gastropod
0.08
Gastropod
0.16
Oyster
12
0.11
Mudskipper
0.09
Sea
anemone
10
0.09
Total
106
Total
50
1. 0.5 point is subtracted for any error in rounding value and error in decimal place.
2. In case of calculation error for any value, 0.5 point is subtracted for each error.
Q3. (4 points)
1. Full points will be given for marks on the appropriate curve, and appropriate titles
and scales for the Y-axis.
2. Full points are given if participant make appropriate graph using data in Q2.
3. For incorrect marks or no marks, 2 points are subtracted.
4. For no title or scales on Y-axis, 2 points are subtracted.
Q4. (4 points)
Species diversity index
of community A (H' A)
2.15
1.51
1. Full points will be given for values between 2.10 2.19 for community A and 1.501.59 for community B.
2. 2 points for each value.
3. 1 point are substracted for each error in rounding value and decimal place.
4. Full Points are given if participant make appropriate calculation using data in Q2.
Q5. (1 point)
A
1. 1 point is given if participant make appropriate answer using the graph of Q3.
2. No point is given if participant mark only one out of both answers.
Q6. (1 point)
A
Participants Value
Participants Value
1. 1 point will be given if the participant wrote the first and second answers.
2. 0.5 point is subtracted if the participant did not round off the numbers.
3. 0.5 point is subtracted if the participant did not record one decimal place or recorded
more decimal places.
Q8. (4 points)
t-value
1.96
SE
Q9. (2 points)
Spiral shellfish
Observed count
Clam
Present
Absent
Present
15
12
Absent
16
Q10. (2 points)
A
1.
Q11. (4 points)
Expected count
Spiral shellfish
Present
Absent
Present
11.6
15.4
Absent
9.4
12.6
Clam
3.96 or 3.89
1. Use the excel table for the evaluation when the answers of Q9 and Q11 are wrong (full
point in the case of exact calculation).
2. Full point is given if the value is within the range of 0.05
Q13. (1 point)
Degree of freedom
(df)
Q14. (2 points)
Fail to reject
Reject
Null hypothesis
Q15. (1 point)
A
Q16. (2 points)
Density
Ts (sec)
Ts (sec)
(number of individuals/m2)
at the Site I
Prey A
1.00
10
10
Prey B
0.75
15
20
Prey C
0.50
10
Prey species
1. 0.5 point is subtracted if the participant did not round off the numbers.
2. 0.5 point is subtracted if the participant did not record one decimal place or recorded
more decimal places.
3. 1 point is subtracted if the participant wrote one or two wrong answer within each row in
the table.
Q17. (2 points)
Prey A
Prey B
Prey C
Height of drop
(m)
60
40
20
10
15
Height of drop
(m)
60
20
10
15
Height of drop
(m)
30
10
10
15
Q18. (2 points)
Prey species
Prey A
80
Prey B
35
Prey C
30
Prey species
Prey profitability
Prey A
0.08
Prey B
25
0.45
Prey C
0.13
Q21. (2 points)
A
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
5. Use pencils and erasers. You can use a scale and a calculator provided.
6. Some of the questions may be marked DELETED. DO NOT answer these questions.
7. Stop answering and put down your pencil IMMEDIATELY after the end bell rings.
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Student Code:
___________
3. Use pencils and erasers. You can use a ruler and a calculator provided.
4. Some of the questions may be marked DELETED. DO NOT answer these questions.
5. The maximal points of Part A is 81 (1.5 point each question).
6. Stop answering and put down your pencil IMMEDIATELY after the end bell rings.
GOOD LUCK!!
1
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Cell Biology
A1. Which treatment is most effective in breaking as many hydrogen bonds as possible in an
aqueous solution (pH 7.0) of 1 mg/mL DNA and 10 mg/mL protein?
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A2. For the elongation of biopolymer molecules, there are two basic mechanisms, as shown
below. In Type I elongation, the activation group (marked with an X) is released from the
chain of growth. In Type II elongation, the activation group is released from the unit
which is coming into the chain of growth. By which of these mechanisms are DNA (D),
RNA (R),and protein (P) biosynthesized?
Type I
Type II
(D)
(R), (P)
(P)
(D), (R)
none
(R), (P)
(D)
(D), (R)
(P)
none
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A3. The movement of a ciliated protozoan is controlled by a protein called RacerX. When
this protein binds to another protein, Speed, found at the base of the cilia, it stimulates
the cilia to beat faster and the protozoan to swim faster. Speed can only bind to RacerX
after phosphorylation of a specific threonine residue. How would you expect the mutant
protozoan to behave if this threonine residue in Speed is replaced by an alanine
residue?
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
APP
-secretase -secretase
A- (-amyloid)
Fibrils
Low oligomers
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A. Only I, II, IV
B. Only I, II, III
C. Only I, III, IV
D. Only II, III, IV
E. I, II, III, IV
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A. 1/2
B. 1/4
C. 1/8
D. 1/16
E. 1/32
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A6. In 1961 Mitchell proposed a highly original explanation for ATP synthesis, which he
called the chemiosmotic coupling model. Which of the following is correct?
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A8. Which of the following are true for the relative permeabilities of human red blood cells
and artificial phospholipid bilayer vesicles (called artificial vesicles hereafter) to glucose
and ethanol?
I. Both red blood cells and artificial vesicles are more permeable to glucose than to
ethanol.
II. Both red blood cells and artificial vesicles are more permeable to ethanol than to
glucose.
III. In both red blood cells and artificial vesicles, the permeability to ethanol is almost
the same as that to glucose.
IV. While red blood cells and artificial vesicles show almost the same permeability to
glucose, red blood cells have a higher permeability to ethanol than artificial
vesicles.
V. While red blood cells and artificial vesicles show almost the same permeability to
ethanol, red blood cells have a higher permeability to glucose than artificial
vesicles.
A. I, IV
B. I, V
C. II, IV
D. II, V
E. III, IV
F. III, V
10
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A9. A previously unknown organism that lacks nuclear membrane and mitochondria has just
been discovered. Which of the following would this organism most likely possess?
A. Lysosome
B. Cilium
C. Endoplasmic reticulum
D. Chloroplast
E. Ribosome
11
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A10. In eukaryotic cells, the oxidative phosphorylation reactions are catalyzed by various
enzymes. Which of the following is correct?
A. All of these enzymes are coded in nuclear DNA, synthesized in ribosomes and
imported into mitochondria.
B. Some of these enzymes are coded in mitochondrial DNA. Their messenger RNA is
exported outside mitochondria and the enzymes are synthesized in ribosomes.
The enzymes are then imported back into mitochondria.
C. Some of them are coded in mitochondrial DNA and synthesized in mitochondrial
ribosomes.
D. All of them are coded in mitochondrial DNA and synthesized in mitochondrial
ribosomes.
E. A copy of mitochondrial DNA is exported outside mitochondria. The synthesized
enzymes are imported into mitochondria.
12
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A. Nucleoli
B. Mitochondria
C. Golgi apparatuses
D. Nuclear pores
E. Chloroplasts
F. Peroxisomes
13
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A12. The recognition sequence for the restriction endonuclease AvaI is CYCGRG, where Y
is any pyrimidine and R is any purine. What is the expected distance (in bp = base pairs)
between the restriction sites of AvaI in a long, random DNA sequence?
A. 4096 bp
B. 2048 bp
C. 1024 bp
D. 512 bp
E. 256 bp
F. 64 bp
14
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A13. The arabinose operon of Escherichia coli is not expressed in the absence of arabinose.
This is attributable to the AraC protein, which binds to the promoter of the arabinose
operon and acts as a suppressor to prevent its transcription. Normally the arabinose
operon is expressed in the presence of arabinose. In mutants that lack the AraC gene,
however, the arabinose operon is not expressed even in the presence of arabinose.
Based on this information, which of the following can be reasonably inferred with respect
to AraC?
15
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A14. Nucleotide sequence duplications in a gene cause severe effects on its function in
some cases while they do not in other cases. Which of the following duplication events
would most likely result in the synthesis of a non-functional protein?
16
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A15. Cell walls of vessels and tracheids of vascular plants contain a phenolic polymer called
"lignin", which together with cellulose confers mechanical strength to these
water-conducting tissues. If vessels/tracheids are deficient in lignin, they:
17
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A16. The following micrograph shows a part of the transverse section of the stem of a dicot
plant. Which arrow indicates the direction towards the center of the stem?
18
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A. xerophyte
B. mesophyte
C. halophyte
D. hydrophyte
E. epiphyte
19
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A18. To examine the effect of phytohormones P1 and P2 in plant tissue culture, leaf
segments were excised from plants grown under the light, placed on medium that
contained P1 and/or P2, and cultured in the dark. As a control experiment, leaf segments
were cultured without P1 or P2 in the dark.
(a) When only P1 was added to the medium, adventitious roots formed on the explants.
(b) When only P2 was added to the medium, neither organogenesis nor callus formation
occurred. The explants retained green color for a longer period than the explants of
the control experiment.
(c) When both P1 and P2 were added to the medium, callus formed on the explants.
Based on this information, P1 and P2 were:
P1
P2
Auxin
Gibberellin
Auxin
Cytokinin
Gibberellin
Auxin
Gibberellin
Cytokinin
Cytokinin
Gibberellin
Cytokinin
Auxin
20
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
this plant, which of the following statements is the most appropriate explanation?
Rest of
seedlings
Cotyledons
Rest of
seedlings
Cotyledons
21
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A20. Two alleles G and g are present at a particular locus of a fern species. Spores were
collected from a heterozygous sporophyte with Gg genotype of the fern species.
Gametophytes were grown from the spores and self-fertilized by isolating each sexually
matured gametophyte. What is the expected ratio of the GG : Gg : gg genotypes of the
sporophytes?
A.
1:2:1
B.
2:1:1
C.
3:0:1
D.
0:3:1
E.
1:0:1
F.
0:1:1
22
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A21. Totally submerged aquatic plants can cause a pH change in the surrounding water
when they carry out photosynthesis. What pH change happens and what causes it?
23
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
24
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A23. When fertilized sea urchin eggs were reared in sea water containing actinomycin D, an
inhibitor of transcription, eggs developed normally until the blastula stage, but stopped
development after that. This is due to the fact that in embryos the process of
transcription does not take place during the cleavage period, and the proteins necessary
for the development are translated from mRNA stored in the eggs.
If protein synthesis is measured during this experiment, which of the following graphs
would be obtained?
Protein synthesis
Onset of gastrulation
25
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A24. At the 16-cell stage, the sea urchin embryo consists of three types of cells: eight
mesomeres, four macromeres and four micromeres, from animal pole to vegetal pole.
When four micromeres were labeled by fluorescent dye, all the spicule forming cells in
the resulting 2-day-old larva were fluorescent (see figure).
Thus, in normal larvae, spicule forming cells are derived solely from micromeres.
However, even if all the micromeres are removed from a 16-cell embryo,
spiculogenesis still occurs in 2-day-old larva. From this we can conclude that:
A. all the cells in a 16-cell-stage embryo can form spicules when receiving an
appropriate signal from micromeres.
B. all the cells in a 16-cell-stage embryo can form spicules when the micromeres are
removed.
C. micromeres or their descendent cells send a spiculogenesis-inhibiting signal to
other cells.
D. micromeres or their descendent cells send a spiculogenesis-inducing signal to
other cells.
26
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A25. The crab-eating frog is a unique amphibian which has adapted to the marine habitat
and lives in mangroves. Different from marine bony fish, these frogs deal with the
osmotic problem by:
27
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A26. Which of the following states occurs if the lung alveoli lose their elasticity?
A. Only I
B. Only II
C. Only III
D. I and II
E. I and III
F. II and III
28
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A27. Which of the following statements about skeletal muscle is NOT correct?
29
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A28. Which of the following would occur if a neuron was experimentally stimulated
simultaneously at both ends?
A. The action potentials would pass in the middle and travel to the opposite ends.
B. The action potentials would meet in the middle and then be propagated back to
their starting positions.
C. The action potentials would stop as they meet in the middle.
D. The stronger action potential would override the weaker action potential.
E. Summation would occur when the action potentials meet in the middle, resulting in
a larger action potential.
30
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A29 What happens when the pancreatic duct of a certain mammal is temporarily ligated for
an experiment? Note that carbohydrate and other nutrients in the diet are in proper
amounts and ligation of the pancreatic duct is not critical for survival of the animal.
31
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A30. Shown is the change of glucose concentration in the blood, measured by taking small
blood samples from the fingertip of a person who drank a solution containing 50 g of
glucose.
(min)
(mmol/L)
4.9
15
6.1
30
7.7
45
6.4
60
4.2
90
4.2
120
4.0
150
4.8
Has the glucose concentration at any time during the experiment been equal to or
higher than 7.7 mmol/L in the hepatic portal vein and the hepatic vein?
hepatic vein
A.
no
no
B.
no
yes
C.
yes
no
D.
yes
yes
32
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A31. A substance from the plant Gymnema sylvestre blocks the sweet taste of sugar and
also blocks absorption of sugar by the small intestine. What can be assumed from these
two phenomena?
33
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A32. When a species of poisonous fish was fertilized in vitro and cultured in an indoor plastic
tank filled with artificial seawater, they were never poisonous. Young fish grown in this
tank were next divided into two groups and placed in separate pens in a bay where
they were exposed to real seawater. One pen had a horizontal net that prevented the
fish from reaching the sea bottom, while the other pen had no horizontal net.
Subsequently, no poison was detected from the fish cultured in the pen with the net, but
poison was found in fish from the other pen.
A. Only I
B. Only II
C. Only III
D. Both I and II
E. Both I and III
F. Both II and III
34
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A33. What can be most likely inferred from the following statements (1 to 4) about a disease
of patient X?
1. Patient X has a disease that makes her very sensitive to infection by bacteria and
viruses.
2. The IgG gene of this patient is normal.
3. This disease is caused by the abnormality of gene x which does not work at all.
4. When T cells of a normal person and B cells of patient X are mixed and cultured in
the presence of reagents that activate these cells, IgG is secreted into the culture
medium. However, when B cells of a normal person and T cells of patient X are
combined, IgG is not secreted.
35
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A34. The diagram shows a simplified kidney tubule and associated blood vessels, and the
table shows the presence or absence of substances (X, Y, Z) in each part (16) of the
diagram.
X
Present
Present
Present
Present
Present
Present
Absent
Present
Absent
Absent
Present
Absent
Present
Present
Absent
Present
Present
Absent
Urea
Glucose
Proteins
Urea
Proteins
Glucose
Glucose
Urea
Proteins
Glucose
Proteins
Urea
Proteins
Glucose
Urea
Proteins
Urea
Glucose
36
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Ethology
A35. The vampire bat of Costa Rica is often not able to acquire blood from a mammal on a
given night. Wilkinson (1984) trapped bats which were not allowed to feed for a night
and found that they were given regurgitated blood by certain cave-mates. Based on this
knowledge, which of the following observations are indispensable to confirm the
occurrence of reciprocal altruism in this species?
Combinations:
A. Only I
B. Only IV
C. I, III
D. I, IV
E. II, III
F. II, IV
37
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A36. In a certain bird species, territory-holding males are sexually mature, have red chest
feathers and aggressively drive out intruders. Several models, shown below, were built
to test territory defense in this species. What is the most likely sequence of attack on
these models in decreasing order of aggression?
Sequences
A. I III IV II
B. I IV III II
C. II III IV I
D. II IV III I
38
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A37. A man with a genetic disease marries a phenotypically normal woman. They have four
girls and four boys; all of the girls have the same disease as their father, but none of the
boys does. What is the most likely explanation?
39
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A38. There is a degenerative disease which develops in people between 35 and 45 years
old. It is caused by a dominant allele. A couple has two children, who are both younger
than 20 years old. One parent has the disease (heterozygote), but the other parent, who
is 50 years old, does not. What is the probability that the both children will develop this
disease when they become older?
A. 1/16
B. 3/16
C. 1/4
D. 9/16
E. 3/4
40
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A39. There are n+1 alleles at a particular locus on an autosome. The frequency of one allele
is 1/2 and the frequencies of the other alleles are all 1/(2n). Under the assumption of
Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium, what is the total frequency of heterozygotes?
A. (n 1)/(2n)
B. (2n 1)/(3n)
C. (3n 1)/(4n)
D. (4n 1)/(5n)
E. (5n 1)/(6n)
41
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A40. At a locus for an enzyme which is inherited independently of sex, the frequencies of
genotypes in a population were as follows.
FF
FS
SS
Female
30
60
10
Male
20
40
40
Predict the frequency of the FS genotype in the next generation, assuming that they will
mate randomly.
A. 0.46
B. 0.48
C. 0.50
D. 0.52
E. 0.54
42
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A41. How does the occurrence of self-fertilization relative to cross-fertilization affect the
fixation of an advantageous and recessive allele that newly appeared in a population by
mutation?
A. The allele will be fixed most quickly when the relative occurrence of self-fertilization
is highest.
B. The allele will be fixed most quickly when the relative occurrence of self-fertilization
is lowest.
C. The allele will be fixed most quickly when the relative occurrence of self-fertilization
is moderate.
D. The relative occurrence of self-fertilization does not affect the fixation of the allele.
E. The relative occurrence of self-fertilization affects the fixation of the allele only
when the population is very small.
43
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A42. The following table shows the number of estimated nucleotide substitutions that have
occurred in a gene among seven species.
a
b
c
39
72
128
126
159
269
81
130
128
158
268
129
127
157
267
56
154
271
151
268
d
e
f
273
Which is the most appropriate tree that shows the phylogenetic relationship among
these seven species?
44
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
45
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A43. Suppose that at a neutrally evolving genomic region of a species the mutation rate from
the base pair GC to AT is three-times the mutation rate from AT to GC. What is the
expected GC content at equilibrium?
A. 1/2
B. 1/3
C. 1/4
D. 1/5
E. 1/6
46
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A44. A species of insect was found to have developed resistance to a commonly used
insecticide. Which of the following is the most likely explanation?
47
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A45. Darwin's finches are a prime example of adaptive radiation. Which of the following best
describes this adaptive radiation correctly?
A. The genetic variability that can be found among individuals of the same species.
B. The evolutionary process by which different forms, adapted to different niches,
arose from a common ancestor.
C. A sudden diversification of a group of organisms from closely related species.
D. The evolutionary process that allows for the changes that occur within the same
lineage.
E. The evolutionary process of adaptation of species through a kind of
polymorphism.
48
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A46. Multigene families are groups of two or more identical or very similar genes. Which of
the following statements about multigene families is correct?
A. Globin gene families do not have pseudogenes, because globins are essential for
oxygen transport.
B. Ribosomal RNA gene families in multicellular eukaryotes have many identical
genes, because many ribosomes are required for active protein synthesis.
C. Compared with multicellular eukaryotes, prokaryotes have many multigene
families, because prokaryotes have to reproduce very quickly.
D. The number of genes in a multigene family always increases by unequal crossing
over.
49
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Ecology
A47. The following table shows the net primary productivity and biomass without soil organic
matter in five ecosystems.
Ecosystem
Biomass (kg/m2)
Tropical rainforest
2200
45
2000
15
II
1200
30
III
900
Boreal forest
800
20
Choose from A to F in the table below the most appropriate combination of ecosystems for I,
II and III above.
I
II
III
50
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A48. The diagram below represents the relationships between organisms in a remote pond
ecosystem.
Consumer 4
Consumer 3
Consumer 1
Producer 1
Detritivore 1
Consumer 2
Producer 2
Producer 3
1
From this information, which of the following is the most likely to be correct?
51
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A49. The table below shows the results of measurements of production in two ecosystems in
the temperate zone: a rainforest and a field with an annual crop. All results are stated in
MJ/m2 / year (1 MJ = 106J).
[I] Rainforest
188
102
Respiration (autotrophs)
134
38
Respiration (heterotrophs)
54
A. [I] < [II]The rainforest has larger GPP and more consumers than the crop field.
B. [I] < [II]The rainforest has larger NPP and more consumers than the crop field.
C. [I] < [II]The rainforest has larger NPP and less consumers than the crop field.
D. [II] < [I]The rainforest has smaller GPP and more consumers than the crop field.
E. [II] < [I]The rainforest has smaller NPP and more consumers than the crop field.
F. [II] < [I]The rainforest has smaller NPP and less consumers than the crop field.
52
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A50. What does the energy input into most food webs typically depend on? Choose the most
likely factor from the following.
53
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A51. Which factor most promotes the stability of population dynamics in a developed
terrestrial ecosystem?
A. Food webs that have many trophic levels each of which consists of few species
only
B. A few species of producers with very high production rates
C. Rapid nutrient recycling by active decomposers
D. Food webs that have very few trophic levels and limited niche overlaps
E. A few eminent and competitively-dominant species
54
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
No. of individuals
in species Y
Relationship between
Reasoning
species X and Y
interspecific competition Y decreases at high density of X
A.
between X and Y
C.
D.
55
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
Biosystematics
A53. The following phylogenetic tree shows the relationships among Antarctic icefish and
their relatives. Icefish refer to all the species in the tree that have lost hemoglobin and
thus possess clear blood. Some icefish species also lost myoglobin which is usually
found in muscle cells. In these species, myoglobin lost its function due to distinct
mutations. In addition, icefish and relatives possess an anti-freezing glycoprotein to
arrest the growth of ice crystals in their tissues. To the right of the tree, whether or not
each species possess hemoglobin, myoglobin and the anti-freezing glycoprotein is
shown. What conclusion can you draw from the tree?
56
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
57
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A54. A list of the shared derived characters for some metazoan phyla is shown below.
Identify all the phylogenetic tree(s) which are consistent with the statements below.
58
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part A
A. a
B. a, c
C. a, d
D. b, c
E. a, b, d
F. a, c, d.
*****
END OF PART A
59
*****
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Country Code___________
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Cell Biology
B1. (3 point) On a dry matter basis, is the average proportion of the following elements
significantly higher in herbaceous vascular plants or in mammals? For each element
mark X in the appropriate box.
A.
Nitrogen
B.
Oxygen
C.
Calcium
D.
Potassium
E.
Sodium
F.
Phosphorus
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B2. (2.5 points) Match each of the following properties of water with a benefit to organisms
by putting a letter (A to E) in the appropriate box.
Property
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
Polarity of molecules
Benefit to organisms
A. Biological membranes composed of lipid molecules are thermodynamically stable.
B. Terrestrial plants and animals can cool themselves with minimum loss of water
content.
C. Temperature changes in plants and animals are minimized under fluctuating
environmental conditions.
D. Plants can efficiently utilize solar radiation for photosynthesis.
E. Plants and animals are protected against freezing at low temperatures.
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B3. (3 points) A coding region of a gene consists of 735 base pairs without a stop codon.
Calculate the molecular mass of the protein from this gene. Assume the average
molecular mass of the free amino acid in this protein is 122. Five disulfide bonds are
present in the protein. Calculate the molecular mass of the protein from this gene. Show
your calculations.
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(1) The figure below shows the reactions of glycolysis. The numbers in the figure indicate
enzymes which catalyze the reactions. Categorize each enzyme into the enzyme
type listed below and put each reaction number in an appropriate box. Note that
some enzyme types may be missing.
Enzyme type:
A.
Oxidoreductase
B.
Transferase
C.
Hydrolase
D.
Lyase
E.
Isomerase
F.
Ligase
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(2) A cell culture of muscle cells was incubated in oxygenated medium that was then
quickly made anoxic. The concentrations of three compounds which are important in
glucose metabolism were measured immediately after oxygen removal (marked as
time 0) and shown in the graph below:
Match each curve of the graph (1, 2, and 3) with the metabolite whose concentration
change it depicts:
Metabolites:
A. Glucose-6-phosphate
B. Lactate
C. Fructose-1,6-bisphosphate
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B5. (2 points) Different patterns of cell cycling (A to D) are shown below. Correctly match
them with the given cell types they represent.
Cell types
I.
II.
III.
IV.
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B6. (3 points) A cell suspension of a microorganism was fed with [3H]-labeled uridine and
incubated. Cell components were fractionated from these cells and radioactivity in the
mRNA fraction was measured, which revealed that 2.5 picomoles of uridine were
incorporated into mRNA in 1 x 106 cells. Assuming that the base composition of mRNA
is random and that the average length of mRNA is 3,000 bases, calculate how many
molecules of mRNA were synthesized in each individual cell during incubation.
(Avogadros number: 6 x 1023)
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B7. (4 points) From the model plant Arabidopsis, 0.3, 0.6, 0.9, 1.2, and 1.5-kbp genomic
fragments upstream of the translation start site of gene Z were isolated and designated
Za, Zb, Zc, Zd, and Ze, respectively. These fragments were fused to the structural gene
of -glucuronidase (GUS) of Escherichia coli. Arabidopsis was transformed with the
resultant chimeric genes Za-GUS, Zb-GUS, Zc-GUS, Zd-GUS, and Ze-GUS, and
examined for GUS activity by in-situ chromogenic reaction. The following figure
schematically shows construction of the chimeric genes and the GUS activity patterns
in heart-shaped embryos of the transgenic Arabidopsis carrying these chimeric genes.
10
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Upstream region
I.
1,500 to 1,201
II.
1,200 to 901
III.
900 to 601
IV.
600 to 301
Functions
A.
AB.
BC.
CD.
DE.
EF.
GF.
11
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B8. (3 points) Deficiency of a particular mineral element in the soil elicits a specific pattern
of leaf discoloration in plants (chlorosis), which is related to metabolic roles and mobility
(translocation) of the mineral element in the plant. The following describes the
deficiency symptoms (leaf discoloration), metabolic roles, and mobility of magnesium
(Mg), iron (Fe), and nitrogen (N).
Deficiency symptoms
A.
B.
Mineral mobility
C.
D.
Metabolic roles
E.
F.
G.
.
12
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Connect each mineral element to the appropriate descriptions of the above three
categories (A or B for Deficiency symptoms; C or D for Mineral mobility; E, F, or G for
Metabolic roles).
13
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B9. (3 points) Growing plant roots were analyzed with respect to spatial patterns of cell
division and elongation growth. The roots were marked with graphite particles (P) at various
positions along the root axis, where x was the distance from the root apex just behind the
root cap to Px.
between P0 and Px
II.
between P0 and Px
III.
14
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
When the data are plotted against x, what types of profiles do these data sets show?
For each data set, choose the most appropriate profile from the followings.
15
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
16
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
17
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B10. (4 points) Henbane (Hyoscyamus niger) is a medicinal plant. Two varieties of this
plant, one of which is annual and the other biennial, were characterized for flowering.
In the first experiment, effects of cold treatment and day- length on flowering were
examined in the annual and biennial varieties. For this purpose, cold-treated and
untreated plants were grown under the short-day condition or the long-day condition.
The following table indicates whether the plants flowered or not.
18
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
In the second experiment, cold-treated and untreated plants of the annual and
biennial strains were grafted as shown in the following figure, and then grown under
the long-day condition. Whether or not the stock and scion flowered or not was
recorded. The results of the two types of grafts (#1 and #2) are summarized in the table
on the next page.
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
based on the above results. Mark the appropriate boxes with "X" about in relation to
florigen response (1) and florigen productivity (2).
20
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B11. (3 points) Plants and animals accumulate starch and glycogen as a storage
polysaccharide, respectively. Starch consists of two sorts of large, water-insoluble
polymers of glucose, amylose and amylopectin. Amylose is essentially unbranched and
linear while amylopectin is highly and regularly branched, which forms branch clusters.
Glycogen is also a branched glucose polymer, but unlike amylopectin, it is relatively
small and water-soluble. In the glycogen molecule, branches are shorter, irregular, and
not clustered.
21
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(1) Biosynthesis of starch involves three classes of enzymes: chain elongation enzymes,
branching enzymes, and debranching enzymes. Sugary, a rice mutant, is deficient in a
particular debranching enzyme. The endosperm of this mutant is characterized by the
accumulation of glycogen-like polysaccharide instead of amylopectin. In consideration
of this information, the role of the wild type debranching enzyme in starch biosynthesis
is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
22
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(2) The seeds of the Sugary mutant of rice are not different from the wild-type seeds in
the size and appearance before desiccation which is associated with seed maturation.
During desiccation, however, the Sugary seeds become shrunk and wrinkled. This
phenomenon suggests that before desiccation, as compared with the wild-type seeds,
the Sugary seeds contain:
both amylopectin and glycogen, but plants have lost the ability of glycogen
synthesis during evolution.
B.
both amylopectin and glycogen, but animals have lost the ability of
amylopectin synthesis.
C.
amylopectin but not glycogen, and animals have acquired the ability of
glycogen synthesis.
D.
glycogen but not amylopectin, and plants have acquired the ability of
amylopectin synthesis.
23
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
24
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
From the above informationprovided, what can be reasonably inferred? For each of the
following statements, mark X in the appropriate box choosing the option in the
bracket.
I.
II.
III.
25
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B13. (3 points) Three patients I, II and III show symptoms of low thyroxine levels. Defects
are found in the hypothalamus for patient I, in the anterior pituitary for patient II, and in
the thyroid for patient III. After thyroid-stimulating-hormone-releasing hormone (TRH) is
given to these patients, the concentration of thyroid-stimulating hormone (TSH) before
and after (30 min) TRH administration is measured in each patient.
26
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Fill Choose the letter of the appropriate data (AC) for each patient (IIII).
27
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B14. (2.5 points) The graph below shows the blood glucose level after three hormones I, II
and III are administered separately or together.
A.
Hypoglycemic
B.
Hyperglycemic
A.
Additive
B.
Antagonistic
C.
Synergistic
D.
None
(3) Pick the three possible hormones that are consistent with the results shown in the
graph.
A.
Insulin
B.
ADH (Vasopressin)
C.
Adrenalin (Epinephrine)
D.
Renin
E.
Glucagon
F.
Angiotensinogen
G.
Cortisol
28
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
H.
Calcitonin
I.
29
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B15. (4 points) The oocytes of a starfish grow within the provided follicle cells in the gonad.
Eventually they cease meiosis at prophase I, and wait as a state of immature eggs. The
immature eggs resume meiosis when stimulated and lose their nuclear envelop as
shown below.
In order to understand the mechanism of this resumption, the following experiments
were conducted.
Experiment 1: When extract from the nerve tissue of adult starfish was added to
immature eggs surrounded by follicles, meiosis resumed.
Experiment 2: When extract from the nerve tissue of adult starfish was added to
immature eggs from which follicles were removed, meiosis did NOT resume.
Experiment 3: When extract from the nerve tissue of adult starfish was added to follicles
after they had been separated from immature eggs, and subsequently the medium was
added to immature eggs without follicles, meiosis resumed.
Experiment 4: When extract from the nerve tissue of an adult starfish was added to
follicles after separationed from immature eggs, and the medium was injected into
immature eggs without follicles, meiosis did NOT resume.
30
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Hypothesis 1: The extract from the nerve tissue contains a substance which directly
acts on immature eggs causing them to resume meiosis.
Hypothesis 2: The extract from the nerve tissue contains a substance which acts on
immature eggs to resume meiosis, but the follicle blocks the substance from reaching
the immature eggs.
Hypothesis 3: The extract from the nerve tissue contains a precursor of a substance
that causes meiosis to resume, which is processed by the follicle into an active
compound that causes immature eggs to resume meiosis.
Hypothesis 4: The extract from the nerve tissue induces follicles to secrete a substance
which then acts on the cell surface of an immature egg to cause a resumption of
meiosis.
31
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B16. (2 points) After the nucleus is removed from a fertilized frog egg, it is re-transferred
back into the enucleated egg. In another experiment, the nucleus from a gut epithelial
cell is transferred into an enucleated egg. In both cases, the eggs grow well and
develop normally into tadpoles.
B.
some genes are not expressed, but the genes themselves are not lost during
development.
C.
D.
E.
(2) In the experiment above, frog gut epithelial cells were used. If this experiment were
performed in mammals, theoretically almost all cell types can be used as a nucleus
donor, but a few cell types cannot. Which of the following cell types is NOT
appropriate as a donor cell?
A.
B lymphocyte
B.
Liver cell
C.
D.
E.
Cone cell
32
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B17. (2 points) The figure below represents a cross section of a vertebrate neurula stage
embryo.
(1) The following are statements about the tissues and organs derived from (a), (b), (c)
and (d) of the figure. Identify whether each statement is True or False and mark X in
the appropriate box.
A.
Tissues derived from (a) are always associated with those from (b).
B.
C.
D.
33
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(2) Neural tube arises from (e). The following are statements about the formation and
later development of the neural tube. Identify whether each statement is True or
False and mark X in the appropriate box.
A.
Cells in the wall of neural tube later differentiate into glial cells as well as
nerve cells (neurons).
B.
C.
Almost all nervous tissue derived from neural tube is central nervous system.
D.
The retinal pigment epithelium in the eye derives from optic vesicle formed
from the neural tube.
34
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B18. (3 points) For intracellular infectious bacteria and viruses to successfully invade a cell,
they must bind to receptors on the cell surface. HIV, specifically infects helper T cells,
which express the CD4 molecule, but not CD8 on their cell surface, making it possible
to distinguish helper T cells from other lymphocytes. Thus, CD4 is hypothesized to be a
receptor for HIV.
(1) Which two of the following experiments would confirm this hypothesis?
B.
C.
D.
E.
35
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(2) It is known that HIV cannot infect mice, although the mouse has CD4-positive helper T
cells, because mouse CD4 cannot bind to HIV. To study further the mechanism of HIV
infection in human cells, the following experiments were carried out, and the results
are as follows:
1. When the human CD4 gene is expressed in mouse T cells, HIV can bind to the
cells but cannot infect them.
2. When human chemokine receptor (CXCR4) is expressed in addition to human
CD4 in mouse cells, HIV is able to infect the cells.
3. When human CD4 and CXCR4 genes are expressed in mouse cells and the cells
are cultivated in the presence of SDF-1a, a ligand of CXCR4, infection by HIV is
perturbed (altered).
Which of the following sentences states the correct conclusion based on the above
experiments?
A.
If CXCR4 is expressed in mouse cells, CD4 is not required for the infection of
HIV.
B.
Human CD4 is required for the binding with HIV, and the binding is enhanced
by the SDF-1a ligand.
C.
D.
Human CD4 is required for the binding with HIV, but infection of HIV into cells
requires help of CXCR4.
36
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B19. (3 points) The majority of humans have erythrocytes that express the Rh (Rhesus)
antigen on their cell surface, but some are negative for the Rh antigen.
An Rh-negative woman marries to a heterozygous Rh-positive man and has three
children.
(1) What is the probability that all three of their children become Rh-positive?
A.
B.
1/2
C.
1/4
D.
1/8
E.
(2) In which combination below could the second child suffer from hemolytic disease?
First child
Second child
A.
Rh-positive
Rh-negative
B.
Rh-negative
Rh-positive
C.
Rh-negative
Rh-negative
D.
Rh-positive
Rh-positive
37
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(3) Which molecules or cells are mainly involved in causing hemolytic disease in the fetus
and newborn infant in case of Rh blood group antigen-incompatibility? Choose TWO
correct options from A to F.
A.
T cells
B.
IgM antibody
C.
Complement
D.
Interferon gamma
E.
IgG antibody
F.
Perforin
38
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Ethology
B20. (3 points)
(1) Foraging honeybees usually perform a waggle dance (Figure 1) when they find an
attractive food source 100 m or more away from their hive. The duration of the waggle
dance indicates the distance to the food source.
The duration of the waggle dance was studied in two honeybee species, Apis cerana
cerana (Acc) and Apis mellifera ligustica (Aml), when food was placed at varying
distances from the hives and the data shown in the graph below.
What were the distances (m) indicated when the average duration of the waggle
dances of Acc and Aml both lasted 800 msec? Answer the distance for each species
from the following numbers.
130
160
39
190
220
250
280
310
340
370
400
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(2) Mixed colonies of Acc and Aml were successfully established by introducing Aml
pupae into Acc colony and vice versa. The young individuals of both species were
accepted by the colony members of the other species. When the same experiment
(Figure 2) was performed on the mixed colonies, the introduced Acc and Aml workers
each showed exactly the same patterns that these species had shown earlier.
In the final experiment, food was placed at 400, 500 and 600 m, all in the same
direction, and the introduced Aml bees trained to forage at the food source 500 m
away. When these bees recruited Acc bees from the hive, the latter were found to
forage at the food site exactly 500 m away. This was also seen when the reverse
experiment was done with Acc bees recruiting Aml bees.
From these experiments, what can we conclude about the transfer of the encoded
and decoded information between the actor and receiver bees, respectively?
40
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
41
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B21. (2 points) Red harvester ants (Pogonomyrmex barbatus) are social insects and live in
underground colonies, in which various functions are carried out by different groups of
ants. Below is a picture of one such ant colony. The open circle in the center is the nest
entrance. The four types of lines (i to iv) indicate paths followed by different groups of
these ants. Match the appropriate groups (A to D) with these lines:
Groups:
A.
Foragers
B.
Patrollers
C.
D.
Midden workers or refuse pile sorters (those who remove (pile) fecal matter
from outside the nest)
42
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B22. (2 points) In birds, there are many ways of singing. This is caused by the fact that
brain regulates the action of the syrinx (vocal organ of birds). In a certain species of
birds, two kinds of vocalization can be recognized: longer songs produced by males in
the breeding season, and other simpler calls heard outside the breeding season.
(1) If the young chicks of such birds are reared in an environment without sound, adult
birds cannot produce the exact longer songs. Which of the following is the most
appropriate as explanation of the above statement?
A.
B.
C.
D.
43
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(2) Although chicken and quail are closely related, their calls are different. An experiment
was carried out in which the presumptive brain region of 5-day-old white chicken
embryo was substituted by that of a brown quail embryo of the same age. Then the
host chicken embryo was incubated. The hatched chicken had some brown parts in its
brain, which indicates that these parts were derived from a quail. The calls of this
chicken were more similar to that of a quail rather than that of a chicken. Which of the
following is the most appropriate conclusion deduced from the experiment?
I.
II.
III.
A.
Only I
B.
Only II
C.
Only III
D.
I and II
E.
I and III
F.
II and III
44
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B23. (4 points) In an experiment on the members of a family with the pedigree shown
below, blood plasma and blood cells from different individuals were mixed in pairs to
test the presence (p) or absence (a) of coagulation. In this pedigree AB- means that the
phenotypes of individual 1 (mother) are AB type and Rh negative (Rh-), and B+ means
that the phenotypes of individual 2 (father) are B type and Rh positive (Rh+).
The results of this experiment are shown below. A blank box in this table indicates a
combination that was not tested in this experiment.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
(2) Which member of this family is probably homozygous with respect to both the ABO
blood group and the Rh loci?
45
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
A.
Individual 2
B.
Individual 3
C.
Individual 4
D.
Individual 5
E.
Individual 6
46
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B24. (4 points) In maize a single locus determines the color of the seed; allele A results in
colored seeds, and allele a in colorless seeds. Another locus determines the shape of
the seeds; allele B results in a smooth shape of the seeds, and b in wrinkled seeds.
In a crossbreeding between the plant that grew from a colored and smooth seed and
the plant that grew from a colorless and wrinkled seed, the offspring were documented
as:
376
13
13
373
A.
AABb x aaBb
B.
AaBb x aabb
C.
AAbb x aaBB
D.
AaBb x AaBb
E.
aabb x AABB
47
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
A.
0.335%
B.
1.68%
C.
3.35%
D.
6.91%
E.
48.52%
(3) Three loci C, D and E are located on the same chromosome in this order. Using
similar experiments to the above, we found that the frequency of recombinants
between C and D is 10% and that between D and E it is 20%. Assuming that crossing
over occurs randomly on the chromosome, what is the expected frequency of
recombinants between C and E?
48
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(1) How many years ago did the two sequences diverge?
(2) What is the relationship between the divergence time between the two sequences
(T1) and the divergence time between the two species (T2) in general?
A.
T1 < T2
B.
T1 = T2
C.
T1 > T2
49
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B26. (3 points) Preproinsulin is the primary product of the insulin gene, and consists of 4
major parts: signal, B-chain, C, and A-chain peptides. After several modifications
including removal of the signal and C peptides, insulin is obtained.
(1) Which of the following peptides is responsible for the transport of polypeptide into the
endoplasmic reticulum?
A.
A-chain peptide
B.
B-chain peptide
C.
C peptide
D.
signal peptide
(2) Comparisons of amino acid sequences among mammals show that the sequence
similarity between species varies substantially among the peptides. Which of the
following is the most likely explanation?
A.
directional selection
B.
frequency-dependent selection
C.
D.
50
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
A.
A-chain peptide
B.
B-chain peptide
C.
C peptide
D.
signal peptide
51
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B27. (4 points) In order to quantify genetic diversity of an endangered plant species, genetic
variation in subpopulations (IIV) was examined at the protein level. Subpopulation I is
the largest in this species, and the number of individuals in all other subpopulations II,
III and IV are each 1/7 of that in subpopulation I. In each subpopulation 5 individuals
were sampled. The diagram below shows the results of proteins separated by gel
electrophoresis. The band pattern in each lane, which consists of alleles F and/or S,
represents the genotype of each individual at a certain locus.
Subpopulation I
Subpopulation II
Subpopulation III
Subpopulation IV
52
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(3) After several generations, we found that the frequency of F changed substantially in
subpopulations II, III and IV, compared with that of subpopulation I. What is the most
likely explanation?
A.
Genetic drift
B.
Migration
C.
Mutation
D.
Natural selection
53
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B28. (3 points) Islands are considered as experimental sites for biological evolution and
community assembly. The diagram below shows two phylogenetic trees, each
consisting of 9 species (aAi and jJr) and community assemblies on 6 islands.
Phenotypic traits of the species are represented by size and color.
Which of the following explanations are responsible for the mechanisms of community
assembly on these islands? Choose THREE correct options from A to H.
54
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
55
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
56
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Ecology
B29. (3 points) The following diagram shows the cycle of nitrogen compounds in an
ecosystem.
(1) BacteriaIn which of the processes do NOT participate in which of the above two
processesbacteria participate? Choose TWO from A to G.
(2) Which of the processes may include a symbiotic relationship between a species of
plant and a species of bacterium?
57
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B30. (3 points) The relationship between population density (Nt) and population growth rate
(R = Nt+1 / Nt ) in a certain animal species is shown below.
Choose from the following graphs the appropriate population growth patterns that
would be obtained if the population is at the densities (I, II, III) shown in the graph
above. Note that the y-axis in A to D is relative density that cannot be compared to the
absolute density in the figure.
58
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B31. (2.5 points) Competitive exclusion among species is regulated by various ecological
factors. Identify whether the following statements are True or False about this process,
and mark X in the appropriate boxes.
Competitive exclusion:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
59
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B32. (3 points) The diagram below shows the results of an experiment on the vine Ipomoea
tricolor, in which root competition and shoot competition were separated. The average
dry mass is indicated by open bars, and the coefficient of variation (ratio of standard
deviation / mean) of mass among plants is indicated by hatched bars. Based on the
data presented, iIdentify whether the following statements are True or False about the
competition mode of this plant species, and mark X in the appropriate boxes
60
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
A. Competition for light has more influence on the average mass than competition for
soil nutrients.
B. Under conditions of competition, individual plants have stronger potential to
monopolize soil nutrients over others than they can monopolize light.The
differences in competitive strength among these plants are larger when competing
for soil nutrients than for light.
C. When grown individually, soil nutrients constitute a limiting factor for growth, but
light does not.
61
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
Biosystematics
B33. (3 points) At which branches A to E in this phylogenetic tree of green plants were the
traits I to VI listed below acquired?
I.
Pollen
II.
Tracheid
III.
Cuticle
IV.
Seed
V.
Carpel
VI.
Multicellular embryo
62
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B34. (5 points) The universal phylogenetic tree based on molecular sequencing analysis
shows three major groups of living organisms as shown below. Woese proposed the
concept of three domains in living organisms in the 1990s based on such a tree.
(1) What was the molecule used for the construction of the universal phylogenetic tree?
What was the benefit of this molecule for the universal tree? Choose the combination
of the molecule and benefit.
(2) The two broken arrows indicate hypothesized endosymbiotic events whereby members
of Domain I became endosymbionts of Domain II. What are the two organisms that were
involved in these events, what did they become in the cells of Domain II and what is their
current biological function in the Domain II organisms?
A. Archaea
B. Bacteria
C. Eukarya
63
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
B35. (4 points) Joseph Camin, a taxonomist, invented artificial non-existing creatures, the
Caminalcules, for his students. Below are depicted four different Caminalcules.
(1) For these four Caminalcules, choose an appropriate cladogram by focusing upon the
following characteristics. The most likely tree should be the one where the largest
number of characters can be mapped in the internal branch.
1.
Antenna
2.
Belly spots
3.
Elbow
4.
Fingers
5.
Neck
6.
7.
Posterior legs
64
IBO-2009 JAPAN
THEORETICAL TEST Part B
(2) Choose characteristics from the list in question (1) which presumably evolved
convergently (independently lost or acquired) in two species of the four.
(3) Assuming that Caminalcule a is a sister taxon of the other species, choose an
appropriate rooted tree from the following.
*****
65
END OF PART B
*****
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
A1
A2
E
X
A3
No.
A21
A23
A4
A5
A6
A27
A8
A28
A9
A29
No.
A41
A43
X
X
X
A44
A45
A46
A47
X
A48
X
X
A49
A30
A11
A31
A51
A12
A32
A52
A13
A33
A14
A34
A15
A35
A16
A36
A18
A19
A20
X
X
X
X
A50
A53
A54
X
X
A37
A38
A39
A40
- 114 -
A10
A17
A42
A26
A24
A7
A25
X
A22
X
X
X
2. Part B
B1. (0.5 points x 6 = 3 points)
A
B
C
Plants
X
Mammals
X
X
D
X
735
122
1 18 {5 (2 1)}
3
3
735
1 122
11 18 {5 (2 1)}
- 115 -
1
B
2
C
3
A
IV
B
B6. (3 points)
2000
(or 2007 by using more precise Avogadros number.)
B7. (1 points x 4 = 4 points)
I
II
III
A
F
E
IV
A
B8. (3 points)
Deficiency symptoms
(0.3x3)
Mg
B
Fe
A
N
B
Mineral mobility
(0.3x3)
C
D
C
Metabolic roles
(0.4x3)
G
E
F
X
X
X
X
- 116 -
to cannot respond
Florigen.
to
The leaves of
B11. (3 points)
(1) (1 point)
A
B
C
X
(2) (1 point)
A
B
(3) (1 point)
A
B
cold-treated
annual plants
untreated
annual plants
cold-treated
biennial
plants
untreated
biennial
plants
X
X
X
X
C
X
D
X
D
- 117 -
X
(3) (0.5 points x 3 = 1.5 points)
C
E
G
B15. (1 points x 4 = 4 points)
Hypothesis
1
Rejected
X
Not rejected
B16. (2 points)
(1) (1 point)
A
B
X
(2) (1 point)
A
B
X
Hypothesis
2
X
B17. (2 points)
(1) (0.2 point x 4 = 0.8 points)
A
B
C
TRUE
X
X
FALSE
X
D
X
D
X
B18. (3 points)
(1) (1 points x 2 = 2 points)
A
B
C
D
E
X
X
(Choosing more than 2 gives no point.)
(2) (1 point)
A
B
D
X
B19. (3 points)
(1) (0.5 point)
A
B
E
- 118 -
Hypothesis
3
Hypothesis
4
X
(2) (0.5 point)
A
B
D
X
B23. (4 points)
(1) (2 points)
A
B
C
X
(2) (2 points)
A
B
C
X
B24. (4 points)
(1) (1 point)
- 119 -
B
X
(2) (1 point)
A
B
(3) (2 points)
26
C
X
B25. (3 points)
(1) (2 points)
2.5
X
106
(2,500,000)
years
6
5 X 10 (5,000,000) years: 1 point
(2) (1 point)
A
B
C
X
B26. (3 points)
(1) (1 point)
A
B
C
(2) (1 point)
A
B
(3) (1 point)
A
B
B27. (4 points)
(1) (2 points)
34
or 0.34
D
X
D
X
C
X
(2) (1 point)
I
II
III
IV
X
(3) (1 point)
A
B
D
- 120 -
X
B28. (1 points x 3 = 3 points)
A
B
C
D
E
X
X
F
X
B29. (3 points)
(1) (0.5 point x 2 = 1 points)
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
X
X
(Choosing more than 2 gives no point.)
(2) (1 point)
A
B
X
(3) (1 point)
A
B
X
E
X
VI
B
- 121 -
Function
4
1
E
F
G
H
I
X
Since the answer of (3) is consequence of the question (1), the combination of the
wrong answer (1) A and the answer of (3) B gives 0.5 point for (3), and that of (1) C and
(3) H, gives 0.5 point for (3).
- 122 -
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
You must write down your results and answers in the ANSWER SHEET. Answers
written in the Question Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each
task. If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand.
At the end of the test, put the Answer Sheet and Question Paper in the envelope. The
supervisor will collect this envelope.
Good Luck!!
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
Quantity
3. Dissecting plate
4. Forceps
5. Scissors
6. Disposable pipette
8. Dissecting pins
20
10. Set of color pencils: one O (orange), one B (blue), and one G (green)
Introduction
Even in insects which undergo complete metamorphosis, the body structure of the adult and
larva are basically common. After closely observing a non-anesthetized caterpillar and
dissecting and closely observing anesthetized caterpillars or moth (Bombyx mori Linn)
larvae (silk worm), answer the following questions. When you dissect the caterpillars, do it in
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
the dissecting plate filled with water, using suitable equipments such as forceps, scissors,
dissecting needle with holder, dissecting pins.
Q.1.1. (1 point2 = 2 points) The insect body is composed of three regions, the head,
thorax and abdomen. Show the boundary between the head and thorax by drawing an orange
line with orange color pencil O and the boundary between the thorax and abdomen by
drawing a blue line with blue color pencil B on the photo of the caterpillar in the Answer
Sheet.
Q.1.2. (3 points) On each side of the caterpillars head, you will find an eye patch. How
many small eyes are in the eye patch of one side of the caterpillar head in front of you?
Answer using numerals.
Q.1.3. (3 points) Insects breathe by means of a tracheal system, with external openings called
spiracles. How many pairs of spiracles do the caterpillars in front of you have? Answer using
numerals.
Q.1.4. (6 points +[2+2 ]3 points = 18 points) The photo in your envelope shows a dorsal
view of a dissected caterpillar. Dissect an anesthetized caterpillar by yourself exactly as
shown in photo. (You may use the second caterpillar if required) When you have finished
the dissection, call your assistant by raising your hand. Your assistant will take a photograph
of your specimen for evaluation (6 points). You should check the photograph of your
dissected specimen after it has been taken.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
Closely observe the internal structures of the caterpillar, focusing on where the
tubular structures A, B and C arise. Answer the name and function of each of the tubular
structures A, B and C by choosing the appropriate answer for the name from numerals 1-10
and function from the alphabet a-j.
Names
Functions
Q.1.5. (2 points3 = 6 points) The insect body contains different kinds of internal organ
systems. Closely observing non-anesthetized and dissected caterpillars, show the positions of
the central nervous system, digestive system (gut) and circulatory system (heart), by drawing
them into the image of the caterpillar prepared in the Answer Sheet using the colors as
indicated below.
Central nervous system - orange color pencil O
Digestive system - blue one B
Circulatory system - green one G.
Notice: If you can show the positions of the systems in the image of the caterpillar, there is
no need to copy their exact shapes: however, in drawing the digestive systems, you should
clearly show both ends.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.1.6. (4 points) The central nervous system of insects is composed of the aggregations of
cell bodies or the ganglia and the bundles of nerve fibers or the nerve cords connecting
ganglia. How many ganglia does the dissected caterpillar have? Answer using numerals.
Q.1.7. (4 points3 = 12 points) Show the positions of the anteriormost, anterior-second and
posteriormost ganglia by drawing arrows and labeling with A for anteriormost, 2 for
anterior second and P for posteriormost with black pencil in the image of the caterpillar
used in Q.1.5.
Q.1.8. (2 points) How many nerve cords are there between each pair of ganglia? Answer
using numerals, choosing the correct number from 1 to 4.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
In this task, fruit and flower morphology are examined and the developmental
process is studied.
Quantity
4
1
4. Knife
5. Scalpel
6. Bottles of staining and rinsing solutions (IKI, IKI-R, CBB, CBB-R, OR, OR-R) 6
7.Small Petri dishes for staining
12
Introduction
Morphology and reserve substances vary across plant species. Reserve substances can be
distinguished by staining.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
Caution
-Some seeds are potential allergens. Wear gloves and do not touch them with your bare hands.
-Do not allow the staining solutions to contact your skin. If they touch your skin, rinse the
area thoroughly with distilled water.
Property
IKI
IKI-R
Starch
Purple
Aqueous solution
CBB
CBB-R
Protein
Blue
OR
OR-R
Lipid
Red
Contain ethanol
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
Staining method:
- Use small Petri dishes for staining and rinsing.
- Stain for 5 to 10 minutes in staining solution.
- Then, rinse the specimens well with rinsing solution.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
5. Knife
6. Colored pencils (orange (O), blue (B), green (G)) (used in Task 1)
7. White tray
Introduction
A fruit may develop from some part of a single flower. Therefore, the morphological
features of a fruit are closely related to those of its flower.
Q.2.B.1. (4 points)
There are fruits of tomato (A) and apple (B). Cut the fruits transversely and vertically on a
paper towel in the white tray. Compare the fruits and flower drawings (I and II).
Enter the number of the flower (I or II) that corresponds to each fruits (A, B) in the Box of
Q.2.B.1. in the Answer Sheet.
10
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
_______________________________________________________________________
Answer Sheet. Then, color the following tissues on the same fruit drawings (A1 and B1) in
the colors designated. Refer to the strawberry drawings.
Ovule (or seeds): color pencil O (orange)
Carpels (and/or tissue derived from carpel): color pencil G (green)
Sepals: color pencil B (blue)
Q.2.B.3. (8 points)
Complete the drawings of the transverse illustrations of the fruits (A2 and B2) of Q.2.B.3. in
the Answer Sheet. Draw additional lines and color the ovules (or seeds) and carpels (and/or
tissue derived from carpel) in the colors designated.
Ovule (or seeds): color pencil O (orange)
Carpels (and/or tissue derived from carpel): color pencil G (green)
11
Task 1
Photo of dissected caterpillar, dorsal view
B
C
Task 2
Flowers I and II
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 1
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER KEY
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.1. (1 point 2 = 2 points
Q.1.2. (3 points)
6
Q.1.3. (3 points)
9
* The answer "8" is scored as one point: the spiracles in the first thoracic segment is
apt not to be noticed, because the first thoracic spiracles are unique in the insects.
Q.1.4. (6 points +[name: 2 points + function: 2 point] 3 points= 18 points)
Photograph of specimen (6 points)
* The students skillfully made a dissection exactly as shown in the photo
prepared are given full marks. Even if the dissection is not so skillful, the dissection,
which may be good enough for the students themselves to distinguish and identify the
tubular structures concerned, is given 4 points. The dissection without sufficient
quality is only given 3 points.
name
Function
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.5. (2 points3 = 6 points) , Q.1.7. (4 points3 = 12 points)
A
P
* Q.1.5.: The students have to answer the questions, based on their own direct
observations on the dissected and non-anesthetized caterpillars. As for the circulatory
system, the students could observe only the heart beating in the dorsum of the
abdomen, and this has to be clearly shown in the drawings: the other information is
not evaluated. As for the central nervous system, the following points are important:
1) the crossing with the gut around the oesophagus, 2) the brain in the head, and 3)
ventral localization . As for the digestive system, the anterior and posterior ends have
to be clearly shown. For each structure, the answers missing only one of key points
mentioned-above are given 1 point.
* Q.1.7. The anteriomost and the anterior-second gangia are clearly shown in the head
and just posterior to the point crossing with the gut, respectively. The posteriormost
ganglion shoud be shown in the seventh abdominal segment; the other answer is given
2 points, so far as it is shown in the range of the post abdomen.
Q.1.6. (4 points)
13
* The correct answer is "13", but the "12", "11" and "10 are respectively given 3, 2
and 1 points.
Q.1.8. (2 points)
2
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.2.A.1. (27 points)
Starch
seeds
Embryo
endosperm
II
III
++
IV
seeds
Embryo
endosperm
II
III
IV
seeds
Embryo
endosperm
++
II
++
III
IV
Protein
Lipid
3 point x 9 = 27 points
barley
sunflower
buckwheat
azuki bean
Hordeum vulgare
Helianthus annuus
Fagopyrum esculentum
Vigna angularis
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Starch
correct combination of symbols
pattern of the
seeds
correct answers
embryo
endosperm
I
II
III
-,
+
or +
-,
-,,+
+
++
N
+
++
or +, N
1. - andare added.
2. Partially point (1 point) are given to - , N, and ++,N pairs.
Protein
seeds
I
II
III
-,
+
+, ++, (+)
+
++
+
++
N
+
++
pattern of the
correct answers
+, N
1. and++are added.
2. Two points are given to +, N pair.
3. One point is given to + in II-embryo box.
4. One point is given to N in II-endosperm box.
5. No points are given when the both box of a seed are filled with N.
Lipid
seeds
II
III
+
++
+
++
+
++
+
N
N
- , (+)
-, (+)
pattern of the
correct answers
>
+, N or ++,N
+,- or ++,-
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.2.B.1. ( 4 points)
Fruit
Flower
II
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.2.B.2. ( 11 points)
or
1 point x 11 = 11 points
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
A1:
1 Sepals are drawn.
2 Sepals are painted in blue
The point is given when a student color the edible part of an apple in blue.
3 Ovules (or seeds) are drawn
4 Ovules (or seeds) are painted in orange
5 Carpels (and/or tissue derived from carpel) are painted in green
B1:
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.2.B.3. ( 8 points)
or
2 points x 4 = 8 points
A2:
B2:
1 Two carpels are shown (there are three carpels in some fruits)
Carpels are shown (1 point), and painted in green (1 point).
2 Ovules (or seeds) are drawn
Ovules are shown (1 point), and painted in orange (1 point).
3 Five carpels are shown (there are more or less carpels depends on fruits)
(The answer shown below is also acceptable)
Carpels are shown (1 point), and painted in green (1 point).
4 Ovules (or seeds) are drawn
Ovules are shown (1 point), and painted in orange (1 point).
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 1 ANSWER KEY
ANIMAL AND PLANT ANATOMY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
************ END OF PRACTICAL TEST 1 *****
10
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
(70 points)
(30 points)
You must write down your results and answers in the ANSWER SHEET. Answers
written in the Question Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each
task. If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand.
At the end of the test, put the Answer Sheet and Question Paper in the envelope. The
supervisor will collect this envelope.
Good Luck!!
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
shoulders
Fig. 1
Fig. 2
Lid
Cuvette
holder
Light
Fig. 3
Fig. 4
Fig. 5
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
Introduction
Acid phosphatase liberates phosphate ions from phosphorylated molecules under acidic
conditions. The purpose of this experiment is to determine the specific activity of the acid
phosphatase. You will measure activities of the acid phosphatase using a crude extract from
potato in Task 1, and determine a protein concentration of the crude extract in Task 2.
Specific activity, which is the activity per unit time per unit weight of protein, is obtained
from Tasks 1 and 2. Specific activity is an index of purity; it increases as the enzyme is
purified.
Caution
1.
2.
In calculations where answers to previous questions are needed, partials marks will be
given if calculated formulas are correct, even if answers are incorrect.
Quantity
1. Spectrophotometer
2. Micropipettes (P1000)
3. Micropipettes (P200)
5. Plastic cuvette
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
A, absorbance
, absorption coefficient (M-1 cm-1)
C, concentration (M=mol litre-1 )
L, light path length (cm)
I0, intensity of incident light
I, intensity of transmission light
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
Two enzyme concentrations are to be examined in Task 1. Find the test tube on which 1x
enzyme is labeled, which contains a crude extract of acid phosphatase. Next, find the 15-ml
tube that contains 3% NaCl and remove 1ml of the solution so that the tube now contains 9
ml of 3% NaCl. Add 1 ml of the 1x enzyme solution to it by using a micropipette, which
makes 0.1x enzyme solution. Relabel the tube as 0.1x. Next, find 6 empty test tubes.
Label each tube with an enzyme concentration and a reaction time as follows.
0.1x, 20 min
1x, 20 min
0.1x, 10 min
1x, 10 min
0.1x, 1 min
1x, 1 min
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.1.1. (10 points) First, make an experimental schedule in order to perform all reactions, by
describing start () and stop () signs for each reaction in the table in the Answer Sheet,
allowing at least 1 min between the beginning of each reaction. An example for the reaction
of 0.1x, 20 min has been described in the table in the Answer Sheet.
Q.1.2. (15+10 points) Perform the enzymatic reactions according to the protocol described
below and the schedule you made in Q.1.1. Use a new pipette tip in every manipulation.
Agitate a mixture by tapping a test tube immediately after an addition. After you perform all
the reactions, measure A400 of the samples. Write the obtained values in the table in the
Answer Sheet, and plot them in the graph. Please note that since water has been used as
blank, the line will not pass through 0 (zero) on Y-axis (origin).
ml
ml
ml
ml
ml
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.1.3. (15 points) Which enzyme concentration gave better linearity in the relationship
between time and A400? Circle the correct one on the Answer Sheet. Read the slope of this
straight line from the graph.
Q.1.4. (5 points) Using the slope obtained in Q. 1.3, calculate the activity in the form of
A400 change per min per 1 ml of an enzyme solution of concentration 1x. The length of the
light path (L) is 1cm. Your answer should be written with your calculations and the
appropriate unit in the Answer Sheet.
Q.1.5. (5 points) Convert the absorbance change obtained in Q.1.4 to a concentration change
by assuming the 400 of pNP to be 19000 M-1 cm-1. Your answer should be written with your
calculations and the unit per min per 1 ml of 1x enzyme solution in the Answer Sheet.
Q.1.6. (5 points) Convert the concentration change obtained in Q.1.5. to a change in number
of moles of pNP. Your answer should be written with your calculations in moles per min per
ml of 1x enzyme solution in the Answer Sheet.
Q.1.7. (5 points) Calculate the total activity (in moles per min) in 4 ml of 1x enzyme solution that
was initially given .
11
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
By diluting a concentrated BSA solution (0.4 mg protein ml-1) with 3% NaCl, a 1/2dilution series was made (0.4, 0.2, 0.1, and 0.05 mg protein ml-1). The dilution series of BSA
and the 0.1x enzyme solution, which was made in Task 1, were all similarly treated with dye.
Optical density at 595 nm (OD595) of these samples was measured and recorded in the table
below.
Table
Sample
[BSA]
(mg ml -1 )
0.00
0.05
0.1
0.2
0.4
OD595
0.000
0.070
0.143
0.261
0.521
0.180
Optical density (OD), a measure of the extent to which a substance transmits light or the
absorbance of suspension of particles.
Q.2.1.(10 points) Plot OD595 against BSA concentration in the graph in the Answer Sheet
and depict an approximate straight line.
12
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.2.2.(10 points) Estimate a protein concentration of the 0.1x enzyme solution from the
graph, and obtain the protein concentration of the 1x enzyme solution.
Q.2.3.(10 points) Calculate the specific activity (activity per min per mg protein) of the 1x
enzyme solution. Your answer should be written with your calculations and the unit per min
per mg protein in the Answer Sheet.
13
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 2
BIOCHEMISTRY
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER KEY
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.1. (10 points)
Enzyme conc.
Time (min)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
0.1x
20
1x
20
0.1x
10
1x
10
0.1x
1
1x
1
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY
STUDENT CODE:
A400
___________________________________________________________________
4.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
0
10
20
Tim e (m in)
30
In this case, time is the independent variable, which must be plotted on the X-axis, while
absorbance is dependent variable, which must be plotted on the Y-axis. Principally, both axes
should be labeled with unit, but absorbance is an absolute number having no units.
1x
0.1x
Slope= (1.342-0.338)/(20-1)
=
0.053 min-1
The slope is calculated from the data point as described in the above box or directly read from
the graph.
Q.1.4.(5 points)
A= Ans(Q..3.) *(1/0.24)*10
=
0.053*
4.17
*10
=
2.2 ml -1 min-1
The slope obtained with 0.24 ml of 0.1x enzyme is proportionally converted to what would be
obtained with 1 ml of 1x enzyme solution.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.5. (5 points)
The rate obtained as the absorbance change per min per ml of 1x enzyme is converted to a
concentration change by using the absorption coefficient of pNP, 19000 M -1 cm-1. Note that L
is 1 cm, as described in the box in the Question paper.
Q.1.6. (5 points)
Mol number is calculated by multiplying the concentration change by the volume of mixture
that was subjected to the measurement of absorbance, that is 1.2 ml. Remember that M
(molar) is mol/liter, and the unit of the volume must be liter, not milliliter.
Q.1.7. (5 points)
Total activity is calculated by multiplying the activity per ml of 1x enzyme solution by the
volume of 1x enzyme solution.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 2 ANSWER KEY
BIOCHEMISTRY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.2.1. (10 points)
0.6
0.5
OD595
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
protein (m g/m l)
0.4
0.5
Optical density is the absorbance of suspension, and can be treated like absorbance in Task
2*. Protein concentration is the independent variable, which must be plotted on the X-axis,
while optical density is the dependent variable, which must be plotted on the Y-axis. Both
axes should be labeled with unit, but optical density is an absolute number having no units
like absorbance.
*Absorbance is a term for solutions, but cannot be used for suspensions. In the Bradford
method, mixing of soluble proteins with the Bradford dye yields insoluble materials that
absorb 595-nm light and are precipitated by low speed centrifugation.
The plot of 5 point gives a straight line. The intersection of the straight line and an OD=0.18
line shows that the concentration of 0.1x enzyme is 0.135 mg ml1. The concentration of 1x
enzyme solution can be obtained by multiplying the concentration of 0.1x enzyme by 10.
Specific activity is the activity per unit weight (mg) of protein. The 1x enzyme
solution has the activity of 1.4 x 107 (mol min1 ml 1) and the protein concentration of
1.35 mg ml1. Thus, the specific activity is calculated by dividing the former by the latter.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
Total Points: 98
Duration: 90 minutes
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
(9 points)
(33 points)
(18 points)
(14 points)
(24 points)
You must write down your results and answers in the ANSWER SHEET. Answers
written in the Question Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each
task. If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand.
At the end of the test, put the Answer Sheet and Question Paper in the envelope. The
supervisor will collect this envelope.
This series of practicals are time consuming. You will need to be well organized and work
quickly to complete the five tasks.
Good Luck!!
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Task 1 (9 points)
Phenotypic observation of mutant flies
Materials and Equipment
Quantity
1.
1 set
2.
Introduction
Fruit flies are commonly used materials in genetics studies. Petri dish (1) contains the wild
type, and each of the Petri dishes (2)-(4) contains different mutant flies. Observe the flies
carefully by using the loupe (magnifying glass), but do not open the lid of the dishes. You may
adjust the height and angle of the loupe for your observations.
Q.1.1. (9 points) In the case of each mutant, what kind of trait differs from the wild type?
Choose the characteristic phenotype of the mutant trait from the following list.
A. eye color
B. eye shape
C. wing shape
D. bristle length
E. antenna shape
F. bristle shape
G. leg shape
H. proboscis shape
I. body color
J. abdomen length
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Quantity
1 set
3. White cardboard (place under the Petri dishes for easy observation)
4. Forceps
Introduction
Wild type fruit flies (WT) have red eyes, while the mutant flies (w) have white eyes. w is a
recessive mutation and located on the X chromosome. Each of tubes (5a) and (5b) or (6a) and
(6b) separately contains male or female flies obtained from two different crossings. Tube (7)
contains flies of both sexes from another crossing. Note that flies can be sexed by their patterns
of the posterior dorsal abdomen, which is uniformly black in males.
Female
Male
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.2.1. (8 points) Remove the flies from tubes (5a) and (5b) into different Petri dishes, and
observe them by using the loupe (magnifying glass). Examine sex and eye color, and complete
the table with the numbers of flies, including zero.
Q.2.2. (8 points) Remove the flies from tubes (6a) and (6b) into different Petri dishes, and
observe them by using the loupe (magnifying glass). Examine sex and eye color, and complete
the table with the numbers of flies, including zero.
Q.2.3. (8 points) Remove the flies from tube (7) into a Petri dish, and observe them by using
the loupe (magnifying glass). Examine sex and eye color, and complete the table with the
numbers of flies, including zero.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.2.6. (9 points) Which of the following crossings produce the flies of tubes (5a) and (5b),
(6a) and (6b), and (7)? Choose all possible cases and answer with symbols.
A. Homozygous red-eyed females and hemizygous red-eyed males
B. Homozygous white-eyed females and hemizygous white-eyed males
C. Homozygous red-eyed females and hemizygous white-eyed males
D. Homozygous white-eyed females and hemizygous red-eyed males
E. Heterozygous females and hemizygous red-eyed males
F. Heterozygous females and hemizygous white-eyed males
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Quantity
In addition to the materials and equipment used in Task 2, you will use the following set of
equipment in this task.
1. 1.5 ml tubes (8) and (9) containing eye-pigments extraction solution
2 (1 spare)
4. Centrifuge
5. Micropipette (P20)
1 pack
2 (2 spares)
8. Cellulose/plastic sheet
1 (1 spare)
9. Micropipette (P2)
1 pack
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Procedure
1. Select five red-eyed and five white-eyed flies classified in Task 2 (either females or males),
and remove their heads from the bodies using two pairs of forceps.
*Be sure not to crush eyes and abdomen of the flies.
2. By using forceps transfer the heads of red-eyed flies into tube (8), the heads of white-eyed
flies into tube (9), the bodies of red-eyed flies into tube (10), and the bodies of white-eyed
flies into tube (11). Tubes (10) and (11) will be used in Task 5.
3. Insert a micropestle in each of tubes (8) and (9) and grind fly heads by revolving and
pressing the pestle against the bottom of the tube with your hand. Use different pestles for
different samples.
4. Centrifuge tubes (8) and (9) at 14,000 rpm for 3 min (see the Instruction for the
centrifuge at the end of this test, pages 18-19, and ask the supervisor for assistance if
required).
5. Transfer 5 l of supernatant from tubes (8) and (9) into new tubes.
6. Look at the cellulose/plastic sheet. The shorter sides of the cellulose/plastic sheet are the
top and the bottom, and the non-glazy surface is the cellulose surface, which is used in this
8
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
experiment. Write your student code with pencil at the top of the cellulose surface.
7. First, spot 1l of the red-eyed heads extract at 1/3 from the left side and about 2 cm from
the bottom of the sheet. Do not draw a line using a pencil or a marker pen, which may
scratch the cellulose coating.
8. Then, spot 1l of the white-eyed heads extract at 1/3 from the right side and about 2 cm
from the bottom of the sheet.
9. When the spots dry, set the sheet into the 50 ml tube so that the bottom of the sheet touches
the solvent, and close the cap tightly. Make sure the spots are not touched by the solvent.
Open and close the cap of the tube quickly to minimize the leak of vapor.
10. Keep the tube straight on the tube rack to start solvent development. You can continue with
task 4 and 5 in the test and come back to this section. Please read part 11 below before
you continue.
11. When the solvent front on the sheet reaches the 30 ml graduation mark of the tube, take the
sheet out from the tube, let it dry on a piece of paper towel and close the cap of the tube.
Raise your hand once the cellulose sheet is dry. (Your assistant will collect your sheet to
evaluate the result.) (18 points)
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
10
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Table 1 summarizes color under UV lamp and Rf value of each pigment separated from
the compound eyes of fruit flies.
Table 1
Code
Name
Rf value
2-amino-4-hydroxypteridin
blue
0.57
biopterin
blue
0.61
drosopterin
orange
0.21
sepiapterin
yellow
0.52
isoxanthopterin
yellow
0.69
xanthopterin
green-blue
0.38
isosepiapterin
violet-blue
0.25
Q.4.1. (5 points) Choose the pigment from Table 1 that corresponds to each of the spots
separated in the Figure 1 chromatography. Answer with the code in the table. How are the
compositions of the pteridin eye pigments of the mutants different from that of the wild type?
Estimate the approximate amount of each pigment deduced from the Figure 1 chromatography.
Write ++ if there is a lot more of the pigment as compared with the wild type, + if the
pigment is present in similar amounts as in wild type, and - if the pigment is not present.
Q.4.2. (9 points) Given the eye color and the results of chromatography shown in Figure 1,
which of the following abnormalities do se (sepia eyes), bw (brown eyes), and cn (cinnabar
eyes) have? Write the corresponding alphabet.
A.
B.
All pteridin pigments are absent but ommochrome pigments must be present.
C.
D.
11
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Solvent front
Spot 1 (yellow)
Spot 2 (blue)
Spot 3 (blue)
Spot 4 (yellow)
WT
se
bw
cn
Figure 1. Chromatography of eye pigments from wild type and mutant flies
12
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
Quantity
1.
2.
3.
2 (1 spare)
4.
5.
Micropipetter (P200)
6.
Micropipetter (P20)
7.
1 pack
8.
9.
13
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
14
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
WT
M1
M2
M3
Q.5.1. (3 points) Which of the following defects of eye pigment genes causes the
electrophoresis results of M1, M2 and M3? Choose the corresponding symbols from A, B and
C.
A. The mRNA initiation site of the white gene is deleted, and the gene is not
expressed.
B. A stop codon mutation has occurred in the coding region of the White protein,
resulting in failure of translation of carboxyl terminal peptide sequence
corresponding to molecular weight 20 kDa.
C. Although a normal White protein is synthesized, genes involved in the synthesis of
ommochrome pigments are defective.
Q.5.2. (3 points) Choose another defect of eye pigment gene from A, B and C that would cause
the same phenotypes as M1, M2 and M3.
15
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
A. The coding sequence of the white gene is fused with the coding sequence of
another gene by chromosomal translocation, resulting in a novel sequence encoding
a fusion protein that retains antibody reacting sites but exhibits about 30 % lower
molecular weight.
B. A single base substitution has occurred in the protein-coding region of the white
gene changing an amino acid coding sequence into another amino acid coding
sequence.
16
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
17
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
_______________________________________________________________________
18
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER SHEET
GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 3
GENETICS
Total Points: 100
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER KEYS AND CRITERIA
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER SHEET
GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.1. (9 points)
3
(2)
(3)
(4)
Q.2.1.(8 points)
Four points for complete row
Four points for complete row
Four points for each complete row.
Two points if other numbers for 10 is written.
No points if other numbers for 0 is written.
red females
white females
red males
white males
(5a)
10
(5b)
10
Q.2.2.(8 points)
Four points for each complete row.
Two points if other numbers for 10 is written.
No points if other numbers for 0 is written.
red females
white females
red males
white males
(6a)
10
(6b)
10
Q.2.3.(8 points)
Two points for each box.
For red females, one point for the numbers 8, 9, 11 or 12.
For white females, only zero is acceptable and other numbers
receive no point.
For red males and white males, one point for 4 or 6.
(7)
red females
white females
red males
white males
10
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER SHEET
GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.2.4.(1 point)
D
Q.2.5.(1 point)
E
Q.2.6. (9 points)
Three points for each.
For (5a) and (5b), one point if only one answer is chosen.
A, C
(7)
4 points
2.
4 points
3.
4 points
4.
6 points
1.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER SHEET
GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.4.1. (5 points)
One point for each column with correct answers for all
Spot No.
WT
se
bw
cn
Pigment
(A-G)
E
++
Q.4.2. (9 points)
3 points for each
se
bw
cn
1.
2.
3 x 3 points
3.
BPB dye bands are well migrated for the two samples
2 x 3 points
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 3 ANSWER SHEET
GENETICS
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.5.1. (3 points)
3 points only when all answers are correct. No partial points.
M1
M2
M3
Q.5.2. (3 points)
3 points only when all answers are correct. No partial points.
M1
M2
M3
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
Total Points: 10191
Duration: 90 minutes
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
You must write down your results and answers in the ANSWER SHEET. Answers
written in the Question Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed for each
task. If any of these items are missing, please raise your hand.
At the end of the test, put the Answer Sheet and Question Paper in the envelope. The
supervisor will collect this envelope.
Good Luck!!
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Introduction
In many unicellular organisms, gene duplication and segregation occur in a controlled
manner as the cell body grows. When the environmental conditions in which cells are
growing become less favorable or stressful, genetic exchange is often seen via cell
conjugation (mating) between cells of different mating the same cell types. That
phenomenon is essential for life and is controlled by both internal and external condition of
the cells. To date, we have tried to reveal these mechanisms by studying mutants in several
model organisms. For example, the investigation of mutants in the fission yeast,
Schizosaccharomyces pombe has provided us with invaluable information. Wild-type S.
pombe cells proliferate by repeated cell elongation followed by symmetric cell division. On
the other hand, under stressful conditions such as starvation, cells undergo arrested growth at
an appropriate stage of the cycle, and spore formation is induced via cell conjugation to
overcome the stressful conditions.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Quantity
6. Microscope
8. Counter
9. 1.5ml microtube
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Part A
The growth curve of S. pombe wild-type haploid (n=1) incubated at 25C is shown below.
Sampling of culture medium has been carried out at time points indicated by an arrow.
Culture media a, b, c and d on the bench correspond to a sample of the culture taken at a
certain time of cultivation I, II, III or IV. Observe each of the media with a microscope, and
answer the following questions. Please stir the microtube just before observation.
II
III
IV
Q.1.A.1. (5 2x2points) Compare the cells in sample a with those in sample b. Determine
whether the following statements are true or false. Put a cross mark (x) in the appropriate
boxes in the answer sheet. , and answer the following questions.
1
There is no difference between samples a and bIn which sample are the cells
rounder?
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Cells in sample a are rounder than those in sample bIn which sample is there a
Population of cells containing septa in sample b are higher than those in sample a
Population of cells containing septa in sample a are higher than those in sample b
Q.1.A.2. (6 points) Measure the number of cells per 1 ml culture medium in sample a by
using the cell counter as indicated below. Daughter cells that have not separated should be
counted as a single cell. Write your Answer on the Answer Sheet. Notice that each student
has received one cell counter but each counter has two counting chambers. You can make
two measurements with this counter.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.1.A.3. (5 points) Cytokinesis is defined as the part of the cell cycle from initiation of
septum formation to the separation of daughter cells. Measure the percentage of cells
undergoing cytokinesis in the culture medium in sample a. You should count more than 100
cells in total by choosing several optical fields at random. You must write the percentage of
cells undergoing cytokinesis AND the total number of cells you counted on the Answer
Sheet.
Q.1.A.4. (4 points) In the growth curve shown above, cells divided asynchronously during
the logarithmic phase. Estimate the time period required for one round of the cell cycle of
cells in logarithmic phase, provided that it takes 25 min from the beginning of septum
formationcytokinesis to the separation of the daughter cells. Enter both the formula and your
answer in the Answer Sheet.
vigorously growing
forming spores
conjugating
undergoing meiosis
Q.1.A.6. (8 points) Which culture medium (I, II, III, or IV ) corresponds to a, b, c and d,
respectively? Fill in the Answer Sheet by putting I, II, III, or IV.
7
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Part B
Both wild-type and cdc25-mutant strains were incubated at 36C for 4 hrs after logarithmic
growth at 25C. cdc25-mutant strain is not able to grow at 36C while it normally grows as
well as wild-type strain at 25C. The number of nuclei per cell is shown below. Daughter
cells that have not separated were counted as a single cell.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.1.B.1.(3 points) By observing the phenotypes of the cultures W25, W36, M25 and M36,
what can we conclude?
Condition
A 25C
Undergo cytokinesis
B 25C
Undergo cytokinesis
C 36C
Undergo cytokinesis
D 36C
Undergo cytokinesis
25C and
36C
type cells
10
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.1.B.2.(4 points) To measure cell length, your microscope is equipped with a micrometer
in the eyepiece lens. In order to calibrate the eyepiece micrometer, a second micrometer,
called the stage micrometer, is place on the stage of the microscope. The distance between
any two adjacent lines on the stage micrometer is known to be 10.0m. By matching the
lines on both micrometers, we can determine the distance between two adjacent lines of the
eyepiece micrometer. Determine this distance inm to two decimal places using the figure
shown below.
11
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.1.B.3.(12 points) Measure the longitudinal length of more than 10 cells selected at
random in culture media of M36. Graph your results in the Answer Sheet according to the
example indicated below. The scale of your eyepiece micrometer is 4m. Do not forget to
indicate the unit of length.
Q.1.B.4.(2 points) What can you conclude from your observations of each culture?
cdc25 cells are longer than wild-type cells at:
12
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Part C
The following experiment was done using wild-type cells and 5 mutant strains (A-E). These
mutant strains grow at 25C as well as wild-type cells but are not able to grow at 36C.
All cells undergoing logarithmic growth at 25C were then incubated at 36C for an
additional 4 hrs before chemical fixation. Fixed cells were stained with both Calcofluor
(stains septa) and DAPI (stains DNA) for observation using fluorescence microscopy (as seen
in the photograph provided on the bench).
Q.1.C.1.(10 points) The following statements describe the phenotype of the mutants
incubated at 36C. Identify the descriptions that correspond with each of the mutant strains
(A-E), respectively.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
13
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Introduction
Some unicellular algae and zygotes of multicellular algae swim actively. This behavior is
important for migration to appropriate conditions for growth and sexual reproduction.
Chlamydomonas reinhardtii, an unicellular green alga, swims using flagella movement.
Flagella often fall out when in contact with some stimuli, and some are absorbed into the cell
body at a specific stage of the cell cycle.
This task concerns the machinery of flagella movement and flagella regeneration in C.
reinhardtii.
Quantity
4. Microscope
9. Disposable pipette1 ml
10
14
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
12. Scissors
Caution
C. reinhardtii flagella frequently stick to glass slides. As a result, the swimming ability of
the cell is hindered. Therefore, cells immobilized on a glass slide should be excluded from
observations for cell movement. It is recommended to make a chamber as indicated below
for the observation. Slips of vinyl tape are stuck on a glass slide in parallel, and a coverslip is
mounted on the slips after the samples are loaded by pipette. This chamber will provide a
space for the cells to swim.
15
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Part A
Microscopically compare the wild-type (wt) and pf17 mutant (pf) cells. This mutant has a
normal shape and cellular structure but lacks a component of the radial spoke head in its
flagella.
Q.2.A.2. (4 2 points) What can you conclude about the function of the radial spoke head?
A
16
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Part B
Microscopically compare the wild-type (wt) and oda1 mutant (od). This mutant lacks a kind
of dynein in flagella whereas the shape and other cellular structures are normal.
Q.2.B.1. (6 points)
In comparison to wild-type cells, oda1 mutant cells swim:
A
Q.2.B.2. (4 2 points)
What can you conclude about the function of the dynein lost in the oda1 mutant?
A
17
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Part C
Study the effect of acetic acid on flagella as follows:
(i) Measure the percentage (A) of wild-type cells containingwith flagella in 20 cells by
choosing the most appropriate strain for this study.
(ii) Transfer about 1 ml of the culture selected in (i) into a 1.5 ml microtube by disposable
pipette, and add one drop of acetic acid solution
(iii) Add one drop of neutralizing solution after 30 seconds
(iv) Measure the percentage (B) of cells containing flagella in 20 cells after the treatment
Q.2.C.1.( (6 4points x 2)=12 8 points) Calculate the percentage of cells containing flagella
in the pretreatment (A) and posttreatment (B) samples.
18
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Part D
Wild-type cells with their flagella removed were incubated under different conditions (i, ii or
iii). The following graph indicates the flagella length relative to its original length at
different time points.
19
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
In addition, photographs of cells after incubation for 120 min are shown.
20
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q.2.D.1.(5 4 points) Are the following statements supported by observing the results of cells
incubated with cycloheximide? Put a cross mark (x) in the appropriate boxes in the answer
sheet.
1
43
54
De novo synthesis of protein is essential for the formation of the basal body of
flagella
Q.2.D.2.(2 points)
Polymerization of tubulin
Polymerization of actin
Polymerization of keratin
Depolymerization of tubulin
Depolymerization of actin
Depolymerization of keratin
21
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER SHEET
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
PRACTICAL TEST 4
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
Total Points: 91
Duration: 90 minutes
ANSWER Key
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER SHEET
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.A.1. (4 (22) points)
1
b
a
Q.1.A.2. (6 points)
4.8
e.g.
cells/ml
1. Actual length of cell is 4.790.60 106 cells /ml. This value is determined in two
independent experiments by 10 graduate students.
2. Full point is given for 2.4106 9.6106 cells /ml.
3. 3 point is given for answer between 1106 9.9106 cells /ml except range
prescribed in 2.
4. 1 point is given for answer between 1105 9.9107 cells /ml except range
prescribed in 2 and 3.
Q.1.A.3. (5 points)
19
120
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER SHEET
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.A.4. (4 points)
formula
solution
132 min
Q.1.A.5. (3 points)
II
IV
III
Q.1.B.1.(3 points)
C
Plural choice is null.
Q.1.B.2.(4 points)
3.85
m
Two points are given for 3.7-4.0.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER SHEET
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.1.B.3.(12 points)
1. It is essential for full mark that students make a graph similar to one of above four.
Top is a summarized result by 10 graduate students when they used objective lens
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER SHEET
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
(40). Three lower graphs may be possible if 4, 10, or 20, are applied.
Because, there is no description which objective lens should be used for experiment
in the problem.
2. 3 points are subtracted if student does not fill the appropriate unit in the bottom
bracket.
Q.1.B.4.(2 points)
A
Plural choice is null.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER SHEET
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Q.2.A.1. (6 points)
D
Plural choice is null.
Q.2.A.2. (2 points)
A
Plural choice is null.
Q.2.B.1. (6 points)
C
Plural choice is null.
Q.2.B.2. (2 points)
C and/or D
Q.2.C.1. (8 (4x2) points)
A
e.g. 95
0
%
1. In A 4 points are given for value more than 70% since almost all cells contain
flagella. Value under 70% is subtracted 2 points because of miss probably caused
by inadequate technique for observation.
2. In B 4 points are given for 0%. Because effect of acetic acid on removal of flagella
is absolute in this experimental condition. Other value smaller than A is subtracted
2 points.
IBO 2009
JAPAN
PRACTICAL TEST 4 ANSWER SHEET
CELL PHYSIOLOGY
STUDENT CODE:
___________________________________________________________________
Not-supported
1
2
3
Q.2.D.2. (2 points)
A
Plural choice is null.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
Country:
___________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants
The questions in Part A have only one correct answer. Mark the correct
answer with X on the Answer Sheet, which is provided separately. The
correct way of marking the cross is shown below. Use a pen or a dark pencil
to mark your answers.
Q.
NO.
20
Mark your answers clearly. Avoid any corrections in the Answer Sheet.
Country: ___________________________________
First name: _________________________________
Middle name: _______________________________
Family name: ________________________________
Student Code: _______________________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
PART A
CELL BIOLOGY (13 points)
1. (1 point) The central dogma originally proposed by Francis Crick has seen
changes reflecting new insights obtained from time to time. Which one of the
following schematics correctly depicts our current understanding of the
replication of genetic material in various organisms and the flow of
information in biological systems?
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
14
C would be
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
4. (1 point) A given DNA sample has 60% purines. The source of this DNA is
most likely to be:
a. a eukaryotic cell.
b. a bacterial cell.
c. a bacteriophage with double-stranded DNA.
d. a bacteriophage with single-stranded DNA.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
5. (1 point) The stage of cell division shown in the figure below represents:
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
a. 1
b. 3
c. 4
d. 40
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
7. (1 point) Which of the primer pairs is the correct one to amplify the gene
sequence below with PCR?
5-GCGTTGACGGTATCAAAACGTTAT TTTACCTGGTGGGCTGTTCTAATC-3
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
8. (1 point) Equal concentrations of urea, ethyl urea, and dimethyl urea were
separately added to a suspension of red blood cells (RBC). The relative rates
of diffusion of these molecules into RBCs will be:
a. 1 > 2 > 3
b. 1 > 2 = 3
c. 3 > 2 > 1
d. 3 = 2 > 1
10
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
The region of DNA enclosed within the box undergoes inversion. Which
one of the following correctly depicts the above DNA after inversion?
11
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
a. DNA ligase
b. Topoisomerase
c. DNA polymerase
d. Helicase
12
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
13
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
12. (1 point) The growth curve of a bacterial culture grown in a rich medium at
37C is shown in Figure A. The same organism when exposed to 45C for 30
min and then inoculated into a rich medium at 37C, exhibited a growth curve
shown in Figure B.
Time (hours)
Time (hours)
Turbidity
OD600
14
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
Choose the most likely reason for this from the following statements:
a. The molecule of drug being hydrophobic in nature passes through gastric and
intestinal membranes to a very small extent. However, because of the much
greater surface area in the intestine, the major quantity of the drug is
absorbed here.
b. The un-ionized form of the drug prevails in stomach, which slows down its
absorption. Hence, the drug gets preferentially absorbed in the intestine.
c. The ionized form of the drug prevails in the intestine which hinders/slows
down its absorption. However, owing to the large surface area available in the
intestine, the drug is absorbed mainly here.
d. Due to rapid churning movement and the low pH in the stomach, the drug is
completely broken down into smaller fragments, which are subsequently
absorbed in the intestine.
15
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
16
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
15. (1 point) The transverse sections of the leaves A and B given below
represent, respectively:
17
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
16. (1 point) Certain plant species such as Red Oak (Quercus rubra) can tolerate
severe drought over a long period of time without affecting its photosynthesis.
Which of the following adaptations is likely to contribute to this ability?
a. Stomatal closure
b. Large negative leaf water potential
c. Kranz leaf anatomy
d. Fibrous root system that increases root surface area
18
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
17. (1 point) The net assimilation of CO2 of a plant is 0.5 moles when illuminated
during the day. The net consumption of O2 is 0.12 moles during the night.
Assuming that all the gas exchange is due to photosynthesis and respiration
of the biomass (equivalent molecular mass of 30), what is the net production
or consumption of biomass in grams during a complete 12 h day:12 h night
diurnal cycle?
a. 3.6 g/day
b. 7.8 g/day
c. 11.4 g/day
d. 15.0 g/day
19
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
18. (1 point) Choose the figure that correctly represents the photosynthetic
efficiencies of C3 and C4 plants.
b.
a.
C4
Rate of photosynthesis
per unit leaf area
Rate of photosynthesis
per unit leaf area
C4
C3
C3
1%
50%
Sunlight
100%
1%
50%
Sunlight
100%
0C
25C
40C
0C
25C
40C
c.
d.
C3
Rate of photosynthesis
per unit leaf area
Rate of photosynthesis
per unit leaf area
C4
C3
1%
0C
50%
Sunlight
25C
100%
40C
20
C4
1%
50%
Sunlight
100%
0C
25C
40C
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
19. (1 point) Plant chloroplasts are believed to have evolved from cyanobacterialike progenitors through endosymbiosis. Which of the following statements
support this hypothesis?
a. I, III, IV and V
b. I, II, IV and VI
c. I, II, III and V
d. II, IV, V and VI
21
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
R
Conidia
Conidiophore
Germination
Hypha S
Germ tube
Ascospore
Antheridia
Ascogonia
Ascus
Plasmogamy
Karyogamy
22
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
CO2 compensation
(klux units)
(klux units)
point (ppm)
13
> 80
II
12
50 80
> 40
III
0.2 0.5
5 10
> 40
IV
12
a. I: C4 plants
III: Shade-loving C3 plants
b. I: Sun-loving C3 plants
III: C4 plants
c. I: C4 plants
III: Sun-loving C3 plants
d. I: C4 plants
III: Deep-sea algae
II: Bryophytes
IV: Shade-loving C3 plants
23
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
22. (1 point) The stem of a lily plant was placed in water tinted with red ink to
monitor the movement of water through it. Two transverse sections of stems
are given below. In which of the labeled structures would you expect the red
color?
A
a. A
b. B
c. C
d. D
e. E
24
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
25
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
26
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
25. (1 point) Which of the following will be an advantage of breathing in air over
breathing in water?
I. As air is less dense than water, less energy is required to move air over
respiratory surfaces.
II. Oxygen diffuses faster through air than it does through water.
III. The oxygen content of air is greater than that of an equal volume of water.
a. Only I and II
b. Only I and III
c. Only II and III
d. I, II and III
27
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
26. (1 point) Which characteristics would allow you to declare an organism found
on a beach as an echinoderm?
a. Radially symmetric adults with presence of spines and tube feet.
b. Radially symmetric adults with dorsal hollow notochord.
c. Exoskeleton with pharyngeal gill-slits and tube feet.
d. Radially symmetric adults with mantle cavity.
28
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
27. (1 point) In an individual X, the pituitary gland was found to function normally
while the adrenal glands were atrophied. In another individual Y, both the
pituitary and adrenal glands were found to be underdeveloped. If
adrenocorticotropic hormone (ACTH) is administered to these individuals as a
remedial measure, it will be effective in:
a. individual X alone.
b. individual Y alone.
c. both X and Y.
d. neither X nor Y.
29
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
28. (1 point) Which of the following are associated with stereoscopic vision?
I. Effect of the blind spot of one eye is cancelled by the other eye.
II. Total visual field of 360 and frontal visual field of 30.
III. More likely to be observed in predatory birds.
IV. Centrally situated fovea that gives good visual acuity.
a. I, II and IV
b. I, II and III
c.
d. I, III and IV
30
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
29. (1 point) The glycoside Phloridzin present in apple peel can block the
normal reabsorption of glucose from kidney tubules. As a result, sugar is
almost completely excreted through the urine. A mouse fed with Phloridzin
along with sodium succinate will develop:
a. hypoglycemia and no sugar will be detected in the urine sample.
b. hyperglycemia and urine test for sugar will be positive.
c. hyperglycemia and no sugar will be detected in the urine sample.
d. hypoglycemia and urine test for sugar will be positive.
31
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
30. (1 point) Cardiac output is defined as the amount of blood pumped by each
ventricle. It is determined by multiplying the heart rate and the stroke volume.
The stroke volume is the amount of blood ejected by each ventricle with each
beat. If the heart of a woman beats 56 times in a minute, the volume of blood
in her heart is 120 ml at the end of diastole and 76 ml at the end of systole,
what would be her cardiac output?
a. 10.976 L/min
b. 2.464 L/min
c. 6.720 L/min
d. 4.256 L/min
32
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
33
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
32. (1 point) If a molecule of carbon dioxide released into the blood in your left
foot travels out of your nose, it must pass through all of the following
structures except the:
a. right atrium
b. pulmonary vein
c. alveolus
d. bronchus
e. pulmonary artery
34
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
33. (1 point) The process of artificial kidney dialysis is shown schematically using
the following symbols:
: erythrocyte
: urea
: salts
: semi-permeable membrane
: proteins
a.
b.
c.
d.
35
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
36
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
35. (1 point) A mink breeder allows random mating among his minks. He
discovers that, on an average, 9% of his minks have rough fur that fetches
less money when sold. So he decides to focus upon smooth fur and does not
allow minks with rough fur to mate. Rough fur is linked to an autosomal
recessive allele. What is the percentage of minks with rough fur that he will
obtain in the next generation?
a. 7.3
b. 5.3
c. 25
d. 23
37
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
36. (1 point) In a breed of rabbits, multiple alleles with the following dominance
relationships control coat coloration:
C (agouti) > cch (chinchilla) > ch (Himalayan) > c (albino).
An experimental cross between agouti and Himalayan produced 50% agouti
and 50% Himalayan progeny. Which of the following crosses could produce
this result?
I. Cch X chch
II. Cc X chc
III. Cch X chc
IV. Cc X chch
a. I, II and III
b. II, III and IV
c. I, III and IV
d. I, II and IV
38
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
37. (1 point) Alleles IA and IB present on chromosome 9 are responsible for blood
groups A and B, respectively. Blood group O results when these alleles are
either absent or not expressed. The alleles IA and IB are expressed only if the
H allele is present on chromosome 19, either in the homozygous or
heterozygous condition, where h stands for the recessive allele.
Gilbert belongs to the AB blood group. His sister Helen belongs to the A
group while their father belongs to the O group. Identify the maternal and
paternal genotypes.
Mother
Father
a. H/H, IA/IB
H/h, IO/IO
b. H/h, IB/IO
h/h, IA/IO
h/h, IO/IO
h/h, IA/IO
d. H/H, IA/IO
H/h, IB/IO
e. h/h, IB/IO
H/h, IO/IO
c.
39
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
Relative frequency
Relative frequency
Relative frequency
Height
X
Height
Height
40
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
41
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
40. (1 point) Hunting of Northern elephant seals reduced their population size to
as few as 20 individuals at the end of the 19th century. Their population has
since rebounded to over 30,000. But their genomes still carry the marks of
this bottleneck when compared to the population of Southern elephant seals
that was not so intensely hunted. Such bottlenecks are manifested in the form
of:
I. abundance of unique mutations.
II. increased frequency of deleterious recessive alleles.
III. reduced genetic variation.
IV. increased population size.
a. Only I and II
b. Only III
c. I, II and IV
d. II and III
42
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
41. (1 point) What is true for both genetic drift and natural selection?
I. They are mechanisms of evolution.
II. They are entirely random processes.
III. They result in adaptations.
IV. They affect the genetic make-up of the population.
a. I and II
b. I and III
c. II and III
d. I and IV
43
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
42. (1 point) The frequencies of two codominant alleles with similar fitness values
in a laboratory population of mice were 0.55 and 0.45. After 5 generations,
the values changed to 0.35 and 0.65, respectively. Which of the following
phenomena may be responsible for this observation?
I. Point mutation
II. Nonrandom mating
III. Genetic drift
IV. Selection pressure
a. I and IV
b. II and IV
c. I and III
d. II and III
44
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
43. (1 point) In pea plants, the allele for green color of seeds (G) is dominant
over that for yellow color (g) while the allele for round seeds (R) is dominant
over that for wrinkled seed (r). The results of an experimental cross with such
garden pea plants are tabulated below:
Seed phenotype
Number
32
28
12
45
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
46
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
45. (1 point) If you have data on genotypic frequencies for several generations of
a population and if you apply the Hardy-Weinberg equation to it, which of the
following can be deduced?
I. Whether evolution has occurred in the population.
II. The direction of evolution, if it has occurred.
III. The cause of evolution, if it has occurred.
a. Only I and II
b. Only I and III
c. Only II and III
d. I, II and III
47
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
46. (1 point) The residues of mines often contain such high concentrations of
toxic metals (e.g., copper, lead) that most plants are unable to grow on them.
However, in a particular study, certain grasses were found to spread from the
surrounding uncontaminated soil onto such waste heaps. These plants
developed resistance to the toxic metals while their ability to grow on
uncontaminated soil decreased. As grasses are wind-pollinated, breeding
between the resistant and non-resistant populations went on. But eventually,
the less resistant plants growing on contaminated soil and the more resistant
plants growing on uncontaminated soil died out. This process is indicative of:
48
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
47. (1 point) Sickle cell anemia is an autosomal recessive trait. Individual 2 in the
following pedigree is a carrier for this trait. Assuming that individuals 3 and 4
are normal homozygous, what is the probability that individual 6 will have the
disease?
2
: Male
AA
Aa
a. 1/16
b. 1/32
c. 1/64
d. 1/128
49
: Female
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
Agouti
Abb
Albino
aaB
Black
aabb
Albino
The biochemical process that can explain the above pattern is:
a.
product of B gene
Colorless precursor
b.
product of A gene
agouti pigment
product of B gene
Colorless precursor
black pigment
product of A gene
black pigment
agouti pigment
c.
product of A gene
Colorless precursor
d.
product of B gene
agouti pigment
product of B gene
Colorless precursor
black pigment
product of A gene
agouti pigment
50
black pigment
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
49. (1 point) In a population, 90% of the alleles at the Rh locus are R. Another
alternative form of this allele is r. Forty children from this population go to a
particular play school. The probability that all are Rh positive is:
a. 400.81
b. 0.9940
c. 400.75
d. 1-0.8140
51
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
50. (1 point) Study the pedigree and answer the following question.
3
1
: Male
: Female
: Dizygotic twins
52
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
ECOLOGY (7 points)
51. (1 point) A typical biomass pyramid is represented in the figure below.
D
E
C
B
A
53
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
P
Q
R
102
103
104
105
Dose in rads
54
106
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
53. (1 point) Hay is boiled in water and cooled. Some pond water, containing only
heterotrophic protozoa, is added to it and kept in the dark for a long time.
Which of the following are true?
I. Heterotrophic succession of protozoa will occur with increase in total
biomass.
II. The energy of the system is maximum at the beginning.
III. Succession will occur, eventually reaching a steady state in which energy
flow is maintained.
IV. The ecosystem may undergo succession but finally all organisms will die
or go into resting stages.
a. I and III
b. II and IV
c. II and III
d. I and IV
55
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
Location
Mean root
Mean shoot
(cm)
biomass (g)
biomass (g)
Site A
27.2 + 0.2
348.7 + 0.5
680.7 + 0.1
Site B
13.4 + 0.3
322.4 + 0.6
708.9 + 0.2
56
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
55. (1 point) In an aquatic ecosystem, the total dry biomass of each of three
groups of organisms is as follows:
I. Ciliates: 1.1041 g
II. Midge larvae: 0.9845 g
III. Oligochaetes: 1.005 g
The correct food chain that they represent is:
a. I II III
b. II I III
c. I III II
d. III II I
e. II III I
57
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
56. (1 point) The reproductive effort of a plant is defined as the ratio of the dry
weight of its reproductive organs to that of its above-ground tissues. The
reproductive effort of two plant species M and N, as compared to their leaf
Reproductive effort
0.5
M
0.1
0
0.1
0.5
Leaf biomass / total biomass
58
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
57. (1 point) Prey-predator relationships are often considered analogous to a lifedinner relationship in behavioral ecology. Which of the following statements
best describe this analogy and the relative evolutionary rates of the prey and
predator species in a population?
I. This analogy indicates the fact that the prey species serves as the dinner
for the predator species, the life of which depends on the former.
II. This analogy indicates that a prey species caught by a predator loses its
life while a predator that fails to catch a prey only loses a dinner.
III. The prey species is usually under greater selection pressure from its
predators and tends to evolve faster than does a predator species.
IV. The predator species is usually under greater selection pressure because
of its dependence on a prey species for food and tends to evolve faster
than does a prey species.
a. I and III
b. I and IV
c. II and III
d. II and IV
59
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
ETHOLOGY (4 points)
58. (1 point) Animals can use their circadian clocks to determine direction from
the position of the sun. In a particular experiment conducted in Iceland, a bird,
kept in a cage open to the sky, was trained to seek food on the western side.
Its circadian rhythm was then phase-delayed by 6 hours and after phase
shifting, the bird was returned to its open cage at 12.00 noon real time. It was
observed to seek food in the:
a. north.
b. south.
c. east.
d. west.
60
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
59. (1 point) Coho Salmon is a fish found in the freshwater streams of North
America. The males of this species have two reproductive strategies to
fertilize the eggs laid by females. Larger males are able to fight with each
other successfully but smaller males are unable to do so. The latter adopt
another strategy, that of sneaking, in which they hide behind rocks and
quickly approach females to fertilize the eggs before the larger males are able
to do so. Which of the following graphs depicts the correct strategies?
a.
Fighting
Sneaking
Proximity to female
b.
Proximity to female
c.
Sneaking
Fighting
Sneaking
Fighting
Proximity to female
d.
Proximity to female
Fighting
Sneaking
61
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
60. (1 point) Young laughing gull chicks peck at the tip of the parents beak which,
in turn, induces the adult gull to regurgitate food. Experiments were
conducted with one-day old and three-day old chicks, the latter being reared
with their parents. These chicks were presented with the following models of
the parent head and the following responses were obtained:
Model
Parental
Experienced
II
III
IV
62
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
a. Pecking behavior is a fixed action pattern where any long pointed object acts
as an equally effective stimulus.
b. The pecking rate of laughing gull chicks increases with age.
c. The response of one-day old chicks is more pronounced when the model is
closer to that of the parent.
d. Act of pecking is an innate behavior while the discriminatory capacity of the
chicks is a result of learning.
63
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
61. (1 point) While studying the frogs of a certain species in their natural habitat
during the mating season, you observe a chorus of male frogs in which some
individuals are calling while others remain silent. On further observation, you
see the silent frogs are sitting closer to those that are calling.
Which of the following is most likely to explain the behavior of this chorus of
frogs?
a. The individuals who are not calling are staggering their calls with those of the
others and are likely to call later in the season after the latter have finished
mating.
b. The silent frogs are close genetic relatives of the calling individuals and do
not expend valuable energy in calling as the matings that the latter will
receive would provide adequate indirect fitness to them.
c. The silent frogs have evaluated that their calls are inadequate in attracting
females, as compared to those of the calling individuals, and lie in wait to
sneak matings with the females that approach the calling males.
d. The silent frogs do not expend energy in themselves calling as the female
frogs that are attracted to the calls of the others are anyway likely to visually
inspect the closely-spaced males and then choose their mating partners.
64
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
BIOSYSTEMATICS (2 points)
62. (1 point) Although Echidna lays eggs, it has been classified as a mammal
due to the presence of mammary glands. Which of the following additional
features support its inclusion in the class Mammalia?
Echidna
a. III and VI
b. I, IV and V
c. Only I and IV
d. I and II
e. I, IV and VI
65
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
_______________________________________________________________________
63. (1 point) Study the adjoining schematically drawn evolutionary lineage. The
Mammalia
Aves
Reptilia
Amphibia
Pisces
Agnatha
Protochordata
Invertebrates
TIME
66
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Answer
B
C
B
D
D
B
C
C
C
A
B
B
C
C
A
B
C
A
B
B
A
Question
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
= OMITTED
Answer
D
D
A
D
A
D
D
D
B
A
B
C
D
B
C
B
C
A
B
D
D
Question
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
Answer
A
B
A
D
C
B
B
A
B
- *
B
C
C
A
-*
A
D
D
C
E
A
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Country:
___________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants
The questions in Part B may have more than one correct answer. Fill your
answers in the Answer Sheet for Part B. The marks for the questions in Part
B vary depending on the number of answers and the complexity of the
question. These marks have been indicated along with the question.
Mark your answers clearly. Avoid any corrections in the Answer Sheet.
Country: ___________________________________
First name: _________________________________
Middle name: _______________________________
Family name: ________________________________
Student Code: _______________________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Answer: _________________Molar
Answer: _________________metre
Answer: ____________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Organ/Cell
SER
SER not
Function/s (if
extensively
extensively
extensively
present
present
present)
a. Adrenal gland
b. Sebaceous glands
c. Intestinal villi
d. Muscles
e. Liver
f.
Pancreas
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
3. (2 points) There are various mechanisms by which a cell can commit suicide
a phenomenon known as apoptosis. One of the mechanisms is triggered
by reactive oxygen species. The outer membrane of mitochondria normally
expresses a protein Bcl-2 on its surface. Another protein Apaf-1 binds Bcl-2.
Reactive oxygen species cause Bcl-2 to release Apaf-1 and a third protein
Bax to penetrate the mitochondrial membrane, releasing cytochrome c. The
released cytochrome c forms a complex with Apaf-1 and caspase 9. This
complex sequentially activates many proteases that digest cellular proteins.
Finally, the cell is phagocytosed.
What will be the fate of a cell exposed to reactive oxygen species in the
following situations? (Choose from options on the next page)
Situation III: A competitive inhibitor of Apaf-1 for Bcl-2 binding is added to the
cell in excess quantity. _______
Situation IV: A chemical which significantly lowers the ratio of Bax to Bcl-2 is
added to the cell. ________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Answer: _________________%
b. Calculate the Respiratory Quotient, which is defined as the molar ratio of the
CO2 produced to the O2 utilized.
Answer: __________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Experiment
Reaction mixture
Result
Quantity of Activity of
enzyme
enzyme
Liver homogenate
++++
II
++++
++++
III
Supernatant + hormone
++++
IV
Pellet + hormone
++++
++++
++++
++++
++++
VI
VII
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Precursor
Polysaccharide
Monosaccharide
Options:
A. Membrane-bound protein
B. Heat-stable molecule
C. Inactive enzyme
D. Active cytosolic enzyme
E. Hormone
F. Organic inhibitor
G. Heat shock protein
Fill in the appropriate letters in the table from the options given.
1
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
6. (4 points) Sugars and fatty acids are important biomolecules that provide
energy to the majority of living systems. The estimated utilization of palmitic
acid and glucose in the human body is shown in the equation below:
16 CO2 + 16 H2O
38 Pi + 38 ADP
38 ATP
(B) C H O + 6 O
6 12 6
2
6 CO2 + 6 H2O
II. ATP yield (in moles) per mole of oxygen in Reaction B:__________
III. ATP yield (in moles) per gram of fuel in Reaction A: ____________
IV. ATP yield (in moles) per gram of fuel in Reaction B:____________
V. Based on the above reactions, state whether the following statements are
true or false by putting tick marks () in the appropriate boxes.
10
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Statements:
a. Under conditions of mild-intensity exercise and abundance of oxygen, the
Respiratory Quotient tends to be < 1.
b. High-intensity exercise is primarily fuelled by fat when oxygen
concentration is limiting.
c. Reaction A represents the energy-acquiring process of nervous tissue
while Reaction B is more common in skeletal muscles involved in rapid
movement.
d. Under conditions of hypoxia, the shift of tissue metabolism from fatty acid
oxidation to glucose oxidation will yield more ATP.
True False
a.
b.
c.
d.
11
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
HindIII
HindIII
HindIII
300bp
200bp
EcoRI
800bp
200bp
700bp
EcoRI
Figure 7.1
She, therefore, mixes the two fragments in the presence of excess DNA
ligase in an appropriate buffer and incubates the mixture. She removes an
aliquot (a small part of the reaction mixture) after 30 minutes and loads it on
an agarose gel to check the results. She is surprised to find many bands
along with the expected 1.1kb band (as shown in the figure 7.2, next page) in
the gel.
12
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
1.9kb
1.1kb
0.8kb
0.6kb
0.3kb
Figure 7.2
b.
13
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
II. If another aliquot of the reaction mixture is removed after 8 hours, which one
of the following would be expected?
a. Prominent bands of high molecular weight.
b. Prominent bands of low molecular weight.
c. Large number of molecules of varying lengths leading to a smearing on the
gel.
d. The gel pattern would remain the same. Only the intensity of bands would
increase.
a.
b.
14
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
III. Leena is interested in the 1.1kb fragment shown in Figure 7.1. Hence, she
elutes the 1.1kb fragment from the gel shown in Figure 7.2 and subjects part
of this sample to HindIII digestion. She obtains the expected pattern with two
bands, 800 and 300 base pairs long. To confirm its restriction map, she
subjects the remaining sample to complete EcoRI digestion. Which pattern of
bands would she obtain?
2 kb
2 kb
2 kb
2 kb
1 kb
1 kb
1 kb
1 kb
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.7
0.7
0.7
0.7
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.5
0.3
0.3
0.3
0.3
0.1
0.1
0.1
0.1
b.
15
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
16
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Protein
I
Mode of regulation
II
III
IV
A
B
C
D
17
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
No.
I
Answer
Cell/s that is/are not alive when
functional.
II
III
IV
18
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
10. (1.5 points) On the basis of the photoperiod required for flowering, plants can
be described as:
I. Short-day plants
II. Long-day plants
III. Day-length indifferent plants
The effect of varying light periods on flowering in these three types of plants is
depicted in the graphs below, where TM, trophic minimum, is the minimum
light that is required to produce the organic matter indispensable to its
TM CP
24
Hours of light/day
Number of days before flowering
TM CP
24
Hours of light/day
19
24
(TM = CP)
Hours of light/day
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Choose the plant type (I, II or III) for each of the three graphs and fill in the
table.
Graph Plant type
A
B
C
20
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
11. (2 points) (A) A mesophyte was planted in soil with high salt concentration
and watered. It showed wilting. Assign the appropriate values of water
potentials to the regions marked P, Q, and R in the schematic representation
of this plant.
Choose from the options given below and fill in the table:
-1 atm
-5 atm
-8 atm
Region Water potential
______ atm
______ atm
______ atm
21
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
(B) Which of the following remedial measures will completely reverse wilting in
this plant? Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box.
a.
b.
22
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
12. (4 points) A few characteristics of some organisms are listed in the table. Put
a tick mark () against the appropriate organisms.
Chlamydomonas Cyanobacteria
Phototrophic autotrophs
Photosystem II absent
23
Green-
Purple-
sulphur
sulphur
bacteria
bacteria
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
13. (3.5 points) The total respiration (R) of a young growing plant is described by
the following expression:
R = 0.27 P + 0.015 W,
where P is the total amount of glucose produced per day and W is the
average mass of the plant.
Of the processes listed below, some influence the factor 0.27 of the above
equation whereas the others do not.
24
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Indicate with a tick mark ( ) in the appropriate column in the table below,
which of these processes do or do not affect the factor 0.27.
Process
Does
affect
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
25
Does not
affect
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Tidal volume
Frequency
(ml/breath)
(breaths/min)
(ml/breath)
800
12
600
500
16
350
600
12
200
Which of the following holds true about the alveolar ventilation of these three
individuals? See options on next page.
26
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Put a tick mark () for the correct statement(s) in the appropriate box of the
table.
a.
b.
27
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
15. (2 points) The relative growth rates of four organs of the human body are
shown in the following graphs.
Q
% of mass in
adults
% of mass in
adults
P
100
100
10
20
Age (years)
10
20
Age (years)
S
% of mass in
adults
% of mass in
adults
R
100
100
10
20
Age (years)
10
20
Age (years)
Match the graphs with the organs by putting a tick mark () in the appropriate
box of the table.
P
Liver
Brain
Thymus
Gonads
28
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
True False
a.
b.
c.
d.
29
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
% saturation of
hemoglobin
Two such curves, I and II, are depicted in the following graph
I
II
Condition
30
True False
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
18. (2 points) Given below are the data on breathing rate, heart rate and body
temperature of four different mammals A, B, C, and D.
Animals
Breathing rate
(inhalations/min)
Heart rate
(beats/min)
Body temperature
(C)
160
500
36.5
15
40
37.2
28
190
38.2
28
35.9
Study the data and rank these animals in descending order of surface area per
unit volume as well as the total volume of blood by filling in the boxes with
appropriate letters (A to D).
31
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
2. Mice
3. Mice
Using sera from the above immunization schemes, the following experiments
were conducted to test the response of these sera towards pathogens P or Q:
Number
Experiment
II
III
IV
VI
VII
VIII
IX
32
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
a.
b.
c.
d.
(B) If serum S2 is heated at 55C for 30 min, and mixed with serum S3, which of
the following pathogen would it lyse?
a. Only P
b. Only Q
c. P and Q both
d. Neither P nor Q
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box.
a.
b.
33
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
(C) Which of the following statements are TRUE or FALSE for the above
experiment?
a. The lysis of pathogen requires only one component, which is heat-labile.
b. The lysis of pathogens requires at least two components. One component is
induced by the pathogen, while the other is non-inducible and is pathogen
non-specific.
c. The pathogen-induced component is heat-labile whereas the non-specific
component is heat-stable.
d. The pathogen-induced component is heat-stable whereas the non-specific
component is heat-labile.
e. The pathogen-specific components cannot function if present together.
f. The non-specific component has to be derived from the same mice in which
the pathogen-specific component would be induced.
True
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
34
False
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
20. (3.5 points) In air-breathing animals, bicarbonate ions present in the blood
play an important role of buffering. Various equilibria that occur in lungs and
plasma are shown below.
Plasma
H+ + HCO3
Lungs
H2CO3
CO2
(dissolved)
CO2
(gaseous)
35
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Options:
I. Decrease in plasma carbon dioxide concentration
II. Decrease in blood bicarbonates
III. Acidosis
IV. Increase in blood bicarbonates
V. Increase in exhalation of carbon dioxide
VI. Alkalosis
36
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Answer: _________
37
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
22. (2 points) E. coli cells were grown in a medium containing glucose and
lactose, and a growth curve was obtained which is shown below.
Fill in the table using tick marks () to indicate which of the listed events
would predominate during the three phases of growth (I to III).
I
Lactose hydrolysis by -galactosidase
Reduction of lac repressors affinity for the lac operator
Utilization of glucose
38
II
III
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
23. (2 points) In a small tribal population, the frequencies of two alleles A and a
at a particular locus were 0.3 and 0.7, respectively. However, not all the
individuals with genotype aa could live up to the reproductive age and the
relative fitness of this genotype was found to be 0.5. The remaining
genotypes had a relative fitness of 1.
Answer: ______________%
39
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
24. (2 points) In the following pedigree, the probability that the individual marked
as
Normal female
Normal male
Affected female
Affected male
Answer: _______________
40
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
25. (2 points) If two heterozygotes (Aa) mate, what is the minimum number of
offspring they should have such that the probability of at least one offspring
having genotype aa is greater than 90%?
Answer: _______________
41
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
26. (2 points) A celebrity has been named in a paternity suit. The defendant
(labeled D in the autoradiogram), the mother (labeled M), and the baby
(labeled B) have each been typed for two loci VNTR1 and VNTR2, as shown
in the autoradiograms below. Each of these VNTR loci has four alleles. For
VNTR1, the frequencies of the alleles 1, 2, 3, and 4 in the general population
are 0.2, 0.4, 0.3, and 0.1, respectively. For VNTR2, the frequencies of alleles
1, 2, 3, and 4 are 0.1, 0.1, 0.2, and 0.6, respectively.
VNTR 1
M
VNTR 2
M
Yes No
b. What is the probability that another male in the general population could be
the father of the baby B?
Answer: _________________
42
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
27. (2 points) In some populations, inbreeding takes place amongst first cousins.
Inbreeding leads to a reduction in the frequency of heterozygotes and is
measured as the inbreeding co-efficient, F, where
heterozygo tes
heterozygo tes
f observed
f expected
1 F
The symbol f denotes frequency.
If F = 1 (complete inbreeding), the population consists entirely of
homozygotes.
a. Calculate F.
Answer: __________
b. If, for another population of the same species, the allelic frequencies remain
the same but the value of F is half of that calculated in a, what will be the
frequency of the heterozygotes (MN) observed in this group?
Answer: ____________
43
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Generation
I
II
III
Answer: _________________
44
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
29. (2 points) The figure given below depicts a region of double stranded DNA, in
a bacterium, containing a polycistronic operon with three of your favorite
genes yfgA, yfgB and yfgC, as shown. The positions of certain bases in the
nucleotide sequence around yfg operon, with respect to position A are
marked in the figure.
The yfg operon
TTGACA
-35 region
TATAAT
-10 region
Transcription termination site
B
C
yfgA
200
300
810
yfgB
yfgC
1230
1560
1750
45
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
a.
b.
c.
d.
II. From the above figure, calculate the maximal expected mass of the YfgA
protein .
________________kDa
(assume the mass of an amino acid to be 110 Da)
46
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
30. (2.5 points) The map distance between two genes on a chromosome can be
calculated using the frequency of crossing over between them. In case of a
genetic cross involving three genes, the crossover (CO) classes of progeny
can be categorized as
(i) Single crossover I (SCO I),
(ii) Single crossover II (SCO II), and
(iii) Double crossover (DCO).
DCO requires the simultaneous occurrence of the two SCOs.
Number of progeny
p q+ r
p+q r+
pqr
p+ q+ r+
p+ q+ r
p q r+
p q+ r+
p+ q r
375
355
50
45
75
85
8
7
Total = 1000
47
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
The middle gene is the one that has altered position in the DCO classes
compared to that in the NCO classes.
(A) Which is the middle gene in the given cross? Put a tick mark () in the
appropriate box.
p
q
r
(B) Assuming 1% crossover as one map unit (mu), calculate the distance
between p, q, and r.
Distance between p and q ________ mu
_________ mu
_________ mu
48
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Growth Curve
Number of organisms
Number of organisms
represent this population and put the corresponding letter in the boxes below.
Time
Time
Survivorship Curve
49
Age structure
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
32. (3 points) Nitrogen, as a mineral nutrient, has the greatest effect on plant
growth. The atmosphere contains nearly 80% nitrogen gas (N2), yet plants
have to be provided with ammonium salts or nitrates as fertilizers for optimum
growth and yield. Certain nitrogen-fixing bacteria (rhizobia, cyanobacteria,
etc.) can convert atmospheric N2 into ammonia using nitrogenase by the
following reaction:
N2 + 8 e- + 8 H+ + 16 ATP
2 NH3 + H2 + 16 ADP + 16 Pi
50
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
b.
c.
d.
b.
c.
d.
(C) Based on the given information, which type of soil bacteria will NOT be
beneficial for plants?
a. Nitrogen-fixing bacteria
b. Nitrifying bacteria
c. Denitrifying bacteria
51
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
b.
52
c.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
2. A female moth (A), the only pollinator, arrives at a Yucca flower (B) with a
ball of Yucca pollen. She places her pollen ball on the stigma and then
lays eggs in some, but not all, of the ovules. Offspring development kills
the seeds on which they feed. If too many seeds are killed, the fruit is
aborted by the plant, killing the developing moth larva.
4. Certain plants (A) attract ants (B) through extra-floral nectaries to deter
herbivores.
Indicate in the table given below whether the species (A and B) involved in
each of these are benefited (indicate by +), harmed (indicate by ) or not
affected (indicate by 0). Identify also the type of interaction by choosing from
the options I to VI given below.
53
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Options:
I.
Amensalism
II.
Commensalism
III.
Competition
IV.
Mutualism
V.
Parasitism
VI.
Predation
Number A
Type of
interaction
1.
2.
3.
4.
54
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
(A) Once a prey has been captured, the profitability (calories gained per unit time)
of each prey species for the predator is, respectively:
a.
E1
TH1
and
E2
TH2
b.
E1
E2
and
TH1 TH2
TH1 TH2
c.
E1
E2
and
N1TH1
N 2 TH2
55
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
d.
E1
E2
and
TH1 TH2 TS
TH1 TH2 TS
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box
a.
b.
c.
d.
(B) The total energy gain E for the predator will be:
a. E E1 E 2 TS
b. E E1N1 E2 N2
c. E E1N1 E2 N2 TS
d. E
E1N1 E 2 N 2
TS
b.
c.
d.
(C) The total time (T) spent to gain the total energy E will be:
a. T TS TS N1TH1 N 2 TH2
b.
T TS TH1 TH2
c.
T 1 N1TH1 N 2 TH2
d.
T TS N1TH1 N 2 TH2
56
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
b.
c.
d.
.
(D) In one situation, the following data were obtained:
Ts = 60 minutes
Prey1
Prey2
N1 = 2/min
N2 = 5/min
TH1 = 10 min
TH2 = 20 min
E1 = 1000 cal
E2 = 700 cal
57
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
a.
b.
58
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
35. (6 points) A female gall fly (Eurosta solidaginis) typically lays a single egg in
the bud of some plants. After the egg hatches, the larva burrows its way
through the bud and produces a tumor-like structure called a gall. Larvae
inside these galls present a very nutritious food source for many birds.
(A) After observing some galls, a student proposed a hypothesis that birds
choose larger galls in preference to smaller ones. In order to gather the data
to test this hypothesis, she conducted a survey of one such site and
measured the widths of disturbed (fed on by the birds) as well as undisturbed
galls. The results are as follows:
Disturbed galls
Undisturbed galls
12
1.
18
2.
15
2.
15
3.
30
3.
22
4.
20
4.
12
5.
23
5.
20
You need to put this hypothesis to test. (Some of the required statistical
formulae as well as the Student-t and Chi-square probabilities are provided in
the Appendix at the end of Part B-Question Paper.)
59
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
b.
c.
d.
b.
c.
d.
60
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
(B) After observing more sites, another student came up with a hypothesis that
patches with high density of galls are foraged more than those with low
density. To test this hypothesis, he surveyed six patches. The results are as
follows:
Gall
Site
Site
Site
Site
Site
Site
description
II
III
IV
VI
Density
High
Low
High
High
Low
Low
Foraged
15
10
14
60
Undisturbed
39
Total
20
17
22
14
17
99
61
Total
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
b.
c.
d.
II. To test the hypothesis, the test that will be required is:
a. Students t test
b. Chi-square test
c. Both Students t test and chi-square test
d. Either Students t test or chi-square test
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box.
a.
b.
c.
d.
62
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
a.
b.
63
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Payoff for
In presence of
Solitary
Social
PB
Solitary
Social
P + B C P + B/2 B/2 C = P C
64
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
b.
65
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
37. (3 points) Game theory models have been borrowed from economics and
often applied to behavioral ecology in order to understand the strategies that
animals use against each other while competing for resources. In a HawkDove game, for example, in which there were two kinds of competing
individuals, Hawks and Doves, with different behavioral strategies, John
Maynard Smith suggested the following pay-offs:
Winner
+50
Injury
-100
Loser
Display
-10
(A) Assuming that (a) Hawks always win against Doves, (b) Hawks win on half
the occasions when they meet other Hawks but suffer injury during the other
half, (c) Doves always display when they meet other Doves, but win on only
half of these occasions, and (d) Doves never display to hawks. What would
be the average pay-off to the attacker in different fights as listed in the
following matrix?
66
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Opponent
Hawk Dove
Hawk
Attacker
Dove
(B) An Evolutionary Stable Strategy (ESS) is one that will always win against any
other strategy and no other strategy can be successful within the population.
Evaluate whether the following statements are true or false given the pay-offs
for the Hawk and Dove strategies listed above.
a. Hawk is an ESS and when all individuals in a population play this strategy, a
mutation to Dove can never be successful.
b. Dove is an ESS and when all individuals in a population play this strategy, A
mutation to Hawk can never be successful.
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box.
Statement True
a.
b.
67
False
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
38. (2 points) White crown sparrows that live in temperate regions show a
complex annual cycle of behavior.
Winter
Autumn
D
B
Spring
Migration to north
Options:
I. Moulting (molting)
II. Gonadal regression (Shrinking of reproductive tissue)
III. Gonadal development (Development of the reproductive tissue)
IV. Fat deposition
V. Hibernation
68
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Points in the
Physiological
behavioral cycle
changes
A
B
C
D
69
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
39. (4 points) The dunnock is a common bird of the British Islands. The females
of this species establish territories represented by solid lines in the figure
below, which may be defended by one or two ( and ) unrelated males
(dashed lines). The numbers in the figure refer to the average number of
young raised per season by males and females in the different mating
combinations. The arrows indicate the directions in which the behaviour of the
males and females encourage changes in the mating system.
Male: 5.0
Monogamy
Female: 5.0
II
III
IV
Female: 3.8
Female: 6.7
Female: 3.8
Polygyny
Polyandry
70
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
(A) Identify the specific individuals, which would attempt to change the mating
system in the directions shown by the arrows.
a. I: Male, II: Female, III: Female, IV: -Male
b. I: Female, II: Male, III: -Male, IV: -Male
c. I: Female, II: Male, III: Female, IV: -Male
d. I: Male, II: Female, III: -Male, IV: -Male
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box.
a.
b.
c.
d.
71
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
a. I and II
b. II and III
c. I and IV
d. II and IV
b.
72
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
BIOSYSTEMATICS (13)
40. (2 points) The schematic diagram below represents group-in-group
relationships. The T3 taxon, represented by the largest circle, includes three
T2 taxa. Each of these three T2 taxa has one T1 taxon, represented by
circles filled with dots; the dots represent individuals.
T2a
T2c
T1a
T1c
T3
T2b
T1b
According to the above scheme, assign the correct taxa from the options
given below to each of the circles. Fill in your answers by writing the
appropriate number in the table. Points will only be awarded if the entire
table is correctly filled.
73
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Options:
I.
Annelida
II.
Lepidoptera
III.
Polychaeta
IV.
Mollusca
V.
Orthoptera
VI.
Insecta
VII.
Arthropoda
VIII.
Crustacea
IX.
Gastropoda
X.
Arachnida
XI.
Lumbricus (earthworm)
XII.
Hirudo (leech)
XIII.
Gryllus (cricket)
XIV.
XV.
Euscorpias (scorpion)
XVI.
Taxon
T3
T2a
T1a
T2b
T1b
T2c
T1c
74
Option
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Species
Sequence site
1
a.
P
Q
4 5
4 5
3
P
R
3 1
d.
1 4 5
Q
1 3
R
1 3
3
P
4 5
1
75
145
1 3
c.
b.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
b.
76
c.
d.
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
no bilateral
invertebrates
aquatic
Fill in the appropriate numbers from the classification chart against the
respective groups in the table below:
77
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
Group
Number
Group
Annelida (Earthworms)
Arthropoda (Crayfishes)
Mollusca (Squids)
Cnidaria (Jellyfishes)
Nematoda (Roundworms)
Echinodermata (Starfishes)
Platyhelminthes (Tapeworms)
Mollusca (Bivalvia)
Porifera (Sponges)
78
Number
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
43. (4 points) The genetic distances between four species are provided in a
matrix below. The numbers represent the percentage differences between
each pair of species.
C D
A -
B 5
C 13 14 -
D 15 16 6
(A) Which of the following tree structures represent the matrix data most
appropriately? (Squares in the generalized figure represent species, and the
lines represent the relationship between them).
a.
c.
b.
d.
79
IBO 2008
INDIA
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
_______________________________________________________________________
a.
b.
c.
d.
(B) Based on the answer selected in the previous question and using the data
given in the matrix, construct the tree that correctly shows the genetic
relatedness of the four species where the numbers on the lines should
approximate the genetic distance between them.
80
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Country: __________________
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
Total Points: 47
Duration: 60 minutes
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
In this test, you have been given the following two tasks:
Task 1: Study of factors affecting the activity of stomata (33 points)
Task 2: Study of plant anatomy and its correlation with the habitat
(14 points)
You have to write down your results and answers in the ANSWER SHEET.
Answers written in the Question Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed
for each task. In case any of these items is missing, please raise the yellow card.
At the end of the test, put the Answer Sheet and Question Paper in the envelope.
The supervisor will collect this envelope.
Good Luck!!
Country: ________________________
Country Code: ____________________
First Name: _______________________
Middle Name: _____________________
Family Name: _____________________
Student Code: ____________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Quantity
3. Glass microslides
4. Box of coverslips
5. Watchglass
6. Forceps
7. Brush
Introduction
Stomata are specialized microscopic structures found in all vascular plants.
These microscopic pores allow exchange of gases between the environment and the
plant cells. Stomata are also the sites from where water evaporates from the plant.
Various environmental factors such as temperature, humidity and light intensity can
affect the opening or closing of the stomata.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q. 1.1. (3 points) Some statements about stomata are given below. Indicate
whether the statements are true or false by putting a tick mark ( ) in the
appropriate boxes in Q. 1.1. in the Answer Sheet.
Statement
True False
a. Guard cells covering stomata are the only epidermal cells that
contain chloroplasts.
b. The Stomatal Index of any plant species is the ratio of number of
stomata in a given area of the leaf to the total number of stomata
and other epidermal cells in that same area.
c. Stomata are characteristic of angiosperms alone.
d. Larger the stomatal pore, greater is the rate of transpiration per
unit area of the pore.
e. The Stomatal Index is always constant for a given species.
f.
A plant with stomata only on the upper surface of its leaves is most
likely to be a submerged hydrophyte.
A thin coat of transparent colourless nail polish is applied on the leaf surface. The
coat is allowed to dry and peeled off using a pair of forceps. This imprint is placed on
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Open and closed stomata can be easily distinguished from these imprints.
Representative microscopic images of the imprints are given below.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
In this task, you will study the effect of various factors on the opening and closing of
the stomata. These experiments are conducted by immersing leaves in solutions of
different chemicals under specified conditions.
Q. 1.2. (0.5 point) The best choice for such an experiment would be:
a. a mesophyte
b. a hydrophyte
c. a xerophyte
d. a halophyte
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 1.2. in the Answer Sheet.
a.
b.
c.
d.
K and 0.1 mM Ca
++
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 1.3. in the Answer Sheet.
a.
b.
c.
d.
Experiment
In order to study the effect of various factors on stomata, leaves of a plant were
treated in eight different ways. The imprints obtained after each of these treatments
(1 to 8 given below) are provided in red-capped vials labeled 1 to 8, respectively.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Table 1.4.
Treatment
Total
Number of
Number of
number of
open stomata
closed
stomata
stomata
counted
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Interpretations
Q. 1.5. (10 points)
Based on the results obtained from the given set of experiments, answer the
questions Q. 1.5.A to Q. 1.5.C in the Answer Sheet. Fill in the blanks with the
appropriate serial numbers from the options given below.
A. The factor/s that clearly lead to stomatal closure is/are: ______________
B. The factor/s that clearly lead to stomatal opening is/are: ______________
C. The factor/s that clearly have no effect on stomatal opening/closing is/are:
______________
Options:
1. Light alone
2. Darkness alone
3. Acidic pH
4. Mannitol
5. Unknown Chemical
6. 10mM KCl alone
7. 100mM KCl alone
8. CaCl2
9. Abscisic acid alone
10. Abscisic acid and acidic pH
10
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q. 1.6. (2.5 points) The correct explanation for the observations in Treatments 7 and
8 is:
+
membrane. This results in entry of K and water molecules to the guard cells.
b. As the pKa of abscisic acid is close to 5.0, most of the molecules remain
undissociated at pH 4.0. This hastens their entry into the guard cells.
c. No effect was observed in either treatment because there was no water stress.
d. Abscisic acid is a strong acid and works best at highly acidic pH.
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 1.6. in the Answer Sheet
a.
b.
c.
d.
Q. 1.7. (2.5 points) Which of the following correctly explains the effect of mannitol on
the stomatal aperture?
a. Mannitol is a highly hydrophilic substance and restricts the entry of water
molecules into the guard cells.
b. High concentration of mannitol in the extracellular fluid forces K +, Cl- and Ca++ to
enter the guard cells. This leads to entry of water molecules into the cells as well.
11
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
c. Entry of mannitol into guard cells increases their solute potential leading to
uptake of water.
d. High solute concentration of mannitol results in withdrawal of water from guard
cells.
e. Entry of mannitol in the guard cells is counter-balanced by the efflux of K+ and
Ca++ leading to the withdrawal of water from the guard cells.
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 1.7. in the Answer Sheet
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Q. 1.8. (2.5 points) You have already observed the effect of the Unknown Chemical
on stomata (Treatment 5). These results suggest that the chemical could be useful
for:
a. weed control by increasing the rate of respiration.
b. keeping plant cuttings fresh over long periods by preventing water loss.
c. weed control by acting as a wilting toxin.
d. increasing crop yield in arid lands by increasing rate of photosynthesis.
e. increasing plant growth by reducing photorespiration.
12
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 1.8 in the Answer Sheet.
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Q. 1.9. (2 points) In this task, you studied the effect of various factors on the
opening and closing of the stomatal aperture. Similar experiments were performed
by scientists and they discovered that light activates zeaxanthin molecules, present
in the guard cells, which in turn, activate an ATP-powered proton pump of the guard
cell membrane. With this background information and the observations made by you
in this task, you have to arrange the sequence of events involved in the response of
stomata to light. Fill in the correct options against each step in Q. 1.9. in the Answer
Sheet.
Mechanism:
Step I: _____ 1_______
Step II: _____2_______
Step III: _____________
Step IV: ____6________
Step V: _____________
Step VI: _____________
Step VII: _____________
13
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Options:
1) Activation of zeaxanthin by light
2) Activation of ATP-powered proton pump
3) Closing of the stomata
4) Influx of K+
5) Efflux of K+
6) Change in membrane potential
7) Efflux of Ca++
8) Efflux of protons
9) Influx of water molecules
10) Efflux of water molecules
11) Opening of the stomata
14
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Quantity
3. Razor blades
4. Glass microslides
5. Box of coverslips
6. Watchglasses
8. Brush
Introduction
Plants growing in different habitats exhibit various adaptations. These adaptations
can be studied macroscopically as well as microscopically and correlated to their
habitats.
In this task, you will study the anatomy of the given specimens using the following
method.
15
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Method
1. Take thin transverse sections of the leaf specimen X.
2. Stain with Safranin staining solution for 45 seconds.
3. Wash the section with distilled water and mount on a clean glass microslide in a
drop of water.
4. Place a coverslip and observe under 10X objective of the microscope.
5. Repeat Steps 1- 4 for the stem specimen Y.
Q. 2.1. (4 points) Choose the appropriate letters from the Dichotomous Keys 1 and
2 given in Annexure 2.1. and fill in Q. 2.1.I. and Q. 2.1.II. in the Answer Sheet.
I. Trichomes
II. Stomata
16
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Q. 2.2. (4 points) Based on your observations on the leaf section, put a tick mark ( )
in the appropriate boxes in Q. 2.2. in the Answer Sheet.
Present
Absent
1. Cuticle
2. Sclerenchyma
3. Collenchyma
4. Air spaces
5. Water storage tissue
6. Glands:
a. Oil gland
b. Salt gland
c. Digestive gland
17
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
Absent
1. Cuticle
2. Sclerenchyma
3. Collenchyma
4. Air spaces
5. Water storage tissue
6. Vascular bundle:
Open
Collateral
Closed
Bicollateral
Q. 2.4. (2.5 points) Based on your observations, identify the type of plant to which
the specimens belong.
a. Mesophyte
b. Succulent xerophyte
c. Submerged hydrophyte
d. Floating hydrophyte
e. Insectivorous mesophyte
f. Parasitic mesophyte
18
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
g. Halophyte
h. Freshwater hygrophyte
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 2.4. in the Answer Sheet.
(In this question, the correct interpretation will be given points if it is
consistent with your observations.)
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
**************
19
f.
g.
h.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
ANNEXURE 2.1
Dichotomous Key 1
Present
Absent
K
Hair
On adaxial
surface
Papillae
On abaxial
surface
On adaxial
surface
I
Peltate A
Peltate E
Capitate B
Capitate
Branched C
Branched G
Simple and
uniserrate D
Simple and
uniserrate H
On abaxial
surface
J
Dichotomous Key 2
Stomata
Present
On adaxial
surface
Stomatal
crypt present
M
Stomatal
crypt absent
Absent
Q
On abaxial surface
Stomatal
crypt present
O
N
20
Stomatal
crypt absent
P
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 1
PLANT ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
_______________________________________________________________________
ANNEXURE 2.2.
Epidermal cells
Papilla
Sub-stomatal
Chamber
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Country: ________________
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
Total Points: 66
Duration: 60 minutes
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
In this test, you have been given the following two tasks:
Task 1: Study of animal skeletal systems (54 points)
Task 2: Semi-quantitative estimation of nitrogenous waste products
(12 points)
You have to write down your results and answers in the ANSWER
SHEET. Answers written in the Question Paper will not be
evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and
equipment listed for each task. In case any of these items is missing,
please raise the yellow card.
At the end of the test, put the Answer Sheet and Question Paper in the
envelope. The supervisor will collect this envelope.
Good Luck!!
Country: ________________________
Country Code: ____________________
First Name: _______________________
Middle Name: _____________________
Family Name: _____________________
Student Code: ____________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Quantity
3. Magnifying hand-lens
Introduction
The skeletal system provides physical support and a scaffold for the body and
defines its architecture in animals. The three types of skeletal systems include
an external (exoskeleton), internal (endoskeleton) and a fluid-based
(hydrostatic skeleton) system.
In this task, you will observe and compare the internal skeletal systems of
three present-day vertebrates. The models of the skeletal parts provided to
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
you include the skull, the vertebral column and the limb bones. At the end of
the task, you will match these parts to form the complete skeletal system of
each of the three vertebrates.
Part A: Comparative study of skulls
(i) Types of skull:
The skull of vertebrates is a bony structure that serves as the general
framework for the head. Structurally, the skull comprises four regions frontal,
parietal, occipital and temporal (Figure 1). There are various openings in
different regions of the skull, including the nostrils, eye sockets and the
temporal openings. The placement of the eyes with respect to each other
determines the field of vision of the animal.
Figure 1
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
(A) Anapsid skull: Anapsids get their name from the fact that they have no
additional openings in their skulls apart from their eye sockets and nostrils.
The temporal region is covered completely by bone. This type of skull is
characteristic of fishes, amphibians, and early reptiles (Figure 2).
Eye Socket
Nostril
Figure 2
(B) Synapsid skull: It has a single pair of temporal openings. It was found in
mammalian ancestors and represented an early divergence from the
anapsids. The skull of present day mammals represents a modified synapsid
pattern (Figure 3).
Eye Socket
Nostril
Temporal
Opening
Figure 3
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Nostril
Temporal
openings
Figure 4
(D) Euryapsid skull: It has a single pair of temporal openings. The euryapsid
skull seems to be derived from diapsid ancestors by loss of the lower temporal
openings. Two groups of Mesozoic marine reptiles (plesiosaurs and
ichthyosaurs) possessed this type of skull (Figure 5).
Eye Socket
Temporal
opening
Nostril
Figure 5
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Modern mammalian
skull
Synapsid
a.
Anapsid
Diapsid
Euryapsid
Synapsid
b.
Anapsid
Diapsid
c.
Synapsid
Anapsid
Diapsid
Euryapsid
Early reptilian and
modern avian skull
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
d.
Synapsid
Anapsid
Early reptilian and
modern avian skull
Diapsid
Euryapsid
a.
b.
c.
d.
Q. 1.A.2. (6 points) Observe the Specimens 1, 2 and 3 for the type of skull
and the respective photographs 1A, 2A, and 3A for their dentition. Put tick
marks () in the appropriate boxes in Table 1.A.2. in the Answer Sheet.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Table 1.A.2.
Character
Type of skull
Anapsid
Diapsid
Synapsid
Euryapsid
Type of dentition
Homodont
Heterodont
Q. 1.A.3. (6 points) Observe the specimens for position of orbit (the eye
sockets), and for types of teeth. Fill in the Table 1.A.3. in the Answer Sheet
by putting tick marks () in the appropriate boxes.
Table 1.A.3.
Features
Vision
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Sacral vertebrae
Caudal vertebrae
Figure 6
10
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
In higher animals, the thoracic vertebrae are important because they articulate
with the ventral sternum and ribs to form a rib cage.
Ribs also provide sites for secure muscle attachment, help suspend the body,
form a protective case around the viscera and sometimes serve as accessory
breathing devices (Figure 7).
True rib
False rib
Floating rib
Figure 7
The sternum is a mid-ventral skeletal structure that offers a site of origin for
chest muscles and secures the ventral tips of true ribs to complete the
protective rib cage. A well-developed rib cage is characteristic of mammals.
11
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Table 1.B.1.
Characters
Ribs
Present
Absent
True
False
Floating
Tail
Present
Reduced /Absent
12
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Table 1.B.2.
Feature
Neck movement
Restricted
Free
girdle
Body
Body
Limb bone
13
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Q. 1.C.1. (12 points) Carefully study the Specimens 7, 8 and 9, and fill in
Table 1.C.1. in the Answer Sheet by putting tick marks () in the appropriate
boxes.
Characters
Position of
Sprawled
limb with
respect to
Underneath
body
Length of
Similar
fore- and
hindlimbs
Claws
14
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Table 1.C.2.
Features
Swinging (rotational
locomotion
movement)
Pendulum-like
Habit of the animal
Saltatorial (jumping)
Cursorial (walking)
Fossorial (digging)
Q. 1.D.1 (6 points) The nine specimens (three skulls, three vertebral columns
and three sets of limb bones) belong to three different animals (I, II, and III). In
the schemes given below, write the respective specimen numbers (4 to 9) in
the appropriate boxes to construct the three animals in Q. 1.D.1. in the
Answer Sheet.
Skull
Vertebral
column
Pair of limbs
15
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Animal I
Animal II
Animal III
Q. 1.D.2 (3 points): Assign each of the three animals to the most probable
class. Choose from the options given below and write appropriate letter in Q.
1.D.2. in the Answer Sheet.
Animal I:
Class: ____________
Animal II:
Class: ____________
Animal III:
Class: ____________
Options:
A. Mammalia
B. Reptilia
C. Aves
D. Amphibia
E. Pisces
16
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Quantity
1.
2.
Toothpicks
20
3.
4.
5.
6.
Reagent
Phosphotungstic acid
Ehrlichs reagent
Sodium nitroprusside
Oxidizing solution
Phenol solution
S1
Simulated Sample 1
S2
Simulated Sample 2
S3
Simulated Sample 3
H2O
Distilled water
17
1 bottle each
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Introduction
Vertebrates have acquired different modes of excretion of nitrogenous wastes,
which are mostly derived from degradation of proteins and nucleic acids. They
have adopted different strategies of excretion of these wastes during their
transition from an aquatic to terrestrial mode of life. The three major forms of
these wastes are ammonia, urea and uric acid. While ammonia is highly
soluble in water, uric acid is the least soluble. Ammonia, being most toxic,
needs to be excreted in a highly diluted form. Uric acid is mostly excreted as
semisolid crystals.
General Instructions
1. For each test, run a positive control and a negative control using
the standard solutions and distilled water, respectively.
3. Please note that the recording of the results for the positive and
negative controls carries NO marks.
18
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
(ii)
(iii)
Grade the colour of the positive control as +++ and that of the
negative control as .
Q. 2.1.1. (3 points) Record the results in Table 2.1. in the Answer Sheet by
putting +++, ++ or + for positive results depending on the intensity of the
colour developed and for negative results.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
(ii)
Method
(i)
(ii)
20
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Q. 2.1.3. (3 points) Record your results after two minutes in Table 2.1. in
the Answer Sheet by putting +++, ++ or + for positive results depending
on the intensity of colour developed and - for negative results. For
comparison, grade the colour of positive control as +++ and that of negative
control as .
Table 2.1.
Samples
S1
S2
S3
Positive control
Negative control
Answer: ________
21
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 2
ANIMAL ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
a. S1: Pisces
S2: Mammalia
S3: Aves
b. S1: Mammalia
S2: Aves
S3: Pisces
c. S1: Mammalia
S2: Reptilia
S3: Aves
d. S1: Mammalia
S2: Pisces
S3: Aves
e. S1: Aves
S2: Pisces
S3: Mammalia
f. S1:Reptilia
S2: Amphibia
S3: Mammalia
g. S1: Mammalia
S2: Reptilia
S3: Amphibia
22
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Country: ________________
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
Total Points: 43
Duration: 60 minutes
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
You have to write down your results and answers in the ANSWER SHEET.
Answers written in the Question Paper will not be evaluated.
Please make sure that you have received all the materials and equipment listed
for the task. In case any of these items is missing, please raise the yellow card.
At the end of the test, put the Answer Sheet and Question Paper in the envelope.
The supervisor will collect this envelope.
Good Luck!!
Country: _________________________
Country Code: ____________________
First Name: _______________________
Middle Name: _____________________
Family Name: _____________________
Student Code: ____________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Task 1
PART A (35 points)
Study of -lactamase activity and its inhibition
Quantity
2. Test tubes
20
20
9. Permanent marker
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Label
Reagent
Container
Vial
Vial
Blue-stoppered tube
Blue-stoppered tube
CuSO4-Neocuproine reagent
Blue-stoppered tube
HCl (2 M)
White-stoppered tube
Handling of micropipette:
Plunger
Tip-ejector
Display
Tip-holder
Figure 1
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Adjustment method
Turn the plunger (Figure 1) to set the value to the desired volume, which can be
seen in the display.
Usage method
Secure the pipette tip to the tip holder (Figure 1). Gently push down the plunger to
the first stop, hold, and dip the tip into the solution vertically to a depth of 2 - 4 mm.
Release the plunger slowly and make it return to the original position. Remove the
pipette from the liquid and transfer the contents to the desired tube. Make sure that
the tip is close to the inner wall of the tube. Push the plunger to the first stop and
then push further to discharge the solution completely from the tip. Remove the
pipette from the tube. Eject the used tip into the discard container by pressing the tipejector.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Wavelength selector
Cuvette holder
Mode selector
Power Switch
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Introduction
Penicillins are antibiotics with a characteristic -lactam ring in their structure. This
antibiotic kills bacteria by inhibiting the cell wall synthesis. However, these molecules
are rendered inactive by some bacteria, which synthesize an enzyme called lactamase. These bacteria, which produce -lactamases, are resistant to penicillins.
Due to this, penicillin treatment is ineffective in patients infected with such resistant
bacteria. One approach to overcome this problem is to develop effective -lactamase
inhibitors.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
H
N
Lactamase
+ H2O
Penicillin G
H
N
O
O
S
N
H
Penicilloic acid
O
O
A dose-response curve for the inhibitor is generated by measuring the activity of lactamase in the presence of varying concentrations of the inhibitor at a fixed
concentration of the substrate.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Q. 1.A.1. (18 points) Follow the protocol given below and enter the absorbance
values in Table 1.A.1. in the Answer Sheet.
Test tube
Sodium
Inhibitor
-lactamase
Distilled
phosphate
(100 mM)
enzyme
water
buffer, pH 7.0
1
1.48 ml
20 l
1.46 ml
20 l
20 l
1.44 ml
40 l
20 l
1.42 ml
60 l
20 l
1.40 ml
80 l
20 l
1.38 ml
100 l
20 l
Blank
1.43 ml
50 l
20 l
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
Table 1.A.1.
Test tube
Absorbance
1
2
3
4
5
6
10
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
II. Consider the absorbance values to be the rates of hydrolysis of penicillin G. Now
calculate vi/v0, where:
v0 is the rate of hydrolysis of penicillin G by -lactamase in the absence of the
inhibitor, and vi is the rate of penicillin G hydrolysis in the presence of the inhibitor.
Note that for Test tube 1, vi = v0.
Enter these values (up to two decimals) in Table 1.A.2. in the Answer Sheet.
Table 1.A.2.
Test tube
[I] (mM)
vi/v0
1
2
3
4
5
6
Q. 1.A.3. (5 points) Plot a graph of vi/v0 versus [I] in the Graph Paper attached to
the Answer Sheet.
11
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
IC50 = _________mM
Q. 1.A.5. (3 points) Calculate the dissociation constant Ki of the inhibitor using the
equation:
S
IC50 K i 1
Km
where Km is the Michaelis-Menten constant of -lactamase for penicillin G and [S] is
the initial concentration of substrate (penicillin G) present in the enzyme reaction
mixture.
Assume the Km of -lactamase for penicillin G to be 0.05 mM. Write down your
answer (up to two decimals) in the box in the Answer Sheet.
Ki = _________mM
12
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
PART B (4 points)
Correlating -lactamase expression to resistance
When penicillin-resistant bacteria are grown in liquid culture media, -lactamase is
secreted into the medium. The supernatant of such a medium can be assayed for lactamase activity. Culture supernatants from four different organisms (P, Q, R and
S), which are suspected to be penicillin-resistant, were obtained and 20 l of each
was assayed for -lactamase activity. The corresponding absorbance values were
measured at 465 nm and are given in the table below.
Organism
Absorbance
0.090
0.450
0.075
0.220
These four organisms were tested for their resistance to penicillin G by the disc
diffusion plate assay as follows:
1. Each organism was separately inoculated into warm growth medium and
poured into a sterile Petri plate. On cooling, the medium solidified.
2. Filter paper discs impregnated with varying concentrations of penicillin G were
then placed on the surface of the medium.
3. The plates were incubated allowing penicillin to diffuse and organisms to
grow.
13
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
4. Organisms sensitive to penicillin will not be able to grow in the vicinity of the
antibiotic disc and hence, a clear zone will be obtained around the disc.
Q. 1.B.1. (4 points) Observe these plates and infer which organism is growing in
each plate. Write your answers in Table 1.B.1. in the Answer Sheet.
Table 1.B.1.
Plate
Organism
III
IV
V
VI
14
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 3
BIOCHEMISTRY AND CELL BIOLOGY
__________________________________________________________________________
PART C (4 points)
Correlating Ki values of pesticides to bacterial growth
Four pesticides P1 to P4 are reversible inhibitors of an enzyme E that is essential for
the growth of a bacterium B. Their Ki values are given in the table below. Each of
these four pesticides is used in four geographically different
regions R1 to R4. The residual concentrations of these four pesticides in the
respective regions are also shown in the table below:
Region
R1
R2
R3
R4
Pesticide
P1
P2
P3
P4
1 nM
5 nM
0.45 M 0.55 M
5.5 M
Q. 1.C.1. ( 4 points) Indicate whether the bacterium B would grow or not in each of
the four regions by putting tick marks ( ) in the appropriate boxes in the Table
1.C.1. in the Answer Sheet.
Table 1.C.1.
Region
R1 R2 R3 R4
Bacterium B grows
Bacterium B does not grow
15
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Country: ________________
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
Total Points: 48
Duration: 60 minutes
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants,
In this test, you have been given the following two tasks:
Task 1: Part A: Study of the olfactory response of Drosophila melanogaster
larvae: Experimental design (6 points)
Part B: Study of the olfactory response of Drosophila melanogaster
larvae: Larval plate test (18 points)
Part C: Study of olfactory adaptation in Drosophila larvae (11 points)
Task 2: Study of fish behavior (13 points)
The duration of the test is 10 minutes for Part A of Task 1 and 50 minutes for
the remaining paper.
You have to answer Part A in 10 minutes after which the buzzer will ring
and the Answer Sheet for Part A will be collected from you. Only then will
the Question Paper and Answer Sheet for Task I Parts B and C, and Task
2 be given to you.
Please do not switch on your computer before your Answer Sheet for Part
A is collected.
You have to write down your results and answers in the ANSWER SHEET.
Answers written in the Question Paper will not be evaluated.
At the end of the test, put both the Question Papers as well as the Answer Sheet
for Task 1 Parts B and C, and Task 2 in the envelope. The supervisor will
collect this envelope.
Good Luck!!
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Country: ________________________
Country Code: ____________________
First Name: _______________________
Middle Name: _____________________
Family Name: _____________________
Student Code: ____________________
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Practical Test 4
Animal Behavior
Task 1 Part A (6 points)
Study of the olfactory response of Drosophila melanogaster larvae
Experimental design
You have been given Part A of this task. You have to answer this part in
10 minutes after which the buzzer will ring and the Answer Sheet for this
part will be collected from you. Only then will the rest of the paper be
given to you.
Introduction
Insects have a strong sense of smell. Adult moths, for example, can find their mates
by smelling pheromone molecules at very low concentrations. The sense of smell is
associated with a discriminatory behavior as well. This is evident from the fact that
insects are able to choose their food by odor. The nature of an odor stimulus can be
categorized into three types: (1) attractive, (2) repulsive, and (3) neutral.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
T1
Larvae
T3
Design II: One of the chemicals and the larvae are placed together at the centre of a
plate. Three such plates are set up for the three chemicals.
T1 and Larvae
T2 and Larvae
T3 and Larvae
Design III: One of the chemicals and an odor-free (neutral) chemical are placed at
two ends of a plate. Larvae are introduced in the centre. The test is repeated for the
remaining chemicals.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
T1
Neutral T2
Neutral T3
Larvae
Larvae
Neutral
Larvae
Design IV: The three test chemicals and a neutral chemical are placed at equidistant
positions on the periphery of a plate and the larvae are introduced at the centre.
T2
Neutral
T1
Larvae
T3
Design V: The three test chemicals and the larvae are placed at equidistant
positions on the periphery of a plate.
T2
Larvae
T1
T3
Choose the most appropriate experimental design and put a tick mark () against it
in Q. 1.A.1. in the Answer Sheet.
Design I
6
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Design II
Design III
Design IV
Design V
Please note that the next question (Q. 1.A.2.) will be evaluated only if your
answer to this question (Q. 1.A.1.) is correct.
Q. 1.A.2. (3 points) Choose the most appropriate statement/s from the following
options to support your choice of design.
I.
II.
III.
The entire experiment (i.e., testing all the chemicals) can be completed
using a single test and thus inter-experimental variation can be avoided.
IV.
It can clearly distinguish the repulsive and attractive nature of the stimuli
as each can enhance the response of the larvae to the other(s).
V.
There will not be any mixing of the odors and hence more reliable results
will be obtained.
VI.
All the chemicals can be tested against the same control in a single plate.
VII.
VIII.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
a.
I, III, IV
b.
V, VII, VIII
c.
d.
e.
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 1.A.2. in the Answer Sheet.
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Practical Test 4
Animal Behavior
Task 1 Parts B and C
Study of the olfactory response of Drosophila melanogaster larvae
You should try and complete Parts B and C of this task in 35 minutes.
Design
Five experiments were conducted to test the response of Drosophila melanogaster
larvae to chemical and light stimuli. Four chemical odorants, A, B, C, and D were
used in the tests. Of these, D was known to be a neutral chemical while A, B, and C
could be an attractant, repellent or a neutral chemical. The design for the experiment
is as shown in the figure:
Filter paper
disc with
chemical
Filter paper
disc with
chemical
Larvae
Zone II
Zone I
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Method
Third instar larvae were used in these experiments. These larvae were obtained by
washing the 6-day-old Drosophila culture with 15% sucrose solution. The larvae that
float in this solution were washed free of sucrose and immediately used in the tests.
The tests were performed in Petri plates containing a layer of 1% agarose.
In each experiment, two chemicals were spotted on separate filter paper discs that
were placed in two Zones, Z I and Z II (marked as semicircular areas) at two
diametrically opposite ends of a Petri plate. Approximately 30-40 larvae were placed
at the centre of each plate and their movement over the next five minutes was
recorded. Five such experiments were conducted. The recordings of these
experiments have been provided to you as video films. Experiments No. 1, 2, and 4
were conducted under uniform light conditions. In Experiments No. 3 and 5, half the
plate was covered with black paper and the remaining half was left exposed to light.
10
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Table 1.B.1.
Experiment
Chemical
Number of
Chemical Number of
in ZI
larvae in ZI
in ZII
(NZI)
larvae in ZII
N ZI
N ZI N ZII
N ZII
N ZI N ZII
(NZII)
A (in dark)
B (in dark)
Q. 1.B.2. (3 points) What is the likely nature of the three chemicals A, B and C? Put
a tick mark () in the appropriate box in the Answer Sheet.
Chemical Attractant Repellant Neutral
chemical
Nature cannot be
determined
A
B
C
11
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
12
False
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Continuous stimulation of the olfactory system with a given odor tends to result in
adaptation, also known as desensitization. As a result, the larvae fail to respond to
the odor to which they have been adapted. A researcher working on olfaction in
Drosophila melanogaster larvae wanted to study adaptation in these larvae. She
selected the following odorants for her study:
1.
Ethyl acetate
2.
Pentyl acetate
3.
Hexyl acetate
4.
Heptyl acetate
13
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Prestimulation
Test odorant
Experiment
Experiment
Experiment
Ethyl
acetate
Pentyl
acetate
Hexyl
acetate
Experiment
D
Heptyl
acetate
NZ I
NZ II NZ I
NZ II
NZ I
NZ II
NZ I
NZ II
None
21
18
14
12
13
Ethyl
14
11
15
11
13
10
15
16
15
12
11
19
14
17
17
14
16
13
13
15
10
13
13
10
13
acetate
3
Pentyl
acetate
Hexyl
acetate
Heptyl
acetate
NZI and NZII are the number of larvae in Zone I and Zone II, respectively.
14
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Q. 1.C.1. ( 5 points) Calculate the Response Index (RI) for each experiment
according to the formula:
RI
N ZI N ZII
100
N ZI N ZII
Table 1.C.1.
Experiment Prestimulation
None
Ethyl acetate
Pentyl acetate
Hexyl acetate
Heptyl acetate
Test odorant
Experiment
Experiment
Experiment
Experiment
Ethyl
Pentyl
Hexyl
Heptyl
acetate
acetate
acetate
acetate
RI
RI
RI
RI
15
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Q. 1.C.2. (2 points) To which odorant have the larvae adapted the most?
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in the Answer Sheet.
Ethyl acetate
Pentyl acetate
Hexyl acetate
Heptyl acetate
Q. 1.C.3. ( 2 points) To which odorant have the larvae adapted the least?
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in the Answer Sheet.
Ethyl acetate
Pentyl acetate
Hexyl acetate
Heptyl acetate
16
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Q.1.C.4. (2 points) In which one of the experiments do you find that larval sensitivity
to the odorant has been reversed?
Put a tick mark () the appropriate box in the Answer Sheet.
Experiment
Experiment
A
1
2
3
4
5
17
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Introduction
The Siamese fighting fish, Betta splendens, is one of the most popular species of
freshwater aquarium fish. This fish shows varied responses when exposed to
different stimuli.
Operculum
You have been provided with a video recording of an experiment using a male
Siamese fighting fish.
Q. 2.1. (11 points) Double click on the video file 6 on the computer monitor and
observe the behavior of the fish before and after introduction of a mirror.
18
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
After observing the film, write a + for the particular behaviors that were displayed by
the fish and for those that were not displayed. Record your observations in Table
2.1. in the Answer Sheet.
Table 2.1.
Number Behavior
1.
2.
Before the
After the
introduction of
introduction of
the mirror
the mirror
tail fin
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
Lateral display
*The lateral display is a behavior where the fish exhibits the lateral surface of its
body, expands its dorsal and caudal fins and vibrates/quivers its body.
19
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
Q. 2.2. (1 point) The differences in behavior of the fish that you observed before and
after the mirror was introduced into the aquarium could be due to:
a. an apparent increase in the size of the territory that the fish now has to defend.
b. an urge to display courtship behavior towards a conspecific individual that the fish
now perceives in its territory.
c. an urge to establish dominance over a conspecific individual that the fish now
perceives in its territory.
d. a startle response displayed by the fish when confronted with a mirror.
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 2.2. in the Answer Sheet.
a.
b.
c.
d.
Q. 2.3. (1 point) Different behaviors in animals have certain benefits and costs
associated with them. For example, prolonged extension of the gill cover or
operculum display may indicate its physical strength but may also severely limit the
ability of the fish to ventilate its gills. In the light of your observation, what could be
the rationale for the experimental fish displaying or not displaying this particular
behavior?
20
IBO 2008
INDIA
PRACTICAL TEST 4
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR
__________________________________________________________________________
a. Fish always prefer to maintain regular opercular movement without any display,
independent of the presence or absence of another conspecific individual, to
maintain the oxygen supply for the body at its optimum.
b. Fish will exhibit the operculum display advertising its ability to tolerate oxygen
stress in presence of another conspecific individual to establish its dominance.
c. Operculum display, being an energetically costly behavior, is usually not
exhibited by a fish under most circumstances. Males of this species, however,
may display this behavior in the presence of a conspecific female because the
potential reproductive success that it will acquire will more than compensate for
the energetic cost of the display.
d. Operculum display is likely to be determined only by abiotic environmental factors
such as level of dissolved oxygen in the water. Thus, fish in sufficiently aerated
water will always show this response so as to declare its territory and maintain its
dominance.
Put a tick mark () in the appropriate box in Q. 2.3. in the Answer Sheet.
a.
b.
c.
d.
21
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Nov. 2007
PRACTICAL EXAMINATION 1
ANIMAL ANATOMY, SYSTEMATICS AND ECOLOGY
26 marks
10 marks
27 marks
TOTAL MARKS = 63
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Before starting the exam, the invigilator will show you a red card and a green
card to test for red-green color blindness. If you are unable to see the difference
between the two cards, raise your hand, and you will be provided with
assistance immediately.
It is recommended that you allocate your time according to the mark value of each
task and question.
All answers for Tasks B and C must be recorded in the answer booklet
provided.
Ensure that your 4-digit student code number is written on ALL pages of
your answer booklet.
Use the pencil provided to fill in the appropriate circle for each question in
the answer booklet.
Fill out each of the two specimen cards with your student number and name and set aside. You
will sign these cards upon completion of your dissections.
2.
Put on your gloves and remove the wet paper towel that is covering the specimen.
Throughout the dissection, use the water bottle to regularly wet your specimen and any
parts removed. This will ensure that the parts do not dry out.
3.
Note the differences in the external features of each worm, namely the increased number of
sensory structures and the presence of multifunctional appendages on annelid 1.
4.
From the mid portion of the body of annelid 1, detach an entire parapodium. Parapodia
function as limbs and gills for the worm. Details of the parapodia allow zoologists to
distinguish between different species of this annelid. Each parapodium consists of a ventral
division called the neuropodium and a bilobed dorsal division called the notopodium. Each
notopodium is supported by a chitinous and stiff rod called an aciculum. A dorsal and a
ventral cirrus project
from the notopodium and the neuropodium, respectively. Setae extend beyond the parapodia.
5.
Use the pins provided to pin the detached parapodium in one corner of the annelid 1
dissecting
pan. Ensure that it is pinned on wet paper towel. Pin as follows:
! red-orange pin for the neuropodium
(2 marks)
6.
Stretch out each worm in its dissecting pan, dorsal side up. Place one steel pin through the 1
segment of the body and one pin through the last segment of the body to secure it in place.
7.
Cut open the body wall of annelid 1 from the anterior tip down the body 3-5 cm. Separate
the body wall from the internal structures and pin the body wall to the dissecting tray by using
the steel pins.
8.
Cut open the body wall of annelid 2 from the anterior tip, and continue the cut posteriorly
approximately 5 cm. Separate the body wall from the internal structures. To open up the
worm, pin the body wall to the dissecting tray by using the steel pins.
9.
Starting at the anterior end of each worm, locate the muscular pharynx. In annelid 1 the
pharynx also contains jaws that are useful in its predatory lifestyle. In both specimens, pin
the following structure:
10.
11.
(2 marks)
(2 marks)
Moving posteriorly in both specimens, locate the long and tubular intestine used in
digestion. In both specimens, pin the following:
! black pin for the intestine on annelid 1
(2 marks)
(2 marks)
Other major features of the annelid digestive system can be seen in annelid 2. Immediately
posterior to the reproductive organs in annelid 2 lie the soft crop and the tougher-walled
gizzard. In annelid 2, pin the following:
! pink pin for the crop on annelid 2
(2 marks)
(2 marks)
12.
13.
Both annelids possess a closed circulatory system with tubular hearts and a dorsal and ventral
blood vessel. In both specimens, pin the following:
! white pin for the dorsal blood vessel on annelid 1
(2 marks)
(2 marks)
Although both specimens are annelids, annelid 1 is sexually dioecious, whereas annelid 2 is
hermaphroditic. Hermaphroditism is an advantage for this slow-moving organism. Examine
the anterior internal structures in annelid 2, and any external features found on the body wall.
In annelid 2 only, pin the following:
! plain steel pin for clitellum
(2 marks)
(2 marks)
(2 marks)
14. After finishing the task, place a wet paper towel over the dissected specimens. Raise your
hand. A lab assistant will take a photo of your dissection. Both the lab assistant and
yourself will sign your dissection pan labels and record the time. Your dissection will then
be taken in and graded as you move onto the next section of the practicum.
Dichotomous Key
1a. Has a prominent posterior sucker ......
1b. Lacks a posterior sucker ........
go to 2
go to 3
2a. Posterior half of body much wider than the anterior end ..
2b. Body more ribbon like, anterior part tapered ....
Glossiphonia
Eropobdella
Lumbricus
go to 4
go to 5
go to 8
Lepidontus
to 6
go to 7
Nerillidopsis
Tomopteris
Nereis
Neoamphitrite
go to 9
Arenicola
Chaetopterus
Objective: Using the pictures provided, determine which adaptations (form) these animals have
that helps them in their environment and life styles (function)
Materials:
! laminated, colour photographs of 10 animals (labeled A to J). Note: there are two
photographs of each animal.
Procedure:
There are two parts to this task. Fill in the tables in your answer booklet.
1.
In Part I, select the best response for each of 6 characteristics (body shape; structures used in
locomotion or for attachment to a host; structures used in feeding; type of digestive tract; body
segmentation; type of sensory structures) from the choices provided.
2.
In Part 2, use your observations from Part 1 to select the best response from the choices
provided for the life style of each animal, the phylum to which it belongs and its body plan.
For each part, indicate your choices by filling in the circles in the appropriate section of the
answer booklet.
- THE END
1
2
3
4
10
Marks
Specimen number:
1
10
Glossiphonia
Eropobdella
Lumbricus
Lepidontus
Nerillidopsis
Tomopteris
Nereis
Neoamphitrite
Arenicola
Chaetopterus
characteristic 1
Body Shape:
Specimen
flattened
not flattened
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
Specimen
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
characteristic 2
Structures used in locomotion or for attachment to a host:
muscular
jointed
sucker, scolex
none of the
foot
appendages
and/or teeth other choices
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
characteristic 3
Structures used in feeding:
mandibles
sucker
radula none of the
or teeth
other choices
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
none
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
characteristic 4
Digestive tract:
incomplete
complete
(single opening for (separate openings
mouth and anus)
for mouth and anus)
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
/12
Specimen
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
characteristic 8
Lifestyle:
Specimen belongs to the phylum
parasitic non-parasitic
free-living Arthropoda Nematoda Mollusca Annelida Platyhelminthes Other
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
characteristic 9
Body plan:
acoelomate pseudocoelomate coelomate
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
No. correct
7
8
9
Total
X 0.5 =
/15
5
PRACTICAL EXAMINATION 2
PLANT ANATOMY, MORPHOLOGY AND PHYSIOLOGY
EXAM BOOKLET 1
TASK A.
16 marks
STUDENT CODE
PLANT MORPHOLOGY
TASK A.
In this task, you are required to answer the following questions, each of which relates to a slide that
you will be shown. Each slide will be shown twice.
In the first showing, each slide will be displayed for 45 seconds, then the second slide will be
shown for 45 seconds and so on until all 16 slides have been once. The second showing is to give
you the opportunity to review your answers. In this showing, each slide will be displayed for 15
seconds.
1. What mutualistic relationship between roots of land plants and specific soil fungi is displayed in
this slide?
a. mycorrhizae
b. mycelium
c. lichens
ANSWER: ___a____
d. root hairs
2. This leafs venation is commonly found in which group of plants?
a. hornworts
b. dicotyledons
c. ferns
d. monocotyledons
ANSWER: ____b___
e. gymnosperms
3. The aerenchyma stem tissue shown here is characteristic of its adaptation as a:
a) mesophyte
b) xerophyte
c) halophyte
ANSWER: ____d___
d) hydrophyte
5.
In this picture of a fern sorus, what is the ploidy level of the structure indicated by the arrow?
a) triploid
b) diploid
ANSWER: ____c____
c) haploid
6. In this longitudinal section of a dicot angiosperm stem, name the structure indicated by X.
a) shoot apical meristem
b) axillary bud
c) lateral inflorescence
d) lateral root
ANSWER: _____b____
e) leaf primordium
ANSWER: _____c_____
9. The name of the meristem responsible for generating the tissues labelled X is:
a) vascular cambium
b) shoot apical meristem
c) root apical meristem
d) cork cambium
ANSWER: ____d_____
e) lenticel
10. The presence of the following illustrated cells gives Pyrus communis L. (pears) their gritty
texture:
a) chlorenchyma
b) guard cell
c) tracheary element
d) collenchyma
ANSWER: ____e_____
e) sclereid
ANSWER: ____a_____
12. The hormone auxin, produced at the terminal meristem, inhibits lateral shoot growth which
results in the illustrated phenomenon, known as:
a) conical shape
b) deciduousness
c) apical dominance
ANSWER: _____c____
d) axillary dominance
13. These tendrils and spines represent evolutionary adaptations of what structures?
a) leaves
b) branches
c) axillary shoots
d) adventitious roots
ANSWER: _____a_____
e) trichomes
14. Which plant cell type shown has the potential to give rise to all of the other cells in the
section?
a) parenchyma
b) companion
c) collenchyma
d) sclereid
ANSWER: _____a_____
e) tracheary element
15. In embryo development, the structure indicated by the arrow is known as the:
a) filament
b) endosperm
c) heart-shaped embryo
d) suspensor
ANSWER: _____d____
e) basal cell
ANSWER: _____b_____
- THE END
#1
#2
#2
#3
#4
#5
#5
#6
#6
#7
#7
#8
#8
#9
#9
#10
# 10
#11
# 11
#12
# 12
##13
13
# 14
#14
#15
# 15
#17
# 16
PRACTICAL EXAMINATION 2
PLANT ANATOMY, MORPHOLOLOGY AND PHYSIOLOGY
EXAM BOOKLET 2
Task B. Identification of flowering plants
23 marks
25 marks
5 points
8 marks
Time allowed:
70 minutes
STUDENT CODE
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
IMPORTANT
! Before starting the exam, the invigilator will show you a red card and a green card
to test for red-green color blindness. If you are unable to see the difference
between the two cards, raise your hand, and you will be provided with assistance
immediately.
! Read the exam paper carefully before commencing the exam.
! It is recommended that you allocate your time according to the mark value of the Task.
! Write your answers in the exam booklet.
! Do not forget to hand in your graph prepared in Task E with your exam booklet.
TASK B..
Procedure:
1. Using the razor blade, cut a thin cross section of each of the samples 1 to 4.
2. Transfer each section to a microscope slide and place 1 drop of toluedine blue
staining solution and 1 drop of water on the section.
3. Put a cover slip on the section (try to avoid air bubbles when placing the cover slip) and
remove excess stain by placing the corner of a piece of tissue paper against one edge of the
cover slip.
4. Starting first with the 4X objective and then using either the 10X or the 40X objective,
examine each slide under the microscope and observe the structure of the tissue.
5. Based on your observation of each slide prepared for samples 1 to 4, identify the
tissue/organ sectioned. For each sample, enter the appropriate letter from the
column labeled KEY in the table below. (8 marks)
6.
Sample
1
Tissue/Organ
B
B = stem
C = root
D = petiole
A = leaf
Examine the sections you prepared for Samples 1 to 4, and the plant parts of
Samples 5 to 10. Identify whether each sample is from a monocot plant or from a dicot
plant and indicate your answer by writing an X in the appropriate column of the
following table. (10 marks)
Plant Sample
Monocot
Dicot
10
7.
KEY
Once you have completed Part 6, place the slide with your best section on the
microscope, focus the microscope and place your plastic bag cover back on the
microscope indicating to the lab assistant that you are finished. A lab assistant will
examine the slide and grade your sectioning technique (5 marks).
Make sure that you have completed TASK B before starting TASK C.
Procedure
1. Write your student number on the specimen board labeled SEED DISSECTION.
2. Using Sample 5 cut the seed longitudinally with the razor blade and dissect the seed into its
component parts.
3. Use the pins provided to pin the correct seed part on the specimen board
!
4. After finishing this task, cover the board with a paper towel indicating to the lab
assistant that you are finished. The lab assistant and yourself will sign the label on the
specimen board, and the lab assistant will photograph your dissection. Your dissection will
then be removed for grading.
TASK C2.
Procedure
1. Examine the flower in Sample 6. Write an X against the correct answer for the
following questions:
(a)
_________
ii) calyx
____X_____
iii) perianth
_______
iv) hypanthium
_______
(b)
TASK C3.
____X___
ii) calyx
_______
iii) perianth
_______
iv) hypanthium
_______
IMPORTANT.
Procedure
1. Write your student number on the specimen board labeled FLOWER DISSECTION.
2. Dissect the flower (Sample 6) into its component parts.
3. Use the pins provided to pin the correct flower part on the specimen board
4.
Use an X to indicate the correct classification of the placentation within the ovule
of this flower (1 mark).
i) marginal
_______
ii) axile
___X____
iii) parietal
_______
iv) free-central
_______
5. After finishing this task, cover the board with a paper towel to indicate to the lab
assistant that you are finished. A lab assistant will photograph your dissection. Both the
lab assistant and yourself will sign the label on the board. Your dissection will then be taken
by the lab assistant for grading.
PLANT EVOLUTION
TASK D. Identification of the Time of Evolution of Higher Plants (5 marks)
Materials
! Plant samples in dishes labeled H to M.
Not all descriptions in Box A will be used and no letter should be used more than
once. The answer for Sample M is provided.
BOX A
Plant Sample Lineage Characteristics
a. This spore-bearing plant group has persisted relatively unchanged for hundreds of
millions of years. In this time period, it was likely an important dietary element of
herbivore dinosaurs.
b. The first macrofossil evidence of the evolution of grasses appears in the fossil record at
the time of the diversification of mammals.
c. In this time period, the indehiscent integumented megasporangium (ovules/seeds)
originated. It is represented in the samples by modern plants producing naked
seeds on a scale.
d. This group of spore-bearing plants included members with tree-like stature (Sample M)
and were common in coal-producing swamp floras (answers provided).
e. Coniferous seed plants, as represented by the sample, were driven to extinction by the
diversification of the superior characteristics of the angiosperms, in this time period.
f. The dichotomous branching and sporangia of this plant were characteristics of the first
terrestrial tracheophytes, which left some of the earliest land plant macrofossils at this
time in history.
g. The evolution of flowering plants, as represented by this angiosperm, first appears in the
fossil record in this time period.
BOX B
Enter the correct codes for each sample
Sample
Description
Time Period
H __
M __
10
11
PLANT PHYSIOLOGY
TASK E. Interpretation of photosynthetic data from plants grown at different light
levels (8 marks)
Materials
! 2 sheets of graph paper, each with the axes labeled differently
NOTE: Before beginning this task, be sure that you have all the materials listed above. If
you do not, notify a lab assistant immediately by raising your hand.
Introduction
Single leaves from two different plants, one grown in full sun, the other in shade, were removed
and placed in separate, clear boxes. The leaves were exposed to increasing light levels and the
rate of O2 release was measured.
The data obtained from this experiment are presented in the following table:
Light Level
(!mol photons m-2 s-1)
0
10
25
50
100
250
500
600
Rate of O2 production
(!mol O2 m-2 s-1)
Leaf A
Leaf B
-20
-2
-10
-0.5
-5
1.5
-1
3
5
6
15
10
28
12
30
11
Procedure
1. Select the sheet of graph paper that has the X-axis and the Y-axis labeled correctly for the set
of data above. (1 mark)
2. Write your name and your student number on the label on the sheet of graph paper you have
chosen.
3. Mark the scale of the units on each axis.
4. Plot the data presented in the table for each leaf to compare the photosynthetic rates (O2
production) of the leaves with respect to light. Clearly identify which line represents Leaf A
and which line represents Leaf B. (2 marks)
12
5. Examine the graphs you have drawn and determine which leaf (Leaf A or Leaf B)
demonstrates the characteristics of a shade-adapted leaf and which demonstrates the
characteristics of a sun-adapted leaf. Indicate your answer in the table below by writing an
X in the correct cell. (1 mark)
Leaf A
Leaf B
Shade-adapted
Sun-adapted
6. Use the data plots on your graph to answer the following questions:
(a)
Is the light compensation point of Leaf A higher than the light compensation
point of Leaf B? Circle the correct answer. (0.5 mark)
YES
(b)
Can the light compensation point be defined as the light level at which the
photosynthetic response reaches saturation? (0.5 mark)
YES
(c)
NO
NO
Which of the answers below most correctly identifies the light compensation
point of Leaf A? Circle the letter of that answer. (1 mark)
i)
ii)
iii)
iv)
v)
(d)
13
(e)
i)
ii)
iii)
iv)
v)
This graph gives information about the photosynthetic response to light. Can it also be
used to estimate the response of respiration rate with regards to light? Circle the
correct answer. (1 mark)
YES
NO
- THE END
FIGURE 1.
PERIOD
CODE
66
55
44
33
22
11
PRACTICAL EXAMINATION 3
Cell Biology/Biochemistry
TASK A.
27 marks
TASK B.
5 marks
18 marks
TASK C.
STUDENT CODE
Introduction
The cabbage family contains a class of compounds known as glucosinolates. Some glucosinolates such
as glucoraphanin have desired medicinal properties helping to prevent cancers while others such as
glucosinalbin have toxic metabolites.
One of the products of the toxic glucosinolates is the thiocyanate ion (SCN-). SCN- interferes with
iodine metabolism resulting in thyroid hormone deficiency. Eating plants of the crucifer family such as
cauliflower will result in the production of a limited amount of thiocyanate ion from glucosinolates such
as glucosinalbin.
The glucosinolate glucoraphanin is metabolized to sulforaphane. Sulforaphane is an inducer of phase 2
proteins. One consequence of phase 2 protein induction is an increased ability of cells to scavenge free
radicals and other oxidants. A consequence of decreased oxidant levels is a lower probability of
activation of pathways that lead to inflammation. One such pathway is through activation of a protein
complex such as NFkappaB.
TASK A. To determine the amount of thiocyanate ion released from cauliflower using a
spectrophotometric assay. (27 marks)
OBJECTIVE:
Materials
! Eppendorf pipettor: one 20-200 microlitre capacity set to 100 microlitres.
! Eppendorf pipette tips.
! Spectrophotometer cuvettes containing 900 microlitres of ferric nitrate reagent as noted above,
this reagent is in a strong acid.
CAUTION: The ferric nitrate reagent solution you will be using is dissolved in 1.0 M nitric
acid. Wear gloves and use goggles to protect your eyes before starting the
experiment.
! Thiocyanate standards in tubes at the following concentrations: 0 micromoles/mL (this is your
blank), 0.5 micromoles/mL, 1.0 micromoles/mL, 2.0 micromoles/mL and 4.0 micromoles/mL.
! One tube of filtered cauliflower homogenate. 1.0 g of cauliflower was homogenized and the
homogenate was diluted to a total volume of 4.0 mL water. This is your unknown and you will be
required to determine how many micromoles of thiocyanate are present in one millilitre of this
homogenate.
Procedure
1. Put on the gloves and the protective glasses.
2. To each of the cuvettes containing the ferric nitrate reagent add 100 microliters of each of the
thiocyanate standards. The standards are: 0, 0.5, 1.0, 2.0 and 4.0 micromoles thiocyanate/mL. A
coloured reaction should become visible except for the 0 micromole thiocyanate standard which
serves as your blank. Be sure to label the cuvettes on the frosted surface.
3. To each of the remaining 3 cuvettes add 100 microlitres of the cauliflower homogenate.
4. Carefully carry the cuvettes to the spectrophotometer which has been set to absorb at 447 nm. Open
the lid to the light path in the spectrophotometer and insert the 0 micromole thiocyanate/mL standard
(i.e., blank) cuvette. The arrow indicates the light path. Ensure that the walls of the cuvettes
through which the light passes is transparent.
Close the lid and push the set reference button on the top right hand of the panel on the
spectrophotometer see the diagram below. Do not touch any of the other buttons!
5. Insert each of the standards and record the reading. Then insert each of the cuvettes containing the
unknown and record the spectrophotometer reading. Leave the cuvettes at the spectrophotometer
and the laboratory assistants will take care of them.
___________
___________
___________
___________
2._____
(10 marks)
(4 marks)
3._____
6. Plot, on the graph paper (page 5), the absorbance measurements for your thiocyanate
standards against the concentration (micromoles/mL) of the standards.
(6 marks)
7. Calculate the average absorbance of your cauliflower homogenate.
ANSWER:
____________________
(2 marks)
(5 marks)
_____________________
(2 marks)
TASK B. To determine the amount of cauliflower needed to be consumed for it to cause toxic
effects because of the presence of thiocyanate (5 marks)
Introduction
The LD50 is a toxicology term that describes the dose (i.e., moles of toxin/kg animal) of a compound that
will kill 50% of the animals tested. In the rat, the LD50 of sodium thiocyanate consumed is reported to
be 9 millimoles/kg. Using the data of the experiment you have just performed, calculate how much
cauliflower a rat that weighs 500 g would have to eat in a short time to reach the LD50 of thiocyanate.
Procedure
Circle the letter of the range that best fits your calculated value. Show your calculations on this page.
Continue on the back of this page if necessary.
(a)
1 g to 5 g
(b)
50 g to 250 g
(c)
500 g to 1 kg
(d)
1.5 kg to 14 kg
(e)
15 kg to 25 kg
Procedure
1. Examine the figures provided in each of the following sections.
2. Using the data presented, identify which data set is derived from animals fed a diet high in
glucoraphanin and provide the basis for your answer.
SECTION A. (5 marks)
Below is a figure that gives data on NFkappaB activation in spontaneously hypertensive stroke-prone
(SHRsp) male rats that were fed one of two diets: a control diet or an experimental diet containing
glucoraphanin. In the experimental diet, the animals consumed 10 micromoles glucoraphanin/kg body
weight.
After several months on these diets, the animals were euthanized, nuclei from the kidney cells were
isolated and prepared for SDS polyacrylamide electrophoresis. Following separation of the proteins on
the gel, the proteins were transferred to nitrocellulose membrane and probed with an antibody that
recognized the NFkappaB p65 protein.
A representative Western blot is shown below (on the left) and next to it is a graph that depicts the
quantification of blots from 5 different animals per diet group.
(1 mark)
2. Which of the following statements gives the best explanation for your answer?
Circle the letter of that statement.
(4 marks)
(a)
Less oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence less p65 in the nuclei.
(b)
Less oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence more p65 in the nuclei.
(c)
More oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence less p65 in the nuclei.
(d)
More oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence more p65 in the nuclei.
(e)
More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation and hence less p65 in the nuclei.
SECTION B.
(8 marks)
Below is a figure that gives Western blot data on a 45 kD nitrosylated protein (N-protein) in the kidneys
of two male SHRsp rats that were put on one of two different diets: a diet containing glucoraphanin and
control diets.
The top part of the figure is a representative Western blot while the bottom part of the figure is the
quantification of Western blots from 5 different animals per diet group.
Answer the following questions:
1. Which group (A or B) represents the animals fed a diet containing glucoraphanin?
ANSWER: __________________________
(1 mark)
2. Circle the letter of the statement below that best explains your answer.
(4 marks)
(a) More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation that results in more iNOS expression
and more peroxynitrous acid formation and thus more nitrosylation of proteins.
(b) More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation that results in more iNOS expression
and more peroxynitrous acid formation but less nitrosylation of proteins.
(c) More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation that results in more iNOS expression
but less peroxynitrous acid formation and thus less nitrosylation of proteins.
(d) More oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation but results in less iNOS expression and
less peroxynitrous acid formation and thus less nitrosylation of proteins.
(e) Less oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation that results in less iNOS expression and
less peroxynitrous acid formation and thus less nitrosylation of proteins.
3)
The figure above shows the amount of an additional protein, actin. Why is the level of this
protein measured?
(3 marks)
a) To quantify the expression of N-protein relative to a protein that is assumed to be equally
expressed in kidney cells independent of the treatment.
b) To show that the expression level of N-protein is independent of the effect of the treatment on
the filtration rate of the kidney.
c) To ensure that N-protein and actin are not bound to each other in the cells of rats that received
the treatment.
d) The level of a protein whose expression is assumed to be independent of the treatment is
measured to ensure that the binding of the antibody used to detect N-protein is unaffected by the
treatment.
10
SECTION C. (5 marks)
The nitric oxide radical (NO.), that is released by endothelial cells of blood vessels, diffuses to smooth
muscle cells where it causes smooth muscle cells to relax and thus decreases blood pressure. The
amount of NO. that can diffuse to the smooth muscle depends upon the overall level of superoxide
radicals. If there are excessive superoxide radicals present, then NO. reacts with superoxide forming
peroxynitrous acid.
Below is a graph depicting the systolic blood pressures of female SHRsp rats placed on one of two diets,
a control diet and a diet containing glucoraphanin. Animals were placed on these diets at the age of 5
weeks post-natal and blood pressures were monitored from 6 to 19 weeks post-natal.
(1mark)
2. Circle the letter of the statement below that best explains your answer.
(4 marks)
(a) Less oxidative stress results in lower scavenging of nitric oxide. Decreased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in more vasorelaxation and thus lower blood
pressure.
(b) Less oxidative stress results in higher scavenging of nitric oxide. Decreased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in less vasorelaxation and thus higher blood
pressure.
(c) Less oxidative stress results in lower scavenging of nitric oxide. Increased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in more vasorelaxation and thus lower blood
pressure.
(d) Less oxidative stress results in higher scavenging of nitric oxide. Increased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in less vasorelaxation and thus higher blood
pressure.
(e) Less oxidative stress results in lower scavenging of nitric oxide. Increased amount of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in more vasorelaxation and thus lower blood
pressure.
- THE END
11
PRACTICAL EXAMINATION 3
Cell Biology/Biochemistry
TASK A.
29 marks
TASK B.
5 marks
10 marks
TASK C.
STUDENT CODE
Introduction
The cabbage family contains a class of compounds known as glucosinolates. Some glucosinolates such
as glucoraphanin have desired medicinal properties helping to prevent cancers while others such as
glucosinalbin have toxic metabolites.
One of the products of the toxic glucosinolates is the thiocyanate ion (SCN-). SCN- interferes with
iodine metabolism resulting in thyroid hormone deficiency. Eating plants of the crucifer family such as
cauliflower will result in the production of a limited amount of thiocyanate ion from glucosinolates such
as glucosinalbin.
TASK A. To determine the amount of thiocyanate ion released from cauliflower using a
spectrophotometric assay. (29 marks)
OBJECTIVE:
Materials
! Eppendorf pipettor: one 20-200 microlitre capacity set to 100 microlitres.
! Eppendorf pipette tips.
! Spectrophotometer cuvettes containing 900 microlitres of ferric nitrate reagent as noted above,
this reagent is in a strong acid.
CAUTION: The ferric nitrate reagent solution you will be using is dissolved in 1.0 M nitric
acid. Wear gloves and use goggles to protect your eyes before starting the
experiment.
! Thiocyanate standards in tubes at the following concentrations: 0 micromoles/mL (this is your
blank), 0.5 micromoles/mL, 1.0 micromoles/mL, 2.0 micromoles/mL and 4.0 micromoles/mL.
! One tube of filtered cauliflower homogenate. 1.0 g of cauliflower was homogenized and the
homogenate was diluted to a total volume of 4.0 mL water. This is your unknown and you will be
required to determine how many micromoles of thiocyanate are present in one millilitre of this
homogenate.
! Marker pen to label the frosted side of each cuvette.
! Gloves and protective glasses
! On your bench is a spectrophotometer set to an absorbance of 447 nm.
NOTE: Before beginning this task, be sure that you have all the materials listed above. If you do not,
notify a lab assistant by raising your hand.
Procedure
1. Put on the gloves and the protective glasses.
2. To each of the cuvettes containing the ferric nitrate reagent add 100 microliters of each of the
thiocyanate standards. The standards are: 0, 0.5, 1.0, 2.0 and 4.0 micromoles thiocyanate/mL. A
coloured reaction should become visible except for the 0 micromole thiocyanate standard which
serves as your blank. Be sure to label the cuvettes on the frosted surface.
3. To each of the remaining 3 cuvettes add 100 microlitres of the cauliflower homogenate.
4. Carefully carry the cuvettes to the spectrophotometer which has been set to absorb at 447 nm. Open
the lid to the light path in the spectrophotometer and insert the 0 micromole thiocyanate/mL standard
(i.e., blank) cuvette. Note that the clear walls of the cuvette should be in line with the arrow
indicators in the spectrophotometer chanber.
Close the lid and push the set reference button on the top right hand of the panel on the
spectrophotometer see the diagram below.
Do not touch any of the other buttons!
5. Insert each of the standards and record the reading. Then insert each of the cuvettes containing the
unknown and record the spectrophotometer reading. Leave the cuvettes at the spectrophotometer
and the laboratory assistants will take care of them.
___________
___________
___________
___________
(10 marks)
2._____
3._____
6. Plot, on the graph paper (page 5), the absorbance measurements for your thiocyanate
standards against the concentration (micromoles/mL) of the standards. (6 marks)
7. Take the average absorbance of your cauliflower homogenate and determine the thiocyanate ion
concentration using the previously plotted graph. (5 marks)
ANSWER:
____________________
8. What is the concentration of the thiocyanate ion present in your cauliflower homogenate? Be sure to
state the units. (3 marks)
ANSWER:
_____________________
9. Calculate the standard deviation of the spectrophotometer reading of the unknown? (2 marks)
ANSWER: ________________________
TASK B. To determine the amount of cauliflower needed to be consumed for it to cause toxic
effects because of the presence of thiocyanate (5 marks)
Introduction
The LD50 is a toxicology term that describes the dose (i.e., moles of toxin/kg animal) of a compound that
will kill 50% of the animals tested. In the rat, the LD50 of sodium thiocyanate consumed is reported to
be 9 millimoles/kg. Using the data of the experiment you have just performed, calculate how much
cauliflower a rat that weighs 500 g would have to eat in a short time to reach the LD50 of thiocyanate.
Procedure
Circle the letter of the range that best fits your calculated value. Show your calculations on this page.
Continue on the back of this page if necessary.
(a)
1 g to 5 g
(b)
50 g to 250 g
(c)
500 g to 1 kg
(d)
1.5 kg to 14 kg
(e)
15 kg to 25 kg
Increased oxidant levels often results in activation of NFkappaB while lowering oxidant levels often
results in decreased activation of NFkappaB and, hence, lowered levels of expression of proinflammatory genes. The nitric oxide that is released by endothelial cells diffuses to smooth muscle
cells where it causes smooth muscle cells to relax. Hence, nitric oxide is a major regulator of blood
pressure.
Procedure
1. Examine the figures provided in each of the following sections.
2. Using the data presented, identify which data set is derived from animals fed a diet high in
glucoraphanin and provide the basis for your answer.
SECTION A. (5 marks)
Below is a figure that gives data on NFkappaB activation in spontaneously hypertensive stroke-prone
(SHRsp) male rats that were fed one of two diets: a control diet or an experimental diet containing
glucoraphanin. In the experimental diet, the animals consumed 10 micromoles glucoraphanin/kg body
weight.
After several months on these diets, the animals were euthanized, nuclei from the kidney cells were
isolated and prepared for SDS polyacrylamide electrophoresis. Following separation of the proteins on
the gel, the proteins were transferred to nitrocellulose membrane and probed with an antibody that
recognized the NFkappaB p65 protein.
A representative Western blot is shown below (on the left) and next to it is a graph that depicts the
quantification of blots from 5 different animals per diet group.
2. Which of the following statements gives the best explanation for your answer?
Circle the letter of that statement. (4 marks)
(a)
Less oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence less p65 in the nuclei.
(b)
Less oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence more p65 in the nuclei.
(c)
More oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence less p65 in the nuclei.
(d)
More oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation and hence more p65 in the nuclei.
(e)
More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation and hence less p65 in the nuclei.
SECTION B. (5 marks)
Below is a figure that gives Western blot data on a 45 kD nitrosylated protein (N-protein) in the kidneys
of two male SHRsp rats that were put on one of two different diets: a diet containing glucoraphanin and
control diets.
The top part of the figure is a representative Western blot while the bottom part of the figure is the
quantification of Western blots from 5 different animals per diet group.
Answer the following questions:
1. Which group represents the animals fed a diet containing glucoraphanin?
ANSWER: ___________C_______________
(1 mark)
2. Circle the letter of the statement below that best explains your answer.
(4 marks)
(a) More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation that results in more iNOS expression
and more peroxynitrous acid formation and thus more nitrosylation of proteins.
(b) More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation that results in more iNOS expression
and more peroxynitrous acid formation but less nitrosylation of proteins.
(c) More oxidative stress results in more NFkappaB activation that results in more iNOS expression
but less peroxynitrous acid formation and thus less nitrosylation of proteins.
(d) More oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation but results in less iNOS expression and
less peroxynitrous acid formation and thus less nitrosylation of proteins.
(e) Less oxidative stress results in less NFkappaB activation that results in less iNOS
expression and less peroxynitrous acid formation and thus less nitrosylation of proteins.
SECTION C. (5 marks)
The nitric oxide radical (NO.), that is released by endothelial cells of blood vessels, diffuses to smooth
muscle cells where it causes smooth muscle cells to relax and thus decreases blood pressure. The
amount of NO. that can diffuse to the smooth muscle depends upon the overall level of superoxide
radicals. If there are excessive superoxide radicals present, then NO. reacts with superoxide forming
peroxynitrous acid.
Below is a graph depicting the systolic blood pressures of female SHRsp rats placed on one of two diets,
a control diet and a diet containing glucoraphanin. Animals were placed on these diets at the age of 5
weeks post-natal and blood pressures were monitored from 6 to 19 weeks post-natal.
(1mark)
ANSWER: _______________________________
2. Circle the letter of the statement below that best explains your answer.
(4 marks)
(a) Less oxidative stress results in lower scavenging of nitric oxide. Decreased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in more vasorelaxation and thus lower blood
pressure.
(b) Less oxidative stress results in higher scavenging of nitric oxide. Decreased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in less vasorelaxation and thus higher blood
pressure.
(c) Less oxidative stress results in lower scavenging of nitric oxide. Increased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in more vasorelaxation and thus lower blood
pressure.
(d) Less oxidative stress results in higher scavenging of nitric oxide. Increased amounts of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in less vasorelaxation and thus higher blood
pressure.
(e) Less oxidative stress results in lower scavenging of nitric oxide. Increased amount of nitric
oxide available to vascular smooth muscle results in more vasorelaxation and thus lower blood
pressure.
- THE END
10
PRACTICAL EXAM 4
GENETICS
Before starting the exam, the invigilator will show you a red card and a
green card to test for red-green color blindness. If you are unable to
see the difference between the two cards, raise your hand, and you will
be provided with assistance immediately.
TASK A.
23 marks
TASK B.
16 marks
TASK C.
Student code:
TASK A.
Quantity
4 mL
! Microcentrifuge rack
! P1000 micropipettor
0.5 mL
0.5 mL
0.5 mL
0.5 mL
3 mL
3 mL
! Timer
! Tube labels
! Marker pen
! Red card
! Access to a microcentrifuge
! Access to vortex
NOTE:
Before beginning this task, be sure that you have all the materials listed above.
If you do not, raise your RED card to call a lab assistant.
Procedure
1.
Pipette 1.5 mL of bacterial culture into each of two 1.5 mL microcentrifuge tubes.
2.
Centrifuge the tubes in a benchtop microcentrifuge for 1 minute - make sure that the
centrifuge rotor is BALANCED.
3.
Completely remove and discard the growth medium from each tube.
4.
Add 100 uL of GET (Glucose-EDTA-Tris) buffer pH 7.9 to the cell pellet (no need to
cap the tubes) - vortex vigorously to resuspend the pellet and leave at room
temperature for 5 minutes.
5.
6.
To each tube from 4. above add 200 uL of this freshly prepared mixture of 1% SDS
and 0.2 N NaOH - cap the tubes and invert 4-5 times.
7.
8.
To each tube add 150 uL 5M KOAc (3 M potassium and 5 M acetate), cap the tubes
and shake briefly by hand to mix.
9.
10. Centrifuge the tubes for 3 minutes - full speed in microcentrifuge - remember to
balance the rotor.
11. Label 2 clean microcentrifuge tubes with your 4-digit student code number.
12. Pipette the supernatant from each of the centrifuged tubes into each of the clean
tubes. Discard the original tube which now contains a white pellet - this is bacterial
chromosomal DNA.
13. Add 800 uL of 95% ethanol to each tube. Cap the tubes, shake vigorously for 10 sec
and leave on bench 10 minutes.
14. Centrifuge the tubes for 5 minutes - full speed in microcentrifuge.
15. Pour off the supernatant from each tube, cap the tube and raise your RED card.
16. The lab assistant will check your pellet (10 marks for a white pellet).
17. The lab assistant will then give you the sequence trace for your plasmid and cDNA.
The cDNA was sequenced from the T3 promoter.
18. Check your sequence (starting at nucleotide 21) against that for the pBluescript
vector and answer the questions on page 5.
EcoR1.
NOTE: The first letter of the enzymes name is located above the first nucleotide of its
recognition sequence. (5 marks)
2. List the first 20 nucleotides of your fragment of DNA (not including the restriction site
sequence). (2 marks)
nucleotide
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
3. Find the first start codon. Using the genetic code table provided, and starting with the
start codon, translate the first 21 nucleotides into their appropriate amino acids. (4 marks)
Start codon
Amino
MET
acid
1
VAL
3
TYR
6
LEU
9
10
11
LEU
12
13
14
LEU
15
16
17
nucleotide
MET
STOP
LEU
18
19
20
21
Task C.
Genetic Control of Seed Coat Colour and Seed Shape in
Beans (20 marks)
Material
!
1 plastic bag containing F1 seeds (flat yellow) from the cross between the parent
beans DO NOT OPEN
1 plastic bag of F2 bean seeds (representing 250 F2 plants) THIS BAG MAY BE
OPENED
To help you answer the questions below, fill in the following table:
Seed shape
(round or flat)
(yellow or red)
Parent 1
FLAT
RED
Parent 2
ROUND
RED
FLAT
YELLOW
Generation
(1 mark)
(1 mark)
(1 mark)
3. (a) There are four phenotypes in your sample of F2 seeds. Classify the seeds into
these phenotypic classes and write the number of each phenotype in the table
below. (2 points)
Phenotype
Number of seeds
(= number of F2 plants)
round, red
13
flat, red
38
round, yellow
18
flat, yellow
55
Total
124
From your data how many genes could be controlling seed shape?
(1 mark)
How many round beans and how many flat ones would you expect in a
population this size?
ROUND ___31___
FLAT ____93______
(2 marks)
(c) Is this segregation ratio significantly different from the observed ratio (circle one)?
YES
And what is the probability?
NO
0.95<p<1.0
(1 mark)
(3 marks)
5. (a)
From your data how many genes could be controlling seed coat colour?
_2_
(1 mark)
(b)
How many red beans and how many yellow beans would you expect in a
population this size?
RED
54.25
YELLOW
69.75
(3 marks)
(c) Is this segregation ratio significantly different from the observed ratio? (circle one)
YES
And what is the probability?
NO
(1 mark)
(3 marks)
Chi-square Distribution
Probability
Df
0.95
0.90
0.80
0.70
0.50
0.30
0.20
0.10
0.05
0.01
0.001
0.004
0.02
0.06
0.15
0.46
1.07
1.64
2.71
3.84
6.64
10.83
0.10
0.21
0.45
0.71
1.39
2.41
3.22
4.60
5.99
9.21
13.82
0.35
0.58
1.01
1.42
2.37
3.66
4.64
6.25
7.82
11.34
16.27
0.71
1.06
1.65
2.20
3.36
4.88
5.99
7.78
9.49
13.28
18.47
- THE END
This table shows the 64 codons and the amino acid each codon codes for. The direction is 5' to 3'.
2nd base
U
1st
base
A
UAU (Tyr/Y)Tyrosine
UGU (Cys/C)Cysteine
UAC (Tyr/Y)Tyrosine
UGC (Cys/C)Cysteine
UUA (Leu/L)Leucine
UCA (Ser/S)Serine
UUG (Leu/L)Leucine
UCG (Ser/S)Serine
UGG (Trp/W)Tryptophan
CUU (Leu/L)Leucine
CCU (Pro/P)Proline
CAU (His/H)Histidine
CGU (Arg/R)Arginine
CUC (Leu/L)Leucine
CCC (Pro/P)Proline
CAC (His/H)Histidine
CGC (Arg/R)Arginine
CUA (Leu/L)Leucine
CCA (Pro/P)Proline
CAA (Gln/Q)Glutamine
CGA (Arg/R)Arginine
CUG (Leu/L)Leucine
CCG (Pro/P)Proline
CAG (Gln/Q)Glutamine
CGG (Arg/R)Arginine
AUU (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGU (Ser/S)Serine
AUC (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGC (Ser/S)Serine
AUA (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGA (Arg/R)Arginine
AUG (Met/M)Methionine
AGG (Arg/R)Arginine
GUU (Val/V)Valine
GCU (Ala/A)Alanine
GUC (Val/V)Valine
GCC (Ala/A)Alanine
GUA (Val/V)Valine
GCA (Ala/A)Alanine
GUG (Val/V)Valine
GCG (Ala/A)Alanine
Q. 4. (b)
(c)
63 :187 was also accepted if the students used 250 as the population size
P = 0.95 was not accepted unless it was the actual p-value.
This answer is based on the expected values in 4b, if the student had different
expected values their numbers were used in a chi-square calculation. This was
necessary as the students did not always get the right # of seeds/phenotype.
Q. 5. (b)
(c)
109:140 was also accepted if the students used 250 as the population size.
Full marks were given if the ratio was reversed (not convinced the translations were
always correct)
This answer is based on the expected values in 5 (b). If the student had different
expected values, those numbers were used in the chi-square calculation. This was
necessary as the students did not always get the right # of seeds/phenotype.
THEORY EXAMINATION # 1
Total marks possible: 99.0
STUDENT CODE
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Check that you have the correct examination paper and an answer sheet.
WHEN YOU HAVE FINISHED THE EXAM, PLACE YOUR ANSWER SHEET INSIDE
YOUR QUESTION PAPER AND HAND BOTH TO THE INVIGILATOR BEFORE
LEAVING THE EXAM ROOM.
REMEMBER TO WRITE YOUR 4-DIGIT STUDENT CODE ON THE FRONT PAGE OF
THE QUESTION PAPER.
Read each question carefully before attempting it.
! If you want to change your answer, use the eraser to remove your incorrect response and
fill in the new circle you require.
! There is only one correct answer to each question.
! Questions 1 - 30 are worth one mark each The mark value for questions 31 60 varies
according to the length and difficulty of the question.
! Marks will not be deducted for incorrect answers.
Question 2. A blood smear of a human shows higher than normal numbers of eosinophils. Which
of the following may be occurring in his body?
ibo! 7/18/07 8:20 PM
Deleted:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 3. The ABO blood type of humans can be determined by a coagulation reaction with
anti-A and anti-B antibodies.
Positive coagulation
Negative Coagulation
With anti-A
antibodies
With anti-B
antibodies
None
Question 4. The graph below shows the result of blood glucose test from a diabetes patient.
When tested 3 hours after having a carbohydrate rich meal, the blood glucose level of this patient
was 3 times higher than that of a normal individual. However, there was no difference in the level
of insulin in the blood between the two individuals.
Which of the following could be the reason for diabetic symptoms in this patient?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 5. The following graph shows the dissociation curves for hemoglobin and myoglobin.
Based on the data presented in the graph, which of the following statements is true?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Questions 6 - 8. This figure indicates some of the pathways involved in the metabolism of
food.
Question 6. When a person consumes a diet rich in carbohydrate, the reactions up-regulated will be:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 7.
be:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 8.
are:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
5, 6, 7
2, 8
5, 8
1, 3, 4
2, 5. 6
When a person performs heavy exercise, the reactions that will be down-regulated will
5, 6, 7, 8
1, 3, 4
4, 5, 6, 7
1, 2, 4
7, 3, 4
If a person suffers from carnitine deficiency, the reactions that will be down-regulated
6, 8 only
1, 3, 4
4, 5, 6, 7
2, 5, 6
5, 6, 7, 8
Question 9. A yeast extract contains all the enzymes required for alcohol production. The extract
is incubated under anaerobic conditions in 1 liter of medium containing: 200 mM glucose, 20 mM
ADP, 40 mM ATP, 2 mM NADH, 2 mM NAD+ and 20 mM Pi (inorganic phosphates). Ethanol
What is the maximum amount of ethanol that can be produced under these conditions?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
2 mM
20 mM
40 mM
200 mM
400 mM
Question 10. Thyroid hormone release is due to the action of thyroid-stimulating hormone (TSH)
released by the pituitary gland. Release of TSH is governed by the TSH-releasing hormone (TRH)
which is synthesized in the hypothalamus and released into the pituitary gland.
The graph below shows the concentration of TSH in human blood during the three hours following
an injection of TRH in two groups of people, A and B. One group was treated with thyroxine in the
days prior to the experiment. Consider endocrine feed-back regulation when answering the
following question.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
I and II
II and III
III and IV
I and IV
I and III
Question 11. Typical intracellular concentrations of the Na+, K+ and Ca2+ ions are 15 mM, 120
mM and 100 nM, respectively. In the cell we are interested in the usual Na+, K+ leak channels that
are present as well as the Na+/K+ pump (ATPase). Extracellularly, the concentrations of Na+, K+
and Ca2+ are 140 mM, 4 mM and 2 mM, respectively. Which of the following would happen if the
extracellular K+ concentration were to be increased to 10 mM?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
I
I, II, III
III
III, IV, V
IV, V
Question 12. Thermogenesis is a process where heat is generated. The energy present in the reducing
equivalents such as NADH + H+ or FADH2 in mitochondria is normally used to pump protons across the
inner mitochondrial membrane to the intermembranous space. This proton gradient is the motive force for
ATP production. Examine the figures below and consider whether ATP synthesis or thermogenesis
predominates when answering the following question.
The molecules represented by I, II, III and IV represent mitochondrial electron carriers.
10
In which of the three situations shown in the figure above does thermogenesis predominate over
ATP synthesis?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
only I
only II
only III
I and II
I and III
Question 13. The figure below outlines the glycolytic pathway. There are several regulatory steps
in glycolysis. A major regulatory step in glycolysis is the conversion of fructose 6-phosphate to
fructose 1,6-biphosphate by phosphofructose kinase. This enzyme is allosterically inhibited by
ATP and allosterically activated by AMP. Thus, cellular ATP:AMP ratios are important in the
regulation of phosphofructose kinase. In addition, low pH inhibits phosphofructose kinase activity.
11
What effect will poisoning of mitochondrial function by the mitochondrial uncoupler dinitrophenol
(DNP) have on glycolysis?
A. It will increase the rate of glycolysis if there is a means of oxidizing NADH.
B. It will result in the immediate death of the cell.
C. It will increase the rate of glycolysis if there is a means of further increasing the
reduction of NAD+.
D. It will inhibit the conversion of phosphoenol pyruvate to pyruvic acid.
E. It will promote the formation of 1,3 biphosphoglycerate from 3-phosphoglycerate.
Question 14. Lions (Panthera leo) live in stable social groups called prides which usually have
three or more adult females, their dependent offspring and one or two dominant adult males. The
old and weak male(s) in a pride may be driven away by other strong males or by a new coalition of
males.
Which combination of the following statements is correct.?
I. Females born into a pride leave before they reproductive maturity.
II. Males born into a pride remain there for life.
III. Females born into a pride remain there for life.
IV. New dominant male try to kill only newly born females.
V. Males born into a pride leave before they reach reproductive activity.
VI. New dominant male try to kill only newly born males.
VII. Adult females in a lion pride are never related to each other.
VIII. New dominant male try to kill as many young cubs as possible.
IX. Adult females in a lion pride are often related each other.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 15. The correct statement pertaining to the following Rank-Abundance Curve is:
Community A
Community B
12
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 16. Stromatolites, layered mounds created by cyanobacteria, have been found in shallow
waters. They resemble small rocks but are organic in origin. Fossilised stromatolites are thought to
be important because they are suggestive of:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Questions 17 18. A student studied the influence of temperature and light intensity upon CO2
flux of plants in a greenhouse. During the experiment cellular respiration is not influenced by light
intensity and cellular respiration of glucose is completely aerobic. At each temperature CO2 uptake
was measured during light exposure and loss of CO2 was measured during the dark period. The
light intensity was constant during the light period and was not a limiting factor for photosynthesis.
The data collected are presented in the following table.
Temp (C)
Loss of CO2 in
dark*
5
0.5
10
0.7
15
1.2
20
1.9
25
2.3
30
2.0
35
1.5
* units: mg per gram dried weight per hour
0.2
0.5
0.9
1.5
2.6
3.9
3.3
Question 17. At which temperatures does the plant release O2 when exposed to light?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
13
Question 18. The optimum temperature for photosynthesis and the optimum temperature of respiration
is somewhere in the range of 5 - 35 C. Which of the following statements is correct?
A. optimum temp for photosynthesis < optimum temp for dissimilation
B. optimum temp for photosynthesis = optimum temp for dissimilation
C. optimum temp for photosynthesis > optimum temp for dissimilation
Question 19. A woman with Turner syndrome is found to be haemophilic (X linked recessive
phenotype). Both her mother and her father have normal blood coagulation.
Which of the statements below gives what you consider to be the best answer to each of following
questions?
I.
How can the simultaneous origin of Turner syndrome and haemophilia by abnormal
chromosome behavior during meiosis be explained?
II. Did the abnormal chromosome behavior occur in the mother or the father?
III. During which division of meiosis did the abnormal chromosome behavior occur?
A.
The father of the woman with Turner syndrome (XXX) must have been a
carrier for haemophilia, an X-linked recessive disorder. Nondisjunction occurred in her
mother. An egg lacking a sex chromosome was fertilized with a sperm with X
chromosome carrying the haemophilic allele. The nondisjunctive event could have
occurred only during first meiotic division.
B.
One of the parents of the woman with Turner syndrome (X0) must have been a
carrier for haemophilia, an X-linked recessive disorder. Because her father has
normal blood coagulation, she could not have obtained her only X chromosome
from him. Therefore nondisjunction occurred in her father. A sperm lacking a
sex chromosome fertilized an egg with X chromosome carrying the haemophilic
allele. The nondisjunctive event could have occurred during either meiotic
division.
C.
One of the parents of the woman with Turner syndrome (XXY) is a carrier for
haemophilia, an X-linked recessive disorder. Because her mother has normal blood
coagulation, she could not have obtained her X choromosome from her mother.
Therefore, nondisjunction occurred in her mother. A sperm with a sex chromosome
carrying the haemophilic allele fertilized an egg with XX chromosome. The
nondisjunctive event could have occurred during second meiotic division.
D.
One of the parents of the woman with Turner syndrome is a carrier for haemophilia, an
X-linked recessive disorder. Because her father has normal blood coagulation, she has
obtained her only X choromosome from her mother. A nondisjunction occurred in her
father during either meiotic division. A sperm lacking a sex chromosome fertilized an
egg with X chromosome carrying the haemophilic allele.
14
Questions 20 21. A rare human disease afflicted a family as shown in the following pedigree.
Question 20. What is the most likely mode of inheritance of this disease?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 21. What is the probability that the first child of the marriage between cousins, 1 x 4, is
a boy with the disease?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
1/2
1/4
1/8
1/16
0
Questions 22 - 23. The wild-type flower color of harebell plants (genus Campanula) is blue.
Using radiation, three mutants with white petals were produced, white 1, white 2 and white 3. They
all look the same, so it was not known whether they were genetically identical. The mutant strains
are available as homozygous pure-breeding lines.
15
The mutant strains were crossed with the wild-type blue genotype and with each other to produce
the following results:
Parental cross
F1 phenotype
F2 segregation ratio
White 1 x blue
all blue
White 2 x blue
all blue
White 3 x blue
all blue
White 1 x white 2
all white
no data available
White 1 x white 3
all blue
no data available
White 2 x white 3
all blue
no data available
Question 22. Using these results, determine which statement is the correct conclusion for this
study.
A.
B.
C.
D.
The mutant genes in white 1 and 3 are allelic and are different to the mutant gene in
white 2.
The mutant genes in white 2 and 3 are allelic and are different to the mutant gene in
white 1.
The mutant genes in white 1 and 2 are allelic and are different to the mutant gene
in white 3.
The mutant genes in white 1, 2 and 3 are all allelic.
Question 23. The type of gene action operating among the crosses between the mutants in this
study is
A.
B.
C.
D.
complete dominance.
dominant epistasis.
recessive (complementary) epistasis
duplicate gene interaction.
16
# the fourth peptide products of normal "-globin were (amino acid residues are abbreviated by
the following letters: V=valine, H= histidine, L= leucine, T= threonine, P= proline, E= glutamic
acid and K= lysine):
VH
VHL
VHLT
TPE
TPEEK
EK
# the fourth peptide products of "-globin of sickle cell anemia were
VH
VHL
VHLT
TPV
TPVEK
EK
Question 24. From these results, how many amino acids is the fourth peptide composed of and
what was the substituted position of amino acid residue counting from the N-terminus?
From the following, choose the one statement which is most appropriate. Assume that this fourth
peptide contains only one molecule of T (threonine).
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
It was composed of 8 amino acids and the 6th amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 8 amino acids and the 3rd amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 7 amino acids and the 6th amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 7 amino acids and the 3rd amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 9 amino acids and the 6th amino acid was substituted.
Question 25. Below is a DNA sequence coding a part of the amino acid sequence in the fourth
peptide of normal "-globin. In sickle cell anemia, it is known that a mutation occurs in the region
enclosed by
.
From the following, choose one that is an appropriate DNA sequence of the mutation.
Normal! TGAGGACTCCTCTTCAGA
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
TGAGGACCCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGACTACCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGACACCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGACCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGAACTCCTCTTCAGA
17
Question 26 - 28. The diagram below represents a nephron from an adult human.
3
4
Question 26. At which of the numbered points would the filtrate be hypertonic to the blood?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
1 and 3 only
1, 2 and 3
2 and 3 only
4 only
3 and 4
Question 27. At which of the numbered points is sodium reabsorbed from the filtrate?
A.
1 only
B.
1 and 2 only
C.
1, 2 and 3
D.
1, 2 and 4
E.
4 only
18
Question 28. The open arrow shows the direction of blood flow into the Glomerulus. What
happens if the diameter of the blood vessel is constricted at point X?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 29. A and B are two 70 Kg individuals with same body water volume. Both of them had
a snack that had a high salt content, and B also drank a glass of an alcoholic drink . Based on this
information, which one of following statements is true?
A.
B.
C.
D
E.
Question 30. Which of the following RNA sequences would hybridize most effectively with the
DNA sequence 5 - ATA CTT ACT CAT TTT 3?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 31. What does a small standard deviation indicate about data obtained from an
experiment?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E
19
IMPORTANT
20
Question 32. For blood under each of the conditions described below, select the letter of the oxyhemoglobin dissociation curve with which it is most likely to be associated. (3 marks)
Oxygen
saturation
(%)
1.
2.
3.
Anaemic blood
Foetal blood
5.
Blood exposed to CO
6.
7.
8.
E
A
A
C
A
21
Question 33. The following graph shows the concentration of thyroid-stimulating hormone (TSH)
in human blood during the 3 hours following an injection of TSH-releasing hormone (TRH) in two
groups of people (A and B). One group was treated with thyroxine daily for a week prior to the
experiment. (2 marks)
B
A
STATEMENT
a. Thyroxine treatment stimulated TSH release in Group A
b. Group A has been treated with thyroxine daily before treatment
with TRH
c. Group B has been treated with thyroxine daily before treatment
with TRH
d. Thyroxine treatment inhibited TSH release in Group B
22
Question 34. Digestion of food is facilitated by enzymes and hormones secreted at various regions
of the gastro-intestinal tract. Select the organs (identified by different letters) from the diagram
below that secretes the following enzymes and hormones: (4 marks)
B
C
D
I.
Amylase
_____A, C____
II.
Lipase
_____C, D____
III. Chymotrypsin
_____C_______
IV. Insulin
_____C_______
V.
_____D_______
Cholecystokinin (CCK)
VI. Aminopeptidase
_____D_______
VII. Gastrin
_____B_______
VIII.Carboxypeptidase
______C______
23
Questions 35 37. A 21 year-old student gets into a car accident and experiences brain trauma.
Use the figure below to answer the following questions.. Use the appropriate number to refer to the
region of the brain affected.
Question 35. The patient experiences lack of co-ordination and problems in balance. What
part of the brain is most likely damaged? (0.5 mark)
ANSWER:
Question 36. The patient slurs her speech and is unable to clearly read even simple passages
from a book. What part of the brain is most likely damaged? (0.5 mark)
ANSWER:
Question 37. The patient experiences double vision and images are blurry. What part of the
brain is most likely damaged? (0.5 mark)
ANSWER:
24
Question 38. To study hierarchial reaction in crickets (Gryllus campestris), five crickets, A, B, C,
D and E, were marked with colours and placed two by two in an experimental field. Observations
were made on their aggressive behaviour and the results are shown below:
Partner
B
Won
fights
6
Lost
fights
0
Won
fights
0
Lost
fights
6
Won
fights
9
Lost
fights
2
Partner
Won
fights
0
Lost
fights
7
Won
fights
6
Lost
fights
2
Partner
Partner
Partner
Indicate if the following statements are correct by writing the appropriate answer code in the
answer column of the following table. (3 marks)
Answer code :
1 = CORRECT
2 = INCORRECT
25
Statement
Answer
c. The hierarchy is linear: with the following order: C " E" A " B " D
d. Some crickets won fights against crickets that were higher in the
hierarchical order.
1
1
Question 39. According to the usual classification, birds are classified as vertebrates with feathers
and reptiles as epidermal scale vertebrates. A different phylogenetic classification has been
proposed and includes birds and crocodiles in the Archosaurian group.
Below are the two types of classification:
Usual classification
Phylogenetic classification
26
Eagle
covering feet
present
present
present
Ostrich
covering feet
present
present
present
present
present
none
none
none
none
Lizard
none
none
none
Frog
none
none
none
none
Indicate if the following statements are correct by writing the appropriate answer code in the
answer column of the table. (2 marks)
Answer code :
No
h.
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
g.
1 = CORRECT
2 = INCORRECT
Statement
Answer
a. Birds and reptiles both have scales. Therefore, we can assume that
they share a common ancestor which is not a common ancestor of the
frog.
b. The eagle, ostrich and crocodile are homologous for the preorbital
fenestra feature
c. Possession of feathers is an ancestral characteristic, whereas the
possession of scales is a more recent modification.
d. Since crocodiles are more closely related to birds than to lizards, scales
are not a relevant characteristic to be used in this type of classification.
1
1
2
27
Question 40. Four tree communities were identified at four different locations to the north, south,
west and east of Ottawa, Canada. The communities are represented below, with each different tree
figure symbolizing a different species. (6 marks)
NORTH Community
SOUTH Community
WEST Community
No
a.
Community attribute
Highest species richness
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
g.
h.
EAST Community
A. North
ANSWER
B. South
C. West
D. East
!
!
!
!
!
!
28
Question 41. A survivorship curve depicts the age-specific mortality through survivorship.
Indicate whether the following statements about the survivorship are true. The graphs shown below
indicate different types of survivorship curves.
Graph I represents organisms that provide good care of their offspring, such as humans
and many other large mammals.
TRUE
FALSE
B. Graph II is typical of survivorship curves for organisms such as many fishes and marine
invertebrates
TRUE
FALSE
C. Graph II is characteristics of the adult stages of birds after a period of high juvenile
mortality.
TRUE
FALSE
D. Birds may have a Graph III-type survivorship curve with a brief period of high mortality
among the youngest individuals, followed by increasing periods of lower mortality.
TRUE
FALSE
FALSE
29
To match the structures and processes involved in this lifecycle, match each number from the
diagram of the lifecycle with the letter of the proper term in the list below and write that letter in the
appropriate box. (3.5 marks)
Diagram
number
Term
from list
Diagram
number
Term
from list
Diagram
number
13
14
3
4
9
10
5
6
11
12
List of Terms
a. megasporangium produces eggs by meiosis
b. fertilization
c. zygote
d. embryo
e. diploid portion of life cycle
f. seedling
g. pollen cone, producing pollen
Term
from list
h. seed coat
i. mature sporophyte
j. integument
k. haploid portion of life cycle
l. megaspore mother cell
m. ovulate cone, bearing ovules
n. microsporangium produces pollen by
meiosis
30
Queston 43. The diagram below represents the stages in the mobilization of starch reserves in a
barley grain.
Water
I
III
IV
II
Starch
hhh
Water
Match the appropriate term with the correct Roman numeral from the diagram above. (Note: not all
terms have answers.) (3 marks)
TERM FROM
DIAGRAM
ANSWER
Alpha-amylase
III
Aleurone layer
Auxn
Gibberellic acid
II
Sugar
IV
Proten
Question 44. The structures in List B develop from the structures shown in List A. Match each
structure in List A with the appropriate structures in List B. Enter your answers in the table below.
(2.5 marks)
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
List A
Microspore
Microsporophyll
Megaspore
Megasporangium
Megasporophyll
List B
1. Pollen sac
2. Primary cell of Embryo sac
3. Carpel
4. Nucellus
5. Pollen grain
31
LIST A
LIST B
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Question 45. Plants obtain various mineral nutrients from the soil. These nutrients have different
physiological roles in plants.
Match the elements/compounds from the left column with their functions in plants in the right
column. Write your answers in the answer table below. (5 marks)
1. Calcium
2. Nitrogen
3. Nitrate
4. Iodine
5. Phosphate
6. Magnesium
7. Potassium
8. Sulfate
9. Manganese
10. Iron
Answer Table
1.
2.
F
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
32
Questions 46 - 48. The ways different substances can be transported through the biological
membrane is shown in Figure 1.
Exterior
Y
out.
in.
Dout.
out.
in.
out.
in.
Eout.
Fout.
Oout.
Mout.
Din.
P
Ein.
Fin.
P
Oin.
Min.
Interior
Question 46. Match the name of the transport systems to the letter(s) in Figure 1 (4 marks)
Transport mechanism
1. Conjugated active transport
Answer
M, O
3. Exocytosis
5. Phagocytosis/pinocytosis;
8. Co-transport
D, E
33
Question 47. Indicate which letters in Figure 1 correspond to each transport system. (4 marks)
Answer
9.
10.
11.
Passive transport
12.
Active transport
Question 48. Identify from Figure 1 the correct example for each transport type. (4 marks)
Answer
13.
Na+, K+-$%Pase
14.
Low-density lipoproteins
15.
water, urea
16.
17.
glucose, aminoacids
18.
19.
20.
Hormonal secretion
M, O
D, E
34
Question 49. The total respiration (R) of a young growing plant can be described by the following
expression:
Total R = Maintenance R + Growth R
Some of the processes that occur during growth of this plant are:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Certain of these processes require energy, some supply energy to the plant and others are not
involved in energy use or supply. Indicate which processes require or supply energy by writing a +
(plus sign) and which processes have no energy involvement by writing a ' (minus sign) in the
correct places in the following table. (3.5 marks)
Process
number
35
Question 50. The following diagram shows an ovule just prior to double fertilization.
Identify each of the structures indicated by an arrow and label it on the diagram with the
appropriate letter code from the table below. (4 marks)
A
F
G
D
STRUCTURE
LETTER CODE
Antipodal cell
Egg cell
Integument
Polar nuclei
Pollen tube
Synergid cell
36
Question 51. A family consists of three children, David, Edna and Sophie and their parents
Alison and Alfred. One of the children is blood group A and is also red green colour blind . Edna is
blood group B and Sophie is blood group O. Of the children only David has blue eyes. Neither
parent is colour blind, but only Alfred has blue eyes and is blood group B.
Choose a possible genotype for each family member and write the appropriate capital letter for that
genotype against the name. (2.5 marks)
A = XC Xc AO Bb
B = XC Y AO bb
C = XC Xc BO Bb
D = XC Xc AO Bb
E = XC Y AO Bb
F = XC Xc OO Bb
G = XC Y BO bb
H = Xc Y AO bb
Family member
Genotype
David
Edna
Sophie
Alison
Alfred
Question 52. In Canada, 7,0 % of the male population is colorblind. This is a sex linked recessive
feature located on the X-chromosome. (1 mark)
What percentage of the female population, not being colorblind, is a carrier of alleles responsible
for colorblindness?
Answer: 13 %
37
Questions 53 - 54. The fox operon, which has sequences A, B, C, and D, encodes enzymes 1
and 2. Mutations in sequences A, B, C, and D have the following effects, where a plus sign (+) =
enzyme synthesized and a minus sign (-) = enzyme not synthesized. Fox is the regulator of fox
operon.
Mutation
sequence
No mutation
A
B
C
D
in
Fox absent
Enzyme 1
Enzyme 2
Fox present
Enzyme 1
Enzyme 2
+
+
+
+
+
+
Question 53. Is the fox operon inducible or repressible? Indicate your answer by writing X in the
appropriate place in the table below. (1 mark)
Inducible
Repressible
Question 54. Which sequence (A, B, C, or D) is part of the following components of the operon?
Match the correct letter against the component in the table below. (2 marks)
Component of operon
Answer
Regulator gene
Promoter
38
Question 55. The following is a list of mutational changes. For each of the specific mutations
described, indicate which of the following terms could apply, either as a description of the mutation
or as a possible cause. More than one term from the right column can apply to each statement in the
left column. (6 marks)
Write your answers in the answer table below.
Code
Description of mutation
Code
1.
2.
3.
Term
a.
transition
b.
base
substitution
c.
transversion
4.
d.
inversion
5.
e.
translocation
6.
f.
7.
8.
9.
deletion
g.
insertion
h.
deamination
i.
X-ray
irradiation
j.
intercalator
k.
unequal
crossingover
Answer table
1
a. b
b, c
39
Question 56. The wild type tryptophan synthetase enzyme of E. coli contains a glycine (Gly) at
position 38. Two trp mutants A23 and A46 have been isolated which have arginine (Arg) instead of
glycine at position 38 (A23) and glutamate (Glu) at position 38 (A46). Both mutants were plated on
minimal medium and from A23 four spontaneous revertants to prototrophy (i.e. are able to grow
without supplements) were obtained and from A46 three spontaneous revertants to prototrophy were
obtained. The tryptophan synthetase from each of the seven revertants were isolated and the amino
acids at position 38 were identified.
mutant
revertant
A23
1
2
3
4
isoleucine (Ile)
threonine (Thr)
serine (Ser)
glycine (Gly)
A46
1
2
3
glycine (Gly)
alanine (Ala)
valine (Val)
A summary of these data is given below. Using the genetic code table provided on the next page,
deduce the codons for the wild type, mutants A23 and A46 and for the revertants and place each
designation in the box provided. (5 marks)
wild type
Gly
GGA
A23 mutant
A46 mutant
Arg
Glu
AGA
GAA
revertants
Gly
Ile
AUA
Thr
ACA
Ser
AGC/AGU
Gly
GGA
GGA
Ala
Val
GCA
GUA
40
This table shows the 64 codons and the amino acid each codon codes for. The direction is 5' to 3'.
2nd base
U
UAU (Tyr/Y)Tyrosine
UGU (Cys/C)Cysteine
U UUA (Leu/L)Leucine
UAC (Tyr/Y)Tyrosine
UGC (Cys/C)Cysteine
UCA (Ser/S)Serine
UUG (Leu/L)Leucine
UCG (Ser/S)Serine
UGG (Trp/W)Tryptophan
CUU (Leu/L)Leucine
CCU (Pro/P)Proline
CAU (His/H)Histidine
CGU (Arg/R)Arginine
CUC (Leu/L)Leucine
CCC (Pro/P)Proline
CAC (His/H)Histidine
CGC (Arg/R)Arginine
CUA (Leu/L)Leucine
CCA (Pro/P)Proline
CAA (Gln/Q)Glutamine
CGA (Arg/R)Arginine
CUG (Leu/L)Leucine
CCG (Pro/P)Proline
CAG (Gln/Q)Glutamine
CGG (Arg/R)Arginine
AUU (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGU (Ser/S)Serine
AUC (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGC (Ser/S)Serine
AUA (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGA (Arg/R)Arginine
AUG (Met/M)Methionine
AGG (Arg/R)Arginine
GUU (Val/V)Valine
GCU (Ala/A)Alanine
GUC (Val/V)Valine
GCC (Ala/A)Alanine
GCA (Ala/A)Alanine
GCG (Ala/A)Alanine
C
1st
base
G GUA (Val/V)Valine
GUG (Val/V)Valine
41
Question 57. In a paternity suit the ABO phenotypes of the mother, the child and the two possible
fathers (F1 and F2) were determined, and a DNA profile was made for each person.
Both the mother (M) and the child (C) are type A, Rh-negative. Father F1 is type B, Rh-negative
and Father F2 is type O, Rh-negative. The DNA profiles are shown below.
42
Question 58. DNA repair" mechanisms can be divided into 3 categories (listed below). A list of
repairing processes is also given.
Match each DNA repair mechanisms with the names of the repairing processes. (4.5 marks)
Answer table
DNA repair mechanism
1. Damage reversal
2. Damage removal
3. Damage tolerance
43
Question 59. The pBR322 plasmid was cut with two different restriction enzymes. The patterns of
ethidium bromide staining of plasmid DNA after electrophoresis on agarose gels are shown.
P
+ HindIII
+BsuI
P
+BsuI + HindIII
a
b
c
d
f
g
h
Reference:
P: plasmid
( ..T ) The pBR322 has only one restriction site for HindIII.
(....T....) The migration rate of a DNA molecule in an agarose gel is inversely proportional to
its size.
(....F.....) The bands in lane 4 indicate that both enzymes have the same restriction site.
44
Question 60. Information on the description and appearance of various chromosomal structural
arrangements is given below.
1. Tandom duplication
2. Reciprocal translocation
3. Interstitial deletion
4. Pericentric inversion
5. Displaced duplication
6. Interstitial translocation
7. Terminal deletion
8. Reverse duplication
9. Paracentric inversion
original order.
H. Movement of a segment of chromosome from one to another
in one way.
K. Chromosomal segment is represented twice but it is not
adjacent to original segment
45
In the following table and using the appropriate letters and Roman numerals, match the correct
definition and appearance to the type of chromosomal change listed. (4.5 marks)
Definition
1. Tandem duplication
2. Reciprocal translocation
3. Interstitial deletion
4. Pericentric inversion
5. Displaced duplication
6. Interstitial translocation
7. Terminal deletion
8. Reverse duplication
9. Paracentric inversion
- THE END -
Appearance
THEORY EXAMINATION # 2
Total marks possible: 53.5
STUDENT CODE
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Check that you have the correct examination paper and an answer sheet.
IMPORTANT
! Use the answer sheet provided to record your answers.
! Ensure that your name and student code is PRINTED in the top margin of the front
page of the answer sheet. The markers will enter this information in the correct places
on the reverse side of the answer sheet.
! Use only the HB pencil provided to mark the answer sheet. Completely fill in the circle.
A
o
C
o
D
o
E
o
Which one of the following is the correct sequence of the development of the structures indicated
by the letters A to E?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
A, C, D, B, E
A, B, D, C, E
C, B, D, A, E
D, B, C, A, E
E, B, D, C, A
A
B
C
D
Question 3. Which of the following correctly lists the hormones in order from A to D?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 5. Ovulation is triggered by a peak in the hormone whose level is shown by the
A.
B.
C.
D.
Line A
Line B
Line C
Line D
A.
B.
C.
D.
uterine wall
ovary
hypothalamus
anterior pituitary
A.
B.
C.
D.
uterine wall
ovary
hypothalamus
anterior pituitary
Question 8. One hypothesis predicts that most of the CO2 produced in the soil originates from
microorganisms feeding on dead plant material. To which trophic level do these microorganisms
belong?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Primary producers
Secondary producers
Decomposers
First order consumers
Second order consumers
Question 9. Joan and Claude (neither have cystic fibrosis) come to you seeking genetic counseling.
Claude was married before, and he and his first wife had a child with cystic fibrosis, an autosomal
recessive condition. A brother of Joans died of cystic fibrosis and Joan has never been tested for
the gene. If they marry, what is the probability that Joan and Claude will have a son that WILL
NOT be a carrier for, nor have cystic fibrosis?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
1/12
1/8
1/6
1/4
1/2
Question 10.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Chromosomal crossing over occurs in which of the following stages of cell division?
Prophase of mitosis.
Metaphase of mitosis.
Prophase I of meiosis.
Metaphase II of meiosis.
Telophase I of meiosis.
Question 11. A man whose blood group is Type A has two boys. The plasma of one of the boys
agglutinates the red cells of his father, but the plasma from the other son does not. Which statement
is incorrect?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 12. In peas, the allele for smooth seed coat (S) is dominant to wrinkled (s), Tall plant (T)
is dominant to short (t) and yellow coloured seed (Y) is dominant to green (y).
A plant with the genotype SsTtyy was test crossed and 145 progeny survived to maturity.
Approximately how many of these progeny are expected to be tall plants with green wrinkled seeds?
A.
B.
C.
D.
9
18
36
72
Question 13. B chromosomes are additional chromosomes possessed by some, but not all,
individuals in a population. Which combination of statements is correct?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
I, III and V
I, IV and V
II, III and V
II, IV and V
Question 14. Often the frequency of a particular deleterious allele is very different in
neighbouring populations. For example, the frequency of the allele causing cystic fibrosis is 0.02 in
Population A and 0.006 in Population B. Such a difference in allele frequencies between two close
populations is probably the result of
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 15. The coefficient of relatedness is a theoretical value determined by the number of
alleles that would be the same between two organisms.
The diagram below shows the relationships between some honeybees. What is the coefficient of
relatedness between II-2 and II-3; and between II-2 and III-1?
II
III
ANSWER
A.
0.50
0.50
B.
0.75
0.50
C.
0.75
1.00
D.
0.25
1.00
E.
0.50
0.75
Question 16. Collenchyma and sclerenchyma are plant support tissues. Which combination of the
following statements correctly differentiates these two types of plant tissue?
I.
I, II, III.
II, III, IV
II, IV, V
IV, V
Question 17. The following figure shows the carbon fixation reactions during
photosynthesis in a typical C4 plant :
Vascular bundle
CELL 1
CELL 2
epidermis
Which of the following answers indicate the dominant carbon fixation enzyme in each of the
two cells?
Answer
Cell 1
Cell 2
A.
Malate dehydrogenase
Sucrose synthase
B.
PEP Carboxylase
Rubisco
C.
Rubisco
PEP Carboxylase
D.
Aspartate aminotransferase
Malate dehydrogenase
E.
Malic enzyme
Pyruvate
dehydrogenase
10
Question 18. Suppose that an illuminated suspension of Chlorella (a photosynthetic alga) was
actively carrying out photosynthesis when the light was suddenly switched off. How would the
levels of 3-phosphoglycerate and ribulose 1,5-bisphosphate change during the next minute?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would increase and that of ribulose 1,5bisphosphate would increase.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would increase; the concentration of
ribulose1,5-bisphosphate would decrease.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would decrease; the concentration of ribulose
1,5-bisphosphate would increase.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would decrease; the concentration of ribulose
1,5-bisphosphate would decrease.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would remain the same; the concentration of
ribulose 1,5-bisphosphate would decrease.
Question 19. Which of the following statements shows the difference between the reaction sites of
photosystem I and II?
A.
B.
C
D.
E.
Question 20. You are a biotechnologist designing novel eukaryotic enzymes that are regulated by
phosphorylation. Which amino acid residues shown below would you most likely use at the
regulatory site?
I.
IV.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
III.
II.
I, III
I, IV
I, II, III
II, IV, V
III, IV, V
V.
11
Question 21. A biologist has discovered two new species of micro-organisms. Micro-organism A
was isolated from a hot spring whereas micro-organism B was obtained from a tropical forest. DNA
was isolated from both organisms and an analysis of the melting profile of each DNA sample was
carried out. The melting temperature (Tm) was 80 C for DNA from micro-organism A, and 70 C
for DNA from micro-organism B.
Which statement best describes the reason for this difference in values?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Coenzyme A
Flavin coenzyme
NADH
Vitamin D
Coenzyme A and Vitamin D
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
I
II
III
IV
I, III
Cell I
Cell II
Cell wall
Present
Present
Ribosomes
Present
Present
Nucleus
Absent
Present
Ability to photosynthesize
Present
Absent
Cell respiration
Present
Present
Question 23. From the characteristics presented in the table, which statement is correct?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
plant cell
eubacterium
archaebacterium
animal cell
cyanobacterium
Question 25. Suppose Species B disappears from an ecosystem in which the interrelationship
among the component species can be described by the food web below.
12
13
Question 26. You have been asked by an international organization to initiate a biodiversity
conservation project on a tropical island off the south coast of Java, and far from any large
continental land. For this purpose, you must identify from three islands the island that has the
highest number of species.
The following information is provided:
Island Name
Boa
Ibo
Bio
Size/Area
418 km2
500 km2
420 km2
Question 28. The best description of the relationships between fundamental niches (FN) and
realized niches (RN) of two competing species A and B that coexist is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
14
Question 29. Use the information given in Figures 1 and 2 to answer this question.
Figure 1. An example of a phylogeny showing characters by which taxa are recognised. Characters
1 4 are synapomorphies, 5 12 are autapomorphies and 13 is an attribute seen in the salmon and
the shark.
The tree shown in Figure 1 is the most parsimonious tree possible using these
characters.
The Lamprey and the Lizard are the oldest because they have the longest line.
The four groups shown in Figure 1 are equally related because they are all at the same
horizontal level.
X, Y and Z are characteristics common to all groups.
The Lamprey is more closely related to the Shark than to the Salmon or the Lizard.
15
Question 30. A woman visits her doctor after noticing several changes in her body over a period
of 6 (six) months. She has noticed weight loss, intolerance to temperature variations, irregular
menstrual cycles, insomnia, and general weakness. Based on these symptoms, you would expect
the doctor to test her for:
A.
B.
C.
D.
Diabetes mellitus
Hyperthyroidism
Hypothyroidism
Hypoglycemia
Produce hormones that are only secreted into the digestive tract
Release most hormones into the bloodstream
Release hormones that generally act as rapidly as nerve impulses
Are present only in vertebrates
Question 32. Long corolla length in tobacco is inherited as a recessive monogenic characteristic.
If in a natural population 49% of the plants have a long corolla, what is the probability that the
result of test crossing a randomly selected plant with a short corolla from this population in F1 will
have uniform progeny?
!.
B.
C.
D.
E.
100%
50%
30%
18%
0%
Question 33. From an evolutionary viewpoint, which of the five following individuals is the most fit?
!.
B.
C.
D.
E.
A child who does not become infected with any of the usual childhood diseases, such as
measles or chicken pox.
A woman of 40 with seven adult offspring
A woman of 80 who has one adult offspring
A 100-year old man with no offspring
A childless man who can run a mile in less than five minutes
16
Question 34. A study of a grass population growing in an area of irregular rainfall found that
plants with alleles for curled leaves reproduced better in dry years, whereas plants with alleles for
flat leaves reproduced better in wet years. Curled and flat leaves are controlled by different alleles
at the same gene locus.
This situation tends to
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 35. The cohesion-tension (C-T) theory of sap ascent states that in plants sap is
transported against gravity by bulk flow through the xylem vessels or chains of tracheids. Which of
the following statements correctly describes the main factors affecting this bulk flow?
A.
B.
C.
D.
Hydrogen bonds within the water, hydrogen bonding to the hydrophilic walls of the
xylem cells, and the gradient of solute potential (! s).
The gradient of the pressure potential (! p), and solute concentration
The gradient of water potential (!), hydrogen bonds within the water and solute
concentration.
Hydrogen bonds within the water, hydrogen bonding to the hydrophilic walls of
the xylem cells, and the gradient of pressure potential (! p).
Questions 36-38. Plants maintain most Indole Acetic Acid (IAA) (an auxin) in conjugated
forms, which complicates IAA quantification.
Question 36. These forms can exist in forms such as IAA-amino acid conjugates
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 37. These forms can exist in forms such as IAA-amino acid conjugates. Before analysis
in order to measure total IAA in a particular tissue, these conjugates must be
A.
B.
C.
D.
dehydrated
dehydrogenized
hydrolyzed
synthesized
17
Question 38. Therefore free IAA, thought to be the active form of the hormone, is measured
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 39. You find a mutant bacterium that synthesizes lactose-digesting enzymes whether or
not lactose is present. Which of the following statements or combination of statements might
explain this?
I. The operator has mutated such that it is no longer recognised by the repressor.
II. The gene that codes for the repressor has mutated and the repressor is no longer effective.
III. The gene or genes that code for the lactose-digesting enzymes have mutated.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Only I
Only II
Only I, II
Only I, III
I, II, III
Question 40.
A.
B
C.
D.
E.
Question 42. The transport of glucose into the mammalian red blood cell is accomplished by
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 43. Isopods are one of the few crustacean groups that have successfully invaded
terrestrial habitats. Which of these statements is INCORRECT?
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 45.
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 46. Someone who has suffered damage to the pancreas might
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 47.
A.
B.
C.
D.
The hypothalamus
18
19
Questions 48 - 49. Ten grams of plant material were homogenized in 50 ml buffer and the
homogenate was centrifuged. Protein from 10 ml of the supernatant was precipitated by
addition of ammonium sulphate and the protein precipitated was collected by centrifugation
and re-suspended in 1 ml of buffer. The re-suspended protein was diluted 10 times for protein
determination.
Question 48. The amount of protein in 1 ml of the diluted sample was 0.4 mg. What is the total
amount of protein recovered from 10 ml of the supernatant?
A.
B.
C.
D.
2 mg
4 mg
6 mg
8 mg
Question 49. The amount of protein in 1 ml of the diluted sample was 0.4 mg. What is the amount
of protein extracted from 100 g tissue?
A.
B.
C.
D.
0.2 g
0.4 g
0.6 g
0.8 g
Question 51. Why are some proteinases synthesized as inactive precursors known as zymogens
(proenzymes)?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
20
Question 54. It takes much longer for sex hormones and other steroids to produce their effect that
it takes nonsteroid hormones. Why?
A.
B.
C.
D.
Questions 55 - 57. To test the origin of CO2 available in the soil, two experiments were
conducted on trees in a Pinus forest.
Question 55. In the first experiment, a 20 cm-wide strip of bark around the stem was removed
from trees mid-way between the ground and the lowest branch.
Which of the following statements correctly describes the effect of this treatment on the trees?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Transpiration will cease. As a result, the tree will lose all its needles.
Transport of auxin in the xylem is prevented. This will cause increased auxin
concentration in the roots and root growth will be stimulated.
Phloem transport is prevented causing the roots to become deficient in nitrogen.
Transport of sugars to the roots ceases and the roots will die.
Transport of potassium and calcium from the roots to the needles will cease.
21
Question 56. In the second experiment, the amount of CO2 released from the soil at the base of
trees was measured on several days during the growing period. The bark-removal experiment was
repeated on a total of 9 trees, three trees per teament. In the first treatment, the bark was removed
in early June (white triangles); in the second treatment, the bark was removed in late August (white
squares); the third treament was the control treatment where the bark was not removed (black
circles).
The data from this experiment are shown in the following graph. The black arrows indicate the
time of bark removal.
Which combination of the following statements best describe the results of this experiment?
I.
The variability of the different treatments overlap and any effect of bark removal is due to
chance.
II. The production of CO2 in the soil shows seasonal variation.
III. Bark removal in June had a much smaller effect on the total CO2 production in the soil during
the whole season than bark removal in August.
IV. The decrease in the CO2 production in the soil in the treatments where bark was removed
cannot be explained by seasonal variations alone.
V. The production of CO2 in the soil is always smaller for trees with bark removed than for
undamaged trees.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Only I, II and V
Only I , II and IV
Only II, IV and V
Only II, III and IV
Only I, III and V
22
Question 57. Which of the following statements is a valid conclusion for the results of the second
experiment?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Most CO2 produced in the soil is due to the decomposition of dead roots.
Most CO2 produced in the soil is due to cellular respiration of root cells.
The amount of CO2 produced in the soil is not influenced by photosynthesis.
When most of the roots die, the production of CO2 in the soil is greatest.
The amount of CO2 produced in the soil depends on the soil temperature.
Question 58. From the following, choose the combination in which the floral diagram is
associated with the correct family.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
A = Brassicaceae
B = Fabaceae
C = Liliaceae
D = Malvaceae
E = Rosaceae
Question 59.
23
In which floral diagram do the all the floral characteristics listed below occur?
B
C
D
E
F
Question 60. Students made cross-sections of leaves collected from two different oak trees.
When they examined the sections under a microscope, they were surprised to see that the leaves
were different.
The following diagrams show cross-sections of leaves from Oak tree 1 and Oak tree 2.
Which of the following statements best explains the difference in leaf structure that the students
observed?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Oak tree 1 grows in a swampy area; Oak tree 2 grows in sandy soil.
Oak tree 1 is a young tree; Oak tree 2 is a mature tree.
Oak tree 1 grows in fertile soil; Oak tree 2 grows in poor soil.
Oak tree 1 is exposed to sun for most of the day; Oak tree 2 grows in a shaded
area.
Oak tree 1 is infected by fungi, which induced the cell proliferation; Oak tree 2 was not
infected.
24
Question 61. Cloning of a new DNA fragment into a circular plasmid/vector always requires:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Cholesterol mixes with phospholipids in a cell membrane because cholesterol molecules are:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
amphipathic
steroid derivatives
entirely hydrophobic
phospholipids derivatives
bound with glycoproteins
Question 63. Which of the following molecules can diffuse through the mammalian phospholipid
bilayer without using a channel/transporter?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
O2
glucose
steroid hormones
K+
amino acids
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
I, III
I, IV
II, III, V
II, III, IV, V
All of the above.
25
Question 64. What is the net charge of aspartic acid when the pH of the solution in which it is
prepared is the same as its pI value? Note the three pKa values of aspartic acid are as follows:
-COOH pKa = 2.1; -NH3+ pKa = 9.8; R group pKa = 3.9
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 65. A quantitative amino acid analysis reveals that bovine serum albumin (BSA)
contains 0.58% tryptophan residues by weight. The molecular mass of the tryptophan molecules is
204 daltons. The molecular mass of bovine serum albumin is known to be approximately 66000
daltons. What number of tryptophan residues is present in each BSA molecule?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
2
3
4
5
6
Question 66. What essential function does gastrulation perform for the developing embryo?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 67. Which of the following is not true about the lymphatic system?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
26
Question 68. The most direct consequence on amphibian development upon removal of the grey
crescent would be:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
- THE END -
Animal
Biology
Raw
%
scores
Plant Biology
Theoretical Exams
Biochemistry
Genetics
Exam 1
Exam 2
Raw
scores
Raw
scores
Raw
scores
Raw
scores
Raw
scores
Maximum
possible
63
100
77
100
44
100
43
100
99
100
53.5
100
Maximum
62.6
99.4
74.0
96.1
44.0
100.0
39.0
90.8
92.5
93.4
50.5
94.4
Minimum
18.3
29.0
17.5
22.7
12.0
27.3
7.0
16.3
34.6
35.0
14.0
26.2
Mean
49.2
78.2
59.3
77.1
36.7
84.1
22.8
53.2
69.9
70.6
38.2
71.3
8.7
13.8
9.9
12.8
6.7
15.1
5.7
12.9
11.2
11.3
7.2
13.5
Standard
deviation
CV (%)
17.6
MEAN SCORE
DISCRIMINATING INDEX
16.6
18.0
73.1%
19.1
24.2
15.9
18.9
71.0%
17.4
Recommended
distribution (%)
No. of
questions
%
distribution
Over/
under
Mark
value of
questions
%
distribution
Over/
under
Cell Biology
20
30
24
+4%
42.5
23
+3%
15
19
15
37.5
20
+5%
25
34
27
+2%
39.5
21
-4%
Ethology
-3%
-2%
Genetics and
Evolution
20
24
20
42.5
23
+3%
Ecology
10
-4%
11.5
-4%
Biosystematics
+2%
Plant Anatomy
and
Physiology
Animal
Anatomy and
Physiology
Recommended
distribution (%)
No. of
questions
%
distribution
Over/
under
Mark
value of
questions
%
distribution
Over/
under
Cell Biology
20
26
25
+5%
35.0
23
+3%
15
18
18
+3%
31.5
21
+6%
25
25
25
31.5
21
-4%
Ethology
-4%
4.0
-2%
Genetics and
Evolution
20
21
21
+1%
36.0
24
+4%
Ecology
10
-6%
7.0
-5%
Biosystematics
+2%
7.5
Plant Anatomy
and
Physiology
Animal
Anatomy and
Physiology
Question
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
Mean
SD
Point
Difficulty
Serial
Discrimination
index
correlation
Index*
(p-score)
(Rit)
% Correct response
Upper 27%
Lower 27%
0.59
0.65
0.66
0.87
0.70
0.92
Skipped
0.47
0.39
Skipped
Skipped
0.40
0.53
0.87
Skipped
0.63
0.59
0.20
Skipped
0.64
0.74
0.74
0.50
0.75
0.89
0.48
0.47
0.63
0.68
0.72
0.81
0.38
0.48
0.41
0.25
0.43
0.28
0.481
0.615
0.442
0.192
0.481
0.154
44
48
46
51
47
51
19
16
23
41
22
43
0.15
0.49
0.212
0.558
28
36
17
7
0.28
0.41
0.31
0.327
0.481
0.212
28
42
51
11
17
40
0.18
0.24
0.23
0.231
0.212
0.231
36
38
20
24
27
8
0.25
0.39
0.34
0.32
0.44
0.40
0.49
0.55
0.34
0.39
0.38
0.33
0.288
0.365
0.442
0.327
0.423
0.269
0.615
0.808
0.385
0.404
0.365
0.288
41
48
51
34
45
52
44
47
42
46
48
52
26
29
28
17
23
38
12
5
22
25
29
37
0.64
0.17
0.35
0.10
0.38
0.16
* A measure of the effectiveness of the question in discriminating between high and low scorers.
Question
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
Point
Difficulty
Serial
Discrimination
index
correlation
Index*
(p-score)
(Rit)
Skipped
0.37
0.79
0.67
0.71
0.80
Skipped
0.98
0.30
0.95
0.65
0.86
Skipped
0.55
0.37
0.63
0.71
0.39
0.84
0.76
0.89
Skipped
0.96
0.46
0.78
Skipped
0.55
Skipped
Skipped
0.56
0.96
0.64
0.87
0.65
0.60
Skipped
0.88
0.32
0.86
0.84
0.81
0.80
0.73
Skipped
% Correct response
Upper 27% Lower 27%
0.43
0.40
0.25
0.25
0.47
0.46
0.37
0.23
0.29
0.44
32
50
38
46
52
8
31
26
31
29
0.24
0.40
0.23
0.39
0.29
0.06
0.44
0.12
0.48
0.21
52
30
52
48
49
49
7
46
23
38
0.20
0.19
0.20
0.33
0.33
0.31
0.44
0.18
0.29
0.29
0.23
0.37
0.46
0.31
0.46
0.15
35
28
41
46
35
50
51
50
20
13
29
27
11
34
27
42
0.30
0.34
0.21
0.12
0.44
0.21
52
36
50
46
13
39
0.45
0.56
41
12
0.18
0.28
0.42
0.31
0.28
0.24
0.23
0.08
0.50
0.29
0.29
0.33
33
52
45
52
42
40
21
48
19
37
27
23
0.33
0.27
0.52
0.36
0.37
0.33
0.36
0.23
0.27
0.44
0.23
0.35
0.33
0.42
49
23
52
47
50
51
47
37
9
29
35
32
34
25
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
Mean
SD
Skipped
0.75
0.82
Skipped
0.68
0.76
0.91
Skipped
0.91
Skipped
0.87
0.79
0.82
Skipped
0.68
0.72
0.06
0.49
0.68
0.68
0.87
0.82
0.88
0.63
0.72
0.19
0.34
0.29
43
48
27
30
0.51
0.38
0.56
0.31
0.35
0.00
0.62
0.40
0.31
48
50
52
16
29
36
0.46
0.27
52
38
0.44
0.44
0.31
0.29
0.35
0.25
51
47
47
36
29
34
0.34
0.37
0.23
0.35
0.36
0.36
0.30
0.20
0.39
0.25
0.42
0.44
0.13
0.46
0.42
0.42
0.19
0.25
0.27
0.29
46
48
7
37
46
46
52
49
51
41
24
25
0
13
24
24
42
36
37
26
0.33
0.10
0.31
0.14
* A measure of the effectiveness of the question in discriminating between high and low scorers.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
THEORY EXAMINATION # 1
Total marks possible: 99.0
STUDENT CODE
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Check that you have the correct examination paper and an answer sheet.
WHEN YOU HAVE FINISHED THE EXAM, PLACE YOUR ANSWER SHEET INSIDE
YOUR QUESTION PAPER AND HAND BOTH TO THE INVIGILATOR BEFORE
LEAVING THE EXAM ROOM.
REMEMBER TO WRITE YOUR 4-DIGIT STUDENT CODE ON THE FRONT PAGE OF
THE QUESTION PAPER.
Read each question carefully before attempting it.
! If you want to change your answer, use the eraser to remove your incorrect response and
fill in the new circle you require.
! There is only one correct answer to each question.
! Questions 1 - 30 are worth one mark each The mark value for questions 31 60 varies
according to the length and difficulty of the question.
! Marks will not be deducted for incorrect answers.
Question 2. A blood smear of a human shows higher than normal numbers of eosinophils. Which
of the following may be occurring in his body?
ibo! 7/18/07 8:20 PM
Deleted:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 3. The ABO blood type of humans can be determined by a coagulation reaction with
anti-A and anti-B antibodies.
Positive coagulation
Negative Coagulation
With anti-A
antibodies
With anti-B
antibodies
None
Question 4. The graph below shows the result of blood glucose test from a diabetes patient.
When tested 3 hours after having a carbohydrate rich meal, the blood glucose level of this patient
was 3 times higher than that of a normal individual. However, there was no difference in the level
of insulin in the blood between the two individuals.
Which of the following could be the reason for diabetic symptoms in this patient?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 5. The following graph shows the dissociation curves for hemoglobin and myoglobin.
Based on the data presented in the graph, which of the following statements is true?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Questions 6 - 8. This figure indicates some of the pathways involved in the metabolism of
food.
Question 6. When a person consumes a diet rich in carbohydrate, the reactions up-regulated will be:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 7.
be:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 8.
are:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
5, 6, 7
2, 8
5, 8
1, 3, 4
2, 5. 6
When a person performs heavy exercise, the reactions that will be down-regulated will
5, 6, 7, 8
1, 3, 4
4, 5, 6, 7
1, 2, 4
7, 3, 4
If a person suffers from carnitine deficiency, the reactions that will be down-regulated
6, 8 only
1, 3, 4
4, 5, 6, 7
2, 5, 6
5, 6, 7, 8
Question 9. A yeast extract contains all the enzymes required for alcohol production. The extract
is incubated under anaerobic conditions in 1 liter of medium containing: 200 mM glucose, 20 mM
ADP, 40 mM ATP, 2 mM NADH, 2 mM NAD+ and 20 mM Pi (inorganic phosphates). Ethanol
What is the maximum amount of ethanol that can be produced under these conditions?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
2 mM
20 mM
40 mM
200 mM
400 mM
Question 10. Thyroid hormone release is due to the action of thyroid-stimulating hormone (TSH)
released by the pituitary gland. Release of TSH is governed by the TSH-releasing hormone (TRH)
which is synthesized in the hypothalamus and released into the pituitary gland.
The graph below shows the concentration of TSH in human blood during the three hours following
an injection of TRH in two groups of people, A and B. One group was treated with thyroxine in the
days prior to the experiment. Consider endocrine feed-back regulation when answering the
following question.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
I and II
II and III
III and IV
I and IV
I and III
Question 11. Typical intracellular concentrations of the Na+, K+ and Ca2+ ions are 15 mM, 120
mM and 100 nM, respectively. In the cell we are interested in the usual Na+, K+ leak channels that
are present as well as the Na+/K+ pump (ATPase). Extracellularly, the concentrations of Na+, K+
and Ca2+ are 140 mM, 4 mM and 2 mM, respectively. Which of the following would happen if the
extracellular K+ concentration were to be increased to 10 mM?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
I
I, II, III
III
III, IV, V
IV, V
Question 12. Thermogenesis is a process where heat is generated. The energy present in the reducing
equivalents such as NADH + H+ or FADH2 in mitochondria is normally used to pump protons across the
inner mitochondrial membrane to the intermembranous space. This proton gradient is the motive force for
ATP production. Examine the figures below and consider whether ATP synthesis or thermogenesis
predominates when answering the following question.
The molecules represented by I, II, III and IV represent mitochondrial electron carriers.
10
In which of the three situations shown in the figure above does thermogenesis predominate over
ATP synthesis?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
only I
only II
only III
I and II
I and III
Question 13. The figure below outlines the glycolytic pathway. There are several regulatory steps
in glycolysis. A major regulatory step in glycolysis is the conversion of fructose 6-phosphate to
fructose 1,6-biphosphate by phosphofructose kinase. This enzyme is allosterically inhibited by
ATP and allosterically activated by AMP. Thus, cellular ATP:AMP ratios are important in the
regulation of phosphofructose kinase. In addition, low pH inhibits phosphofructose kinase activity.
11
What effect will poisoning of mitochondrial function by the mitochondrial uncoupler dinitrophenol
(DNP) have on glycolysis?
A. It will increase the rate of glycolysis if there is a means of oxidizing NADH.
B. It will result in the immediate death of the cell.
C. It will increase the rate of glycolysis if there is a means of further increasing the
reduction of NAD+.
D. It will inhibit the conversion of phosphoenol pyruvate to pyruvic acid.
E. It will promote the formation of 1,3 biphosphoglycerate from 3-phosphoglycerate.
Question 14. Lions (Panthera leo) live in stable social groups called prides which usually have
three or more adult females, their dependent offspring and one or two dominant adult males. The
old and weak male(s) in a pride may be driven away by other strong males or by a new coalition of
males.
Which combination of the following statements is correct.?
I. Females born into a pride leave before they reproductive maturity.
II. Males born into a pride remain there for life.
III. Females born into a pride remain there for life.
IV. New dominant male try to kill only newly born females.
V. Males born into a pride leave before they reach reproductive activity.
VI. New dominant male try to kill only newly born males.
VII. Adult females in a lion pride are never related to each other.
VIII. New dominant male try to kill as many young cubs as possible.
IX. Adult females in a lion pride are often related each other.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 15. The correct statement pertaining to the following Rank-Abundance Curve is:
Community A
Community B
12
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 16. Stromatolites, layered mounds created by cyanobacteria, have been found in shallow
waters. They resemble small rocks but are organic in origin. Fossilised stromatolites are thought to
be important because they are suggestive of:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Questions 17 18. A student studied the influence of temperature and light intensity upon CO2
flux of plants in a greenhouse. During the experiment cellular respiration is not influenced by light
intensity and cellular respiration of glucose is completely aerobic. At each temperature CO2 uptake
was measured during light exposure and loss of CO2 was measured during the dark period. The
light intensity was constant during the light period and was not a limiting factor for photosynthesis.
The data collected are presented in the following table.
Temp (C)
Loss of CO2 in
dark*
5
0.5
10
0.7
15
1.2
20
1.9
25
2.3
30
2.0
35
1.5
* units: mg per gram dried weight per hour
0.2
0.5
0.9
1.5
2.6
3.9
3.3
Question 17. At which temperatures does the plant release O2 when exposed to light?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
13
Question 18. The optimum temperature for photosynthesis and the optimum temperature of respiration
is somewhere in the range of 5 - 35 C. Which of the following statements is correct?
A. optimum temp for photosynthesis < optimum temp for dissimilation
B. optimum temp for photosynthesis = optimum temp for dissimilation
C. optimum temp for photosynthesis > optimum temp for dissimilation
Question 19. A woman with Turner syndrome is found to be haemophilic (X linked recessive
phenotype). Both her mother and her father have normal blood coagulation.
Which of the statements below gives what you consider to be the best answer to each of following
questions?
I.
How can the simultaneous origin of Turner syndrome and haemophilia by abnormal
chromosome behavior during meiosis be explained?
II. Did the abnormal chromosome behavior occur in the mother or the father?
III. During which division of meiosis did the abnormal chromosome behavior occur?
A.
The father of the woman with Turner syndrome (XXX) must have been a
carrier for haemophilia, an X-linked recessive disorder. Nondisjunction occurred in her
mother. An egg lacking a sex chromosome was fertilized with a sperm with X
chromosome carrying the haemophilic allele. The nondisjunctive event could have
occurred only during first meiotic division.
B.
One of the parents of the woman with Turner syndrome (X0) must have been a
carrier for haemophilia, an X-linked recessive disorder. Because her father has
normal blood coagulation, she could not have obtained her only X chromosome
from him. Therefore nondisjunction occurred in her father. A sperm lacking a
sex chromosome fertilized an egg with X chromosome carrying the haemophilic
allele. The nondisjunctive event could have occurred during either meiotic
division.
C.
One of the parents of the woman with Turner syndrome (XXY) is a carrier for
haemophilia, an X-linked recessive disorder. Because her mother has normal blood
coagulation, she could not have obtained her X choromosome from her mother.
Therefore, nondisjunction occurred in her mother. A sperm with a sex chromosome
carrying the haemophilic allele fertilized an egg with XX chromosome. The
nondisjunctive event could have occurred during second meiotic division.
D.
One of the parents of the woman with Turner syndrome is a carrier for haemophilia, an
X-linked recessive disorder. Because her father has normal blood coagulation, she has
obtained her only X choromosome from her mother. A nondisjunction occurred in her
father during either meiotic division. A sperm lacking a sex chromosome fertilized an
egg with X chromosome carrying the haemophilic allele.
14
Questions 20 21. A rare human disease afflicted a family as shown in the following pedigree.
Question 20. What is the most likely mode of inheritance of this disease?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 21. What is the probability that the first child of the marriage between cousins, 1 x 4, is
a boy with the disease?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
1/2
1/4
1/8
1/16
0
Questions 22 - 23. The wild-type flower color of harebell plants (genus Campanula) is blue.
Using radiation, three mutants with white petals were produced, white 1, white 2 and white 3. They
all look the same, so it was not known whether they were genetically identical. The mutant strains
are available as homozygous pure-breeding lines.
15
The mutant strains were crossed with the wild-type blue genotype and with each other to produce
the following results:
Parental cross
F1 phenotype
F2 segregation ratio
White 1 x blue
all blue
White 2 x blue
all blue
White 3 x blue
all blue
White 1 x white 2
all white
no data available
White 1 x white 3
all blue
no data available
White 2 x white 3
all blue
no data available
Question 22. Using these results, determine which statement is the correct conclusion for this
study.
A.
B.
C.
D.
The mutant genes in white 1 and 3 are allelic and are different to the mutant gene in
white 2.
The mutant genes in white 2 and 3 are allelic and are different to the mutant gene in
white 1.
The mutant genes in white 1 and 2 are allelic and are different to the mutant gene
in white 3.
The mutant genes in white 1, 2 and 3 are all allelic.
Question 23. The type of gene action operating among the crosses between the mutants in this
study is
A.
B.
C.
D.
complete dominance.
dominant epistasis.
recessive (complementary) epistasis
duplicate gene interaction.
16
# the fourth peptide products of normal "-globin were (amino acid residues are abbreviated by
the following letters: V=valine, H= histidine, L= leucine, T= threonine, P= proline, E= glutamic
acid and K= lysine):
VH
VHL
VHLT
TPE
TPEEK
EK
# the fourth peptide products of "-globin of sickle cell anemia were
VH
VHL
VHLT
TPV
TPVEK
EK
Question 24. From these results, how many amino acids is the fourth peptide composed of and
what was the substituted position of amino acid residue counting from the N-terminus?
From the following, choose the one statement which is most appropriate. Assume that this fourth
peptide contains only one molecule of T (threonine).
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
It was composed of 8 amino acids and the 6th amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 8 amino acids and the 3rd amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 7 amino acids and the 6th amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 7 amino acids and the 3rd amino acid was substituted.
It was composed of 9 amino acids and the 6th amino acid was substituted.
Question 25. Below is a DNA sequence coding a part of the amino acid sequence in the fourth
peptide of normal "-globin. In sickle cell anemia, it is known that a mutation occurs in the region
enclosed by
.
From the following, choose one that is an appropriate DNA sequence of the mutation.
Normal! TGAGGACTCCTCTTCAGA
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
TGAGGACCCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGACTACCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGACACCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGACCTCTTCAGA
TGAGGAACTCCTCTTCAGA
17
Question 26 - 28. The diagram below represents a nephron from an adult human.
3
4
Question 26. At which of the numbered points would the filtrate be hypertonic to the blood?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
1 and 3 only
1, 2 and 3
2 and 3 only
4 only
3 and 4
Question 27. At which of the numbered points is sodium reabsorbed from the filtrate?
A.
1 only
B.
1 and 2 only
C.
1, 2 and 3
D.
1, 2 and 4
E.
4 only
18
Question 28. The open arrow shows the direction of blood flow into the Glomerulus. What
happens if the diameter of the blood vessel is constricted at point X?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 29. A and B are two 70 Kg individuals with same body water volume. Both of them had
a snack that had a high salt content, and B also drank a glass of an alcoholic drink . Based on this
information, which one of following statements is true?
A.
B.
C.
D
E.
Question 30. Which of the following RNA sequences would hybridize most effectively with the
DNA sequence 5 - ATA CTT ACT CAT TTT 3?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 31. What does a small standard deviation indicate about data obtained from an
experiment?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E
19
IMPORTANT
20
Question 32. For blood under each of the conditions described below, select the letter of the oxyhemoglobin dissociation curve with which it is most likely to be associated. (3 marks)
Oxygen
saturation
(%)
1.
2.
3.
Anaemic blood
Foetal blood
5.
Blood exposed to CO
6.
7.
8.
E
A
A
C
A
21
Question 33. The following graph shows the concentration of thyroid-stimulating hormone (TSH)
in human blood during the 3 hours following an injection of TSH-releasing hormone (TRH) in two
groups of people (A and B). One group was treated with thyroxine daily for a week prior to the
experiment. (2 marks)
B
A
STATEMENT
a. Thyroxine treatment stimulated TSH release in Group A
b. Group A has been treated with thyroxine daily before treatment
with TRH
c. Group B has been treated with thyroxine daily before treatment
with TRH
d. Thyroxine treatment inhibited TSH release in Group B
22
Question 34. Digestion of food is facilitated by enzymes and hormones secreted at various regions
of the gastro-intestinal tract. Select the organs (identified by different letters) from the diagram
below that secretes the following enzymes and hormones: (4 marks)
B
C
D
I.
Amylase
_____A, C____
II.
Lipase
_____C, D____
III. Chymotrypsin
_____C_______
IV. Insulin
_____C_______
V.
_____D_______
Cholecystokinin (CCK)
VI. Aminopeptidase
_____D_______
VII. Gastrin
_____B_______
VIII.Carboxypeptidase
______C______
23
Questions 35 37. A 21 year-old student gets into a car accident and experiences brain trauma.
Use the figure below to answer the following questions.. Use the appropriate number to refer to the
region of the brain affected.
Question 35. The patient experiences lack of co-ordination and problems in balance. What
part of the brain is most likely damaged? (0.5 mark)
ANSWER:
Question 36. The patient slurs her speech and is unable to clearly read even simple passages
from a book. What part of the brain is most likely damaged? (0.5 mark)
ANSWER:
Question 37. The patient experiences double vision and images are blurry. What part of the
brain is most likely damaged? (0.5 mark)
ANSWER:
24
Question 38. To study hierarchial reaction in crickets (Gryllus campestris), five crickets, A, B, C,
D and E, were marked with colours and placed two by two in an experimental field. Observations
were made on their aggressive behaviour and the results are shown below:
Partner
B
Won
fights
6
Lost
fights
0
Won
fights
0
Lost
fights
6
Won
fights
9
Lost
fights
2
Partner
Won
fights
0
Lost
fights
7
Won
fights
6
Lost
fights
2
Partner
Partner
Partner
Indicate if the following statements are correct by writing the appropriate answer code in the
answer column of the following table. (3 marks)
Answer code :
1 = CORRECT
2 = INCORRECT
25
Statement
Answer
c. The hierarchy is linear: with the following order: C " E" A " B " D
d. Some crickets won fights against crickets that were higher in the
hierarchical order.
1
1
Question 39. According to the usual classification, birds are classified as vertebrates with feathers
and reptiles as epidermal scale vertebrates. A different phylogenetic classification has been
proposed and includes birds and crocodiles in the Archosaurian group.
Below are the two types of classification:
Usual classification
Phylogenetic classification
26
Eagle
covering feet
present
present
present
Ostrich
covering feet
present
present
present
present
present
none
none
none
none
Lizard
none
none
none
Frog
none
none
none
none
Indicate if the following statements are correct by writing the appropriate answer code in the
answer column of the table. (2 marks)
Answer code :
No
h.
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
g.
1 = CORRECT
2 = INCORRECT
Statement
Answer
a. Birds and reptiles both have scales. Therefore, we can assume that
they share a common ancestor which is not a common ancestor of the
frog.
b. The eagle, ostrich and crocodile are homologous for the preorbital
fenestra feature
c. Possession of feathers is an ancestral characteristic, whereas the
possession of scales is a more recent modification.
d. Since crocodiles are more closely related to birds than to lizards, scales
are not a relevant characteristic to be used in this type of classification.
1
1
2
27
Question 40. Four tree communities were identified at four different locations to the north, south,
west and east of Ottawa, Canada. The communities are represented below, with each different tree
figure symbolizing a different species. (6 marks)
NORTH Community
SOUTH Community
WEST Community
No
a.
Community attribute
Highest species richness
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
g.
h.
EAST Community
A. North
ANSWER
B. South
C. West
D. East
!
!
!
!
!
!
28
Question 41. A survivorship curve depicts the age-specific mortality through survivorship.
Indicate whether the following statements about the survivorship are true. The graphs shown below
indicate different types of survivorship curves.
Graph I represents organisms that provide good care of their offspring, such as humans
and many other large mammals.
TRUE
FALSE
B. Graph II is typical of survivorship curves for organisms such as many fishes and marine
invertebrates
TRUE
FALSE
C. Graph II is characteristics of the adult stages of birds after a period of high juvenile
mortality.
TRUE
FALSE
D. Birds may have a Graph III-type survivorship curve with a brief period of high mortality
among the youngest individuals, followed by increasing periods of lower mortality.
TRUE
FALSE
FALSE
29
To match the structures and processes involved in this lifecycle, match each number from the
diagram of the lifecycle with the letter of the proper term in the list below and write that letter in the
appropriate box. (3.5 marks)
Diagram
number
Term
from list
Diagram
number
Term
from list
Diagram
number
13
14
3
4
9
10
5
6
11
12
List of Terms
a. megasporangium produces eggs by meiosis
b. fertilization
c. zygote
d. embryo
e. diploid portion of life cycle
f. seedling
g. pollen cone, producing pollen
Term
from list
h. seed coat
i. mature sporophyte
j. integument
k. haploid portion of life cycle
l. megaspore mother cell
m. ovulate cone, bearing ovules
n. microsporangium produces pollen by
meiosis
30
Queston 43. The diagram below represents the stages in the mobilization of starch reserves in a
barley grain.
Water
I
III
IV
II
Starch
hhh
Water
Match the appropriate term with the correct Roman numeral from the diagram above. (Note: not all
terms have answers.) (3 marks)
TERM FROM
DIAGRAM
ANSWER
Alpha-amylase
III
Aleurone layer
Auxn
Gibberellic acid
II
Sugar
IV
Proten
Question 44. The structures in List B develop from the structures shown in List A. Match each
structure in List A with the appropriate structures in List B. Enter your answers in the table below.
(2.5 marks)
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
List A
Microspore
Microsporophyll
Megaspore
Megasporangium
Megasporophyll
List B
1. Pollen sac
2. Primary cell of Embryo sac
3. Carpel
4. Nucellus
5. Pollen grain
31
LIST A
LIST B
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
Question 45. Plants obtain various mineral nutrients from the soil. These nutrients have different
physiological roles in plants.
Match the elements/compounds from the left column with their functions in plants in the right
column. Write your answers in the answer table below. (5 marks)
1. Calcium
2. Nitrogen
3. Nitrate
4. Iodine
5. Phosphate
6. Magnesium
7. Potassium
8. Sulfate
9. Manganese
10. Iron
Answer Table
1.
2.
F
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
32
Questions 46 - 48. The ways different substances can be transported through the biological
membrane is shown in Figure 1.
Exterior
Y
out.
in.
Dout.
out.
in.
out.
in.
Eout.
Fout.
Oout.
Mout.
Din.
P
Ein.
Fin.
P
Oin.
Min.
Interior
Question 46. Match the name of the transport systems to the letter(s) in Figure 1 (4 marks)
Transport mechanism
1. Conjugated active transport
Answer
M, O
3. Exocytosis
5. Phagocytosis/pinocytosis;
8. Co-transport
D, E
33
Question 47. Indicate which letters in Figure 1 correspond to each transport system. (4 marks)
Answer
9.
10.
11.
Passive transport
12.
Active transport
Question 48. Identify from Figure 1 the correct example for each transport type. (4 marks)
Answer
13.
Na+, K+-$%Pase
14.
Low-density lipoproteins
15.
water, urea
16.
17.
glucose, aminoacids
18.
19.
20.
Hormonal secretion
M, O
D, E
34
Question 49. The total respiration (R) of a young growing plant can be described by the following
expression:
Total R = Maintenance R + Growth R
Some of the processes that occur during growth of this plant are:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Certain of these processes require energy, some supply energy to the plant and others are not
involved in energy use or supply. Indicate which processes require or supply energy by writing a +
(plus sign) and which processes have no energy involvement by writing a ' (minus sign) in the
correct places in the following table. (3.5 marks)
Process
number
35
Question 50. The following diagram shows an ovule just prior to double fertilization.
Identify each of the structures indicated by an arrow and label it on the diagram with the
appropriate letter code from the table below. (4 marks)
A
F
G
D
STRUCTURE
LETTER CODE
Antipodal cell
Egg cell
Integument
Polar nuclei
Pollen tube
Synergid cell
36
Question 51. A family consists of three children, David, Edna and Sophie and their parents
Alison and Alfred. One of the children is blood group A and is also red green colour blind . Edna is
blood group B and Sophie is blood group O. Of the children only David has blue eyes. Neither
parent is colour blind, but only Alfred has blue eyes and is blood group B.
Choose a possible genotype for each family member and write the appropriate capital letter for that
genotype against the name. (2.5 marks)
A = XC Xc AO Bb
B = XC Y AO bb
C = XC Xc BO Bb
D = XC Xc AO Bb
E = XC Y AO Bb
F = XC Xc OO Bb
G = XC Y BO bb
H = Xc Y AO bb
Family member
Genotype
David
Edna
Sophie
Alison
Alfred
Question 52. In Canada, 7,0 % of the male population is colorblind. This is a sex linked recessive
feature located on the X-chromosome. (1 mark)
What percentage of the female population, not being colorblind, is a carrier of alleles responsible
for colorblindness?
Answer: 13 %
37
Questions 53 - 54. The fox operon, which has sequences A, B, C, and D, encodes enzymes 1
and 2. Mutations in sequences A, B, C, and D have the following effects, where a plus sign (+) =
enzyme synthesized and a minus sign (-) = enzyme not synthesized. Fox is the regulator of fox
operon.
Mutation
sequence
No mutation
A
B
C
D
in
Fox absent
Enzyme 1
Enzyme 2
Fox present
Enzyme 1
Enzyme 2
+
+
+
+
+
+
Question 53. Is the fox operon inducible or repressible? Indicate your answer by writing X in the
appropriate place in the table below. (1 mark)
Inducible
Repressible
Question 54. Which sequence (A, B, C, or D) is part of the following components of the operon?
Match the correct letter against the component in the table below. (2 marks)
Component of operon
Answer
Regulator gene
Promoter
38
Question 55. The following is a list of mutational changes. For each of the specific mutations
described, indicate which of the following terms could apply, either as a description of the mutation
or as a possible cause. More than one term from the right column can apply to each statement in the
left column. (6 marks)
Write your answers in the answer table below.
Code
Description of mutation
Code
1.
2.
3.
Term
a.
transition
b.
base
substitution
c.
transversion
4.
d.
inversion
5.
e.
translocation
6.
f.
7.
8.
9.
deletion
g.
insertion
h.
deamination
i.
X-ray
irradiation
j.
intercalator
k.
unequal
crossingover
Answer table
1
a. b
b, c
39
Question 56. The wild type tryptophan synthetase enzyme of E. coli contains a glycine (Gly) at
position 38. Two trp mutants A23 and A46 have been isolated which have arginine (Arg) instead of
glycine at position 38 (A23) and glutamate (Glu) at position 38 (A46). Both mutants were plated on
minimal medium and from A23 four spontaneous revertants to prototrophy (i.e. are able to grow
without supplements) were obtained and from A46 three spontaneous revertants to prototrophy were
obtained. The tryptophan synthetase from each of the seven revertants were isolated and the amino
acids at position 38 were identified.
mutant
revertant
A23
1
2
3
4
isoleucine (Ile)
threonine (Thr)
serine (Ser)
glycine (Gly)
A46
1
2
3
glycine (Gly)
alanine (Ala)
valine (Val)
A summary of these data is given below. Using the genetic code table provided on the next page,
deduce the codons for the wild type, mutants A23 and A46 and for the revertants and place each
designation in the box provided. (5 marks)
wild type
Gly
GGA
A23 mutant
A46 mutant
Arg
Glu
AGA
GAA
revertants
Gly
Ile
AUA
Thr
ACA
Ser
AGC/AGU
Gly
GGA
GGA
Ala
Val
GCA
GUA
40
This table shows the 64 codons and the amino acid each codon codes for. The direction is 5' to 3'.
2nd base
U
UAU (Tyr/Y)Tyrosine
UGU (Cys/C)Cysteine
U UUA (Leu/L)Leucine
UAC (Tyr/Y)Tyrosine
UGC (Cys/C)Cysteine
UCA (Ser/S)Serine
UUG (Leu/L)Leucine
UCG (Ser/S)Serine
UGG (Trp/W)Tryptophan
CUU (Leu/L)Leucine
CCU (Pro/P)Proline
CAU (His/H)Histidine
CGU (Arg/R)Arginine
CUC (Leu/L)Leucine
CCC (Pro/P)Proline
CAC (His/H)Histidine
CGC (Arg/R)Arginine
CUA (Leu/L)Leucine
CCA (Pro/P)Proline
CAA (Gln/Q)Glutamine
CGA (Arg/R)Arginine
CUG (Leu/L)Leucine
CCG (Pro/P)Proline
CAG (Gln/Q)Glutamine
CGG (Arg/R)Arginine
AUU (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGU (Ser/S)Serine
AUC (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGC (Ser/S)Serine
AUA (Ile/I)Isoleucine
AGA (Arg/R)Arginine
AUG (Met/M)Methionine
AGG (Arg/R)Arginine
GUU (Val/V)Valine
GCU (Ala/A)Alanine
GUC (Val/V)Valine
GCC (Ala/A)Alanine
GCA (Ala/A)Alanine
GCG (Ala/A)Alanine
C
1st
base
G GUA (Val/V)Valine
GUG (Val/V)Valine
41
Question 57. In a paternity suit the ABO phenotypes of the mother, the child and the two possible
fathers (F1 and F2) were determined, and a DNA profile was made for each person.
Both the mother (M) and the child (C) are type A, Rh-negative. Father F1 is type B, Rh-negative
and Father F2 is type O, Rh-negative. The DNA profiles are shown below.
42
Question 58. DNA repair" mechanisms can be divided into 3 categories (listed below). A list of
repairing processes is also given.
Match each DNA repair mechanisms with the names of the repairing processes. (4.5 marks)
Answer table
DNA repair mechanism
1. Damage reversal
2. Damage removal
3. Damage tolerance
43
Question 59. The pBR322 plasmid was cut with two different restriction enzymes. The patterns of
ethidium bromide staining of plasmid DNA after electrophoresis on agarose gels are shown.
P
+ HindIII
+BsuI
P
+BsuI + HindIII
a
b
c
d
f
g
h
Reference:
P: plasmid
( ..T ) The pBR322 has only one restriction site for HindIII.
(....T....) The migration rate of a DNA molecule in an agarose gel is inversely proportional to
its size.
(....F.....) The bands in lane 4 indicate that both enzymes have the same restriction site.
44
Question 60. Information on the description and appearance of various chromosomal structural
arrangements is given below.
1. Tandom duplication
2. Reciprocal translocation
3. Interstitial deletion
4. Pericentric inversion
5. Displaced duplication
6. Interstitial translocation
7. Terminal deletion
8. Reverse duplication
9. Paracentric inversion
original order.
H. Movement of a segment of chromosome from one to another
in one way.
K. Chromosomal segment is represented twice but it is not
adjacent to original segment
45
In the following table and using the appropriate letters and Roman numerals, match the correct
definition and appearance to the type of chromosomal change listed. (4.5 marks)
Definition
1. Tandem duplication
2. Reciprocal translocation
3. Interstitial deletion
4. Pericentric inversion
5. Displaced duplication
6. Interstitial translocation
7. Terminal deletion
8. Reverse duplication
9. Paracentric inversion
- THE END -
Appearance
THEORY EXAMINATION # 2
Total marks possible: 53.5
STUDENT CODE
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Check that you have the correct examination paper and an answer sheet.
IMPORTANT
! Use the answer sheet provided to record your answers.
! Ensure that your name and student code is PRINTED in the top margin of the front
page of the answer sheet. The markers will enter this information in the correct places
on the reverse side of the answer sheet.
! Use only the HB pencil provided to mark the answer sheet. Completely fill in the circle.
A
o
C
o
D
o
E
o
Which one of the following is the correct sequence of the development of the structures indicated
by the letters A to E?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
A, C, D, B, E
A, B, D, C, E
C, B, D, A, E
D, B, C, A, E
E, B, D, C, A
A
B
C
D
Question 3. Which of the following correctly lists the hormones in order from A to D?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 5. Ovulation is triggered by a peak in the hormone whose level is shown by the
A.
B.
C.
D.
Line A
Line B
Line C
Line D
A.
B.
C.
D.
uterine wall
ovary
hypothalamus
anterior pituitary
A.
B.
C.
D.
uterine wall
ovary
hypothalamus
anterior pituitary
Question 8. One hypothesis predicts that most of the CO2 produced in the soil originates from
microorganisms feeding on dead plant material. To which trophic level do these microorganisms
belong?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Primary producers
Secondary producers
Decomposers
First order consumers
Second order consumers
Question 9. Joan and Claude (neither have cystic fibrosis) come to you seeking genetic counseling.
Claude was married before, and he and his first wife had a child with cystic fibrosis, an autosomal
recessive condition. A brother of Joans died of cystic fibrosis and Joan has never been tested for
the gene. If they marry, what is the probability that Joan and Claude will have a son that WILL
NOT be a carrier for, nor have cystic fibrosis?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
1/12
1/8
1/6
1/4
1/2
Question 10.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Chromosomal crossing over occurs in which of the following stages of cell division?
Prophase of mitosis.
Metaphase of mitosis.
Prophase I of meiosis.
Metaphase II of meiosis.
Telophase I of meiosis.
Question 11. A man whose blood group is Type A has two boys. The plasma of one of the boys
agglutinates the red cells of his father, but the plasma from the other son does not. Which statement
is incorrect?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 12. In peas, the allele for smooth seed coat (S) is dominant to wrinkled (s), Tall plant (T)
is dominant to short (t) and yellow coloured seed (Y) is dominant to green (y).
A plant with the genotype SsTtyy was test crossed and 145 progeny survived to maturity.
Approximately how many of these progeny are expected to be tall plants with green wrinkled seeds?
A.
B.
C.
D.
9
18
36
72
Question 13. B chromosomes are additional chromosomes possessed by some, but not all,
individuals in a population. Which combination of statements is correct?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
I, III and V
I, IV and V
II, III and V
II, IV and V
Question 14. Often the frequency of a particular deleterious allele is very different in
neighbouring populations. For example, the frequency of the allele causing cystic fibrosis is 0.02 in
Population A and 0.006 in Population B. Such a difference in allele frequencies between two close
populations is probably the result of
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 15. The coefficient of relatedness is a theoretical value determined by the number of
alleles that would be the same between two organisms.
The diagram below shows the relationships between some honeybees. What is the coefficient of
relatedness between II-2 and II-3; and between II-2 and III-1?
II
III
ANSWER
A.
0.50
0.50
B.
0.75
0.50
C.
0.75
1.00
D.
0.25
1.00
E.
0.50
0.75
Question 16. Collenchyma and sclerenchyma are plant support tissues. Which combination of the
following statements correctly differentiates these two types of plant tissue?
I.
I, II, III.
II, III, IV
II, IV, V
IV, V
Question 17. The following figure shows the carbon fixation reactions during
photosynthesis in a typical C4 plant :
Vascular bundle
CELL 1
CELL 2
epidermis
Which of the following answers indicate the dominant carbon fixation enzyme in each of the
two cells?
Answer
Cell 1
Cell 2
A.
Malate dehydrogenase
Sucrose synthase
B.
PEP Carboxylase
Rubisco
C.
Rubisco
PEP Carboxylase
D.
Aspartate aminotransferase
Malate dehydrogenase
E.
Malic enzyme
Pyruvate
dehydrogenase
10
Question 18. Suppose that an illuminated suspension of Chlorella (a photosynthetic alga) was
actively carrying out photosynthesis when the light was suddenly switched off. How would the
levels of 3-phosphoglycerate and ribulose 1,5-bisphosphate change during the next minute?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would increase and that of ribulose 1,5bisphosphate would increase.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would increase; the concentration of
ribulose1,5-bisphosphate would decrease.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would decrease; the concentration of ribulose
1,5-bisphosphate would increase.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would decrease; the concentration of ribulose
1,5-bisphosphate would decrease.
The concentration of 3-phosphoglycerate would remain the same; the concentration of
ribulose 1,5-bisphosphate would decrease.
Question 19. Which of the following statements shows the difference between the reaction sites of
photosystem I and II?
A.
B.
C
D.
E.
Question 20. You are a biotechnologist designing novel eukaryotic enzymes that are regulated by
phosphorylation. Which amino acid residues shown below would you most likely use at the
regulatory site?
I.
IV.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
III.
II.
I, III
I, IV
I, II, III
II, IV, V
III, IV, V
V.
11
Question 21. A biologist has discovered two new species of micro-organisms. Micro-organism A
was isolated from a hot spring whereas micro-organism B was obtained from a tropical forest. DNA
was isolated from both organisms and an analysis of the melting profile of each DNA sample was
carried out. The melting temperature (Tm) was 80 C for DNA from micro-organism A, and 70 C
for DNA from micro-organism B.
Which statement best describes the reason for this difference in values?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Coenzyme A
Flavin coenzyme
NADH
Vitamin D
Coenzyme A and Vitamin D
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
I
II
III
IV
I, III
Cell I
Cell II
Cell wall
Present
Present
Ribosomes
Present
Present
Nucleus
Absent
Present
Ability to photosynthesize
Present
Absent
Cell respiration
Present
Present
Question 23. From the characteristics presented in the table, which statement is correct?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
plant cell
eubacterium
archaebacterium
animal cell
cyanobacterium
Question 25. Suppose Species B disappears from an ecosystem in which the interrelationship
among the component species can be described by the food web below.
12
13
Question 26. You have been asked by an international organization to initiate a biodiversity
conservation project on a tropical island off the south coast of Java, and far from any large
continental land. For this purpose, you must identify from three islands the island that has the
highest number of species.
The following information is provided:
Island Name
Boa
Ibo
Bio
Size/Area
418 km2
500 km2
420 km2
Question 28. The best description of the relationships between fundamental niches (FN) and
realized niches (RN) of two competing species A and B that coexist is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
14
Question 29. Use the information given in Figures 1 and 2 to answer this question.
Figure 1. An example of a phylogeny showing characters by which taxa are recognised. Characters
1 4 are synapomorphies, 5 12 are autapomorphies and 13 is an attribute seen in the salmon and
the shark.
The tree shown in Figure 1 is the most parsimonious tree possible using these
characters.
The Lamprey and the Lizard are the oldest because they have the longest line.
The four groups shown in Figure 1 are equally related because they are all at the same
horizontal level.
X, Y and Z are characteristics common to all groups.
The Lamprey is more closely related to the Shark than to the Salmon or the Lizard.
15
Question 30. A woman visits her doctor after noticing several changes in her body over a period
of 6 (six) months. She has noticed weight loss, intolerance to temperature variations, irregular
menstrual cycles, insomnia, and general weakness. Based on these symptoms, you would expect
the doctor to test her for:
A.
B.
C.
D.
Diabetes mellitus
Hyperthyroidism
Hypothyroidism
Hypoglycemia
Produce hormones that are only secreted into the digestive tract
Release most hormones into the bloodstream
Release hormones that generally act as rapidly as nerve impulses
Are present only in vertebrates
Question 32. Long corolla length in tobacco is inherited as a recessive monogenic characteristic.
If in a natural population 49% of the plants have a long corolla, what is the probability that the
result of test crossing a randomly selected plant with a short corolla from this population in F1 will
have uniform progeny?
!.
B.
C.
D.
E.
100%
50%
30%
18%
0%
Question 33. From an evolutionary viewpoint, which of the five following individuals is the most fit?
!.
B.
C.
D.
E.
A child who does not become infected with any of the usual childhood diseases, such as
measles or chicken pox.
A woman of 40 with seven adult offspring
A woman of 80 who has one adult offspring
A 100-year old man with no offspring
A childless man who can run a mile in less than five minutes
16
Question 34. A study of a grass population growing in an area of irregular rainfall found that
plants with alleles for curled leaves reproduced better in dry years, whereas plants with alleles for
flat leaves reproduced better in wet years. Curled and flat leaves are controlled by different alleles
at the same gene locus.
This situation tends to
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 35. The cohesion-tension (C-T) theory of sap ascent states that in plants sap is
transported against gravity by bulk flow through the xylem vessels or chains of tracheids. Which of
the following statements correctly describes the main factors affecting this bulk flow?
A.
B.
C.
D.
Hydrogen bonds within the water, hydrogen bonding to the hydrophilic walls of the
xylem cells, and the gradient of solute potential (! s).
The gradient of the pressure potential (! p), and solute concentration
The gradient of water potential (!), hydrogen bonds within the water and solute
concentration.
Hydrogen bonds within the water, hydrogen bonding to the hydrophilic walls of
the xylem cells, and the gradient of pressure potential (! p).
Questions 36-38. Plants maintain most Indole Acetic Acid (IAA) (an auxin) in conjugated
forms, which complicates IAA quantification.
Question 36. These forms can exist in forms such as IAA-amino acid conjugates
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 37. These forms can exist in forms such as IAA-amino acid conjugates. Before analysis
in order to measure total IAA in a particular tissue, these conjugates must be
A.
B.
C.
D.
dehydrated
dehydrogenized
hydrolyzed
synthesized
17
Question 38. Therefore free IAA, thought to be the active form of the hormone, is measured
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 39. You find a mutant bacterium that synthesizes lactose-digesting enzymes whether or
not lactose is present. Which of the following statements or combination of statements might
explain this?
I. The operator has mutated such that it is no longer recognised by the repressor.
II. The gene that codes for the repressor has mutated and the repressor is no longer effective.
III. The gene or genes that code for the lactose-digesting enzymes have mutated.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Only I
Only II
Only I, II
Only I, III
I, II, III
Question 40.
A.
B
C.
D.
E.
Question 42. The transport of glucose into the mammalian red blood cell is accomplished by
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 43. Isopods are one of the few crustacean groups that have successfully invaded
terrestrial habitats. Which of these statements is INCORRECT?
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 45.
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 46. Someone who has suffered damage to the pancreas might
A.
B.
C.
D.
Question 47.
A.
B.
C.
D.
The hypothalamus
18
19
Questions 48 - 49. Ten grams of plant material were homogenized in 50 ml buffer and the
homogenate was centrifuged. Protein from 10 ml of the supernatant was precipitated by
addition of ammonium sulphate and the protein precipitated was collected by centrifugation
and re-suspended in 1 ml of buffer. The re-suspended protein was diluted 10 times for protein
determination.
Question 48. The amount of protein in 1 ml of the diluted sample was 0.4 mg. What is the total
amount of protein recovered from 10 ml of the supernatant?
A.
B.
C.
D.
2 mg
4 mg
6 mg
8 mg
Question 49. The amount of protein in 1 ml of the diluted sample was 0.4 mg. What is the amount
of protein extracted from 100 g tissue?
A.
B.
C.
D.
0.2 g
0.4 g
0.6 g
0.8 g
Question 51. Why are some proteinases synthesized as inactive precursors known as zymogens
(proenzymes)?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
20
Question 54. It takes much longer for sex hormones and other steroids to produce their effect that
it takes nonsteroid hormones. Why?
A.
B.
C.
D.
Questions 55 - 57. To test the origin of CO2 available in the soil, two experiments were
conducted on trees in a Pinus forest.
Question 55. In the first experiment, a 20 cm-wide strip of bark around the stem was removed
from trees mid-way between the ground and the lowest branch.
Which of the following statements correctly describes the effect of this treatment on the trees?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Transpiration will cease. As a result, the tree will lose all its needles.
Transport of auxin in the xylem is prevented. This will cause increased auxin
concentration in the roots and root growth will be stimulated.
Phloem transport is prevented causing the roots to become deficient in nitrogen.
Transport of sugars to the roots ceases and the roots will die.
Transport of potassium and calcium from the roots to the needles will cease.
21
Question 56. In the second experiment, the amount of CO2 released from the soil at the base of
trees was measured on several days during the growing period. The bark-removal experiment was
repeated on a total of 9 trees, three trees per teament. In the first treatment, the bark was removed
in early June (white triangles); in the second treatment, the bark was removed in late August (white
squares); the third treament was the control treatment where the bark was not removed (black
circles).
The data from this experiment are shown in the following graph. The black arrows indicate the
time of bark removal.
Which combination of the following statements best describe the results of this experiment?
I.
The variability of the different treatments overlap and any effect of bark removal is due to
chance.
II. The production of CO2 in the soil shows seasonal variation.
III. Bark removal in June had a much smaller effect on the total CO2 production in the soil during
the whole season than bark removal in August.
IV. The decrease in the CO2 production in the soil in the treatments where bark was removed
cannot be explained by seasonal variations alone.
V. The production of CO2 in the soil is always smaller for trees with bark removed than for
undamaged trees.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Only I, II and V
Only I , II and IV
Only II, IV and V
Only II, III and IV
Only I, III and V
22
Question 57. Which of the following statements is a valid conclusion for the results of the second
experiment?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Most CO2 produced in the soil is due to the decomposition of dead roots.
Most CO2 produced in the soil is due to cellular respiration of root cells.
The amount of CO2 produced in the soil is not influenced by photosynthesis.
When most of the roots die, the production of CO2 in the soil is greatest.
The amount of CO2 produced in the soil depends on the soil temperature.
Question 58. From the following, choose the combination in which the floral diagram is
associated with the correct family.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
A = Brassicaceae
B = Fabaceae
C = Liliaceae
D = Malvaceae
E = Rosaceae
Question 59.
23
In which floral diagram do the all the floral characteristics listed below occur?
B
C
D
E
F
Question 60. Students made cross-sections of leaves collected from two different oak trees.
When they examined the sections under a microscope, they were surprised to see that the leaves
were different.
The following diagrams show cross-sections of leaves from Oak tree 1 and Oak tree 2.
Which of the following statements best explains the difference in leaf structure that the students
observed?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Oak tree 1 grows in a swampy area; Oak tree 2 grows in sandy soil.
Oak tree 1 is a young tree; Oak tree 2 is a mature tree.
Oak tree 1 grows in fertile soil; Oak tree 2 grows in poor soil.
Oak tree 1 is exposed to sun for most of the day; Oak tree 2 grows in a shaded
area.
Oak tree 1 is infected by fungi, which induced the cell proliferation; Oak tree 2 was not
infected.
24
Question 61. Cloning of a new DNA fragment into a circular plasmid/vector always requires:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Cholesterol mixes with phospholipids in a cell membrane because cholesterol molecules are:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
amphipathic
steroid derivatives
entirely hydrophobic
phospholipids derivatives
bound with glycoproteins
Question 63. Which of the following molecules can diffuse through the mammalian phospholipid
bilayer without using a channel/transporter?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
O2
glucose
steroid hormones
K+
amino acids
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
I, III
I, IV
II, III, V
II, III, IV, V
All of the above.
25
Question 64. What is the net charge of aspartic acid when the pH of the solution in which it is
prepared is the same as its pI value? Note the three pKa values of aspartic acid are as follows:
-COOH pKa = 2.1; -NH3+ pKa = 9.8; R group pKa = 3.9
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 65. A quantitative amino acid analysis reveals that bovine serum albumin (BSA)
contains 0.58% tryptophan residues by weight. The molecular mass of the tryptophan molecules is
204 daltons. The molecular mass of bovine serum albumin is known to be approximately 66000
daltons. What number of tryptophan residues is present in each BSA molecule?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
2
3
4
5
6
Question 66. What essential function does gastrulation perform for the developing embryo?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 67. Which of the following is not true about the lymphatic system?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
26
Question 68. The most direct consequence on amphibian development upon removal of the grey
crescent would be:
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
- THE END -
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
THEORETICAL TEST
PART A
Student code:
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Please check that you have the appropriate examination papers and answer sheet,
as well as a calculator and a black pencil.
Use the answer sheet provided to record your answers.
Remember to write down your personal code number on top of the answer sheet.
All the questions are multiple choice and there is ONLY ONE correct answer.
You must mark your answers in the answer sheet by filling in the corresponding
box.
Use the pencil provided to complete the answer sheet.
You have 2 hrs 30 min (150 minutes) to answer the questions.
The maximum score is approximately 82 points (1 point each question).
CELULAR BIOLOGY
1- Which of the following structures and processes can exist in both prokaryotic and
eukaryotic cells?
I. Nuclear envelope.
II. Ribosomes.
III. Introns.
IV. ATP synthesis.
V. Cell membrane.
VI. DNA polymerase.
VII. Cytoskeletal elements.
VIII. rRNA 18S.
2- What structure in the bacterial cell has the most enzymatic activity?
A) Cell membrane.
B) Cell wall.
C) Mesosome.
D) Capsule.
E) Flagellum.
3- Which of the following functions are carried out in the rough endoplasmic reticulum?
3 Answers
A) I, II and V.
B) II, III and IV.
C) II, IV and V.
D) I, II and IV.
E) III, IV and
4- Which of the following fibers bind to the cytoplasmic site of cell-matrix adherens
junctions (focal adhesion)?
A) cytoplasmic ions.
B) lysosomal pH.
C) temperature.
D) calcium.
E) nuclear DNA.
8- In which of the following processes the membrane integral proteins are NOT involved?
A) Glucose carrier.
B) Sodium ion channel.
C) Surface receptor.
6
D) Urea carrier.
E) Sodium-potassium pump.
9- How do polypeptides find their way from the site of synthesis on the cytoplasmic
ribosome to the place of their destination in the peroxisome?
10- What is embedded in the thylakoid membrane of the chloroplast and protruding as
knobs from the outer surface?
11- Where are most proteins of respiratory chain in that carry out the oxidative
metabolism in the mitochondrial structure located?
12- Two sister chromatids fail to separate because microtubules became improperly
attached to the kinetochores. What is the most likely result?
14- Which of the following reactions are likely to occur in the cytoplasm of an eukariotic
cell?
I. Krebs cycle.
II. Oxidative catabolism of fatty acids
8
III. Glycolisis
IV. Lactic fermentation
V. Etanol fermentation
VI. Glyoxylate cycle
Answers
IV. The product of the tumor-suppressing gene (p53 protein) activates in response to DNA
damage.
V. It is a process that involves loss of energy.
Answers
A) I, IV and V.
B) II, III and IV.
C) I, II and V.
D) II, IV and V.
E) I, III and V.
16- Which of the following enzymes DOES NOT correspond to the Krebs cycle?
A) Isocitrate dehydrogenase
B) Succinate dehydrogenase
C) Citrate sintetase
D) Pyruvate carboilase
E) -cetoglutarate deshidrogenase
17- Which are the key terms to explain water transport in the xylem?
10
18- Which of the following statements about the stomatal opening is true?
20- Which of the following statements is not related to plants pollinated by wind
(anemophily)?
24- In a laboratory, stems and roots of different plants were cut. When putting them into a
box the slides mixed. Which of the following cross sections corresponds to a primary root
of Magnoliopsida?
A)
Epidermis
Cortex
B)
Epidermis
Cortex
Pericycle
C)
Periderm
Secondary Phloem
Cambium
Secondary Xylem
D)
Epidermis
Cortex
Pericycle
20 xylem strands
alternate with phloem
E)
Epidermis
Sclerenchyma
Scattered vascular
bundles
13
Hollow pith
25- Which of the following combinations present primary walls in an adult plant?
A)
Vessels members
Meristematic cells
Parenchyma cells
B)
Colenchyma cells
Fibres
C)
Sclereids
Colenchyma cells
Sieve cells
D)
Meristematic cells
Tracheary elements
Colenchyima cells
E)
Sieve elements
Meristematic cells
Colenchyma cells
14
26- Identify the following characteristics in the floral diagrams below: Calix and corolla with
the same number of parts in each whorl, the number of stamens are twice the number of
sepals and petals, gynoecium with 5 carpels.
II
I
III
IV
A) I, II and IV.
B) II and III.
C) III and IV.
D) I, II and III.
E) I and IV.
15
27- The following figures correspond to cross sections of leaves. Which one/s
correspond/s to a hydrophytic habitat?
I
III
II
IV
A) I, II and III.
B) II.
C) I, III, IV and V.
D) I, II and V.
E) I, III and IV.
16
28- In a 5-m-tall young Eucalyptus, a person stuck 2 long nails horizontally and opposite to
each other in its trunk, at a height of 1.0 m. Today the tree is 10 m tall. Are there changes
in the height above the ground and the distance between the two nails?
A) The height of the two nails above the ground increases due to the activity of vascular
cambium.
B) The height of the two nails above the ground remains unchanged because primary
growth occurs in the stem tip.
C)The distance between the two nails will increase due to activity of vascular cambium.
D) The height and distance between the two nails increase due to activity of the intercalary
meristem.
E) Both B and C are true.
1m
17
A) spinal cord.
B) medulla oblongata.
C) hypothalamus.
D) cerebellum.
30- A naked person inside a room at 21 C of temperature and 80% humidity will lose heat
mainly because of:
18
A) distilled water.
B) a 2 % sodium chloride solution.
C) a 5% glucose solution.
D) a mixture of 1% glucose and sodium chloride solutions.
32- Select the correct combination of the temperature regulating mechanisms activated by
cold:
19
(1729-1799),
developed
very
he
was
the
precursor
of
artificial
20
Since then, developmental Biology has acquired significant advances, and at present the
embryonic development of the amphibia is well known.
33- Which of the following statements about amphibia development are correct?
Answers
21
The amniotic egg is one of the major adaptations in the evolution of the vertebrates. The
following scheme corresponds to an amniotic egg.
22
A) chorion.
B) allantoids.
C) amnion.
D) yolk sac.
35- One of the extra embryonic membranes produces proteins and lymphocytes which
suppress the immune response the mothers body would present against the fetus. This
membrane is:
A) the allantois.
B) the chorion.
C) the yolk sac.
D) the amnion.
36- If the corpus luteum of a pregnant woman is removed before the eleventh week of
pregnancy:
A) the pregnancy proceeds because there is no connection between the corpus luteum
and pregnancy during this period of gestation.
B) the placenta has already secreted enough progesterone and estrogen to sustain the
pregnancy.
C) the embryo is spontaneously aborted.
D) none of the given answers is correct.
23
37- The three embryonic layers established during gastrulation in mammals subsequently
differentiate into specific tissues and organs.
Select the correct pair:
A) Mesoderm liver.
B) Endoderm - dental enamel.
C) Ectoderm crystalline lens.
D) Mesoderm - thyroid.
38- From which part of the paraxial mesoderm do the vertebrae develop?
A) Sclerotome.
B) Dermatome.
C) Myotome
D) Hypomere.
39- Select the correct sequence with relation to the embryonic origin of the nervous
system.
24
40- Upon which organs in the diagram the cholecystokinin (CCK) acts?
A) 1; 2; 3 and 4.
B) 2 and 3.
C) 2 and 4.
D) 3 and 4.
E) 1; 3 and 4.
41- Which of following proteins are synthesized by the organ marked with 1 in the
scheme?
I. Albumin.
II. Fibrinogenous.
III. Transferrin.
IV. Angiotensyn.
25
Answers
A) I, II and IV.
B) II, III and IV.
C) I and III.
D) II and IV.
E) All of them are correct.
A) Cystic duct.
B) Common hepatic duct.
C) Pancreatic duct.
D) Choledoco.
I. Nucleases.
II. Lypase.
III. Pepsin.
IV. Trypsin.
V. Lactase.
VI. Chymotrypsin.
26
Answers
44- Organ 4 of the scheme also has an endocrinous function. One of the main hormones it
releases is insulin. Which one of the following triplets is true regarding the effects of Insulin
on fat tissue (adipose tissue), muscle and liver?
Fat tissue
A)
Muscle
Liver
Decrease in lipid
synthesis
B)
Increase in glycogen
Decrease in ketogenesis
synthesis
C)
D)
Decrease in glycogen
synthesis
synthesis
Decrease in aminoacid
Decrease in protein
synthesis
acquisition
synthesis
27
Increase in ketogenesis
GENETICS
45- This remarkable animal is the only known species that always produces monozygotic
multiple offspring. After 140 days of gestation a female armadillo gives birth to 4 naked
babies with soft armour. We expect that:
46- In an electrophoretic study of enzyme variation in one species of Dasypus you find 31
individuals A1A1, 24 A1A2 and 5 A2A2, in a sample of 60. Which are the frequencies of
alleles A1 and A2?
Table: 2-Distribution
df 0.995
0.99
0.975
0.95
0.90
0.10
0.05
0.025
0.01
0.005
---
---
0.001
0.004
0.016
2.706
3.841
5.024
6.635
7.879
0.010
0.020
0.051
0.103
0.211
4.605
5.91
7.378
9.210
10.597
0.072
0.115
0.216
0.352
0.584
6.251
7.15
9.348
11.345
12.838
0.207
0.297
0.484
0.711
1.064
7.779
9.488
11.143
13.277
14.860
0.412
0.554
0.831
1.145
1.610
9.236
11.070
12.833
15.086
16.750
0.676
0.872
1.237
1.635
2.204
10.645
12.592
14.449
16.812
18.548
0.989
1.239
1.690
2.167
2.833
12.017
14.067
16.013
18.475
20.278
A) Yes.
B) No.
C) It is not possible to determine.
48- If in another population the frequency of the A 1A1 genotype is 0.25 and the frequency
of the A1A2 genotype is 0.45, in Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium, the frequency of matings
between the A2A2 and A2A2 genotypes would be:
A) 0.063.
B) 0.300.
C) 0.090.
D) 0.112.
E) 0.075.
29
49- Among the offspring of a given mating of armadillos, a phenotypic ratio of 9:3:3:1 is
discovered. This is a result of:
A) epistasis.
B) linkage.
C) independent assortment.
D) pleiotropy.
E) polyploidy.
50- Two male specimens of the rodent Akodon molinae belonging to the same population
were analyzed cytogenetically: One of them had 43 and the other 42 chromosomes. The
Fundamental Number (number of chromosome arms in a somatic cell) was 44 in both of
them. This may be due to:
A) chromosome loss.
B) an inversion.
C) Robertsonian translocation.
D) presence of B chromosomes.
E) polyploidy.
30
51- Which of the following statements is NOT true with respect to an X-linked recessive
inheritance?
52- In chickens there exists a genetic condition called creeper (very short crooked legs).
A cross of affected chickens, produced a progeny of 775 creepers and 388 normal chicks.
The closest phenotypic ratio is:
A) 3 : 1.
B) 2 : 1.
C) 1 : 1.
D) 3 : 2.
E) 4 : 1.
53- What is the mode of inheritance of the creeper trait in the above question?
A) Sex-limited.
B) Autosomal recessive-lethal.
C) Epistatic to the normal allele.
D) Both a and b.
E) X-linked recessive.
31
54- You carry out a cross between homozygous purple-eyed flies with vestigial wings, and
wild-type flies. The resulting F1 flies are all phenotypically wild-type. In the progeny of the
testcross of F1 females you observe the following phenotypes:
Phenotype
Progeny
1193
159
161
1129
55- In order to study a viral polymerase, a scientist decided to express the encoding gene
in Escherichia coli using the recombinant DNA technology. Choose the correct option
about steps mentioned below, in the right order.
Answer
A) d, f, e, a, h, g, c, b.
B) d, b, c, a, h, e, f, g.
C) h, g, a, b, d, f, c, e.
D) d, f, e, h, g, b, c, a.
56- Which of the three options (A, B, C or D) shows the characteristics of the DNA
molecule under physiological conditions?
Diameter
turn
Form
A)
12 bp
2 nm
34 nm
B)
10 bp
1 nm
3.4 nm
C)
10 bp
2 nm
3.4 nm
D)
11 bp
1 nm
3.4 nm
33
57- A DNA molecule has 160 base pairs and 20 percent of adenine nucleotides. How
many cytosine nucleotides are present in this molecule?
A) 96 cytosine nucleotides.
B) 60 cytosine nucleotides.
C) 160 cytosine nucleotides.
D) 40 cytosine nucleotides.
E) 48 cytosine nucleotides.
I. DNA polymerase.
II. restriction endonucleases.
III. a probe.
IV. DNA ligase.
V. a host.
VI. donor DNA.
VII. methylases.
VIII. proteases.
IX. a vector.
X. Taq DNA polymerase.
34
Answer
35
ECOLOGY
59- The following graph represents the hypothetical results of an experiment designed to
recognize which nutrients can act as limitants of productivity in a salinized water lake.
According to the areas of limitation, determine the lines in the graphic which correspond to
each of these nutrients: phosphorus, nitrogen, iron and copper.
References
Solid black line: primary production.
a) Iron limitation area.
b) Nitrogen limitation area.
c) Phosphorus limitation area.
36
** During a period of six years, the variation in abundance for five animal species
was registered in the month of October in order to verify the recovery of the fauna
of a contaminated lake after a decontamination process initiated in 1999. The
abundance values are shown in the following figure.
62- The species that allowed evaluating the reduction of contamination were:
A) 1; 2; and 3.
B) 2; 3; and 5.
C) 3; 4; and 5.
D) 1; 4; and 5.
E) 2; 4; and 5.
38
64- In the same way as a population, a community shows several properties. Which of the
following characteristics correspond to the community level?
39
References
R: limiting resources.
C: consumers.
E: natural enemies.
40
66- Identify the organisms with mutualistic interaction between them, and the example
representing this situation:
Mutualistic interaction
Example
between
A)
C1 C2
B)
C1 C2
II
C)
C2 C3
II
D)
III
E)
C1 C2
41
67- Organic matter decomposition depends in part on climatic factors such as temperature
and precipitation. In the following schemes, the distribution of nitrogen in mulch, root, and
soil for six different biomes is shown. Which biome is represented in each of the following
figures: I, II, and III?
References
mulch
root
soil
42
Statements
I. The amount of nitrogen in living organisms is very small compared to the total quantity in
the atmosphere.
II. Less than 30% of the nitrogen available for plants comes from nitrogen-fixing bacteria or
algae.
III. The gaseous nitrogen cycle is global because it implies an exchange between the
ecosystem and the atmosphere.
IV. The input mechanisms of nutrients to an ecosystem are different from the output ones.
V. The nutrients cycles can be studied introducing radioactive markers in natural or
artificial ecosystems.
Answer
43
Statements
I. The life table of a population does not change with the environmental conditions.
II. To project the population growth when birth and mortality rates vary according to
individual age, we must know the proportion of individuals in each age-class.
III. The life table of a population varies according to the density of the population.
IV. The age-class structure of a population is always an indicative of the temporal
heterogeneity in individuals recruitment.
Answer
A) I, and III.
B) I, and IV.
C) II, and III.
D) II, and IV.
E) III, and IV.
44
BIOSYSTEMATICS
45
72- Observe the following diagrams of invertebrates embryos illustrating the characteristics
of the body plan (bauplan).
References
Endoderm
Cross
Mesoderm
I
II
Ectoderm
III
IV
Transversal
Longitudinal
Diploblastic
Triploblastic
No coeloms
pseudocoeloms
Without segmentation
true coeloms
46
Select the correct sequence which corresponds to the Phyla represented with I, II, III, IV
and V.
A)
Cnidaria
Plathyhelminta
Annelida
Nematoda
Arthropoda
B)
Cnidaria
Plathyhelminta
Nematoda
Arthropoda
Annelida
C) Nematoda Arthropoda
Plathyhelminta
Cnidaria
Annelida
D) Annelida
Arthropoda
Plathyhelminta
Nematoda
Cnidaria
73- The following characteristics correspond to: Unicellular organisms, eukaryotic cell with
micronuclei and macronuclei, asexual reproduction by transverse binary fision and sexual
reproduction by conjugation. Most are free-living.
A) Rhizopoda
B) Apicomplexa
C) Zoomastigophora
D) Ciliophora
47
48
49
ETHOLOGY
** The following 2 questions are related to the mulita (Dasypus hybridus) behavior.
To shelter and to look after its babies, the mulita (Dasypus hybridus) excavates
cylindrical burrows where it builds its nest with vegetal matter, specially dry
grasses (herbs).
79 - The mulitas avoid the overlapping of refuge and nestling areas by means of a fragrant
sign: on moving into the burrow, they impregnate its roof with an oily and stinking liquid
that is secreted by a gland placed in the back of the caparison at the pelvis level.
Therefore every adult mulita usually dwells into its own burrow -though sometimes the
burrows may be occupied by several individuals. This behavior corresponds to:
A) an altruistic behavior.
B) a selfish or malicious behavior.
C) a territorial behavior.
D) an agonistic behavior.
E) none of the previous ones.
50
51
A) a conditioned reflex.
B) a displacement activity.
C) an innate response.
D) a sign stimulus.
E) the super normal releaser.
52
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
ANSWER SHEET
THEORETICAL TEST PART A
STUDENT NUMBER
CORRECT:
INCORRECT: X, O;
Cellular Biology
1
A
B
C
D
E
1
2
A
B
C
D
E
1
3
A
B
C
D
E
1
4
A
B
C
D
E
1
5
A
B
C
D
E
1
6
A
B
C
D
E
1
7
A
B
C
D
E
1
8
A
B
C
D
E
1
9
A
B
C
D
E
1
10
A
B
C
D
E
1
11
A
B
C
D
E
1
12
A
B
C
D
E
1
13
A
B
C
D
E
1
14
A
B
C
D
E
1
15
A
B
C
D
E
1
16
A
B
C
D
E
1
Plant Anatomy and Physiology
17
A
B
C
D
E
1
18
A
B
C
D
E
1
19
A
B
C
D
E
1
20
A
B
C
D
E
1
21
A
B
C
D
E
1
22
A
B
C
D
E
1
23
A
B
C
D
E
1
24
A
B
C
D
E
1
25
A
B
C
D
E
1
26
A
B
C
D
E
1
27
A
B
C
D
E
1
28
A
B
C
D
E
1
Animal Anatomy and Physiology
29
A
B
C
D
E
1
30
A
B
C
D
E
1
31
A
N
U
L
A
D
32
A
B
C
D
E
1
33
A
B
C
D
E
1
34
A
B
C
D
E
1
35
A
B
C
D
E
1
36
A
B
C
D
E
1
37
A
B
C
D
E
1
38
A
N
U
L
A
D
39
A
B
C
D
E
1
40
A
B
C
D
E
1
41
A
B
C
D
E
1
42
A
B
C
D
E
1
43
A
B
C
D
E
1
44
A
B
C
D
E
1
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
79
80
81
82
A
A
A
A
Genetics
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
C
D
Ecology
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
Biosystematics
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
Ethology
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
C
D
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
E
E
E
E
1
1
1
1
TOTAL:
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
THEORETICAL TEST
PART B
Student Code:
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Please check that you have the appropriate examination paper and answer sheets,
a calculator, a black pencil, and two pens: a green one and a red one.
Use the answer sheet provided to record your answers.
Remember to write down your personal code number on top of the answer sheet.
There are different kinds of questions: in some of them you will have to choose
one answer, in this case, you must fill in the corresponding box; in other questions
you will have to complete diagrams or in blank spaces.
In the examination sheets you will find the instructions to complete the answer
sheet according to each question.
Use the pencils provided to complete the answer sheet.
You have 2 hrs 30 min (150 minutes) to answer the questions.
The maximum score is approximately 79 points. The points assigned to each
individual question depends on its complexity.
3 CGA 5
3 GGA 5
3 GCU 5
3 UUU 5
3 GGA 5
Mark the DNA nucleotide sequence of the complementary chain to the DNA chain that
encodes for the armadillo intestinal protein:
A) 5-ATG-GCT-GGT-CGA - AAA-CCT-3.
B) 5-ATG-GCT-CCT-CGA - AAA-CCT-3.
C) 5-ATG-GCT-GCT-CGA - AAA-GCT-3.
D) 5-ATG-GGT-CCT-CGA - AAA-CGT-3.
2- In the eukaryotic cell, the ribosomes that are associated with the cytosol, endoplasmic
reticulum, mitochondria and chloroplast carry out the synthesis of specific proteins.
Using the answer code, mark the location of the ribosomes that carry out the synthesis of
the detailed proteins:
Answer code:
01. Cytosol.
02. Rough Endoplasmic reticulum.
03. Mitochondria.
04. Chloroplast.
PROTEINS
CODE
A) Fibronectin.
B) Lactate dehydrogenase.
C) Complex of the cytochrome b6-f.
D) Amylase.
E) Ribulose biphosphate carboxylase.
F) Cytochrome C oxidase.
G) Keratin.
H) NADH deshidrogenase.
3- The nuclear protein DNA polymerase (synthesized by cytoplasmic ribosomes of the cell)
enters into the nucleus through the nuclear pores by:
4- Using the answer code, specify the characteristics of RNA synthesis, mRNA processing
and protein synthesis corresponding.
Answer code:
01. prokaryote.
02. eukaryote.
03. both.
CHARACTERISTIC
A) A single RNA polymerase catalyzes the synthesis of the three types of
RNA.
B) The assembly of RNA polymerase at the promoter requires a set of proteins
called general transcription factors which must be assembled at the promoter
before transcription can begin.
C) The structural genes are not contained in operons.
D) In the mRNA processing, a methylguanine cap is added to the 5-end and a
poly-A tail to the 3-end.
E) Most of the structural genes contain introns that are spliced before the
translation.
F) The protein synthesis starts even before the transcription has been
completed.
G) The protein synthesis always starts on free ribosomes in the cytoplasm.
H) The degradation rate of the mRNA is regulated by extracellular signs.
I) The Shine-Dalgarno sequence in the 5-end of mRNA recognizes the
ribosome and the translation starts.
CODE
Procedure 2
Procedure 3
Procedure 4
Protein A
40 kDa
40 kDa
Not detected
40 kDa
Protein B
Not detected
50 kDa
Not detected
Not detected
Protein C
40 kDa
80 kDa
Not detected
80 kDa
Fill in the blanks using the answer code corresponding to the location of each protein:
Answer code:
01. Suspended in the cytoplasm.
02. Attached to the outside of the vesicle.
03. Entrapped inside the vesicle.
04. Spanning the vesicle membrane with one half being exposed on the outside and the
other half entrapped inside.
05. Cannot be determined from this experiment only.
CODE
Protein A
Protein B
Protein C
II
III
A)
01, 03, 05
02, 04, 08
02, 03, 07
B)
01, 02, 06
03, 04, 09
05, 07, 08
C)
01, 03, 08
03, 04, 05
02, 06, 09
D)
01, 06, 09
02, 04, 07
03, 05, 07
7- Using the answer code, which of the following statements about the transport across the
plasma membrane of the animal cells is correct or incorrect.
Answer code:
01. Correct.
02. Incorrect.
STATEMENT
CODE
10
8- In the following table, some components, processes and structures of mitochondria are
shown. Match both columns and identify the correct combination.
01. Porin.
02. Enzymes of mitochondrial RNA synthesis.
03. ATP synthase.
06. Coenzyme Q.
07. Enzymes of citric acid (Krebs) cycle.
II
III
A)
02, 06, 07
01, 04, 07
01, 05
B)
01, 05, 06
02, 03
02, 04, 07
C)
01, 04
03, 06
02, 05, 07
D)
02, 05
01, 03, 07
06, 07
11
12
10- Look at the following picture and write down the correct answer code.
CODE
13
11- The following figure corresponds to part of the nitrogen cycle. Match the processes
numbered 1 to 4 in the figure with the following answer code.
Answer code:
CODE
Process 2
Process 3
Process 4
14
12- Using the answer code, select which of the following statements about carbohydrates
and the human body are correct or incorrect.
Answer code:
01. Correct.
02. Incorrect.
15
STATEMENT
CODE
13- Complete the following diagram by using the answer code. Fill in the blank boxes with
the number corresponding to the regulation of the cycle phases.
Answer code:
I. Cyclin B-CdK1.
II. Cyclin A-Cdk2.
III. Cyclin E-CdK2.
IV. Cyclin D- CdK4.
16
The diagram on the next page shows the life cycle of a plant. Examine this figure and its
captions carefully. Answer questions 14 to 21 using the diagram on the next page.
14- This life cycle corresponds to a plant from which of the following taxon:
A) Bryophyta.
B) Pinophyta.
C) Magnoliopsida. (dicots)
D) Liliopsida. (monocots)
15- Choose and write down the Arabic number of the figure that represents fertilization
structure.
Answer: ________________................
17
18
16- The following table shows some of possible components in diagram 14 (page 18) of
the plant life cycle. Choose the correct option.
A)
Stigma
Outer
Pollen tube
Zygote
Synergid
Funiculus
Ovary
Archegonium
Ovum
Nucellus
Pollen tube
Male
Synergid
Funiculus
Archegonium
Outer
integument
B)
C)
Pollen
Pollen
tube
chamber
Stigma
Outer
integument
D)
Pollen
Synergid
gametes
Stigma
Funiculus
chamber
E)
Style
integument
Synergid
Stigma
Zygote
Outer
Antipodal
integument
cells
17- Which of the following statements associated with this life cycle is INCORRECT?
A) The anther endothecium (inner lining of an anther) develops into the fibrous layer.
B) The megaspores are arranged in one row and, generally, three of them degenerate.
C) The mature male gametophyte consists of three cells resulting from two meiotic
divisions.
D) The seed develops from the ovule.
E) The embryo constitutes a partially developed young sporophyte.
19
18- It may be reasonable to conclude that the species that shows the life cycle
represented in this figure (page 18) have the following pool of characteristics:
Answer code:
01. Naked seed.
02. Protected seed.
03. Winged seed.
04. Seed without albumin.
05. Perfect flower.
06. Imperfect flower.
07. Free pollen grains.
08. Agglutinated pollen (pollinium).
09. Anatropous ovule.
10. Orthotropous ovule.
11. Gametophyte generation only.
12. Sporophyte generation only.
13. Two alternating generations.
14. Hypogeal germination (cotyledons remain below ground).
15. Epigeal germination (cotyledons emerge above ground).
Answer: ______________________
20
19- Observe the parts of the life cycle that correspond to processes occurring in the ovule
before fertilization and mark with an X the corresponding stages at which mitotic divisions
occur.
II
III
IV
VI
VII
VIII
IX
XI
XII
20- Suppose that the plant corresponding to this cycle, besides producing seeds, can
reproduce asexually through stem pieces or cuttings. Which of the following plant
hormones would you choose to improve rooting?
A) Gibberellins.
B) Cytokinins.
C) Ethylene.
D) Auxins.
E) Abscisic acid.
21
21- In the following table, nine mineral elements essential to the plant whose life cycle is
represented in the figure are listed. Match both columns and identify the correct
combination.
01. Calcium.
02. Potassium.
03. Iron.
04. Nitrogen.
I. Macronutrients
05. Magnesium.
II. Micronutrients
06. Molybdenum.
07. Phosphorus.
08. Zinc.
09. Sulfur.
II
A)
B)
C)
D)
03, 06, 08
E)
22
22- Diagrams A and B correspond to the mechanisms of hormonal action. Complete the
diagram by filling in the boxes with the corresponding answer code (on the answer sheet),
using each answer code once .
Answer code:
01. chemical reaction.
05. receptor
04. protein.
23
23- Complete the following table on the answer sheet about the chemical nature of the
hormones by using the codes below:
Answer code:
01. Peptides or proteins.
02. Amino acid derivatives.
03. Fatty acid derivatives.
04. Steroid.
05. Glycoprotein
HORMONE
CODE
A) Progesterone
B) Insulin
C) FSH (Follicle-stimulating hormone)
D) LH (Luteinizing hormone)
E) Prolactin
F) Oxytocin
G) Estrogen
H) Testosterone
I) ACTH (Adrenocorticotropic hormone)
24
24- The following figure shows the interactions between the hypothalamus, the anterior
hypophysis (pituitary) and the male gonads. The full arrows ( ) indicate excitatory
effects and the dotted arrows ( ) indicate inhibiting effects.
Complete the boxes on the answer sheet by using the corresponding code. Use each code
once.
Answer code:
01. Sertoli cell.
02. Testosterone.
03. FSH - Follicle-stimulating hormone.
04. Leydig cells or interstitial cells.
05. Inhibin.
25
GnRH
Hypothalamus
(Gonadotropinreleasing hormone)
Anterior hypophysis
LH
(anterior pituitary)
Testis
26
25- 48 hours after beginning a hyposodic (low sodium) diet, the renal and hormonal
conditions of a person are controlled. Which combination of the following conditions does
the patient display? Select the correct answer.
Reference signs:
+: increase.
-: decrease.
=: no changes.
Na+
Water
reabsorption
reabsorption
A)
B)
C)
D)
E)
27
26- Next to each type of receptor, write down the answer code of the corresponding
structures. All possible answer codes must be used once only.
CODE
Mechanoreceptor
Chemoreceptor
Photoreceptor
Answer code:
01. Gustatory papillae.
02. Crustacean statocysts.
03. Gustatory hairs in flies.
04. Vertebrate retina.
05. Muscle spindles.
06. Arhtropod ommatia.
07. Diptera halteres.
08. Labyrinth (cochlea and vestibule) vertebrate ear.
28
27- Identify what kind of muscular tissue which corresponds to each of the following sets of
characteristics. Write the correct answer codes in the corresponding box of the answer
sheet.
Muscular kind
Characteristics
Fibre shape
Elongated;
cylindrical;
blunt ends
Elongated;
spindle-like;
pointed ends
Elongated;
cylindrical;
branched;
fibres
interconnected
Number of nuclei
per fibre
Many
One
One or two
Nucleus location
Peripheral
Central
Central
Contraction
speed
Very fast
Very slow
Intermediate
Answer code:
01. cardiac muscle.
02. skeletal muscle.
03. smooth muscle.
29
28- The volume of blood pumped by each ventricle during a beat is known as systolic
volume. If it is multiplied by the number of beats per minute, the product is the cardiac
output.
What is the cardiac output (volume of blood pumped by each ventricle in a minute) of an
adult person at rest whose heart beats 72 times per minute and pumps 70 millilitres of
blood in each ventricular contraction?
Answer code:
A) 3 L/min.
B) 5 L/min.
C) 10 L/min.
D) 7 L/min.
30
29- The cardiac frequency can increase or diminish under the influence of several factors.
Complete the column on the right by writing a (+) sign if the factor increases the cardiac
frequency and a (-) sign if the factor diminishes it.
FACTOR
SIGN
A) Hypoxia
B) Exhalation
C) Fever
D) Excitation
E) Inspiration
F) Exercise
30- The following diagram shows some of the factors that influence the cardiac output.
Complete the blank boxes in the answer sheet by using the answer code below. Use each
code once.
Answer code:
01. Cardiac frequency.
02. Adrenal glands.
03. Sympathetic nerves.
04. Systolic volume.
05. Parasympathetic nerves.
06. Cardiac centre in the medula oblongata.
31
Emotions
Other stimuli
Hypothalamus
----------------------------
----------------------
------------------
-------------------
Adrenalin
increases
Cardiac output =
increases
diminishes
------------------------
32
----------------------
** In a butterfly species, the wing colour is determined by a locus with three alleles:
C (black wings) > cg (grey wings) > c (white wings). In a survey of a large population
living in Ro Cuarto, the following frequencies were obtained: C= 0.5; cg = 0.4, and c
= 0.1.
31- If the butterflies continue to mate randomly, the frequencies of black-winged, greywinged, and white-winged butterflies in the next generation will be:
Black wings
Grey wings
White wings
A)
0.75
0.24
0.01
B)
0.75
0.15
0.1
C)
0.24
0.75
0.01
D)
0.83
0.16
0.01
32- If the population consists of 6,500 butterflies, how many butterflies of each phenotype
will there be?
Black wings
Grey wings
White wings
A)
3656
374
2470
B)
4875
1560
65
C)
3595
1040
65
D)
4875
156
1469
33
PHENOTYPE
FREQUENCY
black wings
0.00
grey wings
0.75
white wings
0.25
cg
A)
0.25
0.50
0.25
B)
0.00
0.75
0.25
C)
0.00
0.50
0.50
D)
0.25
0.25
0.50
33.b- The change in the allelic frequencies in this population as compared to the original
one is an example of:
A) migration.
B) selection.
C) bottleneck effect.
D) founder effect.
34
34- A group of birds migrates into this isolated site in Las Higueras. As the birds find it
easier to spot and catch the white-winged butterflies, the relative fitness of the whitewinged is reduced to 0.2.
Phenotype
Relative fitness
grey wings
white wings
0.2
cgcg
cgc
cc
A)
0.3125
0.625
0.0625
B)
0.25
0.5
0.05
C)
0.25
0.5
0.2
D)
0.263
0.526
0.211
35
Answer code:
36
37
36- The scientists constructed a cDNA library in a lambda vector. They chose a lambda
vector instead of a plasmid vector because lambda vectors:
A) I, II, VII.
B) III, V, VI.
C) II, IV, VIII.
D) I, II, V.
37- They identified in the library the cDNA clone encoding hLf using the sequence of the
hLf gene (with a chemical label) as a probe. The screening procedure employed was:
A) Southern hybridization.
B) colony hybridization.
C) Northern hybridization.
D) plaque hybridization.
E) immuno blotting
38
38- Once the desired cDNA clone was identified, the scientists isolated and sequenced the
insert in order to be sure it was the hLf cDNA. Deduce the nucleotide sequence of the
original strand of this small fragment sequenced with the dideoxy method.
A) 5 TGGCTACC 3.
B) 3 TGGCTACC 5.
C) 5 ACCGATGG 3.
D) 3 ACCGATGG 5.
39- As the sequencing confirmed it was the hLf cDNA, they inserted it into the EcoRI site
of a plasmid. The plasmid contained: a) the wild type of hLf coding sequence including its
signal peptide (PSLf) under the control of the 35S strong promoter and the 35S terminator
of the cauliflower mosaic virus, and b) the left (LB) and right (RB) borders of T-DNA. It was
used to transform E. coli and then transferred to Agrobacterium tumefaciens by
conjugation.
39
The promoter sequence of the cauliflower mosaic virus was necessary because:
40- Leaf discs of tobacco (Nicotiana tabacum) were infected with recombinant
Agrobacterium tumefaciens. To determine which tobacco plants were transgenic, the
scientists performed:
40
41- Twenty tobacco transgenic plants were screened for the expression of the hLf gene:
1g of fresh weight of transgenic leaf tissue was ground in liquid
nitrogen and total soluble proteins were extracted. The following figure
shows the Western analysis of the total soluble protein extract from
transgenic leaves (1. concentrated protein extract; 2. milk hLf. The
position of protein standards is shown on the left). The blot was:
41
42- After the transformation of tobacco (N. tabacum) with a human lactoferrin cDNA under
the control of the 35S promoter from cauliflower mosaic virus, using A. tumefaciens-based
gene transfer, the authors concluded that:
A) I, IV, VI.
B) I, V, VII.
C) III, IV, VIII.
D) II, V, VIII.
42
43- In order to determine the armadillos' (Dasypus novemcinctus) eating habit, a group of
scientists conducted a vegetation survey and compared it with the food remains found in
the excrements. The scientists walked in a straight line through a sunflower and a corn
field, and a natural pasture. They conducted a vegetation census in a 1m 2 square every 50
metres recording the species diversity, the coverage and the phenological stage (stage of
the flowering plant). The following experimental techniques were available:
I. soil sampling.
II. systematic sampling.
III. a graphical presentation of life forms by means of a bar graph.
IV. coverage estimation (% of the ground covered by the species).
V. collection of vegetation biomass.
VI. use of a transect.
VII. data analysis (eg. classifying species and census).
VIII. species listing.
43
A) I, III, V, VII.
B) II, IV, VI, VIII.
C) II, V, VI, VIII.
D) I, II, III, IV.
E) V, VI, VII, VIII.
** The results of the samples of the mulitas excrement (I), and the composition of
the vegetation in the sunflower field (II), in the corn field (III), and in the natural
pasture (IV), are shown below. Column 1 shows the percentage of faeces which
contain remains of a particular plant species and identifies the form of those
remains. In columns II, III and IV, the phenological stage and the percentage
coverage of each species of plant are presented. The excrement and vegetation
sampling was performed at the same time.
44
Plant Species
II
Species 1
Fruit, 90%
Epidermis, 100% Flower, 5%
Species 4
Species 5
IV
Fruit, 90%
Species 2
Species 3
III
Epidermis, 10%
Species 6
Flower, 10%
Flower, 2%
Flower, 10%
Flower, 6%
Flower, 3%
Vegetative, 6%
Vegetative, 2%
Vegetative, 7%
Vegetative, 5%
Vegetative, 20%
Species 7
Vegetative, 8%
Vegetative, 40%
Species 8
Epidermis, 40%
Vegetative, 5%
Species 9
Seeds, 20%
Fruit, 30%
Fruit, 40%
Species 10
Epidermis, 10%
Fruit, 30%
Species 11
Epidermis, 60%
Flower, 10%
Flower, 6%
Species 12
Seeds, 80%
Fruit, 40%
Species 13
Seeds, 100%
Flower, 10%
Flower, 3%
A) Only in II.
B) Only in III.
C) Only in IV.
D) Both A and B are correct.
E) Both A and C are correct.
45
Fruit, 6%
Fruit, 5%
Flower, 30%
45- To compare the population size of mulitas between a corn field and a natural pasture,
another group of scientists carried out two samplings. In the first one, they caught 130
specimens in each environment, marked them without interfering with their survival, and
then released them. Three days later, a second random sample was taken. Of the 125
animals captured in the corn field, 72% were marked. In the natural pasture 45% of the
144 specimens caught were marked. Assuming no changes in the population size within
the three days, which environment had the largest population and what was its size?
Answer:
46
10
6
4
11
MULITA
12
3
2
5
13
14
47
48- On the ANSWER SHEET, complete the figure by adding the appropriate curves to
indicate:
I.
II.
III
II biomass (kg/m2)
IV
Grassland
Shrubland
48
Forest
49- Using the answer code, say whether the following statements are correct or incorrect
according to results shown in the above figure.
Answer code:
01. Correct
02. Incorrect.
STATEMENTS
A) In advanced stages of succession, species richness increases.
B) During the first stage of succession, the number of vascular species (III)
increases.
C) Pioneer and opportunistic species (IV) would be eliminated in the
shrub/scrub phase by competition.
D) Between the 5th and 14th years there is a shift in the trajectory of the
four characteristics (I IV) analysed in this study.
E) Richness of vascular and pioneer and opportunistic species (IV) are
inversely proportional.
F) The number of vascular species fluctuates around an equilibrium.
49
CODE
50- The characteristics of eight taxonomic groups (indicated with letters A to H) are shown
in the table below:
Legs
egg
Bony
Teeth/
endoskeleton
Jaws
Key:
+ feature present
- feature absent
50
Based upon these features complete the following evolutionary tree by writing the correct
taxon group letters in the corresponding branches.
51- In the table over the page you will find several statements about three families of
Liliopsida (Monocot) class. Match both columns and identify the correct answer.
51
02. Most species of this family have bulbs. The bulbs are
tunicated or, sometimes, have numerous overlapping
fleshy scales.
04. Stems of most species of this family are short and each
one usually ends in an umbel-like inflorescence.
I. Araceae
II. Arecaceae
III. Liliaceae
52
II
III
A)
01, 05, 07
04, 08, 09
02, 03, 06
B)
04, 07, 08
01, 05, 06
02, 03, 09
C)
01, 07, 08
02, 05, 06
03, 04, 09
D)
01, 07, 08
03, 05, 06
02, 04, 09
E)
03, 06, 08
02, 05, 07
01, 04, 09
52- In the table below you will find several statements. Using the answer code, indicate on
your answer sheet whether you consider the statement correct or incorrect.
Answer code:
01. Correct.
02. Incorrect.
53
STATEMENTS
CODE
of
megaspores
and
microspores
have
taxonomic
significance.
C) The leaves of Equisetum are small and whorled. Antherozoids
are multiflagellate.
D) Pinus species have female cones with woody scales at
maturity.
E) The indusium is a structure that protects sporangia in true
ferns.
54
** Guppys are among the first fish that beginners in acquaculture get. They are
commonly called "millionaire fish" because of their abundant progeny.
In 1966, professor C. M. Breder, then director of the New York aquarium, decided to
conduct an experiment to investigate the causes of their proliferation.
In a small aquarium - with a capacity of 27.5 liters of water- sufficiently supplied with
food and oxygen to maintain up to 500 fish meticulously taken care of, he
introduced a couple of guppys (1 adult male and 1 adult female). In the course of the
following 6 months and at 4-week-intervals between each breeding (these fish are
ovoviviparous), the female produced 102, 87, 94, 71 and 89 offspring, that is a sum
total of 443 guppys. A later recount showed that only 9 out of all the newborns
remained alive: 6 females and 3 males. All the rest had been devoured by the
mother.
At the same time in another aquarium of equal size and identical conditions, the
researcher put 8 adult males, 8 adult females and 8 young fish, that is to say, a total
of 24 guppys. The females had also abundant offspring here. The data of the
proliferation survey along the 6 months following the introduction of the original
group of 24 guppys in the aquarium, are shown in the following tables.
55
FEMALE 1
4 week
8 week
12 week
16 week 20 week
Males
29
24
31
30
33
Females
58
48
64
58
68
Total
87
72
95
88
101
N of offspring
Males
recounted hours
Females
after breeding
Total
N of offspring in
each breeding
FEMALE 2
4 week 8 week 12 week 16 week 20 week
Males
32
26
33
28
29
N of offspring in
Females
65
50
66
56
58
each breeding
Total
97
76
99
84
87
Males
0
0
0
0
0
N of offspring
Females
0
0
0
0
0
recounted hours
after breeding
Total
0
0
0
0
0
Observations: The newborns were devoured by the own mother
FEMALE 3
4 week 8 week 12 week 16 week 20 week
Males
32
29
25
34
28
N of offspring in
Females
64
56
51
69
55
each breeding
Total
96
85
76
103
83
Males
0
0
0
0
0
N of offspring
recounted hours
Females
0
0
0
0
0
after breeding
Total
0
0
0
0
0
Observations: The newborns were devoured by the own mother
56
FEMALE 4
4 week 8 week 12 week 16 week 20 week
Males
28
25
35
30
29
N of offspring in
Females
57
49
69
61
60
each breeding
Total
85
74
104
91
89
Males
0
0
0
0
0
N of offspring
Females
0
0
0
0
0
recounted hours
after breeding
Total
0
0
0
0
0
Observations: The newborns were devoured by the own mother
FEMALE 5
4 week 8 week 12 week 16 week 20 week
Males
33
30
30
23
30
N of offspring in
Females
67
59
64
47
60
each breeding
Total
100
89
94
70
90
Males
0
0
0
0
0
N of offspring
recounted hours
Females
0
0
0
0
0
after the breeding
Total
0
0
0
0
0
Observations: The newborns were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 6
4 week 8 week 12 week 16 week 20 week
Males
30
29
26
35
25
N of offspring in
Females
62
57
53
70
52
each breeding
Total
92
86
79
105
77
Males
0
0
0
0
0
N of offspring
recounted hours
Females
0
0
0
0
0
after breeding
Total
0
0
0
0
0
Observations: The newborns were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 7
4 week 8 week 12 week 16 week 20 week
Males
29
24
33
28
29
N of offspring in
Females
60
50
71
57
62
each breeding
Total
89
74
104
85
91
Males
0
0
0
0
0
N of offspring
Females
0
0
0
0
0
recounted hours
after breeding
Total
0
0
0
0
0
Observations: The newborns were devoured by their own mother
57
FEMALE 8
4 week 8 week 12 week 16 week 20 week
Males
26
32
33
28
28
N of offspring in
Females
52
65
64
58
57
each breeding
Total
78
97
97
86
85
Males
0
0
0
0
0
N of offspring
Females
0
0
0
0
0
recounted hours
after breeding
Total
0
0
0
0
0
Observations: The newborns were devoured by their own mother
ORIGINAL GROUP
ADULTS
Males
Females
8
8
3
YOUNGSTERS
8
0
Observations:
- The youngsters of the original group were devoured by the adults of the original group
- Some adults of the original group died by unknown causes
53- Which of the following statements can be made from the analysis of the previous data?
58
A) I, II.
B) I, III.
C) I, IV.
D) IV.
E) I.
54- Which of the following statements is more likely to explain the above mentioned
behavior in guppys?
I. Lack of maturity of the instincts in the young mothers (preadult).
II. Instinctive conflicts caused by a premature reawakening of female heat that, in
reaction to male heat, causes the break of mother-offspring bonds.
III. Instinctive conflicts with addictive impulses such as gluttony.
IV. The aggressiveness caused by excessive hunger.
V. An increase of the stress levels, and the consequent increase of aggressiveness due to
the overpopulation.
VI. An increase of the stress levels, and the consequent increase of aggressiveness
caused by lack of vital space.
A) I, II.
B) III, IV.
C) V, VI.
D) V.
E) III.
THE END!!!
59
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
TOTAL:73,5
ANSWER SHEET
THEORETICAL TEST PART B
STUDENT NUMBER
CELLULAR BIOLOGY
1-
1 point
A
2-
CODE
02
0.2
01
0.2
04
0.2
02
0.2
0.2
0.2
01
0.2
0.2
0.4 point
A
4-
1 point
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
3-
13,4
1.8 points
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
CODE
01
0.2
02
0.2
02
0.2
02
0.2
02
0.2
01
0.2
03
0.2
02
0.2
01
0.2
5-
1.2 points
Protein A
Protein B
Protein C
6-
04
0.4
CODE
02
0.2
02
0.2
01
0.2
02
0.2
01
0.2
01
0.2
01
0.2
02
0.2
1 point
A
10-
0.4
1 point
A
9-
01
1.6 points
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
8-
0.4
1 point
A
7-
CODE
03
1.4 points
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
CODE
07
0.2
01
0.2
05
0.2
03
0.2
06
0.2
05
0.2
02
0.2
11-
1 point
Process 1.
Process 2.
Process 3.
Process 4.
12-
0.25
04
0.25
03
0.25
05
0.25
1 point
A
B
C
D
E
13-
CODE
01
CODE
02
0.20
01
0.20
01
0.20
02
0.20
01
0.20
1 point
14-
12
1 point
A
15-
1 point
Answer: ___________________14_____________________________________
16-
2.5 points
A
17-
2 points
A
18-
19-
1 point
I
20-
II
IV
V
x
VI
x
VII
x
VIII
1 point
A
21-
III
1.5 points
A
IX
XI
XII
22-
16
03
06
01
07
04
02
05
23-
2 points
CODE
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
04
0.2
01
0.2
05
0.2
05
0.2
01
0.2
01
0.2
04
0.2
04
0.2
01
0.2
01
0.2
24-
1 point
GnRH
(Gonadotropin-releasing
Hypothalamus
hormone)
Anterior hypophysis
03
LH
05
02
04
01
Testis
25-
3 points
A
26-
Mechanoreceptor
Chemoreceptor
Photoreceptor
CODE
02, 05, 07, 08
01, 03
0.5
04, 06
0.5
27-
1.5 points
MUSCULAR KIND
28-
CODE
03
01
0.5
0.5
0.5
2 points
A
29-
02
1.5 points
A
B
C
D
E
F
SING
+
0.25
0.25
0.25
0.25
0.25
0.25
30-
1.5 points
Emotions
Other stimuli
hypothalamus
06
02
03
05
Adrenalin
increases
diminishes
increases
Cardiac cost =
04
GENETICS
31-
1 point
A
32-
1 point
A
33.a-
14,1
1 point
A
01
33.b-
1 point
A
34-
1 point
A
35-
36-
1 point
A
37-
1 point
A
42-
1 point
A
41-
1 point
A
40-
1 point
A
39-
1 point
A
38-
1 point
A
ECOLOGY
43-
1 point
A
44-
2 points
A
45-
12
2 points
A
46-
1 point
A
47-
1 point
A
48-
2 points (1 x line)
49-
3 points
A
B
C
D
E
F
CODE
02
0.5
01
0.5
01
0.5
02
0.5
02
0.5
01
0.5
10
BIOSYSTEMATICS
50-
2 points
51-
2.5 points
A
52-
1.5 points
A
B
C
D
E
Code
02
0.3
02
0.3
01
0.3
01
0.3
01
0.3
ETOLOGY
11
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
PRACTICAL TEST
1
Plant Anatomy, Systematics and Physiology
Student code:
Procedure
Sample 1
Code
Q2 : Identify the taxon to which each sample belongs, to write its number in the
appropriate box.
Taxon
Ginkgophyta
Pinophyta
Cycadophyta
Magnoliophyta - Magnoliopsida
Magnoliophyta-Liliopsida
Sample number:
Could this leaf structure correspond to some of the organs previously cut and be part of
the same plant? Circle the correct option.
YES
NO
Q 6: Microphotographs with details of leaf sectors are shown (Figure n 2). Select the
codes of those microphotographs corresponding to the sectors pointed out in the leaf
diagram represented in Figure n 1
01
02
03
04
07
06
08
05
12
13
09
11
10
14
15
16
17
7
18
Q7: Keeping in mind all the anatomical characters observed when completing figure 1 you
could infer that this leaf corresponds to a species that belongs to the Family (Circle the
correct answer):
a) Liliaceae.
b) Fagaceae.
c) Brassicaceae.
d) Poaceae.
e) Araceae.
Q8: Leaf anatomy is related to the environment where the plant grows and it indicates its
photosynthetic pathway. Keeping this in mind, observe again the leaf structure
represented in figure 1 and select the codes that correspond to this structure.
01- It follows the Calvin Cycle photosynthetic pathway or C3 pathway.
02- It has an additional method of fixation of the carbon (not alternative) that
works separately from the Calvin Cycle.
03- It shows a stratified mesophyll.
04- It shows a radiated mesophyll (Kranz).
05- It shows chloroplast dimorphisms and /or sizes.
06- Optimum temperature for photosynthesis is between 15-25.
07- Optimum temperature for photosynthesis is between 30-45.
08- It shows two well-developed sheaths around the vascular bundles.
09- It shows one sheath around the vascular bundles.
10- It does not show sheaths around the vascular bundles.
11- The decarboxylation phase takes place in different structures of the leaf.
Answer: ...... ..........................................................................
Q9: Complete the following comparative table of the three main photosynthetic pathways
of carbon assimilation, keeping in mind the codes for each character.
Enzyme responsible for the initial carboxylation:
01- Ribulose 1,5 - bisphosphate carboxylase-oxygenase (Rubisco).
02- Phosphoenolpyruvate carboxylase (PEPase).
03- Sucrose-phosphate synthase (SPase).
04- Rubisco and PEPase.
05- SPase and PEPase.
Leaf anatomy:
01- stratified.
02- Kranz structure (radiated).
03- succulent.
The CO2 fixation time:
01- Day.
02- Night.
03- Day and night.
First stable product of C02 fixation:
01- Made up of six carbons.
02- Made up of four carbons.
03- Made up of three carbons.
Efficiency in water use:
01- Medium.
02- High.
03- Low.
Photosynthetic rate:
01- Medium.
02- High.
03- Low.
Character
Enzyme responsible for the
initial carboxylation:
C3
C4
CAM
Leaf anatomy:
The CO2 fixation time:
First stable product of CO2
fixation:
Efficiency in water use:
Photosynthetic rate:
Q10: If a plant is placed into a closed chamber and exposed to the light, it is observed that
the CO2 concentration in the air inside the chamber decreases for a while due to
photosynthesis. The decrease is gradual but it never reaches the zero value. A balance is
reached between the CO2 captured by photosynthesis and the one released by respiration
and photorespiration. This balance is known as CO2 compensatory point.
In the following graph the effect of the atmospheric concentration of CO2 on the
photosynthesis rate in plants C3 and C4 is observed. The arrows indicate the
compensatory points of each plant.
Indicate the curve that corresponds to each plant by writing C3 or C4 in the right box.
9
Reference:
10
PRACTICAL TEST
2
Animal Anatomy, Systematics and Ecology
Student Code:
PART A
Procedure
1- Put on the gloves and respiratory mask.
2- Before starting the dissection, locate the external parts of the bivalve (Figure 1).
Figure 1
3- The valves are hinged by ligaments. In order to identify the internal structure you
have to dissect the bivalve. You must be very careful when separating the valves so as
not to hurt your hands.
Insert the lancet (Figure 2) and cut
bivalve.
,
Figure 2
4- In order to separate the valves completely, once the muscle/s is/are cut, you must cut
carefully the ligament in the umbo area.
5- Once the three samples are dissected, identify the structures with different color pins.
Use 3 pins for each bivalve sample (green, red, and blue), and a yellow pin only for
bivalve 2, in the following way:
6- After finishing the task you must raise your hand. An assistant will check the
task. The Practical Test Sheet should be signed by both, you and the assistant.
Signatures:
Student.:....................................Assistant:...................................................
PART B
As you have seen during the dissection, the three bivalves show differences in their
muscles.
There exists a muscle classification according to their number and size:
9 Dimyarian isomyarian condition: in which both muscles have similar size.
9 Dimyarian heteromyarian condition: in which both muscles are different in size.
9 Monomyarian condition: Having only one, large adductor muscle to close the
valves.
Bivalve 2
Condition
Codes:
01- Dimyarian isomyarian.
02- Dimyarian heteromyarian.
03- Monomyarian.
Bivalve 3
Figure 1
High
Tide.
Low
Tide.
Figure 2
High tide
Low
tide
Fill in the corresponding box in each table, indicating the site where the samples given in
this practical task can be found.
Codes:
01- Bivalve 1.
Sandy beach
02- Bivalve 2.
Zone I
03- Bivalve 3.
Zone II
Zone III
Zone IV
Rocky
beach
Zone I
Zone II
Zone III
Zone IV
Zone V
PART B (6 points)- Keeping in mind the zones occupied by bivalves in rocky and sandy
beaches, you must determine the category of the given samples by writing an X in the
corresponding box.
Bivalve 1
Bivalve 2
Bivalve 3
Burrowers in soft
substrate
INFAUNA
Surface dwellers attached
to the substrate
EPIFAUNA
Free swimming
PART C (12 points)- A series of characteristics related to the three given bivalves and
their habitats is given below. Examine your dissected specimens and summarize ALL
their characteristics by writing the appropriate answer codes from the list into the table
below.
Answer code:
01- large, burrowing foot
02- reduced, finger-like foot.
03- highly reduced and barely visible foot.
04- no anterior adductor muscle.
05- no siphons.
9
Bivalve 2
Bivalve 3
10
Condition
Bivalve 2
01
Bivalve 3
03
Rocky
beach
Zone I
02
Zone I
01
Zone II
02
Zone III
02
Zone IV
03
Zone II
Zone III
Zone IV
Zone V
01
01
01
03
Bivalve 2
Bivalve 3
X
X
Free swimming
Bivalve 1
02- 05- 10- 11
Bivalve 2
01- 06- 07
Bivalve 3
03- 04- 05- 08- 09
PRACTICAL TEST
3
Biochemistry
Student code:
TASK 1:
with known concentration. Then, plot the results as absorbance versus glucose
concentration (15 points)
Important: Raise the red card to call the lab assistant when you are ready to use the
spectrophotometer.
Introduction:
Glucose oxidase (GOD) catalyzes the oxidation of (beta)-D-glucose to D-gluconic acid and
hydrogen peroxide. It is highly specific for (beta)-D-glucose and does not act on (alpha)-Dglucose. The horseradish peroxidase (POD) breaks down hydrogen peroxide into water
and oxygen, using the dye (4-aminophenazone) as an electron donor. At the same time,
the dye is converted to its oxidized form, which is a colored compound. Since the amount
of hydrogen peroxide produced indicates how much reaction has taken place, the
formation of the red color can be used to follow the course of the reaction.
Its major use is in the determination of free glucose in body fluids. Although specific for
(beta)-D-glucose, glucose oxidase can be used to measure total glucose, because as a
result of the consumption of (beta)-glucose, (alpha)-glucose from the equilibrium is
converted to the (beta)-form by mutarotation.
PRINCIPLE
The reaction system is as follows:
GOD
Glucose + O2 + H2O----------------> Gluconic Acid + H2O2
POD
2 H2O2 + 4-AP + 4-Hydroxybenzoate------------ > red quinoneimine
Glucose oxidase reagent: solution containing glucose oxidase, peroxidase, 4aminophenazone (4-AP), and phosphate buffer pH 7.0 containing hydroxybenzoate.
Reagents:
1. glucose oxidase reagent (ready to use).
2. glucose solution (unknown concentration).
3. glucose solution 5 mg. ml-1.
4. distilled water.
Equipment
1. Lab gloves (1pair).
4. Pipettes (2).
5. Incubator at 37oC .
6. Spectrophotometer (you will use it with lab assistants).
7. Spectrophotometric cuvettes (8).
Instruments:
P1000
P100
Pushing Knob
Counter
Adjustment method
You have to pull up the Adjustable Wheel, then you can revolve the adjustable wheel or
knob. Adjust the required volume and push down the Adjustable Wheel.
Remember that minimal and maximal volumes for P100 are 10 l and 100 l
respectively.
For P1000 minimal volume is 100 l and maximal volume is 1000 l.
Usage method:
Please secure the suction tip, after that slightly push down the pushing knob to first stop,
hold and immerse the tip into solution vertically. The immersed depth of the tip is 2-4 mm,
then release the pushing knob slowly and make it return to the original position. Take off
the pipette from the liquid and place the suction tip of the pipette into a special container
receiving the dispensed liquid. The tip must be close to the inner wall of the container.
Depress the pushing knob to the first stop and further more to discharge the solution
completely from the tip. After that, you can take away the pipette and release the button.
Eject the used tip to the trash recipient by pressing the Tip ejecting knob.
EXPERIMENTAL PROCEDURE
1) Label five 1.5-ml microtubes 1/2 through 1/32 with a marker pen. Using the glucose
standard solution (5 mg. ml -1) perform the following serial dilutions (in distilled water) in a
final volume of 100 l: 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, and 1/32.
2) Mix well and perform (in a new 1.5-ml microtubes set) the enzymatic determination of
glucose for each dilution according to the following squeme.
1/2
1/4
1/8
1/16
1/32
Blank
Sample volume
10l
10l
10l
10l
10l
Water volume
10 l
Glucose oxidase
1 ml
1 ml
1 ml
1 ml
1 ml
1 ml
reagent volume
5) Read absorbance in a spectrophotometer at 505 nm. You have to use the blank for
calibration. (When you are ready to read in the spectrophotometer, please call the lab
assistant). If you have to wait to use the spectrophotometer, please continue with
the questions. The extra waiting time will not affect the results.
6) Plot the absorbance versus the amount of glucose (in g) on the plotting paper below.
Dilutions
1/2
glucose (g in the reaction
mix)
Absorbance at 505 nm
1/4
1/8
1/16 1/32
TASK 2:
Sample
Blank
Sample volume
10l
Water volume
10 l
1 ml
1 ml
QUESTION 1:
DELETED
by the glucose oxidase reaction, it is important that the enzyme used for these assays
presents: (1.5 points)
A) a low catalase content.
B) a high catalase content.
C) a low peroxidase content.
D) a high peroxidase content.
Answer:................................................................................................
QUESTION 2: Glucose oxidase reagent may contain catalase. If such a condition is not
taken into account the obtained results will give (3 points):
A) underestimation of the glucose in the assay.
B) overestimation of the glucose in the assay.
C) no effect in the assay.
Answer:................................................................................................
10
QUESTION 3: The most favorable pH value (the point at which the enzyme is most active)
is known as the optimum pH. Extremely high or low pH values usually result in a complete
loss of enzyme activity due to (1 point):
A) The breakdown of the secondary structure of the protein.
B) The breakdown of the tertiary structure of the protein.
C) The breakdown of the primary structure of the protein.
B.
C.
B, C.
A, B
A, B, C.
QUESTION 4: Glucose oxidase from the fungus Aspergillus niger was overexpressed in
yeast. The recombinant glucose oxidase was purified and glycosylation pattern was
analyzed by treatment with endoglycosidase H and -mannosidase. After treatment, an
aliquot was used for SDS-PAGE (electrophoresis in polyacrylamide gels containing
sodium dodecyl sulphate) in reducing conditions. The remaining enzyme was employed for
determination of the KM (Michaelis-Menten constant) with glucose as the substrate.
Michaelis-Menten constant (KM) is the concentration in moles/litre of a substrate at half the
maximum velocity of an enzymatic reaction. (7 points)
11
The values of the KM for each glycoforms are shown below the figure 1.
kDa
200
116
97
66
KM (mM)
20
28
35
60
Which of the following is/are correct conclusion(s) from these results (figure 1)?
A) Glucose oxidase is a homodimer with a molecular mass of 96 kDa.
B) The deglycosylated form has a molecular mass of approximately 68 kDa.
C) Glucose oxidase is glycosylated since the treatment with endoglycosidase H and mannosidase results in a form with lower molecular mass.
D) The polysaccharide moiety of glucose oxidase contains N-acetylglucosamine and
mannose.
12
Which is/are correct conclusion(s) from the results obtained in the determination of KM for
each glycoform?
A) The affinity of the fully glycosylated enzyme for glucose is higher than the affinity of the
deglycosylated enzyme
B) The glucose oxidase activity is completely abolished in the deglycosylated form
C) The lack of the sugar moiety could cause changes in the structure of the active site of
the enzyme resulting in the observed modifications of the KMs.
13
DTT
DTT
192 kDa
Figure 2: SDS-PAGE analysis of purified
glucose
oxidase.
electrophoresis
in
(non-denaturating
polyacrylamide
gels)
of
96 kDa
Taking in account the results obtained from figure 1 and figure 2 the most probable
conformation of the recombinant glucose oxidase is:
A) A monomeric enzyme non-glycosylated.
B) A monomeric enzyme glycosylated.
C) An homodimer consisting of two monomers both glycosylated.
D) An heterodimer consisting of two subunits one of them glycosylated.
14
15
Dilutions
5 points
1/2
1/4
1/8
1/16
1/32
25
12.5
6.25
3.125
1.56
Absorbance at 505 nm
0,5 pt each
0.8
0.4
0.2
0.1
0.05
Total 10 points
Values properly plotted 5 pt
Rect 1 pt
1.0
Units 0,5 pt
OD (505 nm)
0.8
0.6
Spectro1
Spectro2
Spectro3
Spectro4
Spectro5
Spectro6
mean
0.4
0.2
Title 0,5 pt
0.0
0
10
15
20
Glucose (g)
Title 0,5 pt
Units 0,5 pt
25
Total 10 points
5 points if interpolation is correct
X
1100-1400
5 points
Question 2 (3 points)
A
3 points
Question 3 (1 point)
X AB 1 point
XB 0.5 point
XB
0.9
XC
0.9
XA
2
B
2
XC
2
Question 5 (4 points)
XC
XD
0.9
XA 0.5 point
PRACTICAL TEST
4
MICROBIOLOGY
Student Code:
Practical test 4
MICROBIOLOGY
There are different systems of bacterium classification, but the most commonly used is
the published in Bergey's Manual of Determinative Bacteriology.
A working outline for the identification of a bacterial strain from the biochemical point of
view is proposed below:
1) Isolate the strain and obtain a pure culture.
2) Carry out a microscopic examination of living cells and also of Gram stained smears.
The morphology and type of Gram staining of the microorganism under study is thus
determined. It is also important to determine the presence of clusters, spores and any
other morphological characteristics that may be of interest.
3) Determine the nutritional characteristics (in general they come off from the methods
used in the previous isolate and culture): photoautotrophs, photoheterotrophs,
chemiautotrophs, chemiheterotrophs.
4) Conduce primary tests: The following group of tests, called primary tests, are used
to determine the genus, group of genera or in some cases, the family to which an
isolate belongs to. The primary tests are, beside Gram staining and morphology
observation, the determination of catalase, oxidase, glucose fermentation, and motility,
among others.
8. 2 Lab gloves
9. Respiratory mask
10. Marker pen
11. Paper napkin
12. 1 Bunsen burner
13. Microscope
14. Loop
15. 4 Slides
16. Tray with slide holder
17. 1 plastic bottle with water for rinsing
18. 1 disposable glass
19. 1 dropping bottle with immersion oil
20. 1 dropping bottle with 3% H2O2
21. 2 Luria-Bertani agar plates inoculated with organisms A and B.
22. 1 Eppendorf tube with 2 oxidase disks
23. 1 pair of tweezers
24. 2 Kahn tubes
25. 1 Kahn tube with a stopper containing sterile distilled water.
26. 1 plastic Pasteur pipette.
27. 3 plates with eosin methylene blue agar (EMB) medium (one of them inoculated
with organism A, another inoculated with organism B and the last one without
inoculation)
28. 3 tubes with phenylalanine (one of them inoculated with organism A, another
inoculated with organism B and the last one without inoculation).
29. 1 Dropper containing 10% ferric chloride
30. 3 Kahn tubes with SIM (hydrogen Sulfide Indole Motility) medium (one of them
inoculated with organism A, another inoculated with organism B and the last one
without inoculation)
31. 1 Dropping bottle containing Indole reagent
32. 3 Kahn tubes containing UREA broth (one of them inoculated with organism A,
another inoculated with organism B and the last one without inoculation)
(one of them
inoculated with organism A, another inoculated with organism B and the last one
without inoculation)
34. 3 Kahn tubes containing Simmons citrate (labeled as SC-A and SC-B and
another one labeled SC without inoculation)
35. Clock located in view of all the students in the laboratory.
Caution:
You must be careful in the manipulation of media and reagents since the
quantities provided allow performing this practical test only once.
If you work carelessly, with abrupt movements, far from the burner, you will
contaminate the medium thereby preventing you from obtaining good results.
You will perform the biochemical tests which basis and interpretation are
detailed below by using the media, reagents, and the given bacteriological information
(charts and diagrams)
Note: Do not discard the tubes with organisms A and B. You will use them in
task 2.
EXPERIMENTAL PROCEDURE
Introduction:
Gram stain differentiates between two major bacterial cell wall types. Some
bacterial species, because of the chemical nature of their cell walls, have the ability to
retain the crystal violet even after the treatment with an organic decolorizer such as a
mixture of acetone and alcohol.
1. Make a thin smear of the material to study and allow to air dry.
2. Fix the material to the slide so that it does not wash off during the staining
procedure by passing the slide three or four times through the flame of a
Bunsen burner.
3. Place the smear on a staining rack and overlay the surface with Gentian Violet
solution.
4. After 30 seconds of exposure to the Gentian Violet solution, wash thoroughly
with running water.
5. Next, overlay the smear with Grams iodine solution (lugol) for 30 seconds.
6. Hold the smear between the thumb and forefinger and flood the surface with a
few drops of the acetone alcohol decolorizer until no violet color washes off.
This usually requires 10 seconds or less time.
7. Wash with running water and again place the smear on the staining rack.
Overlay the surface with safranin counterstain for 20 seconds. Wash with
running water.
8. Place the smear in an upright position in a staining rack, allowing the excess
water to drain off and the smear to dry.
9. Examine the stained smear under the 100 x (oil) immersion objective of the
microscope.
10. When you focus the microscope call the assistant.
Results
SELECT THE CORRECT ANSWER, FILLING THE CORRESPONDING BOX
Organism
Gram staining
Positive
Negative
Positive
Negative
Assistant revision
Question
Gram-variability
A) is a term which can be used where two Gram reactions are seen due to an error in
the staining procedure.
B) applies to an organism which changes its cell wall structure from the Gram-positive
type to the Gram-negative type as the culture ages.
Write the letter corresponding to the correct answer on the dotted line below:
In this part of the practical work you will determine, by means of metabolic tests
(already provided or performed by you), the family and genus of the two organisms
labeled as A and B.
Catalase Reaction:
Some bacteria contain flavoproteins that reduce the oxygen resulting in the production
of hydrogen peroxide (H2O2) or superoxide (O2 -), which are extremely toxic since they
are powerful oxidizers able to destroy the cellular constituents in a short time. Many
bacteria possess enzymes that offer protection against these toxic compounds.
Technique
Perform the catalase test to organisms A and B by adding two drops of H2O2 to a
bacterial suspension (3 loopfuls of the liquid culture labeled as LB-A and LB-B) placed
on the slides.
Note: Write the obtained results in the Biochemical test table using + (for a
positive reaction) or (for a negative reaction)
Question
Which of the following reactions is carried out by the catalase enzyme?
1) H2O2 + NADH + H+ 2 H2O + NAD+
2) H2O2 + H2O2 2H2O + O2
3) O2- + O2- + 2H+ H2O2 + O2
4) 4 O2- + 4H+ 2H2O + 3 O2
Write the number corresponding to the correct answer on the dotted line below:
Oxidase Reaction:
Test used for the detection of the cytochrome-c-oxidase enzyme, which is present in
different genera, e.g. Pseudomonas spp., Neisseria spp., Moraxella spp., Vibrio spp.,
Aeromonas spp.
Oxidase discs contain dimethyl-para-phenylene-diamine, which is the substrate of
cytochrome-c-oxidase enzyme.
Organisms possessing this enzyme, in the presence of atmospheric oxygen and the
substrate contained in the oxidase discs give a red-fuchsia color.
Technique
Perform the oxidase test to organism A and B according to the following instructions:
Oxidase test will be carried out using tubes. From a pure culture, prepare a heavy
suspension in 0.2 ml of sterile distilled water, and add one oxidase disc.
Note: Prepare the bacterial suspension starting from 3 colonies of each one of
the plates labeled as LB-A and LB-B respectively.
Results
Generally, within the first minute and at room temperature, positive results are
detected. A delayed reaction, evidenced after 2 minutes must be considered a negative
result.
Instructions
Using the EMB plates provided (labeled as EMB-A and EMB-B for organisms A and B
respectively), determine the sucrose and/or lactose utilization for organisms A and B.
Note: Write the obtained results in the Biochemical test table using + (for a
positive reaction) or (for a negative reaction).
10
Question
Fermentation
A) results in production of acid and possibly gas from the breakdown of sugars.
B) is associated with the type of growth of facultative anaerobes in Thioglycollate
Medium where growth is less dense in the anaerobic region.
Write the letter/s corresponding to the correct/s answer/s on the dotted line
below:
Instructions
Add 4 or 5 drops of the ferric chloride solution to the phenylalanine slants agar tubes
(labeled as Ph-A and Ph-B for organisms A and B respectively). As the reagent is
added rotate the tubes. An intense green color appearing within 10 minutes indicates
the presence of phenylpyruvic acid.
11
Note: Write the obtained results in the Biochemical test table using + (for a
positive reaction) or (for a negative reaction).
Hydrogen Sulfide indole motility medium (SIM) (Tubes labeled as SIM A and SIM
B)
This medium is used for the detection of hydrogen sulfide, indole production, and
motility in the same tube. Hydrogen sulfide production in this medium is originated from
thiosulphate or sulphate reductases and not by cysteine desulfhidrases. Any
blackening along the line of inoculation is considered as a positive hydrogen sulfide
reaction, and it usually appears between 18-24 hours of inoculation. Motile cultures in
SIM medium show diffuse growth away from the line of inoculation. This is an
appropriated medium for the detection of Listeria's characteristic "umbrella-like"
movement. The high content of tryptophan in this medium makes it very suitable for
detection of indole production.
Instructions
Using the SIM tubes provided (labeled as SIM-A and SIM-B for organisms A and B
respectively), determine the production of hydrogen sulfide and indole, as well as the
motility for organisms A and B.
For indole production detection, add 5 drops of the reagent (labeled as indole) to the
heavy growth obtained in SIM tubes. A pink color promptly developed indicates the
presence of indole.
Note: Write the obtained results in the Biochemical test table using + (for a
positive reaction) or (for a negative reaction).
Question
A) is indicated if growth occurs only along the line where the medium was stabinoculated.
UREA BROTH
This medium is suitable for the differentiation of urease producing organism.
Instructions
Using the urea broth tubes provided (labeled as UREA-A and UREA-B for organisms A
and B respectively), determine the production of urease for organisms A and B.
Note: Write the obtained results in the Biochemical test table using + (for a
positive reaction) or (for a negative reaction).
Yellow color: Negative reaction. Yellow color is due to the "default" acid
production from glucose fermentation.
Instructions
Using the MIO tubes provided (labeled as MIO-A and MIO-B for organisms A and B
respectively), determine the production of ornithine decarboxylase enzyme for
organisms A and B.
Note: Write the obtained results in the Biochemical test table using + (for a
positive reaction) or (for a negative reaction).
Results:
Write the results of the biochemical tests in the following table (11 points)
Organism
catalase
A
B
14
Phenyl
alanine
ODC
Ureasa citrate
oxidase
Family
Genus
Organism A
Organism B
Questions
1. You have cultures of five organisms as listed below. However, the labels of the
tubes have come off and you need to re-label the tubes correctly! First, you must
consider the various reactions you know for the organisms in question:
Gram
genus
stain
shape
catalase glucose
lactose
phenylalanine citrate
utilization
Bacillus
rod
+ or
Staphylococcus
coccus
Enterobacter
rod
Morganella
rod
Pseudomonas
rod
a. The results obtained from what specific laboratory procedure will differentiate
Bacillus and Staphylococcus from each other and also from the remaining three
genera?
A) Glucose fermentation
B) Citrate utilization
C) Catalase reaction
D) Gram stain
Write the letter corresponding to the correct answer on the dotted line below:
15
a. Report the total number of CFUs (colony forming units) in the entire 100 ml amount
of the original lake water sample. (TNTC=too numerous to count.)
Write the letter corresponding to the correct answer on the dotted line below:
16
b. Would you expect any change in the answer of the above problem if the first dilution
was made by adding one ml of sample to 9 ml of diluent?
A)
Yes
B)
No
Write the letter corresponding to the correct answer on the dotted line below:
Annex 1
Gram stain (fresh
shape
coccus
coccus
coccus
coccus
rod
rod
rod
rod
rod
rod
rod
rod
coccus
grouping
clusters
clusters
chains
Tetrads
aerobic growing
anaerobic growing
motility
+ or -
catalase
culture)
pairs
+ or + or
+ or + or
oxidase
fermentation of
glucose to acid or
acid+gas
Micrococcus
Staphylococcus
Streptococcus
X
X
X
17
+ (or
)
+ or
Lactococcus
Enterococcus
Clostridium
Bacillus
Alcaligenes
X
X
Pseudomonas
Enterobacterias
Aeromonas
Chromobacterium
Neisseria
18
Cocci
Bacilli
Group XI
Neisseria
Veillonella
Facultative
anaerobic
Aerobic
Group VIII
Pseudomonas,
Alcaligenes
Halobacterium
motile
Non-motile
Group X
Shigella
Klebsiella
Group IX
Escherichia Proteus
Enterobacter Prividencia
Citrobacter Morganella
Erwinia
Salmonella
Lactose fermentation
Lactose +
Lactose -
Indole +
Indole Glucosa +
citrate +
Citrobacter
citrate -
Escherichia
Urea +
Glucosa -
Urea -
Enterobacter
Klebsiella
19
Salmonella
Shigella
Proteus
Providencia
Morganella
Pseudomonas
Alcaligenes
Motility
motile
Non-motile
citrate +
Lactose +
Citrobacter
Enterobacter
citrate -
citrate +
citrate -
Klebsiella
Shigella
Lactose -
Salmonella
Erwinia
Lactose +
Ureasa -
Lactose Ureasa +
Escherichia
Proteus
Providencia
Morganella
20
Family
Genus
oxidation
catalase
Phenyl
ODC
Ureasa
citrate
oxidase
alanine
Enterobacteriaceae
Pseudomonaceae
Escherichia
Shigella
Salmonella
Citrobacter
+/-
Proteus
+/-
+/-
Morganella
Enterobacter
+/-
+/-
Serratia
+/-
+/-
+/-
Klebsiella
+/-
Pseudomonas
+/-
+/-
+/-
+/-
21
Practical test 4
MICROBIOLOGY
TASK 1: Perform Gram-staining in organisms A and B.
Organism
Gram staining
Positive
X Negative
Positive
X Negative
Assistant revision
Question
A, B, C, D
Results:
Write the results of the biochemical tests in the following table (11 point )
Organism
catalas
e
Pheny
lactose
motility indole
SH2
lalani
ODC
Ureasa citrate
oxidase
-(0.5p)
- (0.5p)
ne
(0.5p)
(0.5p)
sucrose
+ (0.5p)
(0.5p)
- (0.5p) - (0.5p)
(0.5p)
+
+
(0.5p)
- / + + / - -(0.5p)
(0.5p)
+ ( 0.5p)
(0.5p)
Family
Genus
Organism A
Escherichiae (2.25 p)
Escherichia (2.25p)
Organism B
Pseudomonaceae (2.25p)
Pseudomonas (2.25p)
Questions
1. (1.6 point)
D
2. a. (1.6 point)
A
b. (2 point)
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
THEORY EXAMINATION
Part 1
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Please check that you have the appropriate examination papers and answer sheets.
It is recommended that you manage your time in proportion to the points allocated for
each question.
IMPORTANT
Ensure your name and three digit code numbers are written on the top of each page of the
answer sheets.
Use the 2B pencil provided to fill in the correct answers on the answer sheet.
1.
Various forces are important in the interactions contributing to the tertiary structure
of a protein. The figure below is a diagram showing several possible interactions.
Please match the numbered interactions with their correct names. (1 point)
A. Hydrogen bond
B. Hydrophobic interaction
C. Peptide bond
D. Disulphide bond
E. Ionic bond
Interactions
Answer: A-E
1
2
3
4
2. Which of the following statements about cytokinesis in plant cells is/are NOT correct ?
(1 point)
(1) Plant cells form cell plates
(2) Cytokinesis can start during mitosis
(3) Plant cells have a contracting ring
(4) Membrane fusion connects cell plate and the cytoplasmic membrane of the
mother cell.
(5) Golgi apparatus does not participate in cytokinesis of a plant cell until two
daughter cells are formed.
A. 1, 2, 4,
B. 3
C. 3, 5
D. 4, 5
E. 4
3. DNA ligase is an important enzyme that connects DNA fragments. Which of the
following is/are TRUE about DNA ligase? (1 point)
1) It is important to the DNA replication process
2) It is important in molecular cloning
3) It requires DNA fragments having sticky ends
4) It could cut DNA molecules in the presence of ATP and Mg2+.
5) It requires ATP for its function because the 3-hydroxyl group of a DNA fragment
needs to be phosphorylated before the DNA molecules could be ligated.
A. 1, 2, 3
B. 2, 3, 5.
C. 1, 2
D. 1, 5
E. 1, 2, 4
Questions 4-6: Checkpoints in the cell cycle are very important in regulation of cell
cycle. The following three questions are about the cells cycles and checkpoints.
4. Two animal cells at different phases in the cell cycle can be induced to fuse to form a
single cell with two nuclei. This system provides a very useful tool for studying the
cell cycle.
Which of the following is correct? (1 point)
A. When a cell in M phase is fused with a cell in G1 phase, the nucleus in M phase
stops the mitotic process.
B. When a cell in M phase is fused with a cell in G2 phase, the nucleus in G2 phase
starts the mitotic process.
C. When a cell in G2 phase is fused with a cell in G1 phase, both nuclei start the
mitotic process.
D. When a cell in M phase is fused with a cell in G1 phase, the nucleus in G1
phase starts DNA synthesis.
E. When a cell in M phase is fused with a cell in G1 phase, the nucleus in M phase
stops the mitotic process.
5. Which of the following are true about checkpoints in the cell cycle? (1 point)
(1) If a cell in the G1 phase does not receive a signal at the G1 checkpoint, the cell
usually goes into the G0 phase.
(2) A cell must receive a signal at the G2 checkpoint to go into mitosis.
(3) A cell must receive a signal at the M checkpoint to go into mitosis.
(4) The protein factors that control checkpoints in cell cycle are mostly present in
nuclei.
(5) The cell cycle in unicellular organisms does not have checkpoints.
A. 1, 2
B. 1, 3,
C. 1, 3, 4
D. 2, 3, 4
E. 1, 5
6. In cloning the first mammal, researchers used a mammary cell as the nuclear donor
and fused it with an enucleated egg (cell with nucleus removed). Which of the
following is CORRECT? (1 point)
A. The mammary cell was in G1 phase
B. The mammary cell was in G2 phase
C. The mammary cell was in S phase
D. The mammary cell was in M phase
E. The mammary cell was in G0 phase
7.
Cyanobacteria (blue-green algae) are a group of very important bacteria that perform
photosynthesis. Which of the following is/are TRUE about cyanobacteria. (1 point)
8.
In creating golden rice that produces betacarotenes in rice kernels, the genes
responsible for betacarotene synthesis are transformed. Which of the following
is/are true? (1 point)
A. 1, 3, 5
B. 1, 2
C. 2, 4
D. 2
E. 4
11. Which of the following graphs correctly displays the relationship of blood flow
velocity in humans as the blood flows from the aorta arteries arterioles
capillaries venules veins venae cavae: (1 point)
12. Lowering the level of a hedge with a hedge trimmer stimulates the hedge to become
bushy because: (1 point)
A. It stimulates the production of ethylene gas.
B. Removing the apical meristems makes more auxin, which stimulates lateral
branch buds to grow.
C. Removing the apical meristems makes less ethylene, which stimulates lateral
branches to grow
D. Removing the apical meristems results in less auxin, which then allows lateral
branches to grow.
E. Removing the lateral buds results in apical dominance under the influence of
cytokinins
10
A. 1, 3, 5,
B. 3, 4, 5
C. 4, 5
D. 2
E. 3
14. For terrestrial and most aquatic environments, neither animal nor plant life could exist
without the metabolic "services" provided by: (1 point)
A.
chemoheterotrophs
B.
extremophile archaeans
C.
Fungi
D.
Homo sapiens
E.
Fertilizer
11
15. The inner ear of humans, and most other mammals, is sensitive to body position and
balance. What organ(s) is/are responsible for this? (1 point)
A.
cochlea
B.
C.
semicircular canals
D.
E.
16. Flukes are often parasites in or on another animals. They could cause diseases in
human beings. Blood fluke (Schistosoma mansoni) is a parasitic trematode that
infects men. Which one of the following is NOT true about its life cycles. (1 point)
12
17. In animal behavior a sign stimulus could trigger a fixed action pattern (FAP). Which
of the following is NOT an example of sign stimulus-FAP? (1 point)
A.
Some moths fold their wings and drop to the ground when they detect an
ultrasonic signal from bats.
B.
C.
A newly hatched bird cheeping loudly in begging for food when its parent
returns to nest.
D.
18. Some birds (eg Gulls) feed on mollusks. The birds grasp the prey and fly upwards to
a certain height before they drop the prey onto a rock to break the shells. If the shell
was not broken by the first drop, the birds will pick it up and drop it again until it is
broken. In one experiment, researchers found the following relationship between the
drop heights and the number of times it was dropped before the shell broke. (1 point)
Height of drop (m)
1
2
3
4
5
6
12
According to the optimal foraging theory, which of the following is the most likely height
that the birds would fly to drop the shells?
13
A. 6.5 m
B. 4.5 m
C. 2.5 m
D. 3.5 m
E. 12.5 m
19. The figure below shows cytological and biochemical changes of a human infected by
HIV. There are three curves in the figure labeled as 1 through 3. Which of the
following is CORRECT? (1 point)
14
20. The figure below shows a generalized life cycle of fungi. Which of the following
is/are TRUE? (1 point)
15
A. 1, 2,
B. 1, 3
C. 1, 4
D. 1, 2, 4
E. 1, 3, 4
16
22. What is the effect of ATP or AMP on the reaction rate? (1 point)
A. Only allosteric Stimulation
B. Only allosteric inhibition
C. Only competitive inhibition
D. Only uncompetitive inhibition
E. Mixed inhibition
17
23. Does this phosphofructokinase play an important role in the regulation of glycolysis
in Pyrococcus furiosus? (1 point)
A. Yes
B. No
C. The conclusion cannot be drawn.
24. Pyrococcus furiosus phosphofructokinase was purified and gave a single band at 52
kDa on SDS-polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis. Its native molecular mass was
determined by gel filtration chromatography to be approximately 190 kDa. The protein
is: (1 point)
A. monomer
B. dimer
C. trimer
D. tetramer
E. hexamer
18
25. Match the following names or descriptions to the right biochemical compounds listed.
(2 points)
Answer
[A-G]
1.
2.
3.
4. Monosaccharide
4.
5. Iron-sulfur center
5.
19
Answer
(A-E)
C. DNA replication
1. Polymyxins
2. Tetracycline
D. RNA transcription
3. Rifampin
4. Penicillin
E. Protein translation
5. Mitomycin
27. Glucose labeled with 14C at C-1 is incubated with the glycolytic enzymes and
necessary cofactors. What is the distribution of 14C in the pyruvate that is formed? (1
point)
A. The label is in the methyl carbon atom of pyruvate.
B. The label is in the carboxyl carbon atom of pyruvate.
C. The label is in both the methyl and carboxyl carbon atoms of pyruvate.
D. The label is in the middle carbonyl carbon atom of pyruvate.
20
28. A common component of NADP, NAD, FMN, FAD, and coenzyme A is: (1 point)
A. A pyrimidine ring
B. A three ring structure
C. An ADP
D. Deoxyribose
E. A triphosphate group
29. Which of the following statements is/are CORRECT? (1 point)
(1) The citric acid cycle (Krebs/TCA cycle) does not exist as such in plants and
bacteria, because its functions are performed by the glyoxylate cycle.
(2) The citric acid cycle oxidizes the acetyl CoA derived from fatty acid
degradation.
(3) The citric acid cycle produces most of the CO2 in anaerobic organisms.
(4) The citric acid cycle provides succinyl CoA for the synthesis of carbohydrates.
(5) The citric acid cycle provides carbon skeletons for amino acid synthesis.
A.
1, 2, 5,
B.
3, 5,
C.
2, 4
D.
2, 3,
E.
2, 5
21
30. Key enzymatic differences between liver, kidney, muscle and brain account for their
differences in the utilization of metabolic fuels. Which of the following does NOT
represent such a biochemical difference? (1 point)
A. The liver contains glucose 6-phosphatase, whereas muscle and the brain do not.
Hence muscle and the brain, in contrast with the liver, do not release glucose
into the blood.
B. The liver has little of the transferase needed to activate acetoacetate to
acetoacetyl CoA. Consequently, acetoacetate and 3-hydroxybutyrate are
exported by the liver and be used by heart muscle, skeletal muscle and the brain.
C. Under conditions of prolonged starvation, the fatty acids stored in the adipose
tissues will be converted into ketone bodies there before being transported to the
brain and muscle for complete oxidation.
D. Lactate dehydrogenase does not appear to exist in the heart muscle. As a result,
the heart depends on aerobic oxidation to obtain the energy for its continuous
pumping.
22
31. An organelle in eukaryotic cell is spherical or ovoid with a diameter of 0.1 to 1.5 m
and consists of a single membrane. It participates in a variety of metabolic processes,
including H2O2-based respiration and lipid metabolism. This organelle is most likely to
be? (1 point)
A. Mitochondrion
B. Peroxisome
C. Endoplasmic reticulum
D. Lysosome
E. Endosome
32. A red alga has two major kinds of photosynthetic pigments: phycobilisomes
(phycobilins) that absorb green light and chlorophylls that absorb red and blue light.
A student performed an experiment and obtained measurement data as shown in table.
Note: light intensity remained constant during the experiment.
Light quality
28
65
47
150
73
146
23
24
33. The figure below shows the nitrogen cycle. Complete the table below according
to the information provided. (1 point)
Bacteria:
Answer:
A through E. Note: there could be more
than one correct answer
25
34. A researcher found that seeds from a plant could inhibit the growth of some fungi.
He isolated some substances from the seeds and performed analyses. The figure
below is the result. He also ran a regular SDS-gel electrophoresis that separated
molecular standard proteins from 14 kDa to 100 kDa.
26
He found no protein could be detected in this molecular mass range with Coomassie stain
(a protein stain) even though the substance(s) showed Coomassie binding in solution.
The substance(s) is colourless, but had a strong absorption in the UV region. Which of
the following is/are correct? (2 point)
A. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
B. 1, 2, 4
C. 1, 3, 4
D. 1, 4
E. 1, 5
35.
Calculate the pI (isoelectric point) value of aspartic acid. Its pK1 is 2.09, pK2 is
3.86, pK3 is 9.82. (1 point)
A. 5.26
B. 2.98
C. 5.96
D. 6.84
27
36. When we refer to a plant as a short-day plant, the exact meaning is: (1 point)
37. Which of the following is the photoreceptor that responds to day-length? (1 point)
A.
Chlorophyll
B.
Carotenoids
C.
Cytochrome
D.
Phytochrome
E.
Retinal
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
28
(2)
(3)
(4)
Pollen from one plant will only develop a pollen tube on its own stigma if
a pollen from another plant is present on the stigma.
(5)
Pollen from one plant will develop a pollen tube on its own stigma, but
will not be able to fertilize the egg.
A. 1, 2
B. 3, 4, 5
C. 4, 5
D. 3
E. 3, 5
29
40. Where do you find cells that undergo meiosis in plants? (1 point)
A. In the shoot apical meristem
B. In the pollen
C. In embryo sacs
D. In the corolla
E. In the ovule
41. Which of the following structures of plants consists of haploid cells? (1 point)
A. Sporophytes
B. Sporocytes
C. Sporangia
D. Tapetum
E. Gametophyte
Questions 42-45. Algae play very important roles in ecosystems. They are also diverse
in pigmentation.
42. Red algae differ from green algae and brown algae in that (1 point)
A. Red algae produce agar
B. Red algae do not produce chlorophyll a
C. Red algae do not have sexual reproduction
D. No unicellular red alga has been found
E. Red algae do not produce flagellated cells in their life cycle.
30
43. Dinoflagellates are a group of algae. Their pigments are similar to brown algae.
Therefore, the pigments of a typical dinoflagellate are similar to: (1 point)
A. Pigments of Chlamydomonas
B. Pigments of Volvox
C. Pigments of a diatom
D. Pigments of a red alga
E. Pigments of blue-green algae
44. According to their pigmentation, which algal group would be most likely to perform
photosynthesis in deepest water? (1 point)
A.
Red algae
B.
Green Algae
C.
Brown algae
D.
Golden algae
31
45.
Seaweeds are large marine algae and they play very important role in marine
ecosystems. Which of the following is/are NOT true about seaweeds? (1 point)
A. 1, 2, 3, 4,
B. 2, 3, 4, 5,
C. 1, 3, 4, 5,
D. 1, 2, 4, 5
E. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
46.
Apoptosis was first described in nematodes and was later found to be present in
many organisms. Which of the following is NOT true about apoptosis? (1 point)
A. It was discovered by cell lineage analysis of nematodes
B. It is a critical process in animal development.
C. It is controlled by a single gene
D. It is found in insects
E. Proteases and nucleases participate in apoptosis.
32
47.
Answer A or B
1. cytoskeletal proteins
2. Mitchondrial proteins
3. Lysosomal proteins
4. Nuclear proteins
5. Cytoplasmic enzymes
6. integral plasma membrane
(cell surface) proteins
7. secreted proteins
8. Chloroplast proteins
9. Peroxisomal protein
48.
B.
C.
D.
E.
33
49. The resting potential in most neurons is primarily due to the membrane permeability
of (1 point)
A. Calcium
B. Chloride
C. Sodium
D. Potassium
E. Magnesium
50. Which of the following cell cycle phases is usually the shortest in duration? (1 point)
A. G1
B. G0
C. G2
D. S
E. M
34
51. Which of the following is/are often used for protein purification? (1 point)
(1) Gel filtration chromatography
(2) Ion exchange chromatography
(3) Salt precipitation
(4) SDS-electrophoresis
(5) Substrate affinity chromatography
A. all of the above
B. 1, 2, 3, 4,
C. 1, 2, 4, 5
D. 1, 2, 3, 5
E. 2, 3, 4, 5
35
A. 1, 2, 3, 4,
B. 3, 4, 5,
C. 1, 2,
D. 3, 4
E. 3
54. Which of the following about tRNA is/are correct? (1 point)
(1) There are stem-loop structures
(2) It consumes ATP in synthesis of aminoacyl tRNA
(3) tRNA is synthesized by RNA polymerase III
(4) tRNA is synthesized as a precursor and was processed before it is
functional.
(5) Although the theoretical number of tRNA molecules is 61, the actually
number of tRNA molecules in most of the cell is smaller, partially because
some anticodons can recognize more than one codon.
36
A. 1, 2, 3
B. 1, 2, 4
C. 1, 2, 5
D. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5,
E. 2, 3, 4, 5
55. Which of the following is/are NOT true about the Freeze-fracture method in electron
microscopy? (1 point)
(1) Low temperature is used to weaken hydrogen bonding.
(2) It is often used to observe structures within membrane.
(3) Particles observed on fractured faces are often liposomes
(4) Both eukaryotic and prokaryotic cells can be observed with this
method
(5) This method actually observes a replica of the specimen.
A. 1, 3
B. 2
C. 3, 4,
D. 4,5
E. 3
37
Questions 56-57. Yeast is one of the ideal organisms for the study of cellular,
developmental and genetic processes. It can grow either on fermentable or nonfermentable carbon sources. With this property, people can isolate and analyze different
yeast mutants associated with certain functions of subcellular organelles.
56. When the yeast mutant cannot grow on oleate (a long chain fatty acid), the mutant has
a defect in which organelle? (1 point)
A. Mitochondria
B. Lysosome
C. Peroxisome
D. Nucleus
E. Endoplasmic reticulum
57. When a yeast mutant cannot grow on glycerol, the mutant has a defect in which
organelle? (1 point)
A. Mitochondria
B. Lysosome
C. Peroxisome
D. Nucleus
E. Endoplasmic reticulum
38
58. Which of the following is NOT a factor influencing membrane fluidity? (1 point)
A. Number of double bonds in the lipids
B. Temperature
C. Flip-flop movement of lipids
D. Cholesterol
Questions 59-61 are about food digestion in the mammalian digestive system.
59. Which of the following is NOT involved directly in protein digestion? (1 point)
A. Trypsin
B. Dipeptidase
C. Aminopeptidase
D. Carboxypeptidase
E. Enteropeptidase
60. Which of the following enzymes is NOT functionally present in small intestine? (1
point)
A. Nucleases
B. Lipase
C. Chymotrypsin
D. Pancreatic amylases
E. Pepsin
39
61. Many hormones are involved in food digestion and absorption. Please match the
functions to the appropriate hormones. (1 point)
A. Regulation of blood sugar
B. Stimulation of bicarbonate release
C. Stimulation of the gallbladder to contract and release bile
D. Stimulation of secretion of gastric juice.
Hormones
1. Cholecystokinin
(CCK)
2. Gastrin
3. Secretin
4. Insulin
40
In this model, a sepal is produced when gene A is active, a petal is produced when genes
A and B are active; Stamen is produced when genes B and C are active and a carpel is
produced when gene C is active. When gene A is missing, gene C takes its place and
when gene C is missing, gene A takes gene Cs place.
62. According to the ABC model, which of the following mutants will produce the
phenotype shown below? (1 point)
41
64. PCR (polymerase chain reaction) is one of the most powerful methods in molecular
biology. Which of the following is/are NOT true about PCR? (1 point)
(1) Primers are needed in PCR
(2) A DNA polymerase that can tolerate high temperature is needed in PCR
(3) ATP is needed in PCR
(4) A DNA template is needed in PCR
42
A. 1, 2
B. 2, 3
C. 3
D. 1, 3,
E. 2, 4
65. Nitrogenous wastes of animals are released to their environments in different
forms. Which of the following statements is/are true about animal nitrogenous wastes?
(1 point)
(1) Urea is excreted by many marine fishes.
(2) Ammonia is so toxic that it is rarely excreted as nitrogenous waste by any
animals
(3) The animals in dry environments could excrete uric acid
(4) The form of nitrogenous waste is often an adaptation to animal habitats.
A. 1, 2, 3, 4
B. 1, 4,
C. 1, 2, 4
D. 3, 4
E. 1, 3, 4
43
66. Among the nitrogenous wastes, urea, uric acid and ammonia the order of toxicity
is: (1 point)
A. Ammonia > uric acid > urea
B. Urea > ammonia > uric acid
C. Uric acid > urea > ammonia
D. Ammonia > urea > uric acid
E. Urea > ammonia > uric acid
F. Uric acid > urea > ammonia
44
Where [M] is the concentration of free protein (no bound ligand) in the dialysis
tube, [L] is the concentration of the ligand and [ML] is the concentration of the
protein with bound ligand. Therefore, KD is the ligand concentration when [M]
equals [ML]. [MT] = [M] + [ML].
Where [MT] is the total concentration of the protein
The table below shows the measurement results of a calcium-binding protein.
The protein has a molecular mass of 20 kDa and the concentration of the protein
in equilibrium dialysis is 1 mg.ml-1.
45
Calcium concentration in
Calcium concentration
20
30
50
68
100
129
200
237
400
442
600
647
1000
1050
1500
1548
2000
2049
[M]/[MT]
Please calculate the values of [M]/[MT] at each concentration and plot the data
(Calcium concentration in solution vs [M]/[MT]) on the plotting (graph) paper
shown below.
46
67. How many calcium ions does one protein molecule bind? (1 point)
A. 1
B. 2
C. 3
D. 4
E. It cannot be determined
47
48
A. 1, 2, 5
B. 2, 4,
C. 3, 4
D. 4, 5
E. 3, 5
70. Which of the following are amniotes? (1 point)
(1) Bony fishes (Osteichthyes)
(2) Reptiles (Reptilia)
(3) Cartilagenous fish (Chondrichthyes)
(4) Jawless fish (Agnatha)
(5) Mammals (Mammalia)
(6) Amphibians (Amphibia)
(7) Birds (Aves)
A. 1, 4, 6, 7
B. 2, 3, 5
C. 2, 5, 7
D. 2, 4, 5, 6
E. 2, 5, 6, 7
F. 4, 5, 6, 7
G. 5, 6, 7
49
71. The figure below shows schematic structures of an amniotic egg. Please name the
structures labelled by numbers 1 through 7. (1 point)
A. amnion B. embryo C. allantois D. chorion. E. yolk sac. F. gut G. allantois cavity
Answer
A-G
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
72. Fill in the appropriate answers based on the functions of the structures shown in the
figure above (question 71). (1 point)
Main Function
Answer:
A-G
50
Answer: A-F
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
74. Fill in appropriate answers according to organs of excretion and gas exchange.
(1 point)
A. Excretion with Malpighian tubules and gas exchange with tracheal system.
B. Excretion with Malpighian tubules and coxal gland, gas exchange with tracheal
system.
C. Excretion with maxillary gland and gas exchange with gill and tracheal system.
D. Excretion with Malpighian tubules and coxal gland, gas exchange with book lung
E. Excretion with Malpighian tubules and coxal gland, gas exchange with book lung
and tracheal system
F. Excretion with maxillary gland and gas exchange with gill.
Answer
A-F
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
51
75. If you are provided with two electron microscopic pictures, one from pancreas gland
cells and the other from endothelial cells from the proximal tubule of a kidney
nephron. Which of the structure shown in the figure will be more developed in the
pancreas gland cell? (1 point)
52
76. As the cells grow, the surface area of each cell increases. Which structure is the
location where the lipids are synthesized for plasma membrane (cell surface)
synthesis? (1 point)
77. If you treat the cells for a short period of time with 3H-Uracil followed by detecting
the labelled cellular structure with autoradiography, which structure will have the
highest concentration of silver grains (strongest labelling)? (1 point)
78. Which structure is assembled in the nucleus and then transported to cytoplasm?
(1 point)
53
80. Which structure would be the site for initial glycosylation of EPO? (1 point)
Answer: choose one from A through G.
81. Which structure would be the site for final glycosylation of EPO? (1 point)
82. Which structure is essential for the transport of EPO inside the cell? (1 point)
83. The receptor for EPO is a membrane bound protein. Which structure is responsible
for EPOs receptor synthesis? (1 point)
84. Which structure has the ability to synthesize some proteins that are not encoded by
nucleus. (1 point)
54
END of PART I
55
THEORY EXAMINATION
Part 2
56
Questions 85-92. Sex determination in fruit flies and mammals are both XY type, that is,
XX leads to female and XY leads to male.
85. Some organisms have abnormal sex chromosomes such as XO (only have one X
chromosome) or XXY (extra X chromosome). The most likely cause of the
abnormal sex chromosome is: (1 point)
A. An error occurred in mitosis of the fertilized egg.
B. Gene mutation
C. An error occurred in meiosis during gamete formation.
D. Sex chromosomes in gametes are either lost or doubled in fertilization.
86. In organisms with XXY chromosome type, there is an extra X chromosome. How do
you most conveniently determine if this X chromosome is from sperm or egg? (1 point)
A. Karyotype
B. In situ hybridization
C. RFLP (Restriction fragment length polymorphism)
D. DNA sequencing
57
87. In mammals, XO leads to female and XXY leads to male. In fruit flies, XO leads to
male and XXY leads to female. Which of the following is NOT correct? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
88. In mammals with abnormal sex chromosomes, the number of individuals with XO
chromosome type is far fewer than the number of individuals with the XXY
chromosome type. It is therefore predicted that: (1 point)
A. The individuals with the XO chromosome type are less capable of surviving than
those with the XXY chromosome type.
B. The individuals with XO chromosome type are less capable of reproducing than
that with XXY chromosome type.
C. The difference is related to gender of the individuals (XO leads to female and
XXY leads to male).
D. None of the above.
58
89. In both fruit flies and mammals, XX leads to female and XY leads to male. The gene
products encoded by two X chromosomes of female individuals are nearly identical to
those encoded by one X chromosome of male individuals. This is accomplished by
gene dosage compensation. In mammals, it is accomplished by converting one X
chromosome into a Barr body (X inactivation). Which of the following about the Barr
body is/are correct? (1 point)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
90. No Barr body can be observed in normal female fruit flies because (1 point)
59
91. The fur color of cats is determined by genes on the X chromosome. XA is the
dominant allele for orange fur, while Xa is the recessive allele for black fur. Which of the
following is true about the fur color of the offsprings from a XAXa female cat and XAY
male cat? (1 point)
92. One of the genes controlling sweat glands in humans is located on the X chromosome.
Two twin sisters show different phenotypes of the sweat gland. One has no sweat
glands on her left arm while the other has sweat glands on her left arm. Which of the
following statements is/are TRUE? (1 point)
60
A. 1, 2, 3, 4
B. 1
C. 2, 3
D. 3
E. 2, 3, 4
93. Mycorrhizae are symbiotic associations of fungi and plant roots. Which of the
following is/are TRUE about mycorrhizae? (1point)
(1) They are often harmful to plant roots while beneficial to fungi.
(2) They are often beneficial to plants but harmful to fungi
(3) They are helpful for plants to absorb water and minerals.
(4) They could even help the older root region above the root hair area to supply
minerals to plants.
A. 1, 3, 4
B. 2, 3, 4
C. 3, 4
D. 3
61
94. Complete the following sentence: Stomata of a plant open when guard cells (1point)
A. accumulate water by active transport.
B. sense an increase in CO2 in the air spaces of the leaf.
C. become more turgid because of an influx of K+, followed by the osmotic entry of
water.
D. sense that water content of the whole plant is low.
96. If N represents population size, r represents the difference in per capita birth rates and
death rates, K represents the carrying capacity, t represents time, which of the
following equations best describes logarithmic growth of the population? (1point)
62
97. Which of the following is usually the limiting process of phosphorous cycles? (1point)
A. Decomposition
B. Utilization in primary production
C. Release from soil
D. Sedimentation
98. Which of the following ecosystems has the lowest primary production per square
meter? (1point)
A. a salt marsh
B. an open ocean
C. a grassland
D. a tropical rain forest
63
99. Which of the following is/are true about Archaea and Eubacteria? (1point)
(1) They dont have a nuclear envelope
(2) They both have branched chains in membrane lipids
(3) They have one kind of RNA polymerase
(4) They have circular chromosomes.
A. 1, 2, 4
B. 1, 4
C. 2, 3
D. 1, 2, 3
100. Four major groups of fungi are recognized. They are chytrids, zygote fungi, sac
fungi and club fungi. Chytrids differ from other three groups in that (1point)
A. Chytrids dont have sexual reproduction
B. They are all aquatic.
C. They have cell walls made of cellulose
D. They have flagellated cells in their life cycles.
64
101. Chlorophyll a is involved in both light energy absorption and initial electron transfer
of photosynthesis. Which of the following are true about the chlorophyll a? (1point)
65
103. The figure shown below is a diagram of an evolutionary tree. Which of the
following statements about evolution are true and deducible from the figure? (2 points)
66
(9) Bacteria are a highly homogenous group of organisms which showed rapid
diversification of their genomes and metabolisms during the last billion years.
(10) Chloroplasts and mitochondria are results of independent endosymbiotic events.
A. 1, 2, 5
B. 3, 4, 7
C. 4, 7, 10
D. 6, 8, 10
E. 4, 9, 10
67
104. The figure shown below is an image of a DNA molecule. Structure of the DNA
molecule can undergo dramatic and highly regulated changes during the cell cycle.
Which of the following statements are true about the cross-like structure on the image.
(2 points)
(1)
During the replication all four DNA strands in the double helix are covalently
interconnected.
(2)
In the prophase of the mitosis chromosomes highly condense and get interconnected
via covalent bonds.
(3)
During the prophase of the first meiotic division recombination between sister
chromatids takes place and new covalent bonds are temporarily formed which results
in the formation of the cross-like conformation of the DNA.
(4)
68
(5)
During the prophase of the first meiotic division recombination between homologous
chromosomes takes place and new covalent bonds are temporarily formed which
results in the cross-like conformation of the DNA.
(6)
Cross-like structures of the DNA molecules could be observed in the nucleus of the
B-cells and T-lymphocytes during their development.
(7)
Figure shows situation in the cytosol of the bacterial cell where translation and
transcription are not separated spatially.
(8)
Some viruses use formation of the cross-like structures to integrate into the host
chromosomes.
(9)
In the apoptotic cells DNA is cleaved and finally forms unusual cross-like
conformation - useful marker of the final stages of the programmed cell death.
(10) Figure shows unusual type of the replication in the Archaebacteria when three double
helixes are formed from one precursor DNA double helix.
A. 5, 6, 8
B. 1, 3, 8
C. 6, 8, 10
D. 2, 7, 9
E. 4, 6, 10
69
105. The Siamese cat is an example of an animal with melanin synthesized in both sexes
mostly at the body extremities. That makes snout, ears, tail and feet much darker
than the rest of the body. Explanation of this type of the body coloration is that:
(1 point)
A. Only at the body extremities the enzyme tyrosinase (responsible for the synthesis
of the melanin) is synthesized.
B. The only places where one of the X chromosomes that have the dominant gene of
the tyrosinase is NOT inactivated
C. Melanin is synthesized only in the colder parts of the body because the Siamese
cat has a temperature sensitive gene for the enzyme producing melanin.
D. Melanocytes are localized only at the snout, ears, tail and feet the rest of the
body lacks melanocytes.
E. The body extremities are more exposed to the UV-radiation which stimulates
production of the melanin.
70
106. Retinoblastoma (Rb) and p53 genes are examples of anti-oncogenes (tumour
suppressors). Which of the following statements is TRUE? (1 point)
A. Mutation in the p53 gene (when p53 lost its regulatory function) can stop the cell
cycle.
B. Overproduction of the Rb protein in the retina can cause cancer.
C. Cells with a mutated p53 gene are predisposed to malignancy.
D. Cells with a mutated Rb gene are resistant to malignancy.
E. Various viruses incorporated homologs of the p53 and Rb genes into their genomes
and use these proteins for the transformation of the host cell.
107. The extracellular matrix is responsible for the mechanoelastical properties of the
tissues. Which of the following molecules is NOT a component of the extracellular
matrix: (1 point)
A. elastin
B. cytokeratin
C. laminin
D. collagen
E. chondroitin sulphate
71
108. Prions are unique infectious agents formed only from protein called PrP. What are
the true statements about prions? (1 point)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
prion disease are restricted only man, cow and sheep - because only these
species express PrP
(6)
prions are small viruses with symmetrical capsid without DNA or RNA
(7)
prion disease is highly infectious and could be transmitted via body fluids
(8)
(9)
mouse with genetic knock-out for the PrP is resistant to the prion disease
(10)
A. 1, 4, 6, 7
B. 2, 3, 4, 5
C. 2, 3, 8, 9
D. 4, 6, 8, 9
E. 1, 3, 9, 10
72
109. Algae were supplied with a radioactive isotope of Carbon, 14C, and allowed to
photosynthesise. After a period of time, the light was switched off and the algae
were left in the dark. The graph shows the relative amount of some radioactive
labelled compounds over the period of the experiment. (1 point)
Which line represents the amount of glycerate 3-phosphate (3GP), ribulose biphosphate
(RuBP) and sucrose formed? (1 point)
Fill out the correct letter of the line in the correct box.
Compound
Line
(1) 3GP
(2) RuBP
(3) Sucrose
73
110. Methylene blue acts as a hydrogen acceptor. It is blue in its oxidised state, but goes
colourless when it is reduced by accepting hydrogen atoms. (1 point)
Methylene blue + hydrogen reduced methylene blue
(blue)
(colorless)
A student wishes to investigate this reaction, he prepares four test tubes as shown below:
Tube A
Tube B
Tube C
Tube D
2 ml
2 ml
2 ml
Glucose solution
2 ml
2 ml
2 ml
1 ml
1 ml
1 ml
Yeast solution
2 ml
2 ml
2 ml
Distilled water
All tubes were incubated at a temperature of 30 C. The colour was recorded at the start
and after intervals of 5 and 15 minutes. The results are shown in the following table.
Colour of content
At start
Tube A
Tube B
Tube C
Tube D
Blue
Blue
Blue
colourless
After 5 minutes
colourless
Blue
Blue
colourless
After 15 minutes
colourless
Blue
Pale blue
colourless
Which test tube can be characterized as a control in this investigation and which test tube
generates an irrelevant (useless) result? (1 point)
Fill out the correct letter below
74
Tube
(1) Control
(2) Useless
111. Morgan crossed Drosophila of two known genotypes, BbVv x bbvv, where B, the
wild-type (grey) body, is dominant over b (black body) and V (wild-type wing) is
dominant over v (vestigial, a very small wing). Morgan expected to see four
phenotypes in a ratio 1:1:1:1. But he observed:
Wild type:
965
Black vestigial:
944
Grey vestigial:
206
Black normal:
185
These results were explained by assuming linkage of alleles together with genetic
recombination (crossing over).
In this particular example the recombinant frequency (defined as the ratio of
recombinants in relation to the total offspring) is: (1 point)
A. 0.205
B. 0.170
C. 0.108
D. 0.900
E. 0.080
75
112. 70% of the population of Beijing is able to taste phenylthiocarbamide. The ability to
taste (T, taster) is dominant over the inability to taste (t, non-taster).
What percentage of the offspring of 'tasters' will be non-tasters? (2 points)
A. 25%
B. 15%
C. 13%
D. 20%
E. 7.5%
Questions 113-116. Wild type individuals of Drosophila have red eyes and strawcoloured bodies. A recessive allele of a single gene in Drosophila causes glass eye and a
recessive allele of a different gene causes ebony body.
A student crosses pure breeding wild type flies with pure breeding flies having glass eye
and ebony body and the resulting F1 flies showed all the wild type phenotype for both
features. On crossing the F1 flies among themselves the student expect a 9:3:3:1 ratio but
the results are not like that. The actual offspring showed:
Eye
Body
Number of flies in F2
Wild
Wild
164
Wild
Ebony
37
Glass
Wild
59
Glass
Ebony
28
76
You are required to check this applying the 2 (chi square) test.
For this situation, e.g. degree of freedom, the following diagram with 2 values should be
used:
77
Question 115. Determine the probability that the deviation of the observed results from
expected results is due to chance alone. (1 point)
A. About 1%
B. About 2%
C. About 5%
D. About 8%
78
Question 116. To explain the observed deviation of the 9:3:3:1 ratio the student suggested
some possibilities.
(1) linkage of both the alleles
(2) crossing over
(3) incomplete dominance
Which combination of suggestions is the correct explanation? (1 point)
A. 1, 2
B. 1, 3
C. 2, 3
D. 1, 2, 3
117. Which of the following diagram shows the correct representation of the urea content
in the urine of a person on hunger strike, who then died. (1 point)
79
118. Wilhelm von Osten gave performances with his horse called smart Hans. He stated
that he taught his horse to make calculations. But in fact this isnt true at all. He had
taught the horse to respond to his hidden but triggering signals. As a result the
horse made the desired movements: swinging the correct number of times with his
foreleg. After that the horse got some reward.
What kind of learning behaviour is this? (1 point)
A. adaptation
B. conditioning
C. habituation
D. imitation
E. imprinting
F. insight
G. Fixed action pattern
80
119. A snail crawling across a board will withdraw into its shell when you drop a marble
on the board. Repetition of dropping marble will lead to a weaker withdraw action
and in the end the snail will ignore the marble dropping. Which of the following
terms do apply for the disappearance of the withdraw action? (1 point)
(1) adaptation
(2) conditioning
(3) habituation
(4) imprinting
(5) insight
(6) learned behaviour
(7) ritualisation
(8) trial and error
A. 1, 3
B. 2, 4
C. 3, 6
D. 4, 5
E. 5, 6
81
120. Bonsai trees need water with a very low lime content. Which types of water could
be used to water them? (1 point)
(1)
(2)
Rain water
(3)
(4)
Tap water with high water hardness treated by leaving it over night with a
mix of peat and crushed stones and filtrating it before use
(5)
Molten snow
1, 5
2, 5
1, 3
4, 5
2, 4, 5
121. Observe the diagrams 1 to 4 representing cross sections of the ovaries of different
flowers.
Match the numbers in front of the placentation type (A-D) with the corresponding
diagram.
82
A. Axile placentation.
B. free central placentation.
C. Marginal placentation.
D. Parietal placentation.
Match the number with correct placenta type. (1 point)
type
Answer
1
2
3
4
83
122. Which curve shows the correct time course of the production of saliva in a human
after the intake of citric acid? (1 point)
Level of
Saliva
Produced
D
E
Time
84
M1
M1
M2
M3
M4
F1
F2
F3
F4
2
5
1
0
3
7
77
95
M2
2
0
9
9
75
1
2
98
M3
5
0
0
0
0
78
6
89
M4
1
9
0
80
8
0
0
98
F1
0
9
0
80
7
0
0
96
F2
3
75
0
8
7
0
0
93
F3
7
1
78
0
0
0
7
93
F4
77
2
6
0
0
0
7
95
98
89
98
96
93
93
92
92
Several months later the same animals were observed again yielding the following values.
M1
M1
M2
M3
M4
F1
F2
F3
F4
4
8
2
1
4
11
60
90
M2
4
0
12
12
65
1
5
99
M3
8
0
0
0
1
62
9
80
M4
2
12
0
70
14
0
1
99
F1
1
12
0
70
10
0
1
94
F2
4
65
1
14
10
0
3
97
F3
11
1
62
0
0
0
10
84
F4
60
5
9
1
1
3
10
90
99
80
99
94
97
84
89
89
During the following years these values tended to remain the same.
123. Analyze the tables and determine the mating system of the Humboldt penguins.
(1 point)
A. promiscuity
B. polyandry
C. polygyny
D. monogamy
85
124. Which is the most common polygamous relationship in these penguins? (1 point)
A. promiscuity
B. polyandry
C. polygyny
D. monogamy
86
A. 1, 2, 5
B. 1, 5
C. 2, 5
D. 1, 2, 6
E. 2, 5, 7
127. The diagram shows a section through a mammalian ovary. The numbers indicate
different stages of development. (1 point)
Choose the correct sequence of numbers in which the structures develop.
A. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
B. 5, 4, 3, 2, 1
C. 5, 2, 4, 1, 3
D. 5, 2, 4, 3, 1
E. 2, 4, 1, 3, 5
87
Questions 128-131. PKU and albinism are two autosomal recessive disorders, unlinked
in the human. If a normal couple produced a boy with both disorders and they want to
have the second child:
128. What is the chance of the second child having PKU? (1 point)
A.1/2
B. 1/4
C. 2/3
D. 1/16
129. What is the chance of the second child having both traits? (1 point)
A. 1/2
B. 1/4
C. 1/8
D. 1/16
130. What is the chance of the second child having either PKU or albinism? (1 point)
A. 1/2
B 3/4
C. 3/8
D. 3/16
88
A. autosomal recessive
B. autosomal dominant
C. sex-linked recessive
D. sex-linked dominant
89
A. DD
B. Dd
C. dd
D. XdY
E. XDY
134. What is the genotype of II-4? (1 point)
A. DD or XDXD
B. Dd or XDXd
C. dd or XdXd
135. If IV-2 married to a man from an unrelated family, what is the chance to get a
normal child? (1 point)
A. 1/2
B. 2/3
C. 100%
D. Cannot be determined
136. For the alleles D and d, which individual should be homozygous? (1 point)
A. III-1
B. III-2
C. III-4
90
D. III-5
E. III-7
137. If this trait is instead quite common in the population, then what is the chance that
IV-4 is heterozygous? (1 point)
A. 1/2
B. 1/4
C. 2/3
D. 100%
138. There are several types of human blood cells such as erythrocytes and monocytes.
They all come from stem cells. Which of the following is/are correct about the stem
cells of blood cells? (1 point)
(1) B cells come from lymphoid stem cells.
(2) T cells come from lymphoid stem cells.
(3) Erythropoietin stimulates production of erythrocytes from myeloid stem cells.
(4) Neutrophils and basophils are derived from the same stem cells.
(5) Lymphoid stem cells come from myeloid stem cells.
A. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5
B. 1, 2, 3, 4
C. 1, 3
D. 1, 2, 4
91
139. Which of the following role(s) do platelets play in the clotting process? (1 point)
(1) They help to form a plug for protection against blood loss.
(2) They release chemical signals for fibrin formation.
(3) They release chemical signals for reducing blood pressure.
A. 1, 2
B. 1, 2, 3
C. 2, 3
D. 1, 3
140. Which of the following is NOT involved in allergic response in human? (1 point)
A. Histamine.
B. Mast cell.
C. Plasma cell
D. Platelets.
141. There are several sensory receptors in human skin. Which of the following is
located deepest in the skin? (1 point)
A. Sensory receptor for pain.
B. Sensory receptor for cold.
C. Sensory receptor for heat.
D. Sensory receptor for strong pressure.
92
142. A mutant zebra fish has a reduced number of hair cells in the neuromast of its lateral
line system. Which of the following will happen? (1 point)
(1) The mutant fish will not be able to detect depth of water.
(2) The mutant fish will swim slowly.
(3) The mutant fish could not detect the sound of its prey.
(4) The mutant fish will show impaired detection of water movement around its body.
A. 1, 2
B. 3, 4
C. 4
D. 2, 4
143. Hemoglobin is responsible for transporting oxygen from the lungs to the tissues.
The Bohr shift is one of the most important properties of hemoglobin. Which of the
following is NOT true about Bohr shift? (1 point)
A. Additional oxygen is bound by hemoglobin in the lungs when pH decreases.
B. Additional oxygen is released from hemoglobin at a lower pH.
C. CO2 is involved in Bohr shift.
D. Bohr shift helps tissues to obtain more oxygen during exercise.
93
144. Which of the following is/are NOT true about the difference in the digestive tracts of
carnivores and herbivores? (1 point)
(1) Carnivores usually have a bigger stomach.
(2) Carnivores usually have a shorter colon.
(3) Herbivores usually have a longer caecum.
A. 1, 2
B. 1
C. 2, 3
D. 3
Questions 145-148. Hemophilia and color blindness are X-linked recessive traits. When
a color-blind woman is married to a hemophiliac man,
145. What is the chance of their having a normal son? (1 point)
A. 50%
B. 0%, all their sons will suffer from color-blind
C. 0%, all their sons will suffer from hemophilia
D. It depends on the recombinant frequency.
94
146. If their son was married to a woman whose mother was colour-blind and their father
was not colour-blind, what is the chance for them to produce a normal daughter?
(1 point)
A. 0%
B. 50%
C. 75%
D. 100%
147. If their daughter was married to a normal man whose father was color-blind, and
produced 1 normal son, 4 normal daughters, 2 color-blind sons, 2 hemophiliac sons
and 1 color-blind, hemophiliac son, the distance between the two genes is: (1 point)
A. 0.5
B. 0.33
C. 0.2
D. 0.1
148. If they have a color-blind daughter, (1 point)
A. There must be a mutation in her fathers germ line.
B. She must have abnormalities other than color-blind.
C. The chance is less than 1/100,000
D. The chance is about 1/1000
95
Questions 149-152. Huntington disease is a rare fatal disease. People with this disease
start to show symptoms in their 40s. Peters father (John) has Huntington disease.
Johns father (Peters grandfather), who also had this disease, had 11 children (5 sons and
6 daughters). Among them, 6 (3 sons and 3 daughters) of them developed the disease and
five died from it.
149. How is the trait inherited? (1 point)
A. autosomal recessive
B. autosomal dominant
C. sex-linked recessive
D. sex-linked dominant
150. What is the possibility that Peter will also develop the disease? (1 point)
A. 50%
B. 25%
C. 75%
D. 67%
96
151. Peter is married to a normal woman. What is the possibility that their first child will
eventually develop the disease? (1 point)
A. 50%
B. 25%
C. 75%
D. 67%
E. 0
152. If Peters mother-in-law died from the same disease, what is the possibility that their
first child will eventually develop the disease? (1 point)
A. 3/16
B. 4/16
C. 7/16
D. 9/16
E. 12/16
153. Trophic levels are indicated below with numbered lines in the flowchart. Write the
appropriate trophic level name in the space provided next to its number. Write
ONLY the letter of the trophic characteristic. (1 point)
NOTE: Left-hand circle in flowchart is Heat; right-hand circle in flowchart is To
detritivores.
97
1. no answer required
5. __________
2. _________
6. __________
C. tertiary consumers
D. energy in wastes
3. __________
7. __________
E. primary producers
F. primary consumers
4. __________
98
154. Match the biome in the figure below with the appropriate plotted area (a, b, c, d, e, and
f) in the climograph. (1 point)
1. _______ arctic and alpine tundra
2. _______ coniferous forest
3. _______ desert
4. _______ grassland
5. ________ temperate forest
6. ________ tropical forest
155. Referring to the action potential graph below, write the letter (from the graph) that
corresponds to the appropriate action potential action on the right of what is occurring at
that stage of the action potential. (1 point) Note, there could be more than one choice
for each question.
99
156. Molting is a process observed in insects. Which of the following statements is/are
true? (1 point)
(1) The exoskeleton of insects is largely made of protein and chitin.
(2) The structure of chitin is similar to that of bacterial cell wall peptidoglycan.
(3) No enzyme has been found to digest chitin.
(4) Molting can be observed in all arthropods.
(5) The only place that is not covered by exoskeleton is the joints between the body
and walking legs.
100
A. 1, 2, 4, 5
B. 1, 4
C. 1, 3, 4, 5
D. 1, 5
157. The mechanism of molting has largely been revealed. The figure below is a diagram
of such a process. Boxes A, B and C represent 3 different growth hormones and molting
hormones. Fill in the answer boxes by choosing the correct letter. (1 point)
101
Answer: A-C
158. The figure below shows 4 different circulation systems of vertebrates. From left to
right, these are the circulation systems of (1 point)
102
159. Match the numbers shown below with correct structures in the figure in question
above (question158). (1 point)
Answer
A-G
1 Sinus venosus
2. Atrium
3 Pulmonary vein
4 Pulmonary artery
5 Conus arteriosus
6 Right Atrium
7 Left ventricle
103
104
160. Match the following terms with the correct structures shown in the figure. (1 point)
1.
collecting duct
2.
glomerulus
3.
distal tubule
4.
Bowman`s capsule
5.
proximal tubule
6.
ureter
7.
afferent arteriole
Answer
A-G
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
105
161. The substances that are reabsorbed in the proximal tubule is/are: (1 point)
(1) Na+
(2) Cl(3) Water
(4) Glucose
(5) Amino acids
(6) Urea
A.
1, 2, 3
B.
6,
C.
1, 2, 4, 5,
D.
1, 2, 3, 4, 5
E.
4, 5
162. In the kidney, ultrafiltration occurs in which of the following structures? (1 point)
(1) Nephrons
(2) Bowmans capsule
(3) Proximal tubule
(4) Distal tubule
(5) Collecting duct
106
A. 1, 2
B. 2, 3, 4, 5
C. 3, 4, 5
D. 2, 3, 4
E. 1, 2, 3, 4
Questions 163-166. Sensory transduction by a taste receptor is shown in the figure below.
The sequential events of the transduction is labeled by numbers 1 to 7. A portion of the
cell is magnified. Structures A B and C are different channels
107
Potassium channel
B.
Calcium channel
C.
Sodium channel
D.
Neurotransmitter channel
E.
Glycine channel
B.
C.
D.
transports signal molecules into the cell so that the cell starts to
synthesize neurotransmitters.
E.
108
166. Which of the following statements is/are true about the action potentials shown as D
and E in the figure? (1 point)
(1) They were both recorded after and before sugar molecules were present,
respectively.
(2) They were recorded before and after sugar molecules were present,
respectively.
(3) The action potential observed after sugar reception is triggered by an
increase of calcium ions which stimulate neurotransmitter release.
(4) The action potential observed after sugar reception is triggered by an
increase of Potassium ions which stimulate neurotransmitter release.
(5) The action potential is recorded from taste sensory receptor cells.
A. 2, 3
B. 1, 3
C. 2, 4
D. 2, 5
E. 2, 4, 5
109
168. Both snake and weasel hibernate. Which of the following is correct? (1 point)
A. They will die when temperature decreases below the critical temperature.
B. Weasel will die when temperature decreases below the critical temperature.
C. Snake will die and weasel will wake up when the temperature decreases
below the critical temperature.
D. Weasel keeps low body temperature and slow heart rate during the entire
period of hibernation.
169. It is possible to predict bird diversity based on forest types. Which of the following
is most critical to bird diversity for a forest? (1 point)
A. Forest area
B. Vertical stratification
C. Species composition of plants
D. Coniferous or deciduous forests
110
170. Four quantity pyramids (total number of organisms) are shown below. Which is
representative for plant-aphid-ladybug (ladybird)? (1 point)
171. Which of the following ecosystems has the highest net primary productivity? (1
point)
A. Tropical rain forest
B. Open ocean
C. Northern coniferous forest
D. Farm lands
172. The figure below shows the vertical distribution of some parameters (Chlorophyll,
Phosphate, Primary production and Temperature) in the North Pacific during summer.
111
B.
C.
Only about 10% of energy in one link can be converted to organic matters in
next trophic level.
D.
112
174. The figure below shows a membrane potential graph detected after a rod cell of
human eyes sees light. Which of the following is the direct trigger for the hyperpolarization? (1 point)
113
114
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Answer
A
B
D
E
C
C
B
A
E
D
B
D
B
D
C
AC
E
B
B
B
A
C
B
E
B
D
G
F
D
A
B
C
E
C
B
Question
32
33-1
33-2
33-3
33-4
33-5
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47-1
47-2
47-3
47-4
47-5
47-6
47-7
47-8
47-9
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61-1
Part 1
Answer
A
A
E
CD
CD
AB
CD
B
D
D
AE
DE
E
E
E
C
A
A
C
B
B
A
B
B
A
A
B
B
A
D
E
D
D
D
C
A
AC
A
C
E
E
C
Question
61-2
61-3
61-4
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71-1
71-2
71-3
71-4
71-5
71-6
71-7
72-1
72-2
72-3
72-4
73-1
73-2
73-3
73-4
74-1
74-2
74-3
74-4
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
Answer
D
B
A
B
D
BC
E
AD
A
C
E
C
A
F
C
D
B
E
G
A
E
G
C
F
A
B
D
F
B
G
D
F
F
A
C
F
E
Answer
C
C
C
A
D
C
D
E
C
C
B
D
B
B
B
A
C
C
C
B
A
C
B
B
D
B
C
D
B
A
A
G
B
C
E
B
A
D
Question
121-4
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153-1
153-2
153-3
153-4
153-5
153-6
153-7
154-1
154-2
154-3
Part 2
Answer
C
B
D
B
B
E
D
B
D
C
C
B
A
D
D
C
A
B
B
B
B
A
B
C
C
A
B
D
F
E
F
E
A
Question
154-4
154-5
154-6
155-1
155-2
155-3
155-4
156
157-1
157-2
157-3
158
159-1
159-2
159-3
159-4
159-5
159-6
159-7
160-1
160-2
160-3
160-4
160-5
160-6
160-7
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
Answer
B
C
D
E
DE
AF
B
B
A
B
C
D
A
B
F
E
C
G
D
F
B
C
D
E
A
G
D
A
A
B
A
A
C
C
AB
A
C
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Beijing
July 2005
Practical Examination
Part I
Very important notice: you should start task 1 first and while the
gel electrophoresis is running, start and finish task 2.
Important:
Raise the blue card on the bench table to ask for help when you want to use the
electrophoresis power supplies.
Introduction
Plasmids are circular double-stranded DNA molecules, which can exist and replicate
independently in bacterial cells. Restriction enzymes can cut the plasmid DNA into
fragments. In the experiment a plasmid and three restriction enzymes BamHI, PstI and
HindIII are provided. You will use the three restriction enzymes to digest the plasmid
DNA and run agarose gel electrophoresis. You need to determine the restriction
3
enzyme sites and calculate the size of restriction fragments between cutting sites
according to migration distance of DNA fragment, which is inversely correlated to the
logarithm of the length of fragment.
Reagents
Equipment
1. Lab gloves
2. Marker pen
3. 0.5 ml centrifuge tubes
4. Centrifuge tube holder
5. Pipettes
6. Centrifuge
7. Incubator
8. Agarose gel electrophoresis apparatus
4
Using a Pipette:
A 0-10l pipette is provided for the experiment. The volume is adjusted by turning the
setting ring. The digits of the volume display should be read from top to bottom.
After attaching an appropriate tip, press the control button down to the first stop and
insert the tip into the liquid. Slowly release the button until it reaches a complete stop
to aspirate (suck up) the sample. Then, insert the tip with the liquid to the target
places (tubes or wells) and press the button down slowly to the second stop until all
collected liquid is completely expelled from the tip. Eject the used tip to the trash by
pressing the ejector button.
2.
Using a Centrifuge
Press the stop lever down to open the lid. Load tubes into the rotor. Be sure to balance
the load properly. Close and firmly press down the lid until the lid locks into its
position. The rotor will begin spinning when the lid is completely closed. Let the
centrifuge run for 20 seconds. Push the stop lever, open the lid and remove the tubes
after the rotor has stopped spinning.
3.
4.
the samples at 100 volt for 40 min. After 40 minutes call the assistant to turn off the
power supply by raising the blue card. Every competitor will use one electrophoresis
tank, while every 2 competitors share one power supply.
Experimental procedure
1. Label eight 0.5-ml centrifuge tubes 1 through 8 with a marker pen, Add solutions
to each tube as follows:
BamHI (l)
PstI (l)
HindIII (l)
ddH2O (l)
9
9
1
9
8
7
10
2. Mix well and incubate tubes 1-6 at 37C for 15 minutes. Leave tube 7 in the tube
holder. If you found droplets of the solution on the inside tube wall, you may
used the centrifuge to spin them to the bottom of the tube. The centrifuges are
provided on your table.
3. Put the agarose gel (previously prepared for you) into the electrophoresis tank,
pour 1TAE buffer into the tank and let the buffer cover the gel about 3-4mm.
The gel has 10 wells for sample loading.
4. Add 6 l DNA size standards into the No.8 centrifuge tube.
5. Add 3 l of 5X dye to each tube and mix them well.
6. Load 5 l of DNA size standards (tube No. 8) into the First well of the gel. Load
all of your plasmid samples from the second well through to the eighth well in the
order of Table 1. Please note that tube numbers differ from the lane numbers in
which they are loaded. Use a clean tip for each load. Close the cover of the
8
electrophoresis tank. Call the assistant by raising the blue card to turn on the
power supply. Run the samples at 100 volt for 40 min.
(Note: during your waiting time for completion of electrophoresis, please
undertake task 2 and finish it.)
6. After the electrophoresis has run for 40 min, call the assistant to turn off the power
supply by raising the blue card. Wear gloves and take out the gel holder. 8. Put
your gel into the box with your competitors number. Close the lid and leave the
box on the table. A lab assistant will take the gel image and print a copy for you.
Due to time limitation, you will not be able to run your own gel for size analysis.
However, the figure below is an agarose gel profile of DNA fragments, in which an
identical plasmid was digested with the same three DNA restriction enzymes. The
procedure for digestion and loading positions of each digestion in the gel are identical
to the instruction in task 1. Please answer the following questions according to the
profile below.
10
Question 1. How many sites does this plasmid have for PstI, BamHI and HindIII,
respectively? (3 points)
A. PstI:1, BamHI: 0, HindIII : 2.
B. PstI:2, BamHI : 0, HindIII : 2.
C. PstI:2, BamHI : 1, HindIII : 0.
D. PstI:1, BamHI : 1, HindIII : 1.
Question 2. Linear lambda DNA is often digested with restriction enzymes and used
as a molecular standard in running agarose gels. The figure below is a profile of
lambda viral DNA fragments obtained with HindIII digestion. The numbers on the
right side of the gel are fragment sizes in kb.
11
Questions 3-5. The gel profile contains eight bands of DNA size standards in lane 1
and the sizes of the DNA fragments in lane 1 are as follows (in bp, base pairs): 200,
500, 800, 1200, 2000, 3000, 4500, 7000. It is known that migration distance of a
DNA fragment is inversely correlated to the logarithm of the fragment length.
Please plot the logarithm of the DNA fragment sizes (kb) versus the migration
distances (cm) on the plotting (graph) paper below, and calculate the sizes (kb) of
the DNA fragments.
12
Question 3. The size (kb) of the smaller restriction fragment between PstI site &
HindIII site is: (3 points)
A. 2.5
B. 0.8
C. 1.1
D. 0.6
13
Question 4. The size (kb) of the smaller restriction fragment between HindIII site &
BamHI site is: (3 points)
A. 0.8
B. 0.4
C. 0.5s
D. 0.6
14
Beijing
July, 2005
Practical Examination
Part II
15
16
Requirement
In this task, you are provided with cell images obtained using different types of
microscopy. You are required to
(1) Distinguish these cell images and choose one name for the microscopic technique
for obtaining each image,
(2) Select one of the techniques for study,
(3) Distinguish between organelles in a given cell image and answer questions.
17
Procedure
You are supplied with two image sheets, Image Sheet 1 and Image Sheet 2.
On Image Sheet 1, seven images (denoted 1-7) of cells or organisms are printed.
These images are obtained with the different microscopic techniques listed below:
A. Light microscopy
B. Fluorescence microscopy
C. Scanning electron microscopy
D. Ultra-thin section transmission electron microscopy
E. Immuno-electron microscopy
F. Negative staining electron microscopy
G. Freeze-fracture electron microscopy
Descriptions:
1. Image 1 is most likely to be obtained with _____. (0.9 point).
2. Image 2 is most likely to be obtained with _____. (0.9 point).
3. Image 3 is most likely to be obtained with _____. (0.9 point).
4. Image 4 is most likely to be obtained with _____. (0.9 point).
5. Image 5 is most likely to be obtained with _____. (0.9 point).
18
Image Sheet 2 shows the ultrastructure of a cell. Roman numbers (I-III) indicate
different organelles and/or cell components.
A list of organelles and/or cell components is given below (A through F). Answer the
following questions.
A. Lysosome
B. The Golgi apparatus
C. Mitochondrion
D. Microtubule
E. The endoplasmic reticulum
F. Plastid
19
17. The cell shown in Image Sheet 2 is likely to be a cell of _____. (choose one from
below) (0.6 point).
A. Plant
B. Animal
C. Fungus
D. Eubacterium
E. Archeon
20
Task 2: Determination of plant types with thin sections of plant leaves (15 points)
Five (No.1-No.5) Petri dishes, each of which contains some leaf samples.
(2)
(3)
Forceps, razor blade, test tube rack, slide, slide cover slip, filter paper.
Background
There are three major types of photosynthesis metabolism in the plants, called C3
metabolism, C4 metabolism and crassulacean acid metabolism. You are now required
to determine which plants are C3 plants and which plants are C4 plants. The
difference between them is that CO2 fixation and sugar synthesis are performed in
different cells in these two types of plants. The different structures of the leaves
between C3 and C4 plants lead to different metabolism.
Task
There are five Petri dishes on the table. Each Petri dish contains pieces of leaves
from a different plant. You are required to determine if the leaves are from C3 plants
or C4 plants.
Procedure
Please follow the procedure below:
(1) Pick up one sample from each dish and make a thin section.
(2) Use several drops of water to wash the section off the blade onto the slide.
21
(3) Remove the excess water with a piece of filter paper, but keep the water around
the sample.
(4) Put the cover slip onto the sample, remove excessive water and observe the
specimen under the microscope.
Answer the following questions.
18. The leaves in Petri dish 1 are (3 points)
A. C3 type.
B. C4 type.
19. The leaves in Petri dish 2 are (3 points)
A. C3 type.
B. C4 type.
20. The leaves in Petri dish 3 are (3 points)
A. C3 type.
B. C4 type.
21. The leaves in Petri dish 4 are (3 points)
A. C3 type.
B. C4 type.
22. The leaves in Petri dish 5 are (3 points)
A. C3 type.
B. C4 type.
22
23
Procedure:
You are provided with three root tips of a plant. The following procedure should be
followed so that you can make an appropriate specimen to observe the chromosomes
from cells in mitosis.
(1) Use the forceps to put one or two root tips into the small bottle containing 1 N
HCl.
(2) Put the bottle into the water bath, which has been adjusted to 60C, for 8 min.
Note, your laboratory has several water baths with temperature adjusted to 60C.
The water baths are on the instructors desk.
(3) Very carefully take the root tips out of the HCl solution with a forceps and put
them into the beaker provided containing distilled water. Gently shake it for 1
min.
(4) Take the root tips out of the distilled water. Important: the root tips are now very
fragile. It is recommended that you use the forceps to pick the root tips and dont
touch the tips of the roots.
(5) Put one root tip on a slide. Cut the tissue of the root tip that is rich in dividing
cells. This region is within 1 mm from the root tip. Discard other parts of the root.
(6) Put one drop of Carbol Fuchsin solution onto the root tissue you have just cut off
and leave it to stain for 7 min. Squash the tissue gently with forceps so that the
tissue is dispersed.
(7) Cover the dispersed tissue with a slide cover slip. Push the slide cover slip gently
with a pencil or forceps until the tissue is completely dispersed and separated.
24
(8) Put the slide between two pieces of filter paper and put it on a flat surface. Gently
press the upper filter paper down so that the tissue is further squashed. In the
meantime, extra dye solution is also removed and absorbed by the filter paper.
(9) Observe your slide specimen under the microscope. Note, you might need to use
all objective lenses.
Note: You are provided with three root tips to prepare your specimen. If you fail to
make a good specimen for your observation, please repeat the procedure and make
another preparation. However, the time for your experiment is limited.
25
24. If you found that different metaphase cells had different number of chromosomes,
how do you determine the exact number of chromosomes? (2 points)
A. Count the chromosome numbers from several cells and use the average
number as the chromosome number.
B. Count the chromosome numbers from several cells; the maximum
chromosome number of a cell is the chromosome number of the plant.
C. Count the chromosome numbers of several cells in metaphase; the
chromosome of the plant is the number with highest frequency.
25. The purpose of the treatment of root with 1 HCl at 60C for 8 min is: (2 points)
A. Stimulate cells so that you can observe more cells in metaphase.
B. Dissolve cellulose of cell walls so that the cells are easily separated.
C. Remove ions of the cell wall so that the cells are separated.
D. Dissolve the hemicellulose of cell walls so that the cells are easily separated.
E. Puncture some tiny holes on plasma membrane so that Carbol Fuschin could
penetrate into the cell.
26
Beijing
July, 2005
Practical Examination
Part III
27
28
29
If you divide an area into smaller identical squares and count individuals in each
square, you will be able to distinguish the distribution patterns. If the distribution
pattern is uniform, the square deviation (S2) of your sampling will be zero. If the
distribution pattern is random, you will get a typical Poisson (normal) distribution in
your sampling. If the distribution pattern is aggregated, you will not be able to obtain
a Poisson distribution in your sampling. Thus, it is possible to distinguish the three
distribution patterns according to square deviation (S2) and averages of your sampling
(m).
30
Here, m = (X1+X2++Xn)/n
S2=[(X1-m)2+(X2-m)2++(Xn-m)2]/(n-1)
X1X2Xn represent the number of individuals in the square 1, 2, . and square
n, respectively, and n represents total number of squares you sampled.
Materials:
A printed photograph of a tray containing some T. molitor is provided. The tray is
divided into 7 x 7 squares.
Procedure
Count the number of the larva in A1, A4, B7, C5, D2, D7, E3, F1, F6, and G3 (total
number of squares is 10), and determine the distribution pattern according to the
formula provided above.
Answer the following questions:
31
Question 3. Which of the following could alter the answer of question 2 above:
(2 points) (Note, there might be more than one answer)
A.
Choose the same 10 squares, but reverse the sequential order in your
sampling (i.e. start from G3 and finish with A1).
B.
Choose only the four corner squares (A1, A7, G1 and G7) in sampling and
calculate S2 and m to determine the distribution pattern.
C.
Choose only the central five squares (D3, D4, D5, C4 and E4) in sampling
and calculate S2 and m to determine the distribution pattern.
D.
32
Population size is one of the most important factors in population ecology. A very
useful tool to estimate population size is Capture-Mark-Recapture method. In this
method, animals are trapped and captured. The captured animals are marked with
tags, collars, etc, and released immediately. After a certain period of time, traps are set
again to capture animals from the same population. A proportion of the marked
(recaptured) animals in the second trapping is assumed equivalent to the proportion of
marked animals in the total population. The population size (N) can be estimated by
the following equation:
N=MR/P
Where M is the number of individuals marked during the first capture, R is the
33
In the population of T. molitor, 100 individuals are marked with black dots near their
tails. These marked T. molitor were first released and mixed with other individuals of
the population. A second capture was performed and the result is shown in the printed
photograph provided.
34
35
36
Question 8. Fill in the table below according to your classification result and mark
them on your answer sheet: (1.4 x 7 = 9.8 points)
Beetle
Answer A-G
37
1 Tarsus of fore legs, middle legs and hind legs have 5-5-4 segments............................................2
Tarsus of foreleg, middle legs and hind legs have 5-5-5 or 4-4-4 segments....................3
2 Body size small and flat; there is a triangular notch at anterior edge of the labrum; wing
tip at end of wing case invisible................................................ Opatrum subaratum Faldermann
Body size large and elevated; straight at anterior edge of the labrum; wing tip
visible at end of wing case in male individual ........... Blaps femoralis femoralis Fischer-Waldheim
3 Tarsus have 4-4-4; body segments; there are 7 black round dots on the wing
cases..Coccinella septempunctata Linnaeum
Tarsus segments are type 5-5-5; body not semicircular.... 4
4 3rd through 8th antennal segments are branchial (gill-like) ..5
Antennal segments threadlike. 6
5 There is a notch at base of each wing case; there are many white and downy (cottony) dots in shapes
of strips, clouds, or waves on the pronotum and wing cases. .. Potosia brevitarsis (Lewis)
There is no notch at base of wing cases; no downy dots on the pronotum and
wing cases...Popillia quadriguttata (Fairmaire)
6 Body elongate and cylinder-like; compound eyes are reniform (kidney-shaped); antenna at frontal
processes;
there are 2 yellowish transverse strips on each wing casePolyzonus fasciatus (Fairmaire)
Body thickset and oval; round compound eyes; body color deep green, blue,
glaucous (waxy blue grey) or indigo; no transverse strips on wing cases.Chrysochus
38
chinensis Baly
Question 9. How many pairs of appendages are there in the shrimps head, thorax and
abdomen, respectively? (2 points)
39
A. 2, 4, 10
B. 5, 8, 6
C. 4, 5, 8
D. 3, 6, 7
Question 10. Find the mouthparts of the shrimp and separate the appendages that form
the mouthparts.
How many pairs of appendages is/are the mouthparts composed of? (2 points)
A. 1
B. 2
C. 3
D. 4
E. 5
Questions 11-12. Observe the schematic structures of appendages in the figure below.
40
Question 11. Could you find all of these appendages on the shrimp provided to you?
(2 points)
A. Yes
B. No
Question 12. Sequentially from appendage 1 through appendage 4 shown in the figure,
the main functions of these appendages are: (2 points)
A. 1: Walking, 2: swimming, 3: sensing and holding, 4: sensing and holding
B. 1: Swimming, 2: sensing and holding, 3: swimming, 4: sensing and holding
C. 1: sensing and holding, 2: swimming, 3: walking, 4: sensing and holding
D. 1: sensing and holding, 2: sensing and holding, 3: swimming, 4: walking
41
Question 14. There are 4 types of nervous systems schematically shown in the figure
below.
Which nervous system shown above is identical to the nervous system of the shrimp
you observed? (4.2 points)
A. Nervous system A.
Formatted: Numbered +
Level: 1 + Numbering Style:
A, B, C, + Start at: 1 +
Alignment: Left + Aligned
at: 0.63 cm + Tab after:
1.27 cm + Indent at: 1.27
cm
B. Nervous system B.
C. Nervous system C.
Deleted:
Deleted:
D. Nervous system D.
Page Break
42
Beijing
July, 2005
Practical Examination
Part IV
43
2. Make sure that all the results are written on the answer paper unless otherwise
instructed.
Deleted: has
3. There are 4 parts in the practical test. Each part lasts 90 min. You should start your
first test according to last digit of your competitor code. For example, if you
have a code of 221, your first practical test will be part I, if you have a code of
223, your first practical test will be part III.
4. Your second practical test is as follows: competitors from part I and part II
exchange labs; competitors from part III and part IV exchange labs;
5. You go to your third practical test according to the following rules:
If the last digit of your competitor code is 1, you go to practical test part III.
If the last digit of your competitor code is 2, you go to practical test part IV.
If the last digit of your competitor code is 3, you go to practical test part I.
If the last digit of your competitor code is 4, you go to practical test part II.
You should follow the instructions from your guides when switching labs.
44
Deleted: O
(1) Initially, observe the plant with a stereoscope and answer questions 1, 2 and 3.
Deleted: y
Deleted: first
(2) Take one plant and put it on a slide: cut some roots off and put them on another
Deleted: through
slide and cover the slide with a cover slip. Press the cover slip slightly and
Deleted: ,
Deleted: d
Deleted: ,
(3) Take one plant and put it on a slide. Cut a leaf and put it on another slide. Cover it
Deleted: c
with a slide cover slip and press it gently. Observe the specimen you made and
Deleted: .
Deleted:
The stem of the pla
A. Vertical
B. Horizontal
45
Deleted: Rosulate
D. Absent
Deleted: no stem)
2. Which one of the following descriptions about its root is correct? (2 points)
A. It contains chlorophyll
B. It is an adventitious root
C. It is a rhizoid
D. It is a spindle-shaped root.
Deleted: n
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
A. 1, 2, 3, 4
B. 1, 2
C. 1, 3
D. 2, 4
E. 1, 2, 3
46
Questions 4-5
4.
5.
A researcher grew the plant for many generations and found that no seeds were
produced. Which of the following could be true based on your observation? (2
points)
(1)
(2)
(3)
Deleted: s
Deleted:
A. 1, 2, 3
B. 1, 3
C. 1, 2
D. 2,
Deleted:
E. 3
Questions 6-8.
6.
Besides the plant tissues and cells, you should be able to observe some other
immobile cells. Which of the following descriptions is/are correct about these
cells? (2 points)
47
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
A.
1,
B.
1, 2, 3, 4
C.
2, 3
D.
2, 3, 4
E.
7. A researcher grew the plants under different conditions and obtained results
shown in the figure below.
48
Deleted:
Which of the following statements is/are correct based on the results shown above? (4
points)
(1) Ampicillin is inhibitory to plant growth only under nitrogen limiting
condition.
(2) The plant can grow without combined nitrogen.
(3) The root system of this plant could fix nitrogen.
(4) There are at least some microorganisms associated with the plant and
they can fix nitrogen.
(5) Nitrogenase activity is directly inhibited by Ampicillin.
49
A. 1, 3, 5
B. 1, 5
C. 2,
D. 1, 2, 4
E. 4, 5
8. If you would like to obtain a culture of the plant that does not contain any
associated organisms, what is the condition to achieve it? (4 points)
A. Grow it with combined nitrogen plus some ampicillin.
B. Grow it with combined nitrogen.
C. Grow it without combined nitrogen.
D. Grow it without combined nitrogen plus ampicillin.
50
You are provided with 6 tubes of pigments, labelled pigment I to VI. You are also
provided with a colorless solution in another tube labelled as control. You will need to
use the following instruments:
Deleted: p
a. Examine the absorption spectra shown in the figure below. The five absorption
spectra are obtained from different organisms and the pigment names are
given in the figure. The major absorptions of these spectra are given. Among
the five pigments in the figure, phycocyanin and phycoerythrin are watersoluble; chlorophyll and carotene are soluble in organic solvents; chlorophyllprotein complexes are soluble in aqueous solution when treated with detergent.
Deleted: p
Deleted:
51
1.Chlorophyll a in water
2.5
2
1.5
678nm
1
0.5
0
400
450
500
550
600
650
700
750
2.Chlorophyll a in ethanol
3
2.5
2
662nm
1.5
1
0.5
0
400
450
500
550
600
650
700
750
3.Phycocyanin
625nm
2
1.5
1
0.5
0
400
450
500
550
600
650
700
750
52
4.Phycoerythrin
2
562nm
1.5
1
0.5
0
400
450
500
600
650
700
750
5.Carotene
450nm
1.5
550
478nm
0.5
0
400
450
Solution
500
550
450nm
600
562nm
650
700
595nm
750
625nm
662nm
678nm
I
II
III
IV
V
VI
53
Deleted: in
Question 9. Which of the pigments would be most efficient at absorbing red light?
(2 points)
A. Phycocyanin
B. Phycoerythrin
C. Carotene
D. Chlorophyll
Solution I.
B.
Solution II.
C.
Solution III.
D.
Solution IV.
54
E.
Solution V.
F.
Solution VI.
G.
None.
55
C. Solution III.
D. Solution IV.
E. Solution V.
F. Solution VI.
G. None.
Question 15. Which of the following pigments (1, 2, 3, or 4)is/are present in all algae
and higher plants? (2 points)
(1) Chlorophyll
(2) Carotene
(3) Phycoerythrin
(4) Phycocyanin
A. 1, 2, 3, 4
B. 1, 3, 4
C. 1,
D. 1, 4
E. 1, 2
Question 16. A cyanobacterium contains chlorophyll, carotenoids and phycocyanin as
major pigments. When a culture of the cyanobacterium is extracted with 80% acetone
and centrifuged, what color do you expect to see in the pellet? (3 points)
A. Orange
B. Blue
56
C. Green
D. Purple
Formatted: Font:
E. Colorless
Question 17. In the analysis of proteins with isoelectric focusing (IEF) gel
electrophoresis, one often uses coloured proteins with known pI (isoelectric point)
values as pI standards. Among these proteins are phycocyanin and phycoerythrin. No
chlorophyll proteins are used as IEF gel standard. Which of the following is the
reason why no chlorophyll-proteins are used as IEF gel pI standard? (3 points)
A. Green colour is not visible in the IEF gel.
B. Chlorophyll molecules are too small to be focused.
C. It is often difficult to obtain enough materials of chlorophyll-proteins from
plants.
D. Chlorophyll molecules are not covalently attached to proteins.
57
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Answer
D
D
B
B
D
Part 2
Question
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Answer
A
F
G
C
B
E
D
B
C
G
D
E
C
B
E
A
A
B
B
A
B
D
B
Part 3
Question
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8-1
8-2
8-3
8-4
8-5
8-6
8-7
9
10
11
12
13
14
Answer
D
C
BC
A
C
ACE
B
D
C
A
G
B
F
E
B
C
A
C
C
A
Part 4
Question
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
Answer
B
B
C
A
D
E
D
A
D
D
B
F
A
G
E
B
D
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
COMPETITOR #:
THEORY EXAMINATION # 1
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-1
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Please check that you have the appropriate examination papers and answer sheets.
It is recommended that you manage your time in proportion to the points allotted for each
question.
IMPORTANT
Good luck.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-2
Questions 1-5. A young family recently bought a Golden Retriever puppy as a pet. They
took delivery of the dog at 8 weeks of age after the pup had been weaned and vaccinated.
Question 1). Following birth, how did the pup find its way to its mothers teat to suckle?
(1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 2). Puppies are vaccinated against a range of pathogenic micro-organisms. Which
host immune responses are stimulated to provide protection? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 3). Training the dog to obey commands (such as walk, sit, stay) involves modulating
which behavioural pattern? (1 point)
A.
Imprinting
B.
Conditioning
C.
Mimicry
D.
Habituation
E.
Sensitization
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-3
Question 4). The Golden Retriever breed is an inbred line of dogs. The pedigree below is for a
rare, but relatively mild, hereditary disorder of the skin.
Autosomal, recessive
B.
Autosomal, dominant
C.
Sex-linked, recessive
D.
Sex-linked, dominant
2. If D = dominant and d = recessive, what is the genotype of individual III-5 in the pedigree
given above? (1 point)
A.
DD
B.
Dd
C.
dd
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-4
Question 5). Dogs, foxes, jackals, wolves and hyenas were all scored for the presence (+) or
absence (-) of seven phenotypic characters (I-VII). The results are shown in the following Table.
Character
II
III
IV
VI
VII
Dog
Fox
Jackal
Wolf
Hyena
Which phenogram indicates the phylogenetic relationships between these five animal groups
based on the data given? (1 point).
A.
B.
dog
fox
wolf
jackal
hyena
C.
dog
fox
jackal
wolf
hyena
D.
dog
wolf
fox
jackal
hyena
dog
wolf
fox
jackal
hyena
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-5
Questions 6-10.
reactions: one reaction using BamHI and HindIII; one using BamHI and EcoRI; and one
using HindIII and EcoRI. The restriction fragments were separated on an electrophoretic
gel.
origin of
replication
200
2400
2800 bp
plasmid
2000
800
1600
B
Size Markers
BamHI
+
HindIII
BamHI
+
EcoRI
HindIII
+
EcoRI
1600 bp
1400 bp
1200 bp
1000 bp
800 bp
600 bp
400 bp
200 bp
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-6
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 7). Which of the restriction sites on the plasmid map (numbered 1-5) correspond to
the restriction enzymes A, B or C. (2 points)
Restriction enzyme
Site
Answer
[A/B/C]
A.
BamHI
B.
EcoRI
C.
HindIII
3
4
5
Question 8). The four sides of the electrophoretic gel are labelled A, B, C and D. Which
represents the cathode ? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 9). The restriction enzyme EcoRI cuts double-stranded DNA as follows:
5 . . G A A T T C . . 3
..C T T A A G..
Which of the following fragments could bind to an EcoRI restriction cut site? (1 point)
(A)
. . CG
(B)
AATTCG . .
. . GCAATT
GC . .
(C)
. . TGAATT
. . AC
(D)
GT . .
TTAACA . .
Question 10). How do single plasmids come to acquire multiple genes for antibiotic resistance?
(1 point)
A.
Transposition
B.
Conjugation
C.
Transcription
D.
Transformation
E.
Transduction
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-8
Question 11-15. A researcher placed ten individuals of each of three different types of
plants at ten different light intensities, ranging from zero to full sunshine, for several days.
The atmosphere was normal air, the temperature was 32C and the plants were well
watered.
The three plant types were:
The researcher then measured the photosynthetic rate of a leaf of each plant, and plotted
the results for plants A, B and C as follows:
C
0
0
20
40
60
80
100
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-9
C3 sun plant
2.
C3 shade plant
3.
C4 plant
Question 12). Which result (A, B or C) would be obtained for the following? (1 point)
Answer
[A/B/C]
1. wheat, rice, oats, barley, peas and beans
2. plant that usually has the thinnest leaves
3. plant with highest water use efficiency
4. plant that preferentially invests nitrogen (N) into the
manufacture of thylakoid proteins and chlorophyll,
rather than enzymes of CO2 fixation
5. plant with some chloroplasts lacking Rubisco
(Rubisco = ribulose bisphosphate carboxylase/oxygenase)
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-10
Question 13). Curve C shows that photosynthesis by this plant decreases as the light intensity is
increased from 60% to 100% of full sunshine. Why? (1 point)
A. It lacks chlorophyll a
B. It does not close its stomates when water stressed, and therefore becomes dehydrated
under high light
C. It has insufficient Rubisco to make use of high light, and reactive oxygen species
consequently accumulate and damage membranes
D. High light stimulates its mitochondrial (dark) respiration, consequently it respires more
CO2 at night than it photosynthetically fixes by day
E. Its chloroplasts migrate to the sides of the leaf cells, making the leaves transparent and
unable to absorb light for photosynthesis
Question 14). Leaves from the three plants exposed to 60% of full sunshine would undertake
photosynthesis faster if provided with extra light (L) or extra carbon dioxide (D)?
(1 point)
Answer
[L/D]
1. Plant A
2. Plant B
3. Plant C
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-11
A.
3-phosphoglycerate
B.
glycolate 2-phosphate
C.
glycerate 1,3-bisphosphate
D.
3-phosphoglyceraldehyde
E.
ribulose 1,5-bisphosphate
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-12
Questions 16-20.
eukaryotic cells. The following diagram shows a normal human male karyotype.
Question 16). Karyotyping is routinely performed on cells that are undergoing which process?
(1 point)
A.
Prophase in meiosis
B.
Anaphase in mitosis
C.
Metaphase in mitosis
D.
Telophase in mitosis
E.
Interphase
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-13
22
B.
23
C.
44
D.
46
E.
(1 point)
Question 18). What are the structures circled at position 6 in the diagram called?...
(1 point)
A.
B.
C.
a chromosome
D.
interphase chromosomes
E.
RNA
Question 19). Which answer gives the correct responses to the blanks in the following
statement?
Human chromosomes are typically divided into two arms by their ....... . On human
chromosome maps, the long arm is referred to as ....., while the short arm is called ......
(1 point)
A.
telomere;
p;
B.
centrosome;
q;
C.
centriole;
L;
D.
centrosome;
l;
E.
centromere;
q;
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-14
Question 20). The technology that produced the karyotype shown in the diagram has been
largely superceded and replaced by which of the following?
(1 point)
Questions 21-25. A new volcanic island forms in the middle of an ocean. A fringing reef
forms as marine currents bring eggs and larvae allowing different species to colonize.
Other factors, such as predation, competition and diseases, are then responsible for
extinctions of some reef species.
Question 21). On average, the reef is colonized each century by ten new species of coral but
10% become extinct each century. How long will it take for the reef fauna to include at least 50
different species of coral? (1 point)
A.
300 years
B.
450 years
C.
500 years
D.
800 years
E.
1200 years
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-15
Question 22). A major change in the direction of marine currents prevents the reef from being
colonized by any new species. Assuming the extinction rate remains the same at 10% per
century, how long will it take for the biodiversity of the reef to be lowered from 50 coral species
to 30 species? (1 point)
A.
300 years
B.
450 years
C.
500 years
D.
800 years
E.
1200 years
Question 23). A marine biologist, wanting to calculate the number of fish (N) that lived on the
reef, captured a sample of individuals (numbering S1), tagged them and released them. One
month later, he collected another sample (numbering S2) and found several marked individuals
amongst them (numbering S3). Which formula can be used to calculate N? (1 point)
A.
N = (S2 x S3) / S1
B.
N = (S1 x S2 x S3)
C.
N = (S1 x S3) / S2
D.
N = (S1 x S2) / S3
E.
N = (S2 + S1) / S3
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-16
Question 24). Three species of reef organisms exhibit the following survivorship curves:
10000
1000
Number of survivors
(log scale)
Species I
100
Species II
10
1
Species III
50
Percentage of maximum life span
100
B.
C.
D.
Adults of species II have longer life expectancy than those of species III
E.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-17
Question 25). Fish caught on the reef were found to be infected with gill parasites. The
intensities of infection were plotted against their frequency, as follows:
Intensity of
infection
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-18
Questions 26-30. Early in the evolution of life on Earth, certain primitive photosynthetic
cells acquired the ability to split water resulting in the accumulation of oxygen in the
atmosphere. Other cells made use of oxygen by combining it with other molecules and
harnessing the energy released.
Question 26).
biochemistry that occurs in the matrix (O = enzyme) and a magnified view of the inner
membrane (right) showing some of the multi-protein complexes within it.
B
pyruvate
pyruvate
NADH
+H+
NAD+
acetyl CoA
citrate
oxalo-acetate
O2
2H2O
C
D
succinate
H+
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-19
Question 27). Consider the metabolic cycle of eight reactions (Krebs cycle/citric acid cycle)
shown within the diagram of the mitochondrion (cycling from citrate to succinate to oxaloacetate). Which of the following statements is correct? (1 point)
A. The cycle occurs in the intermembrane space of mitochondria
B. The cycle is a central part of lactic-acid fermentation
C. The cycle would cease to operate in the absence of NAD+
D. The cycle directly generates most of a heterotrophic cells ATP
E. The cycle is responsible for the generation of oxygen
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-20
Question 28).
other parts of cells, including the cytosol and plastids in plant cells. It is the main molecule used
for the biosynthesis of which combination of the following? (1 point)
1.
2.
Steroids
3.
4.
5.
6.
Fatty acids
7.
A.
1, 5
B.
2, 4, 6, 7
C.
2, 3, 7
D.
1, 4, 7
E.
2, 3, 5, 6, 7
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-21
Question 29).
1.
H2O is a reducer
2.
CO2 is an oxidant
3.
O2 is an electron acceptor
4.
5.
6.
Photophosphorylation occurs
7.
8.
A.
1, 2, 8
B.
2, 3, 4, 7
C.
3, 5, 7, 8
D.
1, 4, 7, 8
E.
2, 3, 5, 6, 7
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-22
Question 30). A student obtained a preparation of isolated mitochondria from a liver and
studied respiration by continuously following the O2 uptake of a 1 mL suspension of
mitochondria in a reaction vessel. Additions were made to the suspension as shown. The
following trace was obtained:
300
2
2,4-dinitrophenol (1 mmole)
3
4
cyanide (1 mmole)
5
0
1
time
The student offers various conclusions for the rates of O2 uptake shown at positions 1-6.
Select either conclusion A or B as correct for each numbered position: (1 point):
1.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-23
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-24
Questions 31-35. Most higher animals have cardiovascular systems that transport blood
and fluids to body tissues.
Question 31). Vertebrate whole blood consists of plasma and suspended cells or fragments. The
following statements relate to the composition of a normal blood sample.
1) Red cells get their colour from the waste CO2 carried by haemoglobin
2) Erythrocytes are the most abundant cell type in blood
3) Platelets contain a nucleus and DNA
4) Haemoglobin is composed of two polypeptide chains
5) Gamma-globulin is a key protein in plasma
6) All adult blood cells originate in the bone marrow
Which one of the following combinations contains only true statements? (1 point)
A.
3, 4, 5
B.
2, 5, 6
C.
1, 2, 3, 5, 6
D.
4, 5, 6
E.
2, 4, 6
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-25
Question 32). The haematocrit (or packed cell volume, PCV) is the proportion of the total blood
volume occupied by blood cells. The normal haematocrit range for adult males is 40-50%. The
graph below shows the haematocrit results for three patients A, B and C.
Which patient could a doctor correctly diagnose as suffering from the following conditions?
(use D to indicate none) (1 point)
Answer
[A/B/C/D]
1. Dehydration
2. Anaemia
3. Decreased albumin levels
4. No apparent health problems
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-26
Question 33). The amount of oxygen carried in the blood is dependent on the amount of
respiratory pigment (such as haemoglobin) and the partial pressure of oxygen. For a fixed
concentration of haemoglobin, the greater the partial pressure of oxygen the greater the percent
Saturation of Haemoglobin with O2 (%)
saturation of haemoglobin.
100
80
60
40
20
20
40
60
80
100
Which of the following combinations represents the oxygen equilibrium curves shown above for
conditions A, B and C, in order? [*Exercise blood is blood collected after a period of extreme
exercise.] (1 point)
A.
normal blood,
foetal blood,
exercise blood*
B.
foetal blood,
exercise blood*,
C.
foetal blood,
normal blood,
exercise blood*
D.
normal blood
E.
foetal blood
normal blood
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-27
Question 34). A major role for blood clotting is to help repair damaged blood vessels and tissue
wounds. Which factors are important in this process? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 35). Various abnormal conditions may arise in the cardiovascular system, including:
A) Cholesterol plaque deposits in arteries
B) Overproduction of red blood cells in the bone marrow
C) Single nucleotide mutation in the coding region of the haemoglobin gene
D) High blood pressure
E) Uncontrolled proliferation of progenitor blood cells
F) Reduction in haemoglobin synthesis
Which of these abnormalities cause the following blood disorders? (1 point)
Answer [A/B/C/D/E/F]
1. Sickle cell anaemia
2. Hypertension
3. Atherosclerosis
4. Beta-thalassemia
5. Leukaemia
6. Polycythemia
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-28
Questions 36-38. Reproduction has many features that vary within the plant kingdom.
Question 36). Which of the following statements concerning reproduction is true?
(1 point)
A. Haploid organisms (i.e. organisms whose cells have only one of each chromosome) do
not exist; the only cells that are haploid are gametes (ova and sperm)
B. It is theoretically and practically impossible for an organism to reproduce without
meiosis
C. Sexual reproduction always involves the production of sperm and ova by separate male
and female individuals
D. All cells of all eukaryotic organisms (even fungi) contain a single nucleus (either haploid
or diploid)
E. Sexual reproduction without meiosis is not possible
Question 37). Which of the following is a principal difference between gymnosperms and
angiosperms? (1 point)
A. Gymnosperms produce flagellated sperm that swim in water whereas angiosperms
produce sperm enclosed in pollen
B. Gymnosperms lack seeds whereas angiosperms have seeds
C. In gymnosperms, the ovule develops into a seed whereas in angiosperms the ovary
develops into a seed
D. Gymnosperms lack ovaries that develop into fruits whereas angiosperms have ovaries
that develop into fruits
E. Gymnosperms produce scaly dry fruit whereas angiosperms produce soft juicy fruit
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-29
Question 38). Plant reproduction was studied in Haplopappus gracilis which is diploid and has
only two pairs of chromosomes, one long pair and one short pair (2n = 4). The diagrams below
represent anaphases of individual cells in meiosis or mitosis in a plant that is genetically a
double heterozygote (Aa Bb) for alleles of two genes, one gene on the long chromosome and the
other on the short chromosome. Single lines represent chromatids, and the points of the V's
represent centromeres.
meiosis II (= B)
3
(3 points)
mitosis (= C)
6
or an impossible situation (= D)
8
10
11
12
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-30
Questions 39-42). A dichotomous key was constructed for ten groups of animals based on seven
characters.
bilateral symmetry
endoskeleton
hardened
structure with
attached muscles
radial symmetry
no
endoskeleton
A
B
no symmetry
bilateral
symmetry
aquatic
also terrestrial
has
separate
mouth and
anus
no hardened
structure with
attached
muscles
segmented
not segmented
anus and
mouth not
separate
D
E
F
G
has
gastrovascular
system
aquatic
also terrestrial
H
I
no gastrovascular
system
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-31
Question 39). Which groups (A-J) are represented by numbers 1 to 10? (2 points)
Group
Letter
1.
Annelida (annelids)
2.
Arthropoda (crustaceans)
3.
4.
Echinodermata (starfish)
5.
Mollusca (bivalves)
6.
Mollusca (gastropods)
7.
Chordata (chordates)
8.
Nematoda (roundworms)
Platyhelminthes (flatworms)
Question 40). Animal body plans vary in the organization of their tissue layers and body cavities. They
may be diploblastic (D) or triploblastic (T). They may be acoelomate (A), pseudocoelomate (P) or
coelomate (C). Indicate the character states for the following animals: (1 point)
1.
Platyhelminthes (flatworms)
2.
3.
Nematoda (roundworms)
tissue layers
body cavities
[D/T]
[A/P/C]
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-32
Question 41). Differences in embryological development allow the differentiation of animals into
protostomes and deuterostomes based on cleavage patterns (radial = R; spiral = S), cell fate
(indeterminate = I, determinate = D) and the development of the mouth of the embryo (arising from
blastopore = B, arising at opposite end to blastopore = O). Which are the correct character states for
deuterostomes? (1 point)
A.
S, D, O
B.
S, D, B
C.
S, I, O
D.
S, I, B
E.
R, D, O
F.
R, D, B
G.
R, I, O
H.
R, I, B
Answer
[A/B/C]
1. Flies
2. Wingless insects
3. Fleas
4. Lice
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-33
Questions 43-47. Bacteria are prokaryotic micro-organisms that grow under a variety of
environmental conditions.
Question 43). Bacterial growth under laboratory conditions at a particular temperature can be
represented as the log number of viable cells plotted against time of incubation.
C
Log (number of cells)
D
B
A
Time
Match the four stages labelled A to D on the graph with the following growth phases. Note: one
phase is not shown and should be entered as E. (1 point)
Growth Phase
Answer
[A/B/C/D/E]
1.
2.
death phase
3.
transition phase
4.
stationary phase
5.
lag phase
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-34
Question 44). Most known bacteria grow in the temperature range of 30 - 40C, but thermophiles are
able to survive at temperatures of up to 80C. Indicate which of the following are reasons for the survival
of thermophiles by answering Yes or No. (1 point)
Answer
[Yes/No]
1.
large size
2.
small size
3.
4.
5.
protein thermostability
Question 45).
extremophiles can survive in environments of high salt, high pressure or extreme temperature
(as shown in the following three graphs).
A) C
D
E
Growth Rate
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-35
Q) C
Growth Rate
40
Temperature (C)
80
Growth Rate
Match the growth characteristics labelled A to F with the following types of bacteria. (1 point).
Type of bacterium
Answer
[A/B/C/D/E/F]
1.
Barophile
2.
Mesophile only
3.
Thermophile only
4.
Halophile only
5.
Psychrophile
6.
Thermophile, halophile
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-36
Question 46).
activity of a bacterial enzyme alone and in the presence of two different substances, A and B.
The y-intercept of each line represents 1/VMAX for the enzyme under the different conditions.
Enzyme plus
substance A
Enzyme plus
substance B
1/V
Enzyme
(without substance
A or B)
1/[S]
Which of the following statements about this enzyme is correct with regard to the
Lineweaver-Burk plot shown above? (1 point)
A. Substance A is a non-competitive inhibitor while substance B is a competitive
inhibitor
B. Substance A is a competitive inhibitor while substance B is a non-competitive inhibitor
C. Substance A is a stimulatory cofactor while substance B is a competitive
inhibitor
D. Substance B is a stimulatory cofactor while substance A is a competitive
inhibitor
E. Both substance A and substance B are stimulatory cofactors
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-37
Question 47).
One way bacterial proteins can maintain stability under extreme conditions is
through disulfide bond bridges between cysteine amino acids. The results below are from an
analysis of a bacterial protein using the reducing agent -mercaptoethanol (BME), which
reduces disulfide bonds. The polypeptide products were separated on the basis of molecular
mass by SDS-polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis. Markers = proteins of known molecular mass
(in kDa).
BME
+BME
Markers
130 kDa
94
67
43
30
20
Based on these results, which of the following diagrams best represents the polypeptide
structure of the native bacterial protein? (Note: represents a disulfide bond) (1 point)
A.
B.
R)
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-38
Questions 48-52. Lipids are vital to cell structure and metabolism; yet fats have a
notorious reputation as being bad for your health.
Questions 48). Which one of the following possible causes of the development of obesity is
INCORRECT? (1 point)
A. Sedentary lifestyle
B. Abnormal hypothalamus function
C. Environmental factors
D. Increased thyroid hormone levels
E. High caloric intake
Question 49). Which statement regarding the hormonal control of fat deposition in adipose
tissue is correct? (1 point)
A. Insulin promotes the formation of triacylglycerol in adipose tissue
B. Insulin promotes the formation of cholesterol in adipose tissue
C. Adrenaline (epinephrine) promotes the formation of triacylglycerol in adipose tissue
D. Adrenaline (epinephrine) promotes the formation of cholesterol in adipose tissue
E. Glucagon promotes the formation of triacylglycerol in adipose tissue
F. Glucagon promotes the formation of cholesterol in adipose tissue
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-39
Question 50). Mitochondria are the primary site in cells for the metabolism of long-chain fatty
acids, and use a process called -oxidation. One cycle of -oxidation of a fatty acid, which has
been prior activated to a coenzyme A (CoA) ester, is shown below:
Based on this diagram, how many cycles of the pathway would be needed for complete
-oxidation of stearic acid (C18:0)? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
16
F.
18
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-40
Question 51). The melting temperature of a fat-containing substance is dependent on the degree
of unsaturation of the constituent fatty acid chains unsaturated fatty acids reduce the regular
packing together of fatty acids. Examples of two common 18-carbon fatty acids, stearic and
oleic, with different degree of unsaturation, are shown below in diagrammatic form:
Which one of the following substances would you expect to have the highest ratio of
unsaturated/saturated fatty acids? (1 point)
A.
butter
B.
vegetable oil
C.
margarine
D.
peanut paste
E.
cake of soap
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-41
Question 52). In humans, many lipids, including cholesterol, are carried in the blood in large
spherical-shaped lipid-protein complexes called lipoproteins. Their structure reflects the
hydrophilic, hydrophobic or other functional properties of the constituent molecules. Given the
major components of lipoproteins below, predict whether they would be in the core (C) or
surface (S) layer of lipoproteins. (1 point)
Answer
C or S
1. Proteins involved in tissue receptor binding
2. Cholesterol
3. Cholesterol ester (cholesterol esterified to a fatty acid)
4. Phospholipid
5. Triacylglycerol
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-42
Questions 53-57. Photosynthesis occurs in plants when their chloroplasts capture light
energy and convert it to chemical energy stored in sugar and other organic molecules.
Question 53). From several parts of pea plants that had been either kept in light for 12 hours or
in the dark for 12 hours, mRNA was extracted and used in Northern blots with five different
gene probes. The results are shown below.
Leaf
Stem
Root
Tendril
Probe
light
dark
light
dark
light
dark
light
dark
++++
++
+++
+++
+++
++
+++
+++
+++
+++
++
+++
++++
+++
+++
+++
++
++
+++
+++
Which result best indicates that the Rubisco small subunit gene was used as a probe? (1 point)
A.
1.
B.
2.
C.
3.
D.
4.
E.
5.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-43
Question 54). The main types of plants are C3 plants, C4 plants and CAM plants (CAM stands
for Crassulacean Acid Metabolism). Match the ten items listed in the left-hand column with the
ten corresponding items in the right-hand column. (2 points)
1.
3. plastoquinone
5. cellulose
7. photorespiration
8. flavonoids
9. oils
10. starch
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-44
Question 55). Plants, directly or indirectly, supply all of humanitys food. Match the crops
listed in the left-hand column with the name of the plant organ forming most or all of the
material actually consumed (listed in the right-hand column): (1 point)
1. broccoli
A. axillary bud
2. ginger
B. stem
3. Brussels sprout
4. pumpkin
D. receptacle
5. celery
E. leaves
6. carrot
7. potato
G. fruit
8. strawberry
H. inflorescence
9. onion.
I. petioles
J. root
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Question 56). The accumulation of salt in soil is a major limitation to agriculture. What is the
primary cause of the inability of non-halophyte (i.e. salt-sensitive) plants to grow in soils of
high salt concentration? (1 point)
A. Salt crystals form in the stomata and stop gas exchange
B. Large quantities of Na+ and Cl- enter the plant cells and poison them
C. Salt accumulates in root cells and osmosis follows, causing the cells to burst
D. The oxygen content of the soil is too low
E. The water potential of the soil is too low
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-45
Question 57). Plants obtain from the soil various mineral nutrients with important physiological
roles. Match each of the phrases in the right-hand column with one of the nutrients listed in the
left-hand column. (2 points).
1. calcium
2. nitrogen
3. nitrate
C. required for the biosynthesis of the side chains of the amino acids
cysteine and methionine
4. iodine
5. phosphate
6. magnesium
7. potassium
8. sulfate
9. manganese
10. iron
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-46
Questions 58-62. Eukaryotic cells contain many different organelles performing a variety of
functions. The following diagram shows several organelles within a typical animal cell.
Question 58). Identify organelles 1-4 using names selected from the following list. (1 point)
A.
nucleus
B.
Golgi apparatus
C.
plasma membrane
D.
mitochondrion
E.
vesicle
F.
endoplasmic reticulum
G.
centrosome
1.
2.
3.
4.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-47
Question 59). Which diagram shows the correct organelle interactions for phagocytosis?
(1 point)
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-48
Question 60). In multicellular eukaryotes, adjacent cells are connected to each other to form
tissues and organs. Which of the following is NOT an example of an intercellular connection?
(1 point)
A.
tight junction
B.
plaque junction
C.
plasmodesma
D.
desmosome
E.
gap junction
Question 61). Organelles can be divided into functional groups. Which of the following
functional groupings is correct? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-49
Question 62). Match the following diagrams to the chemicals listed. (1 point)
Answer
[A/B/C/D/E]
1. Lipid
2. Functional protein
3. Nucleotide
4. Polysaccharide
5. Monosaccharide
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-50
Questions 63-67). The diagram below shows a section through a mammalian ovary.
Question 63). What is the correct sequence in which the labelled structures develop? (1 point)
A.
A-B-D-C-E
B.
D-B-E-A-C
C.
B-D-C-E-A
D.
C-E-B-D-A
E.
E-B-D-C-A
Question 64). Hormonal changes during normal pregnancy are correctly described by which of
the following statements? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-51
Question 65). Which of the listed functions do these hormones play in breast development and
lactation? (1 point)
Hormone
Function
1) Progesterone
2) Estradiol
3) Prolactin
4) Oxytocin
5) Insulin
E. No role
Question 66). Where does fertilization of the oocyte by sperm usually occur? (1 point)
A.
Vagina
B.
Cervix
C.
Uterus
D.
Fallopian tubule
E.
Ovary
Question 67). Which of the following act to block polyspermy in humans? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
All of above
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-52
You test the sera against 2 antigens and obtain the following results:
Specimen
Serum 1
negative (-)
negative (-)
Serum 2
positive (+)
negative (-)
Serum 3
positive (+)
negative (-)
Serum 4
negative (-)
negative (-)
Serum 5
positive (+)
negative (-)
Serum 6
positive (+)
positive (+)
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-53
The animal has shown an immune response to neither Brucella abortus nor to
Brucella melitensis
B.
C.
An immune response to the immunization with Brucella abortus has been proven
by these tests
D.
The animal has been previously exposed to both Brucella abortus and to
Brucella melitensis
E.
The animal has been previously exposed to either Brucella abortus or to Brucella
melitensis
B.
Brucella abortus and Brucella melitensis have been proven to be the same
organism by these tests
C.
The sera tested have no specificity for either Brucella abortus or for Brucella
melitensis
D.
IgG antibodies to both Brucella abortus and to Brucella melitensis are likely
to be present in Serum 6
E.
No conclusions regarding the specificity of any antibodies can be made from the
data
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-54
Question 70). Subsequent testing of the sera with cultures of Yersinia enterocolitica showed that
sera 3, 5 and 6 gave positive (+) reactions. Which of the following statements is true? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
The sera tested have no specificity for either Brucella abortus, for Brucella
melitensis or for Yersinia enterocolitica
D.
E.
B.
C.
IgM and IgG antibodies to Brucella abortus have been demonstrated in these
tests
D.
IgM antibodies to both Brucella abortus and to Brucella melitensis have been
demonstrated by these tests
E.
IgM antibodies to both Brucella abortus and to Yersinia enterocolitica have been
demonstrated by these tests
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-55
Question 72). From the above reactions, which of the following could be assumed to contain
IgM antibodies specific for Brucella abortus? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Questions 73-77. In the following diagrams, you are given the results of six electrophoretic
gel separations. Bands are shown in numbered lanes in polyacrylamide protein gels,
Western blots, Southern blots and Northern blots and spots are numbered on twodimensional protein gels. Use the information to answer the following questions.
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-56
Question 73). A research scientist had designed a probe that recognizes two distinct fragments
of a gene when digested genomic DNA is examined. Which of the following would confirm
that a section of DNA has been lost from this gene in the cells of a tumour compared to normal
tissue? (1 point)
A. When comparing lane 10 from the tumour and lane 11 from normal tissue
B. When comparing lane 11 from the tumour and lane 10 from normal tissue
C. There would be no change in the observed band pattern
D. When comparing lane 14 from the tumour and lane 13 from normal tissue
E. When comparing lane 14 from the tumour and lane 16 from normal tissue
Question 74). Which of the following would suggest that the cause of a patient suffering a
metabolic disease is caused by changes in the post-translational modification of a protein
involved in the metabolic pathway associated with the disease ? (1 point)
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-57
Question 75). Which of the following best supports the hypothesis that the developmental
change seen in two different tissues of an embryo is regulated by controlling transcription? (1
point)
Question 76). Which lanes on panels A, B, C and D best represent the experiments in which
cells have been transfected with a plasmid encoding a recombinant protein?
[First, the expressed RNA that had been transcribed from the plasmid was analysed by a specific
nucleic acid probe. The expressed protein was then purified and visualized to confirm purity.
Finally, the expressed protein was reacted with a specific antibody probe.]
A.
14, 2 and 6
B.
1, 6 and 9
C.
14, 2 and 8
D.
13, 9 and 5
E.
9, 8 and 2
(1 point)
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-58
Question 77). A gene Z has two promoters. One promoter (PI) is used when the cell is
stimulated by a particular steroid hormone, while the second promoter (PII) is used when the
steroid hormone is absent. The single mRNA from transcription using PII is much shorter than
that of the single mRNA transcript generated when PI is used.
PI
PII
Coding region Z
Assuming no degradation, which two lanes best represents the results of an experiment in which
the RNA transcript from gene Z has been specifically probed with a nucleic acid specific to
gene Z mRNA? [The source of the RNA for the blot comes from cells treated with the steroid
hormone compared to RNA from untreated cells.] (1 point)
END
IBO2004-Theory-1-page-59
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
part
1.
2.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
choices
answer
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCD
deleted
ABCD
ABCDE
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABCDE
ABCD
ABCDE
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABCDE
LD
LD
LD
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
D
B
B
AorB
worth
(points)
1
1
1
1
C
D
A
C
A
C
B
B
B
A
B
C
A
B
C
A
C
A
C
L
D
D
E
C
C
B
E
B
D
C
D
E
B
G
C
B
F
1
1
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
1
1
1
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
1/3
1/3
1/3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2/7
2/7
2/7
2/7
5.
6.
7.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
AB
AB
AB
AB
AB
AB
ABCDE
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
A
E
D
C
B
C
B
A
A
B
A
A
B
C
B
D
A
C
D
C
D
A
F
E
B
E
D
D
B
B
B
C
D
D
D
D
A
D
D
F
E
H
B
D
C
A
2/7
2/7
2/7
1
1
1
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1
1
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1
1
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
8.
9.
10.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
DTAPC
DTAPC
DTAPC
ABCDEFGH
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDE
CS
CS
CS
CS
CS
ABCDE
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
G
I
J
TA
TC
TP
G
C
AorB
C
AorB
B
D
E
C
A
N
N
Y
Y
Y
D
E
F
B
C
A
B
B
D
A
C
B
S
S
C
S
C
D
C
I
H
J
B
D
F
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/3
1/3
1/3
1
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1/6
1
1
1
1
1
1
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
61.
62.
63.
64.
65.
66.
67.
68.
69.
70.
71.
72.
73.
74.
75.
76.
77.
8.
ABCDEFGHIJ
9.
ABCDEFGHIJ
10.
ABCDEFGHIJ
deleted
ABCDE
1.
ABCDEFGHIJ
2.
ABCDEFGHIJ
3.
ABCDEFGHIJ
4.
ABCDEFGHIJ
5.
ABCDEFGHIJ
6.
ABCDEFGHIJ
7.
ABCDEFGHIJ
8.
ABCDEFGHIJ
9.
ABCDEFGHIJ
10.
ABCDEFGHIJ
1.
ABCDEFG
2.
ABCDEFG
3.
ABCDEFG
4.
ABCDEFG
ABCDEF
ABCDE
ABCDE
1.
ABCDE
2.
ABCDE
3.
ABCDE
4.
ABCDE
5.
ABCDE
ABCDE
deleted
1.
ABCDE
2.
ABCDE
3.
ABCDE
4.
ABCDE
5.
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
deleted
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
E
G
A
2/10
2/10
2/10
E
F
D
B
J
G
E
A
C
I
H
C
E
B
F
B or F
B
E
D
B
E
C
A
E
1
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
2/10
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1
1
1
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
B
C
B
D
A
D
E
C
D
B
C
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
1
1
1
1
1
B
D
C
A
E
1
1
1
1
1
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
COMPETITOR #:
THEORY EXAMINATION # 2
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-1
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
Please check that you have the appropriate examination papers and answer sheets.
It is recommended that you manage your time in proportion to the points allotted for each question.
IMPORTANT
Ensure your name and three digit code number is written on the top of each page of the answers.
Using the pencil provided, fill in the appropriate circle on the answer sheet.
Unless otherwise indicated, there is only ONE correct answer for each question.
Part marks are given and no marks are deducted for incorrect answers.
Good luck.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-2
Questions 81-85. A 14 year old teenager presents to the family doctor with numerous facial
pimples. The doctor diagnoses a moderate case of acne.
Chocolate
B.
Greasy foods
C.
Puberty
D.
Dry skin
E.
Eczema
Question 82). Acne is characterized by inflamed skin. Which of the following is NOT one of the
principal signs of inflammation? (1 point)
A.
Calor (heat)
B.
Rubor (redness)
C.
Pallor (paleness)
D.
Dolor (pain)
E.
Tumor (swelling)
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-3
Question 83). Acne is caused by infection of the sebaceous glands by Propionibacterium acne. It is
a Gram-positive bacterium which means its cell wall is composed of which of the following?
(1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 84). Which immune cells are delivered to the site of infection to phagocytose invading
bacteria? (1 point)
A.
Lymphocytes
B.
Neutrophils
C.
Eosinophils
D.
Basophils
E.
Plasma cells
Question 85). Treatment with antibiotic drugs helps overcome many bacterial infections. Why is
penicillin toxic to many bacteria? (1 point)
A.
B.
It inhibits transcription
C.
It disrupts translation
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-4
Questions 86-90. One of the most controversial issues in modern-day biology is the genetic
modification of agricultural crop plants that supply food products for human consumption.
Biologists should be aware of the underlying science of genetic modification.
Question 86). Indicate whether each statement concerning genetically modified (GM) crops in
2004 is True (T) or False (F):
(1 point)
Answer
[T/F]
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-5
Question 87). Indicate which of the following major crops have been genetically modified and are
now widely grown commercially by answering Yes (Y) or No (N).
(1 point)
Answer
[Y/N]
1. Maize
2. Wheat
3. Soybean
4. Potato
5. Canola
Question 88). Transgenic plants, like transgenic animals, are genetically-engineered varieties
containing one or more artificially inserted genes. Which of the following methods are used to
introduce genes into crop plants? (1 point)
1.
2.
Electroporation
3.
4.
5.
Microinjection
A.
1,3
B.
1,2,5
C.
2,4,5
D.
4,5
E.
all five
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-6
Question 89). Genetic engineers construct recombinant DNA molecules using two enzymes:
restriction endonuclease and DNA ligase. What do these two enzymes do? (1 point)
A. They catalyse different reactions: restriction endonuclease joins fragments into larger
molecules; DNA ligase hydrolyses DNA into smaller fragments
B. They catalyse different reactions: restriction endonuclease hydrolyses DNA into smaller
fragments; DNA ligase joins fragments into larger molecules
C. They both hydrolyse DNA into smaller fragments
D. They both join fragments of DNA into larger molecules
E. They catalyse different hydrolysis reactions: restriction endonuclease hydrolyses bacterial
plasmid DNA; DNA ligase hydrolyses DNA from eukaryotic cells
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-7
Question 90). Scientists coax transformed cells to grow into whole plants by using tissue culture
techniques in which various plant hormones are included in culture media. Match the hormones
listed in the left-hand column with the actions listed in the right-hand column. (1 point)
A. promotes growth of
excised apical meristems
B. promotes organogenesis
of roots
C. promotes organogenesis
of shoots
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-8
5-CTGACTCTT
3-GACTGAGAA
AAGAGACAG-3
TTCTCTGTC-5
Transposon DNA
Host DNA
Host DNA
5-ACATTAACC
3-TGTAATTGG
ACATTAACC-3
TGTAATTGG-5
Target site duplication
Consider the following ten statements and use them to answer Questions 91 to 95
1.
2.
3.
The two transposons and the host DNA, encoding gene X between the two
integrated transposons could be lost from the host genome
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Gene X will remain in its original position but will also be incorporated into
another chromosome.
9.
10.
Question 91). Movement of transposons is susceptible to errors; for example, if two transposons
integrate into a genome next to each other, it is not possible for the transposase enzyme to
distinguish which terminal repeats belong to which transposon. However, the direction of the
terminal inverted repeats must be conserved in the correct orientation for resolution (removal) of
the transposon. Consider two transposons integrating into a host genome in such a way that they
flank a gene encoding an enzyme for color X. What are the possible outcomes if one or both
transposons were resolved (removed)? (1 point)
A.
B.
1, 2 and 3
C.
D.
3, 5 and 6
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-10
Question 92). Cross-over events during meiosis occur when related sequences align and DNA is
exchanged between chromosomes.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-11
Question 93). If the transposons described in Question 92 were in the opposite direction, what
would the result of the crossover be? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 94). If the two transposons described in Question 92 (both in same direction) caused an
interchromosomal cross-over in which the first transposon in chromosome A crossed-over with the
second transposon contained within sister chromosome B, the resultant cross-over in chromosome
A would lead to which of the following? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
5+7
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-12
Question 95). Barbara McLintock was awarded the Nobel Prize in 1983 because of her ground
breaking work on transposable elements in maize. Her work focused on the effects that intact
transposons had on chromosomes containing defective transposons.
For this question, consider that the defective transposons contained one terminal inverted repeat
and no transposase. When a strain of maize with intact transposons (strain Ac) was crossed with
maize with a defective transposon incorporated next to gene X (strain Dc), she noticed that a loss
of color could be found in the offspring. This would arise from a change in which of the
following? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
10
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-13
Questions 96-100.
Question 96). Name the anatomical features of the heart indicated in the diagram (A-J) using terms
from the list below (1-10). (1 point)
G
F
E
2. Right atrium
7.
Right ventricle
3. Pulmonary veins
8.
Left atrium
4. Tricuspid valve
9.
Pulmonary artery
5. Aorta
10
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-14
Question 97). For the structures labelled A, B, C, E, F, H, I and J in the previous Figure, what is
the correct order for the flow of blood entering from the systemic circulation? (1 point)
A.
I, H, F, J, B, C, E, A
B.
I, H, F, A, B, C, E, J
C.
A, F, H, I, B, C, E, J
D.
J, E, C, B, A, F, H, I
E.
A, F, H, J, B, C, E, I
v = r4 p/8cl
Which of the following will have the greatest effect on the resistance to blood flow? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-15
Question 99). The following graph presents the pressure (systolic and diastolic) of a volume of
blood moving through the circulation system via different blood vessels labelled A-E.
Question 100). All the following statements are FALSE EXCEPT one. Which? (1 point)
A. A normal blood pressure for an adult is 140/90
B. During exercise blood pressure will tend to increase
C. Sympathetic impulses to the heart and blood vessels tends to decrease blood pressure
D. Decreased cardiac output causes increased blood pressure
E. A heart murmur may be caused by a leaky aortic aneurism
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-16
Question 101-105. Researchers studied the carbon cycle of a lake and summarized the results
in the following scheme (numbers represent flow of carbon in gram/m2 per year).
from the
sea
10
B
151
suspended
detritus
111
bottom
detritus
51
51
20
181
192
136
76
sedentary
bottom fauna
biomass 8.0
54
grazing
bottom fauna
biomass 6.0
48
14
36
zooplankton
biomass 0.3
57
micro-algae
net production 75
biomass 3.0
104
9
29
61
7575
phytoplankton
net production 190
biomass 1.3
macro-algae
net production 50
biomass 15.0
190
50
= dissimilation
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-17
10
B
151
111
51
51
20
181
192
136
54
8.0
76
6.0
48
14
36
0.3
57
104
61
75
3.0
29
75
H
190
1.3
50
15.0
190
50
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-18
Question 101). What is the total biomass of consumers present in the scheme? (1 point)
A.
8.3
B.
9.6
C.
14.0
D.
14.3
E.
29.0
Question 102). What is the total gross primary production of this ecosystem? (1 point)
A.
125
B.
240
C.
265
D.
315
E.
630
Question 103). An indicator for the productive power of an ecosystem is the so-called P/B ratio,
where P = net primary production and B = biomass. Which group has the highest P/B ratio?
(1 point)
A.
B.
C.
F (phytoplankton)
D.
G (micro algae)
E.
H (macro algae)
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-19
Question 104). Macro-algae and micro-algae differ in their net production. Which of the following
statements could explain the difference? (1 point)
Question 105). In the lake, approximately how many days are necessary to renew the entire
biomass of micro-algae? (1 point)
A.
75
B.
61
C.
25
D.
15
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-20
Questions 106-110. All organisms reproduce by at least one of two processes asexual or
sexual. Both processes involve replication of genetic material - producing identical offspring
in the case of asexual reproduction, or variable offspring (combination of gametes from two
different parent organisms) in the case of sexual reproduction. In eukaryotic cells,
replication of DNA is controlled by the cell cycle.
Question 106). Which of the following statements regarding human sex chromosomes is FALSE?
(1 point)
A. X chromosomes contain hundreds of genes
B. Y chromosomes contains the fewest genes of any human chromosome
C. The Y chromosome has very likely evolved from an X chromosome in an ancestral species
D. Most X chromosome genes concern female sexual development
E. Y chromosomes are unique in that they can never undergo crossing over during meiosis
Question 107). Mitosis is a fundamental cellular process that has which of the following
properties? (1 point)
A. The outcome is two daughter cells that are genetically identical because they have each
received an identical set of chromosomes
B. Mitosis is crucial for growth, for the replacement of damaged or aging cells and for asexual
reproduction
C. In many species, haploid cells as well as diploid cells undergo mitosis
D. Two of the above
E. All of the above except D
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-21
Question 108). The amount of DNA in a cell can be determined by measuring the fluorescence of a
dye that binds in direct proportion to the amount of DNA. The histogram below represents the
fluorescence of a eukaryotic germ cell during different stages of cell division (I, II, III, IV and V).
Which of the following sequences represents the correct match of stages I-V with the division
stages numbered 1-5?
(1 point)
1. Anaphase I of meiosis
2. Anaphase II of meiosis
3. Cytokinesis following Telophase II
4. Prophase II of meiosis
5. Prophase I of meiosis
A.
1 = II,
2 = IV,
3 = V,
4 = III,
5=I
B.
1 = I,
2 = II,
3 = III,
4 = IV,
5=V
C.
1 = V,
2 = IV,
3 = III,
4 = II,
5=I
D.
1 = I,
2 = II,
3 = IV,
4 = III,
5=V
E.
1 = IV,
2 = I,
3 = II,
4 = III,
5=V
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-22
Question 109). Cytokinesis is the process that divides the cytoplasm of a parent animal cell into
two daughter cells. From the following list of proteins, which are involved in cytokinesis steps? (1
point)
Tubulin
Fibronectin
Histone
Actin
Myosin
Collagen
Albumin
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-23
Question 110). The diagram below represents a eukaryotic cell cycle divided into 5 phases.
E
Non-dividing cells
A
Match phases A-E on the diagram with the cell cycle stages shown in the Table and match the
processes F-J with the appropriate cell cycle stage shown in the Table.
F.
Cytokinesis
G.
H.
Duplication of DNA
I.
Quiescent cells
J.
1.
G2
2.
3.
G1
4.
5.
Go
(1 point)
Phase
Function
[A,B,C,D,E]
[F,G,H,I,J]
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-24
Questions 111-115.
Question 111). Why do the cows go to the milking shed of their own accord? (0.5 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 112) Milk is collected twice daily from the dairy herd. Which of the following statements
is FALSE? (0.5 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-25
Question 113). Cows are ruminants. They have special sacculated digestive tracts to facilitate
fermentative digestion. Name the organs numbered on the diagram using the terms listed below.
(1 point)
A. omasum
B. duodenum
C. reticulum
D. oesophagus
E. rumen
F. ileum
G. jejunum
H. abomasum
I. colon
Answer
[A/B/C/D/E/F/G/H/I]
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-26
Question 114). Digestion of food is facilitated by enzymes produced by various organs. Indicate
the sites of production of the listed enzymes and which substrates they act on. (2 points)
Organs
Food substrates
Enzymes
A. intestines
F. polysaccharides
1. trypsin
B. stomach
G. proteins
2. lipase
C. pancreas
H. fat
3. aminopeptidase
D. salivary gland
4. chymotrypsin
E. liver
5. amylase
Organ
Substrate
(A/B/C/D/E)
(F/G/H)
6. pepsin
Question 115). Cows do not produce cellulase enzymes to digest plant cells. Instead, they rely on
endosymbiotic micro-organisms to do so. Indicate which organisms produce cellulases in the
rumen to digest plant cell walls by answering Yes (Y) or No (N). (1 point)
Answer
[Y/N]
1. viruses
2. bacteria
3. spirochaetes
4. rickettsia
5. protozoa
6. fungi
7. algae
8. helminths
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-27
Questions 116-120. The diagram below shows a single-celled green microalga from the ocean.
Its single chloroplast and several other cellular components are labelled.
A. thylakoid membrane
B. stroma of chloroplast
C. cytosol
D. plasma membrane
E. cell wall
F. flagellum
(1 point)
Answer
[A/B/C/D/E/F]
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-28
Question 117). Two mineral nutrients required for the growth of algae are magnesium (Mg) and
manganese (Mn). What are the roles of these minerals?
(1 point)
Question 118). Indicate whether or not the generation of photosynthetic reducing power by this
alga is directly essential for the indicated cellular processes by answering Yes (Y) or No (N).
(1
point)
Answer
[Y/N]
1. manufacture of sugars from CO2 and H2O
2. conversion of nitrate (NO3-) to the ammonium (NH4+)
required for the biosynthesis of amino acids
3. production of citrate from glucose
4. incorporation of cytosolic phosphate (HPO42-/H2PO4-)
into DNA and RNA
5. assimilation of sulphate (SO42-) into the amino acids
cysteine and methionine
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-29
Question 119). Which statement summarizes the reproductive capabilities of this alga? (1 point)
A. Reproduces by mitosis, in which case genetically variable offspring are produced
B. Reproduces by meiosis, in which case genetically identical offspring are produced
C. Reproduces by mitosis, in which case genetically identical offspring are produced
D. Reproduces by meiosis, in which case genetically variable offspring are produced
E. Reproduces by C and D
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-30
Question 120). Flagella are common among eukaryotic organisms. Some prokaryotic organisms
(bacteria) also possess flagella. Consider the following statements.
1. Bacterial flagella are covered with two membranes
2. Eukaryotic flagella undulate when driving cell movement
3. Both bacterial and eukaryotic flagella use proton gradients as direct energy sources
4. Prokaryotic flagella are formed from actin; eukaryotic flagella are formed from tubulin
5. Prokaryotic flagella are proteinaceous spiral filaments attached to multi-protein rotors
6. All prokaryotic cells have at least one flagellum
7. All eukaryotic flagella are covered with an extension of the plasma membrane
8. All functional eukaryotic flagella contain molecular motor-proteins (dyneins)
9. Prokaryotic flagella can rotate only in the one direction
10. Each eukaryotic flagellum has its own basal body
2, 5, 7, 8, 10
B.
1, 4, 7, 9, 10
C.
3, 5, 6, 8, 10
D.
2, 4, 7, 8, 9
E.
1, 3, 5, 7, 9
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-31
Questions 121-123. Many genotypic and phenotypic traits recognized in animals and plants
have been used in genetic mapping studies and biosystematics.
Question 121). A cladistic classification of part of the Animal Kingdom is shown below.
Salamander
Lung fish
Shark
Sea squirt
(Tunicate)
8
7
Lung
1
Aorta
From the 16 options shown below (A-O), assign the nine most appropriate features to the positions
numbered 1-9. (2 points)
A. Amniotic egg
F. Gill slits
B. Bony fin
G. Hinged jaw
L. Swim bladder
C. Cephalization
M. Vertebrae
D. Three-chambered heart
I. Limbs
N. Ribs
O. Tail
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-32
Question 122). Wing structure and function are characteristic for insect orders. Match the wing
characteristics listed in the right-hand column (1-5) with the insect orders listed in the left-hand
column (A-E). (1 point)
A. Odonata
B. Diptera
C. Orthoptera
3. Wingless
D. Lepidoptera
E. Phthiraptera
(Anoplura)
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-33
Question 123). Three alleles (a, b and c) are linked on a normal chromosome (autosome) of a
plant . An hybrid
ABC
abc
was crossed with a recessive
and the types and numbers of gametes
abc
abc
414
Abc
70
aBc
28
abC
abc
386
aBC
80
AbC
20
ABc
abc
B.
acb
C.
bac
2). What is the correct distance between the three loci (in map units)? (2 points)
distance between a and c
A.
2.1
2.4
B.
3.4
5.0
C.
5.0
15.2
D.
15.2
3.4
E.
15.2
5.0
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-34
Questions 124-126. A plant biologist studies the sexual reproduction of a moss, a fern, and a
flowering plant (tomato). The biologist makes the following drawings:
X.
Y.
Z.
Z
4
2
5
3
9
8
Question 124). Indicate which structures conform to the following statements: (2 points)
1. Haploid cells that carry out photosynthesis
A.
Only 4, 5
B.
Only 3
C.
Only 1, 2, 6
D.
Only 4, 8
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-35
Only 1, 2, 3
B.
Only 3
C.
Only 3, 4, 8
D.
Only 4, 8
Only 1, 2
B.
Only 1, 2, 6, 7
C.
Only 1, 5, 9
D.
Only 6, 7, 9
Only 1, 5, 7, 9
B.
Only 3, 4, 8
C.
Only 1, 2, 5
D.
Only 2, 8
5. Structure(s) that will produce spores destined to germinate and produce a haploid
photosynthetic plant
A.
Only 1
B.
Only 1, 5
C.
Only 1, 5, 7
D.
Only 5, 7
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-36
Question 125). The life cycle of a fern is shown in the diagram below. Five processes (numbered
1, 2, 3, 4, 5) and five stages (labelled I, II, III, IV, V) are indicated.
I
Sporophyte
1
II
Spore
V
Zygote
IV
Gamete (female)
IV
Gamete (male)
III
Gametophyte
Only 1, 3
B.
Only 2, 3, 4
C.
Only 1, 4
D.
Only 3
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-37
Only 1
B.
Only 1, 2, 3
C.
Only 2, 5
D.
Only 3, 4
Only I, III, IV
B.
C.
Only I, V
D.
Only IV
B.
C.
Only II, V
D.
Only I, V
5. Those stages (or equivalents) not present in the human life cycle
A.
Only I, III
B.
C.
Only III, IV
D.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-38
Question 126). The biologist examines sexual reproduction in a grass. He/she examines a rice
grain, makes a cross-sectional drawing and labels the component parts.
A. pericarp
B. aleurone layer
C. endosperm
D. embryo
For each part, select the ploidy of the tissue (n, 2n, 3n, etc) and if two or more tissues have the
same ploidy, indicate whether they are genetically identical or not, as follows:
2n
2n
genetically identical
2n-i
2n-ii
genetically different
A.
A: 2n
B: n
C: n
D: 2n
B.
A: 2n-i
B: 3n
C: 3n
D: 2n-ii
C.
A: 3n-i
B: 3n-ii
C: 3n-iii
D: 2n
D.
A: 2n-i
B: n
C: 2n-ii
D: 3n
E.
A: 2n
B: 3n-i
C: 3n-ii
D: 2n
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-39
Questions 127-131. Albumin, with a molecular mass of 68,000 Da, is the most abundant
protein in blood plasma, accounting for approximately 60% of all plasma protein.
Question 127). A person was found to have reduced levels of plasma albumin, losses occurring as
the result of kidney damage. Indicate the part of the kidney shown in the following diagram that
you would expect to be the primary site of damage for this patient. (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
7
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-40
Question 128).
The patient had swelling around the feet. An explanation for this symptom is that loss of albumin
from plasma leads to which of the following? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-41
Question 129). Albumin is synthesized in liver cells and secreted into the blood plasma. A diagram
showing the ultrastructure of a liver cell is given below.
Which combination of organelles would be involved in the synthesis and transport of albumin to
the plasma membrane for secretion? (1 point)
A.
B.
mitochondria, endosomes
C.
D.
E.
F.
endosomes, cytosol
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-42
Question 130). Eukaryotic proteins encoded by the nuclear genome are translated from an
initiation AUG codon thus newly synthesized proteins have a methionine residue at the extreme
amino-terminus. However, albumin isolated from human blood plasma does not have an aminoterminal methionine. Which of the following statements accounts for this? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-43
Question 131). The concentration of albumin in the blood plasma of a patient can be determined
using a test based on the specific binding of albumin to a chemical dye. The graph shows the
absorbance readings of the albumin-dye complex at different light wavelengths.
Which absorption spectrum is consistent with the above data for albumin at 2 g/L? (1 point)
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-44
Questions 132-136. When oxygen levels are low, some cells may resort to the process of
fermentation to obtain energy. Examples include yeast cells used in bakeries, breweries and
wineries.
Question 132). The manufacture of bread, beer and wine all involve alcoholic fermentation of
glucose to ethanol by yeast. Which combination of the following eight statements concerning this
process is correct? (2 points)
1.
2.
3.
The net generation of ATP is only two molecules per molecule of glucose fermented
4.
More than 80% of the chemical energy of the glucose is released as heat
5.
6.
The conversion of one molecule of citrate to one molecule of malate and two molecules
of CO2 is an integral part of this fermentation
7.
The electron donor for ethanol formation (catalysed by alcohol dehydrogenase) is NADH
8.
CO2 is evolved when beer is produced by alcoholic fermentation, but not when bread or
wine are produced by alcoholic fermentation
A.
1, 2, 3, 4, 5
B.
1, 4, 7, 8
C.
2, 3, 5, 7
D.
2, 3, 6, 7, 8
E.
3, 4, 5, 7, 8
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-45
Question 133). A healthy student decides to enter a 200 metre race. He has not trained to be an
athlete, so he has little chance to prepare except to eat well. On the day of the race, he completes
the run in 27 seconds. He finishes exhausted and suffers from leg-muscle cramps. (1 point)
1. What was the students main source of energy during the race?
A. Muscle glucose and glycogen
B. Free amino acids in his muscle
C. The lipid component of blood low-density lipoproteins
D. Starch being digested from his last meal
3. Which of the following biochemical pathways were important in his muscle during the race?
A. Fatty acid oxidation
B. Glycolysis
C. Gluconeogenesis
D. NADPH-generating oxidative pentose-phosphate pathway
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-46
Question 134). Glucose in human liver cells can be synthesized from which combination of the
following non-sugar sources? (1 point)
1. adenine
2. alanine
3. lactate
4. palmitate
5. glycerol
A.
Only 1, 2, 3
B.
Only 1, 4
C.
Only 2, 3, 4, 5
D.
Only 4, 5
E.
Only 2, 3, 5
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-47
A.
Only 1, 5
B.
Only 1, 2, 6
C.
Only 1, 3, 4, 6
D.
Only 2
E.
Only 2, 5
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-48
Question 137). A widely-held theory is that mitochondria evolved from endosymbiotic bacteria.
Indicate which statements support this theory by answering Yes (Y) or No (N). (1 point)
[Y/N]
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Question 138). Which of the following statements about mitochondria are correct? (Y = correct; N =
incorrect) (1 point)
[Y/N]
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
uestion 139). During oxidation of NADH by the electron transport chain, protons are pumped
across the inner mitochondrial membrane. Which of the following statements about this process is
INCORRECT? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
The ATP synthase complex uses the proton gradient to make ATP
E.
F.
G.
Question 140). Which of the following statements about mitochondrial DNA and protein synthesis
is correct?
(1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
Mitochondrial DNA codes for active RNA molecules but not for proteins
G.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-50
Question 141). An electrochemical proton gradient is also responsible for powering bacterial
flagella. During oxidation of glucose, protons are pumped out of the cell to help establish an
electrochemical gradient. The flagellar motor is driven directly by the flux of protons back into the
bacterial cell from the proton gradient. Addition of FCCP, a proton ionophore, to these bacteria in
+
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Questions 142-146. Animals have developed complex patterns of behaviour which scientists
are slowly learning to decipher through rigorous experimentation. Animals live in complex
ecosystems and many varied parameters influence their behaviour.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-51
Question 142). The following matrix shows elephant head positions relative to their tendency to
fight or fly (with four illustrations labelled 1-4 missing).
The missing illustrations are shown below in random order (labelled I-IV).
Which illustrations (I-IV) correctly match positions (1-4) in the matrix? (1 point)
Position 1
Position 2
Position 3
Position 4
A.
II
III
IV
B.
IV
II
III
C.
II
IV
III
D.
II
IV
III
E.
III
II
IV
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-52
Question 143). Scientists put mallard ducklings (Anas platyrhynchos) into a large outdoor enclosure
and then moved a silhouette shape (pictured below) across the top of the enclosure at intermittent
intervals and in either direction (as shown).
Eight possible behaviours are listed below for different test conditions.
1. The ducklings crouch and run during movement of the shape from left to the right.
2. The ducklings do not respond during movement of the shape from right to the left.
3. The ducklings respond more to the hawk shape than the duck shape.
4. Ducklings reared and tested together with ducks are more likely to crouch
than run in response to the hawk shape.
5. Ducklings will respond more to the duck shape than the hawk shape.
6. Ducklings reared and tested alone are more likely to run than crouch
in response to the hawk shape.
7. Ducklings reared and tested together with ducks are more likely to run
than crouch in response to the hawk shape.
8. Ducklings reared and tested alone are more likely to crouch than run
in response to the hawk shape.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-53
1, 5, 8
B.
3, 5, 6
C.
2, 3, 7
D.
3, 4, 6
E.
4, 7, 8
Question 144). Consider three hypothetical communities I, II and III, each containing ten species.
The following graphs show the relative abundance (vertical axis) of each species, when the species
are ranked in decreasing order of abundance on the horizontal axis.
frequency
0.15
0.9
0.3
II
0.1
0.6
0.2
0.05
0.3
0.1
0
1
10
species
species number
III
number
9 10
species
9 10
number
How would you rank the communities in decreasing order of biodiversity? (1 point)
A.
I = II = III
B.
C.
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-54
Question 145). The following graph indicates the variation in vegetation ground cover with
distance from a stock water supply point in a semi-arid pasture during three successive years. The
pasture was grazed in Years 1 and 2 but was ungrazed in Year 3.
80
60
40
Year 3 ungrazed
Year 1 grazed
Year 2 grazed
20
0
0
10
15
20
The patterns of variation in vegetation cover with distance from water indicate which of the
following? (1 point)
A. Rainfall was approximately equal in Years 1 and 3, and substantially less in Year 2
B. Grazing pressure is much more severe over the entire area in a dry year than in a wet
year
C. Grazing in Years 1 and 2 affects the vegetation cover in Year 3, and grazing pressure is
inversely proportional to distance from the water supply point
D. The animals graze only within 10 km of the water supply point
E. Stocking density was higher in year 1 than year 2
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-55
Question 146). Consider the following schematic diagram of generalized nutrient cycling within
ecosystems. The labelled arrows A to D represent transfer between the pools.
Organic Materials
available as nutrients
Inorganic Materials
available as nutrients
Organic Materials
unavailable as nutrients
Inorganic Materials
unavailable as nutrients
Which of the following statements about the rate of transfer per unit time between these pools is
correct? (1 point)
A. The rate at which transfer A occurs is slower than the rate at which B occurs
B. The rate at which transfer D occurs is faster than the rate at which transfer A occurs
C. All transfers occur at similar rates
D. The rate at which transfer A occurs is faster than the rate at which B occurs
E. These rates are largely unaffected by human actions
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-56
Questions 147-151.
The structures of the components (labelled A-E) are shown separately below.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-57
Question 147). Phospholipids are often represented as having a head (H) and tail (T) region.
Indicate where each of the component parts of phosphatidylcholine are found. (1 point)
Answer [H/T]
A. palmitic acid
B. linoleic acid
C. glycerol
D. phosphoric acid
E. choline
3.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-58
Question 149). Considering the roles of membrane lipids and proteins, and the functions of the
following membranes, match the protein/lipid ratios given below to the following membranes.
(1 point).
A.
B.
C.
Answer
[A/B/C]
1.
1:1
2.
4:1
3.
1:4
Question 150). Proteins can span a membrane by means of a stretch of 20 nonpolar amino acids in
an -helical arrangement. Given that the -helix has a pitch of 0.54 nm and has 3.6 amino acid
residues per turn, what is the thickness of the nonpolar central section of the lipid bilayer?
(1 point)
A.
0.18 nm
B.
3.0 nm
C.
5.5 nm
D.
10.2 nm
E.
37.0 nm
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-59
Question 151). Select two of the following molecules which you would expect to be able to
diffuse readily across a biological bilayer membrane. (1 point)
A.
1+2
B.
1+3
C.
1+4
D.
2+3
E.
2+4
F.
3+4
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-60
Questions 152-156. Two species of nectarivorous bird are feeding in the same meadow. Both
species of bird have already migrated some distance from their wintering ground to reach
the meadow. They need to migrate further to reach their breeding grounds. While on the
meadow, each individual bird holds a feeding territory. They are feeding on the nectar in the
flowers of one species of plant.
Question 152). What are the two main resources that the nectar provides? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 153). What will be the birds primary objective during their time on the meadow?
(1 point)
A.
Find a mate
B.
C.
Rear young
D.
E.
IBO2004-Theory-2-page-61
Question 154). The types of interaction between the plant and the birds, and between the two
species of bird, are called which of the following, respectively? (1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 155). All else being equal, what type of flowers would the birds prefer to choose?
(1 point)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Question 156). A few of the plants have a gene that, when expressed, means they secrete no
nectar. Which of the following statements is true? (1 point)
A.
These plants will have no offspring because the birds will not visit their flowers
B.
C.
Plants that do not secrete nectar save energy that can be used for growth and other
plant functions
D.
Failure to secrete nectar must be a recessive trait that confers no selective advantage
E.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
ANSWER SHEET
Q.
part
81.
82.
83.
84.
85.
86.
87.
88.
89.
90.
91.
92.
93.
94.
95.
96.
deleted
97.
98.
99.
100
101.
102.
103.
104.
105.
106.
107.
108.
109.
choices
answer
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
C
B
B
E
1
1
1
1
ABCDE
ABCDE
B
B
1
1
deleted
deleted
deleted
deleted
deleted
deleted
1.
ABCDEFGHIJ
2.
ABCDEFGHIJ
3.
ABCDEFGHIJ
4.
ABCDEFGHIJ
5.
ABCDEFGHIJ
6.
ABCDEFGHIJ
7.
ABCDEFGHIJ
8.
ABCDEFGHIJ
9.
ABCDEFGHIJ
10.
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDE
ABCDE
1.
ABCDE
2.
ABCDE
3.
ABCDE
4.
ABCDE
5.
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
.
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
D
H
B
G
J
I
F
C
A
E
B
B
D
C
B
E
A
B
D
E
C
B
D
D
E
A
D
1/10
1/10
1/10
1/10
1/10
1/10
1/10
1/10
1/10
1/10
1
1
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
deleted
deleted
110.
111.
112.
113.
114.
115.
116.
117.
118.
119.
120.
121.
122.
123.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDEFGHIJ
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFGH
ABCDEFGH
ABCDEFGH
ABCDEFGH
ABCDEFGH
ABCDEFGH
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDEF
ABCDE
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
ABCDE
ABCDE
deleted
1
ABCDE
2
ABCDE
3
ABCDE
4
ABCDE
5
ABCDE
1.
ABC
2
ABCDE
CJ
DF
AG
BH
EI
C
E
A
D
C
H
E
CG
(CorB)andH
AG
CG
(CorD)andF
BG
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
A
B
E
C
B
Y
Y
N
N
Y
E
A
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/2
1/2
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/8
1/8
1/8
1/8
1/8
1/8
1/8
1/8
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
2
B
A
E
C
D
B
E
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
2
124.
125.
126.
127.
128.
129.
130.
131.
132.
133.
134.
135.
136.
137.
138.
139.
140.
141.
142.
143.
144.
145.
146.
147.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
A.
B.
C.
D.
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCDE
ABCDEFG
ABCDE
ABCDEF
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
YN
ABCDEFG
ABCDEFG
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
HT
HT
HT
HT
B
D
D
A
B
C
A
B
D
B
B
C
E
D
C
B
C
A
B
B
B
E
C
A
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
F
E
A
B
D
B or A
C
D
T
T
H
H
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
2/5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1/4
1/4
1/4
1/4
1
1
1
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1/5
1/5
1/5
1/5
148.
149.
150.
151.
152.
153.
154.
155.
156.
E.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
HT
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABCDE
ABCDEF
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
ABCDE
H
B
A
D
B
C
A
B
E
C
B
E
A
C
1/5
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Country:
TASK 1
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
It is recommended that Competitors proportion their time according to the allotted points for each
task and question.
IMPORTANT
Ensure that your 3 digit code number is written and coded on the top of each page of the answer
sheets.
Using the pencil provided, fill in the appropriate circle on the answer sheet.
TASK 1
TASK 1
MEASUREMENT OF ENZYME ACTIVITY
INTRODUCTION
Alcohol dehydrogenase (ADH) is an enzyme that oxidises ethanol to acetaldehyde (ethanal)
according to the following reaction.
Ethanol + NAD
acetaldehyde + NADH + H
The cofactor nicotinamide adenine dinucleotide (NAD+) is reduced in the reaction. The progress of
the reaction can be monitored by measuring the concentration of NADH at a wavelength of 340 nm.
In this practical task you will use a spectrophotometer to measure the activity of this enzyme at
various concentrations of ethanol.
TASK 1
Chemicals
Ethanol Solutions:
Reaction Buffer:
40mM KCl
Enzyme:
Equipment
Laboratory Timer
Marking pens
Safety glasses
Disposable gloves
Ruler
Black pen
TASK 1
EXPERIMENTAL PROCEDURE
Set up the following duplicate reaction mixtures in 1mL plastic cuvettes, as shown in the Table:
Reaction No.
Reaction Buffer
Ethanol solution
1a
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.063M
1b
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.063M
2a
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.125M
2b
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.125M
3a
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.250M
3b
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.250M
4a
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.500M
4b
0.9 mL
0.1mL of 0.500M
TASK 1
Your spectrophotometer has been set up to measure the absorbance at a wavelength of 340 nm.
Carry out the following steps to prepare for the enzyme activity measurements:
If you are using an Hitachi U-1100 Spectrophotometer
Place the cuvette containing the reaction mixture for reaction 1a in position 1 (front) of the cell
holder.
To set the absorbance reading to zero, press the 100%T/ 0 ABS button (labelled with red dot).
The absorbance display should read 0.000.
Place the cuvette containing the reaction mixture for reaction 1a in position 1 (front) of the cell
holder.
To set the absorbance reading to zero, press the AUTO ZERO button (labelled with red dot).
The absorbance display should read 0.000.
TASK 1
Carry out the enzyme activity measurements one at a time, starting with Reaction No. 1a:
(a) Place the cuvette containing the reaction mixture in the spectrophotometer cell.
(b) To start each reaction, add 10 L of Enzyme to the cuvette placed in the spectrophotometer.
(c) Quickly but gently mix the solution in the cuvette with a white plastic stirrer, close the
spectrophotometer lid, set the Absorbance to zero, AND immediately start your timer.
(d) Record the absorbance reading exactly 1 minute later. This is the t = 1 min absorbance reading.
This reading is equal to the rate of enzyme reaction (designated V), expressed as the change
() in absorbance at 340 nm over the 1 minute period (i.e. A340 /min) from t = 0 to t = 1 minute
Enter the values obtained into the Results Table in Column 1.
For the graphing component of the practical test that follows, also determine the values for 1/Vaverage
-1
and enter these in the column of the Table on the right. The values for 1/S (units mM ), where S =
substrate (ethanol) concentration in mM, have been included for you in the last column. For
example, for Reactions 4a and 4b, the actual ethanol concentration in the reactions is 50mM,
-1
Reaction
No.
TASK 1
Column
Column
graph
V
(Average
A340 /min
1/VAverage
A340 /min)
1/S
-1
(mM )
1a
0.160
1b
2a
0.080
2b
3a
0.040
3b
4a
0.020
4b
TASK 1
If your results were plotted as the enzyme rate (V), expressed as A340 /min, versus ethanol
substrate concentration (S), a graph of the shape shown below would be obtained. This shows that
enzyme rate increases with substrate concentration until a maximum rate (Vmax) is reached. From
this graph, Km, a value equal to the substrate concentration at half-maximal velocity, can be
determined.
Vmax
V
Vmax/2
Km
S
A more accurate way to determine the Km is using a plot of 1/V against 1/S. The point where the
line intersects the X-axis is equal to 1/Km. Use the graph with pre-drawn axes provided to plot
a line-of-best-fit for your results.
1/V
- 1/Km
1/S
Km =
mM
DOUBLE CHECK YOUR Km VALUE (AND UNITS). THEN HOLD UP THE PINK CARD
PROVIDED TO ATTRACT THE ATTENTION OF THE DEMONSTRATOR WHO WILL
RECORD YOUR ANSWER ON THE ANSWER SHEET. (Task P1.T1.5) (6 points)
9
TASK 1
Alcohol dehydrogenase assays can be used to determine the levels of ethanol added to motor fuels.
Assume that you are a scientist in a testing laboratory and you have been given a 10 mL sample of a
fuel sample to test for the level of added ethanol. Following extraction of the sample to remove all
traces of solvent, you are left with a 100 mL aqueous sample that contains the ethanol. Using
spectrophotometry exactly as before, you test for the ethanol concentration of 0.1 mL of this
aqueous sample. The enzyme rate (V), expressed as A340 /min, that you obtained is 0.175. Assume
that, as before, 0.1 mL of each of the standard ethanol solutions was also tested at the same time,
and these measurments allowed you to plot the graph provided. Use the graph to determine the
molar concentration of ethanol in the original fuel sample.
The more usual way of expressing fuel ethanol levels is as a %, i.e. g/100mL. Work out the % fuel
ethanol level for this original sample, given that the molecular formula for ethanol is CH3CH2OH
and using the following atomic masses (g/mol): C = 12, H = 1, O = 16.
10
TASK 1
The light absorption spectra for NAD and NADH are shown in the Figure below.
Which of the following statements (1-7) are correct? (Select from answers on next page.)
11
TASK 1
END OF TASK 1
PLACE YOUR ANSWER SHEET ON TOP OF THE REST OF YOUR PAPERWORK AT YOUR
WORKSTATION
12
Country:
TASK 2
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
It is recommended that Competitors proportion their time according to the allotted points for each
task and question.
IMPORTANT
Ensure that your 3 digit code number is written and coded on the top of each page of the answer
sheets.
Using the pencil provided, fill in the appropriate circle on the answer sheet.
TASK 2
TASK 2
SEPARATION OF PROTEINS BY CHROMATOGRAPHY AND ELECTROPHORESIS
PART A
ION EXCHANGE CHROMATOGRAPHY
INTRODUCTION
Ion exchange chromatography is a technique used to separate proteins on the basis of overall
electric charge. Such a separation depends on the acid-base properties of the relevant proteins and
the charge on the chromatographic matrix used to separate them. Since the net charge on a protein
is dependent on pH, ion exchange chromatography is only effective under conditions of defined pH.
At pH 8.0, cation exchange matrices, such as the Hi-Trap SP to be used in this task, carry a
negative charge and therefore bind positively charged proteins. Ions in the solution with a like
charge to the proteins will compete with those proteins for binding to the matrix. Competing ions in
excess prevent or reverse binding of proteins, thereby causing them to be eluted (washed from the
column) from the matrix.
In this experiment you will be provided with a protein sample containing two proteins, albumin and
cytochrome c. Albumin, a major protein of blood plasma, has a molecular mass of 68,000 Daltons
(Da) and consists of a single chain of amino acids. Cytochrome c functions in electron transport in
mitochondria and consists of a single chain of amino acids that is bound to an iron-containing heme
group that absorbs visible light at a wavelength of 410 nm. Cytochrome c has a total molecular
TASK 2
mass of 12,400 Da. So called Ribbon structures of these two proteins are shown below: Albumin
(left), cytochrome c (right).
In this practical session you will use ion exchange chromatography to separate albumin and
cytochrome c.
TASK 2
Chemicals
Protein sample: 4 mg/mL albumin and 4 mg/mL cytochrome c
Buffer 1: 50mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0 buffer.
Buffer 2: 50mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0 buffer containing 0.5M NaCl
Protein Assay Reagent
Equipment
Safety glasses
Disposable gloves
Marker pen
TASK 2
PROCEDURE
1. Label the microtitre plate (on the attached tape) with your blue Bench Card Number AND
Competitor Number. (For example, if your Bench Card Number is 5 and your Competitor
Number is 14-3, label the plate: 5/14-3).
2. The ion-exchange column is equilibrated with Buffer 1 (50mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0) and ready
for immediate use.
3. Draw up 5mL of Buffer 1 into the 5-mL Buffer 1 plastic syringe.
4. Remove the black screw-on cap from the outlet plug at the bottom of the column.
5. Attach the syringe to the top of the column by firmly pushing into the black adapter
6. Load 1mL of buffer onto the column by gently and evenly depressing the syringe plunger.
Run the waste into the plastic beaker.
7. Now draw up 0.2mL of the protein sample into a 1mL plastic syringe.
8. Load the protein sample onto the column by gently and evenly depressing the syringe
plunger. While loading, start to collect fractions of 4 drops each into each well of Row A of
the 96 well microtitre plate.
9. Once the sample has been loaded, replace the syringe with the 5mL syringe containing
Buffer 1.
10. Continue to collect 4-drop fractions into each well of Row A.
11. When Row A is complete (Fractions 1-12), replace the screw-on plug to the outlet of the
column and remove the syringe from the column.
12. Fill a new 5mL syringe with Buffer 2 (50mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0 buffer containing 0.5 M
NaCl).
13. Attach the new syringe to the column, remove the screw-on plug and continue to collect 4drop fractions into Row C of the 96 well microtitre plate.
14. When Row C is complete (Fractions 13-24), replace the screw-on plug to the column.
6
TASK 2
15. Using an adjustable pipette, transfer 20L from each well in Row A (Fractions 1-12) into
the corresponding well in Row B.
16. Similarly, transfer 20L from each well in Row C (Fractions 13-24) into the corresponding
well in Row D.
17. Using an adjustable pipette, add 200L of the Protein Assay Reagent to each well of Rows
B and D. This reagent reacts with protein to yield a blue colour that can be measured by
spectrophotometry at 595 nm using a plate reader.
18. Check for and eliminate air bubbles in the wells of your 96-well microtitre plate (do this
carefully, using a clean yellow tip).
19. HOLD UP THE BLUE CARD PROVIDED TO ATTRACT THE ATTENTION OF
THE DEMONSTRATOR to note that your 96-well microtitre plate is ready to be
analyzed. The plate reader will measure the absorbance of the fractions at both 595nm and
410nm. A printout of the results will be returned to you by the demonstrator.
Questions
Q1. Which fraction (1-24) contained the first eluted A595 peak
Q2. Which fraction (1-24) contained the second eluted A595 peak (Task P1.T2.2) (1 point)
Q3. Which fraction (1-24) contained the A410 peak
TASK 2
Q4. Subtract the fraction number obtained in answer T2.1 from that obtained in answer T2.2 and
enter the value.
(Task P1.T2.4) (1
point)
Q5. In which fraction (1-24) did the peak of cytochrome c elute?
Q6. In your experiment you would have noted that one protein eluted directly from the column but
the second protein needed added salt to be eluted. Consider these statements:
1. The salt neutralised the ionic interaction between the matrix and the second protein eluted
2. The protein that eluted first was more positively charged than the protein eluted with salt
3. The protein that eluted first was more negatively charged than the protein eluted with salt
4. The protein that eluted first did so because it was larger than the protein eluted with salt
5. The protein that eluted first did so because it was smaller than the protein eluted with salt
TASK 2
Q7. In another experiment you added a third protein (Protein X) to the protein sample containing
albumin and cytochrome c and repeated the ion-exchange chromatography separation and detection
exactly as before. The collated results obtained from the plate reader are shown below: The elution
peak corresponding to Protein X is labelled. For convenience, the other two proteins are arbitrarily
labelled A and B.
A595
A410
A
X
12 13
Fraction
B
24
TASK 2
10
TASK 2
PART B
TWO-DIMENSIONAL GEL ELECTROPHORESIS
The diagram below shows the results of an experiment where a mixture of albumin, cytochrome c
and other, unknown proteins were separated by two-dimensional gel electrophoresis. In this
technique, the proteins were separated in the first dimension on the basis of their isoelectric point
(pI) followed by separation in the second dimension on the basis of their molecular mass. The
isoelectric point is defined as the pH at which the sum of the positive and negative charges on the
protein is zero. The isoelectric point (pI) for albumin is 4.9 and for cytochrome c is 10.7. The
individual proteins were subsequently detected using a protein stain. Each protein spot has been
given an alphabetical letter identifier.
2
100,000
pH
6
A
F
GH
80,000
60,000
Molecular
Mass (Da)
10
14
12
C
40,000
20,000
M
N
O
QR
S
T
U
5,000
11
TASK 2
Q10. Phosphorylation is a relatively common modification of proteins that occurs after they have
been synthesised. The proteins affected can have a variable number of attached negatively charged
phosphate groups; this also leads to a slight increase in their molecular mass.
From the data presented in the figure above, choose which group of proteins best represents the
situation where a parent protein has been modified to generate a number of phosphorylated
species that are less abundant. List the proteins in this group in order, starting with the parent
protein through to the most phosphorylated protein.
END OF TASK 2
PLACE YOUR ANSWER SHEET ON TOP OF THE REST OF YOUR PAPERWORK AT YOUR
WORKSTATION
12
Country:
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
It is recommended that Competitors proportion their time according to the allotted points for
each task and question.
IMPORTANT
Ensure that your 3 digit code number is written and coded on the top of each page of the
answer sheets.
Using the pencil provided, fill in the appropriate circle on the answer sheet.
TASK 1
Binocular microscope - with 10X, 40X, 100X (oil immersion) objective lens and
10X eyepiece lens.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Procedure
You are supplied with a prepared blood smear that has been stained with Wrights stain.
Wrights stain is a standard haematological stain for blood smears. This blood film was
collected from a patient who has a persistent cough and fever. The patient is a male adult and
had a total white cell count (WCC) of 15.0 x 109/L. You are required to complete a
differential leucocyte count and to record your results in the table supplied. The cell
maturation charts will help you identify the leucocytes.
TASK 1
It is recommended that you use a 100X oil immersion objective lens. Focus on
10X objective. Put a drop of oil on the slide. Turn the turret carefully to bring the
100X objective into the oil. Focus.
(ii)
Identify and count 100 consecutive leucocytes in a longitudinal strip from the tail
end towards the head of the smear as shown in Figure 1a, recording the occurrence
of each cell.
(iii) The lateral edges of the smear must be avoided. It may not be possible to count 100
consecutive leucocytes in a single longitudinal strip due to the thickness of the
smear and the subsequent difficulty in cell identification. If this situation occurs,
adopt the technique of counting from the tail to the head end and back again as
shown in Figure 1b.
FIGURES 1a and 1b
TASK 1
(iv) Record the results of the differential count on the answer sheet (Table 1), taking care
that the results are expressed as percentages, and that the total recorded adds up to
100%. An example is given in Figure 1c.
LEUCOCYTES
Absolute count
(109/L)
Neutrophils
(total of band form and segmented)
60
6.0
Lymphocytes
30
3.0
Monocytes
0.8
Eosinophils
0.2
Basophils
Total
100
10
TASK 1
Type of leucocyte
Occurrence
Absolute count
Reference Range
(%)
(109/L)
(109/L)
Neutrophils
2.0 - 7.5
Lymphocytes
1.5 4.0
Monocytes
0.2 0.8
Eosinophils
0.04 - 0.4
Basophils
0.0.- 0.1
Total WCC
100
15.0
4.0 - 10.0
(14 points)
TASK 1
Questions
P2.T1.1 How could you improve the accuracy of your differential leucocyte count?
A. Count 50 cells.
B. Count 200 cells.
C. Only include cells that are easily identified.
D. Only use the x40 objective.
E. Count all red blood cells in each field.
(1 point)
P2.T1.2 In the differential leucocyte count, calculation of the absolute count from the
percentage of each cell type is an important step because of which of the following factors?
A. Absolute counts provide an indication of anaemia.
B. Percentage counts do not vary with the type of infection.
C. A reference range (normal range) for each cell type can be determined.
D. Leucocyte numbers cannot be validated from a blood smear.
E. All of the above.
(1 point)
TASK 2
1.
Images of 12 column agglutination blood grouping cards. Ten are labelled with
patient identification numbers.
2.
You are provided with the images of ten (10) blood group cards, each with a unique patient
identification number. You are required to interpret the ABO and Rh D (Rhesus) blood group
for each patient and record the results in the table provided on the answer sheet. Please refer
to Figure 2 for the ABO grouping reactions table and Figure 3 for the Rhesus group reaction
table. Individuals with the D-antigen are described as Rhesus positive (Rh +) and those
without the D-antigen as Rhesus negative (Rh NEG).
TASK 2
TASK 2
Anti-A
Anti-B
A1 Cells
B Cells
POS
NEG
NEG
POS
NEG
POS
POS
NEG
AB
POS
POS
NEG
NEG
NEG
NEG
POS
POS
Anti-D
Rh POS
POS
Rh NEG
NEG
Patient
identification
number
(Anti-)
(Anti-)
A1
(Anti-)
ABO blood
B
Control
(cells)
(cells)
group
(A,B,O or AB)
Rh D
(POS
or
NEG)
P 942715
P 945857
P 942675
P 974199
P 926723
P 976348
P 923413
P 981342
P 917300
P 981398
(8 points)
Enter your results on the answer sheet.
10
TASK 2
Questions
P2.T2.1 If a persons blood group is O Rh POS which of the following ABO antigens are
present on their red blood cells?
A. A antigens only.
B. B antigens only.
C. Both A and B antigens.
D. Neither A nor B antigens.
E. A1 antigens.
(1 point)
P2.T2.2 A person who has the blood group A Rh NEG has which combination of (non red
blood cell stimulated) ABO antibodies?
A. anti-B.
B. anti-A.
C. anti-A,B.
D. anti-H.
E. None.
(1 point)
P2.T2.3 On the basis of the blood grouping reactions you have recorded in Task 2, which of
the patients is the most likely to have been transfused?
A. Patient P 942715
F.
Patient P 976348
B. Patient P 945587
G.
Patient P 923413
C. Patient P 942675
H.
Patient P 981342
D. Patient P 974199
I.
Patient P 917300
E. Patient P 926723
J.
Patient P 981398
(1 point)
11
Background
Single radial immunodiffusion (SRID) is used to measure the concentration of
immunoglobulins in blood. It is normally carried out by incorporating an antibody in an
agarose gel at a known concentration and placing samples containing an antigen into the
standardised wells in the gel. At completion of immunodiffusion a stable precipitate forms,
with the diameter squared (D2) having a linear relationship with the antigen concentration.
A standard curve of diameter squared (D2) versus antigen concentration plotted on ordinary
graph paper can then be used to estimate the concentration of a number of unknowns. It is
normal for just three standard points to be used to construct the standard curve.
In this task you are required to construct the standard curve for two immunoglobulins (IgG
and IgA), and then determine the immunoglobulin concentration for two patients. There are
also three supplementary questions on the technique.
Requirement
You are required to construct standard curves for two (2) sets of SRID reactions (IgG and
IgA), and then to determine the concentration of the immunoglobulin from each patient.
2 x images of SRID (IgG and IgA) plates with standards and unknown.
2.
Reading ruler.
3.
Graph paper.
12
Procedure
You are provided with two SRID plates. These plates have been loaded with standards of
varying immunoglobulin concentrations, a control serum and serum from a patient. The
diffusion has been allowed to come to completion.
For each plate, measure the diameter (D) of the precipitation rings (standards, controls and
unknowns) using the reading ruler provided. (Hint: place the gel over the ruler, aligning the
centre of the well with the central line of the ruler). Move the gel until the outer rim of the
precipitin circle just touches the inside of both divergent lines. Read to 0.1 mm accuracy.
Plot the square of the diameter (D2) of the precipitin rings against the immunoglobulin
concentration of the standards. For the plot use the graph paper provided, with
immunoglobulin concentration on the horizontal (x) axis and ring diameters squared (D2) on
the vertical (y) axis. A line of best fit is to be drawn through the three points. (Hint: The yintercept should be in the range of 10 mm2 to 12 mm2).
Interpolate the IgG and IgA concentrations of the patient serum from the graphs obtained and
record your results on the answer sheet.
13
Description
IgG
Concentration
(g/L)
Standard 1
2.9
Standard 2
9.2
Standard 3
17.6
Control
14.1
10
Patient A
Diameter
(D) (mm)
D2
(mm2)
Well
Number
Description
IgA
Concentration
(g/L)
Standard 1
1.20
Standard 2
3.55
Standard 3
5.55
Control
2.85
10
Patient B
11
Patient B
(1/4 dilution)
Diameter
(D) (mm)
D2
(mm2)
14
Questions
P2.T3.1 Why is it that the plot of the line does not pass through the origin?
A. The technique is designed for only low concentrations of antibody.
B. The technique is designed for only low concentrations of antigen.
C. The size of the well introduces a zero error.
D. The gel system expands during incubation, introducing an error.
E. Deformation of the gel due to sample application introduces an error.
(1 point)
P2.T3.2 What could cause a poor (non-linear) calibration curve in this technique?
A. Omission of the control sample.
B. Cloudy gel.
C. Patient serum too dilute.
D. Patient serum too concentrated.
E. Incomplete diffusion.
(1 point)
15
Country:
Task 1:
Task 2:
(10 points)
(10 points)
Task 3:
(14 points)
Task 4:
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
It is recommended that Competitors proportion their time according to the allotted points for
each task and question.
IMPORTANT
Ensure that your 3 digit code number is written and coded on the top of each page of the
answer sheets.
Using the pencil provided, fill in the appropriate circle on the answer sheet.
Task 1
Introduction
Grasshoppers are examples of insects with chewing mouthparts. For this task you will be required
to complete three activities.
i.
Identify, dissect out, and display the individual components of the grasshopper
mouthparts and arrange them as shown in Figure 1 below.
ii.
iii.
(5 points)
Label the dissected mouthparts with the numbered pins according to the numbered
names in Table 1.
(3.5 points)
(1.5 points)
Task 1
Name of mouthpart
Mandible
II
Labial palp
III
Labrum
IV
Hypopharynx
Maxilla
VI
Maxillary palp
VII
Labium
Task 1
TASK P3.T1.1
1.
Remove the head from the grasshopper body (Please Note, you are allocated only one
grasshopper for this task.)
With a pin secure the head, anterior down, in the wax dissecting dish.
Identify the most posterior component of the mouthparts. Insert your forceps underneath and
remove the part at its base.
Working forwards, remove each component in turn by grabbing it at its base with your
forceps (as close to the head capsule as possible) and pulling it off.
NOTE. Your dissection and display will be photographed, assessed and recorded on a special
control sheet by an attendant. The correctness of the mouthparts preparation and presentation will
be scored. Points will be lost for damage to parts or failure to remove all parts.
If the attendant is busy with another participant, continue with the next task while waiting to have
your dissection assessed.
2.
3.
Label the dissected parts with the numbered pins according to the number code in Table 1.
4.
Write your competitor number on the piece of paper pinned to the foam.
5.
Display the tick [] on the green card to indicate to the attendant that you have completed
this task.
6.
Task 1
TASK P3.T1.2 Identify the parts A G of Figure 1 using the number code for the appropriate part
from Table 1.
Labelled Mouthpart
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
(3.5 points)
Enter your answer on the answer sheet.
TASK P3.T1.3 By studying each of the mouthparts, determine the primary function. Use the code
number from Table 1 to complete the table below.
Primary function
(1.5 points)
Enter your answer on the answer sheet.
Task 2
TASK 2. Relationship between form, function and ecology in some insect groups. (10 points)
INTRODUCTION
In this task you will investigate the relationship between form, function and ecology in some insect
groups. The task is divided into two parts, Task 2A and Task 2B
(5 points)
Introduction
In Task 2A you will study the relationship between the function and structure of the legs of
different insects.
Materials and Equipment
1. A board with 8 insect specimens labelled I VIII
2. Dissecting microscope
3. Slide with plasticine to hold specimens
TASK P3.T2.1 Study the pinned insect specimens provided. To examine each insect, pin the
specimen into the mound of plasticine on the glass slide and place under the dissecting microscope.
Change the position of the pin to view the insect from different angles. To study the underneath of
the specimen, turn the pin upside down and insert the head of the pin into the plasticine. The insect
specimens are labelled I VIII. These insects belong to a number of different orders and have hind
or fore legs modified for special functions. Table 2a below presents a list of these special functions
(Codes A E) and Table 2b provides list of leg modifications necessary to perform the special
functions (Codes a e). Figure 2 explains the terminology used in Table 2b.
Task 2
Code
Function
Code
Modification
Fossorial (digging)
Saltatorial (jumping)
Gressorial (walking)
Natatorial (swimming)
By closely observing the insect specimens, for each insect leg function (A-E), select one insect
specimen (I-VIII) that has such legs and the type of modification (a-e)
Leg Function
Insect specimen
Leg modification
A. Fossorial (digging)
B. Raptorial (for seizing prey)
C. Saltatorial (jumping)
D. Gressorial (walking)
E. Natatorial (swimming)
(5 points)
Enter your results on the answer sheet.
8
Task 2
Task 2B. Relationship between the external morphology and ecology of two ectoparasites
(5 points)
Introduction
Fleas and lice are both external insect parasites of vertebrates. A louse is an example of a parasite
that spends its entire life cycle on its host. A flea is an example of a parasite that does not spend its
entire life cycle on its host. Each possesses morphological adaptations to suit its respective feeding
style and host-associated habitat. This Task examines some of these morphological adaptations and
how they relate to the biology of these insects.
Materials and Equipment
1. 2 slide-mounted specimens
i)
ii)
2. A compound microscope
TASK P3.T2.2 Using the microscope, examine the flea and louse specimens and determine if the
characteristics in the table below are present (+) or absent (-) in each specimen.
Character/Modification
Flea
Louse
Task 2
QUESTION P3.T2.3 On the basis of your observations, which of the following combinations of
characters would be most important for a parasite that spends its entire life cycle on its host?
(1 point)
A.
Eggs scattered throughout hosts hair/feathers; legs modified for gripping; body dorsoventrally compressed; compound eyes reduced/absent
B.
Eggs cemented onto hosts hair/feathers; legs modified for jumping; body dorso-ventrally
compressed; compound eyes well developed
C.
Eggs scattered throughout hosts hair/feathers; legs modified for gripping; body laterally
compressed; compound eyes reduced/absent
D.
Eggs cemented onto hosts hair/feathers; legs modified for gripping; body dorso-ventrally
compressed, compound eyes reduced/absent
E.
Eggs cemented onto hosts hair/feathers; legs modified for jumping; body laterally
compressed; compound eyes well developed.
10
Task 2
QUESTION P3.T2.4. Which combination of characters would most likely be found in an adult
parasite that feeds only on blood?
A.
(1 point)
Piercing and sucking mouthparts; chewing mandibles absent; digestive tract with specialised
area for grinding; muscular pumps to suck blood
B.
Non-piercing mouthparts; chewing mandibles absent; digestive tract not modified for
grinding; muscular pumps to suck blood
C.
Piercing and sucking mouthparts; chewing mandibles absent; digestive tract not modified
for grinding; muscular pumps to suck blood
D.
Non-piercing mouthparts; chewing mandibles present; digestive tract not modified for
grinding; no pumps to suck blood
E.
Piercing and sucking mouthparts; chewing mandibles present; digestive tract not modified
for grinding; muscular pumps to suck blood
11
Task 3
TASK P3.T3 Identification of ants to species using a dichotomous key. (14 points)
Introduction
Ants are an important part of most terrestrial ecosystems. They occur in large numbers and are
found in soil, on the surfaces and on vegetation. They can occur around homes where they may be
considered pests but they are gaining increasing significance as bioindicators. For these reasons,
their accurate identification is often required.
Task P3.T3.1
You are provided with 10 specimens of ants (numbered I to X) and a dichotomous key to ant
species, including the species provided. Figure 3 explains the terminology used in the key.
Identify the ants using the key. You may remove the ants from the vials and place in the glass
dishes for viewing under the microscope. When you have identified each specimen, enter your
answer on the answer sheet by filling in the letter code corresponding to the species identified.
12
Task 3
13
Task 3
Head and gaster with distinct metallic green or purple lustre; surface of
head, trunk and petiole pitted and rough.................................... Rhytidoponera metallica
Head and gaster not with distinct metallic green or purple lustre;
surface of head, trunk and petiole not pitted and rough................................................. 2.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
14
8.
Task 3
Gaster and head black; trunk and petiole orange/brown............ Camponotus consobrinus
Gaster and petiole black; head and trunk orange/brown...............Iridomyrmex purpureus
9.
10.
11.
15
Task 4
Introduction
Malaria is regarded as one of the most prevalent and destructive diseases in the tropics, with over
40% of the worlds population being at risk of infection. The disease is transferred between
humans by mosquitoes, with the main vectors belonging to the genus Anopheles. More than 422
species of Anopheles have been described, of which 68 have been identified as vectors of malaria.
Species differ in their efficiency as vectors, with some being primary or main vectors, and others
acting as secondary or less important vectors. Factors that determine efficiency as vectors include
distribution, feeding and habitat preference, the time of biting and malarial stability.
Table 4a shows the influence of time of biting and habitat preference on vector efficiency.
Table 4a: Influence of time of biting and habitat preference on vector efficiency
Species
exophilic
low
endophilic
high
endophilic
medium
16
Task 4
Glossary of terms:
Anthropophilic: Likes to feed on humans
Zoophilic: Likes to feed on animals
Endophilic: Likes to feed and rest indoors
Exophilic: Likes to feed and rest outdoors
Malaria Stability: the chance of the mosquito surviving long enough for the malarial
parasite to become infective. A low value represents unstable malaria, meaning the
mosquito dies before it is capable of spreading infection.
TASK P3.T4.1 Based on the information in Table 4a, the glossary above and the Table below,
rank the six species of Anopheles (Anopheles a Anopheles f) on the answer sheet in rank order
where rank 1 is the most efficient malaria vector and rank 6 is the least efficient malaria vector.
Malaria
Biting
Stability
Species
Distribution
Feeding Preference
Anopheles a
wide
highly anthropophilic
Anopheles b
wide
moderately anthropophilic
exophilic
9am - 4pm
1.8
Anopheles c
wide
zoophilic
exophilic
9am - 4pm
0.5
endophilic
9am - 4pm
1.5
Anopheles d
Habitat Preference
Time of
2.5
Anopheles e
wide
highly anthropophilic
endophilic
10pm - 4am
1.8
Anopheles f
wide
zoophilic
exophilic
9am - 4pm
1.2
(3 points)
17
Task 4
TASK P3.T4.2 Figure 4 below is a map of several proposed sites for the construction of a tourist
camp site in an area where Anopheles mosquitoes are found. Table 4b summarises the climatic
conditions of each site. Table 4c lists the five common species of Anopheles (AnophelesI
AnophelesV) found in the vicinity of the five sites. All five species are known vectors of malaria.
Table 4b: Summary of climatic conditions at each proposed campsite
Site
650m
20C
8C
150mm
200m
25C
13C
100mm
50m
28C
17C
300mm
100m
27C
15C
<50mm
50m
27C
17C
300mm
18
Task 4
Larval Habitat
Extra Information
high mortality in temperatures
0.71
<15C
Vector Efficiency
2.49
0.22
6.54
1.36
submerged vegetation
19
Task 4
^^^^^^
^^^ ^^
^ ^ Site 1 ^ ^ lll w lll w
w
lll w lll
w
^^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^
lll
w Site 3 lll
^ ^ ^
^ ^ ^ ^ w lll w w
lll
w
lll w
^ ^ ^ ^ ^
lll w
w
lll
w
lll
^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^
lll
III
w
^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^
ww
Site
2
^ ^
^
^^ w w
w
w
^
^
^
^
^
^
Site 4
ww w w w w
^ ^^^ w w w
w w
w w
w
w
w
w Site 5
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w w
w
w w
LEGEND
^^
Forested areas
www
Swampy area
lll
Open grassland
10km
20
Task 4
(2 points)
TASK P3.T4.3 Using the information provided select the best site (Sites 1 to 5) to locate a tourist
camp site where the risk of contracting malaria would be the lowest, assuming that each species is
confined to the one camp site and the maximum distance species can infect within is 10km.
(1 point)
Enter your answer on the answer sheet.
21
Country:
Task 1: Plant responses to nitrogen nutrition and carbon dioxide levels (20 points)
Task 2: Interactions between two aquatic plants (16 points)
TASK 1
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS
It is recommended that Competitors proportion their time according to the allotted points
for each task and question.
IMPORTANT
Ensure that your 3 digit code number is written and coded on the top of each page of the
answer sheets.
Using the pencil provided, fill in the appropriate circle on the answer sheet.
TASK 1
TASK 1: Plant responses to nitrogen nutrition and carbon dioxide levels. (20 points)
INTRODUCTION
Forty plants were grown in a mixture of fine sand and sandy loam topsoil, in controlled
temperature enclosures in a glasshouse with natural illumination. The temperature regime
(25oC day, 20oC night) was near the optimum for the species concerned and the relative
humidity was maintained above 75%. Nutrients were supplied as half-strength Hoagland
solution which provided a sufficient and balanced supply of essential macro- and micronutrients except for nitrogen. Five nitrogen treatments were applied, containing nitrate at
concentrations of 0, 1, 2, 4 or 8 mM. Nutrient solutions were supplied to the soil surface
each day until solution drained from the base of the pot. Carbon dioxide concentrations in
the chambers were regulated to either 350 or 700 parts per million by volume (ppm) by
scrubbing CO2 from the air stream entering the chambers and then adding CO2 at the
required rates.
The plants were grown for 20 weeks and the five youngest fully expanded leaves were
harvested.
TASKS
You have been provided with a picture of the five youngest fully expanded leaves from one
plant at the final harvest of the treatment that supplied nitrate at 8 mM and a CO2
concentration of 350 ppm. Please do not write on or mark the photograph.
TASK 1
Question P4.T1.1 From the images of the leaves you have been given, indicate in your
answer sheet the plant group to which this species belongs:
A. Monocotyledon (Monocot)
B. Gymnosperm (Conifer)
C. Pteridophyte (Fern)
D. Bryophyte (Moss)
E. Dicotyledon (Dicot)
(1 point)
Task P4.T1.2 For each leaf image, use the measuring scale to measure the length of the
leaf from the apex to the point where the leaf is attached to the petiole, and the maximum
width of the leaf measured at right angles to the direction of the measurement of leaf
length. Record your measurement to the nearest 1 mm in your answer sheet.
Leaf number
1
2
3
4
5
(2 points)
TASK 1
Task P4.T1.3 For another plant from a different treatment, the leaf length and width is
given in Table 1.
Table 1: Length and width of five leaves from one plant from another treatment in
the experiment.
Leaf length
Leaf width
Leaf number
(mm)
112
72
Value a
107
71
Value b
104
68
Value c
99
64
Value d
86
57
Value e
Mean
Value f
Value g
Value h
An estimate of the area of each leaf in Table 1, can be obtained by using the equation:
Area (cm2) = [0.0079 X length (mm) X width (mm)] - 0.252
Calculate the values a to h in Table 1 to the nearest 0.1mm or 0.1 cm2 and record them on
your answer sheet. The value h should be calculated by taking the mean of values a to e.
(2 points)
Task P4.T1.4 Calculate the mean leaf area of the plant in Task P4.T1.3 by using the mean
values for leaf length (value f) and leaf width (value g) in the formula given for estimating
the area of a leaf.
(1 point)
Enter the value (to the nearest 0.1 cm2) on the answer sheet.
TASK 1
TASK P4.T1.5 Compare the values for mean leaf area as calculated by the mean of the
area of each individual leaf with that calculated by using the mean length and mean width
values. Indicate which of the following statements is correct:
A. The values are equal
B. The values are unequal because of an unbalanced data set.
C. The values are unequal because of an error in calculation.
D. The values are unequal because of a normal distribution of leaf area data about
the mean.
E. The values are unequal because of a symmetrical distribution of leaf length data
about the mean.
F. The values are unequal because of an irregular distribution of values within the
data sets.
(2 points)
TASK P4.T1.6 Table 2 shows the mean leaf area for the five youngest fully expanded
leaves of plants grown for 20 weeks under two ambient carbon dioxide concentrations and
five nitrate nutrition regimes.
TASK 1
Table 2: Mean leaf area (cm2) for the five youngest fully expanded leaves on
plants grown under two ambient CO2 concentrations and five nitrate concentrations.
Ambient CO2 concentration (ppm)
Nitrate (mM)
350
700
19.8
17.2
33.0
31.6
44.4
45.6
50.2
51.5
39.5
53.2
On the graph paper provided, prepare a graph comparing mean leaf area against nitrate
concentration in the nutrient solution for each of the two CO2 treatments. From these plots,
which of the following statements is/are most likely to be correct?
I
At both 350 and 700 ppm CO2 and at nitrate concentrations in the nutrient
medium between 0 and 2 mM, leaf area is limited by nitrogen availability.
II
At 700 ppm CO2, photon flux density is likely to limit leaf size at nitrate
concentrations in the nutrient medium higher than 4 mM.
III
This evidence proves that, at 350 ppm CO2, total plant leaf area is reduced when
nitrate supply increases from 4 to 8 mM.
A.
I only
B.
III only
C.
D.
I and II only
E.
I, II and III
(2 points)
TASK 1
TASK 1
Table 3a: Leaf mass for plants grown at 350 ppm and 700 ppm CO2. Calculations for unpaired values
Leaf
350 ppm
CO2 (X)
Number
Leaf mass
(mg) (X)
700 ppm
CO2
X-X
(X X)
Leaf mass
(mg) (Y)
Y-Y
(Y Y)
448
619
383161
104
10816
428
593
351649
78
6084
415
484
234256
-31
961
386
479
229441
-36
1296
370
400
160000
-115
13225
2575
1358507
32382
Mean (X, Y, D)
515.1
(Xi) /n
6630625
2
0.5
90.0
0.5
t = (X-Y)/(S[2/(nx+ny)] )
TASK 1
Table 3b: Leaf mass for plants grown at 350 ppm and 700 ppm CO2. Calculations for
paired values
Leaf
number
350 ppm
CO2 (X)
D = (YX)
D-D
(D D)
700 ppm
CO2 (Y)
448
619
428
593
415
484
386
479
370
400
2575
Mean (X, Y, D)
515.1
SD = ([((D-D) )/(n-1)]
0.5
0.5
)/(n )
t = (D - ((D-D))/ SD
Abbreviations:
n, number of individuals in sample
S, sum of variates
t, Students t
D, difference between pairs of variates
D, mean of differences between pairs of variates
df, degrees of freedom
P, probability of a significant difference
SD, Standard deviation
10
TASK 1
TASK P4.T1.7 Calculate the standard deviation about the mean leaf mass for the 350 ppm
CO2 treatment in the unpaired value comparison and enter the value (to the nearest 0.1 mg)
in your answer sheet.
(1 point)
TASK P4.T1.8 Use the Students t-test to determine the level of probability that the leaf
mass at 350 ppm CO2 is not significantly different from the leaf mass at 700 ppm CO2 in
the unpaired test (Table 3a) is:
A.
B.
0.95 to 0.99
C.
0.05 to 0.10
D.
0.01 to 0.05
E.
(3 points)
TASK P4.T1.9 Use the Students t-test to determine the level of probability that the leaf
mass at 350 ppm CO2 is not significantly different from the leaf mass at 700 ppm CO2 in
the paired test (Table 3b) is:
A.
B.
0.95 to 0.99
C.
0.05 to 0.10
D:
0.01 to 0.05
E.
(3 points)
11
TASK 1
The two tests produce the same level of significance of the difference between the
means.
B.
The variation in significance of the difference between means in the two tests is due
to an error in the formula.
C.
The variation in significance of the difference between means in the two tests is due
to random variation in one sample.
D.
The variation in significance of the difference between the means in the two tests is
due to non-random variation in one sample.
E.
The variation in significance of the difference between the means in the two tests is
due to non-random but matching variation in both samples
(1 point)
Table 4: Leaf mass of plants grown under two ambient CO2 concentrations and five
concentrations of nitrate in the nutrient medium.
Leaf mass (mg)
Nitrate
(mM)
118
103
214
221
310
365
401
514
316
532
12
TASK 1
On the graph paper provided, plot the mean leaf mass for each treatment against the nitrate
concentration in the nutrient solution.
TASK P4.T1.11 From the relationships between leaf area, leaf mass and nitrogen
concentration in your graphs, indicate on your answer sheet which of the following
statements is most likely to be correct:
I
II
III
At 700 ppm CO2, there is no change in leaf mass per unit area at nitrate supply
concentrations between 4 and 8 mM.
A.
I only
B.
III only
C.
I and II only
D.
E.
I, II and III
(1 point)
13
TASK 1
Between 0 and 2 mM NO3-, neither leaf area nor leaf mass is affected by the
concentration of CO2 in the air.
II
The evidence from this study indicates that climate change that results in a
doubling of the ambient CO2 concentration is likely to result in more uniform
plant growth over the surface of the earth
III
A.
I only
B.
II only
C.
III only
D.
E.
I, II and III
(1 point)
14
TASK 2
INTRODUCTION
Lemna is a monocotyledon plant and azolla is a fern. Both are floating plants and
reproduce by vegetative means. Azolla has a cyanobacterium associated with its root
system that fixes nitrogen in water with low nitrogen concentrations. The growth of
colonies of these plants can be indicated by counting leaves (lemna) or fronds (azolla), or
by measuring their dry weights at different times. Both of these procedures have
difficulties, and a common ecological expression of the importance of species in a
community is the proportion of land or water surface that they occupy. The following
questions relate to the estimation of the area occupied by two species in a mixed
population. In most ecological studies, it is impossible to measure every individual, and
sampling must be used. The following problem requires you to evaluate a sampling
procedure.
TASKS
To complete TASKS P4.T2.1 to P4.T2.5, you have been provided with a photograph of an
area of fresh water supporting lemna (small bright green leaves) and azolla (the darker
green fern). For reference, we have provided you with a petri dish with samples of lemna
and azolla. You are required to design in part a sampling procedure to estimate the
percentage of area occupied by different components of this plant community. Sampling
may be carried out by (1) random points, (2) randomly placed transect lines, or (3)
randomly placed sampling areas. Please do not write on or mark the photograph.
15
TASK 2
Ten randomly located transect lines (each approximately 50 mm long) have been drawn on
the photograph. Each line has a number that represents the order of its selection and
corresponds to a row in Table 5. Make your measurements in the order indicated by the
line number.
NOTE: You may not need to measure every line. Analyse your data progressively, so that
after you have measured four lines, you calculate the mean and other values as indicated.
With each additional line, your sample size increases, and you should complete another
calculation.
For each transect line that you select, place your measuring scale on the line with the zero
end closest to the line number. Make your measurements on the side of the line closest
to the number. Measure the total length of the line that lies over:
1. lemna
2. azolla
Light coloured areas on the photograph represent open water. Dark coloured areas on the
photograph represent submerged azolla, which should be measured.
Use these values to calculate the percentage of the transect line occupied by each
species. Record the percentage cover values in your work sheet. For each sample size
greater than three (that is four or more sample lines), calculate:
(1) the mean percentage cover of lemna
(2) the standard deviation and confidence limit (probability 0.05) of the mean
percentage cover of lemna. Use the formulae in Appendix A.
(3) the coefficient of variation , which is the ratio (confidence limit)/(mean
percentage cover of lemna).
16
TASK 2
TASK P4.T2.1 How many transect lines do you need to measure to obtain a coefficient of
variation for percentage cover of azolla which is less than 0.25?
(2 points)
TASK P4.T2.2 The mean percentage of the area of the photograph occupied by lemna (to
the nearest 1 per cent).
(2 points)
TASK P4.T2.3 The mean percentage of the area of the photograph occupied by azolla (to
the nearest 1 per cent).
(2 points)
TASK P4.T2.4 The confidence limit (P = 0.05) of the mean percentage of the area of the
photograph occupied by lemna (to the nearest 0.1 per cent).
(2 points)
TASK P4.T2.5 The confidence limit (P = 0.05) of the mean percentage of the area of the
photograph occupied by azolla (to the nearest 0.1 per cent).
(2 points)
17
TASK 2
The confidence limit of the mean area of each species is independent of sample
size.
II
The confidence limit of the mean area for azolla decreases with increasing
sample size
III
For a given sample size, the coefficient of variation for the area of lemna is
greater than the coefficient of variation for the area of azolla because lemna
plants become separated and are redistributed during vegetative growth but
azolla remains in larger colonies.
IV
For a given sample size, the coefficient of variation for the area of lemna is
greater than the coefficient of variation for the area of azolla because the area
occupied by lemna is smaller than the area occupied by azolla.
18
TASK 2
A2
(A)2
Azolla
Sample
Area Mean
SD
CL
CV
Area
number
(%)
(%)
(A)
(A)
A2
Mean
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Abbreviations: SD, standard deviation; CL, confidence limit (P = 0.05); CV, coefficient of variation
Formulae to describe these parameters are included in Appendix A or in the text.
19
A2
(A)2
SD
CL
CV
TASK 2
TASKS P4.T2.7 to P4.T2.10 Ecological studies are often undertaken in order to predict
the future characteristics of plants or plant associations. The data in Table 6 describe the
change in fresh biomass (g) of a colony of lemna growing in a pond with a high nutrient
concentration.
Biomass of plants
(days)
(g)
10
40.2
12
78.5
16
159.7
20
325
24
TASK P4.T2.7 By graphing the data in Table 6 (after transforming the data if necessary),
extrapolate the relationship to estimate the biomass of the colony on Day 24 of the
experiment.
Enter the value (to the nearest gram) on the answer sheet.
(2 points)
TASK P4.T2.8 From the data in Table 6, calculate the Relative Growth Rate (RGR)of the
lemna colony between Day 0 and Day 8, using the formula given below. Enter the value (to
the nearest 0.001 g g-1 day-1) in your answer sheet.
(1 point)
20
TASK 2
TASK P4.T2.9 From the data in Table 6, calculate the Relative Growth Rate of the lemna
colony between Day 12 and Day 20. Enter the value (to thenearest 0.001 g g-1 day-1)
in your answer sheet.
(1 point)
TASK P4.T2.10 From the graph of lemna biomass vs. time, indicate which of the
following statements are correct:
I
II
III
IV
A.
I only
B.
II and III
C.
III only
D.
II and IV
E.
I, III and IV
(1 point)
21
TASK 2
TASKS P4.T2.11 to P4.T2.12 Lemna and azolla have different maximum growth rates,
and when grown in mixture, one species or the other may dominate the site. The data in
Table 7 indicates the initial biomass values for an experiment where different mixtures of
lemna and azolla with a total mass of 10 g were distributed in samples of a medium with a
constant level of nutrition.
Table 7: Distribution of biomass between lemna and azolla in three populations
established as cultures.
Per cent initial
Azolla biomass
Biomass (g)
Azolla initial
Lemna initial
10
25
2.5
7.5
50
75
7.5
2.5
100
10
After three weeks of growth, the plants were separated and weighed, with the results
presented in Table 8.
22
TASK 2
Table 8: Biomass of lemna and azolla grown for three weeks in three cultures as
described in Table 7.
Per cent initial
Final Azolla
Final Lemna
Final total
Azolla biomass
biomass (g)
biomass (g)
biomass (g)
15.6
15.6
25
4.6
13.1
17.7
50
9.6
9.9
19.5
75
14.5
5.4
19.9
100
18.8
18.8
On the same graph, plot the final azolla biomass, final lemna biomass and final total
biomass after three weeks of growth against the percentage of initial azolla biomass.
TASKS P4.T2.11 Indicate which of the following statements most completely describes
the evidence in the graph:
I
II
III
This experiment proves that azolla releases nitrate ions into the water.
IV
23
I only
B.
II only
C.
II and IV
D.
E.
I and IV
TASK 2
(2 points)
TASKS P4.T2.12 Indicate which of the following statements is correct:
I
II
III
This experiment does not demonstrate that the two species interact in their use
of resources during growth.
IV
Lemna derives some benefit from the presence of azolla, but azolla does not
derive any benefit from the presence of lemna.
A.
III only
B.
IV only
C.
I and IV only
D.
II and IV only
E.
I, II and IV only
(2 points)
24
TASK 2
APPENDIX A
A1.1 Determination of standard deviation of a mean
The standard deviation is calculated from the following attributes of a sample:
!X
2
i
, the sum of the squares of each value of the variable X i where i has values from 1
to n.
to n.
SD =
"X
2
i
(" X )
i
(n ! 1)
t " SD
(n ! 1)
Where t is the value of the distribution of Students t (Appendix B) for the desired level of
probability
(P = 0.05) and the number of degrees of freedom (df) where n is the number of samples in
the analysis. The number of degrees of freedom is (n 1).
25
TASK 2
(X ! X )2
(nx +
+ (Y ! Y )
ny ! 2 )
and
(X
"Y)
2
S!
nx + n y
26
TASK 2
The value of t is compared with the value in the Table of distribution of t (Appendix B), for
the level of significance that you want and the number of degrees of freedom, df, where
df = (n-1).
S =
(D-D)2
(n 1)
n
t = D (D D)
S
The value of t is tested in the same way as described above for unpaired samples.
27
TASK 2
APPENDIX B
df
28
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
THEORETICAL TEST
Dear competitors!
You will have 4.5 hours for answering all the tasks of parts A and B. Tasks for
part A have only one correct answer. You have to mark it by filling in the circle
opposite the test number on the answer sheet. Answers written in the question paper
will not be taken into account.
Tasks for part B may have several (more than one) correct answers. You must fill
them in the answer sheet part B. The marks for the questions of part B depend on
the number and complexity of the questions.. The marks are shown in the text.
Be attentive while filling in the answer sheet. Make sure the correct circle
corresponding to the appropriate question is filled in. Any corrections in answer
sheet should be avoided!
Note there are some questions which are marked SKIPPED. Do Not answer these.
Please read all possible answers before attempting the question, as many questions
continue over from one page to the next page.
2
PART A
Cell Biology (14 questions, 20 points).
A1. (1 point). List the following proteins in the order of decreasing evolutionary
conservativeness of their primary structure:
1. Somatotropin.
2. Catalytic subunit of a DNA polymerase.
3. Histone H1.
4. Prolamines (storage proteins of cereals).
. 1, 4, 3, 2.
B. 2, 3, 1, 4.
C. 3, 2, 1, 4.
D. 4, 1, 2, 3.
E. 1, 2, 3, 4.
A2. (1 point). What is the common feature of amino acids encoded by codons U, where
is any base, U is uracil?
. Hydrophobicity.
B. Positive charge.
C. Negative charge.
D. Sulfur in the side chain.
E. No common feature.
A3. (1 point). A denatured polypeptide chain containing amino acids of different chemical
properties is shown in the figure.
3
If renatured, the most stable configuration of the above polypeptide in the cytoplasmic environment
will be:
A.
B.
B D
D B
F
C
C
C.
D.
A
F
A
B D
C
E
A. A-T.
B. C-T.
C. G-A.
D. G-C.
E. T-G.
A6. (2 points). Define from reaction written below:
HOOC
HOOC
COOH
COOH
6.1. (1 point). To which class does the enzyme catalyzing the reaction of formation of
succinic acid (Succinate) from fumaric acid (Fumarate) belong?
A. Isomerase.
B. Dehydrogenase.(Oxidoreductases)
C. Hydrolase.
D. Synthase.
E. Transferase.
6. 2. (1 point). The coenzyme of this reaction is the derivative of which vitamin?
A. B1 - thiamine
B. B2. - riboflavin
C. B6. - pyridoxalphosphate
D. B12. - cyancobalamine
E. Bc. folic acid
A7. (1 point). It is known that cyanides (CN ) and carbon monoxide bind specifically to the
reduced and oxidized form of cytochrome a3 (cyt a3) (part of complex IV of electron
transport chain), respectively, in mitochondria. Which of the following statements are
correct:
SKIPPED
4. Carbon monoxide is less toxic for animals since it is capable of binding other ironcontaining substances, e.g. hemoglobin.
5. Cyanides are more toxic for animals since they are only capable of binding to
cytochrome a3.
A. 1, 2, 4.
B. 2, 3, 5.
C. 1, 4, 5.
D. Only 4.
. Only 1.
5
A8. (1 point). Lactobacilli lack electron transport chain. However, under special
circumstances, up to 50% of ATP is synthesized by membrane-linked H+ - ATPase.
What are the circumstances to generate a proton gradient to drive ATP formation
mechanism.?
1. If the concentration of lactic acid is higher in the cell than it is in the medium.
2. If the concentration of lactic acid is lower in the cell than it is in the medium.
3. Uniport (unidirectional)of lactic acid.
4. Symport (both in or both out) of lactic acid with H+.
5. Antiport (one in and one out) of lactic acid with H+.
. 1, 3.
B. 1, 4.
C. 1, 5.
D. 2, 5
. 2, 4.
A9. (3 points). The lactose operon of E.coli consists of three genes:
lacZ encodes -galactosidase,
lacY encodes galactosidepermease which carries out lactose transport to the cell,
lacA encodes galactoside-transacetylase.
Lac operon is under the control of LacI (repressor), which is inactive in the presence of
lactose (inductor). There is a wide diversity of the chemical lactose analogs, for example:
Orthonitrophenyl-
-D-galactoside (ONPG) is a substrate for -galactosidase but not an
inductor. The product of this reaction orthonitrophenol is toxic for a cell.
Isopropyl-
-D-thiogalactoside (IPTG) - is an inductor but not a substrate for -galactosidase.
Phenyl-
-D-galactoside (PG) - is a substrate for -galactosidase but not an inducer. The
products of its hydrolysis are nontoxic for a cell.
A9.1. (1 point). Which cells will grow in the medium with PG as the only source of
carbon and energy?
. lacI .
B. lacZ .
C. lacy .
D. lacZ lacy .
E. lacI lacZ .
A9.2. (1 point). Will these cells grow in the medium with ONPG?
A. Yes.
B. No.
A9.3. (1 point). Galactose is a toxic compound for the cells which have galE mutation.
Which cells with this mutation will grow in the IPTG+PG medium (with arabinose
as an additional source of carbon and energy available)?
. lacI .
B. lacZ .
C. lacA .
D. lacI lacA .
A10. ( 2 points). A protein synthesis assay was carried out in vitro. A polyribonucleotide
containing U and C in proportion 1:5 (positions of U and C are random) was used as a
template. Which amino acids and in what proportions will be incorporated into the
synthesized polypeptide molecules?
. 1Phe : 5Pro : 3Leu.
B. 1Leu : 1Pro : 1Ser : 1Phe.
C. 1Phe : 5Ser : 5Pro : 5Leu.
D. 1Phe : 25Pro : 5Ser : 5Leu.
E. 5Leu : 5Pro.
For questions 11 and 12 use the table of genetic code at the beginning of the question paper.
A11. (3 points). The strand of DNA molecule isolated from E. coli bacteria has sequence: 5
GGCCCCCGG 3. Assume that an mRNA is transcribed from the
corresponding double-stranded DNA, the template strand being complementary
to the strand isolated.
RNA-polymerase I.
RNA-polymerase II.
RNA-polymerase III.
Primase.
Impossible to determine.
13. (1 point). Phalloidin, a very toxic compound isolated from the mushroom Amanita
phalloides, has a very high affinity for actin polymers. Phalloidin can be marked by
covalently linking it to a fluorescent molecule, like fluorescein, without affecting its
affinity properties.
If a microscopic slide with methanol-fixed sperm is stained with a reagent containing
fluorescein-marked phalloidin (excess reagent being washed away), which part of the
8
spermatozoids will be glowing under a fluorescence microscope?
. Acrosome.
. Flagellum.
. Head.
D. Mitochondria.
. Whole spermatozoid.
A14. (2 points). On the basis of the following experimental facts, decide which of the four
models (A, B, or D) of Bax and Bcl-2 proteins action in regulation of programmed
cell death (apoptosis) is correct.
Experimental facts:
Mice with inactivated bcl-2 gene had a high rate of apoptosis in various tissues, which
could be corrected by the absence of Bax protein.
Bax gene in a single genome copy was able to promote apoptosis in the absence of
Bcl-2 protein.
A. Bax protein inhibits the action of Bcl-2 protein, which blocks apoptosis
(look at A in the figure).
B. Bcl-2 protein is an inhibitor of Bax protein, which promotes apoptosis
(look at B in the figure).
C. Bcl-2 and Bax proteins act independently, resulting in either survival or death,
(look at C in the figure).
D. Bcl-2 protein blocks inhibitory action of Bax protein on apoptosis
(look at D in the figure).
9
Plant anatomy and physiology (10 questions, 12 points).
A15. (1 point). If the vascular system of a plant tendril is represented by the only one
closed collateral (xylem & phloem are touching) bundle, the tendril is formed by the
metamorphosis of which organ?
. Shoot.
B. Leaf.
C. Stem.
D. Root.
. Impossible to determine.
A16. (1 point). A transverse microscopic section of a spruce needle leaf is shown in the
diagram below. Which roman numerals indicates the upper surface of the leaf?
II
Phloem
Xylem
III
IV
A. I and II.
B. II and IV.
C. I and III.
D. III and IV.
E. II and III.
17. (1 point). The endosperm in conifers develops from:
. The central nucleus resulting from double fertilization.
B. The ovule after fertilization.
C. The megaspore before fertilization.
D. The megaspore after fertilization.
. The megasporangium cells before fertilization.
10
A18. (1 point). Which compounds are the main substrates for growth of xylophilous fungi
(accomplishing decomposition of wood), which elicit white (1) and brown (2) rot?
1.
A. Cellulose.
2.
Suberin.
SKIPPED
B. Cellulose.
Lignin.
C. Lignin.
Cellulose.
D. Suberin.
Cellulose.
E. Pectin
Hemicellulose.
19. (1 point). Which is the correct rank order of the pH value in cytosol (1), chloroplast
stroma (2) the inside of thylakoids (3) in plant cells exposed to light:
A. 1>2>3.
B. 1>3>2.
C. 2>1>3.
D. 2>3>1.
E. 3>1>2.
A20. (1 point). Spirogyra filaments were placed in a medium, in which strict (obligate)
aerobic bacteria were incubated without access to oxygen for some time. Then part of
the spirogyra filament was illuminated with a narrow beam, which passed through a
prism to obtain a spectrum (see figure below).
400
500
600
700
800 wavelength , nm
In which parts of the filament will the greatest concentration of bacteria be observed?
A. 1,3.
B. 1,4.
C. 2,3.
D. 2,4.
. 3,4.
11
A21. (2 points). Plants of wild type corn whose Rubisco function was normal were
compared with a mutant corn variety whose Rubisco is not able to catalyze an oxygenation
reaction. Which of the following statements regarding the photosynthetic capacity
of this mutant corn and the wild type is correct and why would it be correct?
Assume the same temperature conditions.
Reason
D.
E.
12
A22. (2 points). Photosynthesis in plants is dependent on temperature (T) and light intensity
(L). The following graphs show the results of measurements of CO2 consumption for
three plants of the same species under different light intensities. Which combination of
statements concerning limiting factors in the temperature ranges (I) 5 C to 0C and
(II) +20 C to + 30C is correct under the light intensity used?
light intensity
4-fold
CO2-consumption
2-fold
1-fold
-5
10
15
20
25 30
temperature (C)
A.
T and
L limiting factor.
T and L
not limiting factor.
B.
T limiting,
L not limiting.
T not limiting,
L limiting.
C.
T limiting,
L not limiting.
T limiting,
L not limiting.
D.
T not limiting,
L limiting.
T limiting,
L not limiting.
E.
13
A23. (1 point). The result of an experiment which uses guard cell protoplasts of
Vicia faba is given below. Protoplasts were incubated in a suspension medium with
isotonic osmotic pressure. After 30 min under saturating red light they were irradiated
with blue light for 30 sec. During the experiment in which the protoplasts were cultured
the pH of the medium was monitored.
What would be the most plausible conclusion based on the above results?
A. Blue light may help guard cells to take up protons from outside into the cell.
B. Blue light may enhance the ability of guard cells to pump protons out of the cell.
C. Blue light may be a very effective wavelength of light for the respiration of the
guard cells.
D. Blue light may activate all of the protoplasts to give away their energy.
E. Not only blue light but also other wavelengths of light may help guard
cells to transfer protons.
14
24. (1 point). If an oat coleoptile deprived of its epidermis is placed in a physiological
solution with pH = 5.0, relatively fast lengthening of the coleoptile occurs. The action of which
hormone does this experiment imitate?
A. Auxin.
B. Gibberellic Acid
C. Cytokinins.
D. Ethylene.
E. Abscisic Acid
15
Animal Anatomy & Physiology (10 questions, 12 points).
A25. (1 point). In which animals is the volume of the lungs relatively constant during all
the stages of ventilation (breathing)?
A. In insects.
B. In birds.
C. In mammals.
D. In reptiles.
26. (1 point). During the blood flow from the ventricle to atrium in fishes, how does the
pressure change?
A - Atrium.
V - Ventricle.
P - Pressure.
A.
B.
C.
E.
V
D.
16
A27. (1 point). A branched axon is stimulated at the site 1 (see figure below). The excitation
is transferred from site 1 to 2 and then to 3 and 4. The excitation is measured at
these sites. Which statement of impulse frequencies (I) measured at these sites is correct?
3
1
2
4
A. I(1) > I(2) > I(3), I(3) = I(4), I(3) + I(4) = I(2).
B. I(1) > I(2) > I(3), I(3) = I(4), I(3) x I(4) = I(2).
. I(1) < I(2) < I(3), I(3) = I(4).
D. I(1) = I(2) > I(3), I(3) = I(4), I(3) + I(4) = I(2).
E. I(1) = I(2) = I(3) = I(4).
A28. (1 point). Drosophila flies homozygous for the shake mutation are extremely sensitive to
diethyl ether that causes convulsions in homozygous individuals. Convulsions are caused
by abnormalities in nerve impulse conduction. (see graph below). The function of which
structures is impaired in the shake mutations?
mV
shake
wild type
Time
. Na+ -channels.
B. K+ -channels.
C. Ca2+ -channels.
D. K+/Na+ -ATPase.
E. + -pump.
17
A29. (1 point). Daily changes in the concentration of which hormone are represented by
the following graph?
A. Thyroxine
B. Glucagon.
C. Insulin.
D. Cortisol.
E. Parathormone.
A. Thyroxin receptors.
B. Thyroxin.
C. TSH receptors.
D.TSH.
E. Thyreoliberin receptors.
18
A31. (3 points). There are two recessive mutations ob and db in mice. These mutations cause
the same phenotype: obesity, adipose tissue hypertrophy and predisposition to obesity
related diseases (hypertension, physiological diabetes insipidus and so on). The
mutations are not linked. Three experiments of parabiosis (surgically joining blood
circulation systems of two mice with different genotypes) were carried out to define the
roles of the products of these genes in weight regulation. Two weeks after the parabiosis,
the weight of each mouse was determined (see table).
ob /ob
Weight
Loss of
weight
wt+
db / db
Without
changes
Without
changes
wt+
Loss of
weight
ob /ob
+ db / db
Loss of
weight
Without
changes
19
2
1
4
3
A. 1 and 2.
B. 2 and 3.
C. 3 and 4.
D. 3 and 1.
A33. (1 point). Quick movement of the individuals of genus Dryocopus (wood-pecker) on tree
trunks is enabled thanks to the fact that:
SKIPPED
B. Two its leg fingers are directed forward and two leg fingers are directed to the back.
C. Three its leg finger are directed forward and one leg finger is directed to the back .
D. One its leg finger is directed forward and three leg fingers are directed to the back.
20
A34. (1 point). The major difference between humoral immunity and cellular immunity
is that:
A. Humoral immunity is non-specific, whereas cellular immunity is specific for a
particular antigen.
B. Only humoral immunity is a function of lymphocytes
C. Humoral immunity cannot function independently; it is always activated by
cellular immunity.
D. Humoral immunity acts against free-floating antigens, whereas cellular
immunity works predominantly against pathogens that have entered body cells.
E. Only humoral immunity displays immunological memory.
21
Ethology (2 questions, 2 points).
35. (1 point). Which of the following cases result in optimal conditioning (Pavlovian)?
. Unconditional stimulus is delivered before conditional stimulus and unconditional
stimulus is stronger than conditional stimulus.
. Unconditional stimulus delivered before conditional stimulus and unconditional
stimulus is weaker than conditional stimulus.
. Conditional stimulus starts delivered unconditional stimulus and conditional
stimulus is stronger than unconditional stimulus.
D. Conditional stimulus starts delivered unconditional stimulus and conditional
stimulus weaker than unconditional stimulus.
A36. (1 point). The cuckoo (Cuculus canorus) and its hosts is a well studied system of
co-evolution as a long never ending process. A cuckoo lays its eggs in the nest of small
passerines (Passeriformes). The cuckoo and its hosts have adopted different behaviours
that result from the co-evolution between them.
Which combination of the following statements (1 6) are true?
22
Genetics (10 questions, 12 points).
37. (1 point). In birds, for instance chickens, sex is determined by a combination of sex
chromosomes Z and W. At an early age it is difficult to determine their sex. However, it
is commercially very important to distinguish males and females at this age. Using a
genetic marker, it is possible to conduct such crosses so that sex will be determined by
phenotypic expression of the marker gene. On which chromosome must the marker gene
(I) be located and which crossing allows discrimination of the males from females (II)?
Crossing (II)
A.
On Z chromosome.
B.
On W chromosome.
C.
On Z chromosome.
D.
On an autosome.
E.
On Y chromosome.
A38. (1 point). abcde genes are closely linked on the E. coli chromosome. Short deletions
within this region lead to the loss of some genes. For example:
deletion 1 bde genes
deletion 2 ac genes
deletion 3 abd genes
What is the gene order on the genetic map of the E. coli chromosome?
23
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
b, c, d, e, a
e, a, c, b, d
a, b, , d, e
c, a, b, d, e
a, b, c, d, e
A39. (2 points). According to the model proposed for floral organization, each whorl is
determined by a unique combination of three genes, namely, A, B and C.
It has been shown that genes A and C mutually repress each other. The expression pattern
of these genes in wild type flowers is shown below.
P
St C
S: sepal formation
P: petal formation
St: stamen formation
C: carpel formation
C B A
gene activity
1 2 3 4
whorls of flower
A39.1. (1 point). The morphology of flower that lacks the functional gene A will be:
.
St C
1
B.
C P P C
1
D.
C St St C
1
C.
P St C
1
24
A39.2. (1 point). The whorls of a flower that lacks the functional gene C will be:
A.
B.
St
C
1
C.
D.
St
A40. (2 points). Colour of the plant endosperm is determined by a single gene located in the
centromere region. Expression of this gene takes place only in the cells of endosperm.
Experiment 1. Inbred plant line with coloured endosperm (CE) was pollinated by the
pollen of inbred plant line with colourless endosperm (CLE). F1 seeds were with
coloured endosperm.
SKIPPED
Experiment 2. After pollination of F1 plants with pollen of CLE line all F2 seeds were
with coloured endosperm as well.
Experiment 3. After pollination of F2 plants with pollen of CLE line 50% of plant gave
seeds were with coloured and 50% with colourless endosperm.
25
. Monosporical.
SKIPPED
B. Bisporical.
C. Tetrasporical.
Meiosis
Mitosis
A40.2. (1 point). What ratio of seeds with coloured and colourless endosperm would be
observed in experiment 2, if the gene of colouration of endosperm were located
SKIPPED
Phenylalanine
tyrosine
2 + 2
26
A person with PKU marries a person with AKU. What are the expected phenotypes for
their children? Note: both diseases (PKU and AKU) are not sex linked. Both parents are not
heterozygous.
A42. (1 point). The figure shows the results of electrophoresis of PCR-amplified DNA
fragments obtained from members of a single family: mother (1), father (2) and 9
children. Father and 6 children (3, 5, 7, 8, 10, 11) in this family have symptoms of
Huntingtons disease (HD). Father first showed symptoms of the disease after he was
40 years old; the onset age of the disease in children is shown in the figure near
corresponding DNA fragments. What is the probability of 4th, 6th and 9th child in
this family falling ill with the disease?
9 10 11
2
(CAG)n
11
26
40
27
100
14
30
. Child 4 and child 9 are healthy and will never develop Huntingtons disease,
whereas child 6 has high probability of developing the disease.
. Short PCR fragments correspond to appearance of HD at an early age.
. Child 4, child 6 and child 9 all have chances to develop HD at an older age.
27
D. There is no correlation between the age of children with disease symptoms and the
rate of migration of PCR-amplified fragments.
. Huntington disease is an infectious disease therefore most children of the family
must be ill.
43. (1 point). The long corolla of tobacco is inherited as a recessive monogenic characteristic.
If in a natural population 49% of plants have a long corolla, what is the probability that
the result of test crossing plants with a short corolla from this population in F1 will have
uniformity of progeny?
A. 82,4 %.
B. 51 %.
C. 30 %.
D. 17,7 %.
E. 42 %.
44. (1 point). In a genetically balanced population involving alleles T and t. 51 % of the
individuals show the dominant phenotype. Suddenly the living conditions change
causing death of all recessive individuals before they reach maturity. After this,
conditions return to normality. What will be the frequency of allele t after one
generation?
A. 0,41.
B. 0,3.
C. Impossible to determine.
D. 0,7.
E. 0,58.
45. (1 point). On land the process of evolution proceeds faster than in the sea, because:
28
46. (1 point). The phenomenon of reduction in organism complexity during the process of
evolution is called:
SKIPPED
A. Biological regress.
B. General degeneration.
C. Idioadaptation.
D. Aromorphosis.
E. Disjunction.
29
Ecology (8 questions, 10 points).
A47. (3 points). The shell of the land snail shows variation in both colour and banding
pattern. In order to construct a 5-figure banding formula, bands are numbered
from the top of the largest whorl, as shown in the diagram. 0 is used to represent
the absence of a band and square brackets indicate the fusion of two bands.
A47.1. (1 point). Using the appropriate letter, indicate the banding formula of shell S.
. 030[45].
B. 03045.
C. 02045.
D. 003[45].
A47.2. (1 point). Thrushes (which have good colour vision) smash the shells of land
snails against stones (anvils) in order to feed on the soft inner body. If snail types
P, Q, R and S began in equal numbers in a habitat of grassland, which would be
30
the most popular among birds?
A. P.
B. Q.
C. R.
D. S.
A47.3. (1 point). A survey of broken shells collected from thrush anvils amongst dead
beech leaves in a woodland area was carried out. Predict which of the following
sets of results was obtained.
Options
P
13
11
5
6
A.
B.
C.
D.
S
5
6
32
5
A48. (1 point). Which combination of the following statements, referring to the process of
ecological succession, is correct?
1.
2.
3.
A new group of plant species achieves dominance over time and ousts the previous
species.
4.
The height and biomass of the vegetation usually increases as the process proceeds.
5.
Each group of species modifies the habitat making it more favourable for other species.
A. 1, 2, 3.
B. 2, 3, 4.
C. 3, 4, 5.
D. 1, 3, 4, 5.
E. 1, 2, 4, 5.
31
A49. (1 point). Which matching of factors influencing the growth of a population is correct?
A.
Development of territories,
cannibalism.
B.
C.
Development of territories,
temperature.
D.
E.
Parasites, predators.
A50. (1 point). A typical feature of the climax stage of an ecological succession is:
II.
III.
32
C. Only I and III.
D. I, II and III.
E. None of these.
A52. (1 point). You and your family are stranded on a remote island with one cow and a large
stock of wheat for cow food. To obtain the highest amount of energy and survive for the
longest period of time, you should:
A. Feed the wheat to the cow, then drink the milk.
B. Eat the cow, then eat the wheat.
C. Feed the wheat to the cow, drink the milk, then eat the cow.
D. Drink the milk, eat the cow when milk production ceases, then eat the wheat.
A53. (1 point). If an area has a total energy, K, in the sunlight available, the net energy
productivity of the fourth trophic level in the area is roughly:
A. 10 3 K
B. 10 5 K
C. 10 7 K
D. 10 4 K
E. 10 6 K
33
A54. (1 point). Assume first that the graph below shows the changes in two populations of
herbivores in a grassy field. A possible reason for these changes is that:
No. of
organisms
B
A
Time
34
Biosystematics (6 questions, 6 points).
I.
II.
III.
IV.
A. I.
B. II.
C. I and II.
D. I, III and IV.
E. I and III.
A56. (1 point). Which are the characteristics of Cnidaria ?
A. Oceanic/marine or freshwater, mainly predators.
B. Only oceanic/marine, mainly predators.
C. Oceanic/marine or freshwater, filter feeding.
D. Only oceanic/marine, always filter feeding.
E. Only freshwater, predators or parasites.
57. (1 point). Which of the following statements can be used as evidence to prove the close
evolutionary relationship between Phylum Annelida and Phylum Mollusca?
A. Both of them have bodies with bilateral symmetry.
B. Their digestive systems have similar parts.
C. Their bodies consist of similar tegmata (segments).
D. Both of them have a closed circulatory system.
E. Many molluscs and marine annelids have a trochophore larva in their life cycle.
35
A58. (1 point). Zoologists place chordates and echinoderms on one major branch of the
animal phylogenetic tree, and molluscs, annelids, and arthropods on another major
branch. Which of the following is a basis for this separation?
A. Whether or not the animals have skeletons.
B. What type of symmetry they exhibit.
C. Whether or not the animals have a body cavity.
D. How the body cavity is formed.
E. Whether or not the animals are segmented.
A59. (1 point). Phylogenetic connections between three extant (a, b, c) and two extinct (d, e)
taxonomic groups are shown below in the cladogram. What kind of their association into
a taxon of the highest rank (encircled with dotted line) would be in concord with
principles of natural systematics (monophyletic or paraphyletiv groups)?
SKIPPED
b
d
e
d
e
36
A60. (1 point). There are five species (K, L, M, N, O) in a single family. They belong to the
same genus. The table lists data concerning the presence or absence of six features in these
species:
Species
K.
L.
M.
N.
O.
Features
1
+
3
+
4
+
5
+
+
Based on the assumption that the most probable scheme of phylogenetic development
is that which required the least number of evolutionary changes, indicate the species
that is the most probable ancestor of species O.
A. K
B. L
C. M
D. N
37
PART B
Cell biology (10 questions, 51 points).
1. Elastin
5. Glycogen synthase
9. Prothrombin
2. Collagen
10. Keratin
3. Somatotropin
7. Casein
4. Actin
8. Phosphofructokinase
12. Tubulin
Answers:
ER-bounded ribosomes
Cytoplasmic ribosomes
Mitochondrial ribosomes
B2. (9 points). The Human condition albinism is inherited in the autosomal recessive manner
(see figure). The cause of this condition is a mutation from wild type allele A to recessive
allele a, which introduces a stop codon into the middle of the gene, resulting in a shortened
polypeptide. The mutation also introduces a new target site for a restriction enzyme, which
makes it possible to detect mutated genes by restriction mapping.
38
Task:
Depict the expected results of Southern-, Northern-, Western-blot hybridization analyses of all
genotypes (, , ). Results of Southern-blot hybridization should be depicted according to the
length of the largest restriction fragment (11 kb) and length markers shown to the left of each
Southern-blot hybridization lane. Markers have to do only with the length of DNA fragments.
Results of Northern- and Western-blot hybridization should be depicted without scale, but taking
into account the respective positions of different restriction fragments for different genotypes.
39
B3. (3 points). Three human-mouse hybrid cell lines have been created (X, Y and Z). The
table below summarizes their characteristics. Each cell line has several human chromosomes
carrying genes coding for particular enzymes.
Line
+
+
+
+
+
+
Chromosome 3
Chromosome 7
Chromosome 9
Chromosome 11
Chromosome 15
Chromosome 18
Chromosome 20
Glutathione reductase
Malate dehydrogenase
Galactokinase
Line Y
+
+
Line Z
+
+
+
+
Identify by giving the number, the human chromosome that carries the gene of each enzyme.
Answers:
Gene of Enzyme
A. Chromosome
number
Glutathione reductase
Malate dehydrogenase
Galactokinase
B4. (3 points). Two independent mutations event of a DNA segment lead to the following
results. Mark the type(s) of mutations observed.
(See Genetic Codes in the front of Part A)
5`
codon
3`
G AG
G AA
T AG
40
A. Point mutation.
E. Neutral mutation.
B. Transition.
F. Missense mutation.
C. Silent mutation.
G. Nonsense mutation.
D. Transversion.
Answer
1:
2:
B5. (3 points). Mark the correct statements by + and the incorrect ones by in the
appropriate box.
A.
In any region of the DNA double helix only one chain of DNA that is usually used as
a template for transcription.
B.
In bacteria the transcription of all classes of RNA is carried out by RNA polymerase
of a single type, whereas in eukaryotic cells three types of RNA polymerase are
used.
C.
Formation of the peptide bond is carried out by enzyme peptidyl transferase, which
binds to large subunit of ribosome after the initiation of translation.
D.
Since the start codon for protein synthesis is AUG, methionine is only found in N
termini of polypeptide chains.
E.
Many antibiotics used in medicine today selectively inhibit protein synthesis only in
prokaryotes because of structural and functional differences between ribosomes of
prokaryotes and eukaryotes.
F.
41
6. (5 points). Oligoribonucleotide X was treated with phosphatase (for removal of 3 and 5 terminal phosphates), then with RNAase T1, which cleaves all phosphodiester bonds
located in a 3 position of guanosine in a 5-specific manner.
N
N
OH
5'
O
O
P
P
O
OH
P
O
3'
P
O
OH
O
O
N
OH
O
O
G
OH
RNAaseT1
As a result, oligonucleotides L, M and N were generated in equal amounts. Each of them
was further treated with phosphatase and subjected to alkaline hydrolysis. Results are
listed in the table below.
Oligoribonucleotide
Then experiment was modified: oligoribonucleotide X after treatment with phosphatase was
hydrolyzed with RNAaseP, which cleaves all phosphodiester bonds in a 3-position of
pyrimidines in a 5 - specific manner.
N
OH
5'
O
O
O
O
P
O
OH
P
O
N
OH
P
O
Py
OH
3'
OH
P
O
RNAaseP
This hydrolysis yielded five products in approximately equimolar concentrations: uridine
monophosphate, cytidine monophosphate and oligonucleotides P, Q and R. After resolution
of
42
the mixture and alkaline hydrolysis of these oligonucleotides data listed in the table below
were obtained.
Oligoribonucleotide
Using the results given above, deduce the nucleotide sequence of oligoribonucleotide X.
Answer: ________________________________________
B7. (5 points). The amino acid cysteine (Cys) has three ionizable groups:
- -amino group
- -carboxyl group
- a side chain that can be negatively charged.
The pK values are 8.18, 1.71 and 10.28, respectively. In the answer table, enter the ionic
charge of cysteine at pH 1, 5, 9 and 12.
Using an appropriate letter for each direction, show migration of cysteine in an electric field
at different pH values.
. To cathode ()
. To anode (+)
. Does not migrate
Also in the table, circle the pH value nearest to the pI (isoelectric point) of this amino
acid.
Answer:
pH
1
5
9
Ionic charge
Migrates toward
43
12
B8. (8 points). Listed in the two tables below are vitamins (A-K) and functions (1-12).
Designatio
Vitamin
n
A.
B1 (thiamine)
B.
B2 (riboflavin)
C.
B6 (pyridoxine)
D.
Folic acid
E.
A (retinol)
F.
D (calciferol)
G.
E (tocoferol)
H.
(menaquinone)
I.
C (ascorbic acid)
J.
B12 (cobalamin)
K.
Antioxidant
2.
3.
4.
5.
Blood coagulation
6.
Scurvy
7.
Beri beri
8.
Pellagra
44
9.
Anaemia
10.
11.
Co-Enzymes of dehydrogenases
12.
Rickets
Match each of the vitamins with its appropriate biological functions and/or lack of deficiency
of this vitamin or its derivatives. There may be more than one answer per question.
Answers:
Vitamin
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
Function
Vitamin
G.
H.
I.
J.
K.
Function
B9. (4 points). The table below shows haploid or partial diploid lac operon of E.coli, where:
- Gene lacI codes for repressor.
- P and O are promoter and operator, respectively.
- LacZ and lacY represent genes encoding for -galactosidase and -galactoside permease,
respectively.
- Oc is a constitutive mutation in the operator.
- Is represents a mutation in the lacI gene, which causes mutant repressor protein not to
be separated from the operator once it binds to it.
Assume that there is no glucose in the bacterial culture medium. In the following table
write O if - galactosidase is synthesized, and X if it is not.
Strain
1
2
3
Genotype
I Oc Z+ Y
I+ Oc Z / I+ O+ Z+
I P+ Oc Z+ Y+/ I+ P O+ Z+ Y
Lactose absent
Lactose present
45
4
I P O Z Y /I P O Z Y
46
B10. (5 points). Match the number of the organism in the left column with the corresponding
letter for the disease in the right column.
Organism
1. Bacillus anthracis
Disease
A. African sleeping sickness
2. Borrelia burgdorferi
B. Anthrax
3. Escherichia coli
C. Cholera
4. Filarial nematodes
D. Elephantiasis
5. Plasmodium vivax
E. Lyme disease
6. Streptococcus pyogenes
F. Malaria
7. Tryponema pallidum
G. Plague
8. Trypanosoma gambiense
H. Tuberculosis
9. Vibrio cholerae
I. Strep throat
J. Syphilis
K. Urinary tract infection
Answers:
1
10
47
Plant anatomy and physiology (6 questions, 29 points).
B11. (5 points). The figure shows a cross section of part of a plant leaf.
Indicate which of the following statements concerning this plant are true (+) and which are false ().
1.
2.
C4 -photosynthetic pathway.
3.
Kranz anatomy
4.
5.
6.
C3 photosynthetic pathway.
7.
Pinnate venation.
8.
Asteraceae(Compositae) Family.
9.
48
B12. (5 points). Label the plant structures in the following diagram, by inserting the number
in the appropriate circle on the answer sheet.
1. Phloem.
2. Xylem.
3. Endodermis.
4. Fascicular cambium.
5. Epidermis.
6. Parenchyma.
7. Cortex parenchyma.
8. Sclerenchyma.
9. Interfascicular
cambium.
10. Collenchyma.
13. (5 points). The potometer can be used to measure transpiration in a cut shoot such as
rose-bay willow plant, by measuring water uptake.
49
Indicate which of the following statements are true (+) and which are false ().
A.
B.
The water-filled syringe is used to suck water out of the apparatus when
air bubbles appear.
C.
The shoot must be sealed over the cut point with vaseline immediately
after it is cut from the plant.
D.
The hypodermic needle is used to introduce the air bubble into the
potometer.
E.
Enclosing the shoot in a black plastic bag will reduce the transpiration
F.
G.
H.
The rate of water uptake and the rate of transpiration are not always
equal.
I.
Low cohesive properties between the water molecules create problems for
potometer experiments.
J.
B14. (2,5 points). For a short-day plant, indicate which treatments, as listed below,
would inhibit flowering. All the treatments were conducted at night. Mark correct
statements with +, incorrect statements with .
.
50
D.
Exposure to red light, far-red light, white light, red light, and white light,
consecutively.
B15. (6,5 points). Diffusion and osmosis are important for the passive transport of molecules
in the cell.
01. (2,0 points). The figure shows an experiment with a dialysis (visking)
membrane filled with sugar and starch (colorless) suspended in a beaker with
diluted iodine solution (orange brown). Use + to indicate which colour you
would expect in the beaker and in the tube after several hours of dialysis.
Solution in the
beaker.
Solution in the
dialysis tube.
iodine
solution
Colorless
Orange-brown
sugar
starch
Pink-red
Greenishyellow
Blue-black
02. (2.5 points). In a similar experiment, dialysis membranes are filled with solutions
with different concentrations of molecules and left in beakers with solutions with
different molecule concentrations. The dialysis tubes all have the same mass at the
beginning of the experiment. The size of the molecules is bigger than the pore size of
the membrane. Mark with + the experimental settings in which the beaker
contains a hypotonic solution compared to the dialysis tube, and mark with the
ones which do not.
51
Experiment
Concentration in
the dialysis tube
(M).
0.1
0.8
0.4
0.2
0.4
Concentration in
the beaker (M).
0.8
0.1
0.2
0.4
0.4
Hypotonic
solution.
03. (2 points). The tubes are weighed after several hours of dialysis. Their mass is
compared to that before the dialysis. Write the letters of the experiments in the
order of the final mass of the dialysis tube, beginning with the tube having the
lowest mass.
Answers:
52
B16. (5 points). Which position of sporangia is characteristic of present day representatives of
II
III
IV
VI
S
B. S- sporangium
Phylum
Bryophyta (Liverworts
and mosses)
Lycopodiophyta
(Club moss)
Equisetophyta
(Horse-tails)
Pterophyta
(Polypodiophyta)
(Ferns)
Plant number
53
Animal Anatomy & Physiology (6 questions, 26 points).
17. (5 points). The graph indicates the blood levels of three hormones produced in
a pregnant woman.
01. (2 points). Using + (true) and (false), indicate whether each of the following is true
or false.
A.
B.
C.
Hormone A is prolactin.
D.
02. (1 point). Which hormone keeps the smooth muscle of the uterus relaxed during
pregnancy? (mark with +).
A.
Progesterone.
B.
Prolactin.
C.
Oxytocin.
D.
FSH.
E.
LH.
54
03. (2 points). Two other hormones, not shown on the graph, are also produced during
pregnancy. These are prostaglandins and oxytocin. Indicate whether the following
statements are true (+) or false ().
A.
B.
C.
These two hormones are responsible for contractions of the uterine wall.
D.
These two hormones are made by the endometrium and pituitary gland,
respectively.
B18. (3 point). Name the germ layers of a metazoan embryo from which the following systems
or organs developed:
.
Brain.
Hair.
1. Ectoderm.
Autonomic ganglia.
2. Endoderm.
D.
Lungs.
3. Mesoderm.
Cardiac muscle.
F.
Cartilage.
A. Blood clotting.
2. Prothrombin.
3. Ferritin.
4. Vasopressin.
5. Collagen.
6. Rhodopsin.
55
Answers:
1
B20. (4 points). For the curve below, fill in the circles on the answer sheet using appropriate
numbers from the upper figure. In the table, for every number put a correct letter
corresponding to a term given below.
Respiratory volumes
Number in
the diagram
and curve
1.
2.
3.
4.
Term
letter
56
21. (7 points). How can the resting potential of a cell change after addition of the biologically
01. (5 points). Determine which graph reflects the addition of which compound.
MV
0
MV
0
T,mc
T,ms
T,mc
T,ms
___________
___________
___________
MV
0
T,mc
57
A. Hyperpolarisation.
B. Depolarisation.
C. Repolarisation.
D. Action potential.
E. Overshoot.
Answers:
2 _______________________________________________
3 _______________________________________________
B22. (4 points). A mutation in the haemoglobin gene (HbS) causes sickle cell disease that
produces a cascade of symptoms such as:
1. Anaemia.
2. Sickle shaped red blood cells.
3. Breakdown of red blood cells.
4. Clumping of cells and clogging of small blood vessels.
5. Heart failure.
6. Kidney failure.
7. Brain damage.
8. Damage to other organ.
9. Paralysis.
In the following diagram, the symptom in the box on top of the arrow causes the
symptom in
58
the box below the arrow. Fill the empty boxes with the number of the appropriate
symptoms.
59
Sickle cell (abnormal) haemoglobin
60
Ethology (2 questions, 12 points).
B23. (3 points). Guppies are often called millionaire fishes because of their abundant progeny.
In 1966, Professor C.M. Breder, then director of the New York aquarium, decided to
perform an experiment, in order to learn more about fish reproduction. He put pair of
Guppies (one adult male and one adult female) into a small aquarium, with 27.5 liters of
SKIPPED
water capacity supplied with enough food and oxygen to maintain up to 300 fish. During
the 6 following months and with an interval of 4 weeks between each breeding (these
fishes are ovoviviparous), the female produced 102, 87, 94, 51 and 89 offspring, it means a
total of 443 guppies. A later recount showed that only 9 were alive: 6 females and 3 males.
In another aquarium with the same size and conditions, the researcher placed 8 adult
males, 8 adult females and 8 young fishes, a total of 24 guppies. Females got abundant
progeny, too. Data of proliferation during the course of the following 6 months from the
introduction of the original group of 24 guppies in the aquarium, are shown in the
following tables.
FEMALE 1
Week 4
Number of offspring
after each hatching
Week 8
Week 12
Week 16
Week 20
Males
29
24
31
30
33
Females
58
48
64
58
68
61
Total
Number of offspring
Males
counted some hours after
hatching
Females
Total
87
72
95
88
101
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 2
Week 4
Number of offspring
after each hatching
Week 8
Week 12
Week 16
Week 20
Males
32
26
33
28
29
Females
65
50
66
56
58
Total
97
76
99
84
87
SKIPPED
Number of offspring
Males
counted some hours after
hatching
Females
Total
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 3
Week 4
Number of offspring
after each hatching
Week 8
Week 12
Week 16
Week 20
Males
32
29
25
34
28
Females
64
56
51
69
55
Total
96
85
76
103
83
Number of offspring
Males
counted some hours after
hatching
Females
62
Total
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 4
Week 4
Number of offspring after
each hatching
Number of offspring
counted some hours after
hatching
Week 8
Week 12
Week 16
Week 20
Males
28
25
35
30
29
Females
57
49
69
61
60
Total
85
74
104
91
89
Males
Females
Total
SKIPPED
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 5
Week 4
Number of offspring after
each hatching
Week 8
Week 12
Week 16
Week 20
Males
33
30
30
23
30
Females
67
59
64
47
60
Total
100
89
94
70
90
63
Number of offspring
counted some hours after
hatching
Males
Females
Total
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 6
Week 4
Number of offspring after
each hatching
Number of offspring
counted some hours after
hatching
Week 8
Week 12
Week 16
Week 20
Males
30
29
26
35
25
Females
62
57
53
70
52
Total
92
86
79
105
77
SKIPPED
Males
Females
Total
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 7
Week 4
Number of offspring after
each hatching
Number of offspring
counted some hours after
Week 8
Week 12
Week 16
Week 20
Males
29
24
33
28
29
Females
60
50
71
57
62
Total
89
74
104
85
91
Males
64
counted some hours after
hatching
Females
Total
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
FEMALE 8
Number of offspring
counted some hours after
hatching
Males
Week 4 Week 8
26
32
Week 12
33
Week 16
28
Week 20
28
Females
52
65
64
58
57
Total
78
97
97
86
85
SKIPPED
Males
Females
Total
Observation: The just hatched guppies were devoured by their own mother
Females
YOUNGS
65
Initial number of guppies in the
aquarium
Observations: The young of the original establishment were devoured by the adults.
Some adults of the original establishment died by unknown causes.
Which of the following statements arise from the analysis of the previous data? Mark with X
correct statements.
I.
II.
III.
species.
Guppies show selective cannibalism, eating the individuals belonging to its species
SKIPPED
24. (8 points). Two young men (Hans and Henri), behaviour researchers of more or less the
same age and appearance, are going to do some investigations about sexual preferences
of human females. For this purpose they select six nice outdoor cafs popular with
young women and hire two similar bikes of which one is provided with an extra child
saddle
(see diagram).
66
Hans and Henri expect that a man having a bike with a childs saddle is more attractive to
young women. This is checked on a sunny afternoon in July. Hans and Henri make a tour
along the six outdoor cafs, indicated A to F. At every caf they halt for 15 minutes. While
standing in front of the caf with their bikes and pretending they are having a talk
together, they both try individually to make eye contact with as many as possible of the
females sitting outside. The numbers are recorded and after each caf Hans and Henri
change bikes. The results of this experiment are shown in the table.
Number of hits (eye contacts) at caf A to F
Total
Hans
12
10
14
17
12
72
Henri
17
10
10
12
20
78
Total
21
27
24
17
29
32
150
Remark: underlined are the hits obtained by man (Hans or Henri)+bike with child
saddle.
Hans and Henri expect that the man with a bike having an extra child saddle will be more
attractive to females than the man with the bike without a child saddle. Possible arguments
supporting this idea are based on the hypothesis that female organisms often show behaviour
focusing on objects related to survival of species.
01. (1 point). Which of the following statements is a correct Null Hypothesis for
the experiment of Hans and Henri?
67
1. Hans and Henri do have the same attractiveness for females.
2. The attractiveness of a man + bike with childs saddle is the same as man + bike without childs
saddle.
3. The six cafs do not differ in the character of the visiting females.
4. Having eye contact between a male and a female is not an indicator of attraction.
5. The attractiveness of a man+bike with childs saddle is greater than that of a man+bike without
childs saddle.
68
02. (1 point). Hans and Henri do some calculations with their results.
Number of hits per caf
Mean (average)
Standard deviation
Hans
12
3.4
Henri
13
4.5
Hans+Henri
25
5.5
Situation A:
15 (nA)
3.7 (SA)
10 (nB)
1.9 (SB)
You have to check the significance of the differences between situation A and B using
the t-test. The following table should be used.
Level of significance
Critical t-value
10.0 %
2.02
5.0 %
2.57
2.5 %
3.37
1.0 %
4.03
0.5 %
6.86
Calculate the standard deviation of the difference between the means of the two situations A and B
in using the formula:
s = { (s A /n A ) + (s B /n B )}
2
s=
69
03. (1 point). Calculate t, using the formula:
t=
t=d/s
04. (1 point). How sure can we be about rejecting the Null hypothesis (i.e. the difference
between situation A and B is significant)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Over 99.5 %
05. (1 point). Hans and Henri show their results to Paula, their boss. Paula claims that
Hans and Henri made a big mistake looking at the total number of hits per caf
since the six cafs differ too much as a spread of 17 up to 32 is too much. Hans and
Henri do not agree with Paula and want to prove their point of view using the
test. Determine the using the following formula.
( )2
=
2
2 =
06. (1 point). Indicate the degree of freedom (df) for this test:
70
Probability of random deviation (P)
(df)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0.995
0.00
0.01
0.07
0.21
0.41
0.68
0.99
0.975
0.00
0.05
0.22
0.48
0.83
1.24
1.69
0.9
0.02
0.21
0.58
1.06
1.61
2.20
2.83
0.5
0.46
1.39
2.37
3.36
4.35
5.35
6.35
0.3
1.07
2.41
3.67
4.88
6.06
7.23
8.383
0.25
1.32
2.77
4.11
5.39
6.63
7.84
9.04
0.1
2.71
4.61
6.25
7.78
9.24
10.65
12.02
0.05
3.84
5.99
7.82
9.49
11.07
12.59
14.07
0.025
5.02
7.38
9.35
11.14
12.83
14.45
16.0
0.01
6.64
9.214
11.35
13.28
15.09
16.81
18.48
08. (1 point). Which of the following conclusions based upon this test is correct? Look
at the total number of hits per cafe
1. The cafs are different, but the differences are not significant
2. The differences between the cafs are significant
3. The results are dubious or questionable, something must be wrong in the design
of this experiment
4. The cafs are not different, but this is not significant
5. The cafs are not different and this is significant
71
Genetics (7 questions, 26 points).
25. (4 points). For each species listed in the table below, indicate whether it can be
routinely used to study, investigate or manipulate one or more of the numbered items.
1. Obtain gene mutations.
2. Obtain chromosomal mutations in eukaryotes
3. Make gene maps.
4. Investigate meiosis.
5. Investigate mitosis.
6. Investigate X-chromosome.
7. Obtain extranuclear mutations.
8. Use Agrobacterium tumefaciens Ti-plasmid for gene transfer to the cells of given
organisms.
9. Perform the gene transfer by transduction.
10. Investigate the lac-operon regulation.
11. Determine the DNA sequences.
Indicate the correct statements by X in corresponding box of answer table:
Object
Item number(s)
1
Zea mays
Drosophila melangaster
Saccharomyces cerevisiae
Caenorhabditis elegans
Escherichia coli
Bacteriophage
Prions
10
11
72
B26. (5 points). The birth records for 4 children were lost at a hospital. The ABO blood
groups of the four babies are known to be A, B, AB, and O. To determine parentage all of
their parents were tested for blood group. (The father of third child wasnt found). The
results are shown in the following table.
01. (4 points). Match the babies with their parents by marking the right blood types in
the table .
Families
Parents 1
Parents 2
Parents 3
Parents 4
AB
Mother
Father
Mother
Father
Unknown
Mother
Father
Mother
02. (1 points). What is/are the possible blood group(s) the unknown father could have?
B27. (3 points). Connect the terms widely used in population genetics in the left column with
the correct statement in the right column.
Term
Statement
Inbreeding depression.
Gene flow.
Increases genetic diversity within and between subpopulations, but occurs rarely.
73
3
Selection.
Outbreeding depression.
Genetic drift.
Mutation.
Term
An
swers:
B28.. (4 points). In an isolated human population of 8400 persons, the frequency of allele IA is
30% and allele IB is 10%.
People number
O
A
B
AB
B29. (4 points). Suppose that the difference between 10 cm high maize and 26 cm high maize
is due to four pairs of additive genes. The individuals with 10 cm have the aabbccdd
genotype and the 26 cm - AABBCCDD.
01. (1 point). Determine the phenotype of F1 if it is known that the parental plants are
10 cm and 26 cm of high.
74
Answer:
F1:
02. (1 point). How many phenotypes classes would be in F2?
Answer:
F2:
03. (1 point). Determine the phenotypes of F2 if it is known, that the parental plants are
10 cm and 26 cm high.
Answers:
04. (1 point). What fraction of the total number of plants in F2 will be 18 cm high ?
Answer:
hypothetical proteins in a Drosophila embryo. The anterior end is on the left and the
posterior end is on the right. A and B gene products activate the expression of Q gene,
and C and D gene products repress the expression of Q gene.
75
If one of the A, B, C and D genes is mutated, where would the protein Q be found? Choose the
number of the correct answer.
Expression pattern of Q gene
Mutant A
Mutant B
Mutant C
Mutant D
I.
II.
III.
No significant change
IV.
76
31. (2 points). It is known that in some dioecious plants sex can be determined genetically as
in animals. Examine the results of analysis of different types of polyploids and ascertain
the type (mechanism) of sex determination in the given plant species.
Choose the correct statement and put its number in the appropriate box.
Rumex acetosa
Genotype
Sex
2+2
2++Y
2A+X+2Y
2A+X+3Y
2A+2X+Y
2A+2X+2Y
3A+X+2Y
3A+X+3Y
3A+X+4Y
3A+2X
3A+2X+Y
3A+2X+2Y
3A+2X+3Y
3A+3X
3A+3X+Y
3A+3X+2Y
4A+2X+2Y
4A+2X+3Y
4A+2X+4Y
4A+3X
4A+3X+Y
4A+3X+4Y
4A+4X
4A+4X+Y
4A+4X+2Y
5A+5X
6A+4X+4Y
Silene latifolia
Genotype
Sex
2+2
2++Y
2A+X+2Y
2A+2X+Y
3A+2X
3A+2X+Y
3A+3X
3A+3X+Y
4A+X+Y
4A+2X
4A+2X+Y
4A+2X+2Y
4A+3X
4A+3X+Y
4A+3X+2Y
4A+4X
4A+4X+Y
4A+4X+2Y
77
5. In given plants X-chromosome determines maleness and Y-chromosome
determines femaleness.
6. The presence of the Y-chromosome is a necessary and sufficient condition for the formation of
male flowers.
7. Y-chromosome doesnt take part in sex determination.
8. X-chromosome doesnt take part in sex determination.
78
Ecology (5 questions, 19 points).
B32. (3 point). Three pond ecosystems (1, 2 and 3) were used for fish production. When the
total number of fish in each pond was measured, the following pyramids were obtained.
(Age of the fish is divided into six class intervals).
VI
V
VI
IV
III
VI
V
IV
III
V
IV
II
II
III
II
I
1.
2.
3.
Assign to these pyramids the appropriate features from the list below. Using letters indicate
the answer(s) in the table.
A.
B.
C.
D.
Eutrophic pond.
E.
F.
G.
Statement
79
B33. (2.5 points). The following figure shows the food web of a certain ecosystem with five
species (A-E). Arrows indicate the flow of energy. Match the letters to the descriptions of
the species:
(C)
(B)
(E)
(A)
(D)
Reducers
/ decomposers
Destruenten
Producer
Herbivore
Omnivore
Carnivore
34. (8.5 points). Fresh water bodies can be subdivided into still-water systems (lentic
waterbodies = ponds and lakes) and moving water systems (lotic waterbodies =
creeks and rivers). Both groups differ in the abiotic factors and in their flora and fauna.
01. (2,5 points). Indicate with a + which characteristics are typical of the lentic and
lotic systems.
Water system characteristic
lentic
80
02. (3 points). Rivers show a marked profile of various water quality parameters along
their length. Samples taken near the source of the river show different values for
various parameters compared to samples from down stream parts of the river.
Mark the expected tendency of this difference using the symbols + for increase,
- for decrease or = for no change.
A.
Water temperature.
B.
Oxygen content.
C.
Turbidity.
D.
Amount of sediments.
E.
F.
03. (3 points). The graph shows values measured along a river (river continuum). The
P/R ratio represents the ratio of production to respiration in the given part of the
river. From the graph choose the correct parts of the river for the questions below.
biological
diversity
0,1
0,01
1,0
0,1
0,01
0,001
5
4
3
2
diversity
P/R-ratio
P/R-ratio
particle size
10
1,0
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
(source)
(lower parts)
Parts of the river
Answer the three questions. Write the numbers of river parts in the boxes.
81
A.
B.
In which parts is organic material (such as tree leaves) essential for the consumers?
C.
35. (1 point). A student wished to estimate the size of a population of an endangered water
beetle species in a small pond. He captured 30 individuals, marked and then released
them back in the pond. After 24 hours, once again he captured 30 individuals. Of the
newly captured individuals, only 14 were marked. Assume that no individuals were
born, died, immigrated to or emigrated from the population during the experiment.
What would be the student`s estimation of the endangered water beetle population in
the pond? Estimated population size of endangered water beetle in the pond is:
36. (4 points). The graph shows the productivity of an aquatic ecosystem measured in terms
of dissolved oxygen produced and consumed by green plants and photosynthetic algae
where PS = photosynthesis and R = respiration.
30
20
10
0
PS
PS+R
-10
-20
Study the graph and answer the following questions, writing your answers in the box.
82
01. (1 points). Which bar represents net primary productivity?
02. (3 points). An algal bloom occurs until nutrient levels are exhausted. Then the algae
die off and microbial decomposition begins. How will this affect the graph
parameters PS and R?
1. PS will be increased.
2. PS will be decreased.
3. R will be increased.
SKIPPED
4. R will be decreased.
5. PS + R will be increase.
6. PS + R will be decrease.
7. PS + R remain unchanged.
83
02.3. (1 point). How would the graphs (parameters PS, R and PS+R) change if the net
community productivity per dissolved oxygen levels was measured?
SKIPPED
5. PS + R will decrease.
6. PS + R will remain unchanged.
84
Biosystematics (4 questions, 16 points).
37. (3 points). Below is a list of extant (living) mammalian genera. Assign them to the
continents and subcontinents where they live and indicate the Order to which they belong.
Insert the number of the animal into the correct boxes of tables 01 and 02.
GENUS
1.
Ursus (Bears)
2.
3.
Pan (Chimpanzees)
4.
Pongo (Orangutans)
5.
Elephas (Elephants)
6.
Macropus (Kangaroos)
85
38. (3 points). Match the terms in the left column ( 1 to 6) with the names of organisms in the
right column ( A to F).
1. Polyembryony.
A. Fasciola
2. Heterogony.
B. Helix.
3. Metagenesis
C. Apis
SKIPPED
4. Hermaphrodity.
D. Ichnenmon
5. Parthenogenesis.
E. Aurelia.
6. Parthenocarpy.
F. Axolotl (Ambystoma).
Answer:
1
B39. (3 points). The cladogram shows the phylogenetic relationships among seven
hypothetical species.
isEa paraphyletic
group
(A)
01. (2 points).
Species
A Which ofBthe following
C
F
G
H and which is a
polyphyletic group (B)?
1. E + F + G.
2. E + F.
3. E + F + G + H.
4. C + E.
5. B + C.
Answer:
SKIPPED
. ___________________
.____________________
02. (1 point). Which species are most closely related?
1. G and H.
2. G and F.
3. H and F.
4. Evolutionary closeness is equal for all species.
86
87
1 Animalia;
11 Gastropoda;
21 Drosophila;
2 Arthropoda;
12 Annelida;
22 Aphis;
3 Echinodermata;
13 Protozoa;
23 Leptinotarsa;
4 Mollusca;
14 Viviparus
24 Coleoptera;
5 Fungi;
15 Hymenoptera
25
6 Chilopoda;
16
26 Oligochaeta;
7 Insecta;
17 Arachnida;
27 Lepidoptera;
18 Cnidaria;
28 Anopheles;
9 Plantae;
19 Diptera;
29 Locusta;
20
30.
10 Apis;
Kingdom
Phylum:
Class:
Order:
Genus:
02. (1 point). Choose the number corresponding to the type of the insects leg.
1. Leaping.
2. Burrowing.
3. Swimming.
4. Gathering.
5. Walking.
6. Prehensile.
88
03. (1 point). Using the letters, list the leg structural elements this insect possesses in
sequence (beginning with those closest to the body).
. Femur.
. Tibia.
. Trochanter.
D. Coxa.
E. Tarsus.
04. (1 point). Give the number corresponding to the type of insect mouthpart.
1.Piercing-suctorial.
2. Licking.
3. Biting.
4. Suctorial.
05. (1 point). Select the numbers of organs of other organisms, which are homologous to
the wings of the insect concerned.
1. Sparrow wing.
2. Crayfish gills.
3. Bat wings.
4. Fish dorsal fin.
5. Fish pectoral fin.
6. Potato beetle elytrum.
7. Frog legs.
89
06. (0,8 point). In the answer table assign the developmental stages of this insect
according to the letters in the figure.
1.
Sporocyst.
5. Imago.
2.
Egg.
6. Redia.
3.
Graaf vesicle.
7. Pupa.
4.
Larva.
8. Hydatid cyst.
Answer:
90
07. (1 point). What is the significance of the species for humans?
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants!
In the laboratory PLANT PHYSIOLOGY, MORPHOLOGY AND ANATOMY you
will be given the following three tasks:
Good luck!
_____________________________________________________________________________
Country________________________
First name______________________ Family name ____________________
Code_____________________
2
Task 1. (35 points) The study of physical and chemical properties of photosynthetic
pigments.
The conversion of the energy of light into chemical energy occurs in plants with the help of
pigment-protein complexes of chloroplast membranes. These complexes include photosynthetic
pigments which determine the activity of the primary photosynthetic processes. An
understanding of photosynthesis is impossible without knowledge of photosynthetic
pigment properties. Chlorophyll and other photosynthetic pigments have several specific
properties: absorption of different wavelengths of light, ability to participate in redox
reactions, solubility in different types of solvents, etc.
You have to study several of these properties of photosynthetic pigments during this task.
1.
2.
Pipettes.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
A water bath.
9.
A tube holder.
10.
11.
12.
3
1.1. (8 points) Transfer 3 ml of pigment solution from flask A into tube 1 and also 3ml
into tube 2.
Add five drops of 20% KOH from flask B and 1 ml of 2 (from flask C) to the tube 1 and
to the tube 2 - only 1 ml of 2.
Fill in the missing components of the chemical reaction you have just observed in scheme
1.1 of the answer sheet. Please use the number corresponding to the appropriate formulae
from the list below.
KOH
H2O
1. C55H72O5N4Mg chlorophyll.
2. C34H30O5N4 MgK2 potassium salt of the chlorophyllic acid.
3. C55H74O5N4 pheophytin (phaeophytin).
4. C20H39OH phytol.
5. CH3OH methanol.
6. C2H5OH ethanol.
7. MgCl2 magnesium chloride.
8. KCl potassium chloride.
1.2. (4 points) Add 1 ml of the petrolic (petroleum) ether (from the flask D) to the tubes
1 and 2, shake well and leave to stand until the fractions separate completely.
Determine the colour of each fraction in the tubes 1 and 2. Write down the results in
the appropriate cells of the table 1.2 of the answer sheet. Please use single letter colour codes
as shown below.
A. violet;
B. blue;
C. green;
D. yellow;
E. red;
F. olive brown;
G. black;
H. colourless;
4
Tube
Reagent
Experiment 1.1.
Experiment 1.2.
1.3. (4 points) Which pigments are responsible for the colour of the petrolic fraction
on the tubes 1 and 2? Write down in the answer sheet (1.3) single letter codes for the
compounds from the list below:
1: _______
2: _______
A. anthocyanins;
B. carotenoids;
C. phycobilins;
D. chlorophylls;
1.4. (2 points) Add 3 ml of the pigment extract to the tube 3 (flask ) and add 5 drops
of HCl (flask ). Mix the tube contents thoroughly by shaking. Record the new colour.
Add 1 ml of the saturated (CH3COO)2Zn solution (from the flask F) to the same tube. Heat
the solution on the water bath. Mix by shaking andrecord the new colour of the solution.
Write the results down in the table 1.4 of the answer sheet. Please use single letter colour
codes as shown below.
A. violet;
B. blue;
C. green;
D. yellow;
E. red;
F. olive brown;
G. black;
H. colourless.
Reagent
HCl
(CH3COO)2 Zn
1.5. (6 points) In the scheme 1.5 of the answer sheet, please write the possible components
5
of the reaction in the tube 3 after addition of hydrochloric acid to the pigment
extract. Please use the number corresponding to the appropriate formula from the list below.
HCl
1. C55H72O5N4Mg chlorophyll.
2. C34H30O5N4 MgK2 potassium salt of the chlorophyllic acid.
3. C55H74O5N4 pheophytin (phaeophytin).
4. C20H39OH phytol.
5. CH3OH methanol.
6. C2H5OH ethanol.
7. MgCl2 magnesium chloride.
8. KCl potassium chloride.
1.6. (1 point) Add 2 ml of the pigment extract and 2 ml of ascorbic acid (flask H) to the
tube 4. Mix by shaking until the colour changes.
Please note the colour change. Put the results in the table 1.6 in the answer sheet. Please
use the single letter colour codes shown below.
A. violet;
B. blue;
C. green;
D. yellow;
E. red;
F. olive brown;
G. black;
H. colourless.
1.7. (6 points) Complete the scheme of this reaction (1.7 in the answer sheet)
using compound and condition numbers from the two lists below:
Compound 2
Conditions
Compound 1
Compounds:
1. chlorophyll;
2. pheophytin (phaeophytin);
3. ascorbic acid;
Conditions:
4. electrons involved;
5. protons involved;
6. light involved.
1.8. (4 points)
Write the results down in the table 1.8 of the answer sheet. Please use single letter colour
codes shown below.
A. violet;
B. blue;
C. green;
D. yellow;
E. red;
F. olive brown;
G. black;
H. colourless.
Compound
1
2
7
Task 2. (12 points) The study of angiosperm flowers structure.
x3
2.
Forceps.
x1
3.
Dissecting needles.
x2
4.
A magnifying glass.
x1
2.1. (6 points) Study the morphology of flowers , , . Using formula numbers (1-14)
from the list below, indicate the correct formula for each flower in the answer sheet.
1. * K5 C5 G
2. * 5 G
3. * K5 C5 5+5 G(3)
4. * K(5) C5 5+5 G(5)
5. * K5 C5 G1
6. * K(5) C5 G(5)
7. K(5) C1,2,2 (5+5) G1
8. K(5) C1,2,2 (9)1 G1
9. * K0 C5 5 G (2)
10. * K2+2 C4 2+4 G(2)
11. K(5) C(2,3) 2,2 G(2)
12. * K(5) C(5) 5 G(2)
13. K0 C(5) (5) G(2)
14. * 3+3 3+3 G(3)
* = polysymmetrical
= monosymmetrical
8
2.2. (3 points) The diagrams show the types of ovaries characteristic of angiosperm
flowers. Using the numbers (1-4) from the table below, record the types of ovaries for the
flowers , and in the answer sheet.
1.
2.
Superior ovary
(Hypogynous flower)
Middle ovary
(Perigynous flower)
4.
Inferior ovary
(Epigynous flower)
3.
Half-inferior ovary
(Half -epigynous
flower)
2.3. (3 points) Please indicate in the answer sheet to which family the plants with flowers
A, B and C belong. Use the numbers (1-10) from the list below.
1. Ranunculaceae (buttercups)
2. Oleaceae
3. Rosaceae.
4. Leguminosae (Fabaceae), Papilionaceae.
5. Fagaceae
6. Cruciferae (Brassicaceae).
7. Labiatae (Lamiaceae).
8. Solanaceae.
9. Compositae (Asteraceae).
10. Liliaceae.
10
Task 3. (21 points) The study of anatomic structure of a plant organ on a cross
section.
2. Microscope Axiostar.
3. Forceps.
4. Dissecting needles.
5. Blade.
6. Glass slides.
7. Cover slips.
9. Pipette.
Prepare a cross section of the object you are given. Stain this cross section with
phloroglucin and add several drops of HCl. Wash the preparation thoroughly with water
for 2-5 minutes and then cover it with a cover slip. Observe the preparation under the
microscope. Compare the cross section you have just prepared to the schemes
1-6 below and determine which scheme it corresponds to.
11
12
13
14
3.1. (8 points) Please label (using the numbers from the list below) the tissue elements pointed to
by arrows on the scheme corresponding to your cross section in the answer sheet.
1. Endodermis.
11. Periderm.
2. Phloem elements.
12. Sclerenchyma.
13. Pericycle.
4. Collenchyma.
5. Phelloderma.
15. Stoma.
6. Chloroplasts.
16. Chlorenchyma.
7. Epidermis.
17. Cambium.
8. Exodermis.
10.Aerenchyma.
3.2. (9 points) What elements (1-18) are coloured by phloroglucin in the presence
of HCl? Please, mark with + correct answer in the answer sheet.
1. Endoderm cells.
2.Elements of phloem.
4. Cells of collenchyma.
5. Tracheids.
6. Vessel cells.
15. Rhizoids.
7. Epidermis.
8. Trichomes.
3.2.
1
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
15
3.3. (1 point) What compounds are coloured by phloroglucinin the presence of HCl?
Write the corresponding number (1-6) from the list below into the answer sheet.
1. Cellulose.
4. Suberin.
2. Pectin.
5. Cutin.
3. Lignin.
6. Hemicellulose.
3.3.:_____________________________
3.4. (1 point) Determine which organ the cross section was made from. Write the
corresponding number (1-6) from the list below into the answer sheet.
1. Root.
4. Flower stalk.
2. Stem.
5. Runner.
6. Rhizome.
3.4.:_____________________________
3.5. (1 point) Determine which division of higher plants the plant you study belongs
to. Write the corresponding number (1-4) from the list below into the answer sheet.
1. Lycopodiophyta.
3. Polypodiophyta.
2. Equisetophyta.
4. Pinophyta.
5. Magnoliophyta.
3.5.:_____________________________
3.6. (1 point) Using the cross section you have just prepared, determine which ecological
group (relative to water availability) the plant belongs to. Write the corresponding number (1-4)
from the ecomorph list below into the answer sheet.
1. Hygrophyte.
3. Mesophyte.
2. Hydrophyte.
4. Xerophyte.
3.6.:_____________________________
CODE:
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants!
You have to write down your results and answers into the ANSWER SHEET
which will be collected by an assistant when the time elapses. It is not necessary to
write anything in the task sheets.
Result lists taken away from the laboratory will not be accepted!
Please note that the results from the task 1 must be shown to the assistant
BEFORE the time limit!
Please do not forget to put zoological objects and instruments in their
original positions when finished, as these will be used by the next group.
Should the mollusc shells become damaged, you can ask for a replacement.
Good luck!
_____________________________________________________________________________
Country________________________
First name______________________ Family name ____________________
Code_____________________
3
Task 1. (36 points) Detaching pedes (extremities) of crayfish (stacus) and determination
of their function.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Dissecting tray
A magnifying glass.
1
1
5.
Cotton sheet.
6.
Latex gloves.
7.
18
8.
You need to observe the details of animal's segmentation, to find its body parts and
sequentially detach the pedes (appendages excluding the first (antennuales or smallest) pair of
antennae) from one side of animal's body, assembling them in order on a plate with the help of
pins. Then it is necessary to determine the function of each ped and write it down in the answer
sheet.
Description of the techniques.
1. Take the animal in your hand, abdominal (ventral) side up. It is recommended to use a
cotton sheet and latex glove. Beware of small spicules on the carapace! Carefully study
the pedes of all body parts (with the help of a magnifying glass if necessary).
4
2. Using forceps sequentially detach all pedes from one side of animal's body. To do this,
hold the ped at its base with the forceps and pull away from the crayfish. You can also use
scissors and/or scalpel if necessary.
3. Assemble the pedes on pins with the corresponding numbers (1, 2, 3, etc.). Start
numbering from the head. Put the pedes on the foam plate in the correct order.
Please raise your hand when finished with the first task so that your work can be
checked. If the assistant is busy with another participant, you should continue with the next
task, but please note that the results of task 1 are not counted if they were shown to the
assistant after the total time limit (60 minutes).
In the answer list of task 1 each ped has 3 variants of its possible function. Study the table,
determine the function for each ped, then mark the correct function for each ped in the table with
a circle (). Note: a participant gets 1 point for every correct answer and loses
0.5 point for every wrong answer.
Pedes (extremities)
Functions
1.
sensory
respiratory
reproductive
2.
swimming
food grinding
respiratory
3.
respiratory
reproductive
4.
reproductive
sensory
5.
walking
defence/attack
6.
defence/attack
reproductive
7.
reproductive
swimming
respiratory
8.
swimming
reproductive
9.
reproductive
respiratory
defence/attack
10.
reproductive
walking
sensory
11.
reproductive
walking
12.
walking
food grinding
sensory
13.
walking
reproductive
defence/attack
14.
walking
respiratory
reproductive
15.
defence/attack
swimming
walking
16.
swimming
food grinding
respiratory
17.
reproductive
sensory
swimming
18.
swimming
respiratory
6
Task 2. (10 points) Animal taxonomy test.
Page 7 has pictures of ten animals numbered with roman numerals. The table below has
the names of animal phyla (AK), subphyla or classes (ak) and genera (110).
Phylum
.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
Annelida.
Arthropoda.
Chordata.
Cnidaria.
Echinodermata.
Mollusca.
Nematoda
(Nemathelminthes)
H. Platyhelminthes.
J. Porifera.
K. Protozoa.
Subphylum/Class
.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
g.
Anthozoa.
Cephalopoda.
Chelicerata.
Crustacea.
Hydrozoa.
Insecta.
Polychaeta.
h. Scyphozoa.
j. Asteroidea
(Stellaroidea)
k. Trematoda.
Genus
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Araneus.
Asterias.
Corallium.
Cyclops.
Fasciola.
Hydra.
Locusta.
8. Musca.
9. Nereis.
10. Sepia.
Please label the taxonomic position of each animal using the information from the table
put the corresponding code for phylum, subphylum/class and genus next to animal picture in the
answer sheet.
II
III
V
IV
VII
VI
IX
VIII
8
Task 3. (20 points) Determination of species name of freshwater gastropod
molluscs.
Materials, instruments and equipment
1.
2.
3.
A ruler.
4.
5.
A magnifying glass.
Many species of gastropod molluscs live in fresh water. They play an important role in
water ecosystems. Many are specific intermediate hosts of helminthes parasites of humans and
domestic animals. In this connection taxonomic identification of freshwater gastropod molluscs
has not only theoretical, but also applied value.
The tray has 10 numbered shells of gastropod molluscs. The classification key below allows the
identification of species names and includes illustrations explaining the details of shell structure
and measurements. Classify the molluscs you are given and place the numbers written
on their shells next to species names in the table in the answer sheet.
Species name
Viviparus contectus
Bithynia tentaculata
Physa fontinalis
Aplexa hypnorum
Radix ovata
Radix auricularia
Lymnaea stagnalis
Planorbarius corneus
Planorbis planorbis
Segmentina nitida
Shell number
CLASSIFICATION KEY
1a. Shell aperture (opening) has an operculum (lid)(2)
1b. Shell aperture without an operculum (lid)......(3)
2a. Shell is at least 20 mm high, green-brown, sometimes with three dark stripes on the
last turn of the whorl.......Viviparus contectus
2b. Shell is not more than 15 mm high, uniformly brown without
stripes..................................Bithynia tentaculata.
3a. Shell is like a tower or a cone with variable number of turns..(4)
3b. Shell is flat.(8)
4a. Shell is sinistral....(5)
4b. Shell is dextral..(6)
5a. Shell is egg-shaped. Whorl height is less then aperture height. Yellow- brown or light
brown...................................Physa fontinalis.
5b. Shell has spindle-like shape. Whorl height is twice the aperture height. Brown or
dark brown............................Aplexa hypnorum.
6a. Aperture height is significantly more than whorl height....(7)
6b. Whorl height is equal or slightly exceeds aperture height. Shell is up to 60 mm
high.................Lymnaea stagnalis.
7a. Aperture height is approximately twice its width. Shell height is up to 25 mm,
width up to 15 mm..Radix ovata
7b. Aperture height and width are approximately equal. Shell height is up to 40 mm,
width up to 30 mm.....Radix auricularia.
8a. Aperture has bud-like shape, its height exceeds its width .....Planorbarius corneus.
8b. Aperture has another shape, its width exceeds its height. (9)
9a. Diameter of the shell is over 8 mm, walls are thick, 56 turns, curved at top with
flat bottom. Shell walls are opaque, dark-brown .......................Planorbis planorbis.
9b. Diameter of the shell is less than 8 mm, walls are thin, 4-5 turns, curved at top
with plano-concave bottom. Shell walls are semi-transparent,
light-brown. ..Segmentina nitida.
10
dextral shell
sinistral shell
B
E
F
A
Should the mollusc shells become damaged, you can ask for a replacement.
Please do not forget to put zoological objects and instruments in their original
positions when finished, as these will be used by the next group.
_____________________________________________________________________________________________
Dear Participants!
In the laboratory MICROBIOLOGY AND BIOTECHNOLOGY you will be given the
following two tasks:
Answer sheets taken away from the laboratory will not be accepted!
Please be careful when performing reactions and do not let the reagents and solutions
come into
contact with your skin and clothes!
PLEASE USE HAND DISINFECTION SOLUTIONS AFTER THIS PRACTICAL
EXAMINATION
GOOD LUCK!
_____________________________________________________________________________
Country________________________
Code_____________________
2
Task 1. (46 points) Identification of microorganisms.
3
organisms with anaerobic respiration (fermentative metabolism) and letter "O" for organisms
with aerobic respiraction (oxidative metabolism).
Fill all columns of the table except for the last one. Then identify your bacterium using
identification table in the end of the task sheet and put the letter corresponding to the identified
species into the column Result of identification.
nitrate reductase
H2S production
amylase
protease
oxidase
catalase
O\ F-test
Gram reaction
Strain
Result of identification
1
2
3
4
5
4
Test 1.1. Gram reaction
To perform this test you need:
1. Biomass of bacterial strains 1-5 (from the GCO plate).
2. solution (3 % ).
3. Five glass slides.
4. Wooden toothpicks.
Attention! You will need the GCO Petri dish later to perform tests 1.3 and 1.4. Please
perform the tests in the suggested order: 1.1, 1.3, 1.4.
The method:
Using a dropping bottle, put a small drop of the 3 % solution onto a glass slide.
Using a toothpick, transfer some biomass (roughly 3-4 mm in diameter) of one strain to the KOH
drop, trying not to transfer the agar. Mix the bacterial mass with the KOH solution thoroughly. If
the mass sticks to the toothpick and moves behind it, the strain is Gram-negative, otherwise
Gram-positive. You may repeat the test if the results are not clear.
Using a new toothpick each time, repeat the test with the remaining strains. Put the results
in the corresponding column of the "Identification of bacteria" table in the answer sheet using
"+" for Gram-positive bacteria and "-" for Gram-negative.
5
labelled 1a 5a was covered with vaseline oil immediately after inoculation, while the tubes 1b
5b had no oil. The tubes were incubated in a thermostat for 24 hours.
Analyse the colour change in the tubes for each strain. Put the results in the column "O/Ftest" in the table "Identification of bacteria" in the answer sheet. Use letter "F" for organisms
with anaerobic respiration (fermentative metabolism) and letter "O" for organisms with aerobic
respiration (oxidative metabolism).
1.3.1. ___________________________
The method:
Using a dropping bottle, put a drop of DMPA onto each colony. 30-60 seconds later the
colonies of oxidase-positive strains turn pink to dark red. Analyse the colony colour of each
strain and fill the results in the corresponding column of the "Identification of bacteria" table in
the answer sheet.
Question 1.4.1. (4 points) Which of the following statements are true for cytochrome
oxidase positive bacteria?
. Capable of using 2 as terminal electron acceptor in the respiratory chain.
. All are unable to undertake anaerobic respiration.
. All are strict aerobes (obligate aerobes).
D. All are strict anaerobes (obligate anaerobes).
. All are facultative anaerobes.
F. Cytochrome oxidase takes part in chemosynthesis in some strains.
1.4.1. ___________________________
7
1.5. Proteolytic activity test.
For determination of proteolytic activity you must analyse a Petri dish with media
containing casein, inoculated in advance with strains 1-5. This plate is labelled "protease". Record
the results in the table in the answer sheet.
The plate labelled "amylase" contains rich solid medium supplemented with 0.2% of starch
and has been inoculated with strains 1-5 in advance. Cover the surface of this plate with
Lugol's solution (Lugol) and determine which bacteria have the amylolytic activity. Record the
reaction results into the corresponding column of the "Identification of bacteria" table in the
answer sheet.
1.7. Test for hydrogen sulphide generation (2S-test).
Here you must analyse five tubes prepared previously. The tubes contain meat broth that was
inoculated with test strains some time before. The tubes also contain pieces of white indicator paper
saturated with the solution of lead acetate. Record the results in the table in the answer sheet.
Record in the answer sheet the single letter code for the correct answer for each of the two
questions below:
Question 1.7.1. (4 points) When bacteria which are capable of producing 2S grow on
meat broth medium, 2S is generated from:
. RNA.
F. Glycine.
. DNA.
G. Thiamine.
. Arginine.
H. Biotin.
D. Methionine.
I. Taurine.
. Serine.
J. Cysteine.
1.7.1.:________________________________________
Question 1.7.2. (2 points) Which reaction(s) is/are responsible for the colour change of
the indicator paper?
. 2CH3COOH + H2S = (CH3CO)2S + 2H2O
. Pb2+ + S2- = PbS
C. (CH3COO)2Pb + H2S = 2CH3COOH + Pb +S
D. 2CH3COOH + H2S = CHSCOOH + 2H2
E. 2CH3COOH + Pb + 2H2S = 2C2H6 + PbSO4 + S
Write your answer code or codes down in the line 1.7.2. of the answer sheet
1.7.2.:________________________________________
9
Write your answer code or codes down in the line 1.8.1. of the answer sheet.
1.8.1.:________________________________________
Use your results and the identification table to identify the species of your strains. Fill the
results in the table in the answer list.
Identification table
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
Escherichia coli
Xanthomonas
campestris
Lactobacillus
delbrueckii
Erwinia herbicola
Clavibacter
michiganensis
Staphylococcus
saprophyticus
Pseudomonas
mendocina
Pseudomonas
putida
Sarcina
lutea
Streptobacillus
moniliformes
Agrobacterium
tumefaciens
Pseudomonas
fluorescens
Bacillus subtilis
Streptococcus
lactis
nitrate reductase
H2S production
amylase
protease
oxidase
O\ F-test
catalase
Genus, species
F
O
+
+
+
+
+
+
F
O
+
+
+
+
+
+
F
F
+
+
+
+
10
Task 2. (18 points) Study of Bacterial cultures expressing different genes.
4. Pipette.
Two strains of Escherichia coli have been constructed experimentally in which the xylE
gene was fused to promoters of two different genes, gene C and gene D. Figure 1 shows
growth curves for these bacteria, labelled I and II (I - E. coli with xylE fused to gene promoter,
II - E. coli with xylE fused to gene D promoter). The arrows in Figure 1 show when the cell
samples were taken from the cultures. The number on the tube corresponds to the number of the
arrow in Figure 1.
Determine the phases of culture growth in which genes C and D are expressed.
11
Figure 1
OD600
2
1.6
II
1.2
0.8
0.4
4
0
2
10
12
26
Time, hours
Determine in which growth phases genes C and D are expressed and fill the table in the
answer sheet, putting the "+" sign in the corresponding column.
Gene
early log phase
II
stationary phase
Dear Participants!
In the laboratory "GENETICS" you will be given the following two tasks:
You have to write down your results and answers on the ANSWER SHEET
which will be collected by an assistant when the time elapses. It is not necessary to
write anything on the task sheets.
Good luck!
__________________________________________________________________
Country________________________
First name______________________ Family name ____________________
Code_____________________
Time for carrying out this task must not exceed 25 minutes
Materials and equipment
1.
sample 1
2.
sample 2
3.
sample 3
4.
sample 4
5.
Seeds of F generation.
sample 5
6.
7.
The seed-coat colour of common beans (Phaseolus vulgaris L.) is controlled by a number
of genes, which are responsible for the synthesis of pigments and distribution of the seed coat
colour, as well as modifying genes, that can enhance, attenuate or change colour in another way.
In the preliminary experiments breeding of two types of common beans (1 and 2)
differing in seed-coat colour was conducted. Seeds of F1 plants were cultured. Plants (F1)
gave seeds of F1 phenotype.
On the next stage of the experiment test-crossing of F1 plants with testcross line plants
(L) was conducted. Grown hybrids (Fa) gave seeds of Fa phenotype. For the next analysis, one
seed from each Fa plant was taken.
3
Scheme of the experiment.
CROSSING SCHEME
P1
P2
(sample 1)
(sample 2)
F1
(sample 3)
L
(sample 4)
F
(sample 5)
4
Table 1
Kind of seeds
Seed-coat colour
White
w
Yellow-brown
y
Black
b
Determine if parental samples P1 and P2 are pure-breeding lines (homozygous at each gene
locus).
Determine the genotypes of the parental forms of P1 and P2, hybrid seeds F1, seeds of F
generation and testcross line seeds L
5
1.1.1. (1.5 points) Look over samples 1 and 2. Specify the seed phenotypes of
parental forms and F1 using the symbols from Table 1 (Page 4). Fill in the table in the answer
sheet:
Plant
seeds
Sample
F1
Seed phenotype
1.1.2.:__________________________________________
Problem 1.2. Determine the type of inheritance of seed-coat colour in common beans.
You need to analyze the seeds of Fa plants, which were received after breeding of F1 plants
with La plants.
1.2.1. (1 point) Carefully place the seeds from sample 5 (Fa plant seeds) on to the
sheet of white paper. Identify the quantity of the phenotypic classes of Fa by seed-coat colour.
Group the seeds of Fa by phenotypic classes by putting them into Petri dishes for seeds. Using
the codes from Table 1 specify the phenotypes of Fa. Record in the table in the answer sheet.
6
of class
Seed phenotype
1.2.2. (3 points) Using your findings about the quantity of Fa classes, choose the type
of interaction of non-allelic genes A and B, which control seed-coat colour in
common beans. Record the symbols of correct answers on the answer sheet.
. There is no interaction of non-allelic genes in the experiment conducted.
B. Incomplete dominance.
C. Duplicate genes
D. Epistasis
E. Codominance.
F. Pleiotropic gene action.
1.2.2:________________________________________
Problem 1.3. Determine the genotypes of the parental samples P 1 and P2, hybrid seeds
F1, seeds of F generation and testcross line seeds (L)
1.3.1. (4 points) Specify all of the possible genotypes of P 1, P2, F1, Fa, and La plants
using symbols A and B to mark the dominant alleles, symbols a and b to mark the
recessive alleles of the investigated genes in the boxes of the table below. Fill in
the table in the answer sheet.
7
Seed phenotype
Plants
Black
Yellow-brown
White
1
2
F1
L
F
Problem 4. Determine if the investigated non-allelic genes A and B are linked.
of class
Seed phenotype
Number
of seeds
1.4.2. (3 points) Determine the ratio of the different phenotype classes by the colour
of the seeds in Fa. Fill in the answer sheet using the code of the correct answer:
Code
White
Yellow-brown
Black
A.
0.50
0.25
0.25
B.
0.50
0.19
0.31
C.
0.56
0.16
0.28
D.
0.42
0.14
0.44
E.
0.44
0.15
0.41
F.
0.50
0.14
0.36
1.4.2.:__________________________________________
1.4.3. (3 points) To determine whether there is linkage between the genes being
investigated you must specify the expected ratio in Fa in the case of no linkage. You
an receive the points for this task only if your answer for 1.2.2. is correct. Record in
the table in the answer sheet:
Phenotypic class
Ratio (%)
White seeds
Yellow-brown seeds
Black seeds
Phenotypic class
Ratio (%)
White seeds
Yellow-brown seeds
Black seeds
1.4.5.________________________________
1.4.6. (3 points) Use the table of 2 distribution to determine what is the maximum
probability (p) of your H0 (null hypothesis)not being rejected (being accepted). Write the codes
of the answers on your answer sheet.
10
Table of 2 distribution
Value (p) of a significance level 2
df
0.99
0.95
0.90
0.75
0.50
0.25
0.10
0.05
0.025
0.01
0.02
0.10
0.45
1.32
2.71
3.84
5.02
6.63
0.02
0.10
0.21
0.58
1.39
2.77
4.61
5.99
7.38
9.21
0.11
0.35
0.58
1.21
2.37
4.11
6.25
7.81
9.35
11.34
0.30
0.71
1.06
1.92
3.36
5.39
7.78
9.49
11.14 13.28
0.55
1.15
1.61
2.67
4.35
6.63
9.24
0.87
1.64
2.20
3.45
5.35
7.84
1.24
2.17
2.83
4.25
6.35
9.04
1.65
2.73
3.49
5.07
7.34
2.09
3.33
4.17
5.90
8.34
10
2.56
3.94
4.87
6.74
9.34
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
< 0.01
> 0.01
< 0.05
> 0.05
0.01
0.05
1.4.6._______________________________
1.4.7. (3 points) Using your value of p, determine if genes A and B are linked
. Calculate the distance between genes A and B (in cM) if they linked. Record in the
answer sheet the code of correct answer.
. There is complete linkage between genes A and B. The distance between the genes
is 6.94 .
. There is complete linkage between genes A and B. The distance between the genes
is 12.36 .
. There is complete linkage between genes A and B. The distance between the genes
is 27.78 .
D. There is incomplete linkage between genes A and B. The distance between the genes
is 6.94 .
. There is incomplete linkage between genes A and B. The distance between the genes
is 12.36 .
11
F. There is incomplete linkage between genes A and B. The distance between the genes
is 27.78 .
G. Genes A and B are not linked. The distance between the genes is 6.94 .
H. Genes A and B are not linked. The distance between the genes is 12.,36 .
I. Genes A and B are not linked. The distance between the genes is 27.78
J. Genes A and B are not linked
1.4.7:__________________________________________
12
Task 2: (30.5 points) Identification of trp mutations in yeast Saccharomyces cerevisiae
12
7. 1 ml pipette.
13
You are given the yeast Saccharomyces cerevisiae as an experimental organism. The
scheme of life cycle of this organism is presented below.
n
Meiosis
2n
n
n
n
These yeasts have alternating haploid and diploid phases during their life cycle. The fusion
of haploid cells gives rise to a diploid cell which through meiosis can produce four haploid cells
with different genotypes.
13
The scheme below shows the pathway of tryptophan biosynthesis in the yeast
Saccharomyces cerevisiae. The scheme shows some intermediate products and genes responsible
for the synthesis of enzymes of this pathway.
chorismate
anthranilate
trp2 gene
indole
trp4 gene
tryptophan
trp5 gene
Mutations in the trp genes lead to the accumulation of the intermediates in the culture
liquid. Two intermediates of this biosynthetic pathway, anthranilate and indole, can be detected
in the culture liquid of the corresponding mutants through colour reactions with the Erlich
reagent.
2.1. (1.5 points) Using a special pipette, add 0.5 ml of Erlich reagent to the control
tubes with standard solutions of anthranilate, indole and to the tube with water (with no
anthranilate and indole). Observe the colour change and record it in the table in the answer sheet
using single letter colour code.
Compound
Water
Anthranilate
Indole
Colour code:
yellow
R red
N no colour change
14
2.2. (1.5 points) Which compounds will accumulate in the culture liquid if the
mutants are grown in the rich medium? Fill in the table below in the answer sheet using one
letter code.
Mutant
Accumulated intermediate
tr 2
trp 4
trp 5
A anthranilate
Code:
I indole
2.3. (6 points) Three classes of double mutants have been constructed in haploid S.
cerevisiae named as trpX trpY trpZ +; trpX trpY + trpZ ; trpX + trpY trpZ (sign
denotes mutant genes, sign + denotes wild type genes; all trp genes are located on different
chromosomes).
Three matings between these mutants have been performed as shown in the table below.
Each mating has generated all possible types of haploid progeny.
Please write down in the answer sheet the genotypes of all possible progeny from each
cross.
15
ating
II
+
trpX trpY trpZ
III
2.4. (12 points) Clones produced by these matings have then been grown in liquid
medium, cells removed by centrifugation and supernatant collected for analysis. You now
need to identify these clones.
Please test each of the 12 culture liquid samples for the presence of the tryptophan
metabolic intermediates and use these data for the identification of the trpX , trpY and trpZ
mutations. You are given tubes with supernatants from 12 cultures of S. cerevisiae. The tubes are
labelled according to the mating (I, II and III) and clone number (1-4).
To test the accumulation of particular compounds, transfer 1 ml of liquid from each tube to
the wells of the 12-well plate. Use a new pipette for each transfer!
Add 0.5 ml of the Erlich reagent (using a special pipette) to each well containing the 1 ml
of supernatant. Record the colour changes (using a single letter code) in the table in the
answer sheet.
Determine which compound has accumulated in each culture and record this in the same
table in the answer sheet using a single letter code.
16
Tube
Mating
Accumulated
intermediate
I.1
I
I.2
I.3
I.4
II.1
II
II.2
II.3
II.4
III.1
III
+
trpX trpY trpZ
III.2
III.3
III.4
Code:
yellow
A anthranilate
R red
I indole
N no colour change
O neither anthranilate
nor indole
2.5. (3 points) Identify the trpX , trpY and trpZ mutations. Write down names of
the genes in which the trpX , trpY and trpZ mutations are located in the table in the answer
sheet.
Gene
trp 2
trp 4
trp 5
Mutation
17
2.6. (3 points) How would the experimental results change if the
trpX and trpY genes were completely linked? Record in the answer sheet
the letter corresponding to the correct answer:
. The number of different progeny genotypes would be reduced.
. The results would not be changed.
. Phenotypically wild type yeast may be produced.
D. The number of single and triple mutants would increase.
2.6.:__________________________________________
2.7. (1.5 points) How many genotype classes would be obtained if the three genes
were located on the same chromosome and were 100 per cent linked? Write the number for each
mating in the answer sheet.
2.7.: I________________________________________
II_________________________________________
III_________________________________________
2.8. (0.5 points) Which mating will give the single mutant accumulating
anthranilate? Write the mating number (I, II or III) in the answer sheet.
2.8.:__________________________________________
2.9. (0.5 point) Write the genotype of this mutant in the answer sheet using the
actual gene names (trp 2, trp 4 or trp 5).
2.9.:__________________________________________
2.10. (1 point) Which of the double mutants has to be mated with this anthranilateaccumulating single mutant to get progeny with wild type genotype? Write the genotype of this
double mutant in the answer sheet using the actual gene names (trp 2, trp 4 or trp 5).
2.10.:__________________________________________
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Theoretical test
GOOD LUCK !
Part A
Find the one correct answer in each task and mark it in the answer sheet in this way:
The jury will check only the answer sheet!
Cell Biology
A1. In which processes microtubules could be involved?
Beating of cilia
Movements of
and flagella
chromatids
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
in living cells
Beating of cilia
C.
They are found only in plant cells and involved in the movement of chloroplasts
D.
They are found in plant and animal cells and involved in the movement of vesicles
E.
They are found in all eukaryotic cells and involved in the movement of pyruvate
from cytosol to mitochondrial matrix
B.
C.
D.
E. Admission of foreign DNA in a cell is not necessarily lethal for the cell, especially in the
case of
eukaryotic cell
A7. Which of the following is not the metabolic role of tricarboxylic acid (TCA) cycle?
A. Completion of carbohydrates oxidation
B. Supply of metabolic precursors for biosynthesis of some amino acids
C. Supply NADH for the respiratory chain
D. Supply NADPH for biosynthetic reactions
E.
While electrons in the electron transport chain are passing through the transporters
located on the inner membrane of mitochondria, protons are pumped out of the matrix
by the respiratory complexes I, III and IV
B.
C.
The protons return to the mitochondrial matrix through the proton-dependent ATP
synthase
D.
This theory is valid for forming of ATP in photosynthetic electron transport chains
E.
A9. Which three amino acids can be formed directly in one step from the following metabolic
intermediates: pyruvate, oxaloacetate and -ketoglutarate ?
Pyruvate
Oxaloacetate
-ketoglutarate
A.
Alanine
Aspartate
Glutamate
B.
Lysine
Asparagine
Glutamine
C.
Serine
Arginine
Tyrosine
D.
Threonine
Glycine
Tryptophan
E.
Histidine
Proline
Leucine
A 10. How many different primary structures approximately may represent a 10 residues long
polypeptide, which is a random combination of 20 naturally occurring amino acids?
A. 10
B. 200
C. 40 00
D. 10 000 000 000 000
E. 100 000 000 000 000 000 000
A 12. What is the correct sequence of events during immunological responses to viral
infection?
Code
1. Natural killer cell activation
2.
Antibody production
Time
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
A.
Acetyl CoA
NADH2
Lactic acid
B.
Water
CO2
Dehydrogenase
C.
NADH2
CO2
Dehydrogenase
D.
NADH2
Water
Peroxidase
E.
Pyruvate
CO2
NADH2
A 14. Some genes in the genome of bacteria are organised in operons. Which statement about
such operons is correct?
A.
Genes of the operon are arranged in mosaic structures of introns and exons
B.
Translation of all genes of one operon starts at the same initiation codon
C.
D.
Proteins encoded in the genes of the same operon are translated from one common
mRNA molecule
E.
Translation of all genes from the same operon is terminated at the same common
STOP codon
A 15. Which of the given components is not needed for DNA replication in vivo?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
DNA polymerase
A 16. For numerous groups of organisms genes are split in exons and introns. Which
statement about gene expression is correct?
A. The genetic information of only some introns is used for synthesis of proteins
B. A separate promoter induces the transcription of each exon
C. During RNA processing the sequences of introns are removed as a result of splicing
of the pre-mRNA
D. Translation of each exon starts with its own initiation codon (AUG)
E.
During the translation ribosomes are jumping over the intronic part of mRNA
7
A 17. Human hormone insulin is synthesised as pre-protein and modified before secretion in
extracellular space. It contains two polypeptide chains. Which statement about these chains is
correct?
A.
B.
C.
D.
They are synthesised on cytosolic ribosomes and modified in the lumen of lysosomes
E.
A 18. Which statement regarding the amount of genomic DNA per cell (M) during the cell
cycle is correct?
A.
B.
C.
MDNA[G1] = MDNA[G2]
D.
MDNA[G2 after
E.
mitosis]
A 20. Carnivorous plants trap insects. What do they obtain from the insects? What do they
primarily use this substance for?
A. They obtain water, because they live in a dry environment
B. They obtain nitrogen to make sugar
C. They obtain phosphorus to make protein
D. They obtain sugars, because they cant produce enough in photosynthesis
E. They obtain nitrogen to make protein
A 21. The diameter of woody stems is continually increasing. What structure ensures that
there is always enough bark to cover the outside of the stem?
A. Vascular cambium
B. Epidermis
C. Phellogen
D. Endodermis
E. Pericycle
10
A 22. The drawing shows s cross - section of a plant root. The lines (1-6) indicate parts and
the arrow (7) indicates a pathway in the root. Which of the statements (A-E) provides a
correct explanation of the drawing?
11
A 25. A plant biochemist received a specimen from a fellow scientist who noticed that the
plants stomates are closed during the day. The biochemist observed that radioactive carbon in
the form of carbon dioxide, fed to the plant at night, was first found in organic acids that
accumulate in the vacuole. During the day it moved to sugars being manufactured in the
chloroplast. What was the conclusion of the biochemist?
A. The plant fixes carbon by crassulacean acid metabolism (CAM)
B. The plant is a C4 plant
C. The plant is a C3 plant
D. The plant is using mitochondria as chloroplasts
E. The carbon fixation reactions occur in different cells
A 26. Red algae grow at depths beyond those to which red and blue light can penetrate in the
ocean. What could account for this?
A. Red algae have accessory pigments that absorb wavelengths of light available at these
depths
B. Red algae use infrared energy to power photosynthesis
C. Red algae have a more efficient light-absorbing system for red and blue light
D. Red algae are heterotroph organisms
E. The red algae must be identified incorrectly
A. 27. Sections are cut from a willow branch and planted in pots of soil in a greenhouse with
the shoot end of the section exposed and the root end in the soil. Roots sprout from the root
end and shoots sprout from the shoot end. Which statement about the sections is true?
A. The sections lacks the property of polarity
B. The concentration of auxin in the sections is the same in all their length
C. The root end will produce shoots
D. Dedifferentiation will be the first step in the process of root and shoot formation
12
E. The root end has special structures forming roots which the shoot ends lack
A 28. Plants have developed many adaptations to maximize the benefits of available water.
Which of the following is one of these adaptations?
A. Reorientation of leaves in order to increase leaf temperature
B. Decreasing the amount of water lost for each gram of fixed carbon
C. Increasing the leaf surface area
D. Decreasing the thickness of the cuticle
E. Growing more leaves during drought
A 29. You need pears for a large party after three days but they are not ripe enough to use.
What is the best way to hasten the ripening process?
A. To place the pears in the dark
B. To place the pears in a refrigerator
C. To place the pears on the windowsill
D. To place the pears in brown paper bags together with ripe apples
13
A 31. Which of the following are characteristics for animals with an open circulatory system?
A. Haemoglobin, haemocoel, lymph
B. Haemocyanin, haemocoel, haemolymph
C. Haemoglobin, absence of haemocoel, haemolymph
D. Haemocyanin, absence of haemocoel, lymph
E. Haemocyanin, haemocoel, lymph
14
A 32. Which metabolic changes in the cytoplasm of skeletal muscle cells are characteristic of
skeletal muscle fatigue?
1. Increase of creatine phosphate concentration
2. Decrease in the amount of glycogen
3. Increase of H+ - ion concentration
4. Increase of ATP concentration
5. Decrease in lactate concentration
A. 1 and 2
B. 1 and 4
C. 2 and 3
D. 4 and 5
E. 3 and 4
A 33. Which of the following is characteristic for a physically trained person in comparison
with an untrained person?
A. The heart rate can reach a higher level
B. Stroke volume is greater
C. The activity of vagus nerve (nervus vagus) is lower
D. Mechanical resistance of blood vessels is higher
E. Left ventricular and diastolic volume is smaller
15
A 34. Which statements regarding the differences of a compound eye compared with a
vertebrates eye is not correct?
1. Has chromatic aberration
2. The absorption of ultra-violet radiation is lesser
3. Acuity of vision (visus) is lesser
4. The ability to detect movement is lesser
5. The visual field is wider
A. 1 and 5
B. 2 and 3
C. 1 and 4
D. 4 and 5
E. 2 and 5
A 35. Which statement concerning a laboratory animal (white mouse) that lacks a thymus
gland congenitally is true?
A. Cellular immunity does not develop and the antibody synthesis is impaired
B. Only humoral immunity does not develop
C. Only cellular immunity does not develop
D. The immune system is not affected
E. This animal is resistant to viral infections but sensitive to bacterial infections
16
A 36. The numbers in the first column correspond to human, elephant, bat, mouse and carp.
Which number indicates each organism?
Body temperature
Heart rate
Maximal speed of
(C)
(beats/min)
locomotion
Number
(m/s)
1
1-30
30-40
1.5
38
450-550
3.5
31
500-660
14
36.2
22-28
11
36.6
60-90
10
A.
Human
Elephant
Bat
Mouse
Carp
B.
Mouse
Bat
Elephant
Human
Carp
C.
Carp
Mouse
Bat
Elephant
Human
D.
Carp
Mouse
Elephant
Bat
Human
E.
Bat
Mouse
Carp
Human
Elephant
17
18
A 38. Which figure shows the correct blood flow direction in a human?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
19
A 39. Which of the figures shows the correct relations between basal metabolic rate per m2
body surface area and age (in years) of human male and females?
A
20
A 40. The Figure shows cutaneous respiration among different vertebrates: excretion of
carbon dioxide (solid bars) and uptake of oxygen (open bars). Which of the version about
cutaneous respiration is true?
Bullfrog (larva)
Bullfrog (adult)
Lungless salamander
Human
Rana catesbeiana
Rana catesbeiana
Ensatina eschscholtzii
Homo sapiens
A.
I
Bullfrog (larva)
II
Bullfrog (adult)
III
Lungless salamander
IV
Human
B.
Human
Bullfrog (adult)
Bullfrog (larva)
Lungless salamander
C.
Lungless
Bullfrog (larva)
Bullfrog (adult)
Human
salamander
D.
Bullfrog (adult)
Bullfrog (larva)
Lungless salamander
Human
E.
Bullfrog (adult)
Human
Bullfrog (larva)
Lungless salamander
21
Ethology
A 41. Fixed action patterns (FAPs) are important components of behaviour. Which statement
about the fixed action patterns is not true?
A. They are highly stereotypical, instinctive behaviours
B. FAPs are triggered by sign stimuli in the environment, and once begun, are continued to
completion
C. A supernormal stimulus often produces a stronger response
D. FAPs diminish the adaptive significance of behaviour
E. FAPs are often released by one or two simple cues associated with the relevant object in
an organism
A 42. Which feature correctly describes the return of salmon to their native stream to spawn?
A. Insight
B. Olfactory imprinting
C. Habituation
D. Classic conditioning
E. Positive taxis
A 43. Why did psychologists fail in teaching chimpanzees to talk like humans?
A. Chimpanzees have a different location and structure of larynx
B. They have weakly developed cerebrum
C. They have thin tongue
D. They have too large teeth
E. They have bad memory
22
intruder birds?
A. They are more aggressive and better fighters
B. They have more to gain from a fight and so they are prepared to fight harder. The higher
benefit associated with territory, the harder they fight for it
C. Ownership is simply a conventional settlement
D. Owners always have a larger body size
E.
23
A 46. Mouse hair colour is determined by two unlinked loci C and B. Mice with genotype
CC or Cc are agouti, and with genotype cc-albino because pigment production in hair is
blocked. At the second locus, the B allele is dominant to the b, and the B allele determines
black agouti coat colour, but b - brown agouti coat colour.
A mouse with a black agouti coat is mated with an albino mouse of genotype bbcc. Half of
the offspring were albino, one quarter - black agouti, and one quarter were brown agouti.
What was the genotype of the black parent?
A. BBCC
B. BbCc
C. BbCC
D. Bbcc
E. BBcc
24
A 47. After graduation, you and 19 friends (sex ratio close 1:1) build a raft, sail to a deserted
island, and start a new population, totally isolated from the world. Two of your friends carry
(that is, are heterozygous for) the recessive c allele, which in homozygotes causes cystic
fibrosis.
What will be the incidence of cystic fibrosis on your island, if you assume that the frequency
of this allele does not change during the growth of population?
A. 0.05 %
B. 0.0025 %
C. 0.25 %
D. 0.5 %
E. 0.10 %
A 48. Suppose that allele b is sex-linked (located on X chromosome), recessive and lethal. It
kills the zygote or embryo. A man marries a woman who is heterozygous for this gene. What
would be the predicted sex ratio of the children of this couple if they have many children?
Girls
Boys
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
25
A 49. Two X-linked genetic defects have been studied by genealogical method (family
history): colour blindness and deficiency of certain enzyme in red blood cells. The pedigree
shows the results.
Normal female
1
Normal male
Colour-blind male
3
Enzyme-missing male
Male with both defects
Which individual (-s) show (-s) that crossing over has occurred?
A. 8 and 9
B. 1
C. 7 and 8
D. 7 and 9
E. 5
26
A 51. Dihybrid crosses between tall, spherical seeded plants and short, dented-seeded plants
in the F1 generation produced only tall, spherical seeded plants. A testcross of F1 hybrids with
short, dented-seeded plants produced many more tall, spherical seeded plants and short,
dented-seeded plants than tall, dented-seeded and short spherical seeded plants. Which is the
right conclusion?
A. Genes for tallness and seed shape are located in different chromosomes
B. Genes for tallness and seed shape are located in the same chromosome, and are
completely linked
C. Genes for tallness and seed shape show incomplete linkage
D. Traits for tall, dented-seeded plants are dominant
E. Traits for short, spherical seeded plants are recessive
27
A 52. Which part in the given DNA sequence corresponds to the translating sequence of this
gene?
Promoter
-10
0
5`- TATCTTATGTTCTCAATCTTGAGGAGGAGGTACGCTATGAAGTCTCACGAATGGCTTAATAGTAG-3`
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
ATGTTCTCAATCTTGAGGAGGAGGTACGCTATGAAGTCTCACGAATGGCTTAATAGTAG
ATGAAGTCTCACGAATGGCTTAATAGTAG
ATGGCTTAATAGTAG
TATCTTATGTTCTCAATCTTGAGGAGGAGGTA
TATCTTATGTTCTCAATCTTGAGGAGGAGGTACGCTATG
28
A 54. In crossing true-bred yellow and grey fruit flies Drosophila, the following results were
obtained:
Parents
Progeny
All grey
A 55.
In the figure, each column represents a hypothetical haplotype for four RFLP
(restriction fragment length polymorphism) loci, each with two alleles (indicated by 1
or 2), and the disease locus, where n indicates normal allele and m the mutant allele for a Xlinked locus.
Son
Mother
Grandfather
Grandmother
Presence or absence of the mutant allele can be detected by some direct molecular assay. The
data that the mutation is present in the mother but absent in both her parents does not tell us
which of the parents was the source of the mutant gamete. The problem is solved by
haplotype analysis using closely linked polymorphic loci. Where did the mutation, received
by the son occur?
A. In mothers germ cells
B. In grandmothers germ cells
C. In grandfathers germ cells
D. In both grandfathers and grandmothers germ cells
E. There is insufficient information to solve this problem
30
Ecology
A 56. Which statement (-s) is (are) correct?
1. Food chains usually have at least 7 levels
2. Food chains are limited in length by energy losses, for example in
respiration
3. Most of the world terrestrial above-ground production is utilized directly
by detritivores
4. Gross energy production is the remaining assimilated energy after
respiration
A. 2, 3 and 4
B. Only 2
C. Only 1
D. 1 and 3
E.
2 and 3
Some autotrophic bacteria obtain energy oxidizing NH4+ to NO2- or NO2- to NO3-
2.
3.
4.
5.
3, 4 and 5
B.
2, 3, 4 and 5
C.
1, 4 and 5
D.
1, 3, 4 and 5
E.
Only 4 un 5
32
33
2.
3.
In climax forests, most of the under storey species will have high
competitive ability.
5.
species
A.
1, 2 and 4
B.
Only 1, 3 and 5
C.
1, 2, 3 and 5
D.
Only 1
E.
Only 3 and 5
34
A 61. Aphids are common prey for ladybird beetles. The figure shows the amount of time
spent feeding on a leaf by ladybird beetles. What does the figure indicate?
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
0
10
15
20
25
30
35
1. Ladybird beetles become confused when stationary prey is abundant, and have to spend a
longer time capturing an individual
2. The size of the ladybird population is dependent on the number of aphids available
3. Ladybirds do not waste energy searching for aphids when they are in short supply
4. Ladybird beetles have a better chance of spotting from afar a leaf with many aphids as
compared to a leaf with few aphids
5. Ladybird beetles spend more time on leaves where there are more aphids, because their
net energy gain is maximum due to fewer losses from searching
A. Only 1
B. Only 2
C. Only 3
D. 3 and 5
E. All the answers are correct.
35
A 62. Changes that occur in a forest developing on abandoned farmland are represented in the
graph below. What do the curves R, S and T indicate?
Curve R
Curve S
Curve T
A.
Net productivity
Respiration
Succession
B.
Gross productivity
Net productivity
Heterotrophy
C.
Gross productivity
Respiration
Total biomass
D.
Community respiration
Total biomass
Net productivity
E.
Respiration
Total biomass
Gross productivity
36
A 64. In a Latvian pond, a random sample of carp fish consisted of 120 individuals. All
individuals were permanently marked and released without injuring them. On the next day,
150 individuals were captured, of which 50 were marked. Assuming no change in the total
population size between the two days, what is the size of the population in the pond?
A. 3600
B. 6000
C. 170
D. 360
E. 50
37
A 65. Which of the figures below show density-dependent mortality that could play a role in
Number of deaths
number of deaths
population density
population density
mortaility rate
mortality rate
population density
population density
38
A 66. In an experiment to determine the proportion as a percent of cabbage leaf material eaten
by a caterpillar that was converted to biomass, it was observed that the caterpillar ate 2 cm2 of
leaf per day . In order to make an estimate of the conversion several measurements were done.
W. Average dry mass per cm2 of leaf similar to that eaten
X. Total mass of caterpillar faeces per day
Y. Dry mass of caterpillar faeces per day
Z. Mass of carbon dioxide produced per day
Which of the given equations for estimating B, the mass of cabbage leaf converted into
caterpillar biomass per day, is correct?
A.
B = 2W-Y-Z
B.
B = W-Y-Z
C.
B = (2W-Y-Z)/2W
D.
B = 2W-X-Z
E.
B = W-X-Z
39
Biosystematics
40
A 70. Which of the following is false about the life cycle of mosses?
A. Gametophytes arise from a protonema
B. External water is required for fertilization
C. Gametes are produced by meiosis
D. Antheridia and archegonium are produced by the gametophytes
E. Sperms have flagella
A 71. Many benthic marine invertebrates have free-living planktonic larvae. Which of the
following invertebrates all have planktonic larvae?
A. Nematoda, Echinodermata, Polychaeta, Turbellaria
B. Polychaeta, Turbellaria, Echinodermata, Corallium
C. Decapoda, Echinodermata, Corallium
D. Bivalvia, Turbellaria, Porifera, Nematoda
E. Cephalopoda, Gastropoda, Bivalvia, Echinodermata
41
A 73. A biology student made some comments after examining Turbellaria, tapeworm
(Taenia sp.) and trematoda (Fasciola hepatica). Which of his comments is not true?
A. Reduction in digestive system evolved in conjunction with passing to the parasitic life
style
B. With passing to the parasitic life style, the reproduction capacity has increased
C. The total disappearance of the digestive system in the parasitic species did not cause any
additional change in the body
D. The excretory systems of these animals basically resemble each other
E. The parasitic life style did not cause any change in the basic structural plan of the nervous
system
A 74. Parasites are adapted to the host and its life cycle. Which of the following statements
about parasitic species is correct?
A. Numerous Nematoda, Turbellaria and Cestoda are endoparasites in the intestine of fishes
B. Fleas, lice and most female mosquitoes are ectoparasites of warm-blooded animals
C. Cyclops are the intermediate hosts of Trematoda and Cestoda
D. The parasitic Nematoda and Turbellaria develop directly without an intermediate host
E. Trematodes and Turbellaria are endoparasites of cold-blooded animals
A75. Heterothermy is the ability to reduce body temperature during hibernation until it gets
close to the environmental temperature. Which of the following animal groups include
heterothermal organisms?
A. Rodentia, Chiroptera, Insectivora
B. Only Carnivora
C. Carnivora, Chiroptera
D. Penguins
E. All mammals living in burrows
42
Answer key
A1 A2 A3
A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 A18 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23
A
B
C
D
E
A
B
C
D
E
A25 A26 A27 A28 A29 A30 A31 A32 A33 A34 A35 A36
A
B
C
D
E
A
B
C
D
E
A47 A48 A49 A50 A51 A52 A53 A54 A55 A56 A57
A
B
C
D
E
A68
A
B
C
D
E
43
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Part B
Please read carefully all the instructions!
For questions with multiple correct answers, you will be penalised for additional incorrect
responses.
Only the calculators which were provided with the Olympiad materials are permitted.
Mark all the correct answers in the answer sheet! The jury will check only the answer
sheet!
Cell Biology
B 1. The dependence of the initial reaction rate on substrate concentration for 3 different
enzymes (X, Y and Z) is given in the table:
Substrate concentration
(arbitrary units)
0.92
0.91
0.032
1.67
1.67
0.176
2. 85
2.86
0.919
3.75
3.75
2.180
4.40
4.44
3.640
10
4.90
5.00
5.000
15
5.80
6.00
7.337
20
6.23
6.67
8.498
30
6.80
7.50
9.397
50
6.00
8.33
9.824
100
4.20
9.09
9.968
1. Plot the initial rates versus substrate concentrations on the answer sheet! (1 point)
2. Which enzyme (X, Y or Z) is a regulatory enzyme with a co-operative behaviour? (1 point)
3. Which of the enzymes (X, Y or Z) is inhibited by its own substrate? (1 point)
(2 points)
(1 point)
B 4. A species of fungus can dissimilate glucose and produce ATP in two ways.
Aerobically: C6H12O6 + 6O2 = 6 CO2 + 6 H2O,
Anaerobically: C6H12O6 = 2 C2H5OH + 2 CO2
This fungus is cultivated in a glucose-containing medium. Half of the total ATP production is
anaerobic.
1. What is the ratio between the rates of aerobic and anaerobic catabolism of glucose?
(Continuation see on the next page)
2. What is the expected oxygen consumption (moles per mole of consumed glucose)?
3. What is the expected CO2 evolution (moles per mole of consumed glucose)?
For calculations, assume that glucose is fermented via the usual Embden-Meyerhof-Parnas
glycolytic pathway, and that oxidative phosphorylation proceeds with maximum efficiency.
(3 points)
B 5. For the bacteria Bacillus subtilis, several auxotrophic mutants have been obtained which
need addition of aspartate, threonine or methionine to the growth medium.
Mutant
Amino acid
Metabolite,
needed for
accumulating in
by the mutant
growth
the medium
aspA
4. Aspartate
7. Fumarate
5. Methionine
3. Homoserine
metH
5. Methionine
1. Homocystein
thrC
6. Threonine
2. Homoserinephosphate
metA
1. Homocystein
thrB
2. Homoserinephosphate
6. Threonine
3. Homoserine
thrA
3. Homoserine
6. Threonine
4. Aspartate
2. Homoserinephosphate
5. Methionine
1. Homocystein
_________________________________________________________________________
(3 points)
B6. Before a lecture, an assistant noticed that comments on an important diagram are lost. He
found many of terms in a textbook, including some which were unrelated to this diagram.
1. Please help the assistant to locate the correct terms for this diagram and to place the
appropriate numeric labels in the table in the answer sheet.
Enzyme
ATP +
+ AMP + PP
UGU
UGU
5
6
7
UGU
10
8
UAU
11
AUG
CGC
GU
AUA ACA
CGU
CCC
UCA
12
13
14
13
Term
Number
Term
A-1
Amino acid
A-2
Growing polypeptide
B-1
Pentose
B-2
C-1
Fatty acid
C-2
D-1
D-2
Number
polymerase
E-1
tRNA
E-2
Nuclear pore
F-1
IgG
F-2
P site
G-1
Receptor
G-2
Centriole
H-1
Aminoacyl-tRNA
H-2
Large ribosomal
synthetase
subunit
I-1
Protein kinase
I-2
A-site
J-1
Glucokinase
J-2
Z-site
K-1
Aminoacyl-tRNA
K-2
Peptidyl-tRNA
L-1
Inductor
L-2
DNA polymerase
M-1 Operator
M-2
Spliceosome
N-1
N - end
N-2
Adenylate cyclase
O-1
C - end
O-2
Capsomer
P-1
5` - end
P-2
R-1
3` - end
R-2
Codon
S-1
Nucleotide
S-2
Initiation codon
T-1
Lysosome
T-2
Gene
U-1
U-2
Terminal transferase
polymerase
(Continuation see on the next page)
2. Which component of this diagram has (give the number) peptidyl transferase activity?
( 5 points)
B 7. The growth of bacteria is studied. For a period of exactly one duplication, the sample is
moved from an environment with a light nitrogen isotope (14N) to an environment with heavy
nitrogen isotope (15N). After this the sample is again transferred to the environment with light
nitrogen for a period of two duplications.
1. What is the composition of double-stranded DNA (in %) of light and heavy nitrogen
isotopes after the experiment?
A. Only light
B. In between
C. Only heavy
From these cells two types of mRNA {mRNA (A) and mRNA (B), respectively, expressed
from two different genes} were isolated. Both mRNAs were found to contain an identical
number of nucleotides. The nucleotide composition of each mRNA was estimated as (see the
table).
mRNA
A%
C%
G%
T%
U%
17
28
32
23
27
13
27
33
dsDNA
A%
C%
G%
T%
U%
A
B
3. What curve in the plot below represents the DNA melting profile of the coding part of
genes A and B, respectively?
100
80
60
40
20
0
30
50
70
90
110
% of melting
Temperature oC
Curve
5
(3 points)
B 8.
The pie charts show the relative amounts of types of membrane found in two types of cells.
Suggest, why liver cells (answer 1) possess significantly more smooth ER, while pancreatic
cells (answer 2) have more rough ER. Chose the correct statements (A to E) from the left
column and pair them with the appropriate numbers (1 to 5) from the right column.
Process
Structure
Number
D. Higher protein-secretory
B.
activity
E.
Hihger ATP-synthesizing
activity
(2 points)
8
The table shows the amount of suspension (ml) pushed in the glass tube due to CO2
accumulation at regular time intervals.
Time
40 C
100 C
200 C
350 C
550 C
0
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.2
1.0
1.9
3.1
4.0
0.4
1.3
2.2
3.3
NO RESULT
0.7
1.2
2.8
4.4
NO RESULT
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
(min.)
1
2
3
4
5
2C2H5OH + 2 CO2
(4 points)
Phellem
Phellogen
2
BARK
Sieve Tubes
Companion cells
3
Storage Parenchyma
4
Structures
A.
Periderm
B.
Primary phloem
C.
Phloem fibers
D.
Phelloblast
E.
Phelloderm
F.
Secondary phloem
G.
Tracheids
Number
( 2 points)
10
B 11. The figure shows a cross section of gymnosperm stem wood. Write in the table in the
answer sheet the appropriate numbers (each number can be used only once) of corresponding
plant structures.
Plant structure
Number
A.
Early wood
B.
Sieve tube
C.
Latewood
D.
Resin duct
E.
Companion cell
F.
Xylem parenchyma
2
(2 points)
11
B 12. The following features pertain to specific structures and processes in plants. Write the
number that corresponds to appropriate structure in the table in the answer sheet!
1.
2.
3.
4.
Plant structure
A.
Tracheids
B.
Epidermis
C.
Endodermis
D.
Resin duct
E.
Rays
F.
Leucoplast
G.
Etioplast
Number
(2 points)
B 14. The diurnal curve indicates the stomatal opening for a typical C3 plant.
12
Stomatal conductance is an indication of the capacity for diffusion through stomata and an
indirect measurement of stomatal opening. A stomatal conductance of zero indicates that
stomata are closed (i.e., there is no transpiration).
1. Indicate the times of day in the diagram and mark them on the answer sheet, using the
codes:.
1. Midnight
2. Noon
3. 6:00 a.m.
4. 6:00 p.m
A
B
C
D
Stomatal opening vs. closure is regulated through several internal and external factors.
(Continuation see on the next page)
13
2. Indicate and mark in the answer sheet, which of the following corresponds to the factors
depicted in the picture. Use the given code:
1. CO2
2. Light
3. Ca2+
4. Abscisic acid
5. K+
6. H2O
A and B
C
D
(4 points)
B 15. Plants require 16 essential elements - boron (1), calcium (2), carbon (3), chlorine (4),
copper (5), hydrogen (6), iron (7), magnesium (8), manganese (9), molybdenum (10), nitrogen
(11), oxygen (12), phosphorus (13), potassium (14), sulfur (15), zinc (16). The proportional
masses of various elements in plants are shown.
1. Indicate the numbers in the answer sheet, corresponding to each element in the table.
A, B, C
D
E
( 3 points)
14
Volume of fluids
Volume of fluids
absorbed in the
gastrointestinal tract
intestinal tract
or excreated during
during 24 hours.
24 hours.
...................................
...................................
Small intestine
fluids 2 000 ml
absorbs X ml
.................................
...................................
Colon absorbs
1 000 ml
...................................
Water excreation in
the faeces 100 ml
Saliva 1 500 ml
...................................
Gastric secretion
2 000 ml
....................................
Bile 500 ml
..................................
Pancreatic juice Z ml
Sum: Y ml
...................................
Intestinal secretion
1 500 ml
.........................
Sum: 9 000 ml
(1 point)
15
B 17. Lesions in various points in the visual pathway produce deficitsat the visual field. The
level of a lesion can be determined by the specific deficit in the visual field. In the diagram of
the cortex the numbers along the visual pathway indicate the sites of lesions. The deficits that
result from lesions are shown as black areas in the visual field maps on the right.
Choose the corresponding deficits that result from lesions at each site and write the numbers
of the lesion sites in table in the answer sheet!
A.
D.
E.
(3 points)
16
B 18. Please color the arrows in the answer sheet that indicate the direction of the water flow
through the cell membrane of an erythrocyte. Light circles in the figure show the water
molecules, dark circles show the molecules of the dissolved substances.
(1 point)
B 19. Please indicate the direction of the locomotion of protozoan (A) and (B) by arrows in
the boxes in the answer sheet. Arrows in the figure indicate the direction of wave caused by
ciliarys movement.
A.
B.
(1 point)
17
B 20. Please mark with crosses in the table in the answer sheet the locations where filtration,
reabsorbtion and secretion take place in the mammal nephron (more than one correct answer
per process possible)!
Process
1. Renal
2. Proximal
3. Henle
4. Distal
corpuscle
convoluted
loop
convolu-
tubule
ted tubule
A. Filtration
of fluid that is
isotonic to blood
B. Reabsorption
of water, Na+, K+,
glucose, amino
acids, Cl-, HCO-3,
urea
C. Reabsorption of
water, Na+, K+ and
ClD. Reabsorption
of water, Na+ and
ClE. Reabsorption
of water, Na+,
HCO-3 and urea
18
F. Secretion
of H+ and K+
G. Secretion
of H+, NH4+,
urea, and
creatinine
H. Secretion
of urea
(5 points)
19
B 22. Arrange in the answer sheet in the correct sequence the arrows (choose from 1-8) that
characterize the sequence of events in stimulation and contraction of muscle. The black
arrows indicate propagation of excitation (action potential) in the membranes; the white
arrows depolarization - induced Ca2+ propagation in the sarcoplasma.
Stimulation
88
(1 point)
20
Ethology
21
B 25. A blue jay actively hunts on different moths (Catocala ). The hindwings of the moths
are often strikingly coloured yellow, orange, red or other color, but the forewings of the
moths appear cryptic, looking very much like the bark of the trees on which the moths rest.
In other words moths on a cryptic background appears like background. The forewings
cover the hindwings, but when they are distrurbed, the hindwings are suddenly exposed.
On a uniform background the moths are easily seen.
The detection index estimates the ability to spot a moth.
(Continuation see on the next page)
Which statements regarding wing coloration are true? Mark them with crosses in the answer sheet.
A. The forewings are coloured to decrease detection of moths by a predator
22
B.
feature
C.
The hindwings colour may have a startle effect on a bird, causing the bird to stop
The forewings cryptic colour does not defend moths completely, because jays learn
F.
23
Ada`s
Grey body,
Black body,
Grey body,
Black body,
normal wings
curved wings
curved wings
normal wings
236
253
50
61
55
56
241
248
experiment
Donalds
experiment
1. What is the distance (in map units) between these two loci? Mark in the answer sheet.
2. What was the genotype of flies with a dominant phenotype in Ada`s (A.) and Donald`s
(B.) experiment? Give the genotypes and show the linkage phase of genes b and c in the
answer sheet!
A. (Adass flies)
B. (Donalds flies)
(3 points)
24
B 27. Several mutations (A, B, C, D) have been found in the coding sequence of a gene.
Codon 1
2
3
4
Wt
ATG TGC CCC CGA
A.
--- -C- --- --B.
--- --- --- A-C.
--- --- --- --D.
--- --- --- --* Deletion of 1 nucleotide
5
GTC
----A----
6
GAG
---------
7
GAC
---------
8
CTG
------*--
9
AGC
---------
10
CTG
---------
11
ACG
---------
12
AGC
---------
1. Please translate codons of variants of the given sequence (Wt, A, B, C, D) in one letter
codes of amino acids (use table of genetic codes) and place the answers in the table in the
answer sheet. Note: write ST instead of STOP
Codon
1
2
Wt
A.
B.
C.
D.
UCU
UCC
UCA
UCG
CCU
CCC
CCA
CCG
ACU
ACC
ACA
ACG
GCU
GCC
GCA
GCG
C
S
S
S
S
P
P
P
P
T
T
T
T
A
A
A
A
10
11
12
First base
UUU
UUC
UUA
UUG
CUU
CUC
CUA
CUG
AUU
AUC
AUA
AUG
GUU
GUC
GUA
GUG
U
F
F
L
L
L
L
L
L
I
I
I
M
V
V
V
V
(Phe)
(Phe)
(Leu)
(Leu)
(Leu)
(Leu)
(Leu)
(Leu)
(Ile)
(Ile)
(Ile)
(Met)
(Val)
(Val)
(Val)
(Val)
(Ser)
(Ser)
(Ser)
(Ser)
(Pro)
(Pro)
(Pro)
(Pro)
(Thr)
(Thr)
(Thr)
(Thr)
(Ala)
(Ala)
(Ala)
(Ala)
UAU
UAC
UAA
UAG
CAU
CAC
CAA
CAG
AAU
AAC
AAA
AAG
GAU
GAC
GAA
GAG
A
Y (Tyr)
Y (Tyr)
STOP
STOP
H (His)
H (His)
Q (Gln)
Q (Gln)
N (Asn)
N (Asn)
K (Lys)
K (Lys)
D (asp)
D (asp)
E (Glu)
E (Glu)
UGU
UGC
UGA
UGG
CGU
CGC
CGA
CGG
AGU
AGC
AGA
AGG
GGU
GGC
GGA
GGG
G
C (Cys)
C (Cys)
STOP
W (Trp)
R (Arg)
R (Arg)
R (Arg)
R (Arg)
S (Ser)
S (Ser)
R (Arg)
R (Arg)
G (Gly)
G (Gly)
G (Gly)
G (Gly)
U
C
A
G
U
C
A
G
U
C
A
G
U
C
A
G
Third base
Second base
2. Please arrange in the answer sheet the mutations (A-D) in an order, which shows their
influence on protein functions starting from the most deleterious mutation.
(4 points)
25
B 28. A river has two populations of snails; a large population just off the left bank (main
population), and a much smaller one downstream near an island (island population). Consider
a locus that has two alleles, G ang g, in the island population, but is fixed for the G allele in
the main population. Let p be the frequency of the G allele in the island population.
Because of river flow, migration occurs from the large population to the island, but not the
reverse. Assume p= 0.6 before migration. After migration 12% of the islands snails originated
from the main population.
1. Calculate p after the migration!
Following the wave of migration, the island snails reproduce. For some reason, the island
snails, including the new immigrants, have a much higher mutation rate than the main
population. The mutation rate of G g in the island population is 0.003, and there is
essentially no reverse mutation (mutation in the main population is rare, and can also be
ignored).
(2 points)
26
B 29. In a specific population, genotype frequencies have been estimated before and after
selection.
a1a1
a1a2
a2a2
0.25
0.50
0.25
0.35
0.48
0.17
Frequency before
selection
(generation F0)
Frequency after
selection
(generation F1)
1. Calculate the selection coefficient of each genotype (a1a1, a1a2, a2a2) and write the answer
in the answer sheet!
2. Against which genotype is selection the strongest? Write the answer in the answer sheet!
(2 points)
B 30. Expression of some autosomal genes depends on whether that gene came from male or
female parent. These are so called imprinted genes (imprinted genes are expressed in a parent
- specific manner). Imprinting of these genes happens during spermatogenesis or oogenesis,
and may silence the allele coming from one parent.
27
Problem 1. Imprinted genes can account for many cases of incomplete penetrance. The
pedigree shows the incomplete penetrance of an autosomal dominant gene resulting from
imprinting during oogenesis. A woman II1 is heterozygote for this gene. Analysis of DNA
reveals that III2 and III5 have received the mutant gene from their mother.
I
1
II
1
III
1
IV
1
1. What is the probability of II1 and II2 having an affected child? Mark the answer in the
answer sheet!
2. What is the probability of III1 and III2 having an affected child? Mark the answer in the
answer sheet!
3. What is the probability of III4 and III5 having an affected child? Mark the answer in the
answer sheet!
28
Determine which pedigree show maternal (1) and which paternal (2) imprinting (choose from
pedigrees A,B,C,D).
1. Maternal
2. Paternal
( 5 points)
29
B 31. The figures show modes of selection on (Y) a heritable quantitative (continuous) trait
and (Z) a polymorphism inherited as two alleles at one locus. In both cases, the phenotype
was assumed to be inherited additively (i.e. heterozygote intermediate between homozygotes,
there is no interaction among loci that contribute variation to the quantitative trait). The
vertical axis is the proportion of the population with each phenotype. The upper rows of
figures in both Y and Z show the distribution of phenotypes in one generation, before
selection occurs. The shaded portions represent individuals with relative disadvantage (lower
reproductive success). The lower rows of figures in both Y and Z show the distribution of
phenotypes in the following generation, after selection among the parents has occurred. X
marks the mean of the quantitative trait before selection.
(Continuation see on the next page)
30
A. Directional selection does not alter the means, but may reduce the variation
B. Disruptive or diversifying selection is unlikely to be exactly symmetrical, and thus
usually shifts the means
C. Directional selection increases the proportion of genotypes with higher values of
the trait
D. Stabilizing selection is unlikely to be exactly symmetrical, and thus usually shifts
the means
E. Stabilizing selection does not alter the means, but may reduce the variation
Match in the answer sheet the statements (A E) with appropriate schemes (1 - 3)
Not all the rows in the table have to be filled.
Statements
A
B
C
D
E
Number of schemes
(3 points)
31
B 32. Alkaptonuria is a rare genetic disease. The gene for alkaptonuria (alk) is recessive and
has been located on chromosome 9. Gene alk is linked to the gene I encoding the ABO blood
types. The distance between the alk gene and gene I is 11 map units. A pedigree of a family
with the alkaptonuria is shown below. Affected individuals are indicated by shaded symbols.
In addition, the blood type of family members is given.
AB
3
4 4
AB
1. What are the genotypes of individuals 3 and 4? Give the answer in the answer sheet
2. If individuals 3 and 4 are expecting their fifth child, what is the probability that the child
will have alkaptonuria (a physician has determined that foetus has blood type B)? Give the
answer in the answer sheet!
(2 points)
32
Ecology
B 33. The following table shows the commercial fishing catches of smelt and fishing intensity
in the Riga Gulf between 1982 and 1985. The fishing intensity during those years was
estimated by the total time spent by all fishing boats that were concentrated on this species.
The fishing equipment did not change in the investigated time-period.
Year
Catch (tons)
1982
1983
1984
1985
100
150
100
150
2
5
5
3
Estimate and write in the answer sheet the relative sizes of the smelt population, starting with
a relative size of 10 units for the year 1982.
1982 = 10
1983= ..
1984= ..
1985= ..
(3 points)
B 34. Figure 1 shows the number of phytoplankton cells, and P and N (inorganic)
concentrations in water samples in a transect along the coast of the Atlantic Ocean around a
fish processing factory.
The nitrogen concentrations in the water were very low and close to the detection limit. The
closest station to the factory was Station 6. Figure 2 shows the results of a nutrient
enrichment study. Water samples taken at the Stations were filtered to remove phytoplankton.
(Continuation see on the next page)
33
Then standard amounts of phytoplankton were added to the samples, and then they were
enriched with only N, only P, or were unenriched, and the number of phytoplankton cells in
these enriched or unenriched samples were counted at a later time.
Figure 1
8
7
Phytoplankton
(mill. Cells/ml)
5
P (g/l)
4
3
N (g/l)
2
1
0
0
9 10 11
Station
30
25
20
N-enriched
15
P-enriched
Unenriched control
10
5
0
1
9 10
Station
Figure 2
1. Which is pollutant or pollutants that factory is emitting? Give the answer in the answer
sheet using the appropriate codes.
Codes: X. Phytoplankton
Z. Nitrogen
Y. Zooplankton
W. Phosphorus
S. Organic substances
34
B 35.
The diagram shows a 10m x 10m plot located in a forest with two main tree species: Species
X which is shaded grey, and Species Y which is shaded black. The plot is divided into a grid
with step 1m.
1. What are the percentage frequencies of Species X and Species Y using a quadrate size of 2
m x 2m?
2. What are the percentage frequencies of Species X and Species Y using a quadrate size of
5m x 5m. Write the correct answers in the answer sheet.
1. Quadrate of 2. Quadrate of
size 2m x 2m
A.
B.
size 5m x 5m
Species X
Species Y
( 4 points)
35
B 36. The Baltic Sea is brackish, receiving salt water from the North Sea, and fresh water
from rivers. Turnover of water in deep layers is much slower than at surface layers.
Stratification of the water column is common in summer. The following figure shows a depth
profile (in July) for oxygen concentration (mg/l), hydrogen sulphide concentration (mg/l),
salinity (PSU) and temperature (C) in the water column.
Match in the table in the answer sheet the labels A, B, C, and D with oxygen concentration,
hydrogen sulphide concentration, salinity and temperature, and the labels E, F and G with
parts of the curves halocline, redoxycline and thermocline.
1
Oxygen concentration
Salinity
Temperature
Halocline
Redoxycline
Thermocline
(7 points)
36
Biosystematics
B 37. There are 4 flower diagrams shown:
Write the appropriate label (A-D) of a diagram in the table in the answer sheet.
Flower formulas
1
2
3
4
5
Label
B 38. The pictures below show a seed (1) or a fruit (2). Write the answers (1 or 2) in the table
in the answer sheet.
(2 points)
37
(2 points)
B 41. The systematic, morphological, biological and ecological characters of two invertebrate
species are presented. Write the appropriate number of an organism in the table in the answer
sheet!
A. Protist
B. Arthropod
No flagellum, no cilia
Incomplete metamorphosis
Intracellular parasite
Ectoparasite on mammals
..
...
Code: 1 Plasmodium
4 Trypanosoma
2 Dysentery amoeba
5 Tick
6 Flea
3 Paramaecium
7. Human louse
8 Spider
(2 points)
38
B 42. Most birds start to incubate when their clutch is full. There are species which start
incubation after the first egg is laid. Their chicks hatch asynchronously, which is
characteristic to birds of prey and owls (Falconiformes, Strigiformes).
Mark all the correct statements with crosses in the table in the answer sheet.
A.
Food resources for birds of prey, and therefore the number of chicks they
can feed, differ between years significantly
B.
Younger nestlings are fed more often and they catch up with older ones in
the progress of their growth
C.
Birds of prey feed as many chicks of the brood as the food resources
allow in the given year
D.
During years with scarce food resources, food is given mainly to the
oldest nestlings, while the youngest ones starve to death
E.
F.
Room in the nest is not sufficient for several big chicks simultaneously,
therefore they grow up and fly out of the nest one at a time
G.
One fledgling that can reach reproduction age is more important for
species survival then several but not well developed fledglings
H.
The number of fledglings and not their fitness is the most important for
the species survival
(2 points)
39
ANSWER KEY
B 1.
Z
1.
Y
2. Z (1 point)
3. X (1 point)
B 2.
1. A = 0.7 g g-1h-1
B 3.
100 mM [1 point]
B 4.
[1 point]
2. B = 1.4 g g-1h-1
[1 point]
B 5.
1. 7 4 3 1 5
2. 7 4
3. 7 4 3 6
[1p x 3 = 3 points]
40
B 6. 1.
A-1
B-1
C-1
D-1
E-1
F-1
G-1
H-1
I-1
J-1
K-1
L-1
M-1
N-1
O-1
P-1
Number
1
12
2 or 10
5
11
A-2
B-2
C-2
D-2
E-2
F-2
G-2
H-2
I-2
J-2
K-2
L-2
M-2
N-2
O-2
P-2
R-1
R-2
S-1
T-1
U-1
S-2
T-2
U-2
2. 17
Number
6
3. skipped
8
7
9
10
13 or 14 or
both
13
B.
25 %
C.
0%
[1 point]
2.
dsDNA
A
B
A%
20
30
C%
30
20
G%
30
20
T%
20
30
U%
0
0
3.
B 8: skipped
41
B 9.
1.
35C
20C
10C
55C
4C
[1 point]
B 10.
42
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
Number
1
4
2
3
G.
B 11.
A.
Number
3
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
4
1
2
B 12.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
Number
3
2.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
3
2
4
1
2.
A and B
C
D
B 15.
1.
A, B, C
D
E
5,6
2
4
3,6,12
2,8,11,13,14,
15
1,5,4,7,9,10,1
6
2.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
B 16.
1
X = 7900 ml
4
2
B 13.
1.
A.
B.
A
B
C
D
Y = 9000 ml
Z = 1500 ml
B 17.
A. 3
B. 4
C. 6
D. 2
E. 1
5
F.
B 14.
1.
43
B 18.
[0.5p
x2=
1
point]
B 19.
2. A. b + c / bc
B. b + c / bc+
[1p x 3 = 3 points]
B 27.
1.
A.
10
L
11
T
12
S
M C P
V E D L S
M C P R
E D L S
W
t
B.
[0.5p x 2 = 1 point]
B 20.
1.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
M C P R V E D L S
2.
3.
4. 5.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
H.
[5 points]
[1p per each column]
B 21: skipped
B 22.
1,4,6,8
[1 point]
B 23: skipped
B 24: skipped
B 25.
A.
skipped
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
[1p x 2 = 2 points]
[-1p per incorrect answer]
B. 26.
1. 18.5 units
P R V E D L S
M C P R V E D Stop
D
[S,R,I, Stop = 1 point]
2. DACB [2 points]
B 28.
1. p = 0.648
2. p = 0.646
[1p x 2 = 2 points]
B 29.
1. a1a1= 0
a1a2= 0.3
a2a2= 0.6
2. a2a2
[1p x 2 = 2 points]
[1p for part 1 and 1p for part 2]
B 30.
1. 0 %
2. 50 %
3. 0 %
44
1.
[1p x 4 = 4 points]
2.
B 36.
A D
..... .....
[1p x 5 = 5 points]
B 31.
A.
3
B.
1
C.
D.
2
E.
[1p x 3 = 3 points]
[-1p per incorrect answer]
B 32.
1. 3 = JB alk/JC alk
4 = JA alk /JC alk
2. 11 %
[0.5p x 2 = 1 point] +
[1p x 1 = 1 point] = 2 points
C
1
D
2
B
3
A
4
F
5
G
6
E
7
[1p X 7 = 7 points]
B 37.
A
1
2
B
3
D
4
C
5
[0.5p x 4 = 2.0 points]
B 38.
A 2
B 1
C 1
D 2
B 33.
1983 = 6
1984 = 4
B 41.
A.
B.
2
7
[1p x 2 = 2 points]
1985 = 10
[1p x 3 = 3 points]
B 34.
1. .Z, W or Z, W, S
2. A. Z; B (skipped)
[1p x 2 = 2 points]
B 35.
A.
B.
1.
100
16
2.
100
100
B 42.
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
H
[0.5p x 4 = 2.0 points]
[ - 0.5p per incorrect answer]
45
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Code number:
Laboratory I
Animal Systematics and Morphology
Length of the practical test 60 minutes; 40 points
Tools and Equipments
Microscope, microscopic slides, cover slips, preparation needle, forceps, 10 Petri Dishes,
labelled A to J, permanent marker. There are specimens of one species in each vial.
Introduction
Scientists have investigated the fauna of a freshwater lake. Samples of benthos, plankton and
surface dwelling animals were taken to characterise the fauna of aquatic animals and
relationships among them. The samples were sorted, then preserved in formaldehyde and
finally transferred to a 70% solution of ethyl alcohol, or stored alive.
Tasks
Q. 1. Fill in the answer code of the phylum for the specimens in each vial in the answer sheet.
The jury will check only the answers in the answer sheet!
Answer codes:
01 Arthropoda
02 Annelida
03 Porifera
Vial
(5 points)
04 Platyhelminthes
05 Mollusca
Phylum
Code number:
Q. 2. Fill in the answer code of the taxonomic units for specimens in each vial in the answer
sheet.
Answer codes:
01 Crustacea
02 Diptera
03 Heteroptera
04 Hirudinea
05 Turbellaria
06 Odonata
07 Coleoptera
08 Lamellibranchiata
09 Euspongia
(5 points)
Vial
Taxon
Q. 3. Mark with crosses in the table in the answer sheet the observed characters for the
species for specimens in each vial.
Characteristic
Vials
A
Code number:
glycerine. You will get 1 point for choosing the correct specimen and 1 point for a wellprepared slide.
Please raise your hand when you have prepared both slides!
Slide I
Specimen with clearly visible head capsule, spiracles for breathing of atmospheric air and
swimming bristles on the body.
Slide II
Specimen with antenna and antennula, laterally flattened body and compound eyes,
planktonic.
(4 points)
Q. 4B. Select the common characteristic for both animals and write the answer code in the
space provided .
Answer codes:
01 Free swimming
02 Attached to plants
03 Benthic
(1 point)
Q. 5. Fill in the answer sheet with the appropriate code of gas exchange for the specimens in
each vial.
Answer codes:
01 Spiracles and tracheae
Vial
02 Surface of body
Codes
(5 points)
Q. 6. Based on each pair of characteristics provided, complete the diagrammatic dichotomous
key in the answer list by filling in the letters of specimens (A-J) in the appropriate empty
spaces in the boxes.
3
Code number:
(10 points)
Answer codes:
01 Legs present
02 No legs
13 Body segmented
03 Six legs
06 Benthic animal
17 Body naked
07 Adult, no gills
01
04
03
07
02
11
08
12
13
14
09
16
15
10
05
17
18
06
Code number:
LABORATORY II
PLANT SYSTEMATICS, ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY
Length of the practical test - 60 minutes; 40 points
In the laboratory you must solve 3 tasks
Task 1 Plant Systematics
Task 2 Plant Anatomy
Task 3 Plant Physiology
Code Table
A. Apiaceae
E. Fabaceae
H. Poaceae
B. Asteraceae
F. Geraniaceae
I. Ranunculaceae
C. Brassicaceae
G. Lamiaceae
J. Rosaceae
D. Araceae
By morphological characteristics, determine the respective families (from those given in the
code table), for the samples (1-8)!
(continued on next page)
Code number:
Q1. Identify each sample in the dichotomous identification key below. Enter the sample number in the provided
windows in the answer sheet.
(8 points)
Write the family codes (A-J) in the windows provided beside the appropriate sample numbers
(8 points)
Identification key
Thesis
Nr.
Sample
Family
Nr.
code
(A-J)
(1-8)
1.
2.
Inflorescence spike
3.
Inflorescence head
4.
Flowers actinomorphic 5.
Flowers zygomorphic 7.
Tesis
Nr.
5.
6.
7.
Code number:
Sample
Family
Nr.
code
Code number:
Cut the pith of black elderberry (Sambucus nigra) lengthwise in half with a razor blade. Holding with fingers,
secure sample No. 9 lengthwise between the halves (Figure 1. A-D). The black elderberry pith is used only for
fixing. Holding the black elderberry pith in one hand and the razor blade in the other, prepare freehand crosssections of sample No. 9 (Figure1E) and place them in the water in the Petri Dish! Choose the three best crosssections (without the black elderberry pith) and place them on the microscope slide. Add a drop of Astra blue
(stains cellulose) and safranin (stains lignin) mixture. After 0.5 minutes, remove the stain with the filterpaper,
and add a drop of distilled water, and remove them with the filter paper. Twice repeat rinsing with water. Add a
drop of water and place the coverslip over the cross-sections.
The quality of the cross-section and the preparation will be assessed!
Code number:
Q2A. When the preparation is ready, using the low power x10 objective, find the best
cros-section. Raise the card showing 2A, and the assistant of the laboratory task will
assess the quality of the cross-section and preparation, and write the assessment points
in the answer sheet!
(2 points)
Q2B. Using the microscope (objective x10 and x40), study the preparations. Compare the cross-section seen
under the microscope with that in Figure 2. and with its parts [A (Figure 3), B (Figure 4), C (Figure 5), D
(Figure 6)].
Code number:
PART B
F.
G.
H.
B.
Figure 5. Sample No. 9 cross-section part C
K.
L.
M.
C.
N.
O.
D.
(continued on next page)
10
Code number:
Code Table
No.
Part
No.
Part
1.
Pericycle
13.
Phloem
15.
Palisade parenchyma
4.
Hypodermis
16.
Spongy parenchyma
5.
Casparian strip
17.
Guard cell
6.
Endodermis
18.
Sclerenchyma sheath
7.
8.
Trichome
20.
Angular collenchyma
9.
Epidermis
21.
22.
Lobed parenchyma
11.
Resin duct
23.
Xylem
12.
Epithelial cells
24.
Pith
In the answer sheet beside the letters A-O of parts seen on Figures 3-6, write the codes of the correct names of
these parts!
(15 points)
Q2C. Choose the correct plant taxon observed, and enter an x beside the respective code in the answer sheet.
Code table:
A.
Bryophyta
B.
Equisetophyta
C.
Pinophyta
D.
Magnoliophyta
(1 point)
Q2D. Choose the correct ecological group of the plant observed, and enter an x beside the respective code in
the answer sheet.
Code table:
A.
hydrophyte
B.
hygrophyte
11
C.
mesophyte
D.
xerophyte
Code number:
(1 point)
12
Code number:
A characteristic stem modification (bulb) fragment from a representative of the Liliaceae is supplied. Separate
from the bulb fragment one outer fleshy scale leaf, using the instrument set!
Q3A. Determine on which side of the outer fleshy scale leaf can be found the lower
epidermis. Lift the card with sign 3A, the assistant of the laboratory task will arrive,
and you will show him the lower epidermis. His assessment will be entered in the answer
page!
(1 point)
Q3B. Make a preparation: using a razor blade, shave a thin (~5 x 5 mm) piece of the lower epidermis and place
it on the microscope slide. Add one drop of the 1 M Ca(NO 3)2 solution, place a coverslip over the section, and
begin observation of the process occurring immediately under the x10 objective. Raise the card 3B, and the
assistant of the laboratory task will arrive. His assessment of the preparation quality will be entered in the answer
page!
(1 point)
13
Code number:
Q3C. What is the name of the process seen under the microscope? In the answer sheet, enter an x beside the
code of the correct process.
Code table:
A.
Hemolysis
B.
Dissociation
C.
Association
D.
Plasmolysis
E.
Deplasmolysis
F.
Hemophosphorylation
(1 point)
Q3D. Which of the below concentrations of Ca(NO3)2 solution could also cause the process observed? Enter an
x beside the correct codes of the possible concentrations in the answer sheet.
Code table:
A.
5M
B.
3M
C.
2M
D.
0.2 M
E.
0. 1 M
( 3 points)
14
LABORATORY III
Code number:
number of the working place
MOLECULAR BIOLOGY
Length of the practical test - 60 minutes; 40 points
Task: Electrophoretic separation of plasmid pX DNA fragments in an agarose gel and construction of a restriction map of the pX plasmid.
The lab assistants will give 5 points for strict following the lab safety regulations and accurate sample loading:
A - wearing the lab gloves during laboratory experiment 1 point,
B - addressing the assistant before usage of the power supply and correct usage of UV transilluminator
1 point,
C - proper use of pipette 1 point,
D - loading the whole amount of the sample in the well - 1 point,
E - not damaging the gel 1 point.
Note: One power supply is used by 3 - 4 students, one UV transilluminator is used by 2 students!
Technical explanation
Theory
Electrophoresis is a widely used analytical method for separation of molecules by their charge, molecular
weight and size. Frequently electrophoretical separation is performed in gel media where molecules with similar
charges are separated according to their molecular weight and size. The substance, which forms the gel, has to be
dissolved in the buffer solution.
Code number:
sites where specific 4 6 nucleotide (base) pair (bp) sequences are found; e.g. enzyme called
HaeIII cuts the double stranded DNA at sequence (site) GGCC, but enzyme called EcoRI cuts
the double stranded DNA at sequence (site) GAATTC.
Plasmid DNA mapping is placing of the restriction enzyme cleavage sites relative to each
other on the circular scheme of the plasmid molecule. For this purpose we have to determine
the length of DNA fragments produced by cleavage of the plasmid with different restriction
enzymes. Plasmid molecules can be cut by one or by multiple restriction enzymes
simultaneously. DNA fragments produced at cutting migrate as compact bands, which can be
visualised in the gel by staining with specific dyes. The distance, which DNA fragment
migrates in the gel during electrophoresis (cm from the start point of the migration till the
front edge of the fragment band), is inversely correlated to the logarithm of the length of the
fragment as measured in bp. One of the most common gel substances for electrophoresis is
agarose. Pores of the agarose gel are large enough for separation of molecules with molecular
mass over 100 000 Da.
Equipment
Agarose gel electrophoresis tank
(4, Fig.1). contains two electrodes - cathode (5) and anode (6), respectively. Before
electrophoresis the gel is overlaid with buffer solution (7). Samples, which contain the
mixture of molecules to be analysed, are loaded in the wells (1), which are formed by special
comb during the preparation of the gel (2) on the gel support (3). Before connecting to the
power supply the electrophoresis tank is closed with a cover (8).
Code number:
1. By turning of adjustment ring (3) and controlling the volume monitor (2) set the
appropriate volume! In this experiment you need to handle two volumes 5 l and 10 l.
Correct setting of these volumes on the monitor is shown in Fig. 3.
0
5
0
5,0 l
1
0
0
10,0 l
3. Press the button (4,Fig.2) smoothly to the first stop and put the tip in liquid (sample),
(Fig.4,A).
4. Slowly release the button to aspirate the sample (Fig. 4 B).
5. Take the tip with the liquid to the target (other drop of liquid or well in the gel) and press
the button until collected liquid is completely out of the tip (Fig. 4 C).
Take off
the tip with
your fingers
6. Take out pipette from the liquid, release the button (Fig. 4 D) and displace
the used tip in the trash, labelled as:
You can make some trial pipetting attempts with one tip and buffer solution in the tank before starting to
handle DNA samples.
17
Code number:
2. Electrophoresis unit, filled with 0,5x TAE buffer (20 mM Tris-acetate, 0,5 mM EDTA,
pH=8,0).
3. 2x GLB - gel loading buffer, containing 0,05% bromophenol blue in 10% glycerol.
4. St - DNA size standard, premixed with loading buffer (more detailed explanation below)
5. B+C and B+D - 5 l of plasmid pX DNA each, cleaved with restriction enzymes
B + C ; B + D, respectively (detailed explanation see in Q2 below).
To DNA samples fluorescent DNA dye Vistra Green in dilution of 1:10 000 is already added.
For all cleavages DNA of plasmid pX is used. The length of plasmid pX is 4 360 bp.
Let the samples run for 20 min. Mind the time, otherwise you lose DNA fragments! Use this time to prepare the
answers to the questions below!
Code number:
A. negative
B. neutral
C. positive
D. Impossible to determine
Which of the mentioned components is the major determinant of the charge of DNA
molecules?
E. purines
F. pyrimidines
G. deoxyriboses
H. phosphate groups
I. hydrogen bonds between the both DNA strands
J. No one of the mentioned
(2 points)
19
Code number:
Fig. 6 Electrophoretic separation of plasmid pX
cleavage fragments.
Lanes are numbered under the gel, the wells are seen
in the upper part.
Lane 1 DNA fragment length standard
Lane 2 cleavage of plasmid pX with enzymes A + C
Lane 3 cleavage of plasmid pX with enzymes A + D
Lane 4 cleavage of plasmid pX with enzymes C + D
Lane 5 DNA fragment length standard
Q2B. Plot the distance migrated by the DNA fragment length standard bands marked with
Roman numerals in Fig.6 (cm) versus the length of DNA fragments (bp) as determined in
your answer Q2A in the coordinates Q2B in your answer list. Make the graph using the
plotted points
On the X-axis - distance from the well to the front (distant) edge of the band (cm); on the Y
axis length of the DNA fragments (bp).
(4 points)
Q2C. Using the graph constructed in paragraph Q2B determine the size (bp) of DNA
fragments presented in lanes 2, 3 and 4, Fig.6. Put the answers in the columns 2, 3 and 4 of
the table Q2C in the answer list, corresponding the gel lanes 2, 3 and 4, respectively. .
(Allowed accuracy 10% of exact value).
(6 points)
Q2D. In the sample A+C (Lane 2, Fig.6) after mixing with gel loading buffer DNA
concentration was 150 ng/l (nanograms per microliter), 10 l were loaded on the gel.
How much DNA (in ng) was loaded on the gel? Put the answers in the column 1 of the
table Q2D in the answer list.
How much DNA (in ng) is contained in each of the bands in the lane 2, Fig.6 (A+C)
(assuming that all the loaded DNA is distributed between the two bands)? Put the answers in
the column 2 (for the band of the largest DNA fragment) and column 3 (for the band of the
smallest DNA fragment) of the table Question 2D in the answer list. (Allowed accuracy
10%).
(6 points)
20
Code number:
Fig. 7
Experiment (second phase)
20 minutes after the beginning of electrophoresis the assistant will disconnect your
electrophoresis tank from the power supply. Do not hesitate to remind the time to the
lab assistant!
Thereafter:
1. Place the gel together with the gel support in a tray and take them to the UV
transilluminator, the number of which is indicated at your working place.
2. Pick up the protecting shield of the transilluminator.
3. Place the gel on the UV table.
4. Close the protecting shield and switch on UV light.
!
!
5. Observe the image of DNA bands and draw the pattern of bands in the frame given in the
answer list Q3. DNA bands in your picture must be positioned relative to the DNA size
standard precisely as in your gel
(4 points)
6. Switch off the UV light and leave the gel together with gel support at the transilluminator.
7. Clean the hands with paper towel and continue preparing your answers.
21
Code number:
22
Code number:
Laboratory IV
Dendroecology: Growth of aspen (Populus tremula) invading a clear cut (previously spruce) by
seed.
Other materials:
1.
A data sheet. The data sheet is identical to the answer sheet with tables, only with some of the columns
(Table 1) and rows (Table 2) filled in. THIS DATA SHOULD BE COPIED ONTO THE ANSWER
SHEETS. DO NOT WRITE ON THE DATA SHEETS.
2.
3.
4.
one ruler
5.
23
Code number:
Introduction
Aspen has invaded an open area created by a clear cut harvest of a spruce forest. Not all of the trees established
in the same year, but over a 8-year period. Now, 18 years after the start of development of the new forest stand,
the vertical and radial growth of aspen will be investigated by retrospective analysis. Tree rings can be used to
measure the tree stem diameter at different tree ages.
Q1. In the following photograph (Figure 1) of a cross-section of an aspen stem, identify the following, by writing
the respective one correct number from the Figure in the answer sheet!
Code Table
A.
bark
B.
pith
C.
latewood
D.
earlywood
E.
meristem
F.
annual ring
G.
branch
H.
vascular cambium
I.
phloem cells
J.
xylem cells
K.
cork cells
(11 points)
24
Code number:
25
Code number:
The growth of aspen stems in the area will be used to determine response to possible intraspecific competition. It
is assumed that the effect of competition increases with time, because tree density increases and the trees
increase in size.
Q2. For a tree species, not necessarily aspen, what are the possible effects of intraspecific competition for light
resources:
1. increased mortality rate over time,
2. decreased yearly growth increment in height of stems
3. increased variability among stems of yearly growth increment in height
4. decreased yearly growth increment in diameter of stems
5. increased variability among stems in yearly growth increment in diameter
6. accelerated yearly growth increment in height of stems in response to shading by neighbours
Which of the following is the correct combination of correct answers? Enter your choice in the answer sheet!
A. 1, 2, 4
B. 1, 3, 5
C.
1, 2, 4, 6
1, 2, 3, 4, 5
(1 point)
The purpose of this practical work is to determine whether radial and/or vertical growth of aspen is related to
time of invasion of aspen individuals. In other words, since the time of invasion can be determined by estimating
the age of stems, does the growth depend on the age of the individual?
26
Code number:
stem is labelled, and the height of these stems in metres is provided beside the appropriate tree ring code in
Table 1 of the data sheets. Copy the codes and the heights onto the answer sheets.
Count the number of tree rings of each segment, and enter this data in Table 1 of the
answer sheets!
(2 points)
NOTE: Since determination of the first few tree rings is difficult due to rot, the first five tree
rings developed have been determined under a dissecting microscope, and the position
marking the end of five years is marked on each stem. Therefore, you need only to count the
rings developed after this mark, and then add 5 years.
As none of the cut segments are perfectly round (the radial growth differs depending on compass direction),
the mean diameter will be estimated by calculation from the perimeter. Using the cloth tape provided,
measure the perimeter of each stem, and enter this data in Table 1 of the answer sheet!
(2 points)
Using the appropriate formula, use the perimeter measurements to calculate the mean diameter, and enter
this data in Table 1 of the answer sheet!
(1 point)
Using the ruler provided, measure the total width of the first five tree rings (from the centre to the mark on
the segment) and enter this data in Table 1 of the answer sheet!
(1 point)
Using the ruler provided, measure the last five tree rings (at the location of the maximum diameter (marked
by the line), and enter this data in Table 1 of the answer sheet!
(1 point)
G1. Using the graph paper supplied in the answer sheet, produce scatter plot for Graph 1. - Stem age (a) versus
height (h)
(2 points)
27
Code number:
G2. Using the graph paper supplied in the answer sheet, produce scatter plot for Graph 2. - Stem tree age (a)
versus diameter (d)
(2 points)
G3. Using the graph paper supplied in the answer sheet, produce scatter plot for Graph 3. - Stem age (a) versus
width of first produced five tree rings
(f5)
(2 points)
G4. Using the graph paper supplied in the answer sheet, produce scatter plot for Graph 4. - Stem age (a) versus
width of the last five produced tree rings (l5).
(2 points)
Remember to label the axes with the appropriate codes (a, d, h, f5, l5) and scales.
G5. As the graph of stem age versus height appears to indicate a linear relationship, calculate the linear
regression equation (best-fit line through the points) using the Tables provided (Table 1 and Table 2) and draw
the calculated best-fit line on the appropriate graph
(1 point)
NOTE: In the data sheet supplied, you have been given the correct values of the sum of squared ages
(Xi2) and the value of the sum of age times height (Xi*Yi). Therefore, you do not need to calculate these.
ENTER THESE FROM THE DATA SHEET ONTO THE ANSWER SHEET.
(8 points)
28
Code number:
Discussion
Q3. The Graphs that you have produced suggest that intraspecific competition has resulted in:
1. reduced height of shaded individuals
2. reduced diameter of shaded individuals
3. reduced stem structural support of shaded individuals
4. increased variability in height of individuals of the same age
5. Increased variability in diameter of individuals of the same age
1, 2, 3, 4, and 5
B.
1, 2 and 3
C.
2, 3 and 5
D.
2 and 4
E.
4 and 5
(1 point)
29
Code number:
Q4. Which of the following comments are suggested by the Graphs that you have produced?
1. The reduced growth of individuals invading the clear cut later suggests that aspen has a stress-tolerant growth
strategy.
2. The Graphs suggest a certain competitive ability, because late-coming stems are able to maintain the same
growth rate in height as the stems which arrived earlier, indicated by the linear relationship between age and
height.
3. In combination, the Graphs suggest that there will be potentially increased mortality of the individuals
invading the stand later.
4. The Graph 4 suggests that the growth strategy of aspen appears to be a ruderal strategy: rapid growth early in
succession, taking advantage of available resources
2, 3 and 4
D.
4
(1 point)
30
Code number:
1. The Graphs show that the effect of competition increases with time after clearcut.
2. Only the trees arriving on the site during the first few years (but not necessarily all of these individuals) have
been able to support a high radial growth rate during the last few years .
3. Differences in the amount of shading in the occupied patches may be a reason for the high variability in
Graph 3.
4. Graphs 3 and 4 probably reflect linear relationships that are hidden by high variability.
A. 1, 2 and 3
B. 4
C. 1, 2, 3, and 4
D. 1 and 3
E. 2 and 4
(1 point)
31
Code number:
Q6. Which of the following problems clearly need to be considered, as they can affect the results shown in the
Graphs?
1. The annual growth increment in tree ring width is related to the current stem diameter. For this reason,
calculation of the relative growth rate (RGR) would have less bias.
2. Differences in the growth of the different stems should also be assessed in relation to differences in
meteorological conditions during the years after the clear cut.
3. Biotic factors such as herbivory (insects, deer, moose which do occur in the area) and disease may have
caused death or damage to a particular age class of stems, biasing the results.
4. The sample size is too low for conclusive results.
32
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
A 2. During differentiation:
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 3. During meiosis:
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 5. The study of crossing over frequency between linked genes has been
used:
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 77 -
1.
2000.
700.
a practically illimited number.
A 9. Which cell type would probably provide the best opportunity to study
lysosomes?
A.
B.
C.
D.
muscle cell.
nerve cell.
phagocytic white blood cell.
leaf cell of a plant.
lipids.
polysaccharides.
proteins.
glucose.
A 11. A biologist ground up a piece of plant tissue and then centrifuged the
mixture. She obtained some organelles from the sediment in the test tube.
The organelles took up CO2 and gave off O2. The organelles were most
likely:
- 78 -
chloroplasts.
ribosomes.
nuclei.
mitochondria.
A 12. Which one of the following cell structures doesnt contain nucleic
acid:
A.
B.
C.
D.
mitochondria.
nucleus.
rough endoplasmic reticulum.
smooth endoplasmic reticulum.
A 13. Which is the correct series of histones forming the core of a nucleosome?
A.
B.
C.
D.
H1 , H3 and H4.
H2A , H2B ,H3 , H4.
H1 , H2A and H2B.
H1 , H2A , H2B and H4.
A 14. How does cyanide (CN-) cause the death of living things?
A.
B.
C.
D.
by stopping photosynthesis.
by breaking down protein molecules.
by stopping (-oxidation).
by stopping the electron flow through ETS enzymes.
- 79 -
only II.
only III.
only I and II.
I, II and III.
A 17. The oxygen atoms used to form H2O at the end of the oxidative
phosphorylation chain (also named: terminal oxidation), come from:
A.
B.
C.
D.
carbon dioxide.
glucose.
molecular oxygen.
pyruvate.
A 20. You eat a nice portion of Belgian fries (fried potatoes) with chicken
meat and a fresh salad. Which of the following molecules of this meal would
normally not be oxidized in aerobic respiration to generate ATP?
A.
B.
C.
D.
polysaccharides.
proteins.
nucleic acids.
lipids.
- 80 -
A 22. The substance that is the general biosynthetic precursor of sex hormones and hormones of the adrenal cortex is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
inositol.
lecithin.
phosphatidyl-choline.
cholesterol.
is made by a DNAse.
produces OKASAKI fragments.
occurs only in the lagging strands.
occurs in the nucleus.
A 25. Two bottles of liquid were labelled X and Y. The two bottles contained different 0,2 molar (hypotonic) solutions. Red blood cells in a drop
of blood were placed in each bottle. The cells in X swelled and some of
them burst while those en Y shrunk and became shrivelled. On the basis of
this information which of the following conclusions is most valid?
A.
B.
D.
A 26. The diagrams below refer to variation in the amount of DNA (y axis)
as a function of time (x axis) during cell division. (the units are arbitrary).
Which ones of these diagrams depict what happens during meiosis and
mitosis, respectively?
- 81 -
C.
A.
B.
C.
D.
1 and 2.
4 and 1.
3 and 4.
2 and 3.
A 27. The following short DNA sequence 5' AGGATGCTA 3' can be perfectly hybridized with:
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 29. In eucaryotic cells the sequence of organelles involved in the synthesis and secretion of a protein, is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 30. If you extract the DNA of the bacteriophage (X174, you will find that
its composition is 25 % A, 33 % T, 24 % G, and 18 % C. How would you
interpret these results?
- 82 -
C.
D.
A 31. DELETED
A 32. In the nucleus of a eukaryotic cell
A.
B.
C.
D.
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 83 -
A 34. The drug, AZT, is given to AIDS patients to slow down the progress of
the disease. The structure of the drug is given here. The drug is effective as
it:
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 84 -
A 36. Graph demonstrates the amount of evaporated water during the year
in two equally high trees growing in the same habitat in Belgium. To which
tree species belong the two given curves in the graph?
A.
B.
C.
D.
haploid.
diploid.
triploid.
polyploid.
A 38. DELETED
A 40. The changes (colour, texture and chemical composition) that take
place in the fruits when they ripen are due to:
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 85 -
A 39. DELETED
wind.
water.
insects.
birds.
seeds.
gametes.
asexual cells.
pollen grains.
A 45. Which of the following is not an essential mineral element for plants?
A.
B.
C.
D.
potassium.
magnesium.
calcium.
lead.
is performed by plants.
takes place in mitochondria.
is catalyzed by the enzyme nitrogenase.
is known as the nitrogen fixation process.
- 86 -
A 48. The diagram below shows a cut across a portion of a green non
woody stem with a vascular bundle. It may be reasonably concluded that:
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 87 -
A.
B.
C.
D.
the rate of photosynthesis of plant I is less than the rate of respiration for plant II.
the rate of respiration of plant I is less than the rate of respiration
for plant II.
the rate of photosynthesis of plant II is equal to the rate of respiration.
the high concentration of light intensity decreases cellular respiration of plant I.
- 88 -
A 53. Diatoms (Bacillariophyta) can reproduce asexually through the process of template formation of silica-plate boxes (epitheca - hypotheca). As
a result, most of the newly formed boxes will decrease in size and ultimately lead to unviable small cell sizes. This problem is avoided:
A.
B.
C.
D.
through the fact that during sexual reproduction the zygote will
increase in size before formation of new silica plates.
through conjugation (fusion of the content of two small cells into
one large cell).
through the fusion of two small silica plates into one larger silica
plate.
through the fusion of four small silica plates into one larger silica
plate.
A 54. Where does the embryo in flowering plants gets its energy from?
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 89 -
no particular group.
teleosts which possess a gas bladder.
fishes swimming near the surface of seas and lakes.
skates.
A.
B.
C.
D.
1.
2.
3.
10.
- 90 -
sweet.
acid.
hot.
bitter.
A 59. Erythrocytes of man with blood group A are mixed with blood plasma
of another man. No agglutination is observed. It can be concluded that the
blood group of the plasma donor is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
only B.
A or 0.
A or AB.
A, B or 0.
their structure is such that they link to the CNS dopamin recep
tors.
they are less efficiently metabolized by the organism, than the
neurotransmitter they mimic.
they contain an amino group, just as dopamine and adrenaline.
their affinity for dopamine receptors is superior to that of the natur
al neurotransmitter.
A 61. To elevate the level of circulating lactate dehydrogenase (an enzyme) in a rabbit, a scientist injects a solution of sodium lactate. One hour
later he measures the actual lactate dehydrogenase activity in the muscles.
Which physiological mechanism does he challenge in this experiment?
positive feed-back.
negative feed-back.
detoxification.
gene induction.
A 62. Essential oils from such aromatic plants as nutmeg contain large
amounts of aromatic hydrocarbons which, upon simple addition of an amino
- 91 -
A.
B.
C.
D.
oxydoreductases.
hydrolases.
transaminases.
kinases.
in the liver.
in the brain.
in the lung.
in the kidney.
A 63. In fish, inhibition of the ejection of the second polar body can be
achieved by the application of a physical shock (pressure, temperature) at
a precisely determined moment after fertilisation. The resulting embryos
have two sets of DNA from the mother, and one from the father, and thus
are triploid.
a). These individuals are sterile because,
A.
B.
C.
D.
cytoskeleton desorganisation.
the denaturing of some enzymatic systems.
plasmic membrane rigidification.
disintegration of the polar body inside the oocyte cytoplasm.
- 92 -
BAC.
B.
C.
D.
CBA.
ABC.
ACB.
W X Z.
W Y Z.
2W X carbon content of Z.
W + X Y.
Belgium, July 8 - 15, 2001
- 93 -
curve a.
curve b.
curve c.
curve d.
A 68. When a person suffers severe trauma, such as a broken leg, which
hormone mobilizes aminoacids, sugar and fats to be used in the long-term
stress response?
A.
B.
C.
D.
acetylcholine.
cortisol.
aldosterone.
adrenalin.
A 69. DELETED
A 70. Of the following anatomical structures, which one is homologous to
the wing of a bat?
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 94 -
- 95 -
Co-ordinators meeting
A 74. Why are mammals often polygamous, whereas birds are frequently
monogamous?
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 75. P. Marler has carried out many experiments to determine the role of
the genes (inheritance) and the environment (learning) in song acquisition
in males of the white-crowned sparrow Zonotrychia leucophrys. His results
are shown in the following illustration:
- 96 -
2.
3.
4.
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 97 -
A 77. Passerine birds may produce different types of sounds and alarm
calls. The songs of males birds differ between species. Basically, they have
two main functions : defending the territory and attracting/stimulating females to mate. Alarm calls are emitted when birds spot a dangerous predator flying over. Alarm calls when a hawk flies over stimulate other nearby
birds to take action to escape. Whereas the songs of male birds are different between species, alarm calls of several species sound similar i.e., they
share certain common acoustic properties. How do you explain this crossspecies similarity of alarm calls?
A.
B.
C.
D.
there is a convergent evolution of alarm calls because their acoustic properties make the call difficult to locate.
there is a convergent evolution of alarm calls because their acoustic properties allow the caller to locate precisely the predator flying over.
there is a convergent evolution of alarm calls with simple acoustic properties, because simple alarm calls are easily and rapidly
learned by young birds.
predators escape when hearing long calls, because such calls
are also emitted by their own predators.
A 78. DELETED
- 98 -
A 81. The fact that all seven of the garden pea traits studied by Mendel
obeyed the principle of independent assortment means that:
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 82. Given the parents AABBCc x AabbCc, with simple dominance and
independent assortment for each of the three characters. What proportion
of the progeny will be expected to phenotypically resemble the first parent?
1/4.
3/4.
1/8.
3/8.
A 83. Two true-breeding stocks of garden peas are crossed. One parent
had red, axial flowers, and the other had white, terminal flowers. In F1 all
individuals had red, axial flowers. If 1000 F2 offspring resulted from the
- 99 -
A.
B.
C.
D.
190.
65.
250.
550.
A 84. Three babies were recently mixed up in a hospital. After consideration of the data below, which of the following represents the correct baby/
parent series of combinations?
______________________________________________
Couple
I
II
III
Blood groups
A and A
A and B
B and O
______________________________________________
Baby
1
2
3
Blood groups
AB
______________________________________________
A.
B.
C.
D.
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 86. Genes A and B are linked 12 map units apart. A heterozygous individual, whose parents were Aabb and aaBB, would be expected to produce
gametes in the following frequencies:
A.
B.
C.
D.
44 % AB
6 % AB
12 % AB
6 % AB
6 % Ab
44 % Ab
38 % Ab
6 % Ab
- 100 -
6 % aB
44 % aB
38 % aB
44 % aB
44 % ab
6 % ab
12 % ab
44 % ab
A 88. Among the various mice dihybrid crosses indicated below, which one
will give the best chance to obtain in one litter a mouse with genotype AABb:
A.
B.
C.
D.
AaBb x AaBb.
AaBb x AABb.
AABB x aaBb.
AaBb x AaBB.
A 89. Two individuals are differing by one character. When crossed together all the offsprings belong to the parental phenotypes. Which of the
following ratios between the two observed phenotypes seem in accordance
with the hypothesis of a single gene difference (monogenic trait):
A.
B.
C.
D.
421/416.
862/281.
762/435.
1201/304.
A.
B.
C.
D.
0.
1/2.
2/3.
3/4.
- 101 -
4.
8.
2 x 23.
6.
A 93. Suppose you are able to observe under the microscope the total
number of meiosis occurring in one gonad of a given individual and to outnumber exactly the crossovers between two given loci for which that individual is dihybridic. If the frequency of these particular crossovers is 100%
(that is to say that every meiosis exhibits one crossing over between the
two loci you consider) you anticipate that the total percentage of recombinant gametes would be equal to:
A.
B.
C.
D.
100 %
50 %
25 %
12.5 %
A 94. The sequence of a variant of the human globin protein shows a difference at aminoacid number 40 and another difference at aminoacid number
60 as compared to the normal protein. The number of nucleotides between
the two point mutations in the DNA of the corresponding gene is necessarily:
A.
B.
C.
D.
a multiple of 3.
a multiple of 20.
at least 60.
at least 57.
A 95. A tomato plant that is heterozygous for a gene that makes stems
purple or green and also for a gene that makes foliage hairy or hairless is
test crossed to a green hairless plant and the 500 progeny are outnumbered as follows: 42 purple, hairy; 202 purple, hairless; 209 green, hairy;
47 green, hairless. The distance (in cM or m.u.: map units) between these
genes is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
17.8 cM.
35.6 cM.
8.9 cM.
89 cM.
- 102 -
A 99. During Paleozoic era, tree forms are especially dominant during:
A.
B.
C.
D.
Silurian.
Devonian.
Carboniferous.
Permian.
- 103 -
A 101. DELETED
A 102. Soil and cave animals share some common features: which of the
following is not correct?
A.
B.
C.
D.
a reduction of pigmentation.
a reduction of visual performances.
a reduction of all sensory organs.
an adaptation to constant abiotic conditions.
community.
ecosystem.
population.
species.
A 104. While local conditions such as heavy rainfall or the removal of plants
limits the amount of nitrogen, phosphorus, or calcium available to a particular ecosystem, the amount of carbon available to the system is seldom a
problem. The reason therefore is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
A 105. DELETED
A 106. DELETED
A 107. DELETED
- 104 -
1,3,4.
2,3,4.
3,4.
1,2,3,4.
A 110. Which of the following factors tends to be the most important factor
controlling primary productivity in the oceans?
A.
B.
C.
D.
solar radiation.
temperature.
dissolved oxygen.
nutrients.
A 112.The cultural eutrophication of lakes often reduces the oxygen content to a risky level. The main reason for this excessive oxygen reduction
is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 105 -
D.
reef corals get exogenous food by several different ways (cnidoblasts, contact digestion, angling with mucous filaments).
reef corals help their symbiotic algae by giving them amino
acids and glucose and receive from them glycerol and growth
vitamins.
reef corals of the euphotic zone have lost cnidoblasts and do not
need any longer because their zooxanthellae cover all their needs.
the carbon dioxide used for precipitating CaCO3 results from zooxanthellae.
- 106 -
hydrozoa.
porifera.
cephalochordata.
echinodermata.
A 115. DELETED
A 116. Indicate which of the following cavities has a coelomic origin:
A.
B.
C.
D.
pulmonary cavity.
bladder cavity.
peritoneal cavity.
uterine cavity.
A 117.
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
Odonata - Hymenoptera.
Coleoptera - Orthoptera.
Orthoptera - Homoptera.
Hemiptera - Coleoptera.
Lepidoptera - Mecoptera.
In which of the above insect orders do the anterior (front) and posterior
(rear) pairs of wing have different structures and are mouthparts of the
chewing type?
A.
B.
C.
D.
only II.
I and II.
only III.
IV and V.
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 107 -
A 120. To which family does a plant with the following characteristics belong: 5 basely connate sepals, 5 free petals, many stamens, and a superior
gynoecium consisting of 5 fused carpels?
A.
B.
C.
D.
Solanaceae.
Rosaceae.
Cactaceae.
Ranunculaceae.
A 121. DELETED
- 108 -
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
1. Telomerase.
2. DNA topoisomerase.
3. DNA polymerase.
4. DNA helicase.
5. DNA ligase.
this enzyme functions at the square marked I on the diagram.
this enzyme functions at the square marked II on the diagram.
this enzyme functions at the square marked III on the diagram.
B 2. [6 points] The two compartments (A and B) of a tank contain each one
liter of solution and are separated by a membrane whose permeability characters are to be identified.
One has placed in A: 300 g heparin (MW: 6000)
in B: 22.5 g formamide (MW: 45) and 5.8 g NaCl
(MW: 58).
At equilibrium, a small rise in liquid level is observed in compartment A.
Mark your answer by putting an X in the appopriate box.
0.05 molar.
0.5 molar.
2 molar.
5 molar.
- 109 -
- 110 -
-galactosidase gene
Repressor
Operator
Lactose
Lactose-permease
Repressor messenger RNA
Regulator gene
Promotors
9. Lactose-permease gene
10
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
- 111 -
What are the elements present in the cytoplasm of the bacteria growing on
a medium without lactose (put an X in the appopriate boxes).
Column B
A. leucoplasts
1. Krebs cycle
B. rough ER
C. genome
3. microtubule-organizing center
D. mitochondria
E. centriole
F. mesosome
6. starch storage
G. lysosome
7. immunoglobulin
H. microfilament
8. lipid synthesis
I.
9. digestive enzymes
smooth ER
selective medium
differential medium
both selective and differential medium
neither selective nor differential medium
- 112 -
- 113 -
A.
sieve tube.
B.
collenchyma.
C.
sclereid.
D.
xylem vessels.
E.
epidermis.
F.
palisade cell.
B 8 A drawing of a cross-section of a (dicot) root is presented and 4 questions (a, b, c and d) relate to this figure. In this drawing several tissues and
cell types have been marked (with a letter). A list of tissues and cell types
have been numbered (1-14).
a)[4 points] Match the number with the markings on the drawing.
- 114 -
2. xylem
4. phloem
6. mesophyl
8. pericycle
10. cambium
12. xylem parenchyma
14. pollen tube
b) [5 points] Nutrients are taken up from the soil or from nutrient solution
and translocated to the aerial parts of the plant.
- 115 -
which tissue (in the figure above) translocates the nutrients from
root to shoot? Mark the correct roman number in the box.
27 C
34 C
A
B
C
B 10. [1 point] Even when starving, snails still stay green for some time.
Only after longer periods of starving they take up a brown-yellowish color.
Scientists investigated the weight loss (wl) of starving snail. Which results
could they have observed comparing starving green (gr) with starving brownyellow (by) snails? Mark your answer with a X in the box.
wl(gr) = 0 ; wl(by) > 0
wl(gr) > 0 ; wl(by) = 0
wl(gr) > 0 ; wl(by) > 0
wl(by) > wl(by) > 0
- 116 -
1. roots
possess a cuticle
2. stems
3. leaves
- 117 -
Code
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Ranvier node.
nucleus.
dendrites
axon initial segment.
Schwann cell.
terminal button.
B 14. [1 point]
1.
most of the invertebrates neurons are not myelinated.
2.
myelin sheats wrap the full length of the axon except in its end
and in the Ranvier nodes.
3.
there are no ribosomes neither in the axons nor in the nerve
endings.
4.
some neurons of the nervous system dont have any axon.
From the list above,which is the correct combination of statements?
1, 2, 3
2, 4
1, 3, 4
all are correct.
- 118 -
1. yellow marrow
2. contains large
number of granules
cytokines
3. astrocyte
5. microglia cell
6. complement
7. B cell
8. antibody
macrophage in brain
9. chemicals
secreted by several types of cell in
immune system
10. T cell
11. peptides and
proteins
12. spleen or thymus
13. bone marrow
14. albumin
Belgium, July 8 - 15, 2001
- 119 -
II
Longitudinal muscles/circular
muscles
R/C
R/C
C/R
C/R
C/R
C/R
R/C
- 120 -
Physical P
Chemical C
Biological B
Skin
Interferon
Gastric acid
Mucociliary Blanket
Inflammation
Fever
Lysozyme
Phagocytosis
Bile
Urine
- 121 -
From the given information one can conclude that a normal rat has an
endogenous period of rythmicity of:
Put a X in the appropriate box.
less than 24 hours
exactly 24 hours
more than 24 hours
the period varies strongly
there is not enough information for a conclusion
- 122 -
12
13
17
21
Each cell line may carry an intact (numbered) chromosome (+), only its
long arm (q), only its short arm (p), or it may lack the chromosome (-).
The following human enzymes were tested for their presence (+) or absence (-) in cell lines A-H.
Identify the chromosome carrying each enzyme locus. Where possible, identify the chromosome arm.
- 123 -
Steroid sulphatase
Phosphoglucomutase-3
Esterase D
Phosphofructokinase
Amylase
Galactokinase
B 24. [2 points] A certain haploid fungus is normally red due to a carotenoid pigment. Mutants were obtained that were different colours due to
the presence of different pigments: orange (?-), pink (P-), white (W-), yellow
(Y-), and beige (?-). Each phenotype was inherited as if a single gene mutation governed it. To determine what these mutations signified, double mutants were constructed with all possible combinations, and the results were
as follows:
Mutations:
B
PWY-
Ppink
-
Wwhite
white
-
Yyellow
pink .
white
-
B
beige
pink .
white
yellow
- 124 -
Column B
1 translation termination
2 intercalating agent
C. auxotroph
D. ethidium bromide
4 chromosome aberration
E. nonsense mutation
F. missense mutation
6 nutritional mutant
G. inversion
7 base analog
H. transversion
8 allele
- 125 -
A. 5bromouracil
: unaffected female
: affected female
: unaffected male
: affected male
a) The probable mode of inheritance of this trait is:
X-linked dominant
autosomal recessive
X-linked recessive
autosomal dominant
b) What are the genotypes of the mother and father of V-3?
Aa and a/Y
AA and AA
aa and A/Y
Aa and Aa
c) If the individual V-2 marries a homozygous normal person, what is the
probability that their first child will be a carrier?
25 %
100 %
50 %
- 126 -
Directly after birth a baby of couple I must have been changed with a baby
of couple II. Indicate the numbers of the changed babies.
Answer: .. & ...
B 28. [1 point] A dominant gene , A, causes yellow coat colour in rats. The
dominant allele of another independant gene , R, produces black coat colour.
When the two dominants occur together, they interact to produce gray. When
the two recessives interact, they produce cream colour. A mating between
a gray male and a cream female produced a litter in which 3/8 of the offspring were yellow, 3/8 were gray, 1/8 were black and 1/8 were cream. If
the genotype of the female was aarr, what was the genotype of the male?
Belgium, July 8 - 15, 2001
AARR
AaRr
AaRR
AARr
Aarr
- 127 -
25 %
50 %
75 %
50 %
50 %
75 %
50 %
0%
50 %
75 %
25 %
0%
Ecology
B 30. [1 point] The growth of an animal population depends on the biological characteristics of the individuals within such as: life expectancy, fecundity (number of births given by a female during its life), the duration of the
reproductive period, the distribution of the fecundity along the female age,
the development time (the time between birth and thelaying of the first egg)
and the age at the first egg laying. Moreover, the age structure of the population (i.e. the distribution of the age according to the age pyramids will
influence the way these characteristics will be expressed.
Let us consider two populations A and B. Which one of these two populations will undergo the more rapid growth in relationships with the following
statements, all other elements being constant?
population A is mostly composed of young individuals whereas
population B is characterised by a stable age structure.
- 128 -
- 129 -
NO
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
- 130 -
Mortality
rate
Population density
Birth rate
Population density
Number
deaths
Population density
Net recruitment
Population density
Net recruitment
Population density
Population density
- 131 -
Archaeobacteria
Eucaryotes
RNA
Introns
Ribosomes
Mitochondria
Diploid stages
Chlorophyll-based
Photosynthesis
Methanogenesis
Nitrogen fixation
B 38. [5 points] Among the members of the Animal Kingdom, some have
body cavities, some do not. The following animals (1 - 9) possess different
types of body cavities.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Rotifers
Gastropods
Insects
Sponges
Nematodes
Corals
Oligochaetes
Planaria
Sea anemones
- 132 -
54
100
80
55
100
63
57
62
100
62
57
64
74
100
81
55
85
63
64
100
50
86
51
56
56
54
100
83
56
86
65
67
87
54
100
50
87
50
56
56
52
85
54
100
10
61
56
62
90
72
65
55
67
55
100
10
- 133 -
Group II:.........................
Group III:........................
- 134 -
Order
Number
dragonflies
Odonata
grasshoppers Orthoptera
lice
Anoplura
beetles
Coleoptera
flies
Diptera
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Complete the following statements by filling in the spaces, with the number
of the appropriate insect order.
similar in size non-foldable fore wings and hind wings with netlike
venation are characteristic for individuals of the order.
sclerotised fore wings and membranous hind wings with netlike
venation are characteristic for individuals of the order.
secondary reduced wings combined with protruding-sucking
mouth parts are characteristic for ectoparasitic individuals of the
order.
hard fore wings having a protection function and membranous
hind wings are characteristic for individuals of the order.
membranous fore wings and hind wings transformed into halters
having a function of stabilisation during flight are characteristic
for individuals of the order.
- 135 -
D
D
B
D
C
C
D
A
C
C
A
D
B
D
D
D
C
B
B
C
A
D
D
B
C
B
D
D
A
D
Deleted
D
C
B
D
C
A
Deleted
Deleted
C
A 041
A 042
A 043
A 044
A 045
A 046
A 047
A 048
A 049
A 050
A 051
A 052
A 053
A 054
A 055
A 056
A 057
A 058
A 059
A 060
A 061
A 062
A 063
A 064
A 065
A 066
A 067
A0 68
A 069
A 070
A 071
A 072
A 073
A 074
A 075
A 076
A 077
A 078
A 079
A 080
A
D
C
C
D
A
C
C
D
C
Deleted
C
A
D
B
C
A
D
C
C
D
D/D
A/A
D
B
B
D
B
Deleted
B
A
D
C
D
C
C
A
Deleted
D
A
-1 -
A 081
A 082
A 083
A 084
A 085
A 086
A 087
A 088
A 089
A 090
A 091
A 092
A 093
A 094
A 095
A 096
A 097
A 098
A 099
A 100
A 101
A 102
A 103
A 104
A 105
A 106
A 107
A 108
A 109
A 110
A 111
A 112
A 113
A 114
A 115
A 116
A 117
A 118
A 119
A 120
A 121
C
B
A
D
C
B
A
B
A
A
C
B
B
D
A
Deleted
B
A
C
A
Deleted
C
B
C
Deleted
Deleted
Deleted
Deleted
B
D
C
C
C
C
Deleted
C
A
D
C
B
Deleted
a
b
c
d
e
f
B03
B04
B05
B06
B07
B08
B09
B10
B11
B12
B13
B21
B22
B23
B24
B25
B26
1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,
12, 13, 16
6, 7, 5, 1, 3, 2, 9, 10, 8,
4
3, 2, 4, 1
UCGAUU
VI, I, IV, V, II, III
4, 12, 2, 10, 8, 9, 3, 11
III, VI, III
#
B, C, A
answer 4
3, 3, 2, 1, 2, 1, 1, 2,
2, 2
Deleted
upper: 2, 4, 1, 5
lower: 3, 6
All are correct
8, 9, 12, 2, 14, 10, 1,5
Deleted
R/C C/R
Plasma proteins
answer 3
G: fever
P: skin, mucociliary
C: interferon, gastric,
Lysozyme, bile, urine
B: inflammation,
phagocytosis
-2-
B27
B28
B29
B30
B31
B32
B33
B34
B35
B36
B37
B38
B39
B40
Deleted
answer 3
Xp, 6q, 13q, 21, 1p, 17q
a
b
a
b
c
answer 3
answer 1
7, 8, 6, 2, 1, 3, 4, 5
answer 3
answer 1
50%
2&5
answer 2
50 %, 0%, 50%
A, A, B, B
50, 50, 75, 25, 12,5
answer 1
Deleted
Deleted
Deleted
Yes: B, D, E
No: A, C, F
Line 1: X, X, X
Line 2: - , X, X
Line 3: X, X, X
Line 4: - , - , X
Line 5: - , - , X
Line 6: X, - , X
Line 7: - , X, Line 8: X, X, 2/3/7, 5, 8, 6/8/9, 4
Group I: 1/3/6/8
Group II: 10/4/5
Group III: 7/9/2
3, 5, 2, 1, 4
B14
B15
B16
B17
B18
B19
B20
a
b
a
b
3, 4, 2
0.05 molar
0.6 molar
answer 4
answer 4
answer 5
answer 3
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Practical test
- 60 -
The dissection case must be used in two laboratories. Its a gift. Take it
with you.
- 61 -
In this laboratory you will be given three separated tasks. It is of no importance with which you start. The time to perform all the tasks is 70 minutes.
Please be sure that the task paper given to you fits the task you are performing.
1. Make a cross section of sample A. Prepare a wet mount and use the
stains if necessary.
You have a set of reference slides (1-7) with cross sections of different
plant organs.
Examine your preparation under the microscope and compare with the reference slides. Identify the corresponding reference slide and fill in the correct number of that slide on the answer form in the blank 1A1.
(1,5 points)
You have a list of organ types. Select the correct number out of the list and
fill in the blank 1A2 on your task 1 answer form. (2 points)
You have a list of taxonomic group. Select the correct number out of the list
and fill in the blank 1 A3 on your task 1answer form. (2 points)
2. Make a cross section of sample B. Proceed as in 1 and fill in blanks on
your task 1answer form .
1B1 (1,5 points)
1B2 (2 points) 1B3 (2 points)
TASK 1. List of organ types
1. Primary root
2. Primary stem
3. Rhizome
- 62 -
Leaf petiole
Leaf rachis
Secondary root
Secondary stem
2. You have a list of taxonomic groups: select the appropriate group for the
species in Petri dishes A, B and C and fill in the corresponding number in
the blank code 215, 224, 233 (each 2 points) on the task 2 answer form.
- 63 -
1. Transfer the mixture of plant parts into a large petri dish. Select the parts
which belong to the same species (if necessary the binocular microscope
can be used) and transfer the items that belong together.
In petri dish A you have to collect 4 items.
In petri dish B you have to collect 3 items.
In petri dish C you have to collect 2 items.
You have a figure with several plant parts of different plant species belonging to several taxonomic groups. Select those figures, that corresponds
with the items in the petri dishes. Fill in the blanks in 211, 212 , 213 and 214
(each 2 points) for the items belonging to species 1, on the task 2 answer form.
Do the same for species 2 and 3. Fill in for petri dish A and petri dish B
221, 222 and 223 (each 2 points). FilI in for petri dish C 231, 232 (each 2
points) on the task 2 answer form .
Monocotyl
Dicotyl
Cycad
Conifer
Moss
Alga
Horsetail
Clubmoss
- 64 -
1. Ranunculaceae
2. Lamiaceae
3. Oleaceae
4. Fabaceae
5. Apiaceae
6. Asteraceae
7. Poaceae
8. Liliaceae
9. Fagaceae
10. Brassicaceae
- 65 -
- 66 -
- 67 -
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
- 68 -
1. Put the TLC plate in the tank and allow to develop in the dark
(cover the jar with aluminium foil). IMPORTANT: Use your free
time to solve the MC questions (task 2).
2. After approx. 20 minutes, take the plate out of the tank. In any case
take the plate out when the front line reaches 1 cm from the top of the
TLC plate.
- 69 -
- 70 -
H-atoms
N-atoms
C-atoms
O-atoms
4. Plant material often contains red pigments; their structure reveals that
they have no function in photosynthesis and are soluble in water. A perfect
location for these pigments in plant cells is:
A.
B.
C.
D.
Membranes of chloroplasts.
Membranes of mitochondria.
Lumen of vacuoles.
Cytosol of the cell.
- 71 -
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 72 -
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
Code number:
ANSWER LEAFLET N 2
(29 points)
(3 points)
(3 points)
(3 points)
(3 points)
(3 points)
(3 points)
- 73 -
Photosynthetic pigment n 4
name:.........................................
Rf -value:...................................
(3 points)
(3 points)
2. Path selection by ants: two video sequences are displayed. During the
first sequence, a bridge made of two unequal lengths connects the nest to
a food source. During the second sequence, the ants have access to the
food only by using the long path of the bridge during the first part of the
experiment. The ants, however, can use both the long and the short paths
in the second part of the experiment, which started after a heavy traffic was
first established on the long path during the first part of the experiment
(8 points).
A.
B.
C.
D.
3. Honeybee dance: in the video sequence, a bee loaded with pollen per-
- 74 -
4. Social interactions between cows: the video sequences illustrate dominance relationships between feeding cows in five experimental conditions.
Out of the following assertions, which one is correct (8 points)?
A.
B.
C.
D.
5. Maternal behavior in sheep. Three video sequences are shown: the first
illustrates the behavior of a mother and her lamb soon after parturition; the
second, a lamb is washed immediately after parturition before its mother
was able to care for it, after what it is given to its mother who had never
cared for lambs before; the third, the lamb was washed soon after parturition and then given to a foreign ewe who had experienced lamb care before (10 points).
A.
B.
C.
D.
A.
B.
C.
D.
- 75 -
Laboratory 4: Ethology
1.a; 2.c; 3.b; 4.c; 5.a; 6.d
- 76 -
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
4. 3. Theoretical Test
General remarks:
This test consists of two parts, A and B. In part A there are 103 multiple
choice questions, each having only one correct answer. In part B there are
46 questions, each of which may have more than one answer.
In order to eliminate the consequence of guessing in the marking of Type
A questions, one point will be deducted for every 5 incorrect answers.
Failing to answer a question will not result in any penalty.
In the marking of Type B questions a percentage of the total mark for that
question will be deducted for each incorrect answer. The minimum mark
for each question with deductions will be zero.
For the multiple choice questions (type A) mark the correct answer with a
cross X in the blank space provided. If you want to change your answer
with a new one in order to cancel it, you may draw a parallel line on your
old mark.
170
correct
delete
171
172
Basal bodies
III. Centrosome
IV. Flagellum
1- There is a 9+2 arrangement in a ring around a pair of single
microtubules
2- Most of these structures are longer than the cell
3- It is shorter than the cell
4- There are nine groups of three microtubules, fused into triplets
with an empty core
5- These are the main structures for movement
6- They function in the synthesis of spindle fibers
7- They bind cilia and flagella to the cell membrane
Which of the combinations below for structure and function are
correct?
___A) I: 1, 3, 5
II: 3, 4, 5
III: 3, 4, 6
IV: 1, 2, 3
___B) I:1, 4, 5
II: 1, 2, 7
III: 2, 3, 4
IV: 1, 3, 5
___C) I:1, 4, 7
II: 3, 4, 5
III: 2, 3, 6
IV: 2, 3, 4
___D) I:3, 4, 6
II: 2, 4, 7
III: 3, 4, 5
IV: 4, 5, 6
___E) I:2, 4, 6
II: 2, 4, 7
III: 3, 4, 5
IV: 2, 4, 5
___D) Phospholipids
___C) Wax
173
9. Which of the following are the fibers that attach to the the
cytoplasmic face of spot desmosomes?
___A) Collagen fibers
___B) Cytoskeleton fibers
___C) Elastic fibers
___D) Tubulin protein fibers
___E) Reticular fibers
10. Which of the following is the correct description of a microsome?
___A) It consists of vesicles detached from the Golgi apparatus
___B) It consists of vesicles containing waste products digested by the
lysosomes
___C) It consists of various amounts of ribosomes and fragmented
endoplasmic reticulum
___D) It is a vacuole that contains secretions
___E) It is a ribosome dimer
11. In aerobic respiration glucose is converted to pyruvate in the
___A) Inner mitochondrial membrane
___B) Cytoplasm
174
5. Introns
2. ATP synthesis
6. DNA polymerase
3. Cell membrane
7. Photosynthesis
4. Nuclear envelope
8. Mitochondria
___B) 1, 2, 3, 5, 7, 8
___D) 1, 3, 5, 6
___E) 2, 3, 7, 8
___C) 1, 2, 3, 4, 7
175
16. Agarose gel electrophoresis was applied to the DNA samples given
below. What will be the order of migration from the well, at the
completion of the electrophoresis?
I- F+ bacterial plasmid
II- F ' bacterial plasmid
III- Hfr E. coli chromosomal DNA
IV- E. coli chromosomal DNA
___A) I, II, III, IV
___B) II, III, I, IV
___D) III, IV, II, I
17. If you observe two DNA samples X and Y (each containing 1200
base pairs) migrating at different rates in an agarose gel, what
would your interpretation be ?
___A) The amount of adenines in sample X is greater
___B) The amount of guanines in sample Y is greater
___C) The percentage of agarose in the gel is greater than 0.8 %
___D) There are intercalating agents in the agarose gel
___E) Samples X and Y have different conformations
18. The enzyme phosphofructokinase;
I- It is the major regulatory enzyme in glycolysis
II- ATP is the substrate for the enzyme
III- ATP is the negative modulator of the enzyme
IV- Citrate activates the enzyme
Which of the following is the correct answer for the above statements
concerning the enzyme phosphofructokinase?
___A) Only IV is correct
176
177
22. Inside the choloplast the potential uses for the G3P
(glyceraldehyde 3-phosphate) produced in the Calvin cycle
include the synthesis of:
___A) Fatty acids
___B) Glycerol
___C) Glucose
___D) Amino acids
___E) All of the above
23. The following statements are about the effect of a competitive
inhibitor in a reaction catalyzed by an enzyme.
I- V max is unchanged
II-
III- Km increases
IV- The inhibitor binds to the enzyme at a different site than the
active site
Which combination of statement(s) is/are true?
___A) I, II and III
___D) Only IV
178
25. Consider these two relationships and the four statements about
the aminoacids/proteins and fatty acids/triglycerides
Left
Right
Left
Right
Amino acids:
Proteins
Fatty acids:
Triglycerides
I.
II.
___E) Only IV
179
180
Citrate synthase
Isocitrate
dehydrogenase
Low level of
ATP+NADH
Low level of
ATP+NADH
___B)
High level of
ATP+NADH
Low level of
ATP+NADH
___C)
High level of
ATP+NADH
Low level of
ATP+NADH
High level of
ATP+NADH
High level of
eitherADP or NAD+
andAMP
___E)
181
182
O f f s p r i n g s(F2)
___A)
3aaB-
3A-bb
1aabb
___B)
aabb X AAbb
9A-B-
3aaBb
3Aabb
1aabb
___C)
3aaBb
3Aabb
1aabb
___D)
aaBb X Aabb
9A-B-
3aaB-
3A-bb
1aabb
___E)
3aaB-
3Aabb
1aabb
___A)
0.3
0.2
0.5
___B)
0.2
0.5
0.3
___C)
0.2
0.3
0.5
___D)
0.5
0.2
0.3
___E)
0.3
0.5
0.2
37. Deleted
183
___C) Epistasis
39. Deleted
40. The fruit weights of a squash plant vary between 2 and 4 kg. The
fruit weights are a product of pairs of additive polygenic genes.
Which of the following is true for the F2 generation that resulted
from a 2 kg squash being pollinated with a 4 kg one in terms of
the number of individuals of any weight classes and also
regarding the genotypes of the pollinated 2 kg and 4 kg squashes.
4 kg
3.5 kg
3 kg
2.5 kg
2 kg
2 kg
parent
4 kg
parent
___A)
aabb
AABB
___B)
AaBb
aaBB
___C)
AAbb
aaBB
___D)
AABb
AABB
___E)
aabb
AABB
41. Which of the following is not a reason why recessive alleles are
not observed in the phenotypes of heterozygotes?
___A) The recessive allele codes for a nonfunctioning protein
___B) The recessive allele is linked to the dominant allele
___C) The dominant allele produces so much product as to swamp the
product of the recessive allele
___D) The recessive allele is normal, but the product of the dominant
allele inhibits the function of the recessive allele
___E) The alleles product (e.g.an enzyme) is much less functional and
therefore masked by the dominant alleles product
184
42.
3
Healthy : Empty
Carrier : Spotted
AA
XX
XY
XY
___B)
Aa
Aa
aa
___C)
aa
XX
XY
XY
___D)
aa
Aa
aa
___E)
Aa
AA
aa
___A)
185
42
Abcd
43
ABCd
140
abcD
145
aBcD
AbCd
ABcd
305
abCD
310
Which of the following shows the arrangement of the genes and their
distance (in centimorgans)?
186
Brown
White
Brown
White
White
___A)
Aabb
AaBb
Aabb
AaBb
aabb
___B)
AaBb
aabb
AaBb
aaBb
aabb
___C)
AaBb
aaBb
AaBb
Aabb
Aabb
___D)
AaBb
aabb
AaBb
aaBb
aabb
___E)
aaBb
AaBb
Aabb
aaBb
aabb
187
46. Deleted
47.
Phenotypes of the individuals
Genotypes
Female
Male
AA
Aa
aa
188
189
Crosses
Phenotype of
parents
Black
Silver
Creamy
Albino
black x black
22
black x albino
10
creamy x creamy
30
11
silver x creamy
23
11
12
190
Phenotype of offspring
51. Which of the following is not a proof that eukaryotic cells evolved
by endosymbiosis?
___A) Similarity between spirochetes and flagellum
___B) Similarity between mitochondrial DNA and procaryotic DNA
___C) Similarity between bacterial and chloroplastic ribosomes
___D) Similarity between chloroplast and cyanobacteria
___E) Similarity of the inhibition of the protein synthesis between the
eucaryotic cells and the mitochondria
52. Which of the following has the best evolutionary adaptation
capacity?
___A) Primitive, heterogenous heredity material, high number of
generation, short life span
___B) Highly specific, homogenous heredity material , high number of
generation, long life span
___C) Highly specific feeding regime, living underground, asexual
reproduction
___D) Living on high mountains, nocturnal, feeding on the most common
plants
___E) Highly tolerant to hereditary changes, low offspring success,
specific feeding regime
53. Which of the following is not a biological characteristic of desert
organisms?
___A) No regular reproductive cycle
___B) Seeds germinate immediately after flowering and fruiting
___C) Fewer stoma (in plant)
___D) Specialized kidney capable of reabsorbing water (in animal)
___E) More succulent plants
191
54. Deleted
55. Biologists assume that the first heredity material to appear was
RNA. Which of the following may be the main reason for that?
___A) RNA was produced in Millers experiment
___B) RNA is structurally more primitive than DNA
___C) The RNA called ribozyme catalyses some chemical reactions
___D) DNA can not stay stable in hydrophobic medium
___E) RNA appears in all animals
56. Which of the following is not evidence that higher plants are
derived from green algae?
___A) Some green algae have multicellular sporophyte and gametophyte
phases
___B) Both plants and algae have cellulose in their cell walls
___C) Both plants and algae have similar photosynthetic and accessory
pigments
___D) Both plants and algae synthesize starch as a main store product
___E) Green algae and higher plants have the same amount of DNA per
cell
57. The statements below are about various pollination strategies in
plants. Which one could be the most disadvantageous for
evolutionof new species?
___A) The stigma can recognize the origin of pollen grains, and does not
accept those from the same flower
___B) The stigma never emerges from the corolla, and only accepts
pollen grains from the same flower
___C) The corolla forms a long tube, only allowing some specialized
pollinators which carry pollen grains from the same species to
enter
___D) The stamens and pistil mature at different times
___E) The stamens and pistil are located in different flowers
192
58. Which of the following triplets is false for the hearing organ?
Structure
Animal
Function
___A)
Columella
Lizard
___B)
Weber bones
Fish
___C)
Tarsal bones
___D)
Some cranial
Whale
___E)
59. Deleted
193
II
III
___A) N
Ca
Mg
___B)
Mn
Mg
___C)
Mn
___D) Mn
Ca
Cl
___E)
194
Cl
63. When the temperature is high and the amount of dissolved oxygen
is higher than that of CO2 in the chloroplasts, in which of the
following plants does growth not slow down?
___A) Wheat
___B) Watermelon
___C) Sunflower
___D) Sugar cane
___E) Rice
64. Deleted
65. Deleted
66. Deleted
67. Deleted
68. Which of the following cannot be referred to as blue-light
responses in higher plants and fungi?
___A) Phototropism in Phycomyces
___B) Carotenoid biosynthesis in Neurospora
___C) Stomatal opening in higher plants
___D) Chloroplast rearrangements
___E) Flavenoid synthesis
195
196
0
-0.8
-1.6
4
6
Time (Days)
10
197
___B) Potassium-magnesium
___C) Phosphorus-nitrogen
___D) Calcium-magnesium
___E) Iodine-magnesium
72. Which of the following is not true for the auxin transport in
plants?
___A) IAA transport usually does not take place in sieve tubes and xylem
___B) IAA transport usually occurs in parenchymatic cells adjacent to
vascular bundles
___C) Auxin moves rather slowly within the plant
___D) IAA moves mainly from the apex to the base (basipetal direction)
___E) Auxin transport does not require energy
73. Light is perceived by all living organisms in one way or the other.
The pigment which is chosen for this process of photoperception
are carotenoids. Which of the following properties make
carotenoids the right pigment for this function.
___A) Their ability to absorb most of the visible and ultraviolet light
___B) Their high capacity to store and transfer light energy as chemical
energy
___C) As saturated organic compounds, their capability to preserve
themselves against environmental factors such as high energy
currents
___D) Their high affinity for proteins which have a role in perception
___E) The efficiency of long structures of alternating double bonds in
their structure to initiate light sensitive stereoisomerism
198
74. The changes that take place in climacteric fruits when they ripen
(colour, texture and chemical composition) are mainly due to:
___A) The CO2 content in the atmosphere
___B) The temperature variation
___C) The ethylene synthesis in the fruit
___D) The auxin concentration in the fruit
___E) Giberellin concentration in fruit
75. Deleted
76. The data were obtained relating to the rates of oxygen release and
uptake in plants. The plants were placed in the dark for 12 hours
followed by 12 hours in light. The temperature was constant
throughout the experiment. The results are shown in the graph.
199
200
___C) K4 C4A5G5
___E) *K4 [C4A5]G5
83. Which of the following is true for a C 4 plant in which some leaves
can carry out C3 photosynthesis while others can carry out C4
photosynthesis?
___A) In fact, it is a C3 plant
___B) The leaves which carry out C3 photosynthesis lack Kranz anatomy
___C) PEP (phosphoenolpyruvate) is not synthesized in the leaves which
carry out C4 photosynthesis
___D) It indicates that the C4 pathway was evolved from the C3 pathway
___E) Both C3 and C4 photosynthesis do not occur on the same leaf
84. Deleted
201
BIOSYSTEMATICS
85. Deleted
86.
I.
II.
II
III
Which of the following combinations are correct for the fruit types?
___A)
___B)
___C)
___D)
___E)
202
I
Siliqua
Legume
Siliqua
Achene
Achene
II
Legume
Siliqua
Achene
Siliqua
Legume
II
Achene
Achene
Legume
Legume
Siliqua
87. Deleted
88. Deleted
89. Which one of the following is not a characteristic of a
deuterostomian animal ?
___A) Radial cleavage during the embriyonic development
___B) Regulative development during the embriyonic period
___C) Enterocoelom
___D) Pharyngeal slits on the pharynx
___E) Original (evolutionary origin) bilateral symmetry
90. The main reason for echinoderms living only in the sea is because;
___A) They were adapted to be sessile so they do not have a great
distribution
___B) They appear first in the seas
___C) They live in different habitat types in the sea
___D) They have no excretory system
___E) There are safer places in the deep sea
91. Which one of the following structures of earthworms has similar
functions to the liver of vertebrates?
___A) Typhlosolis
___B) Coelomocytes
___C) Chloragogen cells
___D) Cells that line the inner surface of the small intestine
___E) Calcium gland cells
203
204
Partial O2 pressure
II-
pH
Body temperature
III decreases
IV increases
___B) II increases
V decreases
III increases
___C) I decreases
IV increases
III increases
___D) V increases
IV decreases
I increases
___E) II decreases
III decreases
V decreases
205
98. A nerve-skeletal muscle isolated preparation is placed in a Ca 2+ free medium appropiate for its survival. If the nerve is electrically
stimulated, which of the following events will occur?
___A) The muscle will not be stimulated
___B) The muscle will be stimulated but will not contract
___C) The muscle will be both stimulated and contract
___D) The muscle will not be stimulated, but even if it is, it will not contract
___E) The muscle may be stimulated, and may contract but it will not relax
99. Which of the following is false about the differences between the
vertebrate skeletal muscles and smooth muscles?
___A) Skeletal muscle is more sensitive to electrical stimulation while
smooth muscle is more sensitive to chemical stimulation
___B) Skeletal muscle has a certain length in the resting state; smooth
muscle has not
___C) Smooth muscle contracts more than skeletal muscle after stretching
___D) Skeletal muscle consumes 10% less of the energy than that of
smooth muscle for the same degree of contraction
___E) Without a nerve connection, skeletal muscle cannot function
normally but smooth muscle can
206
100. The figure shows a feedback system for the control of the output
of blood from the heart (cardiac output). Which of the following
gives the correct description of the parts played by the
components X, Y and Z?
___A)
X
Monitor
Y
Receptor
Z
Effector
___B)
Monitor
Effector
Receptor
___C)
Receptor
Monitor
Effector
___D)
Receptor
Effector
Monitor
___E)
Effector
Monitor
Receptor
207
101.
I-
102. Deleted
103. The figure shows some parts of a mammalian eye numbered 1-5.
If light suddenly strikes the eye, which of the following will be
the nervous pathway for the evoked unconditional pupil reflex?
(CNS= Central Nervous System)
___A) From 4 to the CNS and then to 3
___B) From 1 to 4 then to the CNS and
then to 2
___C) From 3 to the CNS and back to 3
___D) From 5 to 1 then to 2
___E) From 4 to the CNS and then to 5
208
209
106. The left-hand diagram shows a frog sciatic nerve lying across a
number of electrodes. The electrodes A and B are used for
stimulating and C and D for recording. The right-hand diagram
shows a typical recorded action potential. Based on this
information, which of the following statements is correct?
210
109. Diagram shows the rates of filtration (F), reabsorption (R) and
excretion (E) of a substance (X) in relation to its plasma
concentration by the kidneys. Which one of the following
statement is incorrect?
211
112. Deleted
113. Deleted
114.
Chromosome number
2N
N
Cell number
Which of the following can be said according to the graph given
above?
I
II-
___D) I, II and IV
___C) II and IV
212
BEHAVIOUR
116. In the picture, a flying dummy (silhouette) of a bird is
illustrated. If the dummy is moved over hatched chicks of a
pheasant
(Phasianus
colchicus) from left to right
(upper arrow) or from right
to left (ie. moving backward)
(lower arrow), the chicks will
react as follows (mark the
correct answer with an X):
I.
213
__A)
___B)
___D)
___E)
214
___C)
119.
215
120. When a goose notices an egg outside her nest, she rises, extends
her neck, touches the egg with her beak, and then rolls it back in
very gently. She completes the same recovery behavior whether
the objects she sees is a beer bottle or golf ball, even when the
object is removed after she has begun to reach for it.
Which of the following statements is correct according to the
situation above?
___A) The reason why the goose rolls back the objects that do not
structurally look like an egg is her lack of recognition
___B) This behaviour is caused by instinct
___C) In order to fill her nest to provide suitable incubation conditions
___D) This behavior is learnt from the parents.
___E) The goose recognises her own egg shape. For this reason, egg
rolling is a fixed action pattern and continues without another
stimulus
216
ECOLOGY
121. Deleted
122. Which one of the following environmental conditions affects the
dispersal trend of a population positively?
___A) The conditions that cause high mortality sometimes create empty
habitats
___B) Very frequent disturbances in the habitat conditions
___C) Absence of suitable habitats very close to each other
___D) A low level of natality causing the differences between the habitats
___E) A breakdown at any level of the food chain
123. Deleted
124. According to the population growth curves given below, which
population has reached equilibrium by responding properly to
negative feedback mechanisms with time?
___A) limit K
___D)
limit K
___B) limit K
___E)
limit K
___C) limit K
217
125. Deleted
126. A mosquito species which lives in hot and highly humid
environment generally chooses little isolated aquatic habitats to
reproduce and completes its larval development. This species
gives many generations by reproducing in late May and early
October. To increase its population in a given area which in the
following is the most important limiting factor for this species
which is very sensitive to the chemical changes in the habitat
water .
___A) Increase in the saturation deficit in the air during the reproductive
season
___B) Predation
___C) Competition with another species in the microhabitat
___D) Increase in the shadow factor
___E) Increase in relative humidity
127. Which one of the following explanations cannot be given about
the relationship between the carrying capacity and the
environmental response of populations with a high density?
___A) Competition increases
___B) The natality (birth) rate decreases
___C) The negative feedback mechanism works
___D) The environmental response decreases
___E) The mortality rate increases
128. Deleted
129. Deleted.
130. Deleted
218
131. Which one of the following cannot be said about the distribution
of populations?
132. A park was built in a place that was occupied by a lot of
speciesAtrees. A long time ago they were all cut down no
species A trees remained. Later gardeners planted more
species A trees and also species B trees and species C
trees had species B and C never grew in that region before.
Nobody took care of this garden. After 100 years there were a lot
of new A trees and B trees, but no young C trees . Which
processes refer to the A, B and C trees in that park?
A
___A) Introduced,
Acclimatized,
Reacclimatized
___B)
Acclimatized,
Introduced,
Reacclimatized
___C)
Introduced,
Reacclimatized,
Acclimatized
___D) Reacclimatized,
Acclimatized,
Introduced
___E)
Reacclimatized,
Introduced
Acclimatized,
219
133. The graph represents the changes in the biomass, diversity and
primary production in the ecological succession. Which blocks
on the graph represent the first settler stages and the climax
stage, respectively.
I
II
III
Years
Primary production
Biological diversity
___A) I and II
___B) II and III
___C) I and III
___D) I, II and III
___E) None
220
Biomass
221
222
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
61.
62.
63.
64.
65.
66.
67.
68.
A
C
Deleted
B
Deleted
E
B
A
C
C
A
Deleted
B
E
B
Deleted
E
A
A
Deleted
C
E
B
E
Deleted
E
Deleted
D
D
Deleted
Deleted
Deleted
Deleted
E
69. B
70. C
71. D
72. E
73. E
74. C
75. Deleted
76. D
77. B
78. E
79. D
80. E
81. Deleted
82. D
83. D
84. Deleted
85. Deleted
86. E
87. Deleted
88. Deleted
89. D
90. D
91. C
92. B
93. E
94. Deleted
95. Deleted
96. C
97. C
98. A
99. D
100. C
101. C
102. Deleted
103. A
104. D
105. A
106. A
107. Deleted
108. C
109. E
110. A
111. Deleted
112. Deleted
113. Deleted
114. B
115. C
116. C
117. C
118. A
119. A
120. E
121. Deleted
122. A
123. Deleted
124. C
125. Deleted
126. A
127. D
128. Deleted
129. Deleted
130. Deleted
131. A
132. D
133. A
134. E
135. Deleted
77
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Dynein
___
___
Na -K ATPase
Nexin
___
Connexon
4. Transport protein
___
Porin
___
Keratin
___
Desmin
5.
A) (5') A G C C T A A T G G C C T A (3')
B) (3') T C G G A T T A C C G G A T (5')
The DNA above is replicated in the direction of the arrow. Write the
appropriate letter showing the templates for leading strand and
lagging strand synthesis in the blanks. (2 points)
template for the lagging strand _________
template for the leading strand _________
129
6.
A
C
E
D
F
B
_________
Template
_________
_________
_________
_________
_________
7. Two molecules of DNA (I and II) are the same size (1000 bp) but
differ in base composition. The first one contains 42% and the
second one 66% A+T. (1.5 points).
A) How many G residues are there in DNA I and II? (1 point).
I: _______
II: _______
B) Which molecule (I or II) has a higher Tm. (Tm =dissociation
point) (0.5 point)
_______
130
DNA polymerase I
3 5 exonuclease
activity_________
DNA Ligase_________
Topoisomerase II_________
DNA Polymerase I
53 exonuclease
activity_________
131
C) Match the enzymes with the reaction it catalyzes. Put the letter
in front of the enzyme in the appropriate blanks below. (2
points).
E. Primase
F. Ligase
G. DNA Polymerase II
H. DNA Polymerase III
I. DNA Polymerase I
- Enzyme ___________catalyzes the synthesis of fragment I
- Enzyme ___________catalyzes the synthesis of fragment II
- Enzyme ___________catalyzes the synthesis of RNA primer
- Enzyme ___________seals the nick shown as III in the diagram
132
B) Origin
C) 35
D) 53
E) dNTP
F) NTP
G) Yes (+)
H) No (-)
RNA
Polymerase
DNA
Polymerase III
133
B) Using the genetic code table given on the next page, write the
amino acid sequence of the polypeptide coded by this mRNA.
__________________________
C) Suppose the other (complementary) strand is used as a template
for the transcription. What is the amino acid sequence of the
resulting peptide?
__________________________
D) If the labeled base above in the template strand is converted to
A instead of T, what would be the type of the mutation?
Transition (X), transversion (Y), deletion (Z) or insertion (W)
Write the correct letter on the line below.
_________________________________
134
BASE
I
U
UUU
phe
UUC
UUA
A
UAU
G
tyr
UGU
IBASEI
II
UCU
ser
cys
phe
UCC
ser
UAC
tyr
UGC
cys
leu
UCA
ser
UAA
stop
UGA
stop
UUG
leu
UCG
ser
UAG
stop
UGG
trp
CUU
leu
CCU
pro
CAU
his
CGU
arg
CUC
leu
CCC
pro
CAC
his
CGC
arg
CUA
leu
CCA
pro
CAA
gin
CGA
arg
CUG
leu
CCG
pro
CAG
gin
CGG
arg
AUU
ile
ACU
thr
AAU
asn
AGU
ser
AUC
ile
ACC
thr
AAC
asn
AGC
ser
AUA
ile
ACA
thr
AAA
lys
AGA
arg
AUG
met
ACG
thr
AAG
lys
AGG
arg
GUU
val
GCU
ala
GAU
asp
GGU
gly
GUC
val
GCC
ala
GAC
asp
GGC
gly
GUA
val
GCA
ala
GAA
glu
GGA
gly
GUG
val
GCG
ala
GAG
glu
GGG
gly
15. Deleted
16. Deleted
135
17.
A) The heart muscle while working aerobically
B) A bacterium culture that cannot grow in the dark
C) A propionic acid bacteria that can grow under anaerobic
conditions in the dark
D) Erythrocytes
Fill in the blanks with the suitable letters above.(2 points)
_____ provides ATP requirement by photosynthesis
_____ provides ATP requirement by converting glucose to lactate
_____ provides ATP requirement by fermentation
_____ provides ATP requirement by oxidative phosphorylation
18. Atmospheric nitrogen (N2) is chemically very stable. Only a few
prokaryotic species can convert atmospheric nitrogen into usable
form by plants. One of the characteristics of these organisms is
that they possess the nitrogenase enzyme complex that can fix the
nitrogen. O2 irreversibly inhibits this enzyme. Considering that
we live in an oxidizing environment, nitrogen fixing organisms
must have a variety of mechanisms for protection from O2.
A) Below are given some characteristics of bacteria. Put an X in
the blank for the ones that can fix nitrogen. (4 points).
_____A free living bacterium under soil like Clostridium
_____Cyanobacteria like Nostoc muscorum possess thick cell walls
_____Bacteria like E.coli that are inhabitants of the intestinal tract
_____Symbiotic bacteria like Rhizobium of leguminous plants that
possess specialized protein leghemoglobin
_____High mutation rate bacteria like Salmonella typhimurium
B) Which is the major product of the nitrogenase enzyme complex?
(Mark with an X)
_____ammonia
136
_____nitrite
_____nitrate
_____nitrogen gas
137
22. In peas, the allele for green seed color (A) is dominant over the
allele for yellow seed color (a) and the allele for normal leaf (B) is
dominant over the allele for rolled leaf (b). The F 1 generation is
obtained by crossing AABB x aabb. When these F1 plants are
tested again, the following results are found;
117 green seed / normal leaf
115 yellow seed / rolled leaf
76 green seed / rolled leaf
80 yellow seed / normal leaf
2 = (O-E)2 / E
O: Observed value
138
139
Root water
conductivity
3
4
PHASE
The graph represents the water conductivity of a root. Mark the true
alternative(s) with an X.
___A) The temperature decreases between the phases 1-2 and 4-5
___B) CN- is added to the medium between the phases 0-1 and 2-4
___C) There is enough oxygen between the phases 1-2 and 4-5
___D) The root cannot get enough nutrient between the phases 1-2 and 45
140
Dark
I
A
Light
II
B
RF
C
RF
FRF
RF
FRF
RF
RF
FRF
RF
D
E
FRF
F
0
12
16
20
24
A)
B)
C)
D)
E)
F)
II
26. Deleted
141
27. Deleted
28. Deleted
29. Deleted
30. Label the figure using the numbers (2.1 points)
01 Anther
05 Phyllary
02 Ovarium
06 Nectar
03 Stigma
07 Pappus
04 Corolla
142
II
143
144
32. Select numbers from the answer key and mark the parts of the
different fruit types (3 points)
Answer key:
1-
Remains of sepals
2-
Receptacle
3-
Seed
4-
Placenta
5-
Pedicel
33. Deleted
34. Deleted
145
Increases
Decreases
Membrane potential
pH of the medium
35. 2 (1 point)
Taken up
Glucose
146
Not taken up
BIOSYSTEMATICS
36. Deleted
37. Deleted
38. Which of the following descriptions about vertebrates is/are
correct? Mark the correct ones with an X. (2.5 points)
______The scales of fish are epidermal scales
______The scales of snakes are epidermal scales
______The scales of lizards are epidermal scales
______The scales of pangolins are epidermal scales
______The hairs of humans are derivatives of epidermis
______The horns of deers are epidermal in origin
______The horns of cattles are epidermal in origin
______The horns of rhinoceros are epidermal in origin
39. Deleted
40. Deleted
41.
I. Rhynia
IV. Lycopodium
II. Spirogyra
V. Equisetum
III. Rhizopus/Mucor
147
Excretes
hipertonic urine
relative to the
body fluids
148
Terrestrial
mammal
Excretes
isotonic urine
relative to the
body fluids
(Mouse)
Excretes
hipotonic urine
relative to the
body fluids
Marine
mammal
Actively
absorbs salt
(whale)
Actively
secretes salt
Lizard
Wastes are
discarded as
uric acid
(Chameleon)
Wastes are
discarded as
urea
Marine fish
Wastes are
discarded as
ammonia
(sea bass )
Bird (pigeon)
Fresh water
fish (carp)
Drinks water
regularly
44.
In the figure, some parts of a mammalian nephron are numbered (IV). Match these numbers with the events or properties given in the
table (a number can be used more than once). (2.5 points).
Cl- is actively pumped out
Blood is filtered
Almost all glucose is reabsorbed
Urine becomes acidic
Na+ is reabsorbed under aldesterone control
149
Stimulus
Decreased red
blood cell count
46. Deleted
150
Stimulated
Secreted
organ/tissue
Substance
Target Biological
Response
151
48. 1. Indicate the letter of the box which represents the placenta. (1
point).
Answer:________(fill in a letter)
48. 2. Calculate the ratio of blood flow through the lungs just before
and few days after the birth, assuming that the total amount of
blood leaving the heart at both are equal. (1 point).
Answer: (Ratio) Before / After =__________
152
Stretch receptors
Cardioaccelatory
Cardioinhibitory
center
center
inhibited
stimulated
inhibited
stimulated
inhibited
increases
stimulated
inhibited
stimulated
Cardiac output
Vasomotor
center
Arterioles
decreases
constricted
dilated
50. Deleted
153
51.
Tissue cells
Plasma
Red
blood
cell
The figure shows the reactions occuring during gas and electrolyte
exchange between blood capillaries loaded with O 2 and the tissue
cells. Fill in the empty boxes in the figure and below with the
appropriate numbers out of the 13 substances given below. (3.5
points).
1. Hb (hemoglobin)
6. H2PO4
11. HCO3
2. H2CO3
7. H2SO4
12. HbO2
3. H2O
8. Cl-
13. HHb
4. CO2
9. Na
5. NaHCO3
10. Ca2+
154
II
III
IV
VI
VII
RQ
(completely oxidised)
Carbohydrate
1,0
Fat
0,7
Protein
0,9
RQ lower
155
_____ Snake
_____ Man
_____ Mouse
156
Arterial chemoreceptors
Respiratory rate
stimulation
increase
inhibition
decrease
increase
increase
decrease
decrease
______
Frog
______
Reptile
______
Bird
______
Mammal
______
157
56. The following statements are about calcium and its regulation in
humans. Match correctly the substances given in the answer key
with the statements (put the letter of the substance in front of the
statements). (2 points).
_____It is the vitamin which promotes the accumulation of calcium in the
body
_____It is the gland which secretes calcitonin, the hormone causes
calcium accumulation
_____It is the the place where calcium accumulates in great amounts in
the body
_____It is the gland which secretes hormone that increases the calcium
level in the blood
Answer key:
A. Vitamin D
B. Bones
C. Thyroid
D. Blood
E. Parathyroid gland
F. Vitamin C
G. Adrenal gland
158
57. Some human endocrine and exocrine glands are numbered in the
figure . In the following statements some functions related to these
glands are given. Match the statements with the glands in the
figure (Put the number of the gland in front of the statements). (3
points)
58. Deleted
159
59. Deleted
60. Deleted
ECOLOGY
61. Deleted
62. A food web including 6 different species (A to F) in an ecosystem
is shown in the figure illustrated below. The arrows refer to the
energy flow directions. Match the following according to that
figure. (3.5 points).
B
C
F
D
Producer species
Decomposer species
Consumer species on the first trophic level
Consumer species on the second trophic level
Consumer species on the third trophic level
The species in which biomagnification is seen at the highest level
160
_____
_____
_____
_____
_____
_____
161
64. In the tables below, one might see the relationships among the
populations and the results of these influences. Mark the correct
answer(s) by an ellipse in each box. For clarity, an example has
been given for competition. (3.5 points).
Competition
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
0
Predation
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
0
Parasitism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
0
Neutralism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
0
Mutualism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
0
Commensalism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
0
Amensalism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
0
162
65. In the figure illustrated below the energy flow between the
organisms on different trophic levels in a food web is shown. On
the scheme given below, please fill in the blanks with the numbers
given below for the producers, and 1o, 2o, 3o trophic level
consumers according to their levels. (3.6 points).
Producers
0
_____
2 consumers _____
10 consumers
0
3 consumers
_____
_____
163
66. Deleted
67. The figure given below represents the carbon cycle. Fill in the
blanks with the suitable numbers that corresponds to the
processes concerning the cycle given to you. (2 points).
Processes:
Combustion
Consumption
Death
Photosynthesis
Respiration
Decomposition
164
______________
______________
______________
______________
______________
______________
Fungi
II.
Phytoplankton
III.
Inorganic components
IV.
Zooplankton
Abiotic substance
Producer
Consumer
Decomposer
69. Deleted
70. The density of a population that reaches equilibrium is known as
the carrying capacity in that species for that habitat. When a
population approaches the carrying capacity of any habitat,
which of the following shows a tendency to increase? Mark all
correct answers with an X. (2.5 points).
________ Competition for resources
________ Competition for shelters
________ Competition for mating areas
________ Immigration
________ Accumulation of toxic wastes
165
71. In any habitat that includes a predator species and its prey, it is
known that both of their populations show linked fluctuations.
Show the curve belonging to the predator species by putting an
X in the circle. (1 point).
N1
N
N2
Time
166
BEHAVIOUR
72. Thorleif Schjelderup- Ebbe reported the results of a study about
the social organization carried out in a poultry yard with Leghorn
hens . He found that there was a kind of order (arrangement) in
the peck that was related with a real hierarchy in the group.
The following matrix shows the peck frequency within a group of
13 females (from A to M). Each datum indicates the times that the
hen identified by the letter in the horizontal line is pecked by one
in the vertical line. (4 points)
M
A 53
45
38
51
35
36
41
29
33
34
41
39
B 42
34
37
28
36
29
40
46
43
53
47
C 36
29
26
44
31
38
24
42
37
32
D 35
27
39
29
36
52
43
31
26
E 48
30
27
43
41
40
36
35
F 43
39
42
40
39
33
31
G 39
38
28
36
41
39
H 35
52
47
37
37
41
42
54
33
29
31
32
K 42
37
L 39
M -
72.1. Which of the following female has the highest hierarchy within
the group? (2 points)
___A) A
___B) B
___C) J
___D) H
___E) M
72.2. Deleted
72.3. Deleted
167
0.50
Identical twins
1.00
Grandparent Grandchild
0.25
First cousins
0.125
Uncle nephew
0.25
168
73.2. If you take into consideration the knowledge given in the table
above, which of the following statements about the sterilization
of the worker bees given as I, II, III and IV is true? (1 point).
I-
II-
169
5.
A
B
6.
A
B
C
E
D
170
F
7.
A) I: 580, II: 340
B) I
8.
DNA Helicase___2___
Primase___1___
DNA polymerase I
3 5 exonuclease activity___5____
DNA Ligase___4____
Topoisomerase II___6___
_
DNA Polymerase I
53 exonuclease activity____3____
9.
A)
171
B)
C)
H
H
E
F
10.
A
172
11. Deleted
12. Deleted
13.
P
E, P
P
P
E, P
P,E
P
14.
A) 5'GAA GGG CUA UCC UUA UCA AAG
B) Glu-Gly-Leu-Ser-Leu-Ser-LysC) Leu-stop-stop
D)
E)
173
15. Deleted
16. Deleted
17.
B
D
C
A
18.
A)
__X__
__X__
_____
__X__
_____
B)
__X__ammonia
_____ nitrite
_____ nitrate
_____ nitrogen gas
19.
a. 0.49
b. 0.25
20.
5/8 or 62.5%
174
21. Deleted
22.
A) 3
B) 14.98 or 15.0 > 7.815 - 387.45 or 387 > 7.815
C) Genes are linked
D) Deleted
23.
1
4
5
3
2
24.
A, D
25.
A)
B)
C)
D)
E)
F)
175
26. Deleted
27. Deleted
28. Deleted
29. Deleted
30.
31.
31.1. E
31.2. B
176
32.
1
2
3
5
5
2
1
33. Deleted
34. Deleted
35.
35.1.
Increases
Membrane
Decreases
X
potential
pH of the medium
35. 2.
Taken up
Glucose
Not taken up
36. Deleted
37. Deleted
177
38.
______
___X__
___X__
___X__
___X__
______
___X__
___X__
39. Deleted
40. Deleted
41.
V
III
II
I
IV
IV
II
I
IV
42. Deleted
178
43.
X
X
Terrestria
l mammal
(Mouse)
Marine
mammal
(whale)
Marine fish
(sea bass )
Lizard
(Chamele
on)
Bird
(pigeon)
Fresh
water fish
(carp)
Drinks water
regularly
Does not
drink water
Wastes are
discarded as
ammonia
Wastes are
discarded as
urea
Wastes are
discarded as
uric acid
Actively
secretes salt
Actively
absorbs salt
Excretes
hipotonic
urine relative
to the body
fluids
Excretes
isotonic
urine relative
to the body
fluids
Excretes
hipertonic
urine relative
to the body
fluids
X
X
X
X
179
44.
II
I
III
IV
V
45. Stimulus
Decreased red
blood cell count
Biological
Response
12
46. Deleted
47.
IV
I
III
II
48.1. G
48.2. 1:7
49.
Stretch
receptors
Vasomotor
center
inhibited
stimulated
inhibited
Cardioinhibitory
center
stimulated
inhibited
stimulated
180
inhibited
Stimulated
X
Cardioaccelatory
center
Cardiac output
increases
Arterioles
decreases constricted
dilated
50. Deleted
51.
1
13
11
II
III
IV
VI
VII
52.
RQ
higher
RQ lower
X
X
X
X
53.
II
V
IV
III
I
181
54.
Arterial chemoreceptors
Respiratory rate
stimulation
increase
inhibition
decrease
increase
increase
X
55.
3
_______
1, 2, 3, 4
1, 2, 3, 4
1, 2, 3, 4
56.
A
C
B
E
57.
5
3
2
182
decrease
decrease
X
4
9
1
7
8
6
58. Deleted
59. Deleted
60. Deleted
61. Deleted
62.
A
E
B,D
C
F
F
63.
183
64.
Competition
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
Neutralism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
Predation
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
Mutualism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
Amensalism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
184
Parasitism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
0
Commensalism
Species
A
B
+
0
0
+
+
+
-
0
0
65.
12
7, 8, 9, 10, 11
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6
1, 2, 3, 5
66. Deleted
67.
9
3
4,5,7
1
2,8,10
6
68.
III
II
IV
I
69. Deleted
185
70.
__X__
__X__
__X__
_____
__X__
71.
N2
72.1.
72.2.
Deleted
72.3.
Deleted
72.4.
73.1. 0.50
1.00
0.50
0.75
0.50
73.2. D
186
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Eckhard Klieme
Eckhard R. Lucius
Erwin Zabel (Eds.)
Report of the
9th International Biology Olympiad
ipn
ipnmaterialien
5.1
Theoretical Tests
11-20
21-30
31-40
41-50
51-60
61-70
71-80
10
C(2)
A(2)
A(2)
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
C(2)
B(2)
D(2)
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
B(2)
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
B(2)
C(2)
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
B(2)
C(2)
C(2)
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
B(2)
C(2)
D(2)
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
D(2)
B(2)
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
D(2)
A(2)
E(2)
Tab. 11: Answer codes of the following tasks, part A of the theoretical test
The following part A tasks were skipped: 2, 5, 11, 29, 33, 39, 43, 49, 48.
84
th
CELL BIOLOGY
A 1:
How do polypeptides find their way from the place of synthesis
(1 pt)at cytoplasmic ribosomes to the place of their destination in
the mitochondria?
A:
B:
C:
D:
E:
A 2:
A:
B:
C:
D:
E:
A 3:
How does the
(1 pt)increase in a cell?
A:
B:
number
of
mitochondria
and
plastids
C:
D:
E:
A 4:
How is the distribution of light to the photosystem I (PS I) and
(2 pts) the photosystem II (PS II) adjusted to different conditions of light?
A:
B:
C:
D:
E:
85
A 5:
(1 pt)
A:
glycosylation
C:
prenylation
B:
ubiquitination
D:
phosphorylation
A 6:
E: ADP ribosylation
(1 pt)
A:
B:
C:
D:
E:
A 8:
Animal and plant cells possess channels directly connecting
(1 pt)the cytoplasm of one cell to the cytoplasm of another cell. How
are these structures called?
A:
plasmodesmata, desmosomes
B:
plasmodesmata, Ca2+-ATPase
C:
D:
86
th
A 9:
III. to mitochondriaI
IV. to ribosomes
A:
B:
D:
C:
only III
E:
only I
C:
I and II
B:
only II
D:
only III
A 11:
E:
III and IV
(1 pt)
A:
cytomorphogenesis
C:
mitotic prophase
B:
meiotic anaphase I
D:
E:
cytoplasmic circulation
A 12:
87
NADP reduction
synthesis of fatty acids
III.
endoxidation
IV. gene expression
A:
B:
C:
D:
E:
I, III, V, VIII
A 14:
(1 pt)
V. Calvin
VI. citric acid cycle
VII.oxidative catabolism of fatty acids
VIII. nitrit reduction
I.
apoplast
IV
intermicellar space
VII
II.
mircofilament
keratin
VIII cutin
III.
microfibre
VI
chitin
IX
A:
I,III,VII,IX,
B:
II,V,VII,VIII,
C:
III,IV,V,VIII
D:
II,VI,IX
E:
I,III,V,VI
A 15:
lignin
suberin
What is a prion?
(1 pt)
A:
a protein
B:
C:
D:
E:
88
th
I and VII
B:
II and VIII
C:
II and V
D:
III and VI
E:
IV and VI
A 17: Which classes of lipids have non-polar side chains and polar
(1 pt)head groups?
A:
phospholipids
B:
triglycerides
C:
cholesterol
D:
waxes
E:
glycerol
89
I, IV, VI
C:
II, V, VI
B:
II, V, VII
D:
E:
A 19: In the following three plant species(I to III) are listed. Among 1 to 7
(2 pts) anatomical and physiological characteristics are mentioned as well.
I.
II.
III
I: 1, 3, 6
II: 1, 5, 7
III: 2, 4, 6
B:
I: 2, 4, 6
II: 3, 6
III: 1, 3, 6
C:
I: 2, 4, 6
II: 2, 3, 6
III: 3, 6
90
th
D:
I: 1, 5, 7
II: 2, 4, 6
III: 3, 6
E:
I: 1, 5, 7
II: 3, 6
III: 2, 4, 6
A 20:
air
B:
vacuum
C:
water
D:
hypertonic solution
E:
cell sap
A 22: What happens if you put a turgescent cell into its own cell sap
(2 pts) (i.e. a solution with the same water potential as the osmotic
potential of the cell)?
A: There is no change.
B: The cell loses water until its water potential is equal to the water
potential of the surrounding solution.
C: Water is released until incipient plasmolysis occurs.
D: Plasmolysis occurs.
E: The cell bursts.
91
A 23:
(1 pt)
respirat. photosynthesis
respirat. photosynthesis
light intensity
respirat. photosynthesis
respirat. photosynthesis
light intensity
respirat. photosynthesis
light intensity
light intensity
light intensity
92
B: II
C:
III
D:
IV
E:
th
curve A
B:
curve B
C:
curve C
D:
curve D
Sunrise
Sunset
93
A 26:
dro(1 pt)
The following figure shows a germ which was grown in hyponics in a glass vessel and which was exposed to light only
from the right-hand side. The growth curvatures you can observe in the stem axis are called:
A:
photonasty
B:
phototropism
C:
phototaxis
D:
photomorphosis
E:
photoperiodism
V 0 ppm NOx
IV 0,5 ppm NOx
2,0
1,8
1,6
1,4
1,2
1,0
0,8
0,6
0,4
0,2
0,0
1
Tage
th
A 28:
(1 pt)
Which function
germination?
does
the
glyoxylate
cycle
A:
B:
synthesis of ATP
C:
D:
E:
have
during
A 29: Which three sensory systems regulate light-depending develop(1 pt)ment and differentiation of angiosperms?
I.
phytochrome
II.
cryptochrome
III.
protochlorohyllid
IV.
chlorophy
V.
anthocyan
A:
I, III and V
B:
I, II and IV
C:
D:
I, II and III
E:
II, IV and V
95
A 30:
(1 pt)
The eyes of squids are highly efficient, those of snails are poorly
efficient. Consider whether efficiency of organs may be coupled
with the intensity of their metabolism. If squids were provided
with poorly efficient eyes and snails with highly efficient eyes
whereas the further body organisation remained unchanged in
both cases, this would be:
A:
B:
C:
D:
A 31:
(1 pt)
gonad
gastric filaments
A:
B:
C:
D:
96
th
A 32:
(1 pt)
(1 pt)
(2 pts) freshwater have a reproductive cycle called heterogony: Reproduction occurs temporarily only in females and temporarily
in males and females. If this is an advantage to these species of
Rotatoria, which of the following statements is correct?
A: Several generations of females and males are followed by one with
only females.
B: Several generations of only females are followed by one with females
and males.
C: Every generation of only females is followed by one with females and
males, and vice versa.
D: Several generations of only females are followed by several with females and males, and vice versa.
97
A 35:
(1 pt)
only I
A 37:
(1 pt)
B:
only IV
C:
I, V
D:
II, III
E:
I, III, IV
B:
III, IV, V
C:
I, II, V
D:
E:
only IV, V
98
II, IV
th
A 38:
(1 pt)
only I, II
C:
all answers
B:
only II, IV
D:
only V
A 39:
E:
only II, IV
(2 pts) region of retinal cells is directed towards the incoming light. The
figure below taken from a text book illustrates how an everse
median eye of a spider could have developed by invagination.
Why should this suggested eye structure be considered incorrect?
Legend:
1:
lens
2:
vitreous body
3:
4:
optic nerve
A 40:
(1 pt)
Bones are dynamic rather than static structures. How may this be
realized?
B:
C:
D:
E:
100
th
ETHOLOGY
A 42:
House swallows mostly breed in colonies. They live on flying insects. Predators spotted during flights for prey or near the nest are noisily attacked in nosedives. This mobbing reaction communicates itself to the other swallows and
supports the defence against enemies. The table shows the ethological status
of the swallows and their share in the mobbing reaction and in the population,
respectively.
birds status
in per cent
11
14
10
51
77
young animals
20
total
100
100
Which of the following hypothesis have to be assumed to be correct according to the results?
I:
II:
III:
IV:
V:
VI
A:
IV, V, VI
III, IV, V
C:
II, IV, VI
D:
I, IV, VI
101
attacking
being attacked
A
16
16
14
10
18
total
53
33
23
29
10
11 33
14
24
10
10
13
13
16
10
27
52
10 28
36
45 224
Read the matrix and choose which one of the females is the lowest in the rank order.
How do you call the individual loosing conflicts within the group?
I.
female A
II
female I
III.
female E
IV.
female F
V.
female H
VI.
female G
IX.
subdominant
I, III, IV
D:
IV, VI, IX
B:
II, V, VII
E:
V, VII, IX
C:
III, VII, IX
102
th
GENETICS/EVOLUTION
A 44:
(1 pt)
A:
B:
C:
D:
E:
A 45:
(1 pt)rect?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
VI.
I, II, III
C:
I, IV, VI
B:
I, III, V
D:
II, V, VI
E:
II, V, VII
A 47: Did Gregor Mendel know some of the phenomena (I- VII )? Under
(2 pts) which capital letter do you only find such phenomena?
I.
II.
extrakaryotic inheritance
III.
break of coupling
IV.
polyploidy
V.
VI.
cleistogamy in pea
VII.
A: I, II
C:
V, VI
B: I, III
D:
III, VI
E: IV, VII
B:
non disjunction
C:
endomitosis
D:
centromere fracture
E:
duplication
104
th
transformation
IV.
sexduction
II.
transposition
V.
mutation
III.
transduction
VI.
transfection
A:
I, II, III
C:
I, V, VI
B:
I, III, IV
D:
II, IV, VI
E:
, III, IV
A 51: The table sums up characteristics which are original (plesiomor(1 pt)phic) or deduced (apomorphic) within the group of angiosperms.
characteristics
1
10
11
ovary superior
12
ovary inferior
1, 3, 5, 7, 10, 11
C: 2, 4, 6, 8, 9, 12
B:
1, 4, 5, 8, 10, 12
D: 2, 3, 5, 8, 9, 12
E: 1, 4, 6, 7, 10, 12
105
Lycopodium (Lycopodiophyta)
Gingko (Pinophyta)
III.
IV.
V.
Pinus (Pinophyta)
Cycas (Pinophyta vel Cycadophyta)
Magnolia (Magnoliophyta)
1. aggregations of sprophylls (strobili) or blossoms unisexual
2. aggregations of sprophylls (strobili) or blossoms bisexual
3. aggregations of sprophylls (strobili) or blossoms sexually
not differentiated
4. fertilization by spermatozoids
5. fertilization by immobile sperms
I: 1, 4
II: 3, 4
III: 3, 4
IV: 1, 5
V: 3, 4
B:
I: 1, 5
II: 2, 5
III: 1, 4
IV: 2, 5
V: 2, 5
C:
I: 3, 4
II: 1, 4
III: 1, 5
IV: 2, 5
V: 2, 5
D:
I: 3, 4
II: 1, 4
III: 1, 5
IV: 1,4
V: 2, 5
1, 2, 3
C:
only 1, 3
B:
only 2, 4
D:
2, 4, 5
106
E: 1, 3, 4
th
ECOLOGY
A 56: Why do some columnar cacti in their natural habitat turn their
(1 pt)longitudinal axis to the point where the sun is at its zenith in
summer-time? Evaluate the explanations I - III.
I.
II.
III.
108
th
A 59: Why do you often find cyanobacteria and red algae in places with
(1 pt)low irradiance?
I.
D:
E:
A 60:
(1 pt)
I, II and III
C:
I and II
B:
Only I
D:
II and III
A 61:
(1 pt)
E:
Only III
Which one of the desert plants I and II has to tolerate more heat in
a habitat with the same solar radiation and why?
I. a desert plant with large leaves and water-storing bulbs
II. a desert plant with small but succulent leaves
Only I
C:
I and II
B:
Only II
D:
Only III
A 63:
E:
I, II and III
(2 pts) and vanishing habitats. They are selected for quick colonisation,
for fast and complete utilisation of these habitats and for fast
search for new favourable places. Which of the following
characteristics apply to r-strategists?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
V.
A:
I, II and III
C:
B:
I, II and IV
D:
110
E:
I, III and V
th
A 65: The ecosystems shown in the table differ in the amount of their
(2 pts) net primary production.
selected ecosystems
number
ecosystem
savannah
tundra
Name the correct order (increasing net primary production ) of the ecosytems shown in the table.
A:
3, 6, 2, 5, 4, 1
B:
3, 6, 5, 2, 4, 1
C:
6, 3, 5, 2, 4, 1
D:
6, 3, 2, 5, 1, 4
A 66:
(1 pt)
Which possible effects does the smoke from the vast forest fires
in tropical rain forest have on the plants in neighbouring areas?
I.
II.
III.
IV.
A:
I and II
B:
II and III
C:
I and III
D:
III and IV
E:
II and IV
111
I.
elephant
II.
frog
III.
rabbit
A 67:
(1 pt)
I (2),
II (3)
B:
I (1),
II (3)
C:
II (3),
III (1)
D:
I (1),
II (2)
E:
II (2),
III (3)
112
th
SYSTEMATICS
A 68: Which characteristics are typical for wind-pollinated (anemophi
(1 pt)lous) plants?
A: smooth stigma, viscous pollen and polyspermous dehiscent fruit
B: smooth stigma, non-viscous pollen and polyspermous indehiscent fruit
C: papillate stigma, non-viscous pollen and monospermous indehiscent
fruit
D: papillate stigma, viscous pollen and monospermous dehiscent fruit
E: papillate stigma, viscous pollen and polyspermous indehiscent
A 69: Where do beans (Fabacae, e.g. soybean Glycine max, syn. Soja
(1 pt)hispida) store reserve material for germination?
A: in the pericarp
B: in the cotyledons of the embryo
C: in the triploid nutritive tissue (endosperm) of the seed
D: in the diploid nutritive tissue (perisperm) of the seed
A 70:
A:
onion
A 71:
(2 pts)
C:
tuber
B:
turnip
D:
rhizome
1. monocotyledons
2. dicotyledons
3. stone fruit
4. capsula
5. nut or caryopsis
I: 1, 3
II: 1, 4
III: 1, 4
IV: 2, 4
V: 1, 5
B:
I: 1, 4
II: 2, 5
III: 1, 5
IV: 2, 3
V: 1, 3
C:
I: 1, 4
II: 2, 5
III: 1, 3
IV: 2, 5
V: 1, 3
D:
I: 1, 4
II: 2, 3
III: 1, 3
IV: 2, 5
V: 1, 5
E:
I: 1, 4
II: 2, 3
III: 1, 4
IV: 2, 5
V: 1, 3
113
Rosaceae
C:
Fabaceae (Leguminosae)
B:
Brassicaceae (Cruciferae)
D:
Asteraceae
A 73:
E: Fagaceae
I, II
C:
only II
B:
I, III
D:
only III
A 74:
E:
only IV
(2 pts) I.
II.
III.
IV.
I, IV
C:
only V
B:
D:
I, II, III
A 75:
E:
II, IV, V
(1 pt)
I.
only I, II
C:
only V
B:
only III, IV
D:
I, II, III
114
E: III, IV, V
th
MICROBIOLOGY / BIOTECHNOLOGY
A 76: A broth culture of Escherichia coli (50 ml inoculated with 0.5 ml
o
(1 pt)of an overnight culture), grown at 37 C for 18 hours, contains:
A: cells of E. coli which all divide at the same rate
B: mostly endospores
C: cells of E. coli which are all in the stationary growth phase
D: cells of E. coli which are in all possible growth phases
A 77: Clear plaques in a bacterial lawn that do not increase in size are
(1 pt)caused by
A:
B: bacteriophages.
C: bacteria producing antibiotics.
D: bacteriocin-producing bacteria.
A 78: In a wastewater treatment plant flocks of activated sludge swim
(2 pts) on the surface of the settling tank. Which physiological process
causes this problem?
C: denitrification
D: alcoholic fermentation
A: nitrification
B: sulphate reduction
I, III, V
C:
I, III, IV
B:
I, II, III
D:
II, IV, V
E:
I, II, V
Escherichia coli
C:
Agrobacterium tumefaciens
B:
Rhizobium trifolii
D:
Salmonella typhimurium
115
74
74
5.2.2
CELL BIOLOGY
B 1:
(1 pt)
Code numbers:
1.
2.
resting potential
depolarisation
3.
4.
5.
6.
116
th
B 2:
Match the molecules or proteins listed below with the various
(2 pts) sub-compartments of mitochondria.
1, 2
6, 9
1. pyruvate ehydrogenase
2. DNA polymerase
3. cytochrome c
4. ATP synthase
5. porin
6. aconitase
4, 10
3, 8
5, 7
117
B 3:
S K I P P E D .
(3 pts) Bacterial ribosomes are distinguished from ribosomes coded by
the nucleus because of their sedimentation (Svedberg-constant S)
and their composition of rRNA. Name the ribosomes and their
subunits according to the Svedberg constant and their rRNA
composition. Fill in the correct code number in the corresponding
space in the following table.
Code numbers:
1. 5S rRNA
3. 16S rRNA
5. 23S rRNA
2. 5.8S rRNA
4. 18S rRNA
6. 28S rRNA
.......80..............S
large subunit
large subunit
......50.....S
........60.............S
........ .1..............
.........5.........
..........2.............
....................
..........1.............
small subunit
small subunit
.....30...S
..........40..........S
118
..........3.........
...........4.............
.....................
..........................
.....................
..........................
th
B 4:
The average time of duplication of mammalian cells in cultures is
(2 pts) 24 hours. Just divided cells growing on a cover-slip were treated
with radioactively labelled (tritium) thymine for 10 minutes and
immediately fixed. Figure I shows a typical microscopic section.
Figure II shows the autoradiography with the dispersion of the
silver grains of the section in figure I using the same magnification. Calculate the average duration of the S-phase in these cells
with a maximum error of 30 minutes.
figure 1
Average
duration
figure 2
of
S-phase:
.....2,5
h..........
119
B 5:
The following table shows structures of eukaryotic and prokary(2 pts) otic cells as well as various membranes (types of membrane).
Which cell structures possess which type of membrane (types of
membrane)? Mark the correct answer with a cross.
no membrane
monolayer
membrane
1. nucleus
2. lysosomes
3. mitochondria
4. Golgi apparatus
5. peroxisomes
6. rough endoplasmic
reticulum
7. chloroplasts
8. vacuoles
9. ribosomes
10. centrioles
11. nucleolus
12. flagella of
eukaryotes
13. flagella of
prokaryotes
120
double
membrane
th
B 6:
Label the marked structures of the chloroplast in the following
(2pts) figure. Use the corresponding code numbers.
Code numbers:
1. thylakoid
5. nucleoid
9. plastidome
(collection of plastids)
13. pyrenoid
2. cristae
6. nucleolus
10. granum
3. stroma
7. amyloplast
11. elaiosplast
4. nucleosome
10
3 14 1
121
B 7:
The following table shows types of plastids and their specific
(2 pts) characteristics. Match the characteristics to the types of plastids
by marking with a cross.
Types of plastids
characteristics
starch formation
Chloroplast
photosynthesis
coloured
contains DNA
Chromoplast
Rhodoplast
Proplastid
Leuko-amyloplast
B 8:
(1 pt)
X
X
122
th
B 9:
e
- donator to NADP as the e terminal acceptor.
stroma
intrathylakoid space
legend: FdR = Ferredoxin-NADP+-Reductase; Fd = Ferredoxin; FeS = Ironsulphur-centre; P700, P680 = chlorophylls of the reaction centres; PC = Plastocyanin; PQ = Plastoquinone; Q = Quinon; Ph = Pheophytine; OEC = water
splitting complex .
123
B 10:
Plot with a yellow pen (1) the course of gas exchange of a typical
(3 pts) CAM plant and with a pencil (2) the course of gas exchange of a
C3-plant using the figure.
The malic acid concentrations in the CAM plant vacuoles should
be plotted in blue (3).
light period
CO2 output/h
CO2 input/h
dark period
B 11: S K I P P E D .
(2 pts)
COOAmino acids can be divided in various classes
+
H3N - C - H
according to the polarity of their R-groups.
R
1: serine (Ser)
6: glutamine (Gln)
2: alanine (Ala)
7: arginine (Arg)
3: valine (Val)
4: phenylalanine (Phe)
5: tyrosine (Tyr)
124
th
2, 3, 4
1, 5, 6
8, 9
B 12:
4: isocitrate 7: 2-oxoglutarate
2: malate
5: fumarate
8: malonate
3: cis-aconitate
6: glyoxylate
9: succinate
Citrate
CO2
Succinyl-CoA
125
figure A figure B
figure A
figure B
126
th
B 14:
Within the wall of a garden hose, flexible fibres which can hardly
127
B 15:
(1 pt)
Microscopically small marine annelid worms differ in various aspects from their macroscopically large relatives. Mark the correct
statement with a cross.
In the former, the relation of body surface to body volume is
smaller than in the latter.
In the former, the brain volume occupies a smaller part of the
body volume than in the latter.
A heart is often absent in the former, but always present in the
latter.
External fertilization is widespread among the former and
does not occur among the latter.
Planctic larvae are widespread among the former and do not
occur among the latter.
B 16: The main waste product of protein and purine metabolism is urea
(2 pts) in mammals and uric acid in birds. The solubility of these products
in water is different. If mammals produced uric acid and birds
urea (with an otherwise unchanged body organisation) why
would
this be disadvantageous to both? Mark the correct answer.
128
th
129
B 18: S K I P P E D .
(3 pts) Inspired by nature, the presented patterns I and II were generated
by a computer. Pattern formation takes place only at the growth
edge (at the bottom in the figures). An activator stimulates pigmentation (responsible for black parts of the patterns), while this
process is inhibited by an inhibitor (responsible for white parts
of the patterns). Patterns form, because the concentrations of
activator and inhibitor vary in time and space. The activator promotes
its own production by autocatalysis and, additionally, promotes
production of the inhibitor by catalysis. Both activator and inhibitor can diffuse and can be broken down. The example shows, the
laws of pattern formation differ only by their rates of diffusion D
and the rate of decomposition R of activator and inhibitor.
In order of increasing size the values are (A stands for activator, I for inhibitor):
DA = 0.005 and 0.1
RA = 0.01 and 0.06
time
growth edge
time
growth edge
Write down which values correspond to pattern I and which to pattern II.
values of pattern I: 0,005 DA =
0,005
RA =
0,01
RI =
0,015
0,1
RA =
0,06
RI =
0,003
130
DA =
th
ETHOLOGY
B 19:
(4 pts) Reproduction and parental care cause costs and yield benefits.
The right mate selection can optimize the cost-benefit-ratio (e.g.
measured by the number of eggs per nest or by the number of the
hatched and fledgling offspring). Male and female swallows differ
in their behaviour and in the length of their outer tail feathers
(see table below).
Characteristics of swallows
swallow Body
length
weight
feathers
tail feather
other than
mil feathers
arrival from
Africa
male
19 cm
18-26 g
identical
to females
106 mm
(100%)
before
(females)
female
19 cm
18-26 g
identical
to males
91 mm (84%
of 106 mm)
after
(males)
Courting male swallows change their flight path in the presence of a female
and show two long feathers in the spread tail fan. These feathers might indicate certain features of males as a secondary sexual characteristic. If that is
correct, experiments with modified ordinary tail feather lengths should yield
various results. In the picture males are shown with ordinary and experimentally modified tail feathers.
131
The next table shows the results of three groups of males (A, B, C), which had
different feather lengths.
Results of an ethological experiment
male tail feathers
A: 106 mm (ordinary)
B: 85 mm
(shortened)
C: 127 mm
(lengthened)
time of courting
6.8 days
12.3 days
3.4 days
offspring / season
5.0 young
3.3 young
8.4 young
aggression
(males)
as B, C
as A, C
as A, B
against (males)
(2)
How many offspring on average does a female have with a male C (long
tail feathers) compared to an ordinary male A (result in %)? .....68...... %
(3)
According to the results, what determines the most successful reproduction of breeding pairs? Mark with a cross.
the condition and the behaviour of females in the choosing of
a mate against males (female choice)
the condition and the successful competition of males against
each other (male-male competition)
the condition and the successful competition of females
against each other (female-female competition)
the condition and the behaviour of males in the choosing of a
mate against females (male choice)
132
th
B 20:
After the comparison each person stated their preferred model. The following
table (next page) shows the results for 4 - 20- year-olds, divided by
I.
II.
III.
133
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
choice by
(males)
%
45
43
39
35
33
32
28
26
26
28
34
42
50
57
63
67
68
choice by
(males)
%
55
57
61
65
67
68
72
74
74
72
65
57
50
43
37
33
32
choice by
(females)
%
43
44
44
42
39
37
36
36
37
42
50
57
63
66
67
63
58
choice by
(females)
%
57
56
56
58
61
63
64
64
63
58
50
43
37
34
33
34
42
Evaluate the table and mark the correct answer with a cross.
(1)
(2)
(3)
134
p.t.o.
th
(4)
(5)
B 21:
(2 pts) In the population of one species A males which are ready to reproduce
sing on fixed locations. The females are orientated towards the songs,
approach the males and get on them (inversion of the sexual role
com-pared to other grasshoppers). The males produce one spermatophore during their lifetime, and it can only be given to one female.
Nevertheless, a female can produce more than one clutch of eggs and
mate with several males in succession. Contrary to the otherwise rare
fema-le reproduction products (compared to the number of male gametes) in this case the females should have a measurably higher success rate in reproduction. An investigation showed the following results:
135
3.23 g
30
Accepted by males
3.71 g
48
(2)
How many eggs can each of four males fertilize, when it mates with a
female that produces four clutches of eggs in succession and weighs
3.87 g, 3.74 g, 3.52 g and 3.74 g, respectively when copulating?
male 1 with female 1
.....54...... eggs
.....49...... eggs
.....41...... eggs
.....49...... eggs
B 22:
(2 pts)
(Haematopus ostralegus)
Oyster catchers are birds that look for prey in the shallow water of sea
coasts, e.g. bivalve. The shells in a habitat are of different sizes and
these sizes correlate with the amount of energy in the shell meat:
Small shells can be opened fast and easily (costs) but provide less
food energy (benefit).
Big shells provide more energy (benefit), but they are more difficult
and time-consuming to open (costs).
136
th
II.
III.
Number and energy content (relative units) in shells living in a feeding territory
that were selected by birds
total amount shells present energy pre(n)
sent (E)
of energy
per shell (E)
1
1
1
2
17
34
3
11
33
4
9
36
5
6
30
6
7
42
7
20
140
8
22
176
9
19
171
10
13
130
11
6
66
12
2
24
13
1
13
1 to 13
134
sum 896
0
0
1
3
6
7
11
10
14
13
6
2
1
0
0
3
12
30
42
77
80
126
130
66
24
13
74
sum 603
Analyse and evaluate the table and answer the following questions:
(1)
What total amount of energy could be expected from 74 shells that were
randomly selected from 134 shells?
.......495...... energy units E (propotional)
(2)
What is the absolute total amount of energy and the total amount of energy in percentage, that can additionally be consumed from 74 shells
that were selected by birds.
........108........ energy units R (real)
........21,8....... % benefit
137
GENETICS/EVOLUTION
B 23:
(2 pts) diploid flowering plants have? From the list below, select and
write down the code numbers of the correct reasons or explanations in the circles below.
properties of the hybrid
3
138
th
B 24: In DNA replication the 3-end priming problem is known (end rep(2 pts) lication problem). From the list below, write in the circles in the
corresponding genophores (chromosomes DNA) the numbers of
the phenomena by which the problem is solved or avoided.
genophores
1
plasmids of eubacteria
mitochondrial DNA
plastid DNA
chromosomes of nuclei
DNA of lambda-phages
DNA of adenovirus
DNA of retrovirus
139
B 26:
..1.............5..........
code numbers:
1.Chromosomes move to the poles.
2.Single chromatids move to the poles.
3.The moving chromosomes consist of two chromatides.
4.The chromosomes can carry two alleles of a gene.
5.One haploid set of chromosomes can move to each pole.
6.There are four spindle poles per cell.
B 27: In the course of the evolution of plants the haploid life phase,
(2 pts) i.e. the gametophyte, has been more and more reduced and the
diploid life phase, i.e. the sporophyte, has become the dominant
generation. Write the number of the following taxa in the correct
order according to the increasing dominance of the diploid life
phase.
I.
Ulothrix (Chlorophyta)
II.
Chlorella (Chlorophyta)
III.
Pinus (Pinophyta)
IV.
Polytrichum (Bryophyta)
V.
Rosa (Magnoliophyta)
VI.
th
B 28:
(1 pt)
S K I P P E D .
The principle of natural selection is essentially important to Darwins theory of natural selection, and this is essentially important
to our understanding of evolution. According to the principle of
natural selection, exponential growth of populations forces selection to occur again and again.
141
ECOLOGY
B 29:
(1 pt)
net rate
of photosynthesis
+2
+1
0
-1
temperature
procuction
B 30: The following graph shows the changes in values of various bio(2 pts) logical factors/parameters in relation to increasing density of
fish.
population density
142
th
Match the curves 1, 2, 3 and 4 from the graph to the terms in the table.
Match each curve only once.
curve from the graph
total fish production
individual growth
A. flat fish
at the bottom of shallow sea
B: tuna
in the open water in sea
C: angler-fish
at the bottom of deep sea
D: eel
predominantly at the
bottom of fresh water
Match the fish A, B, C and D from the picture to the gill surfaces in the table.
143
Gill surface per gramm body weight (in arbitrary units) of fish of various locations.
B 32:
gill surfaces
fish
2551
902
462
51
(3 pts) tem.
chemoautotrophic
producers
bacteriophages
predator (2)
predator
Write down the numbers from the figure at the appropriate place in the
following table.
144
th
organic waste
pantophage (omnivore)
saprophage (delritivores)
phytophage (herbivore)
decomposers
mycophages
parasitic animals
zoophage (predator I)
145
B 33: Genetically identical seedlings of the sunflower (Helianthus, As(2 pts) teraceae) were planted in two neighbouring gardens A and B.
After three months the plant height was measured with the following results:
garden
number of plants
average height
(in mm)
standard
deviation
A
B
12
16
1.6
1.4
0.3
0.2
(2)
critical t-value
1.32
1.71
2.06
2.48
2.78
Exercises:
(1)
S 2 S 2
S = A n + B n
A
B
Calculate the t-value and determine by which probability the null hypothesis can be rejected (the differences are significant). Mark with a
cross.
probability
146
< 90 %
95 to 97.5 %
99 to 99.5 %
th
90 to 95 %
97.5 to 99.0 %
> 99 %
SYSTEMATICS/TAXONOMY
B 34:
(2 pts)
(1)
Which fungus group does the fungus whose life cycle is shown belong to? Mark the correct answer with a cross.
Ascomycota
Basidiomycota
X
(2)
Zygomycota
Which kind of spores are spread at X?
haploid meiotic spores
(3)
(4)
B 35: A synapomorphy is a homologous characteristic of various spe(3 pts) cies (therefore Syn-), that has evolved/is derived (apomorphic)
compared with the primary absence or previous state of that
characteristic in other species. The original characteristic m
evolves into m and m on the one hand and to m* on the other
(see figure).
Note that m is apomorphic compared with m, but not compared
with m. M, N, O and P could be the taxa in which the characteristics occur.
Mark the statements which are compatible with the definition of synapomorphy.
m is a synapomorphy of N compared with m in M
m is a synapomorphy of N
m is a synapomorphy of NO (N plus O) compared with m in M
m is a synapomorphy of O compared with m in M
m is a synapomorphy of O
m is a synapomorphy of O compared with m* in P
m is a synapomorphy of O compared with the primary
absence of m in P
m is a synapomorphy of N compared with the primary
absence of m in M
148
th
ized
but nevertheless hypothetical stem species.
For calling a studied set of species monophyletic the proof of at
least one synapomorphy of this set is
necessary and sufficient
X
149
MICROBIOLOGY/BIOTECHNOLOGY
B 38: The diagram represents a sequence of reactions taking place in a
(2 pts.) bacterium, in which amino acids are produced from one another by
the action of specific enzymes. Numbers 1 to 6 represent different amino acids; letter V to Z represent different enzymes. All the
amino acids are essential for survival. The original strain of the bacterium required only amino acid 1. A mutant strain of the bacterium could only survive when provided with amino acids 1,2 and
5 in its culture medium. Which enzymes were missing in the
mutant strain?
V
4
X
6
Z
150
th
B 40:
X
151
152
th
Task 2:
Read the questions for both tasks and then decide in which order you would
like to work.
Please, do not forget to write down your personal data (Surname, First name,
Country, Code Number) in the space provided.
Task 1:
(14 pts)
Introducing remarks:
The required equipment and chemicals for the examination are at your bench.
Use the equipment and chemicals suitable for you examinations. Make several
cross sections through the penne of the leaf (figure 1). Stain these cross sections with the aqueous solutions of the dyes Astra-blue (stains cellulose) and
Auramin (stains lignin) and analyse the anatomic structures under the microscope. As supplementation you can make longitudinal and surface sections.
1 (1.1)
Label the given schematic drawing (figure 1). Write down the
(9 pts)
151
Code numbers:
1.
Cuticula
2.
Epidermis
3.
Hypodermis
4.
Spongy parenchyma
5.
Palisade parenchyma
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Transfusion tissue
Accessory transfusion
tissue
11.
Stomatic cells
1 (1.2) Which of the following systematical groups does the object refer
(2 pts) to? Mark with a cross.
Fern (Polypodiophyta, Pteridophyta)
Gymnosperms
Angiosperms
152
th
Task 2:
(24 pts)
Introducing remarks:
On your bench there are four vessels. In each vessel there is a flowering shoot
of a plant species. The species are labelled A, B, C and D. The required
equipment and a magnifying glass microscope are on your bench as well.
Analyse the given objects A, B, C and D morphologically. Answer the following
questions with the help of the answer code and fill in the corresponding code
numbers in the table below.
use
D1
as code numbers
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
1 (2.2) Which family name belongs to which species? Fill in the corre(8 pts) sponding code number in the table.
Code numbers:
1. Asteraceae 4.
4. Lamiaceae
2. Brassicaceae
5. Oleaceae
3. Fabaceae
6. Ranunculaceae
7. Rosaceae
153
1 (2.3) Which species have which kind of fruit (F 1 - F 7)? Fill in the
(4 pts) corresponding code number in the table.
Code numbers:
F 1. Achene
F 2. Follicular fruit
F 5. Aggregate of nutlets
F 3. Pulse
F 7.
Berry
B 4.
Thyrsus
B 2. Capitulum
B 5.
Bunch, Raseme
B 3. Panicle
B 6.
Solitary flower
B 7.
Volute
1 (2.5) Which species have which leaf arrangement? Fill in the corres(4 pts) ponding code number in the table.
Code numbers:
P 1. alternating
P 2. decussate
P 3. distichous
Table
A
Diagram
Family
Fruit
Inflorescence
Leaf arrangement
154
th
5.2.2
Introducing remarks:
Electron transfer through several redox systems to the terminal acceptor as it happens for instance in the endoxidation of the respiratory chain can be simulated in a
model experiment in a test tube, following the so-called BAUMANN experiment.
Add Fe2+ to a solution of sodium acetate containing the amino acid cysteine, shake it
for a short time and write down the colour immediately and after some minutes.
Shake the mixture again and write down the colour immediately and after some minutes etc.
Information: Cysteine forms a coloured compound with Fe3+, whereas Fe2+ does not.
COO
H3N+C
CH2SH
(=solution a).
It should be produced by mixing 0,2 M sodium acetate solution (solution b) with 82 mM cysteine solution (solution c).
CYSTEINE
H:1;
O: 16;
C: 12;
Na: 23.
1640 mg
155
O: 16;
C: 12;
S: 32;
N: 14.
1g
Obtain solution b (6 ml), solution c (6 ml) and the required Fe SO4 from the
assistant and start the experiment.
II: Procedure
2 (1.3) Mix solution b and solution c in the correct volume ratio to get
(2 pts) 10 ml of the required solution a.
The use of a pipette aid is obligatory.
Present your experiment and the remaining solutions immediately for judgement (score credit) to the laboratory advisor. Leave your pipette aid with the
laboratory advisor.
If you have made a mistake in the procedure you can get solution b and solution c again. In this case you cannot score in (3).
2 (1.4) Add FeSO4 to the solution a, plug the test tube with a stopper and
(1 pt)
2 (1.5) Leave the test tube open (without stopper) for 1-2 minutes. Which
(1 pt) colour does the solution have after this time? Mark with a cross.
156
th
red
white
green
blue-violet
(1 pt)
2 (1.8) The redox potential Eo of the system Fe3+ / Fe2+ is + 0,77 Volt.
(1 pt) Which redox potential does an e- donator of this system have?
Mark with a cross.
greater than + 0,77 V
equal to + 0,77 V
2 (1.9) Which value does the redox potential Eo of the e- terminal
(1 pt) acceptor have in the performed experiment? Mark with a cross.
157
2 (1.10) Which enzyme in the respiratory chain is analogous to the Fe(1 pt) system in the BAUMANN experiment? Mark with a cross.
NADH ubiquinone reductase
cytochrome oxidase
ATP synthase
ubiquinone cytochrome c reductase
2 (1.11) Complete the incomplete schematic drawing of the electron
(8 pt)
H2O
2e
2e
1/202
Cys-s-s-Cys
2 H+
158
th
I. Procedure:
2 (2.1) Observe the movement of the awns after moistening.
(2 pts) Put the air-dry spikelets together with the awns on a piece of paper and sprinkle the awns with water (use the sprayer) and observe (with the help of the magnifying glass as well) your object.
Which reactions can you observe? Mark with a cross.
No reaction
Both of the awns show a synergic rotation based on decoiling.
The awns do not touch each other.
Both of the awns show a synergic rotation based on spiralisation.
Occasionally they hook together and sometimes start saltatory
movements.
Both of the awns show a synergic rotation based on decoiling.
Occasionally they hook together and sometimes start saltatory
movements.
The movement of one awn is based on decoiling, the movement of
the other one on spiralisation.
159
II. Evaluation
2 (2.3) Texture and imbibition of cellulose
(3 pts) On your bench there are two pieces of typing paper. According to
the manufacturing process the cellulose fibres are essentially
longitudinally orientated.
2 (2.3a) Give the paper a good spray of water from both sides and decide
(1 pt)
160
th
2,3 %
Column 2
2 (2.5) Link the observations regarding the awn movement to the result
(2 pts) of the (4) pilot experiment (mental experiment).
Which texture are the movements of the awns based on?
Mark with a cross.
( aa )
( bb )
( ba )
( ab )
( ac )
161
5.2.3
tated
3 (1.1) Determine the correct order of the steps. Write down the code
(4 pts) letters of the following steps in the correct order.
A
Order: D, B, C. A...
3 (1.2) Assign one of the temperatures (T) and incubation times (I) given
(3 pts) below to each of the following steps.
Disruption of the cytoplasmic membran
T: .+ 600 C I: 2 min..
T: .
T: . +370 C. I: 10 min.
0 C,
2 min,
10 min,
15 min,
0
00 C I: 30 sec
30 min
+1000 C
th
Sample II:
164
th
interphase (1 pt)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
165
metacentric
acrocentric
dicentric
acentric
satellite chromosome
3 (2.3c) Label the parts of the larger chromosome using the code
(5 pts) numbers of the following terms.
1. chromosome arm
2. chromatide arm
3. daughter chromosome
4. centromere
Labelled drawings (task 3):
5. centrosome
6. satellite
7. nucleolus organisator region
8. nucleosome
166
th
tetraploid (4 n)
3 (2.6) Effects of the treatments (1) - (4) (see introducing remarks p.7)
(1 pt)
Match the treatments (1) - (4) to the effects you achieved. Write
down the numbers of the treatment in the corresponding circles.
inhibition of the centromere fission
inhibition of tubuline association
fixation of protoplasmic structures
shortening of the chromosomes
staining of the chromatine
staining of the nucleus spindle
destruction of the middle lamella
destruction of the primary walls
167
168
th
5.2.4
Task:
4 (1)
Move your thumb and index finger of one hand without any
(2 pts) optical control against each other. In which area do they touch
each other? Mark with a cross.
inner side of the thumb and outer side of the finger
outer side of the thumb and inner side of the finger
outer side of the thumb and outer side of the finger
inner side of the thumb and inner side of the finger
4 (2) How is this co-ordination possible? Mark with a cross.
(2 pts)
by learning
by ontogenetic maturing
by the construction of the skeleton
169
by neuronal decisions
by flexor and extensor muscles
4 (3)
170
th
4 (4)
(29 pts) man: Arrange 20 sunflower seeds in the sand-filled Petri dish I in
such a way that they lie flat, istributed over the whole dish, and
do not touch each other.
4 (4a) Grasp each seed one after the other with your thumb, index
(5 pts) finger and middle finger at the same time (triad grasp). All 20
seeds are put individually one after the other in the empty Petri
dish II. Measure the required time in minutes and seconds (e.g.
0:49 minutes) with the help of a stop-watch. Smoothen the
sand in dish I, transport all the seeds with the help of a pair of
forceps from dish II to dish I and weigh the sand (on a filter
paper, in mg) that has been transported from dish II when
grasping. Repeat the experiment 10 times, write down all data
and fill in the results in the table on page 11.
4 (4b) Grasp each seed from the smoothened sand with your
(5 pts) thumb and index finger only (forceps grasp). Repeat the
procedure from task (4.1).
Determine the time and the transported amount of sand in 10
experiments and fill in the data in the table on page 11.
4 (4c) Prepare the following experiment as described under (4.1).
(5 pts) However, this time a pair of forceps should be used for picking
up the seeds (tool grasp). Repeat the experiment 10 times,
measure the time and amount of sand and fill in the results in the
table on page 11.
4 (4d) Decide in which of the experiments the smallest amount of sand
(4 pts) (on average) was transported together with the seeds. Mark with
a cross.
smallest amount of sand in (4.1) (triad grasp)
smallest amount of sand in (4.2) (forceps grasp)
171
significant
insignificant difference
significant
insignificant difference
significant
insignificant difference
Table
experiment 1
exp. no.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
sum
mean
172
experiment 2
time (sec) sand (mg)
experiment 3
time (sec) sand (mg)
th
standard
deviation
Evaluation:
(1.) experiment 1:
experiment 2 (sand)
t =_______________;
(2.) experiment 1:
p
experiment 3 (sand)
t = _______________;
(3.) experiment 2:
p
experiment 3 (sand)
t = _______________;
x 1 s1 =
x2 s2 =
x3 s3 =
Degrees of freedom
m1 = n1 + n2 2
m2 = n1 + n3 2
(1.) experiment 1: experiment 2
2
s D = s1 + s2 =
m3 = n2 + n3 2
t=
x1 x2
sD
s D = s1 + s3 =
t=
x1 x3
sD
sD = s2 + s3 =
t=
x2 x3
sD
173
m
0,05
0,01
0,001
--------------------------------------------------18
2,10
2,88
3,92
174
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
C) Endodermis
D) Cortex parenchyma cells.
E) Pericycle
16. Which of the followings is the origin of multicellular branch roots?
A) Epidermis
B) Cortex
C) Endodermis
D) Tracheid
E) Pericycle
17. In order for a bacterium to produce an eucaryotic protein, which of the followings must first be
isolated from an eucaryotic cell prior to cloning?
A) The protein from the rough endoplasmic reticulum
B) The protein primary DNA transcript from the nucleus
C) The protein of mRNA from the cytoplasm
D) The segments of DNA that control transcription for this protein
E) The introns from the segment of DNA that codes for the protein
18. In humans the majority of ingested calcium is excreted in the:
A) Urine
B) Sweat
C) Plasma
D) Feces
19. The old blind man have not noticed the wasp in his cup of juice. It has string in his throat. What
is the best help for him?
A) To warm his neck
B) To give him some alcohol
C) To give him some cold water
D) To give him some sedative
E) To give him vomitory
20. Which of the following cells recognizes an antigen presented in combination with MHC II?
(Major Histocompatibility Complex II)
A) Suppresser cell
B) Cytotoxic cell
C) Neutrophil cell
D) Helper cell
E) Basophil cell
21. When humans movement become incorrect disorderly trembling and lose equilibrium and there
are pronunciation disorders and speech difficulties the lesion is found in:
A) Spinal cord
B) Thalamus
C) Hypothalamus
D) Medulla oblongata
E) Cerebellum
22. Which of the following structures is formed due to the transformation of the lateral organ?
A) Pressure receptors
B) Semicircular canals
C) Middle ear
D) Cohlea
E) Statocyst
23. Which of the followings depicts the pattern flow of energy and materials through an ecosystem?
A) Food chain
B) Biomass pyramid
C) Numbers pyramid
D) Food web
E) A and D
24. Into a large, tightly stoppered flask filled with nitrogen 100m1 of live yeast
made suspension in minimal medium containing 0.1 mole/l glucose as carbon source was
introduced. After 24 hours somewhat more than 100 ml of carbon dioxide (as measured under
standard conditions) accumulated in the flask (assume no carbon dioxide dissolves in the medium).
What was the approximate concentration of glucose in the medium at that moment?
A) Almost zero
B) 0.01 mole/l
C) 0.05 mole/l
D) 0.075mole/l
E) 0.09 mole/l
25. The principal constitute of myelin is
A) Carbohydrate
B) Lipid
C) Mucopolysaccharide
D) Nucleic acid
E) Protein
26. Various substances can affect the excitability of neuron. Calcium ions make a neuron less
excitable by:
A) Increasing the amount of sodium ions that enter the voltage gated sodium channels
B) Binding to the neurolemma, making it less permeable to potassium ions thus limiting
repolarization and reducing the action potential.
C) Binding to the proteins that make up the sodium channels thus reducing the amount of sodium
ions that can enter.
D) Binding to the active site of the sodium potassium pump which causes repolarization at a
voltage lower than -70 mV
E) Reacting with the negatively charged chlorine ion to form calcium chloride which neutralizes the
membrane potential.
27. In certain terrestrial animals the body surface has evolved as a respiratory structure. This is
characterized by
A)The presence of deep indentations in the body surface to facilitate the diffusion of gas deep into
the body.
B) The exchange of gas directly between all the body cells and the atmosphere
C) Special enzymes that allow for active transport of oxygen into the body and carbon dioxide out
of the body.
D) The counter current exchange of carbon dioxide and oxygen between the air and mucus
covering the animals' body surface.
E) The presence of blood vessels close to the surface to receive and transport oxygen to other
body regions.
28. The function of RUGAE in the stomach is to ______________ .
A) Crush the food
B) Increase the capacity of the stomach.
C) Secrete amylase
D) By muscular contractions, mix the food with gastric juices
E) Increase the surface area for secretion
29. Which statement is false in comparing Metanephridia with protonephridia?
A) Metanephridia have a tuft of cilia to move fluids along while
protonephiridia only have a single flagellum.
B) The metanephridium is open at both ends
C) Metanephridia are surrounded by capillaries which permits useful materials to be reabsorbed
and returned to the circulation
D) Useful materials are reabsorbed in the metanephridia.
E) Water is conserved and urine is concentrated
30. In a colony of honey bees, the dominance of the queen is maintained by the
A) Provision of eggs by the queen
B) Secretion of pheromones by the queen
C) Suppression of sexual development of the workers
D) None of the above
31. Substitution of a nitrogen base in a gene can resulted in:
A) Nonsense mutation
B) Frame shift mutation
C) Missense mutation
D) Silent mutation
E) All kinds of the above mentioned mutations except B
32. The frequency of crossovers between linked genes A and B is 30% between B and C is 40%,
between C and D is 45%, between A and C is 10%, between B and D is 5%. The sequence of
genes on chromosome is :
A) ABCD or DCBA
B) BDCA or ACDB
C) CABD or DBAC
D) DBCA or ACBD
E) DCAB or BACD
33. Some mammals have no collar bone in their shoulder girdle. A typical feature of these
mammals is;
A) Being arboreal
B) Being aquatic
C) Being capable of soaring or active flight
D) Having mobility of forelimbs limited to one plane only
E) Neither of the features given above
34. How old are the earliest known fossils of the genus Homo ?
A) Several hundred thousand years
B) 1-9 million years
C) 10-19 million years
D) 20-100 million years
E) More than 100 million years
35. Which of the followings makes up the inner bark of a woody plant?
A) Primary phloem
B) Secondary phloem
C) Primary xylem
D) Secondary xylem
E) Pith
36. Which of the following statements about the upper and lower epidermis is correct?
A) Lower epidermis cells are living parenchyma cells while upper epidermis cells are not.
B) Upper epidermis cells' wall on the outside of the leaf is thicker than on the inside while it is not
valid for lower epidermis.
C) Upper epidermis cells are relatively transparent while lower epidermis cells contain chloroplasts.
D) The upper epidermis has a thicker cuticle than the lower epidermis.
E) The lower epidermis mostly contains lots of trichomes while there is no trichome in the upper
epidermis.
37. The resemblance between one orchid species and female wasps is so strong that male wasps
mount the flowers and attempt to copulate with them. This is an example of:
A) Parasitism
B) Coevolution
C) Artificial selection
D) Adaptive radiation
E) Selective breeding
38. Fruits that form from a single flower that contains many separate carpels, are referred to as:
A) Accessory fruits
B) Aggregate fruits
C) Dry fruits
D) Multiple fruits
E) Simple fruits
39. How do shade-avoiding plants respond when they absorb more far-red light?
A) They produce more leaves
B) They grow additional parts
C) They branch extremely
D) They grow taller
E) They stop growing
40. Plants respond to wounding by herbivorous insects by producing a plant polypeptide known as
___________ that may trigger the plant to produce proteinase inhibitors that disrupt insect
digestion.
A) Florigen
B) Polyamine
C) Phytoalexin
D) Salicylic acid
E) Systemin
4l. Which of the following models maintains that populations diverge from one another by the slow
accumulation of adaptive characteristics within each population?
A) Punctuated equilibrium
B) Paedomorphosis
C) Hybridization
D) Gradualism
E) Allopoliploidy
42. Proteins synthesized in E-coli have which of the followings at their terminal end?
A) N- formyl- methionine
B) N- acetyl- adenine
C) Adenine triphosphate
D) The AUG codon
E) The UUU codon.
43. Which of the followings are the ancestors of mitochondria and chloroplasts according to
endosymbiosis theory respectively?
A) Purple sulfur bacteria, cyanobacteria
B) Purple non-sulfur bacteria, cyanobacteria
C) Purple sulfur bacteria, green algae
D) Purple non- sulfur bacteria, green algae
E) None of the above
44. Catabolite activator protein __________________ .
A) Increases the affinity of the promoter region for RNA polymerase
B) Decreases RNA polymerase activity
C) Becomes nonfunctional when it binds to cAMP
D) Both A and B are true
E) Both A and C are true
45. The lactose operon regulates the synthesis of ________________ .
A) b - galactosidase
B) Galactoside transacetylase
C) Galactose transferase
D) Both A and B
E) A, B, C are correct
46. TATA box is seen in ________ cells and is the site where ___________ .
A) Procaryotic; RNA polymerase binds
B) Eucaryotic cells; DNA ligase cleaves introns
C) Multicellular eucaryotes, RNA polymerase binds
D) All of the above are true
E) None of the above is true
47. How may recombinant genes be introduced into monocotyledons?
A) By the use of Ti vectors
B) By the use of plasmids as vectors
C) By the use of genetic shotguns
D) By the use of radioactive probes
E) None of the above
48. Which of the followings can be used as DNA vectors?
A) Bacteriophages
B) Plasmids
C) E- coli cells
D) Both A and B
E) Both A and C
49. Immunoglobulins, designated ________ increase antimicrobial activity in mucus.
A) Ig A
B) Ig E
C) Ig G
D) Ig M
E) Ig Z
50. Antibody- mediated responses work best against _______________ .
A) Intracellular pathogens.
B) Extracellular pathogens
C) Toxins
D) B and C
E) All of the above.
51. Which of the followings is wrong?
A) The peroxysomes in plant cells are also called glyoxysomes
B) Peroxysomes and glyoxysomes contain enzymes that degrade fatty acids
C) Peroxysomes are present in the photosynthetic cell of green plants
D) Microbodies are cytochemically defined by their catalase activity
52. Which of the followings is true?
++
A) Dynein is a Ca ATPase and generates the energy for the bending of the ciliurn and flagellum.
B) The initial polymerization of tubulin often occurs at certain regions of the cell termed microtubule
organizing centers (MTOCs).
++
C) If cells are microinjected with Ca microtubule disassembly is blocked and assembly is
promoted.
D) Desmin is a kind of microfilament.
E) Desmin is not found in cardiac or smooth muscle.
53. Which of the following statements is wrong?
A) The nuclear lamina is composed of four different polypeptides termed lamins.
B) The lamins are intermediate filaments.
C) Nuclear envelope contains structural proteins but does not contain any enzymes.
D) Small molecules enter the nucleus more readily than do large ones.
E) All of them is true
54. In eucaryotes there are commonly three different RNA polymerases, which act at different
promoters to transcribe the various kinds of RNA in the cell. Which of the followings about the RNA
polymerase I is true in eucaryotes?
C) Centrifugation
D) Increasing pH
E) Both A and C are true
63. Which of the following areas of the world produce the most O2 per year?
A) Temperate forests
B) Grasslands
C) Lakes and streams
D) Oceans
64. The concentration of phytoplancton is significantly lower in open seas than in coastal waters. It
is commonly believed that this is caused directly by:
A) Insufficient abundance of mineral nutrients
B) Too low concentration of dissolved carbon dioxide
C) Insufficient mixing of water
D) Massive presence of phytoplanctophagous fish
E) Too high salinity
65. Lianas and epiphytes are especially common in:
A) Tropical rain forests
B) Savannah
C) Temperate grassland
D) Taiga
66. Lichens are most typically formed by the symbiotic association of an alga or cyanobacterium
and a(n) :
A) Ascomycota
B) Deuteromycota
C) Basidiomycota
D) Zygomycota
E) Spirochete
67. The logistic equation:
A) Models an S-shaped growth curve
B) Takes into account the carrying capacity
C) Shows continued exponential growth
D) Both A and B
E) Both B and C
68. At which of the given times should the C02 concentration in the forest be at the highest level
each day during the summer?
A) Just before sunrise
B) Noon
C) Just before sunset
D) Midnight
69. Clumped dispersion is typically influenced by :
A) Social behavior such as family groups
B) Asexual reproduction in plants or invertebrates
C) Limited seed dispersal in plants
D) A patchy distribution of resources
E) All of these
70. The area of greatest seasonal ozone depletion is in the:
A) Stratosphere above the Arctic
B) Stratosphere above the Antarctic
C) Troposphere above the Arctic
D) Troposphere above the Antarctic
E) Lithosphere above the Arctic
88. In chemiosmosis hydrogen ions (protons) release their energy to produce ATP as they pass
through _______________________ .
A) The outer mitochondrial membrane
B) ATP synthase
C) ATP dehydrogenase
D) ATP decarboxylase
E) A group of electron carriers
89. Tetanus toxin inhibits the breakdown of acetyhcholine at the myoneural junction. This effects
muscle contraction by _____________ .
A) Not allowing the muscle to contract
B) Preventing the muscle from relaxing
C) Preventing calcium from entering the muscle
D) Inhibiting potassium from leaving the muscle
E) Stopping the formation of actomyosin
90. Protein leaves the interstitial fluid and enters the circulatory system:
A) Through pores on the arterial side of a capillary bed
B) Through pores on the venous side of a capillary bed
C) By being phagocytized and transported to the blood through eosinophils
D) Via the lymphatics which deposits them into the subclavian vein
E) By active transport mediated by permeases in the capillary epithelium
91. In the citric acid cycle, two acetyl CoA molecules are metabolized to:
A) 2 CO2 + 2 ATP + 2 NADH + 2 FADH
B) 4 C02 + 6 NADH + 2 FADH2 + 2 ATP
C) Fructose 1,6 biphosphate
D) Glucose + 2 C02 + 2 NADH + 2 FADH2 + 2 ATP
E) 2 PGAL
92. Which of the followings is true?
A) Lactose operon in E. coli is only controlled by negative control by the lactose repressor
B) When E.coli is grown in the presence of both glucose and lactose, both glucose and lactose is
utilized
C) Catabalite gene activator protein (CAP) has no influence on transcription until ATP has bound to
it
D) Different proteins that are coded by a same mRNA molecule are always produced in similar
numbers
E) DNA repair genes at many different sites on the chromosome are regulated by only a single
repressor in prokaryots
93. A mRNA "cap'' :
A) Marks the mRNA for degradation
B) Serves as the attachment point for a poly-A tail
C) Prevents translation
D) Decreases the half - life of the mRNA
E) None of the answers is correct
94. Which of the followings can be found on a completed bacterial mRNA?
A) Intron region
B) A leader sequence
C) A primer sequence
D) Poly A tail
E) None of them
95. In an E-coli bacterium, there are three types of DNA polymerase which are called DNA
polymerase I, DNA polymerase III and DNA polymerase II. Which of the followings about the
functions of these enzymes is wrong?
A) All of them have 5' 3' polymerization activity
B) Only DNA polymerase II has not the 5' 3' exonuclease activity
C) Only DNA polymerase I and III have the 3' 5' exonuclease activity
D) DNA polymerase I has the capacity to remove the RNA primers
E) DNA polymerase III makes up the Okazaki fragments
96. Which of the followings is not correct for CAM plants?
A) Crassulacean Acid Metabolism is found in fewer than 5 percent of plants
B) Although the cell could not metabolize normally if the acid accumulated in the cytoplasm,
throughout the night more and more malic acid is produced and stored in the cell's vacuole,
building a reservoir of fixed CO2
C) Malic acid is broken down into C02 and pyruvate during day-time. It is then that CO2 becomes
fixed to RBP
D) CAM synthesis helps to conserve precious water by separating the time of CO 2 fixation; the light
reactions, and the Calvin cycle
97. Which of the following amino acids enter the Crebs cycle via being converted to ketoglutaric
acids?
A) 2- carbon amino acids
B) 3- carbon amino acids
C) 4- carbon amino acids
D) 5- carbon amino acids
98. Intolerance to cold and myxodema are typically seen in ____________ .
A) Hyperthyroidism
B) Hypothyroidism
C) Acromegaly
D) Cretinism
99. What's the effect of insulin in adipose tissue?
A) It stimulates glucose uptake
B) It stimulates lipolysis
C) It stimulates hormone-sensitive lipase and lipoprotein lipase
D) It stimulates urea synthesis
100. The largest white blood cell in humans which is a part of the body's macrophage defense
system is:
A) Neutrophil
B) Lymphocyte
C) Monocyte
D) Eusinophil
E) Basophil
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
B) Isogamous
C) Anisogamous
D) Conjugation
E) Vegetative
8. MATERIAL NUMBER: 4
The shape of chloroplast is
A) Star
B) Oval
C) Spiral
D) Rod
E) Circle
9. MATERIAL NUMBER: 5
The shape of bacteria is
A) Spirillum
B) Bacillus
C) Coccus
D) Vibrio
E) Staphylococcus
10. MATERIAL NUMBER: 5
The group of bacteria is
A) Gram (+)
B) Gram (-)
C) Gram (+) and Gram (-)
D) One flagellated
E) Poly flagellated
11. MATERIAL NUMBER: 6
The shape of bacteria is
A) Spirillum
B) Bacillus
C) Coccus
D) Vibrio
E) Staphylococcus
12. MATERIAL NUMBER: 6
The group of bacteria is
A) Gram (+)
B) Gram (-)
C) Gram (+) and Gram (-)
D) One flagellated
E) Many flagellated
13. MATERIAL NUMBER: 7
The number of flagella on the bacteria is
A) 0
B) 1
C) 2
D) 4
E) Many
14. MATERIAL NUMBER: 8
The shape of bacteria is
A) Staphylococcus
B) Diplococcus
C) Streptococcus
D) Micrococcus
E) Spirillum
15. MATERIAL NUMBER: 9
The shape of bacteria is
A) Staphylococcus
B) Diplococcus
C) Streptococcus
D) Micrococcus
E) Spirillum
16. MATERIAL NUMBER: 10
Which of the followings includes this organism?
A) Zygomycota
B) Ascomycete
C) Basidiomycete
D) Phaeophceae
E) Rhodophyta
17. MATERIAL NUMBER: 10
The structure includes
A) Only sporangium
B) Only zygote
C) Sporangium and zygote
D) Only egg.
E) Egg and sperms
18. MATERIAL NUMBER: 11
Which of the followings includes this organism?
A) Zygomycota
B) Ascomycete
C) Basidiomycete
D) Phaeophceae
E) Rhodaphyta
19. MATERIAL NUMBER: 11
The organism includes..................in its structure.
A) Zygote
B) Lamellate structure
C) Basidium
D) Gametophyte
E) Ascus
20. MATERIAL NUMBER: 12
The dark structures on the section of this fungus are..
A) Spores
B) Spore vesicles
C) Ascus
D) Zygote
E) Hypha
D) Liliaceae
E) Muscopsida
35. MATERIAL NUMBER: 21
This section consists of..
A) Only cork cambium
B) Only lenticel
C) Only cork tissue
D) Only cork cambium and lenticel
E) Cork cambium, lenticel, cork
36. MATERIAL NUMBER: 22
This section of leaf belongs to a plant.
A) Polyticum
B) Pinus
C) Marchantia
D) Triticum
E) Quercus
37. MATERIAL NUMBER: 23
This leaf belongs to a.. plant.
A) Hydrophytic
B) Succulent
C) Mesophytic
D) Xerophytic
E) Carnivore
38. MATERIAL NUMBER: 24
This leaf belongs to a.. plant.
A) Hydrophytic
B) Succulent
C) Mesophytic
D) Xerophytic
E) Carnivore
39. MATERIAL NUMBER: 25
This leaf belongs to a.. plant.
A) Hydrophytic
B) Succulent
C) Mesophytic
D) Xerophytic
E) Carnivore
40. MATERIAL NUMBER: 26
This flower belongs to a .. plant.
A) Triticum
B) Lamium
C) Syringa
D) Opuntia
E) Ginkgo
41. MATERIAL NUMBER: 27
This structure which belongs to a lilium is...
A) Ovulary
B) Tetrad
C) Anther
D) Embryo
E) Seed
42. MATERIAL NUMBER: 28
This tissue which is seen at the outermost part of the stem is. ..
A) Epidermis
B) Cork
C) Lenticel
D) Stoma
E) Trichome
43. MATERIAL NUMBER: 29
The supportive tissue in this structure is
A) Sclereid
B) Schlerenchyma
C) Collenchyma
D) Tracheid
E) Trachea
44. MATERIAL NUMBER: 30
The crystal shape in this tissue is a.
A) Raphides
B) Druse
C) Prism
D) Cubic
E) Sand
45. MATERIAL NUMBER: 31
The pink lines between the lumens are.
A) Middle lamella
B) Secondary cell wall
C) Primary cell wall
D) Plasmodesmata
E) Edged passage
46. MATERIAL NUMBER: 32
Which of the followings isnt found in this root structure?
A) Epidermis
B) Cortex
C) Starch
D) Vascular bundle
E) Cork cambium
A) Cilia
B) Flagellum
C) Pseudopod
D) Myosin filament
E) Flow of water
8. MATERIAL NUMBER: 4
This organism is
A) Euglena
B) Paramecium
C) Chlorella
D) Plasmodium
E) Vorticella
9. MATERIAL NUMBER: 4
This organism moves using
A) Cilia
B) Flagellum
C) Pseudopod
D) Myosin filament
E) Flow of water
10. MATERIAL NUMBER: 5
The reproductive pattern of this single celled organism is
A) Conjugation
B) Fission
C) Isogamy
D) Anisogamy
E) Autogamy
11. MATERIAL NUMBER: 6
This organism is
A) Euglena
B) Trypanosome
C) Chlamydomonas
D) Chlorella
E) Vorticella
12. MATERIAL NUMBER: 7
This organism belongs to
A) Hydrozoan
B) Scyphozoan
C) Anthozoan
D) Euspongia
E) Oligochaete
13. MATERIAL NUMBER: 7
This reproduction pattern is..
A) Conjugation
B) Isogamy
C) Budding
D) Oogamy
E) Fission
D) Centrolecithal
E) Polylecithal
28. MATERIAL NUMBER: 13
The type of segmentation is
A) Superficial
B) Mesoblastic
C) Meroblastic
D) Holoblastic
E) Discoidal
29. MATERIAL NUMBER: 13
. show this kind of division.
A) Frogs
B) Birds
C) Turtles
D) Starfish
E) Salamander
30. MATERIAL NUMBER: 14
This blastula stage is formed by..............type egg.
A) Isolecithal
B) Mesolecithal
C) Telolecithal
D) Centrolecithal
E) Polylecithal
31. MATERIAL NUMBER: 14
The type of segmentation.
A) Superficial
B) Mesoblastic
C) Meroblastic
D) Holoblastic
E) Discoidal
32. MATERIAL NUMBER: 14
This blastula stage is formed by.
A) Frogs
B) Birds
C) Turtles
D) Starfish
E) Salamander
33. MATERIAL NUMBER: 15
This structure is the. tissue of a mammal.
A) Cartilage
B) Bone
C) Pancreas
D) Thyroid
E) Secretory
34. MATERIAL NUMBER: 15
The big gap in the middle is..
A) Secretory Channels
B) Langerhans Islands
C) Secretory Lumen
D) Haversian Channels
E) Chondrocytes sets
35. MATERIAL NUMBER: 16
This blood tissue belongs to..
A) Locusta
B) Myotis
C) Cebus
D) Lumbricus
E) Anuran
36. MATERIAL NUMBER: 17
Circular structure observed in the cross section of skin is..
A) Adipose tissue
B) Vater paccini
C) Crause
D) Ruffini
E) Meissner
37. MATERIAL NUMBER: 17
The duty of this structure is..
A) Storing lipid
B) Sense the pressure
C) Sensing the high temperature
D) Sensing the low temperature
E) Secreting sweat
38. MATERIAL NUMBER: 18
This vessel that cats have is
A) Artery
B) Vena
C) Arteriole
D) Lymphatic
E) Arteriosclerosis Vena
39. MATERIAL NUMBER: 19
The type of epithelium is..
A) Transitional
B) Pseudo Stratified
C) Stratified
D) Cubic
E) Goblet
40. MATERIAL NUMBER: 20
This person, whose bar bodies has been stained, has..
A) XX
B) XY
C) XXX
D) XXY
E) XXXY
41. MATERIAL NUMBER: 21
These jaw bones belongs to
A) Mammalia
B) Piciformes
C) Testudinate
D) Caudata
E) Teleostei
42. MATERIAL NUMBER: 22
This skull belongs to.
A) Anura
B) Myotis
C) Lacerta
D) Clupea
E) Petromyzon
43. MATERIAL NUMBER: 23
This tooth belongs to
A) Strix
B) Ciconia
C) Sycliorhinus
D) Ascidia
E) Dryocopus
44. MATERIAL NUMBER: 24
This human bone is.
A) Atlas
B) Lumbar
C) Thoracic
D) Cervical
E) Axis
45. MATERIAL NUMBER: 25
This human bone is.
A) Atlas
B) Lumbar
C) Thoracic
D) Cervical
E) Axis
E. Ascidia
8- MATERIAL NUMBER: 5
This organism belongs to ............................
A. Turbellaria
B. Trematoda
C. Cestoda
D. Hirudinea
E. Polychaeta
9- MATERIAL NUMBER: 6
This organism belongs to .................................
A. Turbellaria
B. Trematoda
C. Cestoda
D. Hirudinea
E. Polychaeta
10- MATERIAL NUMBER: 6
The name of the species in this slide is ............
A. Nereis
B. Hirudo
C. Asterias
D. Polycellis
E. Scolopendra
11- MATERIAL NUMBER: 7
This organism belongs to .................................
A. Crustacea
B. Chelicerata
C. Tracheata
D. Chilopoda
E. Homoptera
12- MATERIAL NUMBER: 7
This organism has ............................. antennae
A. No
B. One pair
C. Two pairs
D. Four pairs
E. Six
13- MATERIAL NUMBER: 7
The name of the species in this slide is .................................
A. Astacus
B. Daphnia
C. Cyclops
D. Areneus
E. Aphis
14- MATERIAL NUMBER: 8
This organism belongs to ............................
A. Crustacea
B. Chelicerata
C. Tracheata
D. Chilopoda
E. Hymenoptera
15- MATERIAL NUMBER: 8
This organism has ....................... antennae
A. No
B. One pair
C. Two pairs
D. Four pairs
E. Six
16- MATERIAL NUMBER: 8
The name of the species in this slide is .................................
A. Ixodes
B. Scolopendra
C. Pedinculus
D. Leptinotarsa
E. Gerris
17- MATERIAL NUMBER: 8
The the number of legs in this organism is ...........................
A. Two pairs
B. Three pairs
C. Four pairs
D. Six pairs
E. Eight pairs
18- MATERIAL NUMBER: 9
This organism belongs to ................................
A. Diptera
B. Hymenoptera
C. Anoplura
D. Isoptera
E. Odonata
19- MATERIAL NUMBER: 9
Mouth parts are ........................
A. Sucker
B. Chewer
C. Piercing
D. Chelicer
E. Lapping for pollen grains
20- MATERIAL NUMBER: 9
The name of the species in this slide is ...........
A. Ichneumon
B. Leptinotarsa
C. Aphis
D. Anopheles
E. Pedinculus
21- MATERIAL NUMBER: 10
This organism belongs to ...........................
A. Diptera
B. Hymenoptera
C. Anoplura
D. Isoptera
E. Odonata
22- MATERIAL NUMBER: 10
Mouth parts are
A. Piercing
B. Chewer
C. Licking
D. Chelicer
E. Lapping for pollen grains
23- MATERIAL NUMBER: 10
This the number of legs in this organism is .....................
A. Two pairs
B. Three pairs
C. Four pairs
D. Six pairs
E. Eight pairs
24- MATERIAL NUMBER: 10
The name of the species in this slide is ................
A. Drosophila
B. Araneus
C. Formica
D. Gerris
E. Ixodes
25- MATERIAL NUMBER: 10
This is organism has ...................... antennae
A. No
B. One pair
C. Two pair
D. Four pair
E. Six
26- MATERIAL NUMBER: 11
This organism belongs to ..........................
A. Diptera
B. Hymenoptera
C. Anoplura
D. Isoptera
E. Odonata
27- MATERIAL NUMBER: 11
This number of legs in this organism is ............
A. Two pairs
B. Three pairs
C. Four pairs
D. Six pairs
E. Eight pairs
28- MATERIAL NUMBER: 11
The name of the species in this slide is .............
A. Drosophila
B.
C.
D.
E.
Araneus
Pediculus
Gerris
Ixodes
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
Solanaceae
Magnoliaceae
Rosaceae
Rununculaceae
Brassicaceae
Answer the question 2,3,4,5,6 according to the given information below. In the sitophilus
oryzae population density dependent egg laying number is given below.
Number of mite=128
Number of wheat seeds=200
The number of eggs that a female lay in each day=1,6
The number of eggs found in each seed=2,56
Percentage of adults getting out from eggs=~70
Percentage of seeds that doesnt have any egg=5,0
Female, male ratio=1
2. Number of wheat mite for each seed?
A) 32.8 B) 1.56 C) 3.2 D) 0.64 E) 6.4
3. The total number of eggs that females lay everyday?
A) 204.8
B) 512
C) 327.6
D) 140
E) 102.4
4. The total number of eggs in the seeds is
A) 512
B) 327.6
C) 486.4
D) 163.8
E) 304
5. The number of seeds with egg is
A) 10
B) 6.4
C) 64
D) 100
E) 190
6. The total number of eggs that give rise to adults..
A) 358
B) 229
C) 340
D) 114
E) 212
Answer the question 7,8,9,10,11,12 according to the information given below. The
numbers of female and male individuals in the Panaeus incidus population (for each
season) is given below
..........................Number of.................Number of
............................MALES....................FEMALES
Winter......................130..............................142
Spring.......................60................................67
Summer....................482.............................458
Fall...........................243.............................246
7. Whats the maximum population size in year
A) 915
B) 913
C) 1828
D) 940
E) 518
8. The number of maximum female individuals in a year.
A) 915
B) 913
C) 458
D) 482
E) 1828
9. The season, in which the percentage of males is the highest, is
A) Winter
B) Spring
C) Summer
D) Fall
E) All seasons are same
10. Whats the maximum percentage of male individuals in a year?
A) 54
B) 47.7
C) 51
D) 49
E) 50.05
11. The season in which the mortality number is the highest.
A) Winter
B) Fall
C) Spring
D) Summer
12. The season in which the mortality percent is the highest..
A) Winter
B) Fall
C) Spring
D) Summer
Answer the questions 13,14,15,16,17 according to information given below.
Following figure compares the terrestrial and aquatic areas.
...........................................TERRESTRIAL AREA...................AQUEOUS AREA
Total Area....................................149x106 km2.................................361x106 km2
Total Net Primary Production......120x109 ton/year ............................60x109 ton/year
Total Secondary Production..........0.8x109 ton/year............................3.0x109 ton/year
Total Food
(Both animal and plant made)........1.3x109 ton/year...........................17.0x109 ton/year
13. Total net primary product per km2 on terrestrial area for a year is
A) 85
B) 8.50 x 102
C) 805.369
D) 8.5 x 103
E) 8505 x 102
14. Total secondary product per km2 on terrestrial area for a year is..
A) 53x102
B) 5.369
C) 5.3x103
D) 0.053
E) 0.53
15. Total food per km2 on terrestrial area for a month is..
A) 7.27
B) 0.72x103
C) 2.7x102
D) 0.727
E) 0.00727
16. Total net primary product per km2 on aqueous area for a month
is.
A) 1.3x103
B) 13.850
C) 138
D) 1.3x102
E) 0.0138
17. Total secondary product per km2 on aqueous area for a month
is
A) 6.92
B) 0.0069
C) 609.2
D) 60.29
E) 0.692
18. Total food per km2 on aqueous area for a year is..
A) 47.091
B) 4.7
C) 47.7x103
D) 47.7x102
E) 4.7
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
grow better than the C3 plant after one year in that condition;
grow slower than the C3 plant after one year in that condition;
be able to survive longer than the C3 plant, but ultimately die; +
be able to survive not as long as the C3 plant.
18%;
32%;
36%;
64%. +
content
glucose + homogenised cells;
glucose + mitochondria;
glucose + cytoplasm lacking organelles;
pyruvic acid + homogenised cells;
pyruvic acid + mitochondria;
pyruvic acid + cytoplasm lacking
organelles.
1,2 and 3;
1,4 and 5; +
3,4 and 6;
3,5 and 6.
a)
b)
c)
d)
1
brown rat
brown rat
kangaroo rat
kangaroo rat
2
coypu
kangaroo rat
brown rat
coypu
3
kangaroo rat;
coypu;
coypu; +
brown rat.
the tissues from the patient and from potential donors are matched; +
the cornea has almost no blood or lymphatic vessels associated with it;
drugs and X-rays have been used to destroy T-lymphocytes;
most patients do not have immune system.
11. The heavy line in the graph above illustrates the relationship
between auxin concentration and cell growth in stem tissues. If the
same range of concentrations were applied to lateral buds, what curve
would probably be produced?
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
I; +
II;
III;
IV;
either I or III.
12.
B cell;
T cell; +
mast cell;
mucrophage;
plasma cell.
stroma;
cytosol;
space enclosed by the thylakoid membranes; +
space enclosed by the inner and outer membranes.
14.
What is the type of life cycle of green algae shown in the Fig. above?
a)
b)
c)
d)
haplontic type; +
diplontic type;
isomorphic diplohaplontic type;
heteromorphic diplohaplontic type.
15. Red algae differ from the green algae and brown algae in having:
a)
b)
c)
d)
no chlorophyll a;
no differentiated cells;
no phycocyanin within their cells;
no flagellated stages in their life cycles.+
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
A;
B;
C;
D;
E.
epidermis;
collenchyma;
sclerenchyma;
parenchyma. +
19. Tissues that form long, tough strands, as in the leaf stalk of celery,
are:
a)
b)
c)
d)
epidermis;
collenchyma;
sclerenchyma; +
parenchyma.
1,3,5;
2,4;
3,4,5;+
4,5.
1, 2, 4; +
2, 3, 4;
3, 4, 5;
1, 2;
3, 5.
23. One of the most widely used natural insecticides are the toxins
produced by
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
Bacillus thuringiensis; +
Salmonella sp.;
Bacillus stereothermophelis;
Bacillus cereus;
Escherichia coli.
a)
b)
c)
d)
P and Q;
Q and R;
Q and S; +
R and S.
25. For the next ten items refer to the data plotted on the following
graph.
Use statements, which are supported by the data of this graph.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
3, 8;+
1, 2, 6, 7;
4, 5, 9, 10;
3, 6, 10;
1, 8.
26. The following are statements about the female reproductive system.
Respond by true.
1. Both oestrogen and progesterone are necessary for ovulation to take
place;
2. Oestrogen tends to inhibit the production of FSH by the anterior pituitary
gland;
3. Fertilization of the ovum by the spermatozoon normally takes place in the
uterus;
4. Progesterone production is largely under the control of Lh;
5. Throughout the part of the mensual cycle that follows ovulation, there is
a slight rise in body temperature.
a) 1, 2, 5;
b) 1, 3, 5;
c) 2, 3, 4;
d) 2, 4, 5;+
e) 5.
27. A man of blood group A has 2 children. Plasma from the blood of
one
of them agglutinates his red cells while that from the other does not.
Choose correct statements.
1. Father must be heterozygous group (A).
2. Children must have different mothers.
3. "Agglutinating" child could be group O.
4. Mother of "agglutinating" child must be group O.
5. "Non-agglutinating" child could be group AB.
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
1, 2, 5;
1, 3, 5;+
2, 3, 4;
2, 4, 5;
5.
concentration of bile;
salivation;
glomerular filtration; +
sweating;
29. If (Rh+) blood is transfused into an (Rh-) woman who has not
previously
been transfused, then:
(Choose correct statements.).
8
1.
2.
3.
4.
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
1, 3;
2, 4;
1, 2, 4;+
2, 3, 4;
1, 2, 3, 4.
31.
10
34. The main organ which produces glucose from lactic acid is:
a)
b)
c)
d)
kidneys;
liver; +
spleen;
intestines epithelium.
actin;
myosin;
dynein; +
kinesin;
ATP;
electrohimical potential;
phosphorylation;
phosphoendpiruvate;
transposition;
transformation;
transversion;
transduction. +
11
T- lymphocytes; +
B-limphocytes;
monocytes;
neutrophilus;
basophilus.
41. A heron standing in a cold water for a long time doesnt get its legs
overchilled because of:
a)
b)
c)
d)
countercirculation in limbs ; +
even thin sat layer under limbsskin;
branched blood stream in limbs:
intensive metabolism in limbs.
diabetes;
influenza;
malaria;
dysentery. +
hypophysis;
cerebellum;
epiphysis; +
diencephalon.
45. The following creatures are natural carriers of the agent plague of
human being in the nature:
a)
b)
c)
d)
wolves, foxes;
birds;
rodents; +
a human being.
12
c) turtles (chelonia); +
d) crocodiles (crocodilia);
47. Ectoderm, endoderm and mesoderm develop into tissues and
organs.Which of the following combinations is correct?
Ectoderm
a)
b)
c)
d)
nervous system
nervous system
skin
epidermis
mesoderm
blood
large intestine
bones
liver
endoderm
lungs; +
lungs;
kidneys;
heart.
48. The corn culm diameter is determined by the activity of the following
type of meristem:
a)
b)
c)
d)
primary; +
secondary;
primary and secondary;
first primary then secondary.
51. Mammals arterial blood flows through veins and venous blood
though arteries:
a)
b)
c)
d)
13
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
Psilophyta;+
Rhuniophyta;
Phaeophita;
Rhodophyta;
Cylorophyta.
54. Which of the following higher plants was brown coal formed from?
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
jointweeds;
ferns;
lycopodiums;
gymnosperms;
rborescentflowering plants.
cytoplasm;
nucleus;
canalicular apparatus;+
cell center.
14
d) plastids;
e) canalicula apparatus.+
58. Gibberellins (substances of plants growing) are:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
phospholipids;
three acyl glycerol;
wax;
steroids;
terpenes.+
59 Gens for ribosomal RNA in chromosomes are situated in the area of:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
telomere;
primary stretching;
kinetochore;
satellite;
secondary stretching.+
carbohydrates;
N-terminal protein sequence;+
C-terminal protein sequence;
lipids;
ions.
61. What is the main factor to limit the increasing of general biomass on
the definite territory?
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
62. Spatial structure of actin-myosin system is put into the basis of the
muscular tissues classification. According to this way of approach all
muscular tissues of multicellular are divided into three types:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
15
diameter of axon;
distance between Runves interception and amplitude of action potential;
magnitude of rest potential and size of;
a.&b;+
a.&c.
65. In nature there are only several main mechanisms of moving which
are used by different groups of animals in different ways. This is:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
66. The high limit of force (in relative magnitudes) is approximately the
same for locomory muscles of different animals. It can be explained in
following way:
a) the force of muscle doesnt depend on area of cross-section;
b) the force of the muscle doesnt depend on it belonging to phasic or
postural groups of muscles;
c) the force of muscles contraction depends on quantaty of myofibrillas that
take part in contraction;+
d) the force of muscles contraction depends on reserve of ATP in muscles
cell;
e) the force of muscles contraction is limited by entrance of O2 .
67. The heart of the homoiotherms has the mechanical structures
(endoskeleton) which formed by fibers of collagen and elastic. Its
function is:
16
a) to provide the length of rest of the cardiac muscle and to prevent its
oversprain;
b) to increase efficiency of the cardiac muscle and to provide its quick
returning to the primary condition;
c) to provide active affluence of blood to the heart;
d) all answers are correct;+
e) there are no correct answers.
68. Which animals have the system of giant axons?
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
69. Which reactions are made with the help of system of giant axons?
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
amylase pH 5,8-7,8;+
amylase pH 1,5-1,8;
lactase pH 5,8-7,8;
lactase ph 1,5-1,8;
theres no correct answer.
17
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
1;
1, 2;
2, 3;
3, 4;
1, 2, 3, 4.
1;
2;
3;
1, 2;
2, 3.+
74.The graph below illustrates action potential of the neuron. Using the
code denote which parts of it are marked with letters.
6. levelling phase;
7. inhibitory phase;
8. parabiosis;
A
a) 7;
b) 1;
c) 2;
d) 5;
B C
4; 3;
3; 2;
3; 1;
6; 3;
D
1;
5;
4;+
7;
single - membrane,organelles;
double - membrane organelles;
they have the genetic make up of their own that includes circular DNA;
they have no the genetic apparatus of its own;
they have ribosomes that differ from ribosomes of cytoplasme in structure;
they have ribosomes that do not differ from ribosomes of cytoplasm;
they have a lot of common features with bacterium;
they have a lot of common features with blue - green algae.
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
1, 4, 5, 7;
2, 4, 6, 7;
1, 3, 6, 8;
2, 3, 5, 8;+
there are no correct answers.
1, 2, 6, 8;
1, 3, 5, 7, 8;
2, 4, 6, 7, 8;
1, 3, 5, 7;
2, 4, 6, 8.
19
1. A cell;
2. A tissue;
3. An organ;
4. A plant organism;
5. An animal organism;
6. A procaryotic cell;
7. An eucaryotic cell;
8. A fatty tissue;
9. A supportive tissue;
10. A cross-section of a root;
11. A cross section of a plant axis;
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
3, 4, 11;
2, 9, 10;
1, 4, 6;
1, 4, 7;+
3, 5, 8.
20
Escherichia coli;
Penicillium notatum;
Bacillus subtilis; +
Salmonella typhimurium;
Convallaria mayalis.
81. Regard the following illustration and decide what kind of structure
is depicted.
21
chlorophyll a;+
chlorophyll b;
carotines;
fucoxanthines of phaeophyceae;
phycobiliproteids.
22
I. Edwards syndrome
II. Down syndrome
III. Turner syndrome
IV. Slanted eyes, skeletal deformity (flattened back of the head) , severe
mental retardation, male or female.
V. Feminine constitution, rudimentary and functionless sexual organs,
infantilism.
VI. Deformed fingers, heart conditions, high voices, lessened beard growth.
a) I and V;
b) II and IV;+
c) II and IV;
d) II and V.
86. The following statements are possible, general connections between
the speed of evolution and sexual or asexual reproduction.
I. The rate of evolution will be higher in a smaller population than it would be
in a larger one.
II. The rate of evolution will behave oppositely proportional to the generative
duration.
III. The rate of evolution will increase in proportion to the variety of the
different ways of life. It will decrease in proportion to the density of competition
which newcomers find in an certain area.
a) only III is right;
b) only I and II are right;
c) all statements are correct;+
d) none of the statements are correct;
87. The rate of hereditariness H can expressed in the following
mathematical manner. Which statement is correct?
23
VG genetic variability;
VP phaenotypic variability;
VE environmentally caused (modificated) variability.
a)
b)
c)
d)
A;+
B;
C;
D.
24
c) II and VII;+
d) IV and VIII.
89. Brachionus calyciflorus is a frequent inhabitant of eutroph ponds
and lakes. Different kinds are known, especially one with a pair of thorns
on the hind or caudal end of the shell. This appearance, which is quite
frequent with plancton organisms is known as cyclomorphosis:
25
a) A;+
b) B;
c) C.
91. Reproduction is often connected with a shift from haploid to diploid
or the other way round. Please regard the diagram and decide with
group of organisms show the below mentioned type of shift.
26
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
zero;
0.25;
0.5;
0.125;
0.25 if the gene is autosomal, 0.125 if it is on a sex chromosome.
97. In root nodules, the nitrogen-fixing bacteria obtain from the host
plant:
a) nitrogen dissolved in vascular sap;
b) oxygen dissolved in vascular sap;
c) nitrates
d) sugars
e) neither of the above;
98. Certain physiological process occurs in a plant only after it has been
illuminated with full-spectrumn white light or its red component; other
monochromatic cannot produce this effect.Based on this, one may
expect that process is regulated via:
a) chlorophyll;
b) a flavonoid pigment;
c) phytochrome;
d) auxins or giberellins;
e) the information given is not sufficient to choose from among above
answers.
99. A medium-strong stimulation of a tactile receptor (touch receptor)
causes in its nerve fibre an action potential, whose oscillograph
representation is shown in fig."X". How will the action potential look like
after a stronger stimulus?
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
A;
B;
C;
D;
E.
28
29
111. In the blood of an adult man the total content of haemoglobin is,
roughly:
a) several hundred gram;
b) tens of gram (10-100 g);
c) several gram;
d) several hundred milligram;
e) tens of milligram.
112. The action of a chemical inhibiting the enzyme acetylcholinesterase
will cause, as a primary response:
a) complete relaxation of all muscles;
b) relaxation only of skeletal (striated) muscles;
c) contraction of most of the muscles. both striated and smooth;
d) contraction of some of the striated muscles only;
e) contraction of some smooth muscles only.
.113. Penicillin does not harm nondividing bacterial cells, but in its presence bacteria cannot increase in number. From this information it is
reasonable to assume that penicillin inhibits:
a) transcription;
b) protein biosynthesis;
c) biosynthesis of cell-wall component(s);
d) DNA replication;
e) more than one of the above is consistent with the given information.
114. Callus cells were incubated for several hours in a medium
containing all necessary substances, with one of the chemicals being
radioactive( tritium-labelled). Afterwards the cells were fixed for
microscopy; using autoradiography it was observed that the
radioactivity was concentrated exclusively in the nucleus,the
mitochondria and chloroplasts. It is reasonable to assume that the
compound labeled was?
a) an aminoacid;
b) uridine;
c) thymidine;
d) glucose;
e) more than of the above possibilities is very likely.
115. Rough endoplasmic reticulum should be particularly abundant in:
a) reticulocytes ( immature erythrocytes);
b) nerve cells;
c) pancreas cells;
d) smooth muscle cells;
e) it is abundant to a similar degree in all of the above types of cells.
116. Correct ordering of structures, from the least complex one (that is,
containing the lowest number of different kinds of protein molecules) to
the most complex (that is, containing the largest number of different
kinds of protein molecules) is given in answer:
31
K
50
30
10
10
0
0
0
0
L
92
4
0
0
1
1
1
1
M
75
5
5
5
5
5
0
0
N
0
25
20
20
20
5
0
0
P
0
2
3
5
40
50
0
0
Q
0
65
20
10
3
2
0
0
a) K;
b) L;
c) M;
32
d) N;
e) P.
120. Tolerance spectra of water temperature and salinity of a
craustacean
species is shown in the graph. This species is likely to be found on New
Year's eve (Christian) in surface waters of:
a) an alpine pond;
b) Aral See;
c) Indian Ocean;
d) The Dead Sea;
e) in more than one of the above.
121. A simplified genealogy tree of seven species is shown. Based
solely
on this tree, which of the following statements is correct:
I;
II;
III;
I, II;
I, II, III.
34
The extra amount of CO2 being produced and excreted during the
third week probably originates from:
a) ethanol;
b) ethanal;
c) lactic acid;
d) NAD H2;
128. Four pupils have the following schematic drawings of
chromosomes during Meiosis I.
35
Turgor highest
1
1
2
2
concentration highest
1
2
1
2
36
the stem is cut off and during one hour the amount of released fluid is
measured.
Results:
hinese rose
sunflower
tomato
evaporation
6,20 ml
4,80 ml
0,50 ml
released fluid
0,02 ml
0,02 ml
1 0,07 ml
John concludes:
root pressure has a considerable influence on the watertransport
Mary concludes:
capillary forces have a considerable influence on the watertransport.
Who is right?
a) John and Mary;
b) only John;
c) only Mary;
d) neither John,nor Mary;+
132 Examine the figure showing a drawing + magnification of a piece of
a cross section of a root of a dicotyledon plant.
37
d) 4;
133 The influence of pCO2 on the amount of refreshed air in the lungs is
determined of a test person. The experiment is done at sealevel and
high up in mountains at 5800m. The diagram shows the results.
concentration
of Na+ mmol/l)
290
190
130
470
1
Diffusion of water and Na+ may occur in the gulls of these fishes.
Which fish(es) will have for both water and Na+:
excretion / intake <1
a) I;
b) II;
38
c) III.
135 The relative excretion activity is determined of the protozoan
Zoothamnium in different mixtures of seawater and fresh water. The
results are shown in the diagram.
39
a) I;
b) II;
c) III;
d) IV;
137 The figure shows possible positions of the black headed gull ( Larus
lanoce phalus).A gull has landed by accident in the territory of another
gull and both gulls have met each other. Which position will probably be
shown by the visitor gull?
a) position 1;
b) position 3;
c) position 5;
d) position 7;
e) position 9;
138 In a certain human population 64% is able to roll the tongue. This
ability is based on a dominant allele. A roller marries a non-roller.
Calculate the chance to have a roller baby.
a) 0,1;
b) 0,225;
40
c) 0,5;
d) 0,625;
e) 0,75.
139. A certain feature of a plant is based on three alleles: E1, E2 and E3.
A pollen grain of this plant is unable to create a pollen tube if one and
the same allele exists in both the pollen grain and the cell of the pistil. A
plant with genotype E1E2 is pollinated with pollen of a plant with
genotype E1E3. Which genotype(s) is (are) to be expected in the
offspring?
a) E1E1 E1E2;
b) E1E3 E2E3;
c) 1E3 E1E2.
140 Three alleles are determining the ABO-bloodgroups: IA, IB and i.
Color blindness is caused by a recessive X-chromosomal allel. Inspect
the following family trees.
As you can see some of the parents and children are colorblind. Also
the bloodgroups are indicated. Directly after birth a baby of couple I
must have been changed with a baby of couple II. Indicate the numbers
of the changed babies.
a) 1 - 3;
b) 2 - 6;
c) 2 - 5;
d) 2 - 4;
e) 1 - 5.
141 The figure shows a karyogram of a sell of a individual with 2n = 4.
41
42
c) I
d) II
IV;
IV.
143. The diagram shows the relationship between the intake of CO2 and
light intensity of leaves of a beech tree in a sunny and in a shadow
position.
146. When a new male, takes over a lion pride, they sometimes kill or
evict
the cubs already present, this phenomena can be explained from
behavioral
ecology:
a) the male doesn`t like cubs;
b) the male cannot afford too much for caring those cubs;
c) the male breed his own offspring;
d) degeneration of the male`s parental behavior.
147. Honey-bee is a kind of social insects. In its colony, males develop
from
unfertilized eggs and are haploid, while workers develop from normal
fertilized
eggs and are therefore dipliid. Which of the following is the correct
coefficient of realatadness (R) between workers on the colony:
a) 0.5;
b) 0.25;
c) 1;
d) 0.75;
e) 0.375.
148. There is significant correlation between intensity of sexual
selection and mating system. Which of the following is correct?
a) intensity of sexual selection in promiscuity is strong;
b) intensity of sexual selection in monogamy is strong;
c) intensity of sexual selection in polygyny is strong;
d) intensity of sexual selection in polyandry is strong.
149. Which is the determinant factor in distinguishing dominant from
subordinate for animals living in group?
a) aggressive;
b) amicable;
c) territory;
d) recognition.
150. In addition to providing immediate energy, which of the followings
is the most prominent contribution of glycolysis to aerobic respiration?
a) glucose production;
b) NAD + production;
c) ATP production;
d) lactic acid production;
e) pyruvate production.
151. Which of the following is the rate-limiting step in glycolysis?
a) isomerization of glucose-6-phosphate to fructose-6-phosphate;
b) phosphorylation of fructose-6-phosphate;
c) phosphorylation of glucose
d) conversion of pyruvate to lactate.
44
incorporate first?
a) PGA;
b) phosphoglyceraldehyde;
c) NADPH;
d) ribulose-1,5 diP;
e) pyruvic acid.
162.Which of the following Cyanophyta member cannot
fix the atmospheric nitrogen?
I. Anabaena;
II. Scenedesmus;
III. Calotrix;
IV. Nostoc.
a) I,IV;
b) III,IV;
c) I,III;
d) I,III,IV;
e) only II;
163. A mollusc sample is given to a biologist. After examining the
sample he says that it belongs to Bivalvia. Which of the followings may
be the key that makes him to reach this conclusion?
a) gills;
b) absence of radula;
e) body symmetry;
c) mantle.
164. Which of the followings occurs if an acetylcholine esterase inhibitor
is added to a synaptic cleft?
a) postsynaptic neuron is continuously stimulated;
b) postsynaptic neuron cannot be stimulated;
c) presynaptic neuron does not release neurotransmitters;
d) presynaptic neuron cannot be stimulated;
e) postsynaptic neuron membrane is hyperpolarised.
165. Which of the following impulse conducting ways is activated if our
head makes rotational movements?
a) utriculuc and sacculuscerebellumbrain cortex;
b) semicircular canals--cerebellum--brain cortex;
c) semicircular canals--brain cortex--cerebellum;
d) utriculus and sacculus--brain cortexcerebellum.
166. An extremely high amount of ammonia is found in a soil sample.
Which of the followings is the reason of this?
a) absence of nitrogen fixing fungi;
b) absence of bacteria which free the bound nitrogen;
c) competition among bacteria;
d) absence of nitrogen fixing bacteria;
e) inability of rocks to make absorbtion.
47
48
b) hydra and earth - warm have body cavity, but planaria do not .
c) earth - warm has cyrculatory system, but hidra and planaria do not .
d) all those animals are aerobic organisms.
172. Phenilketonuria is a recessive human genetic disorder, causing the
disturbance of aminoacids methabolism. Phenilketonuria causes :
a) incability to synthesize phenilalanile.
b) incability to decompose phenilalanile.
c) incability to absorbe phenilalanile.
d) incability to include phenilalanile in protein synthesis.
173. In which cases the transpiration in plants intensifies ?
1. The air temperature and the rate of wind increases.
2. The light intensity weekens and the weather becomes calm .
3. The water amount in soil and the air temperature decreases.
4. The air temperature decreases and the night begins.
a)
b)
c)
d)
1 and 3
1 only
4 only
2 only
174. Look at the pictures illustrating the structure of fresh watter fish
nephron (1) and marine fish nephron (2). Which one of the statements is
correct ?
a) marine fish loses more water with urine than fresh water fish.
b) the absence of glomeruli helps marine fish to get rid of spare water.
c) salts reabsorb more intensively in marine fish tubules, than in fresh watter
coiled tubules.
d) glomeruli help fresh water fish to get rid of spare water.
***Following information deals with the questions 175,176
The next items are based on the following diagram illustrating a
coleoptile tip from a plant grown in the dark and placed on blocks
of agar separated by a sheet of mica.
49
175. The tip is exposed to light as shown. The influence effect of the
light on the distribution of auxin will be such as:
a) block A will contain more than block B.
b) block B will contain more than block A.
c) both blocks will contain the same amount.
d) neither block will contain auxin.
176.After exposure to light as shown, agar blocks alone are placed back
on the cut surface on the oat plant so that a half of the (side I) is
covered by block A and an other half ( side II) is covered by block B. It
is likely that
a) neither side will grow.
b) both sides will grow equally fast.
c) side II will grow faster than side I.
d) side I will grow faster than side II.
***Following information deals with the questions 177-180;
The codes of the answers:
1. Body is divided into carapace and abdomen;
2. Head, chest, abdomen carapace - abdomen;
3. Two pairs of antenna;
4. No antennas;
5. One pair of oral members;
6. The stage of larva is presented;
7. No larval forms;
8. Three pairs of ambulatory legs;
9. Four pairs of ambulatory legs;
10. Imagoes breath only through tracheas;
177. Choose the features typical for representatives of the class
Crustacea.
a) 5, 7, 10;
b) 2, 6, 8, 10;
c) 1, 3, 6;
d) 4, 7, 9.
178. Choose the features typical for the representatives of the class
Myriapoda
a) 5, 7, 10;
b) 2, 6, 8, 10;
c) 1, 3, 6;
50
d) 4, 7, 9.
179. Choose the features typical for representatives of the class Insecta.
a) 5, 7, 10;
b) 2, 6, 8, 10;
c) 1, 3, 6;
d) 4, 7, 9.
180. Choose the features typical for representatives of the class
Arachnida.
a) 5, 7, 10;
b) 2, 6, 8, 10;
c) 1, 3, 6;
d) 4, 7, 9.
***Following information deals with the questions 181-183;
The code of the answers:
1. Have highly - developed conductive tissues;
2. Gametophyte prevail;
3. Sporophyte prevail;
4. Male gametes - spermatozoides;
5. Male gametes - spermatozoid
6. Equal - spored;
7. Hetero - spored;
8. Equal - spored or hetero - spored;
9. Have roots;
10. Havent roots.
181. Chose the features which are typical for Pteridophyta.
a) 1, 3, 5, 7, 9;
b) 1, 3, 4, 8, 9;
c) 2, 4, 6, 10.
182. Chose the features which are typical for Bryophyta.
a) 1, 3, 5, 7, 9;
b) 1, 3, 4, 8, 9;
c) 2, 4, 6, 10.
183. Chose the features which are typical for Spermatophyta.
a) 1, 3, 5, 7, 9;
b) 1, 3, 4, 8, 9;
c) 2, 4, 6, 10.
***Following information deals with the questions 184,185;
The code of the answers:
1. Have only pulmonary breathing;
2. Poikilotherma amniotes;
3. Have urinary bladder;
51
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
184. Using the code denote which features are tupical for Amphibia
a) 2, 3, 6, 7, 9;
b) 3, 5, 6, 8, 9;
c) 1, 2, 3, 4, 7, 9;
d) 1, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9;
185. Using the code denote which features are tupical for Reptilia.
a) 2, 3, 6, 7, 9;
b) 3, 5, 6, 8, 9;
c) 1, 2, 3, 4, 7, 9;
d) 1, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9;
***Following information deals with the questions 186-188;
Codes of the answers:
1. Trees bushes, herbaceous plants;
2. Trees,bushes;
3. Trees, herbaceous plants;
4. Haploid endosperm (n);
5. Diploid endosperm (2n);
6. Triploid endosperm (3n);
7. Male gametes - spermatozoons;
8. Male gametes - spermatozoids;
9. Male gametes - spermatozoons or sperma;
10. Insemination isnt connected with water;
11. Insemination is connected with water;
12. Insemination of ones is connected with water, while of others is not;
13. Vegetative organs have vessels;
14. Vegetative organs have not vessels;
15. Have specialized vegetative organs (tubers, rhizomes, bulbs).
186. Chose the features typical for Angiospermatophyta
a) 1, 6, 8, 11, 13, 15;
b) 3, 8, 11, 13, 15;
c) 2, 4, 9, 12, 13;
d) 1, 6, 7, 10, 13, 15;
e) 2, 3, 8, 12, 15.
187. Chose the features typical for Gymnospermatophyta
a) 1, 6, 8, 11, 13, 15;
b) 3, 8, 11, 13, 15;
c) 2, 4, 9, 12, 13;
d) 1, 6, 7, 10, 13, 15;
52
e) 2, 3, 8, 12, 15.
188.Chose the features typical for Pteridophytes
a) 1, 6, 8, 11, 13, 15;
b) 3, 8, 11, 13, 15;
c) 2, 4, 9, 12, 13;
d) 1, 6, 7, 10, 13, 15;
e) 2, 3, 8, 12, 15.
***Following information deals with the questions 189-191;
The code of the answers:
1. Autotroph;
2. Heterotroph;
3. They have chlorophyllin protoplasm;
4. They have chloroplasts;
5. They have mitochondrions;
6. They have a nucleus;
7. Genetic material is situated in cytoplasm;
8. They have cytoplasmic membrane;
9. They have cellulose membrane;
10. They can move;
11. They cant move.
189. Denote, which processes of vital activity and peculiarities of
structure are characteristic for cells of animals.
a) 2, 5, 6 ,8, 10;
b) 1, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11;
c) 2, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11;
d) 1, 2, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11;
e) 1, 3, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11.
190. Denote, which processes of vital activity and peculiarities of
structure are characteristic for cells of fungi
a) 2, 5, 6 ,8, 10;
b) 1, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11;
c) 2, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11;
d) 1, 2, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11;
e) 1, 3, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11.
191. Denote, which processes of vital activity and peculiarities of
structure are characteristic for cells of bacterium.
a) 2, 5, 6 ,8, 10;
b) 1, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11;
c) 2, 5, 6, 8, 9, 11;
d) 1, 2, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11;
e) 1, 3, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11.
***Following information deals with the questions 192,193;
53
54
57
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
VI INTERNATIONAL
BIOLOGY
OLYMPIAD
(Ly co p o d i um )
b ut
no t
in
horsetail
6 . T he f re qu en cie s o f re c o mb i na t io n betw ee n g e ne s ( lo ci ) a , b, c, d, e a nd f li n ke d o n t he
sa me c hro mo so me a re: ( a - c) 2 ,5 %, ( f - d) 8 ,5 %, ( b- d) 4 ,5 %, ( d- e) 4 %, ( c- e) 9 ,5 %, ( a - b)
2 0 ,5 %, ( f - a ) 7 ,5 %. T he o rde r o f t he se g e ne s ( lo ci) i s:
a) a, c, d, e, f, b; b) b, c, e, f, d, ; ) a, c, f, e, d, b; d) b, e, f, c, a, d.
15. The graph shows the relationship between the yield of a crop
and the quantity of positive ions used to fertilize a field. A field is
fertilized with 20 kg/ha of the positive ions and 20 kg/ha of the
negative ions. Are the cations and anions under these conditions
limiting factors for the yield?
a) no, neither of them;
b) only the positive ions;
c) only the negative ions;
d) yes, both of them.
16. Incipient plasmolysis is the moment when:
a) turgor pressure of the cell equals zero;
b) the protoplast completely shrinks away from the cell wall;
c) the cell volume is at a maximum;
d) the cell wall can stretch no further.
17. Based on the figure above, identify plant parts of the same
generation of the life cycle.
a) 111 and VI, I and VI;
) III and V, III and VI;
1 8 . A co nd it io n nec es sa ry f o r s pec ia ti o n is :
a) a high rate of gene mutation;
b) geographical separation of populations;
c) separation of a very small group of individuals from the initial large population;
d) behavioural, geographical, genetic or other barriers preventing gene flow between populations.
1 9 . T he g ro u p o f a na mn io t es is:
a) pigeon, salamander, marsupial;
d) 1, 4 .
18
02. In
5. pinna;
6. scrotum;
7. hair;
8. viviparity. Answers:
c) 2, 3, 5, 6, 7; d) 1, 4, 6, 7, 8.
33. A cross between two types of white-flowered sweet peas produced all purple-flowered peas in Fr 382
purple-flowered and 269 white-flowered peas were observed in F2. These numbers are consistent with the
9/7 ratio. If the purple F { were crossed to one of the parental types, what proportion of white-flowered peas
would you expect among the progeny?
a)l;
b)0,75;
c) 0,5; d) 0,25;
e) 0.
36. U is inserted between the 9-th and 10-th base (counting in 5? - 3f direction) of the following mRNA:
5' GCUAUGCGCUACGAUAGCUAGGAAGC 3f and when it is translated into a peptide, the length of the
peptide chain is*:
a) 4;
b)5;
c) 8;
37. The F t genotypes resulting from a cross between a drone honeybee and a 1 queen honeybee are
males (AB, Ab, aB, ab) and females (AaBb, Aabb, aa Bb, aabb). What are the genotypes of the
parents?
a) aaBb x Ab; b) AaBb x ab; c) Aabb x aB;
d) AaBb x Ab.
40. The hypothesis postulated by A.Oparin and experimentally tested by S.Miller suggests that:
a) the primitive atmosphere contained molecular oxygen;
b) the primitive oceans contained high concentrations of proteins and nucleic acids;
c) bacteria appeared on the earth 3,5 x 109 years ago;
d) organic molecules could have been formed without life.
41. The chief role of ATP in neurotransmission is to:
a) inhibit transport of Na" and K" across the membrane;
b) induce an action potential;
c) increase an action potential when it is already formed;
d) maintain the resting potential.
42. The above nucleotide chain is:
a) DNA; b) mRNA; c) tRNA;
d) rRNA.
43. If frog tadpoles receive insufficient iodide from food and the surrounding water medium, which of the
following may occur?
The codes of the answers:
1. enlargement of thyroid gland;
2. over-secretion of TSH;
3. growth stimulation;
4. exhibition of cretinism;
5. remaining in larval stage;
6. enlargement of the pituitary gland. Answers:
a) 1, 2 , 3 ; b) 3 , 4 , 6 ; c) 2, 4, 6; d) 1, 2, 5.
44. Which of the following is typical for both gymnosperms (Pinophyta)
(Magnoliophyta)?
a) sporophylls differentiating into a carpel and a stigma;
b) haploid endosperm and vascular tissues with tracheids;
c) heterospory and nonflagellated sperm (male gamete);
d) isogamy and wind pollination.
and angiosperms
45. Which combination of the following human gametes will produce a Down syndrome male individual?
The codes of the answers:
1. 23+X;
2. 21+Y;
3. 22+XX;
Answers:
a) 1 and 2; b) 1 and 3; ) 1 and 4;
4. 22+Y.
d) 2 and 3;
e) 3 and 4.
48. One locus has 5 alleles: A 1 ,A 2 ,... A 5 . How many different genotypes can exist in a population if
the dominance hierarchy of these alleles is A 1 > A 2 > A 3 > A 4 > A 5 ?
a) 5; b) 10; c) 15; d) 32.
49. An average of 50 yeast cells per unit area was observed under the microscope. After 4 hours
the liquid culture was diluted 10 times. Again a microscopic slide was prepared under the same
conditions as before. An average of 80 cells per unit area was observed this time. What was the
average time between cell divisions?
a) 1/4 hour; b) 1/2 hour; ) 1 hour; d) 2 hours.
50. Consider the pedigree below. If IV-1 is male and IV-2 is female, which of the following
statements is correct?
a)
the probability that IV-1 would have both AD and SLR abnormalities is 1/8;
b) the probability that IV-2 would have both AD and SLR abnormalities is 1/4;
c) the probability that IV-1 would manifest AD abnomiality but not the SLR abnoniiality is 1/8;
d) the probability that IV-2 would manifest AD abnormality but not the SLR abnomiality is 1/8.
51. Which are the possible conditions that could lead to serious hypoglycemia (low blood glucose
level) and unconsciousness?
The codes of the answers:
1. type I diabetic patients (insufficient B-cells) who receive an insulin injection several hours
before a meal;
2. type II diabetic patients (non-functional insulin receptors) who receive an ex cessive insulin
injection;
3. patients with a tumor of the islets of Langerhans who receive an acute injec tion of insulin;
4.injection of insulin to a normal subject after heavy exercise.
Answers:
a) 1 , 3 ;
b)l,4;
) 1, 2, 3; d) 2, 3, 4 .
52. Through how many of membranes would a molecule have to pass from the interior of a chloroplast
thylakoid to the mitochondrial matrix?
a)3;
b)5;
c) 7;
d) 9.
53. Substances can be transported across a membrane against their concentration gradient because:
a) some membrane proteins are ATP-dependent carrier molecules;
b) some membrane proteins act as channels through which specific molecules can enter the cell;
c) the lipid bilayer is permeable to numerous small molecules;
d) the lipid bilayer is hydrophobic.
54. Of the following modes of inheritance, which one could
describe the genetic character appearing in the above pedigree?
The codes of the answers:
1. autosomal dominant;
2. autosomal recessive;
3. sex-linked dominant;
4. sex-linked recessive. Answers:
a) 1; b) 2; ) 1 or 3; d ) 2 o r 3 ;
e) 2 or 4.
55. Which of the following is true for RNA?
a) G + = A + U;
b) G + = + U;
c) G + > A + U;
56. Which of the following numbers (lines) correctly matches stimuli specific for receptor cells , and C?
57. If the following DNA is transcribed in the direction shown. The RNA product will be:
58. A suitable vector for inserting DNA into the genome of a human cell is:
a) T-plasmid; b) phage;
c) retrovirus;
59. Touching the mantle of the siphon of the seahare (Ap ly sia , phylum Mo l lu sca ) , normally
triggers a reflex that protects the mantle by withdrawing it. If the mantle is touched repeatedly,
the withdrawal response becomes progressively weaker. This type of behaviour is called:
a) habitation;
b) a conditioned reflex;
d) a chain of reflex.
a) 12000;
100000
b) 35000;
) 50000;
d)
61. A given fungus fails to digest starch in a certain culture medium. What are possible causes of
this lack of digestion?
The codes of the answers:
1. this fungus contains no amylase;
2. the amylase in the fungal mycelium is not secreted;
3. there is some substance interfering with starch digestion by the fungus;
4. the only respiratory substrate for this fungus is carbohydrate.
Answers:
a) 1 , 2 ; b ) 3 , 4; ) 1, 2, 3; d) 1, 2, 3, 4 .
62. The figures I-IV illustrate transportation of substances and ions through the cell membranes.
Which of the following statements is correct?
a ) there i s diffusion in all figures;
b) there is active transport in all figures;
c) there is active transport in fig. II and III and
passive transport in fig. I and IV;
d) there is osmosis in fig. I, II and IV;
e) there is active transport in fig. Ill and passive
transport in fig. I, II, and IV.
6 4 . Wh ic h o f t he f o llo w i ng is no t i mp o rta nt fo r mi g ra ti ng b ir ds i n f in di ng a n d
dete r mi n i ng ro ut e s?
a) auditory stimulation;
b) infrared sensitivity;
c) rotational force of the Earth;
d) using the stars as a compass.
Fo ur ma j o r r ep ro d uc t i v e ho r mo ne s me a s ur ed fro m blo o d s er u m o f a w o ma n d u ri ng a
no r ma l me n st r ua l cy cl e a re s ho w n in t he f ig u r e. If A i s F SH , w ha t a r e , a n d D? W hi ch
is t he mo st s uit a bl e c o nd it io n t o sto re see d s o f mo st tro pi ca l p la nt s so tha t t hey ca n
re ma i n v ia bl e f o r t he lo ng e st t i me ?
65.
6 8 . Wh ic h o f t he f o llo w i ng a re no t t h e c ha ra ct er s o f xe ro p hy t ic pla nt s?
T he co de s o f t he a n sw e rs:
1 . sho rt ste m;
2 . sto ma ta p re se nt o n bo t h s i de s o f l ea f s ur fa ce s;
3 . enl a rg e me nt o f lea f su r f a ce;
4 . hy po de r ma pr e se nt .
Answers:
a) 1,2; b)2,3; c) 3, 4; d) 1, 4.
c) GCA;
d) GGC
7 0 . Wh ic h e nzy me i s no t no r ma lly f o u nd in h u ma n ?
a) DNA-polymerase;
b) hexokinase;
c) chitinase;
d) ATP-synthetase.
d) 5' AUG 3.
b) diaphragm;
77. Messenger RNA was transcribed in vitro from a double-stranded DNA molecule, which was later
separated into single strands. For each strand of the DNA, the base ratio was analyzed and compared with
that of mRNA. On the basis of the data given in the table, which strand of the double-stranded DNA served
as the template for the mRNA synthesis?
a) DNA-l; b) DNA-2;
c) DNA-3;
d) DNA-4.
78. Which procedure would be used in a choice chamber to decide whether a \f response of
animals to two different light intensities is taxis or kinesis?
a) record the pathway of each animal;
b) record the velocity of the animal movement;
c) count, at intervals, the number of animals in each chamber;
d) count, at intervals, the number of moving and stationary animals.
c) 2, 3, 5;
d) 3, 4, 5 .
80. To determine their need for oxygen, three types of bacteria were grown in three different
tubes. The regions of bacterial growth are shown in the figures above. Which is the correct
classification of the bacterial types.
b)II
c)III:
d) IV:
e) V
8 3 . Wh ic h
ho r mo ne s
i nc rea s e
and
dec rea se
b lo o d
g l uco se
l ev e ls,
r es pe ctiv ely ?
8 4 . Wh ic h o f t he f o llo w i ng a ni ma l p hy la po s se ss g i a nt a xo n sy ste ms ?
a)
b)
c)
d)
87. Select plant numbers from the diagram below and write a correct order of the phases of see d
germination anddevelopment of young plants.
88. Put X in the appropriate place to indicate whether each statement concerning photosynthesis
in plant is true or false.
I.
7.
8,
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
microspore;
parenchyma;
root hairs;
protoderm;
transpiration;
aerenchyma;
respiration.
90. Fill in the blanks with answer codes to indicate the main edible parts of the following fruits.
The codes of the answers:
1. exocarp;
2. mesocarp;
3. endocarp;
4. receptacle;
Answers:
I.Strawberry
II.Banana
III.Peanut
IV.Orange
V.Coconut
5.
6.
7.
8.
perianth;
endosperm;
cotyledon;
aril.
91. List all possible characteristics from the answer codes of the following organisms.
The codes of the answers:
1. autotrophic;
6. having nucleus;
2. heterotrophic;
7. having main genetic materials in cytoplasm;
3. chlorophyll in protoplasm;
8. having cellulose cell wall;
4. having chloroplasts;
9. having mobility;
5. having mitochondria;
10. having no mobility.
Answers:
I.Bacteria ..................
II.Blue-green algae ............. III. Fungi ............
92. The figure shows the response of net carbon
dioxide consumption rates of a single leaf to
ambient C0 2 concentration (ppm) at a light
intensity of 75% full sun.
Indicate with for true and "-" for false
statements.
I.
Plant A is a C4-type because it has a net greater CO.
consumption rate at high CO.
concentration
II.
At a C02 consumption rate equal to zero, there is no
photosynthesis and respiration for both plants A and
III. The CO. consumption rate of plant A will ultimately reach saturation as the C0 2 concentration increases further if
light intensity is held constant...
IV. C4-plants have greater light use efficiency in photosynthetic process than C 3-plants at the C02 concentration of
200 ppm
V.
At a light intensity of 100% full sun, the C02 consumption rate of plant will reach saturation at C02
concentration greater than above in the graph
9 3 . Sa tu ra t io n o f b lo o d he mo g lo bi n w i th o xy g e n is i nfl ue nc ed by th e pa rtia l pre s su re o f
o xy g e n. T h is i s inv es t i g a t ed i n f o ur o rg a n is ms: h u ma n a d ult, h u ma n fet u s, lla ma ( i n t he
An de s) a n d co w . Fo r t w o o f t he m t h e re s ult s a re s ho w n i n t he fig ur e. W ha t co u l d be t he
thre e po s si b le pa ir s o f I a nd I I ?
T he co de s o f t he a n sw e rs:
An s wer s:
I.
P o ss ib i li t y
II.
P o ss ib i li t y
III.
P o ss ib i li t y
........
.......
.....
se creto ry v e si cle s;
ri bo so me ;
mi to c ho n dr io n;
ch ro mo so me;
cent rio le;
An s wer s:
I . ... I I . ... I I I . ...
2 . mi cro t u bu le s;
4 . ly so so me;
6 . v a cuo le;
8 . Go lg i bo dy ;
1 0 . n ucl eo l u s.
I V. . .. V. ...
VI . .
Answers:
I.Mammals
II.Non-mammalian vertebrates
9 7 . M a tch a ll po ss ib le a ni ma l g ro u p s i n co lu mn w ith ea c h de sc ri ptio n i n co lu mn A:
I. no c irc ula t o ry sy st e m;
I I. o pe n c irc ula t o ry sy st e m;
I II. clo se d ci rc ula t o ry sy st e m w it ho ut hea rt c ha mb ers ;
IV. hea rt w i t h si ng le - c ir cu i t cir cu la tio n;
V. hea rt w i t h 2 a t ria a nd 2 v ent r ic le s.
T he co de s o f
1 . in se ct;
2 . bir d;
3 . sha r k;
4 . pla na r ia ;
t he a n sw ers ( co l u mn B ) :
5 . cro co di le;
6 . sea ho r se;
7 . a nne li de s (g ene ra l);
8 . hy dra .
Answers:
I .............
II .........
III ..........
IV ......... V .........
With these data it is possible to compare the efficiency in energy investment of the parent birds.
Which type of nesting (number 1, 2 or 3 from the table) has the lowest efficiency and which one
has the highest?
Answers:
I. The lowest efficiency
.....
II. The highest efficiency
......................
100. While investigating and comparing the efficiency in
energy investment of the parent birds, some conditions have
to be considered. Choose two possible conditions below.
The codes of the answers:
1. all young birds have to be about the same size during the
investigation;
2. all parent birds have to have about the same mass;
3. the nests have to be close together;
4. the food has to be at about the same distance from all the
nests;
5. the experiment shoud last no longer than one year;
6. all the parent birds shoud feed their young on the same
type of food.
Answers:
.................
101. Choose the correct number (1-5) from the given diagram
of the nitrogen cycle to match each statement (I-V).
Answers:
I.
Fixation of nitrogen by the bacteria in nodules
II.
Absorption of nitrogen compounds by the roots
III. Action of nitrifying bacteria
.....................
IV. Action of denitrifying bacteria ....................
V Action of decomposing bacteria .......................
102. Assume the genotype AABB was crossed with recessive genotype and the x offspring are
mated at random to produce F 2 offspring consisting of 22 A-B-, 5 A- bb, 5 aaB- and 4 aabb.
Estimate the recombination frequency between A
and B?
Answer:
103. Let " X " be the amount of nuclear DNA in a gamete of a diploid organism. Fill in each blank
the amount of nuclear DNA in different stages of the cell cycle of this organism. The DNA amount
per cell in the following stages of the cell cycle (example: 0,5 X , X , 2 X or 4 X )
I.Mid S =
II. G 1 =
. G 2 =
VI. Anaphase =
V. Metaphase =
IV. Prophase =
104. If the initial frequencies of genotypes 1 A 1 , 1 A 2 and A 2 A 2 are 0,04, 0,32 and 0,64,
respectively, what are the genotypic frequencies after one generation of complete selffertilization?
Answers:
I. 1 A 1 ............... II. A 1 A 2 ......... III. A 2 A 2 ...........
105.
The diagram shows genotypic frequencies during
subsequent generations in a population.
I.
What was the frequency of allele A at generation 0,
assuming a Hardy-Weinburg equilibrium at that point?
Answer: frequency of allele A is .....................
II.
What would be the frequency of aa after a very
large number of generations?
Answer: frequency of aa would be
106. In a human population at equilibrium, the frequency of I A =0,2, I B = 0,4 and i = 0,4. What
are the genotypic frequencies of blood group A, B, AB and 0?
Answers:
I.
II.
Group A
Group
III. Group AB
IV. Group 0
107. If the statement is correct for both chloroplasts and mitochondria, mark with "+". If it is
not correct for both, mark with
I. Contain proteins
II. Contain coenzymes for binding hydrogen
+
.....
.....................
.....
.....
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
Du ri ng
12 . T he c hro mo so me s n u mb e r i n t o ma to p la nt s is 2 4 . A to ma to ce ll u n derg o es me io si s.
T hre e o f t he re su lt i ng cel ls d eg e nera t e. T he l a st c el l i mme d ia t ely u n derg o es th ree
mi to se s w it ho ut cy t o ki ne si s. H o w ma ny ce ll n ucl ei w i ll y o u fi nd ; ho w ma ny
chro mo so me s do e s ea c h o f t h es e n uc le i co nta in :
a) 4 nuclei with 12 chromosomes each;
b) 4 nuclei with 24 chromosomes each;
c) 8 nuclei with 12 chromosomes each;
d) 8 nuclei with 24 chromosomes each.
l3 . R epa ir reg e ne ra t io n mea n s:
a) general property of the tissues and organs to renew throughout cell life and aging;
b) physiological changes that take place during the period of differentiation and specialization of cells;
c) restoration of tissues and organs after induced injury;
d) replacing of old cells with new ones.
14 . T he un i qu e pro pert ie s o f ea ch a mi no a ci d a re dete r mi n e d by it s p a rtic ula r :
a) R-group
b) amino group
c) type of the peptide bonds;
d) number of the bonds with other amino acids.
15 . A mu ta t io n t ha t c h a ng e s a n a la ni ne re s id u e i n t he int er io r o f a pr o tei n mo le cu le to
v a li ne is fo u n d t o lea d t o a lo s s o f a ctiv ity . T h e rea so n i s :
a) valine is acidic but alanine is basic;
b) alanine is necessary for a-helix formation, whereas valine is not;
c) valine occupies more space than alanine, hence the shape of the protein molecule is changed;
d) the presence of valine changes the isoelectric point of the protein.
19. The diagram below represents a student' s view of DNA synthesis occurring in an animal
cell. The arrows represent newly synthesized DNA.
This diagram is:
a) correct as shown;
b) incorrect because DNA synthesis in animal cells is unidirectional;
c) incorrect because DNA synthesis proceeds in 3' - 5' direction;
d) incorrect because DNA synthesis is proceeding in wrong direction on two of the strands.
20. A synthetic mRNA has only two nucleotide types; it contains five times as much U as C:
a) there are 4 possible codons
b) there are 6 possible codons;
c) there are 8 possible codons
d) there are 16 possible codons.
24. Which one the following statements refers to a human cell with 22+X chromosomes?
a) it is a fertilized egg
b) it is a cell which has undergone a meiosis;
c) it is a somatic cell
d) it is a cell which has undergone a mitosis;
e) it is a polyploid cell.
25. Which one of the following substances could be subjected to denaturation?
a) only proteins
b) only nucleic acids:
c) only lipids
d) nucleic acids and proteins.
26. Which one of the following statements is correct? Denaturation is a process of:
a) losing of the secondary and tertiary structure and destroying the primary structure;
b) losing of the secondary and tertiary structure without destroying the primary structure;
c) only losing of quaternary structure;
d) reducing of the chemical reactivity of the polymers.
enzyme
34. Some blue-green algae (Cyanobacteriae) are both autotrophic (photosynthetic) and
heterotrophic (being able to assimilate organic compounds). It has been shown by
experiments that light promotes the assimilation of organic compounds by them. Which one
of the following is the most probable explanation of this phenomenon?
a) the presence of organic compounds inhibits photosynthesis;
b) the uptake and utilization of organic compounds by blue-green algae consume no energy;
c) ATP and NADPH produced in photosynthesis can be used for the uptake and further transformation of
organic compounds;
d) blue-green algae can fix atmospheric nitrogen.
35. Which one of the following processes constitute a part of the light- dependent
photosynthetic reactions?
a) 1, 3 , 6;
b)l , 4 , 8
c ) 2, 3, 6;
d)2 , 4 , 5 ;
e) 5, 7.
36. Which of the following does not affect the number of
gas bubbles per unit of the time in the above figure?
a) volume of the glass container;
b) intensity of the light;
c) number of the leaves on the plant;
d) amount of C02 dissolved in the water;
e) temperature of the water.
37. In C 3 -photosynthesis the C0 2 acceptor is:
a) 3-phosphoglycerine aldehyde
b) pyruvic acid;
c) ribulose-1,5-diphosphate
d) ferredoxin.
38. In photosynthesis, in contrast to mitochondrial respiration:
a) water is decomposed
b) water is formed;
c) electrons are transported with the aid of cytochromes, among others;
d) participation of colorful metallocompounds;
e) more than one of the above are characteristic for photosynthesis only.
39. In the 1930th, C.B. Van Niel correctly hypothesized that oxygen gas released by plants
come from:
a) H20
b) C02
c) C6H]206
d) 03;
40. Auxins function as:
a) stimulators of leaves and fruits drop;
b) stimulators of lateral bud growth;
c) inhibitors of length growth;
d) stimulators of cell elongation and root development.
41. Besides the three factors: photoperiod, temperature and nutrition, another factor, which
also controls the flowering of plants is:
a) the rate of photophosphorylation;
b) the rate of the transport of organic substances within the plant;
c) the age of the plant;
d) the pH of soil solution.
42. Plant cells were incubated for several hours in the presence of radioactive (tritium
labeled) uridine. Afterwards cells were collected, gently homogenized and fractionated to
obtain various organelles. Radioactivity will be found chiefly in:
a) nucleolus, plastids and Golgi apparatus;
b) nucleus, nucleolus and lysosomes;
c) nucleus, ribosomes and vacuoles;
d) nucleus, nucleolus, ribosomes and chloroplasts;
e) all of the mentioned organelles will exhibit roughly the same level of radioactivity.
43. T he n u mb er o f s ee d s i n a po d i s de ter mi ne d by th e nu mb er o f :
a) pistils in the flower
b) carpels in the pistil;
c) ovules in the ovary
d) embryos in the ovular sac;
e) stigmata in the pistil.
44 . Wh ic h o f t he f o l lo w ing r ef e rs t o t he s po ro phy t e i n pla nt s :
a) diploid that produces haploid cells by mitosis;
b) diploid that produces haploid cells by meiosis;
c) haploid that produces gametes by meiosis;
d) haploid that produces gametes by mitosis.
45 . Wh en th e ro o t ca p o f a ma ize s ee dl ing i s e xc i se d, a new ro o t ca p w ill be fo r me d
w ithi n a bo u t 5 da y s . B ut i n a f ly ing s pa ce s hi p , the re i s no reg en era ti o n o f t he ro o t
ca p. W ha t i s t he rea so n ?
a) root cap formation is related to the C02 content of the atmosphere;
b) root cap formation is related to photoperiod;
c) root cap formation is related to temperature difference between day and night;
d) root cap formation is related to gravity.
46 . In h ea lt hy a du lt h u ma n s, re d blo o d c el ls a re fo r me d o nly in:
a) sternum, ribs and vertebrate bodies
b) thigh and shank bones;
c) liver;
d) spleen.
47 . As b lo o d f lo w s t h ro ug h t h e h ea rt t he v a lv e s o pe n a n d clo se a t th e co rre ct
mo me n ts . Th es e v a lv es a re f o r ce d t o o pe n by :
a) the contraction of the powerful muscles of the ventricles;
b) small muscles in the valves themselves;
c) strings attached to them called chordae tendineae;
d) the pressure of the blood itself.
48 . Wh ic h o f t he f o l lo w ing st a t e me nt s e xp la i n s the pe r si sti ng a b no r ma lly hig h lev e l o f
g lu co s e i n t he h u ma n b lo o d :
a) insufficient filtration by the kidneys;
b) excessive amount of thyroid hormones in the blood;
c) muscles in a total resting state (motor hypoactivity, hypodynamics);
d) insufficient hormone secretion by the pancreas;
e) an excessive amount of glucose absorbed by the intestine.
49 . Why th e h u ma n o rg a ni s m ca n no t be fe d o n ly by ca r bo hy d ra te s i s :
a) because the human body is composed mainly of proteins;
b) because man for his life needs many other substances, that cannot produce himself;
c) because the calorific value of the carbohydrates is not very high;
d) because the carbohydrates do not contain nitrogen and the human organism cannot assimilate it from the air.
50 . A s tu de nt a d de d s a l iv a t o st a rc h so lut io n a nd e x pect ed th e s ta rc h to be co nv ert ed
into mo no - a n d d i sa cc h a ri de s. Wh ic h o ne o f t h e fo l lo w ing i s t he be st co n dit io n fo r hi s
ex pe ri me nt ?
a) the mixture was kept at 0C;
b) the mixture was kept at 30C;
c) the mixture was boiled and then kept at 30C;
d) the mixture was kept at 70C.
51 . B a sa l me t a bo li c ra t e i s :
a) the minimal amount of energy needed to maintain life under exactly defined conditions;
b) issue of energy after obtaining nutrition - 100 g of proteins;
c) issue of energy by effort - ten knee-bends;
d) amount of energy needed for converting 1 g of lipids.
52 . M a mma l ia n s pec ie s X a n d Y ha v e si mi la r o v era l l sha pe s a n d bo dy co v er a n d
ex h ib it si mi la r lo co mo t o ry a ct iv it y . H o w ev er, in div i dua ls o f sp eci e s X a re tw ice a s
la rg e a s t ho se o f s pe cie s Y . Th e lo s s o f hea t th ro ug h t hei r su rfa ce , p e r u nit o f bo dy
ma s s, fo r t he se s pe cie s w ill be a bo ut :
a) for X twice as large as for Y
b) for X four times as large as for Y;
c) for Y twice as large as for X
d) neither of the given answers is correct.
53 . A mu s c le ha s bu ilt up a n o xy g en d ebt . W h en t he re is e no ug h o xy g en fo r a ero b i c
res p ira tio n t o re s u me , a ll o f t h e f o l lo w ing w il l o cc ur e x ce pt :
a) lactic acid will be converted into pyruvic acid;
b) 02 will be used up;
c) acetyl-CoA will be converted into CO? and H20;
d) pyruvic acid will be converted into acetyl-CoA;
e) an excess of NADPH will accumulate.
54 . E xc es s iv e co nc en t ra t io n o f t hy ro xi ne ca u s e s un co u pl i ng o f mito ch o nd ria , i. e. i n
sp ite o f t he e le ct ro ns f l o w ing a lo ng t he o x i da ti v e c ha i n no A TP i s pro du ce d. B a se d o n
thi s fa ct o ne sho u ld e x pect p eo p le w it h e xce s s iv e a ct iv ity o f t he t hy r o id to b e :
a) obese in spite of consuming small amounts of food and with body surface colder than in healthy individuals;
b) obese in spite of consuming small amounts of food and with body surface warmer than in healthy
individuals;
c) lean in spite of consuming large amounts of food and with body surface colder than in healthy individuals;
d) lean in spite of consuming large amounts of food and with body surface warmer than in healthy individuals.
55. Blood hydrostatic pressure powers the pro cess of:
a) filtration across the glomerulus;
b) reabsorption of water and dissolved substances at the venule end of capillary;
c) sodium gradient maintenance in the kidney tubules;
d) salt and glucose reabsorption in the kidney tubules;
e) Na+ reabsorption in the loop of Henle.
56 . In th e ma mma l ia n e mb r y o , t he f ir st str uc t ure to d ev e lo p re la tio n sh i p w it h t he
w a ll o f t he ut e ru s is ?
a) the amnion;
b) the chorion
c) the allantois
d) the trophoblast.
3. islets of Langerhans
4. spleen;
5. lymph
64. To reach the right hand the blood from the stomach and intestine:
The codes of the answers: 1. must pass through the heart (once)
2. must pass through the heart
(twice) 3. do not pass through the heart
4. must pass through the lungs;
5. must pass through
the liver;
6. must pass through the brain. Answers:
a) only 2
b) 1 and 4
c) 2, 4 and 6
d) 2, 4 and 5;e) 3, 4 and 5.
65. A hungry brown rat was placed in a closed metal box with a food slot and a foodreleasing lever.
The rat was allowed to poke around randomly until it accidentally tripped the lever and released a
food pellet. The rat soon learned to trip the lever whenever it wanted food. What type of learning is
this:
a) imprinting;
b) sensitization
c) habituation
d) trial and error.
66. Which process of cell division is essential if Mendel's First Law (the Law of Segregation) is to be
fulfilled:
a) division of the centromere
b) duplication of chromosomes;
c) pairing of homologous chromosomes
d) formation of chiasmata.
67. Man A has a rare X-linked recessive factor which is expressed as trait A. Man has a rare
dominant autosomal factor which is expressed only in males as trait B. Would you distinguish these
two cases just by studying the progeny:
a) no, because the progeny of man A and man can have just the same trait of their respective male
ancestors;
b) yes, because in the progeny of man A and man would not be woman with trait B;
c) no, because man A would not have sons with trait A, and man would not have sons with trait B;
d) yes, because the sons of man A's daughter could be with trait A, whereas the sons of man B's daughter
and the sons of his son could both be with trait B.
68. In numerous bird species males have very colorful and ornate plumage.
Cho o se th e b e st e x pla n a t io n f o r t he ev o l utio n a ry sta b il iza tio n o f s uc h a fea tu re :
a) ornate plumage is a good camouflage among colorful tropical plants;
b) this feature is neither advantageous, nor detrimental, so is neither selected for, nor against;
c) females mate preferentially with ornate males, so the genes "causing" this feature spread among the
population;
d) ornate plumage makes it easier for the birds of the same species to recognize each other, thus potentially
dangerous encounters with individuals of other species are being avoided;
e) bright and ornate plumage serves as a warning against dangerous (often poisonous) species.
69 . Very s i mi la r sp eci e s o f f i sh re lea se t he ir e g g s a nd s pe r m i nto t he sa me w a ter, b ut
the s per m a t o n e s p eci e s ca n no t pe netra t e t he eg g s o f th e o t her s pec ie s. T hi s is a n
exa mp l e o f pre zy g o t i c i so la t io n by :
a) ecological isolation
b) behavioral isolation;
c) mechanical isolation
d) gametic isolation.
70 . In s il k w o r ms , si l k g la n d c el ls a re s pe cia l i zed i n t he sy nth es i s o f la rg e q ua nt it ie s
o f the p ro tei n kn o w n a s si l k- f i bro in. T he s e sa me cel l s do no t ma ke b l o o d sp eci fic
pro te i ns . O ne w o u ld e x pect t ha t s il k - g la n d c el ls ha v e :
a) only silk fibroin genes;
b) the genes for both blood protein and silk fibroin;
c) silk fibroin genes and some other genes, but not blood protein genes;
d) fewer genes than the zygote.
71 . Ple io tro pic g e ne a c t iv it y co u ld b e rev ea l ed ma i nly th ro ug h :
a) studying of genes;
b) studying the interaction of genes of the organism;
c) studying pedigrees (genealogy);
d) studying of phenotypic changes, caused by gene mutations.
I B IX H X h ,
I B IX H Y;
3. I A IX h Y,
I A I B X H X\
I B IX h Y;
4. I A I A X h Y,
I B IX H X\
I B IX H Y
Answers:
a) only 1 and 3
b ) only 2 and 4
c) only 1 and 4 ;
d) only 2 and 3 e) only 2 , 3 and 4 .
7 5. What is the most probable sequence of the genes ABCD if the distance between them is:
A-B = 1,5 map units; B-C = 18 map units and A-D = 18,5 map units.
The codes of the answers:
1. ABCD; 2. BACD;
3. ABDC; 4. ACBD.
Answers:
a) only 1
b ) only 3 ;
c) 2 or 3
d ) only 4 ;
e) all answers are incorrect.
76. After crossing a guinea-pig with black hair and guinea-pig with white hair, all F 1
individuals were with black hair. After analyzing the progeny of a F 1 - female crossed with a
homozygous recessive individual the phenotypes in the backcross were in the following ratio
3 white : 1 black. What are the possible genotypes of the parents and individuals of F 1 ?
The codes of the answers:
1. AA, aa, Aa;
2. AAbb, aaBB, AaBb;
3. AABB, AAbb, AABb;
4. AABB, aabb, AaBb.
Answers:
a) only 1;
b) only 3;
c) only 2;
d) only 4
e) all answers are incorrect.
7 7 . T he g ra p h ic s ho w n in di ca t e s t he a mo un t a nd
co lo r o f l ig ht p en et ra t i o n i n t he s ea .
Co n si de ri ng t hi s da t a , o ne w o u l d e x pect th e b a si c
ma s s o f p hy t o pla n kt o n t o be s i t ua te d i n t he
lev e l :
a) 1-5 m
b) 5-10 m
c) 10-20 m
d) 20-30 m
e) 30-40 m.
82. The water-hyacinth was introduced into a tropical country and has
become a major menace to boating, clogging rivers and lakes. A single
plant can produce 1000 offsprings in 50 days.
The reason for its success is:
a) lack of predators;
b) good climate;
c) high reproductive rate;
d) the empty niche it occupied;
e) all of the above answers could be correct.
83. Plants with soft stems and badly developed supportive tissue, few
stem parenchyma cells with large intercellular spaces and with a thin
cuticule, belong to which ecological group?
a) mesophytes
b) xerophytes
c) hydrophytes
d) halophytes.
84. Plants that have mutualistic relations with nitrogen fixing bacteria provide the bacteria with:
a) N2
b) enzymes;
c) sugars;
d) nitrites.
86. Organisms belonging to two closely related animal species were placed in a container with all
parameters kept constant, and a limiting supply of food. There is no direct interspecies interaction. In
the state of equilibrium:
a) there will be constant numbers of animals of both species (static equilibrium), irrespectively of the initial
numbers;
b) there will be oscillating numbers of animals of both species (dynamic equilibrium);
c) there will be constant numbers of animals of both species (static equilibrium), determined by the initial
numbers;
d) animals of only one species will survive;
e) each of the above situations may take place, depending on the species used for the experiment.
88. A potential danger to an isolated population that has been greatly reduced in number is the:
a) loss of genetic variability
b) tendency toward assortative mating;
c) reduced gene flow
d) Hardy-Weinberg disequilibrium.
89. The struggle for existence is a consequence of:
a) each organism leaving more offspring than needed to replace itself;
b) innate competitive tendencies;
c) the inevitable difficulty of coping with climatic conditions;
d) territories and dominance hierarchy.
90. In a stable ecosystem of a pond sudden heavy pollution causes death of all plants. The first visible
change in pond water composition will be decreased in the concentration of:
a) carbon dioxide
b) nitrates
c) oxygen;
d) phosphates e) answers a and are correct.
91. Which of the following promotes diversity of living things:
a) classification of organisms;
b) natural selection in different environments;
c) inheritance from a common ancestor;
d) homeostatic regulation.
92. Which of the following cannot be a result of the ecological succession:
a) increase in the trophic levels in the food chain;
b) increase in the productivity;
c) increase in the stability of the community;
d) gradual decrease in the organic material (humus);
e) increase in the species diversity.
c) the total mass of the organism remains relatively constant once maturity is reached;
d) growth tends to become confined to special groups of cells.
97. Which of the following structures is common in fish, bird and mammalian auditory
(hearing) organ:
a) auriculum
b) semicircular channels;
c) auditory (hearing) channel
d) Eustachian tube;
e) a well developed cochlea.
98. Choose the correct statement:
a) reptiles like fish and amphibians have a body temperature regulating mechanism;
b) the bodies of reptiles are covered by moist, soft scales that help to protect them against dehydratation;
c) due to the development of kidney tubules as water conserving structures, reptiles are able to survive in the
desert;
d) reptiles secrete nitrogenous waste as urea.
99. Of the following groups the first animals to serve as pollinators were:
a) ant
b) beetle
c) bees
d) hummingbird.
100. The sense organ of balance in the crayfish is the:
a) claws
b) ears
c) antennal statocyst;
d) first mouth appendages;e) eye stalks.
101. Heart with two atria and one ventricle can be found in:
a) sparrow
b) toad
c) ray
d) carp.
102. Which animal is reproduced by parthenogenesis as a normal process:
a) hydra;
b) tapeworm
c) earthworm;
d) honey bee.
103. Approximately what percentage of existing animal species are invertebrates:
a) 20 %
b) 50 %
c) 70 %
d) 95 %.
104. Study the following diagrams of cell division. For
Fig. 1 (104.1)
Stage of cell division
Number of 2n chromosomes (in
interphase)
Fig. 2 (104.2)
105. The following biopolymers: nucleic acids, proteins and polysaccharides are characterized by the
following features:
The codes of the answers:
1. linear, almost never branched;
2. linear or branched;
3. homopolymers;
4. heteropolymers.
Put the correct answers into the table using the respective letters.
biopolimers
characteristics
1
nucleic acids
proteins
polysaccharides
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
What amino acid is most likely to be built in, aspartic acid (Asp) or methionine (Met) and which nucleotide is
mutated?
A.
B.
C.
D.
amino acid
aspartic acid
aspartic acid
methionine
methionine
nucleotide mutated
adenine
thymine
adenine
thymine
2.(2pt)
The table shows two different mRNA molecules and the two different protein molecules
synthesized from them.
mRNA
protein
.....AGAGAGAGAGAGAGAGAGAGAGAG.....
P
.....AAUGAAUGAAUGAAUGAAUGAAUG.....
Q
How many different types of amino acids can be found in each protein molecule?
A.
B.
C.
D.
P
1
1
2
2
Q
3
4
3
4
3.(1pt)
.(1pt)
Which one of the following items is not required for protein synthesis?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
5.(1pt)
B.
C.
D.
Enzymes loose some or all of their normal activity if their three dimensional structure is
disrupted.
Enzymes provide the activation energy necessary to initiate a reaction.
The activity of enzymes is independent of temperature and pH.
An enzyme acts only once and is then destroyed.
A bacterial mRNA with a length of 360 nucleotides in length codes for a protein of:
A.
B.
C.
D.
7.(1pt)
mRNA
ribosomes
tRNA
endoplasmic reticulum
amino acids
6.(1pt)
synthesis of proteins
synthesis of ATP with energy from dissimilation
reactions
synthesis of ATP with energy from the sun
transport of proteins
8.(1pt)
When a muscle cell has a shortage of oxygen will the pH
decrease or increase? What substance is responsible for this change in pH?
A.
B.
C.
D.
change in pH
decrease
decrease
increase
increase
caused by
carbon dioxide
lactate (lactic acid)
carbon dioxide
lactate (lactic acid)
9.(1pt)
10.(1pt)
11.(1pt)
What happens during glycolysis and what are the end products?
A.
Oxygen from CO2 is replaced by hydrogen and glucose is formed.
B.
As a result of splitting by fermentation of a glucose molecule, two molecules of tricarbon
acid are formed and 2 molecules of ATP are synthesized.
C.
As a result of the splitting of fat molecules, energy is released, which the cell needs.
D.
Tricarbon acid is split up into carbon dioxide and water, as a result of which 36 molecules
of ATP are synthesized.
12.(1pt)
The concentration of an electrically neutral substance within a certain type of blood cell is much
higher than it is in the surrounding blood plasma, yet the substance continues to move into the
cell. The process by which this substance moves into the cell is called:
A.
osmosis
B.
simple diffusion
C.
facilitated diffusion
D.
active transport
13.(2pt)
An U-shaped tube is filled with two different solutions, R and S, separated by a semi-permeable
membrane (X). R is hypotonic in relation to S, seen by the lighter tone in figure 4.
When an equilibrium is reached in the U-shaped tube of figure 4, are the surfaces equally high or
not, and are the osmotic pressures equal or not (see also figure 5)?
A. The right side is higher, the two solutions are isotonic
B. The right side is higher, the right side is hypertonic
C. The left side is higher, the right side is hypertonic
D. The surfaces are equally high, the two solutions are isotonic
14.(1pt)
15.(1pt)
A.
B.
C.
D.
A
B
C
D
16.(1pt)
17.(2pt)
18.(2pt)
19.(1pt)
What property/properties make(s) the phospholipids especially well suited to make up cellular
membranes?
A.
they are hydrophobic
B.
they are hydrophilic
C.
they absorb water readily
D.
they are both hydrophobic and hydrophilic
20.(1pt)
If one were observing a cell undergoing mitosis, which of the following would be evidence that it
was a plant rather than an animal cell?
A.
absence of spindle
B.
absence of centrioles
C.
replication of chromosomes
D.
disappearance of nuclear membrane
21.(1pt)
22.(1pt)
23.(1pt)
24.(1pt)
25.(1pt)
The molecular formula of glucose is C6H12O6. What would be the molecular formula of a
polymer made by linking ten glucose molecules together by a condensation reaction?
A.
C60H120O60
B.
C6H12O6
C.
C60H102O51
D.
C60H100O50
E.
C60H112O51
26.(1pt)
Cells of the pancreas will incorporate radioactive amino acids into proteins. This labels newly
synthesized proteins and enables to track the location of these proteins in a cell. In this case we
are tracking an enzyme that is eventually secreted by pancreas cells. Which of the following is
the most likely pathway for movement of this protein in the cell?
A.
endoplasmic reticulum - Golgi nucleus
B.
Golgi - endoplasmic reticulum lysosome
C.
nucleus - endoplasmic reticulum Golgi
D.
endoplasmic reticulum - Golgi vesicle that fuses with plasma membrane
E.
endoplasmic reticulum -lysosome vesicles that fuses with plasma membrane
27.(1pt)
28.(1pt)
Which one of the following elements is needed for the synthesis of chlorophyll, but is not itself a
component of chlorophyll?
A.
carbon
B.
magnesium
C.
nitrogen
D.
iron
E.
oxygen
29.(1pt)
With the help of a light microscope, it can be observed that when cells are dehydrated, plant cells
shrink less than animal cells. This is caused by the difference in:
A.
the flexibility of the plasmalemma
B.
the number of pores in the plasmalemma
C.
the osmotic potential of the cells
D.
the existence of a cell wall in plant cells
E.
the size of the vacuoles
30.(2pt)
If a stem is exposed to light from one side only, it bends towards the light (Fig.9A). This positive
phototropism is caused by substances which are synthesized in the top of the stem. In a stem of
a plant (which had been exposed from all sides) a crosswise incision was made just under the
top. In the incision, a small slide of glass was placed, after which the plant was exposed on the
side of the incision (Fig.9B).
How will the stem now grow, and what is the correct explanation of this phenomenon?
A.
The stem will bend away from the light. The sheet of glass in the incision causes an
increase in the concentration of growth-stimulating substances on the exposed side.
B.
The stem will bend away from the light. The sheet of glass stops the transport of growthinhibiting substances on the exposed side.
C.
The stem keeps growing straight upward. Positive phototropism of the untreated plant is
not caused by a decrease in the growth on the exposed side.
D.
The stem will bend towards the light. Light causes the transport of growth stimulating compounds towards the unexposed side of the stem.
32.(1pt)
33.(1pt)
A.
B.
C.
D.
34.(1pt)
A C3- and a C4-plant are both put into the same glass jar. The jar is kept away from the outside
air and is exposed to light during 12 hours a day for some time. After a week the C3-plant has
died. This happens because:
A.
the C4-plant needs less oxygen for respiration at night
B.
the C4-plant is more resistant to drought
C.
the C4-plant is more efficient in its photosynthesis
D.
the C4-plant exhausts the C3-plant by photosynthesizing its carbon dioxide which is
released during respiration
35.(1pt)
Potassium plays an important role in opening and closing of stomata. This role consists of:
A. changing the permeability of the plasmalemma of the guard cells for water
B. changing the osmotic potential of the guard cells
C. regulating the synthesis of the plant hormone called abscisic acid, which is needed for the
conversion of sugars into starch in the guard cells.
D.
regulating the production and degradation of starch and organic acids in the guard cells
37.(1pt)
Under conditions of a high atmospheric humidity hardly any calcium (Ca) is transported to
developing fruits. This is caused by:
A. calcium only being transported through the xylem and this transport not taking place
anymore
B. calcium only being transported through the phloem and this transport not taking place
anymore
C. transpiration stopping and, as a result both xylem and phloem transport stopping
D. the stomata closing and transport to the fruit stopping
38.(1pt)
C4-plants can start photosynthesis with a lower concentration of CO2 in the atmosphere than C3plants. This is because:
A.
respiration of C4-plants is higher
B.
respiration of C4-plants is lower
C.
C4-plants do not have photorespiration
D.
C4-plants do have photorespiration
39.(1pt)
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
40.(1pt)
From two trees, diameter 10 and 40 cm, the bark of the stem is equal in thickness.
The reason for this is:
I.
secondary phloem is produced much less than secondary xylem
II.
dead phloem cells are pressed together
III.
rhytidome is produced and the outer bark peels off
What is correct ?
A.
I and II only
B.
I and III only
C.
II and III only
D.
I, II and III
41.(1pt)
The table in Fig. 14 shows the percentages of identity of alpha-hemoglobin amino acid
sequences among four animal species: L, M, N, P.
The species investigated are: man, chimpanzee, horse and kangaroo, but it is not known which
letter corresponds to which species. Which one of the given keys is most likely to be correct?
man
chimpansee
horse
kangaroo
A.
L
M
N
P
B.
P
N
M
L
C.
L
P
M
N
D.
M
N
L
P
42.(1pt)
In one of the groups listed below more than one heart may be found. In which group?
A. echinoderms
B. bivalves
C. cephalopods
D. non-vertebrate chordates
43.(1pt)
Only one of the following features of the phylum of the Chordata also is present in adult
Tunicata (=Urochordata). Which feature?
A.
possession of a chorda
B.
possession of visceral slits ( = pharyngeal slits)
C.
possession of a tail
D.
possession of a dorsal tubular nervous system
44.(1pt)
One of the following properties can be used to distinguish reptiles from amphibians. Which one?
A.
a closed type of circulatory system
B.
reproductive organs opening into the intestine
C.
a single compartment stomach
D.
a metanephros type of kidney
45.(1pt)
The increase in complexity of the vertebrate circulatory system is represented by one of the
following combinations. Which combination?
A.
toad
- rabbit
- alligator
- shark
B.
shark
- frog
- alligator
- rabbit
C.
shark
- crocodile
- rabbit
- frog
D.
alligator - dog
- shark
- toad
46.(1pt)
Blood loses its oxygen rapidly in one of the following places. Which one?
A.
lung alveoles
B.
blood capillaries in intestines
C.
lung veins
D.
liver portal vein
47.(1pt)
Four possibilities for the transport of carbon dioxide from the body cells to the lungs are listed
below. Which possibility does not exist?
A.
bound to the ferro-ions of hemoglobin in erythrocytes
B.
as a hydrocarbonate ion in the buffering system of the blood
C.
bound to the protein of hemoglobin in erythrocytes
D.
dissolved in blood plasma and in erythrocyte cytoplasm
48.(1pt)
49.(1pt)
50.(1pt)
51.(1pt)
The concentration of a substance in Bowman's capsules of a healthy human kidney is 0.1%, while
its concentration in the urine is zero. Which one of the following substances is meant?
A.
calcium phosphate
B.
glucose
C.
sodium chloride
D.
uric acid
Which of the four organs listed below does not belong to the immune system?
A.
lymph nodes
B.
pancreas
C.
thymus
D.
spleen
Which of the following statements about macrophages is
false?
A.
Macrophages look like amoebas.
B.
Macrophages produce antibodies.
C.
Macrophages produce interleukines
D.
Macrophages practise phagocytosis
52.(1pt)
Which organ(s) in Fig. 15 is/are under the control of a
hormone released by the pituitary gland?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
1 only
2 only
1 and 2 only
2 and 8 only
1, 2 and 8
53.(1pt)
Which one of the following symptoms can be used as evidence for an insufficiency of the
hormones secreted by the parathyroid glands?
A.
decrease in blood glucose
B.
increase in blood urea
C.
decrease in blood calcium
D.
decrease in blood amino acids
54.(1pt)
The vitelline sac (=yolk sac) is expected to be very small in one of the following groups. In which
one?
A.
in groups that fertilize externally
B.
in groups with embryos that are fed from maternal blood
C.
in groups that fertilize internally
D.
in groups that have an allantoic membrane
55.(1pt)
One of the following traits is common to both avian and mammalian development. Which one?
A.
holoblastic cleavage
B.
primitive streak
C.
trophoblast
D.
yolk plug/mass
56.(1pt)
57.(1pt)
entoderm
lungs
lungs
kidneys
heart
One of the alternatives below defines the layers of the retina in the correct sequence. Which one?
N.B! The first layer in each sequence is supposed to be located next to the jellylike vitreous
humor that fills the eyeball.
A.
pigmented cells - bipolar cells
- ganglion cells
- photoreceptors
B.
photoreceptors - pigmented cells
- ganglion cells
- bipolar cells
C.
ganglion cells
- bipolar cells
- photoreceptors
- pigmented cells
D.
photoreceptors - bipolar cells
- ganglion cells
- pigmented cells
58.(1pt)
During starvation or hibernation, the supplies of energy substrates are used up in the order:
A. fats
- proteins
- carbohydrates
B. fats
- carbohydrates
- proteins
C. carbohydrates
- fats
- proteins
D. proteins
- carbohydrates
- fats
59.(1pt)
60.(1pt)
61.(1pt)
The red patch of the bill of a herring gull has a special function for its chickens. One of the
statements below is true. Which one? It serves as a:
A. super normal stimulus
B. sign stimulus
C. inhibitor of aggression
D. recognition marker of the parent
Some bees in an observation hive found a white clover field at 500 m. distance. At 10 a.m. they
danced in the hive according to figure 16A.
In the same hive other bees found a group of linden trees; they danced at 10 a.m. according to
figue 16B. How would these bees dance at 2 p.m.?
A.
according to figure 16A
B.
according to figure 16B
C.
according to figure 16C
D.
according to figure 16D
63.(1pt)
A number of moth species use pheromones to achieve the encounter between the sexes.
Generally it is the stationary female that produces this odour, and the male often flies long
distances to find the female.
A. He is activated by the pheromones and flies upwind to the odour source (anemotaxis); the
pheromones induce landing near the female.
B. He is activated by the pheromones and uses the odour gradient (chemotaxis) both for
orientation and landing.
C. He is activated by climatic conditions; after a random flight he spots the female nearby
through the perception of pheromones.
D. He is activated by climatic conditions; celestial cues enable a directed flight; the
pheromones induce landing near the female.
64.(1pt)
During autumn migration the young of some bird species fly with their parents, while in other
species old and young birds migrate separately. This is related to :
A. the number of broods the parents make in a season
B. the average life span of an individual of that species
C. food requirements during migration
D. the direction and distance of the migration being learned or innate
65.(1pt)
Pigeons were trained to collect food from a feeding machine at 10 a.m., by picking at a pigeon
key. Then they were transported 60 degrees eastward to a place P. At this new location they
are expected to pick at the pigeon key (local time in P) at:
A.
10 a.m.
B.
4 a.m.
C.
4 p.m.
D.
2 p.m.
66.(1pt)
67.(1pt)
68.(1pt)
So-called altruistic behaviour (e.g. the protection of lion pups by `aunts') occurs in natural
populations because (choose the primary reason):
A.
it ensures survival of the species
B.
it ensures survival of kin
C.
it ensures spread of the genes shared by relatives
D.
of group selection mechanisms
69.(1pt)
70.(2pt)
71.(1pt)
Which form of natural selection can lead to differentiation in species and to polymorphism?
A.
directional selection
B.
stabilizing selection
C.
disruptive selection
D.
density dependent selection
72.(1pt)
73.(1pt)
74.(1pt)
75.(1pt)
76.(1pt)
Which factor possibly played a selecting role in the evolution of the flower:
A.
the fertilization process becoming independent on the presence of water
B.
development of adaptations to pollination
C.
development of a surplus of nutrients in the seed
D.
development of adaptations to the spreading of fruits
77.(1pt)
78.(1pt)
79.(1pt)
80.(1pt)
Which two pictures in figure 17 give a summary of the theory of natural selection according to
Darwin:
A.
B.
C.
D.
81.(1pt)
82.(2pt)
I and III
I and IV
II and III
II and IV
In the European population, about 1 in 2500 people suffers from Cystic Fibrosis, a genetically
determined (descared), autosomal disease. Healthy parents have a child suffering from Cystic
Fibrosis. The woman remarries a healthy man. What is the chance of a child from this second
marriage suffering from Cystic Fibrosis:
A.
1 : 25
B.
1 : 50
C.
1 : 100
D.
1 : 625
The pedigree in figure 18 shows an inheritance of a rare form of muscular dystrophy.
Extinct marine xiphosaurs are found in a large area in 150 million-year-old sediments
(150 Myr BP). From each individual, the length/breadth ratio of the carapax was measured. This
length/breadth ratio is referred to as 's'.
In figure 19, graph P represents the distribution of quality 's' for 150 Myr BP.
In sediments of 100 Myr BP, three different populations of xiphosaurs are found in three different
places. The graphs a, b, c in figure 19 represent the distribution of quality 's' in each of these
three populations. Answer the following two questions:
1
for which of the three populations (a, b, c) is it most probable that species formation occurs?
2
for which of the three areas (a, b, c) is it most probable that the environment remained
constant?
species formation
constant environment
A
b
a
B
c
c
C
c
a
D
b
b
84.(1pt)
85.(1pt)
The order of appearance of the main groups of organisms during evolution can best be described
as follows:
A.
autotrophic, anaerobic heterotrophic, aerobic heterotrophic
B.
aerobic heterotrophic, anaerobic heterotrophic, autotrophic
C.
anaerobic heterotrophic, aerobic heterotrophic, water oxydizing autotrophic
D.
anaerobic heterotrophic, water oxydizing autotrophic, aerobic heterotrophic
The main trend in the evolution of land plant was:
A.
a sharp demarcation of the phases of sporophyte and gametophyte
B.
a shortening of the haploid phase
C.
a shortening of the a-sexual phase
D.
an increase in the complexity of the gametophyte
86.(1pt)
87.(2pt)
How many different phenotypes can be expected in the F2 of the crossing: AA BB * aa bb when:
I the genes are completely coupled and,
II the genes inherit independently:
I
II
A.
3
4
B.
3
9
C.
4
9
D.
4
16
E.
9
16
88.(3pt)
In the domestic cat, the locus Orange is sex linked and intermediary dominant: heterozygous cats
are 'tortoise'. A tortoise pussy cat (Oo) mates with a red tomcat (oY); the third colour is tabby
(OO, OY). What can be expected for the fur colour of the kittens?
females
males
A.
tortoise
red and tabby
B.
tortoise and red
red and tortoise
C.
tortoise and red
red and tabby
D.
red and tabby
red and tabby
89.(3pt)
In the domestic cat, the autosomal locus White is dominant and epistatic; the locus Orange is sex
linked with allele O tabby and allele o red, while the heterozygous is tortoise. A white female
mates with a tabby tomcat.
The kittens turn out to be:
1 red male
1 tortoise female
1 tabby female
1 white male
1 white female
What is the genotype of the mother:
A.
WW Oo
B.
Ww OO
C.
Ww Oo
D.
Ww oo
90.(1pt)
The following reactions produce the eye pigments B and D in fruit flies:
enzyme X
substrate A ----------------> pigment B
substrate C
enzyme Y
----------------> pigment D
Mixing of both pigments results in a reddish brown eye colour with wild type flies. Absence of
pigment B results in bright red eyes, absence of pigment D results in brown eyes, absence of
both pigments results in colourless (white) eyes.
When a homozygous fly with colourless eyes is crossed with a homozygous wild type fly, which
enzymes can be demonstrated in the F1 descendants:
A.
X only
B.
Y only
C.
X and Y
D.
none
91.(3pt)
92.(1pt)
Crossing of two white dogs with the same genotype results in descendants in the following
relation: 12 white : 3 black : 1 brown. When the brown descendant is crossed with a white which
has the same genotype as the parents, what is the expected relation in this second crossing:
white :
black :
dark brown :
brown
A.
9
3
3
1
B.
1
1
1
1
C.
12
3
1
D.
2
1
1
A simplified representation of the nitrogen cycle in an ecosystem is shown in figure 20.
Which group of bacteria is involved in the conversion of proteins to NH3 ?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
93.(1pt)
94.(1pt)
Decomposers
Chemosynthetizers
Nitrogen oxidizers
Free nitrogen fixers
Ammonia oxidizers
95.(1pt)
The transfer of energy through a terrestrial ecosystem is often depicted by energy pyramids.
Which of the following statements is true ?
A. Ecological efficiency is highest for top consumers.
B. About 10 % of the energy from one trophic level is incorporated into biomass of the next
level.
C. The energy lost as heat or in cellular respiration is 10 % of the available energy of each
trophic level.
D. Only 25 % of the energy in one trophic level is passed on to the next level.
96.(1pt)
Nitrogen fertilization of rice fields can be low in the presence of one of the following types of
organisms. Which one ?
A.
Water fern (Azolla species)
B.
Green algae
C.
Brown algae
D.
Mosses
97.(1pt)
On the border of two ecosystems (grassland and wood), there is a transitional zone (ecotope).
Characteristic for the fauna of this ecotope is:
A. A smaller species diversity in comparison with the two adjoining ecosystems.
B. A greater species diversity in comparison with the two adjoining ecosystems.
C. A greater number of herbivores in comparison with the two adjoining ecosystems.
D. A greater number of predators and parasites in comparison with the two adjoining
ecosystems.
98.(1pt)
The growth of a population of animals is mainly determined by the combination of two important
parameters. Which?
A.
birth rate and food supply
B.
mortality rate and migration
C.
mortality rate and the size of the area occupied by the population
D.
birth and mortality rate
E.
food sources and the size of the territory
99.(1pt)
100.(2pt)
A.
B.
C.
D.
101.(1pt)
A.
B.
C.
D.
102.(1pt)
A
tropical grassland
tropical rain forest
tundra
tropical grassland
B
tropical rain forest
broad-leaved forest from temperate regions
tropical rain forest
grassland from temperate regions
In a laboratory, a competition experiment is executed with two types of bacteria, which compete
for food. During the experiment, it is determined what the relationship is between the frequency
of type 1 in the mixed culture after 1 generation (zt+1) as a function of the frequency of type 1
during the previous generation (zt). In figure 23, the drawn line indicates the observed
relationship between zt+1 and zt, the dotted line is the relationship zt+1 = zt.
In a trout hatchery, a density experiment was executed. In figure 24, the eventual density is
plotted as a function of the starting density. The eventual densities were determined before a
new generation of trouts was born in the fish-breeding pond. What is the explanation for the fact
that, for higher starting densities, the eventual density is no longer dependent on the starting
densities?
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
104.(2pt) In figure 25, the biomass of the macrofauna and the microfauna in various ecosystems is
presented.
Which conclusion can be drawn about the breakdown speed of litter and the accumulation rate of humus.
A.
B.
C.
D.
tundra:
tundra:
tropical rain forest:
tropical rain forest:
105.(2pt) In figure 26, the changes in time of three quantities are shown during the secondary succession
after a forest fire.
These quan
secondary production
biomass of the
vegetation
ecosystem respiration
106.(1pt)
During the last decades, the concentration of CO2 in the atmosphere has gradually increased.
Which of the following factors does not partly cause this:
A.
cutting down the tropical rain forest.
B.
The combustion of fossil fuels.
C.
The increasing motorized traffic.
D.
The increasing desert forming in the Sahel zone in Africa.
E.
The world-wide increase of the net primary production.
107.(1pt)
108.(2pt)
The decomposition rate of dead material, expressed as the change in dry weight in time, is
often described by means of a negative exponential equation:
mt = m0 . e
-kt
In this equation, mt is the mass at time t, m0 is the mass at time 0 (when the material has just
died off) and k is the decomposition constant. k varies strongly with different types of material.
In which sequences below the value of k is increasing from left to right ?
A.
Wood
- leaves of Prunus (cherry-tree)
- leaves of Fagus (beech)
B.
Wood
- leaves of Fagus
- leaves of Prunus
C.
Leaves of Prunus
- leaves of Fagus
- wood
D.
Leaves of Fagus
- leaves of Prunus
- wood
E.
Leaves of Fagus
- wood
- leaves of Prunus
109.(3pt)
The growth speed of a population can often be described with the logistic growth equation:
dN/dt = rN(K-N)/K
In this equation, N is the number of individuals, r is the intrinsic relative rate, and K is the carrying
capacity.
According to this equation, the equilibrium number of individuals in the population is determined by:
A.
r only
B.
K only
C.
r and K
D.
N and K
E
r and N
110.(2pt) In many experiments it has been observed that the light extinction in a vegetation decreases with
2
2
an increasing Leaf Area Index (LAI : m leaf per m area), in accordance with this equation:
(-k x LAId)
Id = I0 x e
In this equation, Id is the light intensity at depth d in the vegetation (measured from the top!), I0 is
the light intensity above the vegetation, k is the extinction coefficient and LAId the cumulative Leaf
Area Index (measured from the top of the vegetation).
Which statement is not correct ?
k increases with an increasing:
A.
thickness of the leaves
B.
concentration of chlorophyl in the leaves
C.
amount of leaves in the vegetation
D.
reflection of light in the vegetation
111.(2pt)
The curves 1 to 4 in figure 27 are growth curves of bacterial populations under conditions W, X,
Y, and Z.
The arrows mark the first and last codon for gene A. Just a small portion of the
flanking DNA is shown. Indicate in the table which chainpart and which number do
match correctly. (ss = single stranded, ds = double stranded).
chainpart:
number:
ss DNA
ss RNA
ds DNA
ds RNA
ds DNA/RNA
113.(4pt) In the model of a gene given below, the organisation of the DNA in and around the
chromosomal "single copy" gene for the polypeptide musculase is shown. Marked are
the initiation and termination sites of transcription, the start and stop codons of
translation and the boundaries of the intron in the gene (). The distances are given in
kilobases (kb), but not drawn on scale.
ini
sta
sto ter
Of how many aminoacids does the polypeptide musculase consist? Assume the
musculase does not undergo any posttranslational processing.
Answer:
...........
Of how many nucleotides does the musculase mRNA consist that is used in the
ribosomes? Assume that there is a 100 nucleotides long poly-A-tail connected to the
mRNA at the 3'-terminus before it is operational.
Answer:
.............
114.(4pt) In the wild type of Escherichia coli the polypeptide P consists of 169 aminoacids. The
sequence of the aa 161 to 165 (counted from the N-terminus) is:
161
trp
---
162
his
163
met
164
glu
165
tyr
---
There is a population which has a mutation in the structural gene for polypeptide P, as
a result of which the pp only contains 165 amino acids. The order of the first 161 amino
acids is the same as with the wild type. The order of the others is as follows:
161
trp
---
162
thr
163
tyr
164
gly
165
val
---
Assume in the following questions that the mutant mRNA differs in only one nucleotide
of the wildtpye mRNA.
a.
Give the mRNA codons for the aminoacids 161 to 165 for the wildtype and the
mutant. Use figure 1 for the codons. For each aminoacid only one code will be
the correct one.
B.
161
UGG
UGG
162
163
164
165
What kind of mutation has happened? Place a tick in the correct column:
substitution mutation
addition mutation
deletion mutation
C.
.............
115.(3pt) Plants can move. We distinguish between nastic movements and tropism.
Give the most common mechanism by which these movements take place, both for
nastic movements and tropism. Choose from the following list:
A.
by means of contractile proteins
B.
by means of elongation of the group of cells involved
C.
by means of restraining cell division of the group of cells involved
D.
by means of stimulating the cell division of the group of cells involved
E.
by means of changing the permeability of the plasmalemma
F.
by means of water absorption of the group of cell involved
Answer:
Tropism:
.......................
Nastic movements :
.......................
116.(3pt) From a one-year-old plant, a growth analysis has been made by measuring a number
of parameters at various points in time. In figure 29, the obtained results are plotted on
the Y-axis, on different scales, against time (X-axis).
Match each of
the parameters with the curves. Place a tick in the correct column.
A
parenchyma
collenchyma
sclerenchyma
water absorption
less
same
more
Figure 30 shows the pith rays close to the cambium on a tangential cross-section of
the bark of a tree. With this tree, dilatation only takes place in the pith rays.
Quite far from the cambium, the pith rays in the bark, on a tangential cross-section look like
figure:
.........
(Fill in A, B, C or D)
120.(2pt)
The soil of an oat field gets exhausted at the beginning of flowering. Then half of the
field is manured with artificial fertilizer, which contains all elements needed, and in a
form that can easily be taken in by the plants. What will happen with the plants on
that part of the field that was not manured ? Place a tick in the correct column.
true
false
The following animal phyla are placed in the supposed chronological order in which
they developed during evolution:
1-Protozoa;
2-Porifera;
3-Cnidaria;
4-Platyhelminthes;
5-Annelida;
6-Arthropoda;
7-Chordata.
Fill in which of the phyla mentioned above was the first in evolution in having:
A.
extracellular digestion?
nr:
B.
a nervous system?
nr:
C.
a closed tubular circulatory system?
nr:
D.
a digestive tract with a mouth and an anus separated
nr:
from each other?
122.(4pt)
nrs:
nrs:
nrs:
nrs:
.......
.......
.......
.......
................
................
................
................
123.(3pt) In the digestive system of the human body, the ingested organic substances are
digested (= broken down) to monomers (= simple substances). Indicate the shortest
way along which one of these monomers, glucose, can reach the kidneys from the
intestine, by putting the numbers of the structures involved in the right sequence.
These numbers are to be chosen from the following list:
1 = jugular veins
7 = aorta
12 = left ventricle
2 = inferior vena cava
8 = renal arteries
13 = carotic arteries
3 = liver
9 = lungs
14 = brain
4 = left atrium
10 = right ventricle
15 = hepatic portal vein
5 = superior vena cava
11 = pulmonary veins
16 = pulmonary arteries.
6 = right atrium
Answer: ............................................................................
124.(2pt)
Indicate in the margin with + or which of the following statements about nutrition
and digestion are true (+) or false ().
A.
In mammals, the protein-hydrolyzing enzyme pepsine is produced in the liver.
B.
In mammals, the production of saliva by the salivary glands is regulated by
nerves originating from the brain.
C.
Gland cells in the wall of the stomach of ruminants produce an enzyme that
digests cellulose.
D.
Which of the amino acids are to be called exogenous/essential amino acids,
as opposed to endogenous/non-essential amino acids, depends on the animal
species under consideration.
125.(2pt) Write down the numbers of the following structures as appearing from Fig.31:
See next page
Fout! Bladwijzer niet gedefinieerd.
A.
B.
glomerulus:
C.
D.
loop of Henle:
Answer:
126.(2pt) Rh+ blood is transfused into a Rh- woman who has not previously been transfused.
Indicate in the margin with + or which of the following statements are true (+) or false
().
A. Anti-Rh antibodies will be produced by the woman.
B. The transfused blood and the blood of the woman are incompatible, so red cell
agglutination and death may follow.
C. In a subsequent pregnancy, a Rh+ foetus could be threatened by haemolytic
disease.
D. There is no immediate or long term effect as 70% of the Rh+ population are
heterozygous.
127.(2pt) Indicate in the margin with + or which of the following statements about insulin are
true (+) or false ().
A.
Insulin stimulates the conversion of lipids to glucose.
B.
Excess amounts of insulin in the body can cause a state of coma.
C.
Insulin increases the storage of glycogen in the liver.
D.
Insulin increases the blood glucose level.
128.(2pt)
Indicate in the margin with + or which of the following statements about the
female reproductive system are true (+) or false ().
A. Both oestrogen and progesterone are necessary for ovulation to take place.
B. Oestrogen inhibits the production of FSH by the anterior pituitary gland.
C. Fertilization of the ovum by the spermatozoon normally takes place in the
uterus.
D. Progesterone production is largely under the control of LH.
129.(3pt)
Figure 32 shows
changes in the blood
concentration levels of
several hormones
involved in pregnancy,
birth and lactation. The
various curves in the
Figure are labelled with
the letters A to E.
curve
oestrogen
oxytocin
prolactin
progesterone from placenta
progesterone from corpus luteum
130.(2pt)
The following statements are related to the regulation of the processes of moulting
and metamorphosis during the lifecycle of butterflies.
Indicate in the margin with + or which statements are true (+) or false ().
A.
If, early in the second larval stage, the secretion by the corpora allata of
juvenile hormone is inhibited; the next moult will result in a new caterpillar.
B.
If, early in the last larval stage, the secretion by the prothoracic glands of
ecdyson is inhibited; the metamorphosis to a fully developed butterfly will
occur.
C.
If, early in the second larval stage, the secretion by the brain of a hormone
which stimulates the prothoric glands is inhibited; there will be no more
moulting
D.
If, early in the last larval stage, extra juvenile hormone is injected, the next
nr:
nr:
nr:
nr:
132(2pt) Write down the numbers of the following structures as appearing from figure 34:
nr:
nr:
nr:
nr:
133.(2pt) The statements below are partly related to figures 33 and 34.
Indicate in the margin with + or which statements are true (+) or false ().
A.
Bilateral destructions of parts 11, 12, 13 and 14 of figure 33 lead to deafness.
B.
Cutting certain spinal nerves which originate from the neck region of the spinal
cord results in deafness.
C.
Cutting the dorsal roots of spinal nerves which originate from the chest and the
D.
belly regions of the spinal cord results, among others, in the loss of the skin's
sensitivity to tactile contact stimuli in certain regions of the body surface.
Eliminating the left hemisphere of the cerebrum results in the loss of the skin's
sensitivity (=skin senses) mainly in the left part of the body.
134.(2pt) Somebody has a small injury at the retina of the left eye. This injury is situated at the
top of this retina, into the direction of the left ear of this person. He is looking with his
left eye to a paper with a cross and a spot on it. The image of the spot is exactly
projected on the injury of the retina. Choose from figure 35 the correct combination of
the positions of spot and cross on the paper.
Answer (combination):
135.(2pt)
..............
The daily food intake of a 30 year old woman contains 70 g of protein, 70 g of fat and
an unknown amount of carbohydrate.
Assume energy values per gram are 17 kJ for protein, 37 kJ for fat and 16 kJ for
carbohydrate.
A.
How much is the maximum energy yield of the fat in the diet?
Answer: .................. kJ
B.
If the energy needs of the woman are 10800 kJ per day, how much
carbohydrate must she consume to be in energy balance?
Answer: .................. g
136.(2pt) A person eating an entirely vegetarian diet must usually eat a greater mass and
variety of protein per day than a person eating a diet containing animal protein.
Consider the statements A, B, C and D about this. Indicate in the margin with + or
which statements are a correct (+) or incorrect () explanation for the necessary
differences in the two diets.
A.
In general, the diversity of amino acids essential for human beings is not as
great in a plant protein as it is in an animal protein.
B.
In general, the ratio between the amounts of various essential amino acids in
a plant protein differs strongly from that in an animal protein.
C.
In general, the percentage of proteins is lower in vegetable food than in animal
food.
D.
In general, plant proteins are more difficult to be digested and less completely
digestible than animal proteins.
137.(1pt) Figure 36 compares the appearances of two types of cows, A and B.
Indicate for each curve in this Figure which type of cow it represents. Fill in A or B.
Answer
curve 1:
type ........
curve 2:
type ........
curve 3:
type ........
curve 4:
type ........
139.(2pt) Match each of the organisms listed below with its corresponding trophic level
A. earthworm
1. primary producer
B. phytoplankton
2. primary consumer
C. pike
3. secondary consumer
D. grasshopper
4. detritivore
E. frog
5. tertiairy consumer
Answer:
A matches with:
..........(Fill in 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, etc)
B matches with:
..........
C matches with:
..........
D matches with:
..........
E matches with:
..........
1. camouflage
2. animals with effective defenses are often brightly coloured
3. one partner benefits without significantly affecting the other
4. both partners benefit from the relationship
5. a harmless species resembles an `armed' one
A matches with:
B matches with:
C matches with:
D matches with:
E matches with:
END
.............
.............
.............
.............
.............
(Fill in 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, etc)
2
2
3
2
C
2
B
2
11 - 20
21 - 30
31 - 40
41 - 50
51 - 60
61 - 70
71 - 80
81 - 90
91 - 100
101 - 110
111
2
2
B
C
115
116
117
118
119
120
121A
B
C
D
122A
B
C
D
(Part B)
ssDNA 2,4,6
ds DNA/RNA 1,3,5,7
300
3200
162 163
164 165
CAU AUG GAG UAU
ACA UAU GGA GUA
addition
U
T B
N F
A
B
C
p - s
p c - s
p c c less
less
less
less
less
same
skipped
true
true
false
false
3
3
5
5
4, 5, 6
5, 6, 7
(4), 5, 6
4, 5, 6, 7
123
124A
B
C
D
125A
B
C
D
126A
B
C
D
127A
B
C
D
128A
B
C
D
129
skipped
+
+
9
5
10
7
+
+
+
+
+
+
C
D
E
B
A
130A B
C
+
D
+
131A 15
B
3
C
6, 7
D
17
132A 10
B
13
C
5
D
2
133A
B
C
D
134
135
136A
B
C
D
137
138
139
140
+
+
B
skipped
+
+
+
A
B
A
B
A
4
1
5
2
3
4
3
1
2
5
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
PRACTICAL TEST
4th International Biology Olympiad 1993, Utrecht, the Netherlands
The test consists of five sections: I to V.
There are two groups of participants.
Group A: participants with nos. 1 - 30;
Group B: participants with nos. 31 - 60.
There are five halls, numbered 1 - 5.
You will not do all five sections of the test in the same hall. There are guides to tell
you where you are supposed to go and where your seat is. You are not allowed to
leave before the end of each section.
Group A will do the practical test in the following sequence:
Section I in hall 1
(60 mins.)
Section II in halls 2 and 3 (60 mins.)
Section III in hall 1
(45 mins.)
break
(15 mins.)
Section IV in hall 4
(45 mins.)
Section V in hall 5
(45 mins.)
The sequence for group B is as follows:
Section II in halls 2 and 3 (60 mins.)
Section III in hall 1
(45 mins.)
Section IV in hall 4
(45 mins.)
break
(15 mins.)
Section V in hall 5
(45 mins.)
Section I in hall 1
(60 mins.)
The maximum number of points to be obtained amounts to a total of 201.
The maximum points to be gained from sections I - V separately are as follows:
Section I:
40 points
Section II:
41 points
Section III: 45 points
Section IV: 39 points
Section V:
36 points
The maximum score for each separate question is indicated between brackets in the
margin of the answer sheets.
1
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
PRACTICAL TEST
4th International Biology Olympiad 1993
Section I: The reaction of nematodes to manuring. (60 mins., hall 1)
Some 80 % of all multicellular animals on earth are nematodes. One kilogramme of
soil contains an average of 30,000 individuals, representing some 30 to 60 different
species.
You are going to analyze the effects of manuring on these nematodes.
Preliminary research showed that a certain type of poor sandy soil contained the
following types of nematodes:
plant parasites (pp)
bacteria eaters (ba)
fungus eaters (fu)
carnivores (ca) and
omnivores (om).
Dehydrated nematode-free cattle manure was added to this sandy soil. Six days
later, a second sample was taken for nematode fauna analysis. We now have two
samples, one taken before manuring, the other afterwards. The table below shows
the composition of the nematode fauna in percentages before manuring:
Name
Acrobelus
Aphelenchoides
Diplogaster
Eudorylaimus
Hemicycliophora
Prionchulus
Rhabditis
Rotylenchus
Trichodorus
Tylenchus
Others
Food
ba
fu
ba
om
pp
ca
ba
pp
pp
pp
group %
2
46.5
2
4.5
1
1.5
3
11.0
3
6.0
3
3.5
1
3.0
3
9.5
3
2.0
2
5.5
7.0
Each name is followed by the type of food and a number from 1 to 3. This number
gives information about the life strategy of the species in question. The following
characteristics are distinguished:
Group 1 Enrichment opportunists.
These nematodes can exploit new food sources fast.
They have a life cycle of several days.
They produce numerous small eggs.
They are relatively insensitive to stress.
They are transported by insects.
They are found in soil with high food density and show dormancy periods
(dauerlarvae) when the food supply decreases.
Group 2 General opportunists.
These nematodes have a longer life cycle than the enrichment opportunists.
They are susceptible to stress but are not found in poor soil.
Group 3 Persisters.
These nematodes have a life-span of several months.
The produce few but large eggs.
They are relatively sensitive to stress.
2
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
Find the nematodes with the small magnification, then use the 40x-lens
and identify them on the basis of the pictures supplied.
Return to the small magnification. Begin on the left hand side of the
specimen and work through the specimen systematically and
representatively until you have identified 40 nematodes. Allow at least 45
minutes for this task. Keep a record of your observations.
3
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
4
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
(3)
Number
Acrobelus
.........
.........
Aphelenchoides
.........
.........
Diplogaster
.........
.........
Eudorylaimus
.........
.........
Hemicycliophora
.........
.........
Prionchulus
.........
.........
Rhabditis
.........
.........
Rotylenchus
.........
.........
Trichodorus
.........
.........
Tylenchus
.........
.........
Unidentified
.........
.........
(2)
.........
.........
.........
5
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
(2)
I.1
In the triangle (fig. I.1) the point has shifted in a certain direction.
What does this indicate?
O Larger presence of predators
O Increased food supply
O Stress
O Increase in number of nematodes
O Shift within food types
(2)
I.2
(1)
I.3
(2)
I.4
(2)
I.5
I.6
(3)
6
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
(3)
I.7
7
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
PRACTICAL TEST
4th International Biology Olympiad 1993
Section II:
The plants used for this experiment, the agricultural crop maize (Zea mays), were
grown in a greenhouse under different nitrogen conditions. These nitrogen levels are
indicated with L (low) and H (high). The levels of all other nutriments were the same
for both test groups. In this section, you will study the resulting growth differences.
For this purpose, you will have to
A
weigh
B
determine leaf surface
C
determine root length
You will do this in various places in halls 2 and 3.
There are not enough practical test sets for all of you. The following are available:
5 scales for weighing (takes very little time)
10 sets for determining leaf surface (takes little time)
20 sets for determining root length (takes a bit longer)
It makes no difference which set you use.
Plan your time in such a way that you can do all the tasks.
As you also need time to process your findings, you will hardly have to wait for each
other, if at all.
Task IIA
A number of plants were harvested before this Olympiad. The leaves, stems and
roots of these plants have been collected and dried separately. This is the dried
material that you will find in the plastic pots and cups. Each pot contains leaves,
stems or roots of three plants. The net weight of each pot is indicated on the
outside.
-
Determine the dry weight of the leaves, stems and roots of three plants with
an (electronic) scale.
Do this for both nitrogen levels.
Write the code (LA ... or HA ...) of the pots used and the average dry weight
for each plant on your answer sheet.
Now calculate the ratio between the average dry weight of the shoot
(leaves plus stem) and the average dry weight of the roots as follows:
leaves + stem
root
For maximum growth under fixed nitrogen conditions, the plant could
distribute its biomass across shoot and root in several ways. This would
result in changes in the shoot/root weight ratio. On the answer sheet, a
number of possible explanations are suggested for the differences found.
Indicate in the margin with + or - which of these suggestions can and which
cannot serve as possible explanations.
Task IIB
Apart from the weight of a plant, the leaf surface is also an important factor. One
way of determining it is to measure the lengths of the leaves of a plant and the
widths at half the length of each leaf. The average leaf surface can then be
calculated as follows:
length x width x 0.761.
8
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
The leaves of plants grown at two different nitrogen levels have been placed
under transparent plates. For each nitrogen level, determine the total leaf
surface of one plant.
On the answer sheet, enter both the code of the plants measured (LB ... or HB
...) and the results.
The fresh weight of the leaves is indicated for each individual plant under the plates.
Another experiment showed that the dry weight/fresh weight ratio is equal to:
0.13 for leaves of the high-nitrogen plants
0.15 for leaves of the low-nitrogen plants.
On the basis of these data, the calculation carried out in the first part of task
IIB and the results of task IIA, calculate the average leaf surface of the highnitrogen (H) and the low-nitrogen (L) plants you weighed for task IIA.
Task IIC
Another important factor besides leaf surface is root length. It is determined as
follows. A representative piece of root is placed in a large Petri dish filled with water.
The dish is placed on a grid showing parallel horizontal and vertical lines at fixed
intervals. The larger the number of crossings of root and grid lines, the larger the
root length. The formula for root length calculation is the following:
Root length = the number of crossings x correction factor.
The correction factor for the grids used is 0.987.
20 grids are available. Choose one of them.
Determine the total root length of a piece of root, for both high-nitrogen and
low-nitrogen plants. On the answer sheet, enter the code of the roots (LC ...,
HC ...) and your findings.
Data on the fresh weight of the roots you have weighed are supplied. The dry
weight/fresh weight ratio is equal to:
0.09 for high-nitrogen roots
0.10 for low-nitrogen roots.
On the basis of these data, the calculation carried out in the first part of task
IIC and the results of task IIA, determine the average root length of the highnitrogen (H) and the low-nitrogen (L) plants you weighed in task IIA.
Now calculate, for both high-nitrogen and low-nitrogen levels, the ratio
between average leaf surface and average root length for the plants weighed
in task IIA.
You have now calculated two indexes for the plants from task IIA:
dry weight of the shoot
dry weight of the roots
(task IIA), and
total leaf surface
total root length
-
(task IIC).
9
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
H (code HA ...)
..........
..........
..........
(2)
Ratio between average dry weight of shoot (stem + leaves) and average
dry weight of roots:
Low nitrogen level: ...............
High nitrogen level: ...............
(7)
(3)
(5)
Task IIB
1 Total measured surface of the leaves.
Treatment
Leaves surface (cm2)
L (code LB .......)
....................
H (code HB .......)
....................
2 Total calculated average surface of the leaves from task IIA:
Treatment
Average leaf surface (cm2)
L
....................
H
....................
10
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
Task IIC
Total measured length of representative piece of root.
Treatment
Total length of the roots (cm)
L (code LC ......)
....................
H (code HC ......)
....................
(6)
(4)
Total calculated average root length of the plants from task IIA:
Treatment
Average root length (cm)
L
....................
H
....................
(2)
Calculated ratio between average leaf surface and average root length
of the plants from task IIA:
Treatment
average leaf surface
average root length
L
..................
H
..................
(2)
Which index gives the most information? (mark the correct answer)
O
shoot weight/root weight
O
leaf surface/root length
(6)
Which of the arguments below concerning the indexes are correct, and
which are not? Indicate your views by placing + (correct) or - (incorrect) in
the margin.
a
11
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
PRACTICAL TEST
4th International Biology Olympiad 1993
Section III: The effects of nitrogenous fertilization on the anatomy of the plant
(45 mins., hall 1)
In section II of the practical test you studied maize plants grown at two different
nitrogen levels. For each of these levels, you will now make a cross-section of a
piece of stalk.
The stalks have already been prepared for you for this purpose.
Dye your cross-sections with a solution of iodine in potassium iodide.
Study the anatomical structure of the stalk and the effects of nitrogenous fertilization
on this structure.
-
12
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
LIST III.A
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
Apical Meristem
Lateral Meristem
Cambium
Epidermis
Hypodermis
Exodermis
Cortex
Stele
Pith
Pith Ray
Vascular Bundle
Protophloem
Metaphloem
Secondary phloem
Protozylem
Metaxylem
Secondary Xylem
Parenchyma
Collenchyma
Sclerenchyma
Sclerenchyma Fibre
Scleride
Vessel
Sieve Tube
Sieve Cell
Companion Cell
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
Subsidiary Cell
Xylem Fibre
Phloem Fibre
Xylem Parenchyma
Phloem Parenchyma
Tracheaid
Bundle Sheath
Pit Pair
Chloroplast
Starch
Diameter Cell
Intercellular Space
Primary Cell Wall
Secondary Cell Wall
Lignin
LIST III.B
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G.
H.
I.
J.
present
absent
thicker
thinner
larger
smaller
larger amount
smaller amount
there are more cell layers
there are fewer cell layers
13
IBO-1993 - Practical Test
Cell type
(in figure III.1
Number
(in list III.A
Tissue
(in figure III.1
(25)
Number
(in list III.A)
Differences
Cell type/Tissue/Cell part
(number from list III.A)
Indicate with a + or - in the margin which statements can (+) and which cannot (-)
serve as possible explanations for the differences.
(2)
(2)
(2)
Plants which are cultivated under high nitrate conditions (high nitrate
plants) are able to form many new structures. In doing so, they use up
photosynthesis products, preventing the build up of starch in the plants.
Little energy is wasted on the storage and maintenance of reserve
materials in these plants. Low nitrate plants, on the other hand, need so
much energy for this that less energy is left over for growth.
A low starch content in high nitrate plants suggests that the processing
capacity is fairly equal to the photosynthesis capacity. Furthermore, it
appears that the photosynthesis occurs at a faster rate in these plants
than in low nitrate plants.
The slower rate of growth in low nitrate plants is the result of the smaller
amount of carbohydrates available for redistribution throughout the plant.
The slower rate of photosynthesis in low nitrate plants is a result of the
fact that there are fewer proteins and fewer leaves because more roots
have been formed. Because of this relatively small amount of "green"
biomass, the capacity for photosynthesis is relatively small. Conversely,
the larger root system leads to higher respiration. This causes the lower
16
IBO 1993 Practical Test
(2)
17
IBO 1993 Practical Test
PRACTICAL TEST
4th International Biology Olympiad 1993
Section IV:
Caution: For task IV.B you must take measurements with costly light meters of
which we only have a limited number. You will have to take turns. Pay
attention to each other and manage your time so that you can take a turn.
18
IBO 1993 Practical Test
Task IV.A
The increase in biomass for both species under the influence of two nitratefertilization levels is given in figure IV.2:
Calculate what the end yield is in dry weight per m for Lolium as well as for
Plantago based on the data from the graph.
Do this for the unfertilized and the fertilized case and fill in the calculated values
on the answer sheet.
Task IV.B
In the room, there are a number with trays of vegetation from grasslands with a high
(tray 1) and with a low (tray 2) nitrate-fertilization level.
Measure the luminosity (intensity of light) at different heights with the available
light meters. Measure every 10 cm starting at soil level.
Take care that the vegetation in the trays remains intact.
Make a graph on the answer sheet reflecting your findings in percentages of
the original light. Choose your axes yourself.
Rosette plants only grow moderately in the lower 10 cm of vegetation in the
case of nitrogen fertilization. A number of possible explanations for this are
given on the answer sheet. Indicate which suggestions can or cannot serve as
explanations.
19
IBO 1993 Practical Test
Task IV.C
The outcomes of a competition experiment between species 1 and species 2 are
given in figure IV.3.
In this experiment the species were cultivated in monoculture (with 10 plants of one
species per pot) as well as mixture (with 5 plants of species 1 and 5 of species 2 per
pot) during a growing season. The relative yield of the mixture with regard to the
monoculture is shown for species 1 and species 2 in this graph.
-
The line for species 2 bends upwards and the line for species 1 bends
downwards.
A number of suggestions as to why this is so are given on the answer sheet.
Indicate which suggestions can and which cannot serve as possible
explanations.
Finally, indicate on the answer sheet which of the two species is a rosette
plant.
End of section IV
20
IBO 1993 Practical Test
Lolium Perenne
...................
....................
Plantago lanceolata
...................
....................
(12)
Task IV.B
Graph
21
IBO 1993 Practical Test
(8)
(4)
Indicate with a + or - in the margin which statements can (+) and which cannot (-)
serve as possible explanations.
a
Rosette plants (for example Plantago) cannot grow better under high nitrate
fertilization conditions because the nitrate inhibits photosynthesis and,
consequently, growth.
Rosette plants are able to grow faster under low nitrate conditions because
more rain water reaches the soil.
The leaves of rosette plants receive little light in the case of high nitrogen
fertilization and therefore are only able to grow moderately.
Rosette plants develop a compact, stocky form in the case of high luminosity.
Under high nitrate fertilization conditions they receive less light and therefore
show higher growth and take on an ascending form.
Rosette plants dry out more quickly in the case of nitrogen fertilization
because all the rainwater reaches the soil by way of grass shoots, therefore
benefiting the grass.
The leaves of rosette plants are low in the vegetation and are overshadowed
by the longer grasses after fertilization, so that they are less able to
photosynthesize.
The leaves of rosette plants are low in the vegetation. Little CO2 is available
there because it is used up by the higher grasses. For this reason less
photosynthesis occurs.
Task IV.C
Indicate with a + or - in the margin which statements can (+) and which cannot (-)
serve as possible explanations.
a
(fill in: 1 or 2)
End of section IV
22
IBO 1993 Practical Test
PRACTICAL TEST
4th International Biology Olympiad 1993
Section V:
Task V.A
The nitrogen cycle for a West European grassland fertilized with nitrogen is given on
the answer sheet.
In figure V.1, a number of processes c.q. phenomena are missing.
Complete the schematic drawing.
Name the processes (phenomena) which are missing from the cycle.
Choose from the provided list of processes (phenomena).
Write the corresponding numbers in the correct places in figure V.1.
Task V.B
There are a number of water samples (samples 1, 2 and 3) in the room.
One sample is collected rainwater. The other two samples are both groundwater
collected at a depth of 50 cm. One of the samples is from an unfertilized natural
grassland and the other from a nearby agricultural grassland fertilized with nitrogen.
From each sample determine:
a) the acidity (pH) using the strip method.
b) the nitrate content using the strip method.
c) the ammonium content using the drip method.
The strip method is simple: dip, compare with the colouring chart and match
with a colour comparison value.
The drip method for ammonium is as follows:
1
Rinse the measuring vessel with the water to be tested and fill to the 5
ml mark.
2
Add 10 drops of reagent 1 and swirl.
3
Add 1 microspoon of reagent 2. Dissolve by swirling and wait or set
aside for 5 minutes.
4
Add 6 drops of reagent 3 and swirl.
5
After 5 minutes, place the measuring vessel on the colouring chart and
match with a colour comparison value.
-
Fill in your measurements on the answer sheet. Pay attention to the units of
measurement.
Fill in on the answer sheet where each sample comes from
For both grasslands, calculate the amount of run-off ammonium + nitrate per
m.
Do this using the fixed concentrations in the water samples and considering
the fact that the rainfall balance (precipitation minus evaporation) is 300 mm.
1 mm precipitation corresponds with 1 litre of rainwater
per m. Fill in your answers on the answer sheet.
23
IBO 1993 Practical Test
Task V.C
Two photographs of grassland A and grassland B are shown in fig. V.2.
24
IBO 1993 Practical Test
In many countries in Europe and America extra nitrate and ammonium is added to
natural areas by "acid rain".
On the answer sheet there are some descriptions of what could happen to the
variety of plant species in originally nutrient-poor nature reserves when extra
nitrate and ammonium are added by way of "acid rain". Indicate which
descriptions are correct or incorrect.
25
IBO 1993 Practical Test
Complete the figure. Choose the correct processes/phenomena out of the list and
write the corresponding numbers in the right places in the figure.
List of phenomena (task V.1)
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
denitrification
mineralization
N-fixation
acid rain
nitrification
sulphate reduction
herbivore
methanogenesis
ammonia volatilization
soil leaching
run off
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
ammonification
harvest
photosynthesis
assimilation
volcanic emission
soil weathering
soil fixation
N allocation
transpiration
respiration
retranslocation
26
IBO 1993 Practical Test
(8)
Task V.B
The measured values are (pay attention to units of measurement):
sample 1
sample 2
sample 3
(3)
(6)
pH
Ammonium
Nitrate
........
........
........
.............
.............
.............
............
............
............
........
fertilized grassland
........
unfertilized grassland
........
...............
...............
(1)
Task V.C
The grassland with the greatest variety of species is: .............
(fill in A or B)
(1)
The grassland that has been fertilized with nitrates and ammonium the most is:
...........
(fill in A or B)
(10)
Indicate with a + or - in the margin which descriptions can (+) and which cannot (-)
serve as possible explanations.
a
the variety of plant species does not change as a result of extra nitrogen
compounds in the air, because in almost all cases, phosphor limits growth
and, therefore, no overshadowing by extra growth can occur
the variety of plant species will decrease, because a number of fast-growing
plant species (usually grasses) will increase, and the amount of light close to
the ground is strongly limited causing many low-plant species to disappear
the variety of species will only increase if the initial conditions were very poor
in nutriments, as a result of which hardly any plant species could grow.
Because of the extra nitrogen boost, more plant species can grow in the
beginning and, thus, the variety of species will increase.
the variety of plant species will not change, because all extra nitrogen
compounds conveyed from the air, under dry as well as wet environmental
conditions, are fully denitrificated and are released into the atmosphere as
nitrogen gas
the variety of species will not change because the soil has the effect of a
buffer, so that the concentration of nitrogen compounds available to the plant
is kept practically constant
28
IBO 1993 Practical Test
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
II INTERNATIONAL
BIOLOGY
OLYMPIAD
22. Lung ventilation is necessary to maintain concentration of carbon dioxide and oxygen of the
following relation:
C02
02
a) high high;
b) low low;
c) low high;
d) high low.
23. In a plant cell the organelles separated by two membranes from cytoplasm
are:
a) the nucleus only; b) the mitochondria and the plastides only;
c) the nucleus, the mitochondria and the plastides;
d) the mitochondria, the lysosomes and the plastides.
24. What days of female menstrual cycle fertilization is mostly probable?
a) the 7-th the 9-th;
b) the 8-th the 10-th;
c) the 11-th the 17-th;
d) the 21-th the 28-th.
25. Sexual reproduction in plants and animals:
a) increases variation;
b) reduces variation;
c) is able to promote or reduce variation; d) has no effect on variation.
26. Cells from the skin of a person suffering from Down's syndrome are examined through the
microscope. Which of the following could be observed in each cell?
a) additional chromosome;
b) the shortage of chromosomes;
c) a haploid set of chromosomes;
d) chromosome number differs from that in adjacent cells.
27. Human individual features depend:
a) on genotype entirely; b) on environment impact entirely;
c) on interaction between genotype and environment;
d) on parents genotype entirely.
28. DNA composition analysis showed that one of the listed correlations cannot change:
)/T; b) G/C; c) A+T/G+C; d) A+G/T+C.
29. Bacteria are characterised by the following peculiarity:
a) they have a cell structure; b) they are diploid;
c) they can be seen through the powerful microscope;
d) they are free living, parasitic or symbiotic organisms.
30. Which of the listed below organs produce non-active enzyme forerunner into mammal's
digestive tract?
a) salivary glands; b) pancreas; c) gall bladder; d) liver.
31. Which of the listed below processes is not connected with adrenaline action?
a) stimulation glycogen change to glucose;
b) speeding up the heart contractions;
c) intensification peristalsis of the intestine;
d) pupil's dilating.
32. A simple key for determination four different plants is worked up:
1. The vascular tissues are present...................2;
The vascular tissues are absent...........Plant A.
2. Male gametes have flagellums.........................3;
Male gametes don't have flagellums......Plant B.
3. Spores of one type..................................Plant C;
Spores of two type...................................Plant D.
Which of this plants is an angiosperm one?
a) A; b)B; ) C; d) D.
33. The sporophyte generation of the flower plant is a diploid one. Then its
endosperm is:
a) n; b) 2n; c) 3n; d) 4n.
34. The diagrams illustrate the situation, when:
a) 1 and 2;
b) 1 and 4;
c) 2 and 5;
d) 3 and 4.
36. Which of the soil processes is useless for vascular plants?
a) nitrogen fixation from atmosphere; b) oxidation ammonium compounds;
c) oxidation nitrites into nitrates;
d) reduction nitrates to nitrogen.
37. Vitamin, which is the most important for growth and crepuscular vision,
is:
a) A; b)B; ) C; d) D.
38. Breathing is more rapid, when physical load is concerned with?
a) high 02 blood concentration;
b) low 02, blood concentration;
c) high C02 blood concentration;
d) low C02 blood concentration.
Antibodies Rh+
-
41. The nerve impulse travels in the organism by one of the listed below ways:
a) dendrite > synapse > neuron body > axon;
b) axon > neuron body > dendrite > synapse;
c) dendrite > neuron body > axon > synapse;
d) dendrite > synapse > axon > neuron body.
42. Transfer of Rh is:
a) transfer of genetic information from DA/A to mRNA;
b) transfer of information from mRNA to rRNA;
c) organition of amino acids according to the codons;
d) recognition of anticodons mRNA.
43. Which of J.B. Lamark's statements is turned down nowadays?
a) sometimes it is difficult to distinguish one species from another with the help
morphological features;
b) living beings vary; c) benefit features are heredited;
d) living beings adapt themselves to the environment.
44. Which of the number pyramids correlates with the food chain: plants-aphid (Aphididae) ladybird (Coccinellidae)l
45. Which of the listed birds will get more evolution benefit?
Bird
Number
laid eggs
hatched nestling
reproducing offspring
a)
9
8
2
b)
2
2
2
c)
9
9
3
d)
7
5
4
46. The general cause of verdure correlated variations from the South to the North and from
the plain to the peaks of the mountains, i.e. with increasing latitude as well as altitude is
connected with:
a) while altitude as well as latitude increases temperature declines;
b) sun lights fall angle is smaller on mountain slopes;
c) clouds gather over the mountain peaks;
d) plants have some difficulties about slope setting.
58. How many centrioles are seen in the beginning of prophase in human
cell?
a)l; b)2; c) 4; d) a lot.
59. How many chromosomes one can observe simultaneously when anaphase
finishes in human skin cell?
a) 23; b)46; c) 69; d) 92.
60. Home fly (Musca domestica) is able to adapt to environmental changes
quicker than human because:
a) it is smaller;
b) it is a good flyer;
c) it has a great number of offspring; d) rapid succession of generations occurs.
61. Lipid's binary membranes are not freely permeable to which of the following
molecules?
a) oxygen; b) carbon dioxide; c) amino acids; d) water.
62. The result of Na+-K+-pump function is not:
a) low NaT concentration in the cell;
b) facilitated diffusion of amino acids into the cell;
c) developing the proton's gradient of concentration;
d) high K+ concentration in the cell.
63. If one-cell animal (Amoeba proteus) and the erythrocyte are put into distillate water:
a) both cells would be destroyed;
b) amoeba would be died, and the erythrocyte would go on living;
c) amoeba would go on living and the erythrocyte would be died;
d) both cells would go on living.
64. Which of the following ways of transporting molecules across membranes utilise ATP
directly?
a) diffusion;
b) Na+-K+-pump;
c) facilitated diffusion;
d) transporting across open channels.
65. Of the following crosses, which is a testcross?
a) AA x aa;
b) AA x Aa;
c) Aa x Aa;
d) Aa x aa.
66. When a healthy mouse is infected with Pneumococcus, it is likely to become ill and die if the
Pneumococcus is:
a) heat-killed;
b) is alive, but lacking a polysaccharide coat;
c) a mixture of some heat-killed Pneumococcus having polysaccharide coat and some
Pneumococcus lacking coat;
d) both lacking polysaccharide coat and heat-killed.
67. The eucaryotic cell, with one more chromosome is:
a) diploid; b) haploid; c) aneuploid; d) monoploid.
68. Who proposed a coherent theory in the field of evolution first:
a) Charles Darwin;
b) Jean Baptiste de Lamark;
c) Alfred Wallace;
d) Julian Kuxley.
69. In the rocks of nearly 3,5 milliard years the fossils are found of:
a) viruses; b) dinosaurs; c) bacteria; d) algae.
84. You sneeze and have watery eyes every spring. Your physician tests you and says that
you are allergic to pollen of a plant Ambrosia. You guess that Ambrosia is:
a) high plant;
b) insects pollinated;
c) wind pollinated;
d) excreta phytoncids.
85. All helminths are characterised by:
a) the digestive system is absent;
b) high reproduction intensity;
c) the senses are absent;
d) hermaphroditism.
86. There are 24 chromosomes in the cells of pine {Pinus sylvestris) leaves. Then its endosperm
would contains chromosomes:
a) 12 chromosomes; b) 24 chromosomes; c) 36 chromosomes; d) 48 chromosomes.
87. Which of the listed pairs aren't homologous organs?
a) tendrils in grapes (VWs) and tendrils in the garden pea (Pisum);
b) tendrils in grapes (Vitis) and strawberry {Fragaria) runners;
c) tendrils in grapes (Vitis) and hawthorn (Crataegus) prickles;
d) needles (Pimis) and cactus prickles (Mammillaria).
88. The seed germinating on the soil surface has a root growing vertically nevertheless of
seed's posture. It is because of:
a) negative heliotropism;
b) positive geotropism;
c) substratum structure;
d) positive hydrotropism.
89. Organic compounds pass through xylem:
a) after autumn leaf-fall only;
b) at night only;
c) only when buds of leaf-fall trees develop; d) never.
90. Sponges (Porifera) digestion is:
a) out intestine; b) in the cavity; c) in the cell; d) b + c.
91. The common features for Annelida and Arthropoda are:
a) exoskeleton;
b) having extremities;
c) closed circulatory system;
d) segmentation.
92. Lymnaea stagnalis - lung mollusc, inhabiting water permanently, lay his eggs:
a) on above-water plant parts; b) into the bank soil;
c) on underwater plant parts; d) digs into silt.
93. Flatworms (Plathelminthes):
a) don't have any circulatory system and body cells get their feed and oxygen as a result
of diffusion;
b) have closed circulatory system and a heart;
c) have opened circulators' system;
d) don't need any circulatory system because they don't have any organs.
94. Air flows through birds lung:
a) on inhalation from the tail to the head;
b) on exhalation from the head to the tail;
c) on inhalation and on exhalation from the tail to the head;
d) on inhalation from the head to the tail and on exhalation from the tail to the head.
recolonization;
coprophagous;
symbiote;
symplast;
sporophyte;
thermophobic;
tissue;
evolution;
8. rhizome;
9. crossing-over;
10. xerophyte;
19. parthenogenesis;
20. pericardium;
29.
30.
neuston;
etology.
136. The certain or by chance movement of organisms of some species from the
area lines...
137. The permanent or temporary living together organisms of various species
in which one of the partners eats meat residues or excretes of the other
not harming it...
138. Vegetative genetically identical offspring of one organism...
139. An organism which eats excrements of other animals, mainly mammals..
140. A group of living beings inhabiting upper level of water on the border
with air...
141. Artificial return to some territory of the species extinct there before...
142. Origin of living beings from former living forms...
143. Plants of arid habitants stable to overheating and dehydrating because
of a number of adaptive features...
144. Colourless plastides of various form and function in plant cells...
145. Organism inhabiting at permanent low temperature conditions...
146. The exchange of corresponding chromatid segments between homologous
chromosomes responsible for new combinations of various alleles...
147. Reproducing part of hearing system of mammals and humans, which
transfer the energy of sound waves into the nervous impulse...
148. The independent development of similar structures in unrelated organisms
to identical environment...
149. Interaction between members of the population of one species or various
species in order to obtain a mutually required resource available in limited
supply...
150. Variant of bone tissue forming the placoid fish scales and the main
part of mammals teeth...
151. Liquid tissue circulating in insects body...
152. The type of evolution coming into existence of taxons higher than
species...
153. The outer crease of the skin in Mollusca, Brachiopoda, Cirripedia covering
the whole body or its part...
154. Embodiment of plant or animal cells in tissues while out-cells matter
is destroying or dissolving...
155. A symbiotic association between fungi and the roots of a vascular plant...
156. Origin of the group of organisms from common ancestor...
138. Vegetative genetically identical offspring of one organism...
139. An organism which eats excrements of other animals, mainly mammals..
140. A group of living beings inhabiting upper level of water on the border
with air...
141. Artificial return to some territory of the species extinct there before...
142. Origin of living beings from former living forms...
143. Plants of arid habitants stable to overheating and dehydrating because
of a number of adaptive features...
144. Colourless plastides of various form and function in plant cells...
145. Organism inhabiting at permanent low temperature conditions...
146. The exchange of corresponding chromatid segments between homologous
chromosomes responsible for new combinations of various alleles...
147. Reproducing part of hearing system of mammals and humans, which
transfer the energy of sound waves into the nervous impulse...
148. The independent development of similar structures in unrelated organisms
to identical environment...
149. Interaction between members of the population of one species or various
species in order to obtain a mutually required resource available in limited
supply...
150. Variant of bone tissue forming the placoid fish scales and the main
part of mammals teeth...
151. Liquid tissue circulating in insects body...
152. The type of evolution coming into existence of taxons higher than
species...
153. The outer crease of the skin in Mollusca, Brachiopoda, Cirripedia covering
the whole body or its part...
154. Embodiment of plant or animal cells in tissues while out-cells matter
is destroying or dissolving...
155. A symbiotic association between fungi and the roots of a vascular plant...
156. Origin of the group of organisms from common ancestor...
46
157. The course of development of an individual, the whole complex of transformations
Answers:
. a) b) c) d) e) f) g) h)
i) j) k) 1) m) n) o) ....
167. What terms refer to types of interactions of the living organisms, which are
shown in the figure?
The codes of the answers:
1. neutralism;
3. mutualism;
5. predation;
2. commensalism;
4. parasitism;
6. competition.
Answers: a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f) ....
168. Find the connection between terms and structures, which are shown in the
figure:
The codes of the answers:
1. uterus cavity;
2. cervix;
3. miometrium;
4. endometrium;
5. vagina;
6. chorion;
7. chorion villus;
8. placenta;
9. amnion;
10. amnion cavity;
11. umbilical cord;
12. allantois;
13. resides of yolk sac.
Answers:
a) b) c)
g)
h) i)
d)
j)
e)
k)
f)
l)
m)....
169. Find the connection between the families of plants and flower diagrams,
which are shown in the figure:
The codes of the answers:
1. Magnoliaceae;
6. Lamiaceae;
2. Ranunculaceae;
7. Solanaceae;
3. Rosaceae;
8. Liliaceae;
4. Fabaceae;
9. Orchidaceae;
5. Brassicaceae;
10. Poaceae.
Answers: a)
b)
c)
d) e)
f) g)
h)
i) j) ....
173. From the listed information collect the data about spider (Arachnida).
The codes of the answers:
1. Members:
a) scorpion (Scorpiones);
b) slater (Oniscoidea);
c) crawfish (Palinuridae); d) cyclop (Cyclopes);
e) mite (Acarina);
f) solifuga (Solifugae).
2. Species number:
a) nearly 1 million; b) nearly 35000; c) nearly 60000.
3. Their body is clearly subdivided into the head, thorax and abdomen.
4. The body is formed by cephalothorax - prosoma and abdomen epistosoma, can consist of different number of segments.
5. Segments are organized into tagmas - the head, the thorax, the abdomen.
In many species the basal of the head is covered by chitin fold - carapace.
6. Antennas are absent.
7. There is one pair of antennas.
8. There are two pairs of antennas.
9. There are mandibular and maxillas.
10. There are cheliceras and pedipalps.
11. There are 3 pairs of walking legs on the thorax.
12. There are 4 pairs of walking and feeding legs.
13. There are 5 pairs of walking legs.
14. The legs are uniramulous.
15. The legs are biramulous.
16. There are simple eyes (ocellus) in different number (from 1-2 pairs
to 8 pairs; 4 pairs usually on the cephalothorax).
17. There are two types of eyes - compound (in the most species) or simple
(ocellus).
18. The eyes are compound (in many species) or there is the unpaired
nauplial eye.
19. The nervous system is formed alike the one in primitive Arthropods
and even Annelids: this is the brain, consisting of overesophageal
double ganglia and ventral nerve cord.
20. The nervous system is concentrated. The dorsal ganglia (brain) is
fused with the subesophageal ganglia. In some species one or more
nervous ganglia of ventral nerve cord are remained.
21. They are the unique invertebrate animals who are capable to distinguish
sounds.
22. The excretory system is formed by Malpighian tubules.
23. Antennas glands or maxillary glands are excretory system.
24. Sexual glands and Malpighian tubules are excretory system.
25. There are two variants of respiratory system: tracheas and/or lungs.
Some small animals do not have neither lungs nor tracheas.
26. They breathe through the gills, but when they are absent - through
the body surface.
27. Breathing occurs by the help of tracheas system or through the body surface.
28. There are respiratory pigments in the blood.
29. The process of development involves incomplete or complete metamorphosis.
30. In the most species the process of development involves metamorphosis. The certain larva nauplius - hatches from the egg.
31. The process of development is a direct one or involves metamorphosis.
32. Moult is common for larva as well as for adults.
33. Adults do not moult.
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
I INTERNATIONAL
BIOLOGY
OLYMPIAD
1. A relict is:
a) a rapidly spreading organism that is not indigenous to the given area;
b) the term for an organism causing dangerous disease;
c) a genetically unstable hybrid;
d) an organism which in the given area is a remainder from earlier times, when it was widespread.
2. As a result of intensive nitrogen use of fertilizers this one has spread to a number of
biotopes which are not typical of it:
a) coltsfoot (Tussilago far far a);
b) viper's bugloss (Echium vulgare);
c) great nettle (Urtica diodica);
d) dandelion (Taraxacum officinale).
3. The highest gross primary production is typical of the ecosystem:
a) beech wood; b) meadow; c) mountain pine forest; d) oak grove.
4. Water organisms characterized by striking active movement are known as:
a) plankton; b) benthos; c) nekton; d) pleuston.
5. Indicate which ecological group is referred to the plants which have a thin, fragile stalk
with reduced mechanical tissue, inside the stem are large intercellular spaces, the leaves are
fleshy with a thin cuticle...
a) mesophyte; b) hygrophyte; c) xerophyte; d) thermophyte.
6. The marking of territory is particularly significant for:
a) finding a partner;
b) genetic adaptation;
c) a successful struggle for survival;
d) competition within a species.
7. Putrefactive bacteria belong to:
a) producers;
c) consumers of the 2-nd order;
33. In a case where one parent has blood group 0 and the other - AB, the
children may belong to the group:
34. In the interbreeding of individuals with genotypes AABb and aaBb the
following genotype cannot occur in further generations:
a) AABb; b) AaBb; c) AaBB; d) Aabb.
35. The biogenetic law (onthogenesis is an abbreviation of phylogenesis)
was formulated by:
a) E. Haeckel; b) G. Cuvier; c) J.B. Lamarck; d) Ch. Darwin.
36. Among the oil soluble vitamin is:
a) vitamin K; b) pyridoxine; c) thiamin; d) vitamin .
37. Which tree releases allelopathic substances to the environment?
a) beech (Fagus sylvatica);
b) sallow (Salix caprea);
c) bastard acacia (Robinia pseudacacia);
d) small-leaved lime (Tilia cordata).
38. During which process most energy quantity is released?
a) photolysis; b) glycolysis;
c) Krebs cycle (the cycle of citric acid);
d) final oxidation in the respiration chain.
39. Some substances enter a photosynthesising cell and some leave the
a) 0, AB, A, B; b) , ; c) 0, AB; d) AB.
cell:
a) glucose and CO, water and 02;
b) glucose and 02 water and C02;
c) water and 0, glucose and C02;
d) water and C02 - glucose and 02.
40. Which of the given actions are linked with the primary processes of 49 photosynthesis
(with the light phase):
The codes of the answers: 1. photolysis; 2. Calvin cycle;
3. elimination 02;
4. absorption C02.
a) 1, 2; b) 1, 3;
c) 2, 3; d) 2, 4.
41. The energetic effect of anaerobic glycolysis are 2 molecules of:
a) lactic acid;
b) pyruvic acid;
c) ATP;
d) ethanol.
42. In the photosynthesis of C3-plants the acceptor of C02 is:
a) 3-phosphoglycerol aldehyde;
b) ribulose-l,5-diphosphate; 51
c) phosphoenolpyruvic acid;
d) ferredoxin
43. Photorespiration is a process typical for:
a) all plants without exception in roughly the same intensity;
b) mainly C4-plants;
c) mainly C3-plants;
d) this process is not typical for plants. 52
44. The following has a marked capacity for vegetative reproduction:
a) orache (Atriplex);
b) plantain (Plantago);
c) coltsfoot (Tussilago);
d) chicory (Cichorium).
45. Gametophyte is in the life of plants a generation which:
a) creates gametes through the process known as meiosis;
b) arises from gametes;
c) arises as a result of the combining of gametes;
d) is created by cells with a haploid number of chromosomes in the nucleus.
b) Claviceps purpurea;
d) Saccharomyces cerevisiae.
66. When at rest the surface of the membrane of a nerve cell is:
a) electropositive; b) electronegative; c) electroneutral; d) without electric charge.
67. The composition of lymph (sap) is similar to the composition of blood
plasma. Select the correct statement:
a) proteins are lacking in lymph;
b) there are more proteins in honph than in plasma;
c) there are less proteins in lymph than in plasma;
d) the difference is in the quality of Na+ ions.
68. The semilunar valves separate:
a) the chambers of the heart from the arteries; b) the left ventricle from the right atrium;
c) the right ventricle from the left atrium;
d) hollow veins from the right atrium.
69. Progesteron is eliminated by:
a) the Graafian follicle;
b) the corpus luteum (Yellow body);
c) the maturing egg;
d) the ovulating egg.
70. The biosynthesis of proteins takes place in all cells of the human organism
with the exception of:
a) the cells of the pancreatic gland;
b) the cells of the mucous membrane of the intestine;
c) mature red corpuscles (erythrocytes);
d) white blood corpuscles (lymphocytes).
71. The veins (trachea) of the altered root of mistletoe (Viscum) grow through
a pine (Pinus) branch, for instance, into the:
a) pithy part of the vascular bundle (phloem);
b) woody part of the vascular bundle (xylem);
c) pith of the branch;
d) immediate surroundings of individual vascular bundles, but do not penetrate them.
72. Sexual reproduction in Infusoria with gene recombination takes place
by:
a) encystation; b) strobilation; c) conjugation; d) longitudinal splitting.
73. The mesoderm appears first in phylogenesis in the:
a) Scyphozoa; b) Turbellaria;
c) Tracheata;
d) Annelida.
74. The symbiosis between termite (Isoptera) and the microorganisms, living
in their intestines and feeding on cellulose is an example of:
a) competition; b) predation; c) mutualism; d) commensalism.
75. Various tissues and organs are formed from the ecto-, meso- and endoderm.
Which combination is correct?
ectoderm
mesoderm
endoderm
a)
blood
lungs
b)
large intestine
lungs
c)
skin
bone
kidneys
d)
epidermis
liver
heart
76. The human organism does not synthesise and must therefore require
from food:
a) purines;
b) pyrimidines;
c) fructose; d) aromatic amino acids.
77. Caterpillars of the cabbage white (Pieris brassicae) form a chrysalis:
a) underground near a nutrition's plant;
b) on various objects above ground (trees, posts, walls);
c) on a food plant;
d) do not make a chrysalis because it is an insect with imperfect metamorphosis.
78. Colorado beetle (Leptinotarsa decemlineata) was brought to Europe from
North America in:
a) 1925;
b) 1938;
c) 1947;
d) 1914.
79. Cricket (Gryllidae) chirp:
a) by rubbing their front wings together;
b) by rubbing the front wing against the back leg;
c) by means of a special organ on the lower side of the thorax;
d) by pushing collected air out through the stigmata.
80. Rotifers (Rotatoria), like all roundworms (Nemathelminthes), do not have a developed.
system.
a) digestive; b) eliminative; c) respiratory; d) nervous.
81. Halters are:
a) moisture loving ribbon like shapes of the spores of horsetails;
b) part of the mandibles of some beetles;
c) the reduced wings, for example, of the mosquitos;
d) the sensitive cilia on the rear part of the body of homoptera.
82. Which type of parasitic worms has a stage of development with life in fresh
water?
a) roundworm (Ascaris lumbricoides);
b) nematode worm (Trichinella spiralis);
c) beef tapeworm (Taeniarhynchus saginatus);
d) liver rot (Fasciola hepatica).
83. Parthenogenesis can occur in all the following organisms with the exception
of:
a) rotifers (Rotatoria);
b) insects (Insecta);
c) crustaceous (Crustacea);
d) spiders (Arachnida).
84. What is the largest number of elements of which an insect's leg may be
made up?
a) 5;
b)6;
c) 9;
d) 15.
85. Planorbis breathe:
a) through gills hidden by part of the shell so that they are actually within the body;
b) through two external gills;
c) through a lung sac formed from the wall of the shell hollow;
d) through a single gill (ctenidium) near the anal opening.
86. Chorda (chorda dorsalis) is preserved in mature age by:
a) sea squirts (Ascidiae);
b) sturgeon (Acipenser);
c) lamprey (Petromyzones);
d) dipnoan fish (Protopterus).
87. The most primitive placental mammals are:
a) insect-eating mammals (Insectivora);
b) marsupials (Marsupialia);
c) rodents (Rodentia);
d) protothere (Monotremata).
88. In herbivores the food returns to the mouth for cuddling from:
a) the crop (ingluvies);
b) the honeycomb (reticidum);
c) the second stomach (rumen);
d) the psalterium (omasum).
89. European species of amphibians live on a diet which is:
a) mainly animal;
b) mainly vegetable;
c) for the young - vegetable, for adult - animal;
Answers:
a) ...; b) ...; c) ...; d) ...; e)
102.
Answers:
a) a) ...; b) ...; c) ...; d) ...; e)
103.
Answers:
a) a) ...; b) ...; c) ...; d) ...; e)
104.
Answers:
a) a) ...; b) ...; c) ...; d) ...; e)
Answers:
)...; b) .. ).. d) ....
***Following information deals with the questions 109-110.
The are schemes of embryogeny of bird (109) and mammal (110) are represented
on the figures. Numerate on the schemes:
The codes of the answers:
1. yolk sac;
4. chorion;
2. amnion;
5. navel string;
3. allantois;
6. chorionic villus.
109.
Answers:
a ) . . . ; b)
c)
d) . . . .
110. Answers:
a ) . . . ; b)
c)
d) . . . . e)
f)
1. cell body;
2. axon;
3. dendrite;
4. Schwann cell;
Answers:
a)
b)
5. node of Ranvier;
6. presynaptic membrane;
7. postsynaptic membrane.
c)
d)
e)
f)
g) . . . .
112. Stages of the cell's cycle are marked by numbers. Find the according
between the numerals on the figure I and letters, which dente the stages of cell's
cycle, on figure II.
Answers:
a)
b)
113.
c)
d)
e) . . . .
f)
of lancelet:
g)
h)
f)
117. There are schemes of situation of the conductive textures in the cross-cuts of stalk
of extinct rhynia (1), of club-moss (2), of horsetail (3), of fern (4) and pine (5). Numerate on the schemes (ph - phloem, x - xylem).
Answers: a)
b)
c)
d)
e) . . . .
b)
c)
d)
e)
A ) . . . ; B)
C)
D) . . . .
119. Outgoing from the ecological regularity, complement the Figure into squares
with the denominations of such plant's species, which can constitute, as a result, fragment
of defoliated forest with natural species composition. Order of designation of species in a
separate several horizons are not important.
The codes of the answers:
1. durmast oak (Ouercus petraea);
2. small-leaved lime (Tilia cordata);
3. European hazel (Corytus avellana);
4. weymouth pine {Pinus strobus);
5. golden osier {Salix alba);
6. European hornbeam (Carpinus betulus);
7. loranth {Loranthus europaeus);
8. juniper common (Juniperus communis);
9. frail (Phragmites australis);
10. daphne february {Daphne mezereum);
11. annual meadow grass {Poa annua);
12. fescue (Festuca rubra);
13. nightshade black (Solanum nigrum);
14. chickling (Lathyrus vernus);
15. mustard dish (Thlaspi arvense);
16. wood bluegrass {Poa nemoralis);
17. Symphoricarpos alba;
18. Nardus strica.
Answers: a)
b)
c)
d) . . . .
All IBO examination questions are published under the following Creative Commons license:
CC BY-NC-SA (Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike) https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc-sa/4.0/
The exam papers can be used freely for educational purposes as long as IBO is credited and
new creations are licensed under identical terms. No commercial use is allowed.
I IBiO